Sunteți pe pagina 1din 355

UNIVERSITY OF THE PHILIPPINES

COLLEGE OF LAW
Bar Operations 2008

COMMERCIAL LAW

Bar Operations Head Arianne Reyes

Academics Head Henry Aguda


Ryan Balisacan

Subject Head Henry Aguda


Tere Licaros

Subject Committee Lynn Ramos * Johaira Wahab


Ruby Alberto * Dianne Capco

Information Management Chino Baybay [Head] * Simoun Salinas [Deputy] *


Committee Rania Joya [Design & Lay-out] * Ludee Pulido
[Documentations] * Linus Madamba * Des Mayoralgo *
Jillian De Dumo * Mike Ocampo * Abel Maglanque *
Edan Marri R. Caete * Carmie Rome Cargo

Commercial Law
TABLE OF CONTENTS CRIMINAL LAW I

TABLE OF CONTENTS

I. Corporation Law 3
II. Negotiable Instruments Law 88
III. Insurance Code 125
IV. Transportation Law
203
V. Code of Commerce
255
VI. Banking Law
275
VII. Intellectual Property Law
327

100% UP LAW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 2 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

CORPORATION LAW Has the powers, attributes and properties expressly


authorized by law or incident to its existence: as it
a. is a mere creature of the law, it can exercise only
such powers as the law may choose to grant it,
either expressly or impliedly
THE CORPORATION CODE OF THE
PHILIPPINES

(BATAS PAMBANSA BLG. 68) 1.3..Advantages of the Corporate


Organizations

1) Separate juridical personality personality


Chapter I separate and distinct from individual
stockholders and members
INTRODUCTION
2) Limited liability to investors stockholders are
liable only to the extent of their contribution
1. The Corporation as a Legal
General rule: Where a corporation buys all
Concept
the shares of another corporation, this will
not operate to dissolve the other
1.1 Corporation Defined corporation and as the two corporations
still maintain their separate corporate
A Corporation is an artificial being created by entities, one will not answer for the debts
operation of law, having the right of succession and of the other. [Nell v Pacific Farms (15 SCRA
the powers, attributes, and properties expressly 415), Nov. 23, 1965]
authorized by law or incident to its existence. (2) Exceptions:
A corporation is a creature of: o If there is an express assumption of
liabilities;
A general enabling statute (requirements of o There is a consolidation or merger;
the law must be complied with); and o If the purchase was in fraud of
The agreement of individuals who seek to creditors;
incorporate (internal contractual o If the purchaser becomes a
arrangements: articles of incorporation and continuation of the seller;
by-laws). o If there are unpaid subscriptions
(stockholder is liable for the unpaid
balance).
1.2 Four attributes of a corporation
An artificial being: 3) Free transferability of units of ownership
stockholders hold their shares as personal
1. a juridical person capable of having rights property with rights to dispose, assign or
and obligations, w/ a personality separate encumber them as they may desire (63)
and distinct from its members or
stockholders 4) Centralized Management all corporate powers
2. hence, stockholders are not personally are exercised by the board of directors (23)
liable for corp. obligations and cannot be
held liable to third persons who have claims 1.4 Partnership vs. Corporation
against the corp. beyond their agreed
contribution to the corporate capital (paid- 1. Extent of Liabilitypartners are personally
up capital and unpaid subscriptions) This is liable for the debts of the partnership;
known as the doctrine of limited liability. stockholders cannot be made to personally
answer to corporate creditors
2. Creationmere agreement of the parties,
Created by operation of law: w/c can be composed of just 2 persons,
1. mere consent of the parties to form a corp. gives rise to the juridical personality of the
is not sufficient: the State must give its partnership, whether or not registered w/
consent either through a special law (in the the SEC (Art. 1768, NCC); a corp., w/ a
case of a govt corp.) or a general law (for minimum of 5 incorporators, derives its
a private corp.) juridical personality from the certificate
2. the general law under w/c a private corp. issued by the SEC (19)
may be formed or organized is the 3. ManagementIn most cases, all the
Corporation Code owners in a partnership actively participate
in management, w/ capacity to bind it by
any usual contract (Art. 1818, NCC); in a
Has the right of succession: corp., management is centralized in the
1. its continued existence during the term board of directors w/c has exclusive power
stated in its articles of incorp. cannot be to bind the corp. (23)
affected by any change in the members or 4. Nature of Relationshippartnership is
stockholders based on mutual trust and confidence
2. nor is it affected by the transfer of shares (delectus personae) so that its existence is
by a stockholder to a 3rd person precarious because of the facility w/ which
it can be dissolved (i.e. through the death
or unilateral act of a partner); a corp. has
more stability as it enjoys the right of

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 3 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

succession and is not affected by the death 1. Devices or schemes employed by, or any
or insolvency of a stockholder; also, act of, the BOD, business associates,
dissolution before a corp.s term requires a officers or partners, amounting to fraud or
2/3rds vote of the stock (Secs. 118 and misrepresentation which may be
119, Corp. Code), always subject to SEC detrimental to the interest of the public
intervention and/or of the stockholders, partners or
5. Powersa corporation has only such members of any corporation, partnership,
powers as are expressly granted to it and or association;
such as are necessary to the exercise of the 2. Controversies arising out of intra-
powers so granted or fro the corporate, partnership, or association
accomplishment of its purpose(sec.2, 36 relations, between and among
(11), and 45); In a partnership, as long as stockholders, members or associates; and
the parties have agreed to it, the between, any or all of them and the
partnership can perform any act as long as corporation, partnership, or association of
it does not violate any law or right of which they are stockholders, members or
others. associates, respectively;
3. Controversies in the election or
1.5 Government Regulation of Corporations appointment of directors, trustees,
officers, or managers of corporations,
By the Legislature
partnerships, or associations;
Basis: police power of the state (Northern Ry Co. v. 4. Derivative suits; and
State of Washington, 300 U.S. 154) and the fact 5. Inspection of corporate books.
that corporations owe their existence to the state
Manner: by amending or repealing the Corp. Code Morato v CA (2004)
or any part thereof
Petitioners, stockholders of TF Ventures, Inc., filed
a petition with the SEC against private respondents
NDC v Phil Veterans Bank (1990) for the declaration of nullity of stockholders and
directors meetings and damages. They assail the
PD 1717 ordered the rehabilitation of the Agrix validity of the notice and stockholders meeting of
Group of Companies to be administered by NDC. TF Ventures, Inc. and the organizational meeting of
Sec 4(1) provides that all mortgages and liens the members of the BOD. The petition was referred
presently attached be extinguished, and that all to the Securities Investigation and Clearing
accrued obligations shall not bear interest. Among Department (SICD) of the SEC for investigation and
those ordered extinguished was a lien in favor of resolution.
Phil Veterans Bank over prop in LB. NDC filed to Meanwhile, one of the private respondents
foreclose the mortgage. (Matsura, Chairman of the BOD), wrote a letter to
the Examiners and Appraisers Dept of the SEC,
HELD: New Agrix was created by special decree requesting for an examination of the basis for the
even if 1973 Consti mandates that Batasang capital increase of T.F. Ventures, Inc. from
Pambansa, cannot, except by general law, provide P10,000,000 to P100,000,000, alleging the
for formation, organization and regulation of commission of devices, schemes and criminal acts.
private corps, unless for GOCCs. The letter was forwarded by the SEC to the
NDC was only mandated to extend loan and to Prosecution and Enforcement Dept (PED).
manage company. New Agrix was entirely private Petitioners contended that with the filing of the
and should have been organized under Corp Law. letter-petition with the PED, Matsura resorted to
forum shopping.

HELD: Matsura is not guilty of forum shopping.


By the SEC There is no identity of causes of action or identity
of rights asserted by the parties in both cases. In
Basis: Sec. 3, PD 902-A and Sec 5.1(a), RA8799. this case, SEC Case is pending before the SICD,
The Commission shall have absolute jurisdiction, which has exclusive jurisdiction to investigate and
supervision and control over all corporations, resolve intra-corporate disputes. The respondents
partnerships or associations, who are the grantees letter-petition, on the other hand, was referred by
of primary franchises and/or licenses or permits the SEC to the PED and is pending before the
granted by the government, to operate in the Prosecution and Enforcement Department of the
Philippines; xxx SEC.

Section 8 of P.D. No. 902-A, as amended,


Note: Under Sec. 5.2 of RA8799, SECs jurisdiction provides:
over all cases enumerated under Sec. 5, PD 902-A
SECTION 8. The Prosecution and
was transferred to the Regional Trial Court which
Enforcement Department shall have,
has jurisdiction over the principal office of the
subject to the Commissions control and
corporation, partnership or association concerned.
supervision, the exclusive authority to
investigate, on complaint or motu propio,
any act or omission of the Board of
According to the Interim Rules of Procedure for
Directors/Trustees of corporations, or of
Intra-Corporate Controversies (A.M. No. 01-2-04-
partnerships, or other associations, or of
SC), which took effect on April 1, 2001, the
their stockholders, officers or partners,
Regional Trial Court has jurisdiction over cases
including any fraudulent devices, schemes
involving the following:
or representations, in violation of any law
or rules and regulations administered and

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 4 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

enforced by the Commission; to file and supervision, monitoring, suspension or take over
prosecute in accordance with law and the activities of exchanges, clearing agencies and
rules and regulations issued by the other SROs; (e) the imposition of sanctions for the
Commission and in appropriate cases, the violation of laws and the rules, regulations and
corresponding criminal or civil case before orders issued pursuant thereto; (f) the issuance of
the Commission or the proper court or cease-and-desist orders to prevent fraud or injury
body upon prima facie finding of violation to the investing public; (g) the compulsion of the
of any laws or rules and regulations officers of any registered corporation or association
administered and enforced by the to call meetings of stockholders or members
Commission; and to perform such other thereof under its supervision; and, (h) the exercise
powers and functions as may be provided of such other powers as may be provided by law as
by law or duly delegated to it by the well as those which may be implied from, or which
Commission. are necessary or incidental to the carrying out of,
the express powers granted the Commission to
Prosecution under this Decree or any achieve the objectives and purposes of these laws.
Act, Law, Rules and Regulations enforced
and administered by the Commission shall However, Section 8 of P.D. No. 902-A, as amended,
be without prejudice to any liability for has already been repealed, as provided for in
violation of any provision of the Revised Section 76 of RA 8799.
Penal Code.
Thus, under the new law, the PED ceased to exist.
Under the said provision, the SEC, through the However, the SEC retains jurisdiction to continue
PED, is vested with authority to investigate, either with its investigation of the letter-petition of
motu proprio or upon complaint, any act or respondent Matsuura.
omission, fraudulent schemes, devices or
misrepresentations in violation of any law, rules or When RA 8799 took effect, the SEC case had not
regulations, administered and enforced by the SEC, yet been submitted for decision by the SEC.
and to file and prosecute appropriate civil or Hence, the said case should be transferred to the
criminal cases upon a prima facie finding of RTC of Makati City, to be raffled to the appropriate
violation of such laws, rules or regulations. The branch thereof assigned to try such cases. Despite
petitioners, in the SEC case, sought the nullification the repeal of Section 8 of P.D. No. 902-A and the
of the Notice for the Annual Stockholders Meeting, abolition of the PED, the SEC may continue with its
the stockholders meeting and organizational investigation of the letter-petition of respondent
meeting held on September 22, 1997, on their Matsuura.
claim that the holding of the same was in violation
of the Corporation Code and the By-Laws of the
petitioner corporation. In his answer to the The Sandiganbayan has jurisdiction over
petition, the respondent asserted the validity of the presidents, directors or trustees, or managers
said meeting and prayed, by way of counterclaim, of government-owned or controlled
for the nullification of the October 20, 1997 corporations organized and incorporated under
meeting of the petitioners, and for damages. In the Corporation Code for purposes of the
contrast, the respondent alleged in his letter- provisions of RA 3019, otherwise known as the
petition in the PED case that the petitioners were Anti-Graft and Corrupt Practices Act. Basis: Sec
engaged in fraudulent schemes, devices or 4, RA 8249 (People v Sandiganbayan, 2005)
misrepresentations in violation of the law, and SEC Union Bank v. Danilo Concepcion
rules and regulations. The complainant Matsuura GR No. 160727 June 26, 2007
asked the PED to investigate the complaint and file EYCO Group of Companies filed a petition for
the corresponding administrative, civil or criminal suspension of payment, appointment of
cases before the SEC, the proper court or body, for receiver/committee and approval of
violation of the laws, rules or regulations rehabilitation plan with alternative prayer for
administered and enforced by the SEC. The fact liquidation and dissolution of corporations.
that the SICD has not yet resolved the SEC case Suspension was granted by the SEC Hearing
does not constitute a bar to the resolution of the Panel. Union Bank became part of the
PED case. The proceedings in the said cases are ManCom which represented the creditor
independent and separate of each other and may banks but later on broke away without
thus proceed separately. notifying the group. It filed a slew of cases
with the Makati RTC and applied for
Note that while this case was pending in the SC, RA preliminary attachment. Union Bank filed a
8799, Securities Regulation Code, took effect on motion to dismiss the case pending with the
August 8, 2000. Section 5.2 of the law provides SEC, and when the SEC issued an order
that SECs jurisdiction over all cases under Sec 5 of appointing regular members of the ManCom,
PD 902-A is transferred to the RTCs. Union Bank filed a petition for certiorari with
the CA seeking the nullification of the SEC
Among the powers and functions of the SEC which
Order and again assailing the jurisdiction of
were transferred to the RTC include the following:
the SEC. It alleged that the jurisdiction over a
(a) jurisdiction and supervision over all
basic petition for suspension of payments was
corporations, partnerships or associations who are
with the RTC under Act No. 1956 (Insolvency
the grantees of primary franchises and/or a license
Law). The CA and later on the SC ruled that
or permit issued by the Government; (b) the
the jurisdiction is with the SEC pursuant to PD
approval, rejection, suspension, revocation or
902-A. The proceeding in the RTC was thus
requirement for registration statements, and
suspended. Concepcion was later appointed as
registration and licensing applications; (c) the
liquidator by the SEC en banc and he filed a
regulation, investigation or supervision of the
motion to intervene and set aside order of
activities of persons to ensure compliance; (d) the
attachment in the said RTC case. The SEC en

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 5 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

banc approved of the liquidation plan that cannot be fully equated to due process in its
Concepcion submitted but his motion to strict jurisprudential sense. It is the
intervene with the RTC was denied for lack of administrative order, not the preliminary
standing. The RTC also declared EYCO in report, which is the basis of any further
default in the said case, proceeded to receive remedies the losing party in an administrative
evidence ex parte and later rendered partial case may pursue. Thus, petitioner has no right
judgment ordering EYCO to pay P400M to to be notified of the preliminary report by the
Union Bank. Concepcion appealed the decision Financial Analysis and Audit Division of the
and was sustained by the CA, which modified SEC.
the partial judgment of the RTC. Union Bank
now comes to the SC assailing the CAs order. Petitioners claim that the SECs referral of the
petition for rehabilitation to the said division
HELD: Denied. CA Order AFFIRMED. What is violated its right to due process deserves no
being assailed is the validity of the consideration. Petitioners right to
appointment of Concepcion as liquidator and administrative due process only entitles it to
his standing to intervene in the RTC case. an opportunity to be heard and to a decision
Albeit jurisdiction over a petition to declare a based on substantial evidence. No more, no
corporation in a state of insolvency strictly lies less.
with regular courts, the SEC possessed, during
the period material, ample power under P.D.
No. 902-A as amended, to declare a
Chapter II
corporation insolvent as an incident of and in
continuation of its already acquired jurisdiction
over the petition to be declared in the state of CLASSIFICATION OF PRIVATE
suspension of payments in the two instances CORPORATIONS
provided in Section 5(d) thereof.
Said Section 5(d) vests the SEC with exclusive
and original jurisdiction over petitions for
1. General Classification under 3:
suspension of payments which may either be:
(a) a simple petition for suspension of
1.1 Stock corporation
payments based on the provisions of the
Insolvency Law, i.e., the petitioning
One which has a capital stock divided into
corporation has sufficient assets to cover all
shares and is authorized to distribute to the
its debts, but foresees the impossibility of
holders of such shares dividends or
meeting the obligations as they fall due, or (b)
allotments of the surplus profits (i.e.,
a similar petition filed by an insolvent
retained earnings on the basis of the shares
corporation accompanied by a prayer for the
held (3)
creation of a management committee and/or
It is organized for profit.
rehabilitation receiver based on the provisions
of P.D. No. 902-A, as amended by P.D. No. The governing body of a stock corporation
1758. The petition of EYCO in this case was a is usually the Board of Directors (Except in
mix of both situations. EYCOs petition for certain instances for close corporations)
suspension for payment was, for all intents
and purposes, still pending with the SEC as of
June 30, 2000. Accordingly, the SECs 1.2 Non-stock corporation
jurisdiction thereon, by the express terms of
R.A. No. 8999, still subsists until [the All other corporations are non-stock
suspension of payment case and its incidents corporations (3)
are] finally disposed. One where no part of the income is
distributable as dividends to its members,
trustees, or officers, subject to the
provisions of the Code on dissolution.
Viva Footwear v. SEC
Provided that any profit which a non-stock
GR No. 163235 April 27, 2007
corporation may obtain as an incident to its
Petitioner Viva Footwear Manufacturing
operation shall whenever necessary or
Corporation is a domestic corporation engaged
proper be used for the furtherance of the
in the manufacture of rubber footwear.
purpose or purposes for which the
Respondents Philippine National Bank (PNB)
corporation was organized. (87)
and Philippine Bank of Communications
Not organized for profit.
(PBCom) are two of petitioners creditors. The
SEC, upon petition by Viva, declared the latter Its governing body is usually the Board of
to be in a state of suspension of payments. Trustees.
The petition for rehabilitation was eventually
dismissed because it was not viable to do so CIR vs. Club Filipino, Inc de Cebu (1962)
as it was not financially sound. Viva now
claims that its right to due process was Club Filipino is a civic corporation organized to
violated when the SEC referred the develop and cultivate sport of all class and
rehabilitation plan to the Financial Analysis denomination for the healthful recreation and
and Audit Division without notice to petitioner. entertainment of its SH and members. Its AOI and
by-laws are silent as to dividends and their
HELD: NO MERIT. DISMISSED. In distribution but it was provided that upon its
administrative proceedings, due process dissolution, the Clubs remaining assets after
simply means an opportunity to seek a paying debts shall be donated to a charitable Phil.
reconsideration of the order complained of; it Institution.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 6 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

6. Eleemosynary corporation One organized for


HELD: Club Filipino is a non-stock corporation. a charitable purpose
According to Section 3 of the Corporation Code, 7. Domestic corporation A domestic corporation
there are two elements for a stock corporation to is one formed, organized, or existing under the
exist: 1) capital stock divided into shares, and 2) laws of the Philippines
an authority to distribute to the holders of such 8. Foreign corporation One formed, organized or
shares, dividends or allotments of the surplus existing under any laws other than those of the
profits on the basis of shares held. Nowhere in Philippines and whose law allows Filipino
Club Filipinos AOI or BL could be found an citizens and corporations to do business in its
authority for the distribution of its dividends or own country and state. (123)
surplus profits. 9. Corporation created by special laws or charter
(4)
Corporations which are governed primarily
by the provisions of the special law or
2. Other kinds of corporations charter creating them (4)
Corporation Code is suppletory in so far as
1. Public corporation - One formed or organized they are applicable (Ibid)
for the government or a particular state. Its 10. Subsidiary corporation one in which control,
purpose is for the general good and welfare. usually in the form of ownership of majority of
2. Private corporation - One formed for some its shares, is in another corporation (the parent
private purpose, benefit, aim or end corporation)
3. Close corporation (96) One whose Articles 11. Parent corporation its control lies in its power
of Incorporation provide that: to elect the subsidiarys directors thus
a) all of the corporations issued stock of all controlling its management policies
classes, exclusive of treasury shares, shall
be held of record by not more that a
specified number of persons, not exceeding
20
b) all of the issued stock of all classes shall be Chapter III
subject to one or more specified restrictions FORMATION AND ORGANIZATION OF
on transfer permitted by the Code CORPORATION
c) the corporation shall not list in any stock
exchange or make any public offering of 1. Who May Form a Corporation
any of its stock of any class
d) at least 2/3 of its voting stock must not be
owned or controlled by another corporation 1.1 Incorporators
which is not a close
e) must not be a mining or oil company, stock Any number of natural persons not less than five
exchange, bank, insurance company, public (5) but not more than fifteen (15), all of legal age
utility, educational institution or corporation and a majority of whom are residents of the
vested with public interest Philippines, may form a private corporation for any
4. Educational corporation (106) - Those lawful purpose or purposes. Each of the
corporations which are organized for incorporators of a stock corporation must own or
educational purposes. This type of corporation be a subscriber to at least one (1) share of capital
is governed by Section 106 of the Corporation stock of the corporation. (10)
Code
1) Natural persons
Corporations and partnerships cannot be
5. Religious sole and aggregate (110, 111 (2), incorporators, but may be stockholders.
123) This prevents layering which may harbour
A corporation sole is one formed for the criminals and will make the corporation a
purpose of administering and managing, as tool for defrauding the public.
trustee, the affairs, property and Incorporators are those stockholders or
temporalities of any religious denomination, members mentioned in the articles as
sect, or church, by the chief archbishop, originally forming and composing the
bishop, priest, rabbi, or other presiding elder corporation and who are signatories
of such religious denomination, sect or thereof.
church. (110) Corporators are stockholders or members
The corporation sole is an exception to the who join the corporation after its
incorporation.
general rule that at least five (5) members
are required for a corporation to exist. Original subscribers are persons whose
Here, there is only one (1) incorporator. names are mentioned in the Articles, but
This is applicable to religious communities not as incorporators. They do not sign the
the regulations of which provide that the Articles.
communitys properties are to be placed in
the name of the head and administered by 2) At least five incorporators but not more than
him. (111(2)) fifteen
A corporation aggregate is a religious They must sign the articles of
incorporation.
corporation incorporated by more than one
GENUINE INTEREST: Each incorporator
person.
must own or subscribe to at least one
share of stock of the corporation.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 7 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

3) Majority of the incorporators must be residents The promoter brings together persons
of the Philippines interested in the business enterprise and
General rule: need not be a citizen sets in motion the machinery that leads to
Exceptions: public utilities (Art XII, Sec 11. the formation of the corporation.
Consti), schools (Art XIV, Sec 4(2), Promoter is a person who, acting alone or
Consti), banks (General Banking Act), retail with others, takes initiative in founding and
trade (RA 1180), savings and loan organizing the business or enterprise of the
associations (RA 3799), investment houses issuer and receives consideration therefor. 1
(Sec 5, PD 129), and other areas of
investment as congress may by law provide 3.2. DRAFTING OF ARTICLES OF
(Art XII, Sec. 10, Consti). INCORPORATION
Even though there are no legal restrictions
as to alien ownership, where > 40% of the These constitute the charter of the corporation
outstanding capital stock will be owned and
controlled by aliens, must get written 1. CORPORATE NAME
authorization from BOI before it can No corporate name may be allowed by
register with SEC. (purpose is to enable the SEC if the proposed name is
BOI to determine whether such corporation identical or deceptively or confusingly
wherein aliens own a substantial number of similar to that of any existing
shares would contribute to the sound and corporation or to any other name
balanced development of the national already protected by law or is patently
economy) deceptive, confusing or contrary to
existing laws. (18)
4) Incorporators must be of legal age A corporate name is essential to the
corporations acquisition of juridical
personality
2. Conditions Precedent for Incorporation Change of corporate name shall require
the approval of the SEC. SEC will issue
2.1 Consent or agreement of at least 5 natural amended certificate of incorporation
persons with respect to: under the amended name (Ibid)
A change in corporate name involves
1. Compliance with the Corp Code; an amendment of the Articles, which
2. Contribution/pooling of resources requires a majority vote of the board
delivered to and held in trust by a and the vote or written assent of
designated trustee; stockholders holding 2/3 of the
3. Governance of: outstanding capital stock (16) Note:
Contributions; Does not include the non-voting stock.
Distribution of contributions; It is the sole means of identifying the
Division of profits/sharing of corporation from its members or
losses; stockholders, and from other entities
Pursuit of purpose/objectives; and corporations
Corporate combination; and Amendment in a corps AOI changing
Transactions with third parties; its corporate name does not extinguish
and the personality of the original
4. Continuity or termination of existence. corporation. The corp upon such
change of its name, is in no sense a
2.2 Mandatory Requirements of the Code: new entity, nor the successor of the
original corp. it is the same corp with a
1. Execution of constitutive documents different name, and its character is not
(AOI, By-laws); changed. Consequently, the new
2. Payment/delivery of contributions corp is still liable for the debts and
delivered to and held in trust by a obligations of the old corp (Republic
designated trustee; Planters Bank v CA, 1992)
3. Submission of constitutive documents This is essential because through it,
to SEC for review or evaluation; and corporation can sue and be sued
4. SEC action issuance of certificate of SEC may allow incorporators to reserve
registration. the name for a particular period
To distinguish from partnerships and
Note that once contributions are made before other business orgs, the law requires
incorporation, such subscriptions are irrevocable corporations to append the word
for a period of 6 months (general rule). Corporation or Inc to its chosen
Exceptions: name
1. When all of the other subscribers consent A corporation should transact business
to the revocation; or only through its chosen name
2. When the incorporation fails to materialize
(Sec. 61)
Philips Export BV (PEBV) v CA (1992)
3. Steps in the formation of a
PEBV is a foreign corp under the law of
corporation Netherlands, although not engaged in business in
the Phils. It is the registered owner of the Philips
3.1. PROMOTION

1
Sec. 3.10, The Securities Regulation Code (RA 8799)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 8 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

trademark, and owns two local companies with the o so that management will know
name Philips also. what lines of business it is
authorized to act
PEBV asked the cancellation of the word Philips o so that anyone who transacts with
from Standard Philips, a local manufacturer, the corporation may ascertain
alleging infringement of its exclusive right to use whether a transaction he is
the same. SEC and CA ruled for Std Philips, saying entering is one with the general
there was no confusion (unlike in Converse case). authority of the management
Under Sec 14(2) a corporation can
Held:
have as many purposes as it wants
Corps right to use its corp and trade name is a provided:
property right, a right in rem. o AOI specify the corporations
primary and secondary purposes
General Rule: Corp must have a name by which it
which need not be related to each
is to sue and be sued and do all legal acts.
other
Accdg to Corp Code, no corp name may be allowed o Corporation for which special
provisions are made can only have
1) if complainant corp acquired a prior right
the purpose peculiar to them
over name and
o Purposes must be lawful
2) proposed name is
If purpose is lawful, SEC is not
a) identical or
authorized to inquire whether
b) deceptively or confusingly similar or
corporation has hidden motives and
c) patently deceptive, confusing or
mandamus will lie to compel it to issue
contrary to existing law
certificate
PEBVs local companies were incorporated 26 yrs
PD 902-A, Sec 6(h) gives SEC, after
before Std Philips.
consultation with BOI, NEDA, or other
TEST OF CONFUSING SIMILARITY IN CORP NAMES: appropriate government agency, the
Whether similarity is such as to mislead a person power to refuse or deny the application
using ordinary care and discrimination for registration of any corporation if its
establishment, organization, operation
Philips is the dominant word. No need to prove that
will not be consistent with the declared
there was actual confusion, as long as probable or
national economic policies
likely to occur. Std Philips purpose, as per its
A corporation may not be formed for
articles of incorp also includes sale and
manufacture of electrical products, which is PEBVs the purpose of practicing a profession
line of business. Even if SEC guidelines mandate
that a corp could add 2 other words to proposed 3. PRINCIPAL OFFICE
name, only one word Std was added. Corp not Must be within the Philippines (14 (3))
counted. AOI must specify both province or city
or town where it is located
Note: A prior user can consent to the use of its Important in (1) determining venue in
name an action by or against the corporation
(2) determining the province where a
2. PURPOSE CLAUSE chattel mortgage of shares should be
Where a corporation has more than 1 registered (Chua Gan v Samahang
purpose, the AOI shall state which is Magsasaka)
the primary purpose and which is The statement of the principal office
secondary (14(2)) establishes the residence of the
A non-stock corporation may not corporation
include those which contradict or
change its nature (Ibid) 4. TERM OF EXISTENCE
SEC can reject or disapprove the AOI if When a corporation is organized, the
the stated purpose is patently maximum life that can be stipulated in
unconstitutional, illegal, immoral, the AOI is 50 years. But during the life
contrary to government rules and of the corporation, the life or term can
regulations.(17 (2)) be extended to another 50 years at any
Purpose clause confers as well as limits one instance (11)
the powers which a corporation may But such extension of the life a
exercise corporation cannot be made earlier
A corporation only has such powers as than 5 years before the end of its
are expressly granted to it by law and original term. Exception: where there
by its AOI, those which may be are justifiable reasons for an earlier
incidental to such conferred powers extension as may be determined by the
(45), those reasonably necessary to SEC. (Ibid)
accomplish its purposes (Section 36 Exception: Condominium corporations
(11), and those which may be incident can be organized for a period of 200
to its existence (2). years
Reasons for purpose clause: Extension involves an amendment of
o so that a stockholder contemplating the AOI. Thus, the requisites under
an investment will know what lines 16 must be complied with. Any
of business his money is to be dissenting stockholder may exercise his
risked appraisal right (37).

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 9 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

5. INCORPORATORS AND DIRECTORS; divided, and the par value of each par
NUMBER AND QUALIFICATIONS value shares (14(8), 15(7))
Directors is used for stock o Stock corporations are not required to
corporations, while trustees is used have any minimum authorized capital
for stock corporations. stock except when special laws provide
GENERAL RULE: not less than 5 but otherwise (12)
not more than 15
EXCEPTIONS: Subscribed capital stock
i) Non-stock corporations articles or o It is the amount of the capital stock
by-laws may provide for more than subscribed whether fully paid or not. It
15 trustees (92). connotes an original subscription
Exception: Educational non- contract for the acquisition by a
stock corporations trustees subscriber of unissued shares in a
may not exceed 15. However, corporation (60,61)
the number of trustees shall be o At least 25% of authorized capital stock
in multiples of 5 (108) must be subscribed (13)
ii) Merger of banks new board is o Subscription mutual agreement of the
allowed to have such number of subscribers to take and pay for the
directors as is equivalent to the stock of a corporation
total number of directors of the o Pre-incorporation subscription
merging banks, though it may amount which each incorporator or
exceed fifteen (General Banking stockholder agrees to contribute to a
Act, as amended). proposed corporation
Incorporators and directors of a stock
corporation must own at least one Outstanding capital stock
share of stock of the corporation. In a o It is the portion of the capital stock
non-stock corporation, a trustee must which is issued and held by persons
be a member thereof. other than the corporation itself.
In nationalized industries, aliens may Under 137, it is the total shares of
be directors of a corporation only in stock issued under the binding
such number as may be proportional to subscription agreements to subscribers
their allowable ownership of shares, 2 or stockholders, whether or not fully or
e.g. if the articles provide for 10 partially paid, except treasury shares.
directors, and alien ownership is limited It is thus broader than subscribed
to 40% of the capital, then aliens may capital stock
occupy a maximum of 4 board seats. o The terms subscribed capital stock
and issued or outstanding capital
6. CAPITAL STOCK; SUBSCRIPTION; stock are used synonymously since
PAYMENT subscribed capital stock, as
distinguished from the certificate of
Capital stock stock, can be issued even if not fully
o Capital stock is the amount fixed in the paid. But while every subscribed share
AOI, to be subscribed and paid in or (assuming there is a binding
secured to be paid in by the subscription agreement) is
shareholders of a corporation, either in outstanding, an issued share may not
money or property, labor or services, have the status of outstanding share
at the organization of the corporation (as in the case of treasury shares)
or afterwards and upon which is to
conduct its operation. (Fletcher) Paid-up capital
o The capital stock limits the maximum o 25% of subscribed capital stock must
amount or number of shares that may be paid-up for the purpose of
be issued by the corporation without incorporation, but in no case shall be
formal amendment of the AOI. It less than P 5000 (13)
remains the same even though the o Portion of the authorized capital stock
actual value of the shares as which has been subscribed and paid.
determined by the assets of the Not all funds or assets received by the
corporation is diminished or increased. corporation can be considered paid-up
capital, for this term has a technical
Authorized capital stock signification in corporation law. Such
o ACS is synonymous with capital stock must from part of the authorized
where the shares of the corporation capital stock of the corporation,
have par value. If the shares of stock subscribed and then actually paid-up.
have no par value, the corporation has [MSCI-NACUSIP Local Chapter v.
no ACS, but it has capital stock the National Wages and Productivity
amount of which is not specified in the Commission]
AOI as it cannot be determined until all o Must be in the form of (a) cash
the shares have been issued. In this deposited in a bank or (b) property
case, the two terms are not which may be used or actually needed
synonymous (De Leon) by the corporation in its operations
o State the authorized capital stock in o Capital cant consist or be invested in
lawful money of the Philippines, the money market placement
number of shares into which the ACS is o Corporations with more stringent
capital requirements:
2
Sec. 2-A, CA 108 (Anti-Dummy Law) as amended by PD 716.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 10 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Insurance corporations must


have paid-up capital stock of at 3.3. FILING OF ARTICLES AND PAYMENT OF
least P 5 M (Insurance Code, Sec FEES
188)
Banks monetary board fixes Corporations governed by special laws have
minimum paid-up capital to submit a recommendation from the
requirements for the different appropriate government agency to the
classes of banks (Central Bank Act effect that such articles are in accordance
and General Banking Act). with law.
a) banks, banking and quasi-banking
Unissued capital stock institutions,
o It is that portion of the capital stock b) building and loan associations,
that is not issued or subscribed. It c) trust companies and other financial
does not vote and draws no dividends intermediaries,
d) insurance companies,
Legal capital e) public utilities,
o It is the amount equal to the aggregate f) educational institutions, and
par vale and/or issued value of the g) other corporations governed by special
outstanding capital stock. When par laws (17)
value shares are issued above par, the Non-stock corporations that intend to solicit
premium or excess is not to be gifts, donations, and contributions from the
considered as part of the legal capital public at large for the benefit of an
(Cf43). In the case of no par value indefinite number of persons must secure a
shares, the entire consideration Certificate of Registration from the
received forms part of legal capital and Insurance Commissioner.
shall not be available for distribution of Failure to file AOI will prevent due
dividends (6, par 3) incorporation of the proposed corporation
and will not give rise to its juridical
Capital personality (19). It will not even be a de
o It is used broadly to indicate the entire facto corporation (20)
property or assets of the corporation. 1. Unless the certificate of
It includes the amount invested by the incorporation has been issued,
stockholders plus the undistributed there can be no de facto
earnings less losses and expenses. corporation (Hall vs. Piccio, 1950)
o In the strict sense, it refers to that 2. Camposthis statement should not
portion of the net assets paid by the be taken as an absolute principle,
stockholders as consideration for the but in the light of the
shares issued to them, which is utilized circumstances before the court.
for the prosecution of the business of
the corporation (De Leon) 3.4 EXAMINATION OF ARTICLES BY SEC;
APPROVAL OR REJECTION
7. TREASURER-IN TRUST
The person elected by the subscribers as The SEC may reject any AOI thereto if the
Treasurer of the corporation at the time of same is not in compliance with the
the incorporation, who is named as such in requirements of this Code (17)
the AOI and who has been authorized to The SEC shall give the incorporators a
receive for and in the name and for the reasonable time within which to correct or
benefit of the corporation, all subscriptions, modify the objectionable portions of the
fees, contributions or donations paid or articles or amendment. ( 17)
given by the subscribers or members

8. TREASURERS AFFIDAVIT
The sworn statement of the Treasurer
elected by the subscribers stating at least 4. Grounds for disapproving articles of
25% of the authorized capital stock of the incorporation (17)
corporation has been subscribed and that
at least 25% of the total subscription has
a) AOI does not substantially the form
been fully paid to him in actual cash and/or
prescribed
property, the fair valuation of which is
b) Purpose is patently unconstitutional, illegal,
equal to at least 25% of the said
immoral, contrary to government rules and
subscription, such paid-up capital being not
regulations
less than 5,000.00 (14)
c) Treasurers Affidavit concerning the amount
of capital subscribed and or paid is false
9. OTHER MATTERS
d) Percentage requirement of ownership of
Classes of shares, as well as the
Filipino citizens as required by the
preferences or restrictions on any such
Constitution not complied with.
class (6)
After consulting with BOI, NEDA,
Denial or restriction of pre-emptive
appropriate government agency, SEC may
right (39)
deny registration of any corporation if its
Prohibition against transfer of stock
establishment will not be consistent with
which would reduce stock ownership to declared national policies
less than the required minimum in the Certificate of authority required of the
case of a nationalized business or
following:
activity (15(11))

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 11 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

a) Insurance Companies- Insurance that a warrant for its creation can be


Commission found in some other valid law or in the
b) Banks, Building and Loan recognition of its potential existence in
Associations, Finance Companies- the general constitution of the state.
Monetary Board The mere fact that Balabagan was organized before
c) Educational Institutions- Secretary the statute was invalidated cannot make it a de
of Education facto corporation because, independently of the
d) Public Utilities- Board of Power, Administrative Code, there is no other valid statute
Board of Transportation, National to give color of authority to its creation. This
Telecommunication Commission, doesnt mean that the acts done by Balabagan in
etc.. the exercise of its corporate powers are a nullity.
Remedy in case of rejection of AOI: by The existence of EO 386 is an operative fact which
petition for review in accordance with the cannot be justly ignored.
Rules of Court (6, last par., PD 902-A)

ISSUANCE OF CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION


b) User of corporate powers there has been
A private corporation formed or organized some user of corporate powers, the
under this Code commences to have transaction of business in some way as if it
corporate existence and juridical were a corporation
personality and is deemed incorporated not necessary that dealings between
from the date the Securities and Exchange the parties should have been on a
Commission issues a certificate of corporate basis
incorporation under its official seal (19) election of directors and officers would
Thereupon the incorporators, not be user of corporate powers since
stockholders/members and their successors these acts are just indicative of a mere
shall constitute a body politic and corporate association
under the name stated in the articles of taking subscriptions to and issuing
incorporation for the period of time shares of stock, buying lot,
mentioned therein, unless said period is constructing, and leasing a building on
extended or the corporation is sooner it will constitute sufficient user of
dissolved in accordance with law. (Ibid) corporate powers to constitute a de
If incorporators are found guilty of fraud in facto corporation
procuring Certificate of Incorporation, SEC c) Substantial or Colorable compliance - there
may revoke the same after proper notice has been colorable compliance with legal
and hearing (6(I), PD 902-A) requirements in GOOD FAITH
while the corporation is still in the
process of incorporation, it is quite
clear that there can be no substantial
5. Defective Attempts to Incorporate
or colorable compliance and therefore it
cannot be at such a stage a de facto
5.1 DE FACTO CORPORATIONS a corporation corporation
where there exists a flaw in its incorporation A corporation which has not yet been
issued a certificate of incorporation
Requisites of a de facto corporation (Ballantine cannot claim in good faith to be a
as cited in Campos) corporation. Thus, it cannot be a de
facto corporation [Hall v. Piccio 86 Phil
a) Valid statute there is an apparently valid 603]
statue under which the corporation with its
purposes may be formed. There can be no Compliance with the above conditions would make
de facto corporation under a statue the corporation de facto whose incorporation
subsequently declared unconstitutional cannot be attacked collaterally. It may only be
attacked directly by the State in a quo warranto
Municipality of Malabang vs. Benito (1969) proceeding
Compliance with the above conditions
The municipality of Balabagan was created by EO would make the corporation de facto whose
386 of President Garcia out of barrios and sitios of incorporation cannot be attacked
Malabang. The petitioners seek to nullify the EO. collaterally. It may only be attacked
They rely on the Pelaez ruling that the Presidents directly by the State in a quo warranto
power to create municipalities under Sec. 68 of the proceeding (20)
Administrative Code is unconstitutional. De facto doctrine grew out of the necessity
Respondents argue that the Pelaez ruling is to promote the security of business
inapplicable because Balabagan is a de facto transactions and to eliminate quibbling over
corporation. irregularities
The de facto doctrine is the exception to
HELD: The Municipality of Balabagan was not a de the general rule that when there is no corp
facto corporation. The color of authority requisite entity to talk about, it is the natural
to a de facto municipal corporation may be an persons who are liable
unconstitutional law, valid on its face, which has Where corporations are neither de jure or
either: de facto, associates may be held liable as
a. Been upheld for a time by the courts; partners unless estoppel applies ( 21)
or No articles and no by-laws: no de facto
b. Not yet been declared void; provided corp. Theres no colorable compliance at all

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 12 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

De facto corp is like a de jure corp, has all Lozano vs. delos Santos (1997)
the powers and liabilities of de facto corp
THE ONLY DIFF: its incorporation can be This case involved two incorporated drivers
attacked by State in quo warranto action associations that decided to unite and elect one set
Ratio: Only State can give it legal of officers to be given authority to collect the daily
existence, so only the State is wronged dues of the drivers who are members of the
consolidated association.
5.2 CORPORATION BY ESTOPPEL HELD: Doctrine of estoppel applies when persons
assume to form a corporation and exercise
It is a status acquired by persons who corporate functions and enter into business
assume to act as a corporation knowing it relations with third persons. Where there are no
to be without authority. Such persons shall third persons involved and the conflict arises only
be liable as general partners for all debts, among those assuming to form a corporation, who
liabilities and damages incurred or arising therefore know that it has not been registered,
as a result thereof. (21) there is no corporation by estoppel.
When such ostensible corporation is sued
International Express Travel v. CA (2000)
on any transaction entered by it as a
corporation or any tort committed by it as
The doctrine of corporation by estoppel may apply
such, it shall not be allowed to use as a
to:
defense as lack of corporate personality
o a third party - a 3 rd party who had
(21)
dealt with an unincorporated association as a
One who assumes an obligation to an
corporation may be precluded from denying
ostensible corporation as such, cannot
its corporate existence on a suit brought by
resist performance thereof on the ground
the alleged corporation on the contract even if
that there was in fact no corporation (21)
he did not know of the defective
Note that an unincorporated corporation is
incorporation. 3rd party is considered to have
not barred from transacting business admitted the existence of a corporation by the
before the commencement of corporate fact that he dealt with it as a corporation
existence. Limit: personal liability.
o the alleged corporation - when a
Complication: when the corporation did not
third person has entered into a contract with
come about
an association which represented itself to be a
Against whom will estoppel lie? Who
corporation, the association is estopped from
committed the active misrepresentation? denying its corporate capacity in a suit against
Where a person convinces other parties to it by such 3rd person. It cannot allege lack of
invest money for the formation of a personality to be sued to evade responsibility
corporation, but which has never duly on a contract it has entered into and by virtue
incorporated, there can be no resulting of which it has received advantages and
partnership among them, and the mere benefits
passive investors cannot be held liable to o associates as partners - when
share in the losses suffered by the business business associates fraudulently
enterprise (Pioneer Surety v CA, 1989) misrepresents the existence of a corporation
When applicable: and the 3rd party contacts with the association
1. Persons assuming to act as corp are as a corporation without knowing the serious
liable as gen partners; defects in its incorporation, such 3 rd party may
2. 3rd party who had dealt with an sue associates as general partners. Where
unincorporated association as a corp both the associates and the 3rd party were
may be precluded from denying its ignorant of the defective incoroporation, 3 rd
corporate existence on a suit brought party cant hold the associates liable since they
by the alleged corp person deemed were in good faith. If 3rd party knew of defects
to have admitted the existence of the in incorporation and still dealt with the
corp corporation, he must be deemed to have
3. alleged corp that has entered into a chosen to deal with the corporation as such
contract by virtue of which it has and should be limited in his recovery to the
received advantages and benefits corporate assets.
However, if business associates
fraudulently misrepresent the existence of
a corp, 3rd party can sue them as gen 6. Internal Organization of the
partners. 3rd party is not estopped from Corporation
asserting their liability because he had
recognized the corporations existence.
6.1 APPROVAL OF BY-LAWS
Ratio: They cannot profit by their own
misrepresentation.
1. Definition of by-laws
Hence, if associates did not know of thee
These are regulations, ordinances, rules
defective incorp, they cant be personally
or laws adopted by an association or
held liable by innocent 3rd party (Cf
corporation or the like for its internal
Salvaierra v Garlitos, 1958)
governance. By- laws define the rights
But if 3rd party knew of defects of incorp,
and obligations of various officers,
he is estopped from recovering from
persons or groups within the corporate
individual associates, but must recover
structure and provide rules for routine
only from corp assets
matters such as calling meetings.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 13 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Every corporation under this code shall Cannot bind stockholders or corporation
have the power and capacity: to adopt pending approval
by-laws not contrary to law, morals, or By-laws or any amendment thereto of
public policy, and to amend or repeal any bank, banking institution, building
the same in accordance with this code and loan association, trust company,
(36 (5)) insurance company, public utility,
These are subordinate to the AOI, Corp educational institution or other special
Code, and other statutes. (Fleischer vs. corporations governed by special laws
Nolasco(1925)) must be accompanied by a certificate
of the appropriate govt agency to the
2. When to adopt by-laws (46) effect that such by-laws are in
Every corporation formed under this accordance with law
code must within 1 month after receipt By-laws, like AOI are contracts of
of official notice of the issuance of its adhesion. They will bind the
certificate of incorporation by the SEC corporation and stockholders including
adopt a code of by-laws for its those who vote against as well as those
government not inconsistent with this who became members after approval
code. Contracts entered into without strict
May be adopted and filed prior to compliance with by-laws may be
incorporation, in such case, shall be binding on the corporation due to long
approved and signed by all acquiescence and usage (Board of
incorporators submitted to SEC Liquidators vs. Kalaw (1967))
together with AOI By-laws are mere internal rules among
stockholders and cannot affect or
Failure to file By-laws on time: prejudice 3rd persons who deal with the
corporation unless they have
knowledge of the same (China Banking
Loyola Grand Villas Homeowners Assn v. CA Corp v CA, 1997)
(1997)
6. Contents (47)
Subject to the provisions of the
The Supreme Court held that although the Constitution, this Code, other special
Corporation Code requires the filing of by-laws laws, and the articles of incorporation,
within one month after the issuance of the a private corporation may provide in its
Certificate of Incorporation, it does not expressly by-laws for:
provide for the consequences of non-filing within a) The time, place and manner of
the said period. Failure to file the by-laws within calling and conducting regular or
that period does not imply the "demise" of the special meetings of the directors or
corporation. By-laws may be required by law for an trustees;
orderly governance and management of b) The time and manner of calling and
corporations but they are not essential to corporate conducting regular or special
birth. Therefore, failure to file them within the meetings of the stockholders or
period required by law by no means tolls the members;
automatic dissolution of a corporation. c) The required quorum in meetings of
stockholders or members and the
manner of voting therein;
3. How filed (46)
d) The form for proxies of
Must be approved by the affirmative
stockholders and members and the
vote of the stockholders representing manner of voting them; By laws
the majority of the outstanding capital may not prohibit the use of proxies-
stock or majority of members (if filed Peoples Home Savings Bank vs.
prior to incorporation, must be Superior Court, cited in Campos
approved and signed by all e) The qualifications, duties and
incorporators) compensation of directors or
Must be signed by the stockholders or trustees, officers and employees;
members voting for it f) The time for holding the annual
Must be filed with the SEC certified by election of directors of trustees and
the majority of directors/trustees and the mode or manner of giving
countersigned by the secretary of the notice thereof;
corporation which shall be attached to g) The manner of election or
original AOI appointment and the term of office
of all officers other than directors
4. Where kept (46) or trustees;
Must be kept in the principal office of h) The penalties for violation of the
the corporation; subject to inspection by-laws;
of stockholder or member during office i) In the case of stock corporations,
hours (Cf 74) the manner of issuing stock
certificates; and
5. Effectivity of by-laws j) Such other matters as may be
In all cases, the by-laws shall be necessary for the proper or
effective only from the issuance of SEC convenient transaction of its
of certification that bylaws are not corporate business and affairs.
inconsistent with the Code

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 14 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

The contents may be subdivided into


two major headings:
a) Management and control of the
corporate entity; and
b) Rights and obligations of
stockholders

7. Amendment or repeal (48)


Majority vote of the members of the
Board and majority vote of the
outstanding capital stock or majority of
members, in a meeting duly called for
the purpose; or
2/3 of the outstanding capital stock or
members may delegate to the BOD the
power to amend or repeal any by-laws
or adopt new by-laws (such power may
be revoked by majority vote only)
In all other respects, the procedure for
adopting the original by-laws shall be
the same in amending or repealing by-
laws or adoption of a new set of by-
laws

6.2 ELECTION OF DIRECTORS discussed in


Chapter VII Chapter IV

6.3 COMMENCEMENT OF BUSINESS THE CORPORATE ENTITY

7. Effects of non-use of 1. Doctrine of separate juridical


charter/continuous inoperation ( 22) personality

A corporation has a personality separate and


1. Non-user for 2 years (non-use of charter)- distinct from that of its stockholders and
when the corporation does not formally members and is not affected by the personal
organize and commence the transaction of rights, obligations, and transactions of the
its business or the construction of its works latter. Since corporate property is owned by
within 2 years from the date of its the corporation as a juridical person, the
incorporation, its corporate powers cease stockholders have no claim on it as owners, but
and the corporation shall be deemed have merely an expectancy or inchoate right to
dissolved (automatic) the same should any of it remain upon
Formal organization may consist in dissolution of the corporation after all corporate
the election of new board of directors creditors have been paid. Such right is limited
or trustees and corporate officer only to their equity interest (doctrine of limited
Commencement of business may liability).
take the form of contracting for lease Although stockholders interest in the corp may
or sale of properties to be used as be attached by his personal creditor, corp
business site of the corporation and property cannot be used to satisfy his claim
other preparatory acts geared towards (Wise & Co. vs. Man Sun Lung, 1940)
fulfillment of the purpose for which the General Rule: Separate personality is vested to
corporation was established a corporate entity when it is issued the
2. Non-user for 5 years (continuous certificate of incorporation by the SEC. The
inoperation)- when the corporation has exceptions are:
commenced the transaction of its business a. de facto corporation
but subsequently becomes continuously b. corporation by estoppel
inoperative for a period of at least 5 years. As a separate juridical personality, a
The same shall be a ground for the corporation can be held liable for torts
suspension or revocation of its corporate committed by its officers for corporate purpose
franchise or Certificate of Incorporation (PNB v CA, 1978)
(not automatic). Notice and hearing before It cant be held criminally liable for a crime
SEC is required. committed by its officers (People v Tan Boon
3. Exception: cause or non-use or operation Kong, 1930)
was due to causes beyond the control of Corporate entities are entitled to the following
the corporation as determined by SEC (ex. constitutional rights: due process, equal
Mineral lands to be developed by the protection, and protection against
corporation as per its purpose are the unreasonable searches and seizures. However,
object of court litigation and a court a corp is not entitled to the privilege against
injunction against the corporate activities self-incrimination (Bataan Shipyard & Engg Co.
has been issued) v PCGG, 1987)
A corporation is not entitled to moral damages
ANNUAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS filed with SEC (LBC Express, Inc v CA)
annually (SEC Rule, Nov. 20, 1980)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 15 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Juridical personality of the corporation ends considered as a means of evading such thus
when liquidation ends (payment of debts and the need for the piercing.
distribution of assets) and inchoate rights or
In applying the doctrine, determine:
expectancies of stockholders are realized. Until
1. the rights and obligations of the
such conveyance is made, title over the assets
parties.
remains with the corporation.
2. the possibility of non-enforcement
of such rights and obligations
because of the shield or veil.
2. Piercing the veil of corporate
3. look into the circumstances and
fiction underlying purpose of putting up
the corporation

2.1 Nature of the piercing doctrine


2.2 Extent of the legal effects of piercing
Piercing the veil of corporate entity requires
the court to see through the protective The application of the piercing doctrine to a
shroud which exempts its stockholders particular case does not deny the
from liabilities that ordinarily they could be corporation of legal personality for any and
subject to, or distinguishes one corporation all purposes, but only for the particular
from a seemingly separate one, were it not transaction or instance for which the
for the existing corporate fiction [Lim v. doctrine was applied. [Koppel Phil. Inc. v.
CA, 2000]. But to do this, the court must Yatco] (1946)
be sure that the corporate fiction was Piercing is not allowed unless the remedy
misused, to such an extent that injustice,
sought is to make the officer or another
fraud or crime was committed upon
corporation pecuniarily liable for corporate
another, disregarding, their, his, her or its
debts
rights. It is the protection of the interests
of innocent third persons dealing with the
corporate entity which the law seeks to
protect by this doctrine. [Traders Royal
Bank v. CA, 1997] 2.3 Illustrative Cases where piercing the veil
Whether the existence of the corporation is allowed
should be pierced depends on questions of If done to defraud the government of taxes
facts, appropriately pleaded. Mere due it
allegation that a corporation is the alter If done to evade payment of civil liability
ego of the individual stockholders is If done by a corporation which is merely a
insufficient. The presumption is that the conduit or alter ego of another corporation
stockholders or officers are distinct entities. If done to evade compliance with
The burden of proving otherwise is on the contractual obligations
party seeking to have the court pierce the If done to evade financial obligation to its
veil of corporate entity. [Ramoso v. VA, employees
2000]
Piercing the veil of corporate entity is
merely an equitable remedy, and may be 2.4 Parent-subsidiary relationship
awarded only in cases when the corporate
The mere fact that a corporation owns all
fiction is used to defeat public convenience,
justify wrong, protect fraud or defend crime or substantially all of the stocks of another
or where the corporation is a mere alter corporation is not sufficient to justify their
ego or business conduit of a person. being treated as one entity. If used to
When it comes to applying the doctrine, perform legitimate functions, the
subsidiarys separate existence may be
the first point to consider is the liability of
respected. However, to prevent abuses of
obligation of the individual (the one who is
the separate entity privilege, the court will
being sought to be liable). Without such
pierce the veil of corporate entity and
liability, everything would have been in
regard the two corporations as one.
compliance with statutes (U.S vs.
Circumstances which if present in the
Milwaukee, 1905; Umali vs. CA, 1990).
In case of wholly-owned corporations, proper combination renders the subsidiary
an instrumentality:
corporations with common stockholders, or
a) The parent corporation owns all or
corporations having a parent-subsidiary
most of the subsidiarys capital stock
relationship, the following are the
b) The parent and subsidiary corporations
inevitable consequences:
have common directors or officers
a) Control and management of the
c) The parent corporation finances the
corporation;
subsidiary
b) Interlocking directors;
d) The parent corporation subscribes to all
c) Common access to the use of resources,
the capital stock of the subsidiary or
services, and 3rd-party providers; and
otherwise causes its incorporation
d) Intra-corporate dealings.
e) The subsidiary has grossly inadequate
In the above consequences, there is no
capital
necessity for applying the doctrine of piercing
f) The parent corporation pays the
the corporate veil unless there is a particular
salaries and other expenses or losses of
act by the corporation, stockholder, or BOD
the subsidiary
that gives rise to a liability. If theres a liability
to speak of, such consequences may be

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 16 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

g) The subsidiary has substantially no corporate veil shall be lifted and he shall be held
business except with parent corporation personally liable for the particular corporate
or no assets except those conveyed to obligation involved.
or by the parent corporation
h) In the papers of the parent corporation
or in the statements of its officers, the
subsidiary is described as a department
or division of the parent corporation or 3. Nationality of the Corporation
its business or financial responsibility is
referred to as the parent corporations 3.1 The place of incorporation test.
own The corporation is a national of the country
i) The parent corporation uses the under whose laws it is organized or
property of the subsidiary as its own incorporated(123):
j) The directors or executives of the Domestic corporations organized and
subsidiary do not act independently in governed under and by Philippine laws
the interest of the subsidiary but take Foreign corporations organized under
their orders from the parent laws other than those of the Philippines an
corporation in the latters interest can operate only in the territory of the
k) The formal ledger requirements of the state under whose laws it was formed.
subsidiary are not observed (PNB v However, they may be licensed to do
Ritratto Group, 2001). business here.
The subsidiary cannot be considered a
mere instrumentality of the parent 3.2 Nationality of the Corporation as
corporation just by the combination of the determined by the Control Test
11 signs listed above. For the veil of Exploitation of Natural Resources - Section
corporate entity of the subsidiary to be 2, Art. XII CONST. only Filipino Citizens or
pierced so that it is considered just an Corporations whose capital stock are at
instrumentality, the act questioned must least 60% owed by Filipinos can qualify to
have an illegal or unfair purpose which exploit natural resources.
results to prejudice to third persons who Public Utilities - Sec. 11, Art XII, CONST.
may seek redress from the corporate entity xxx no franchise, certificate or any other
form of authorization for the operation of a
De Leon vs. NLRC (2001) public utility shall be granted except to
citizens of the Philippines or to corporations
or associations organized under the laws of
FACTS: FISI contracted with FTC for security
the Philippines at least 60% of whose
services. Subsequently, the stockholders of FISI
capital is owned by such citizens.
sold all their participation in the corporation to a
War-time Test - If the controlling
new set of stockholders which renamed the
stockholders are enemies, then the
corporation MISI. Afterwards, FTC preterminated
nationality of the corporation will be base
its contract of security services with MISI causing
on the citizenship of the majority
petitioner security guards to lose their employment
stockholders in times of war (Filipinas
and file ULP case against FTC, FISI and MISI.
Compania de Seguros v Christian Huenfeld,
HELD: There was ER-EE relationship between FTC
1951) .
and petitioners. It was shown that FISI was a
Investment Test - Sec. 3(a) and (b),
mere adjunct of FTC. Records show that FISI and
Foreign Investments Act of 1991 (RA7042).
FTC have the same owners and business address,
It considers for purpose of investment a
and FISI provided security services only to FTC.
Philippine National as a corporation
The purported sale of the shares of the former
organized under the laws of the Philippines
stockholders to a new set of stockholders who
of which at least 60% of the capital stock
changed the name of the corporation to MISI
outstanding and entitled to vote is owned
appears to be part of a scheme to terminate the
and held by citizens of the Philippines, or a
services of FISI's security guards posted at the
trustee of the funds for pension or other
premises of FTC and bust their newly-organized
employee retirement or separation
union which was then beginning to become active
benefits, where the trustee is a Philippine
in demanding the company's compliance with Labor
national and at least 60% of the fund will
Standards laws. Under these circumstances, the
accrue to the benefit of Philippine nationals.
Court cannot allow FTC to use its separate
corporate personality to shield itself from liability
for illegal acts committed against its employees.
3.3 Grandfather rule
Used to determine the nationality of a
Francisco vs. Mejia (2001)
corporation by which the percentage of Filipino
equity in corporations engaged in nationalized
With specific regard to corporate officers, the and/or partly nationalized areas of activities,
general rule is that the officer cannot be held provided for under the constitution and other
personally liable with the corporation, whether nationalization laws, is computed, in cases
civilly or otherwise, for the consequences of his where corporate shareholders are present in
acts, if he acted for and in behalf of the the situation, by attributing the nationality of
corporation, within the scope of his authority and in the second or even subsequent tier of
good faith. In such cases, the officer's acts are ownership to determine the nationality of the
properly attributed to the corporation. However, if corporate stockholder. (Villanueva, 2003)
it is proven that the officer has used the corporate
fiction to defraud a third party, or that he has acted
negligently, maliciously or in bad faith, then the SEC formula: SEC Letter Opinion

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 17 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Shares belonging to corporations or Corp. is not bound by the contract Since the
partnerships at least 60% of the capital of corp. did not yet exist at the time of the contract, it
which is owned by Filipino citizens shall be could not have had an agent who could legally bind
considered as of Philippine nationality, but it.
if the percentage of Filipino ownership in
the corporation or partnership is less than 3.2 Exception:
60% only the number of shares
corresponding to such percentage shall be Corp. may be bound by the contract if it makes the
considered as of Philippine nationality. contract its own: How?
a. Adoption or ratification
By express resolution
Implied from the acts of responsible
officers of the corp.
* The corp. cannot adopt only the part of the
contract which may be beneficial to it &
then discard the part that is burdensome.
* The contract to be capable of adoption or
ratification, must be one within the powers
of the corp. to enter.
b. Acceptance of benefits under the contract
with knowledge of the terms thereof

4. Personal Liability of Promoter on


Pre-Incorporation Contracts

There are three possible situations intended by the


promoter and the other party in pre-incorp.
Chapter V contracts:
PROMOTERS CONTRACTS PRIOR TO 1. Promoter takes a continuing OFFER on behalf of
INCORPORATION the corp, which if accepted by the corp.
becomes a contract Promoter does not
assume any personal liability, whether or not
1. Functions of Promoters the offer is accepted by the corp.
2. Promoter makes a contract at the time binding
Organize and establish corporation himself with the UNDERSTANDING that if the
Solicit or pool capital contributions corp., once formed, accepts or adopts the
Exercise/identify/consummate opportunities contract, the promoter will be relieved of all
Make available capital responsibilities
contributions/investments (underwrite) 3. Promoter binds himself PERSONALLY &
Manage/control assumes the responsibility of looking to the
Note: may be done prior or after incorporation. proposed corp. for reimbursement
Complications arise if performed prior to
incorporation. For whom was the promoter In the absence of any express or implied
acting in behalf of? (no juridical entity yet) agreement to the contrary, the 3rd situation will be
presumed and the promoter will be considered
2.What are Promoters Contracts? personally liable for the contracts. Thus, the corp.s
adoption or ratification of the contract will not
release the promoter from personal liability unless
Contracts prior to existence of corporation thus a novation was intended. (Wells vs. Fay & Egan
the corporation could not have been a party to Co., 143 Ga. 732, 87 S.E 873, 1915) Exception:
it. Quaker v Hill case. In this case, Quaker looked to
However, the corporation may make the the uincorporated entity when making the contract.
contracts its own and may become bound on Thus, the promoter was not liable.(Quaker Hill Inc.
such contracts if after incorporation, it adopts vs. Parr, 148 Colo. 45, 364 P. 2d 1056, 1961)
or ratifies the same, or accepts its benefits with
knowledge of the terms thereof.
Adoption or ratification need not be by express 5. Compensation of Promoters
resolution of the board and may be implied
from the acts of responsible officers of the Gen rule the corporation is not liable to pay
corporation. compensation because this would be an imposition
on innocent investors. (Ballantine)
3. Liability of Corporation for
Exceptions:
Promoters Contracts
if after it is formed, corporation expressly
promises to do so (Ballantine; Indianapolis Blue
Rules on the liability of the corp. on promoters Print & Manufacturing Co. v. Kennedy et. al.,
contracts: 215 Ind. 409, 19 N.E 2d 554, 1939)
Services done partly before and partly after
3.1 General Rule
incorporation and the corporation takes the
benefits thereof

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 18 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

j. To establish pension, retirement, and other


The Corp. Code does not contain any provision as plans for the benefit of its directors, trustees,
to the compensation of promoters. But the officers and employees; and
Securities Act authorizes a promotion fee IF it is k. To exercise such other powers as may be
provided for in the registration statement of the essential or necessary to carry out its purpose
securities involved. or purposes as stated in the articles of
incorporation. (in the purpose clause)

6. Fiduciary Relationship between Sources of express power (Villanueva)


Corporation & Promoter o Section 36 (Corp Code and other applicable
statutes)
The promoters, being responsible for the financing o Purpose clause (AOI, supplemented by by-
& organization of the corp., are under duty to laws)
exercise good faith & fairness in all their acts & Sec 38 par 11 grants such power as are
transactions. essential or necessary to carry out its purpose
or purposes as stated in the AOI. A corporation
Example: Promoters often have to take options or is presumed to act within its powers and when
title to property in their name but for the benefit of a contract is not on its face necessarily beyond
the corp. In such cases, they should not make its authority, it will, in the absence of proof to
secret profits in passing title to the corp. If they do, the contrary, presumed valid
they would have to account for all such profits to The general powers are to be exercised by the
the corp. when formed. (Old Dominion Mining and BOD. However, the power to amend AOI is to
Smelting Corp., 203 Mass. 159, 89 N.E 193, 1909) be exercised by the stockholders or members
2 general restrictions on the power of the
corporation to acquire and hold properties:
o that the property must be reasonably and
necessarily required by the transactions of
its lawful business
o that the power shall be subject to the
limitations prescribed by other special laws
and the constitution (corporation may not
Chapter VI acquire more than 30% of voting stocks of
CORPORATE POWERS a bank; corporations are restricted from
acquiring public lands except by lease of
not more than 1000 hectares)
1. General powers of corporations
(36) 2. Specific Powers - TCB PDA IDM
(DIP CAB MDT)
a. To sue and be sued in its corporate name;
b. Succession by its corporate name for the period Extend or shorten the corporate Term ( 37)
of time stated in the articles of incorporation Increase or decrease Capital stock ( 38)
and the certificate of incorporation; Incur, create or increase Bonded indebtedness
c. To adopt and use a corporate seal; ( 38)
d. To amend its articles of incorporation in Deny Preemptive right ( 39)
accordance with the provisions of this Code; Sell or otherwise Dispose of substantially all its
e. To adopt by-laws, not contrary to law, morals,
assets
or public policy, and to amend or repeal the
Acquire its own shares ( 41)
same in accordance with this Code;
Invest in another corporation or business (
f. In case of stock corporations, to issue or sell
42)
stocks to subscribers and to sell stocks to
Declare dividends ( 43)
subscribers and to sell treasury stocks in
accordance with the provisions of this Code; Enter into Management contracts ( 44)
and to admit members to the corporation if it
be a non-stock corporation; 3. Implied Powers
g. To purchase, receive, take or grant, hold,
convey, sell, lease, pledge, mortgage and These implied powers are deemed to exist because
otherwise deal with such real and personal of the following provisions:
property, including securities and bonds of 1. except such as are necessary or incidental to
other corporations, as the transaction of the the exercise of the powers so conferred (36)
lawful business of the corporation may 2. such powers as are essential or necessary to
reasonably and necessarily require, subject to carry out its purpose or purposes as stated in
the limitations prescribed by law and the the AOI catch-all phrase (45)
Constitution;
h. To enter into merger or consolidation with Remember: (Coleman vs. Hotel de France Co., 29
other corporations as provided in this Code; Phil. 323, 1915)
i. To make reasonable donations, including those 1. A corporation is presumed to act within
for the public welfare or for hospital, charitable, its powers.
cultural, scientific, civic, or similar purposes: 2. When a contract, entered into by the
Provided, That no corporation, domestic or corporation, is not on its face necessarily
foreign, shall give donations in aid of any beyond its authority, it will be presumed valid.
political party or candidate or for purposes of
partisan political activity;

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 19 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

considered within the corporations charter


4. The Ultra Vires powers.

Doctrine (45) Stevedoring services are incidental and


indispensable to unload the coal shipments.
Definition These are acts which a corporation is
not empowered to do or perform because they are
Republic of the Philippines vs. Acoje
not based on the powers conferred by its AOI or
Mining Co. (1963)
by the Corporation Code on corporations in
general, or because they are not necessary or
Acoje Mining requested the Director of Posts
incidental to the exercise of the powers so
to open a post office in its mining camp for
conferred.
the benefit of its employee and their families.
In a resolution, Acoje agreed to be directly
Rule No Corporation under this Code shall
responsible for the dishonesty, carelessness,
possess or exercise any corporate powers except
or negligence of the employee it assigns.
those conferred by this Code or by its articles of
Acojes employee, Sanchez, was designated
incorporation and except such as are necessary or
as the postmaster but he later disappeared
incidental to the exercise of the powers so
with 13K of post office funds. Acoje denied
conferred.
liability on the ground that the resolution was
ultra vires-BOD had no authority to act on the
An ultra vires act, if not illegal, can be remedied
matter.
(by ratification)
HELD: The company is estopped from
denying liability on the ground that the board
resolution is ultra vires. Assuming arguendo
Atrium v. CA (2001) that the resolution is an ultra vires act, the
same is not void for it was approved not in
contravention of law, customs, public order
Atrium Management Corporation filed with
and public policy. The term ultra vires should
RTC an action for collection of the 4 postdated
be distinguished from an illegal act for the
checks issued by the Hi-cement Corporation,
former is merely voidable which may be
though its signatories de Leon, treasurer, and
enforced while the latter is void and cannot
delas Alas, chairman of the corporation to a
be validated.
certain ET Henry, and Co, which the latter
endorsed to Atrium for rediscounting.
Pirovano v De la Rama Steamship (1954)
HELD: The act of issuing was well within the Stocks are owned by Don de la Rama, his 2
ambit of a valid corporate act, for it was daughters, and their EEs with nominal shares.
for securing a loan to finance the One of the daughters was married to the
activities of the corporation, hence, not company president, Enrico Pirovano. While
an ultra vires act. An ultra vires act is the business grew, the father distributed his
distinguished from illegal act, the former stocks among his 5 daughters and his wife.
being voidable which may be enforced by NDC was also represented in the BoD because
performance, ratification, or estoppel, the corp had a debt to it. To secure the debt,
while the latter is void and cannot be all assets were mortgaged to NDC. Debt was
validated. SC however, held de Leon later converted to stock, such that NDC now
negligent. held 4 of 9 seats in BoD. Such conversion
released the mortgaged assets.

NAPOCOR v Vera (1989) Enrico Pirovano died, so the BOD passed a


resolution converting insurance proceeds on
NAPOCOR has a pier at its coal plant in his life to stocks for each of his minor
Batangas. It did not renew its stevedoring children. Approved by SHs.
contract at the plant, but instead, took over However, the other SHs realized that they
the services itself. RTC Judge issued would actually be donating 1.44 M. instead of
preliminary injunction against NAPOCOR, the 400K they intended (since the value of
saying that it was not empowered by its the stocks increased), and that Mrs. Pirovano
Charter to engage in stevedoring and arrastre would now have 2x voting power as her
services. sisters.
Held: BOD later changed donation into cash, but
Under its Charter, NAPOCOR can exercise would be retained by the company as a loan,
powers as may be reasonably necessary to and the interest payable to the children, both
carry out its business of constructing, amounts to be paid to the children after debt
operating and maintaining power plants, or to NDC paid, and later, when company is in
which, from time to time, may be declared by position to meet obligations. Mrs. Pirovano
the Board to be necessary, useful, incidental formally accepted the donation. BOD later
or auxiliary to accomplish said purpose. approved release of some funds held in trust
for Mrs. Pirovano to buy house in NY. SHs
If act is lawful, and not prohibited, and for the formally ratified the donation.
purpose of serving corporate ends, and
reasonably contributes to the promotion of SEC later gave opinion that donation was void
those ends in a substantial sense, it may be bec it was beyond the scope of the corps
powers. SHs later voted to revoke the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 20 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

donation to the Pirovano children.


1. Allocation of power and control
Held:
(Campos)
1) Donation was remunerative- for services
rendered by Enrico Pirovano. 3 levels of control in the corporate hierarchy:
2) Donation was already perfected. Ratified
by SHs, and agreed to by NDC, the only 1. the Board of Directors or Trustees
creditor. - responsible for corporate policies and the
3) Donation is within scope of the AOI. It is general management of the business and
provided that corp can invest and deal affairs of the corporation
with moneys not immediately required, in
such manner as from time to time may be 2. the Officers
determined, and that corp can aid in any - in theory, execute the policies laid down by
other manner any person of which any the board
obligation or in which any interest is held - in practice, often have wide latitude in
by this corp, or in the affairs of prosperity determining the course of business
of which this corp has a lawful interest. operations
Corp has given donations to EEs in the
past, and to political campaigns. 3. The stockholders or members
- have residual power of fundamental
Assuming donation was ultra vires, corporate changes
donation was ratified, making the act
valid and enforceable. NOTE: BOD can delegate its function to the officers
Ultra vires act: outside scope of powers and also to committees appointed by it (Executive
granted to it by its articles of incorp. Not Committee, 35)
necessarily illegal, because ultra vires
acts can become valid by ratification and
estoppel. 2. Who Exercises Corporate Powers

2.1 BOARD OF DIRECTORS


General consequences of ultra vires acts
1. On corporation itself-Corporation 1) Authority; repository of corporate powers
May be dissolved under a quo warranto proceeding The board of directors or trustees are
but in most cases, the court merely enjoins the responsible for corporate policies and
corporation from commission of the ultra vires acts general management of the business
(Campos) affairs of the corporation
-Certificate of Registration may be suspended or Directors have a fiduciary duty to the
revoked by SEC corp and to the SHs
2. On immediate parties- Parties to the ultra General Rule: once elected, SHs have
vires contract, if executory on both sides, no right to interfere with the BOD.
neither party can ask for specific Exceptions: removal of director (28),
performance. Will be left as they are if the amendments of AOI (16),
contract has been fully executed on both fundamental changes (6), declaration
sides. If one party has performed his part, of stock dividends (43), entering into
the contract will be enforced provided it is management contracts (44), fixing of
not illegal consideration of no-par shares (62),
- Contract proceeding from an ultra and fixing of compensation of directors
vires act is voidable (Republic v. Acoje Mining (30)
Co., GR L-18062, Feb. 28, 1963; 7 SCRA Unless otherwise provided in the Corp
361) ) Code, the Board of Directors control
3. On the rights of stockholders- Any stockholder and exercise:
may bring either an individual or derivative suit o the corporate powers of
to enjoin a threatened ultra vires act or corporation
contract. If act or contract has already been o all business conducted,
performed, a derivative suit for damages may o all property of such corporation
be filed against the directors, but their liability (23)
will depend on whether they acted in good faith The board exercises almost all
and with reasonable diligence in entering into corporate powers, lays down all
contracts. When based on tort, cannot set-up business policies and is responsible for
the defense of ultra vires against injured party the efficiency of management. The
who had no knowledge that such was ultra stockholders have no right to interfere
vires with the boards exercise of its powers
May become binding by the ratification of all and functions except where the law
stockholders unless third parties are prejudiced expressly gives them the final say, like
thereby or unless the acts are illegal (Pirovano v. in cases of removal of a director,
de la Rama Steamship Co. 96 Phil. 335; 1954) amendment of articles of incorporation,
and other major changes (Cf 6, 42,
43).
Limitations on the BODs authority or
Chapter VII
powers:
CONTROL AND MANAGEMENT OF 1. Action by SHs in order to elect a
CORPORATIONS BOD

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 21 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

2. Certain act of the corp that require o When directors or officers act
joint action of the SHs and BOD against the corp in conflict-of-
Their resolutions on matters other than interest situation
the exceptions are legally not effective
nor binding and may be treated as 1) Requirements
merely advisory or may be totally Qualifying share (23)- Every director
disregarded. (Ramirez v. Orientalist Co. must own at least one (1) share of the
et. al., 38 Phil. 634; 1918); Wolfson v. capital stock of the corporation of which
Manila Stock Exchange, 72 Phil. 492; he is a director, which share shall stand
1941) in his name on the books of the
Unless Otherwise Provided may corporation. Any director who ceases to
pertain to instances where a be the owner of at least one (1) share
management contract is entered hence of the capital stock of the corporation
corporate powers are exercised by the of which he is a director shall thereby
managing company and not the board cease to be a director.
Authority of BOD can be delegated to
agents/ officers/ committees (AOI, Lee vs. CA (1992)
statutes, by-laws, resolutions) (YU
Chuck v Kong Li Po, 46 Phil 608). Summons was served upon Lee and Lacdao,
Delegation may be explicit, implicit, or president and vice president of ALFA. The two,
based on exigencies of the business however contended that they are no longer
(cf. Board of Liquidators v Kalaw) corporate officers of the corporation because of the
The BOD may delegate its corporate voting trust agreement executed to DBP, hence,
powers to either an executive not authorized to receive summons. Summons
committee or officials or contracted must be served upon DBP
managers. The delegation, except for
the executive committee, must be for HELD:
specific purposes. The delegation Execution of a voting trust creates a dichotomy
makes the officers agents of the between equitable or beneficial ownership of the
corporation. For such officers to be corporate shares of a stockholder and legal title
deemed fully clothed by the corporation thereto. The change from the old code to the new
to exercise a power of the BOD, the code with respect to qualifying shares of directors
latter must specially authorize them to is the omission of the phrase in his own right
do so. (ABS-CBN Broadcasting Corp v pertaining to beneficial ownership of shares. In the
CA, 1999) new corpo code, persons may be directors if they
The directors or trustees shall not act are stockholders although not in their own right
individually nor separately but as a hence includes trustees. There is clear indication
body in a lawful meeting. Contracts that to be a director, what is material is legal title
entered into without a formal board and not beneficial ownership. With the execution of
resolution does not bind the corporation the voting trust agreement, Lee and Lacdao were
except when majority of the board has divested of their legal title to their shares hence
knowledge of the contract and the can no longer be directors and are no longer
contract benefited the corporation. corporate officers. Because of this, they are not
(ratification) authorized to receive summons
Directors owe their duties to
corporation as a whole rather than to
Requirements/Disqualifications:
individual shareholders of classes of
o Residence (23) - a majority of the
shareholders
directors or trustees of all
Business Judgment Rule
corporations organized under this
- Sec 23 embodies the essence of the
Code must be residents of the
business judgment rule, that unless
Philippines
otherwise provided in the Code, all corp
o Nationality no requirement for
powers and prerogatives are vested
citizenship of a director or trustee
directly in the BOD. Consequently, the
so even an alien may be elected as
rule has two consequences:
such excepts in business activities
The resolution, contracts and
totally closed to aliens
transactions of the BOD, cannot be
o Disqualification of directors,
overturned or set aside by the SHs
trustees or officers (27):
or members and not even by the
Convicted by final judgment of
courts under the principle that the
an offense punishable by
business of the corp has been left
imprisonment for a period
to the hands of the BOD; and
exceeding six (6) years, or
Directors and duly authorized
Violation of this Code
officers cannot be held personally committed within five (5) years
liable for acts or contracts done prior to the date of his election
with the exercise of their business or appointment
judgment.
By-laws may provide for
Exceptions:
additional
o When the Corp Code expressly
qualifications/disqualifications
provides otherwise; as long as such additional
o When the directors or officers qualifications/disqualifications
acted with fraud, gross shall not modify requirements
negligence or in bad faith; and as prescribed in the corporation

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 22 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

code or be in conflict with such corporation multiplied by the whole


prescribed requirements number of directors to be elected
(47(5)) o Gives the minority an opportunity
o Note: To sit on the BOD is not a to elect a representative to the
vested right. Ownership of shares BOD. Cannot itself give the
does not automatically equate to a minority control of corporate affairs
seat in the BOD but may affect and limit the extent
o In widely-held corporations, SEC of majoritys control
mandates the presence of at least o Theoretically, this allows the
2 or 20% of its board size, minority block to dominate the
whichever is lesser, independent election of BOD. However, the
directors (Securities Regulation minority still needs the majority in
Code, 38 and Guidelines on the order to constitute a quorum.
Nomination and Election of o By-laws cannot provide against
Independent Directors, Memo Circ cumulative voting since this right is
No. 16, 2002) mandated in 24 (mandatory in a
stock corporation statutory right
Term: Directors shall hold office for 1 of SHs)
year. However, incumbent directors o In determining how many shares
shall continue to be directors/trustees are needed to vote for the desired
until their successors have been elected # of directors (necessary when one
and qualified (23) campaigns for proxies), the
following formula may be followed:
2) How elected (24) [ (outstanding shares) x (desired #
Manner of election: of directors) + 1 ] / [ (total # of
o There must be present in person or directors) + 1 ]
by representative majority of the o Unless otherwise provided in the
outstanding capital stock / member AOI or in the by-laws, members of
o In any form; or must be by ballot corporations which have no capital
when requested by any voting stock may cast as many votes as
stock holder or member there are trustees to be elected but
o Voting may be in person or by may not cast more than one vote
proxy for one candidate.
At all elections of directors or trustees, Candidates receiving the highest
there must be present owners of a number of votes shall be declared
majority of the outstanding capital elected.
stock, or if there be no capital stock, a Any meeting of the stockholders or
majority of the members entitled to members called for an election may
vote. adjourn from day to day or from time
Every stockholder entitled to vote shall to time but not sine die or indefinitely
have the right to vote the number of if:
shares of stock outstanding, at the time o For any reason, no election is held,
fixed in the by-laws, in his own name or
on the stock books of the corporation, o If there are SHs not present or
or where the by-laws are silent, at the represented by proxy at the
time of the election meeting, the owners of a majority
Time to determine voting right of the outstanding capital stock, or
o As per share standing in ones if there be no capital stock, a
name at the time fixed by the By- majority of the member entitled to
Laws vote.
o Where By-laws silent, at time of Since the provision requires presence,
election meeting of stockholders is required
Cumulative voting A system of voting
designed to increase the voting power 3) How Removed (28)
of minority stockholders in the election Any director or trustee of a corporation
of corporate directors when more than may be removed from office by a vote
one director is to be elected. of the stockholders holding or
o A stockholder shall have as many representing 2/3 of the outstanding
votes as he has number of shares capital stock, or if the corporation be a
times the number of directors up Non-stock Corporation, by a vote of 2/3
for election of the members entitled to vote (with
o Cumulative voting is allowed for or without cause).
election of members of the Board in Note: Such removal shall take place
a stock corporation. Members of either at a regular meeting or at a
the Board in a Non-stock special meeting called for the purpose
Corporation shall not be voted of removal of Directors or Trustees,
cumulatively unless specifically with previous notice of the time and
provided for in the By-laws. place of such meeting, as well as the
o The total number of votes cast by a intention to propose such removal. If
stockholder shall not exceed the the officers refuse to call a meeting to
number of shares owned by him as consider the removal of the Director, it
shown in the books of the may be called at the instance of any

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 23 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

stockholder or member, but with due result of an amendment of the articles


notice. authorizing such increase
Removal without cause may not be
used to deprive minority stockholders 5) Compensation (30)
or members of the right of In the absence of any provision in the
representation to which they may be By-laws fixing their compensation, the
entitled to under Section 24 directors shall not receive any
The board cannot remove a director or compensation, except for reasonable
trustee as member of the board per diems.
Any such compensation (other than per
Roxas v Dela Rosa (1926) diems) may be granted to the directors
by the vote of the stockholders
Binalbagan Estate Inc is engaged in the mfg of raw representing at least a majority of the
sugar from canes. Possessors of majority of shares outstanding capital stock at a regular or
formed a voting trust composed of 3 trustees. special stockholders meeting.
Trustees now controlled 3,000 out of 5,500 shares. Limit: In no case shall the total yearly
compensation of directors, as such
Voting trust was able to vote BOD, without directors, exceed 10% of the net
opposition from minority. income before income tax of the
Trustees soon wanted to remove the directors they corporation during the preceding year.
had elected, even if their terms had not yet
expired. Voting trust caused SEC to issue notice for
a special gen mtg to elect a new BOD. Western Institute of Technology v Salas
(1997)
Held: Under the law, directors can only be removed
by vote of SHs representing at least 2/3 of the
In a meeting of the Board of Trustees of Western
subscribed capital stock entitled to vote. When the
Institute of Technology, a resolution was passed
purpose is to remove directors, it must be stated in
granting monthly compensation to officers
call for meeting. But vacancies in BOD can be filled
respondents who are members of the Board. The
by mere majority vote.
resolution is valid. The prohibition with respect to
Trust does not have clear 2/3 majority. Voting trust granting compensation to corporate
should have stated in notice that purpose was to directors/trustees under Section 30 of the
remove present BOD. Meeting called by trustees Corporation Code is not violated since the
enjoined. compensation is being given to private respondents
in their capacity as officers of WIT and not as board
In this case, removal was sought to be done by members.
replacing directors
BUT cant remove thru election of new officers bec
directors have fixed term of office 6) How corporate powers exercised Board
must act as a body in a meeting

Note: 28 need not be resorted to in all instances. Requisites of board meetings


If removal is for cause (mismanagement or abuse Meeting of the Board duly assembled
of powers, the remedy of SHs shall be: Existence of quorum
a) Receivership; Decision of the majority of the quorum
b) Injunction if the act has not yet been duly assembled (EXCEPTION: Election
done; of directors requires a vote of
c) Dissolution if abuse amounts to a ground majority of all the members of the
for quo warranto but Sol Gen refuses to board)
act;
d) Derivative suit or complaint filed with WHEN? (53)
the RTC; Regular meetings of directors or
e) Criminal action trustees shall be held monthly, unless
the by-laws provide otherwise.
4) Vacancies (29) Special meetings of the board of
Vacancies in the Board of Directors or directors or trustees may be held at
Trustees MAY be filled by a vote of at least any time upon the call of the president
a majority of the remaining directors or or as provided in the by-laws.
trustees; if still constituting a quorum
WHERE? (53)
In the following cases, the stockholders or Meetings of directors or trustees of
members shall fill the vacancy (REAQ): corporations may be held anywhere in or
a. When the remaining outside of the Philippines, unless the by-
directors or trustees do not constitute a laws provide otherwise.
quorum;
b. If the vacancy is WHO MAY ATTEND?
caused by the removal of a director or The members of the Board themselves;
trustee directors in Board meetings cannot be
c. If the vacancy is represented or voted by proxies.
caused by the expiration of term; and
d. In case of increase in WHO PRESIDES? (54)
the number of directors or trustees as a

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 24 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

The president shall preside at all meetings a. A president, who shall be a director
of the directors or trustee, unless the by- b. A treasurer who may or may not be
laws provide otherwise. a director (SEC opinion that the
treasurer must be a resident and
NOTICE REQUIREMENTS (53) citizen of the Phil.)
Notice of regular or special c. A secretary who shall be a resident
meetings stating the date, time and and citizen of the Philippines, and
place of the meeting must be sent to d. Such other officers as may be
every director or trustee at least one provided for in the By-laws
(1) day prior to the scheduled meeting, Any two (2) or more positions may be
unless otherwise provided by the by- held concurrently by the same person,
laws. except that no one shall act as
A director or trustee may waive this president and secretary or as president
requirement, either expressly or and treasurer at the same time.
impliedly Additional qualifications of officers may
be provided for in the by-laws (47(5))
QUORUM REQUIREMENTS (25)
Unless the articles of incorporation or the Ongkingco v. NLRC (1997)
by-laws provide for a greater majority, a
majority of the number of directors or Where the By-laws of the condominium corporation
trustees as fixed in the articles of specifically includes the position of
incorporation shall constitute a quorum for Superintendent/Administrator in a roster of
the transaction of corporate business, and corporate officers, then such position is clearly a
every decision of at least a majority of the corporate officer position and issues of
directors or trustees present at a meeting reinstatement would be within the jurisdiction of
at which there is a quorum shall be valid as the SEC and not the NLRC.
a corporate act, except for the election of
Tabaug v. NLRC (1997)
officers which shall require the vote of a
majority of all the members of the board.
When the By-laws of the corporation provide that
one of the powers of the Board of Trustees is to
Filipinas Port Services Inc., represented by appoint a Medical Director,
stockholders, Eliodoro C. Cruz v. Victoriano Comptroller/Administration, Chief of Services, and
S. Go, et al. such other officers as it may deem necessary and
GR No. 161886 prescribe their powers and duties then such
March 16, 2007 specifically designated positions should be
Cruz, a stockholder of the corporation, filed a considered corporate officers positions.
derivative suit against the members of the
board questioning the creation of certain 2. Disqualifications (27)
positions. Cruz thus prayed that the respondent No person convicted by final judgment of
members of the board of directors be made to an offense punishable by imprisonment for
pay Filport, jointly and severally, the sums of a period exceeding six (6) years, or a
money variedly representing the damages violation of this Code committed within five
incurred as a result of the creation of the (5) years prior to the date of his election or
offices/positions complained of and the appointment, shall qualify as a director,
aggregate amount of the questioned increased trustee or officer of any corporation.
salaries.
3. Authority of corporate officers
HELD: The boards creation of the positions of The authority of corporate officers to
Assistant Vice Presidents for Corporate bind the corporation is usually not
Planning, Operations, Finance and considered inherent in their office but is
Administration, and those of the Special derived from law, the corporate by-
Assistants to the President and the Board laws or by delegation from the BOD
Chairman, was in accordance with the regular either expressly or impliedly by habit,
business operations of Filport as it is authorized custom, or acquiescence in the general
to do so by the corporations by-laws, pursuant course of business
Gen rule: A person dealing with a
to the Corporation Code. Besides, the
determination of the necessity for additional corporate officer is put on inquiry as to
the scope of the latters authority but
offices and/or positions in a corporation is a
an innocent person cannot be
management prerogative which courts are not
prejudiced if he had the right to
wont to review in the absence of any proof that presume under the circumstances the
such prerogative was exercised in bad faith or authority of the acting officers.
with malice.

2.2 CORPORATE OFFICERS AND Peoples Aircargo vs. CA (1998)


AGENTS
Corporate President Punsalan solicited a proposal
1. Minimum set of officers and from respondent Sano for the preparation of a
Qualification (25) feasibility study. Sano prepared feasibility study
Immediately after their election, the and was paid for it. Another proposal for the
directors of a corporation must formally preparation of operations manual was solicited from
organize the election of: Sano and was accepted by Punsalan. Manual was

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 25 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

prepared and approved by Commissioner of Bureau board, it is not sufficient to give them effect.
of Customs, seminar-workshops conducted but Stockholders or members approval expressed
payment was not made in a meeting duly called and held for the
purpose is still necessary. Exception:
HELD: Corporation is liable to Sano for services Corporations may be bound by
rendered. General rule is that absent the authority unanimous agreement of its stockholders
from the Board of Directors, no person, not even its although expressed elsewhere than at a
officers, can bind the corporation. However, acts of meeting
person in behalf of the corporation may be ratified.
When corporation previously allowed First Contract, 7) Requirements of stockholders or
it gave president apparent authority to execute in members meeting (notice and
its behalf the other contract, and is estopped from quorum)
denying such authority. Corporation accepted
operations manual and the seminars and have WHEN? (50)
already benefited from the contract. This ratifies Regular meetings of stockholders or
the act of the president and makes it binding upon members shall be held annually on a date
the corporation. President is presumed to have fixed in the by-laws, or if not so fixed, on
authority to act within the domain of the general any date in April of every year as
objectives of the corporation determined by the board of directors or
trustees.
Rural Bank of Milaor vs. Ocfemia (2000)
WHERE?
When a bank, by its acts and failure to act, has Stockholder's or member's
clearly clothed its manager with apparent authority meetings, whether regular or special,
to sell an acquired asset in the normal course of shall be held in the city or municipality
business, it is legally obliged to confirm the where the principal office of the
transaction by issuing a board resolution to enable corporation is located, and if practicable
the buyers to register the property in their names. in the principal office of the
It has a duty to perform necessary and lawful acts corporation: Provided, That Metro
to enable the other parties to enjoy all benefits of Manila shall, for purposes of this
the contract which it had authorized. section, be considered a city or
municipality. (51)
Members of non-stock corporations
2.3 BOARD COMMITTEES may provide in by-laws that meetings
may be held any place even outside the
(SEC opinion-requirin all members must be place where the principal office is
members of the board) located provided proper notice is sent
The by-laws of a corporation may and that it is within the Philippines
create an executive committee, composed (93)
of not less than three members of the
board, to be appointed by the board. (35) WHO MAY ATTEND AND VOTE?
Said committee may act, by majority Stockholders may attend and vote in
vote of all its members, on such specific person, or by proxy.
matters within the competence of the a. Pledgors, mortagors, executors,
board, as may be delegated to it in the by- receivers and administrators (55)
laws or on a majority vote of the board, In case of pledged or mortgaged
except with respect to: shares in stock corporations, the
o Approval of any action for which pledgor or mortgagor shall have the
shareholders' approval is also required; right to attend and vote at
o The filling of vacancies in the board; meetings of stockholders
o The amendment or repeal of by-laws or o UNLESS, the pledgee or mortgagee is
the adoption of new by-laws; expressly given by the pledgor or
o The amendment or repeal of any mortgagor such right in writing
resolution of the board which by its which is recorded on the
express terms is not so amendable or appropriate corporate books.
repealable; and Executors, administrators,
o A distribution of cash dividends to the receivers, and other legal
shareholders. representatives duly appointed by
Cannot go as far as to render the BOD the court may attend and vote in
powerless and free from all responsibilities behalf of the stockholders or
imposed on it by law (Campos) members without need of any
Must be provided in the by-laws and written proxy.
must be composed of not less than 3 b. Joint owner of stocks (56)
members of the board The consent of all the co-owners shall
Essential the executive committee acts be necessary in order to vote, U NLESS
by majority vote of all the members there is a written proxy, signed by all
the co-owners, authorizing one or some
of them or any other person to vote
2.4 STOCKHOLDERS OR MEMBERS such share or shares PROVIDED, That
when the shares are owned in an
Stockholders action is needed in major "and/or" capacity by the holders
changes(6) in the corporation which would thereof, any one of the joint owners
affect their contract with the corporation and can vote said shares or appoint a proxy
although such action is usually initiated by the therefor.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 26 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

c. Treasury shares (Cf 41, 57. 68) a majority of the outstanding capital
Definition (9): These are shares stock or a majority of the members in
of stock which have been issued the case of non-stock corporations.
and fully paid for but subsequently By-laws may provide for a greater
re-acquired by the issuing or lesser quorum (47(3))
corporation by purchase, Where quorum is present at the
redemption, donation or through start of a lawful meeting, stockholders
some other lawful means. Such present cannot without justifiable cause
shares may again be disposed of break the quorum by walking out from
for a reasonable price fixed by the said meeting so as to defeat the
BOD. validity of any act proposed and
Treasury shares shall have no approved by the majority (Johnston v
voting rights as long as such shares Johnston, 1965 CA decision)
remain in the Treasury. (57)
WHY ATTEND MEETINGS?
WHO PRESIDES? To make substantial changes
The president shall preside at all To exercise control
meetings of of the stockholders or To be apprised of events
members, unless the by-laws provide To elect BOD
otherwise. ( 54) To confirm actions requiring
When there is no person authorized to confirmation
call a meeting, the SEC, upon petition
of a stockholder or member on a 8) Corporate Acts Requiring Approval of
showing of good cause therefor, may ALL Stockholders (including non-voting
issue an order to the petitioning shares)
stockholder or member directing him to
call a meeting of the corporation by a. AMENDMENT OF ARTICLES OF
giving proper notice required by this INCORPORATION discussed in Chapter
Code or by the by-laws. ( 50) XIV
The petitioning stockholder or member
shall preside thereat until at least a b. EXTEND OR SHORTEN CORPORATE
majority of the stockholders or TERM discussed in Chapter XIV
members present have been chosen
one of their number as presiding c. INCREASE OR DECREASE OF CAPITAL
officer. (50) STOCK discussed in Chapter XIV

NOTICE REQUIREMENTS (50) d. INCURRING, CREATING OR INCREASING


Written notice of regular meetings BONDED INDEBTEDNESS discussed in
shall be sent to all stockholders or Chapter XI
members of record at least two (2)
weeks prior to the meeting, unless a e. SALE, LEASE, MORTGAGE OR OTHER
different period is required by the by- DISPOSITION OF SUBSTANTIALLY ALL
laws CORPORATE ASSETS discussed in
Written notice of special meetings Chapter XVII
shall be sent at least one (1) week prior
to the meeting, unless otherwise f. INVESTMENT OF FUNDS IN ANOTHER
provided in the by-laws. CORPORATION OR BUSINESS (42)
Notice of any meeting may be A private corporation may
waived, expressly or impliedly, by any invest its funds in any other
stockholder or member corporation or business or for any
Failure to give notice would render purpose other than the primary
a meeting voidable at the instance of purpose for which it was organized
an absent stockholder, who was not Approval, voting and notice
notified of the meeting (Board v. Tan, requirement
105 Phil. 426(1959). 1) Majority of the board of
Attendance to a meeting despite directors or trustees and
want of notice will be deemed implied 2) Ratified by the stockholders
waiver. (Campos) representing at least two-thirds
All proceedings had and any (2/3) of the outstanding capital
business transacted at any meeting of stock, or by at least two thirds
the stockholders or members, if within (2/3) of the members in the
the powers or authority of the case of non-stock corporations,
corporation, shall be valid even if the at a stockholder's or member's
meeting be improperly held or called, meeting duly called for the
provided all the stockholders or purpose.
members of the corporation are present 3) Written notice of the proposed
or duly represented at the meeting. investment and the time and
(51) place of the meeting shall be
addressed to each stockholder
QUORUM REQUIREMENTS (52) or member at his place of
Unless otherwise provided for in the residence as shown on the
Code or in the by-laws, a quorum shall books of the corporation and
consist of the stockholders representing deposited to the addressee in

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 27 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

the post office with postage Whenever any amendment or new


prepaid, or served personally by-laws are adopted, such
Appraisal right - any amendment or new by-laws shall
dissenting stockholder shall have be attached to the original by-laws
appraisal right in the office of the corporation, and
When SH approval not a copy thereof, duly certified under
necessary- where the investment oath by the corporate secretary and
by the corporation is reasonably a majority of the directors or
necessary to accomplish its primary trustees, shall be filed with the SEC
purpose as stated in the AOI. the same to be attached to the
Rules in case a corporation will original articles of incorporation and
invest its funds in another original by-laws.
corporation The amended or new by-laws shall
o If it is the same purpose or only be effective upon the issuance
incidental or related to its by the Securities and Exchange
primary purpose, the board can Commission of a certification that
invest the corporate fund the same are not inconsistent with
without the consent of the this Code.
stockholders. What is required
is only the vote of the majority 3. MERGER AND CONSOLIDATION
of the BOD. No appraisal right discussed in Chapter XVII
o If the investment is in another
corporation of different 4. DISSOLUTION OF THE CORPORATION
business or purpose, the discussed in Chapter XVI
affirmative vote of majority of
the board consented by 2/3 OS 5. Other instances requiring
capital stock is required stockholders action (voting shares only)
o Apparent conflict: 36(7) limits
corp powers to those a. DEC
reasonably and necessarily LARATION OF STOCK DIVIDENDS
required. But 42 implies that discussed in Chapter XIII
can invest in another business
as long as theres 2/3 vote. b. MA
Campos says that 42 should NAGEMENT CONTRACTS (44) any
be subject to 36. contract whereby a corporation
o Accdg to Campos, if articles of undertakes to manage or operate all or
incorp provide that can invest substantially all of the business of
in another business, only 2/3 another corporation, whether such
vote needed. Otherwise, should contracts are called service contracts,
amend articles first. operating agreements or otherwise

2. ADOPTION, AMENDMENT AND REPEAL Approval and Voting Requirement:


OF BY-LAWS (48) (44)
Voting Requirement: BOD or BOT Approval by the board of
by a majority vote and the owners directors, and
of at least a majority of the Approval by stockholders
outstanding capital stock, or owning at least the majority of the
majority of the members of a non- outstanding capital stock, or by at
stock corporation, at a regular or least a majority of the members of
special meeting duly called for the both the managing and the
purpose, may amend or repeal any managed corporation (at meeting
by-laws or adopt new by-laws duly called)
Delegation of power to amend the 2/3 vote required of the
BOD: The owners of two-thirds managed corporation when:
(2/3) of the outstanding capital o Where a stockholder or
stock or two-thirds (2/3) of the stockholders representing the
members in a non-stock same interest of both the
corporation may delegate to the managing and the managed
board of directors or trustees the corporations own or control
power to amend or repeal any by- more than one-third (1/3) of
laws or adopt new by-laws the total outstanding capital
Revocation of the delegation of stock entitled to vote of the
power to amend: Any power managing corporation; or
delegated to the board of directors o Where a majority of the
or trustees to amend or repeal any members of the BOD of the
by-laws or adopt new by-laws shall managing corporation also
be considered as revoked whenever constitute a majority of the
stockholders owning or members of the BOD of the
representing a majority of the managed corporation
outstanding capital stock or a Term of management contract: not
majority of the members in non- longer than five years
stock corporations, shall so vote at
a regular or special meeting c. FIXI
NG CONSIDERATION OF NO-PAR

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 28 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

SHARES (62) The issued price of no- shall pay the fair value thereof as
par value shares may be fixed in the of the day prior to the date on
AOI or by the BOD pursuant to which the vote was taken,
authority conferred upon it by the AOI excluding any appreciation or
or the by-laws, or in the absence depreciation in anticipation of such
thereof, by the stockholders at a corporate action (provided that the
meeting duly called for the purpose proposed corp action is
representing at least a majority of the implemented or affected).
outstanding capital stock. If within a period of sixty (60) days
from the date the corporate action
d. FIXI was approved by the stockholders,
NG COMPENSATION OF DIRECTORS the withdrawing stockholder and
(30) Any such compensation (other the corporation cannot agree on the
than per diems) may be granted to the fair value of the shares, it shall be
directors by the vote of the determined and appraised by three
stockholders representing at least a (3) disinterested persons
majority of the outstanding capital o One of whom shall be named
stock at a regular or special by the stockholder, another by
stockholders meeting. the corporation, and the third
by the two thus chosen
6. Appraisal right The findings of the majority of the
One of the ways to get out of the corporation. appraisers shall be final
It is an exception to the trust fund doctrine. The award shall be paid by the
The other way is to sell the shares of stock. corporation within thirty (30) days
after such award is made
a. Definition (81) No payment shall be made to any
This is a remedy available to a dissenting stockholder unless the
stockholder who dissented and voted corporation has unrestricted
against certain extraordinary matters to retained earnings in its books to
withdraw or get out of the corporation cover such payment (Cf 41).
by demanding payment of the value of Ratio: to protect the creditors and
his shares, as provided in the code. the remaining SHs
Upon payment by the corporation
b. Instances of appraisal right (81) of the agreed or awarded price, the
a) In case any amendment to the stockholder shall forthwith transfer
articles of incorporation which has his shares to the corporation.
the effect of (cf 16):
- changing or restricting the d. Effect of demand and termination of
rights of any stockholder or right (83)
class of shares, or From the time of demand for payment
- authorizing preferences in of the fair value of a stockholder's
any respect superior to shares until either (1) the
those of outstanding shares abandonment of the corporate action
of any class, or involved or (2) the purchase of the said
- extending or shortening shares by the corporation, all rights
the term of corporate accruing to such shares, including
existence (cf 37) voting and dividend rights, shall be
b) In case of sale, lease, suspended,
exchange, transfer, mortgage, pledge EXCEPT the right of such
or other disposition of all or stockholder to receive payment of the
substantially all of the corporate fair value thereof, PROVIDED, if the
property and assets as provided in the dissenting stockholder is not paid the
Code (cf 40); and value of his shares within 30 days after
c) In case of merger or consolidation the award, his voting and dividend
d) In case of investment of corporate rights shall immediately be restored.
funds in another corporation or
business or for any other purpose e. When right to payment of fair value of
(42) the shares ceases (84)

c. What are the requirements for the No demand for payment may be
successful exercise of appraisal right? withdrawn unless the corporation
(Section 82 and 86) consents thereto.
By making a written demand on the Instances when right to payment
corporation within thirty (30) days ceases:
after the date on which the vote 1) If such demand for payment is
was taken for payment of the fair withdrawn with the consent of
value of his shares the corporation
o Failure to make the demand 2) If the proposed corporate
within such period shall be action is abandoned or
deemed a waiver of the rescinded by the corporation
appraisal right. 3) If the proposed corporate
By surrendering the certificate or action disapproved by the SEC
certificates of stock, the corporation

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 29 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

where such approval is b. Signed by the stockholder or


necessary, member
4) If the SEC determines that such c. Filed before the scheduled meeting
stockholder is not entitled to with the corporate secretary
the appraisal right By-laws can also impose additional
In such instances, his status as a requirements (ex. Must be notarized)
stockholder shall be restored, and Unless otherwise provided in the proxy, it
all dividend distributions which shall be valid only for the meeting for which
would have accrued on his shares it is intended. No proxy shall be valid and
shall be paid to him. effective for a period longer than five (5)
years at any one time (continuing proxy).
f. Who bears costs of appraisal (85) Right of proxy can be waived only for close
Generally, it shall be borne by the corporations (89)
corporation Senses of proxy:
Exception: by the SH, when the fair a. Person duly authorized by
value ascertained by the appraisers stockholder or member to vote in his
is approximately the same as the behalf in a SHs or members meeting.
price which the corporation may Proxy is an agent for a special purpose
have offered to pay the SH, thus the general rules of agency would
In the case of an action to recover normally apply to the relationship
such fair value, all costs and created by proxy
expenses shall be assessed against b. Formal authority given by the
the corporation, unless the refusal holder of the stock who has the right to
of the SH to receive payment was vote it to another to exercise the voting
unjustified. rights of the former.
Instrument or document which
g. Notation on certificates; rights of evidences the authority of the agent.
transferee (86) Failure to comply with requirements will
Within ten (10) days after render proxy void and ineffective.
demanding payment for his shares, To what extent does the proxy holder
a dissenting SH shall submit the exercise his discretion? Extent of authority
certificates of stock representing given by the SH
his shares to the corporation for Proxy is revocable even when it is
notation thereon that such shares expressly provided to be irrevocable unless
are dissenting shares. it is coupled with an interest. The Supreme
His failure to do so shall, at the Court has held that a proxy in favor of the
option of the corporation, terminate pledge of the shares subject of the proxy
his rights. as sufficient interest to render such proxy
Effect of transfer of certificates irrevocable. (Alejandrino vs. De Leon,
bearing notation: 1943)
1) The rights of the transferor as a Revocation may be made orally, in writing
dissenting stockholder shall or implied:
cease; a. Appearance of the stockholder at
2) The transferee shall have all the meeting will terminate the proxy
the rights of a regular b. Death of the stockholder will also
stockholder; and terminate the proxy
3) All dividend distributions which
would have accrued on such 3.2 VOTING TRUST AGREEMENT(59)
shares shall be paid to the Definition: An arrangement created by
transferee. one or more stockholders for the purpose
of conferring upon a trustee or trustees the
Note: right to vote is lost only if stock becomes right to vote and other rights pertaining to
delinquent (71) the shares for a period not exceeding five
(5) years at any time (Villanueva). The
arrangement is embodied in a document
3. Devices Affecting Control called a voting trust agreement (VTA)
A voting trust, which is specifically
General Rule: Extent of control is proportional to required as a condition in a loan
the number of shares owned by the SH agreement, may be for a period exceeding
Exceptions: proxy device, voting trust agreements, five (5) years but shall automatically expire
pooling and voting agreements, cumulative voting, upon full payment of the loan
classification of shares, restriction on transfer of Essence: separation of real ownership
shares, additional qualifications for directors, and voting rights
founders shares, management contracts, and Requirements of a VTA:
unusual quorum and voting requirements a. In writing
b. Notarized
3.1 PROXY (58, cf 20, Sec Regulation Code) c. Shall specify the terms and conditions
Stockholders and members may vote in thereof
person or by proxy in all meetings of d. Certified copy of such agreement shall
stockholders or members. be filed with the corporation and with
Requirements of proxies: the SEC
a. In writing (oral proxies are not o OTHERWISE, said agreement is
valid) ineffective and unenforceable

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 30 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Procedure: The trustee cant dispose of the block


a. The certificate or certificates of of shares/ receive dividends. Can only
stock covered by the voting trust vote
agreement shall be cancelled and new The SH can revoke the VTA on the
ones shall be issued in the name of the ground of breach of fiduciary obligations
trustee or trustees stating that they are Status of transferee and transferor:
issued pursuant to said agreement. a. Voting trustee is only a share
b. In the books of the corporation, it owner vested with apparent legal title
shall be noted that the transfer in the for the sole purpose of voting upon
name of the trustee or trustees is made stocks that he does not own
pursuant to said voting trust b. Transferring stockholder retains the
agreement. right of inspection of corporate books
c. The trustee or trustees shall which he can exercise concurrently with
execute and deliver to the transferors the voting trustee
voting trust certificates, which shall be
transferable in the same manner and Powers and rights of voting trustees:
with the same effect as certificates of a. Right to vote and other rights
stock. pertaining to the shares in their names
Right to inspect VTA: The voting trust subject to terms and conditions of and
agreement filed with the corporation shall for the period specified in the
be subject to examination by any agreement
stockholder in the same manner as any b. Vote in person or by proxy unless
other corporate book or record. The agreement provides otherwise
transferor and the trustee or trustees may c. Rights of inspection of corporate books
exercise the right of inspection of all and records
corporate books and records in accordance d. Legal title holder qualified to be a
with the provisions of this Code. director
Any other stockholder may transfer his The clear intent is that in order to
shares to the same trustee or trustees be eligible as director, what is
upon the terms and conditions stated in the material is the legal title to, not the
voting trust agreement, and thereupon beneficial ownership of, the stock
shall be bound by all the provisions of said as a[appearing on the books of a
agreement. corporation. Therefore, a director
Restriction: No VTA shall be entered who executes a voting trust
into for the purpose of circumventing the agreement over all his shares,
law against monopolies and illegal remains only a beneficial owner,
combinations in restraint of trade or used and therefore is automatically
for purposes of fraud. disqualified from his directorship.
Automatic expiration of rights under (Lee v. CA, 1992)
the VTA: Unless expressly renewed, all Limitations on voting trust agreements:
rights granted in a voting trust agreement a. should not exceed 5 years except if
shall automatically expire at the end of the a condition in a loan agreement, shall
agreed period. The voting trust certificates automatically expire upon full payment
as well as the certificates of stock in the of the loan
name of the trustee or trustees shall b. must not be for purposes of
thereby be deemed cancelled and new circumventing the law against
certificates of stock shall be reissued in the monopolies and illegal combinations in
name of the transferors. restraint of trade
The voting trustee or trustees may vote c. must not be used for purposes of
by proxy unless the agreement provides fraud
otherwise. d. must be in writing, notarized,
Purpose to make possible a unified specify the terms and conditions
control of the affairs of the corporation and thereof
consistent policy; to make possible for a e. certified copy must be filed with
majority group of shareholders to dispose corporation and SEC otherwise
of a beneficial interest in a large proportion unenforceable
of their shares and still retain control of the f. agreement is subject to
corporation through the voting trustee examination by stockholder
Under the prevailing view, a voting g. shall automatically expire at the
trust should have a legitimate business end of the agreed period
purpose to promote the best interests of h. vote in person or by proxy unless
the corporation, or even to protect the agreement provides otherwise
legitimate interests of others in the i. rights of inspection of corporate
corporation (Ballantine, cited in Campos) books and records
No principal-agent relationship
The trustee has unlimited authority. Distinction between proxy and voting trust
The only limitation is that he should act for
Proxy VTA
the benefit of the SH (fiduciary obligation)
Legal title No legal title Acquires legal title
Voting trust certificates issued by the
Revocability Revocable unless Irrevocable if
trustees (not the corp). These certificates
coupled with validly executed
confirm (1) that a trustee has been interest BUT SH can
constituted, (2) the extent of shares, and revoke if theres a
(3) the participation of the SH in the VTA breach of fiduciary

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 31 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Proxy VTA against stockholders not party to the


obligation contract. Thus, it is void if it provides that
Extent of Can only act at a Not limited to any directors, once elected, should vote for
power specified particular meeting certain persons as officers. (McQuade v.
stockholders or Stoneham, 263 NY 323 (1934)) EXCEPTION:
members Close corps may provide that a VTA can
meeting interfere with discretion of the BOD
When to Absence of the Even when owner
vote
Does not involve a transfer of stocks but is
owner is present merely a private agreement
Capacity to Cant be voted as Can be voted as a
be a No transfer of ownership and voting rights
a director, unless director.
director Agreements by stockholders in close
he is also a SH of Considered as the
record (owns SH of record in corporations (100):
other shares) the books of the o Agreements by and among
corp stockholders executed before the
Subject Voting rights Shares + voting formation and organization of a close
Matter rights corporation, signed by all stockholders,
Duration Usually shorter Usually longer but shall survive the incorporation of such
but cant exceed 5 cant exceed 5 corporation and shall continue to be
years years except in valid and binding between and among
loan agreements such stockholders, if such be their
intent, to the extent that such
agreements are not inconsistent with
Natl Investment & Devt Corp v Aquino (1988) the articles of incorporation,
irrespective of where the provisions of
Batjak, a Fil-Am corp, owed money to PNB. Its oil such agreements are contained, except
mills were also mortgaged to other banks. They those required by this Title to be
further borrowed money from NIDC, a wholly embodied in said articles of
owned subsidiary of PNB, to pay off the mortgages. incorporation.
In return, NIDC got preferred shares, convertible o An agreement between two or
into common shares. Batjak executed a 1st more stockholders, if in writing and
mortgage on all its properties to PNB in exchange signed by the parties thereto, may
for a credit facility etc. provide that in exercising any voting
Next, a Voting Trust Agreement was executed in rights, the shares held by them shall be
favor of NIDC by SHs representing 60% of Batjak. voted as therein provided, or as they
Period of 5 years, irrevocable. During this time, all may agree, or as determined in
dividends to be paid to SHs. When Batjak became accordance with a procedure agreed
insolvent, PNB foreclosed the mortgaged upon by them.
properties. When Batjak failed to redeem, it o No provision in any written
transferred ownership to NIDC. agreement signed by the stockholders,
Batjak later sued NIDC, asking for the turn-over of relating to any phase of the corporate
all the assets and in the alternative, asked for affairs, shall be invalidated as between
receivership. the parties on the ground that its effect
Held: is to make them partners among
*Receiver is appointed if applicant has interest in themselves.
property. But title of properties is now with NIDC. o A written agreement among some
*Batjak did not impugn validity of the foreclosure or all of the stockholders in a close
sales. Also, no evidence that prop is in danger of corporation shall not be invalidated on
loss, removal or material injury if receiver not the ground that it so relates to the
appointed. conduct of the business and affairs of
What was assigned to NIDC was only power to vote the corporation as to restrict or
shares of stock of Batjak. Such power includes interfere with the discretion or powers
authority to execute any agreement or doc of the board of directors: Provided,
necessary to express consent or assent to any That such agreement shall impose on
matter by SHs. the stockholders who are parties
Voting trust did not provide for transfer of assets. thereto the liabilities for managerial
What was stipulated to be returned were only acts imposed by this Code on directors.
certifs of stock. Voting trust transfers only voting or o To the extent that the stockholders
other rights pertaining to shares or control over the are actively engaged in the
stock. management or operation of the
business and affairs of a close
corporation, the stockholders shall be
3.3 POOLING AND VOTING AGREEEMENTS
held to strict fiduciary duties to each
Agreement between 2 or more stockholders
other and among themselves. Said
to vote their shares in the same way stockholders shall be personally liable
There must be a valuable consideration for for corporate torts unless the
each party corporation has obtained reasonably
Usually relate to election of directors adequate liability insurance.
Parties often provide for arbitration in case
of disagreement. Note: arbitrator is not PROXY TRUSTEE POOLING
like a trustee. The former has no voting AND VOTING
rights AGREEMENTS
Valid as long as they do not limit the
discretion of the BOD in the management
of corporate affairs or work any fraud

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 32 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Principal Trustee- Consensual Chapter VIII


agent beneficiary DUTIES OF DIRECTORS AND
Proxy cant The only limit to Merely an CONTROLLING STOCKHOLDERS
exceed his authority: agreement to
delegated must be for vote in the
authority benefit of same way 1. Duties and Liabilities of Directors
trustee
(fiduciary 1.1 Duties In General
obligation)
Duty Violation under 31
Must be in Must be in No formalities
writing writing and required Obedience - Willfully and knowingly
notarized vote for or assent to
patently unlawful acts of the
Copy must Copy must be Merely a
corporation
be filed filed with SEC contract
with corp between SHs Diligence - Guilty of gross negligence
sec or bad faith in directing the
affairs of the corporation
Transfer of legal
title to trustee Loyalty - Acquire any personal or
pecuniary interest in conflict
Regular Absolute voting Owner still
with their duty as such
voting rights, subj exercises
directors or trustees
rights only to voting rights
fiduciary duty
Another
Extent of liability: Directors or trustees
person Another person
exercises exercises shall be liable jointly and severally for all
voting voting rights damages resulting therefrom suffered by
rights only continuously the corporation, its stockholders, or
for a members and other persons
specific mtg Directors act as a body in formulating corp
(unless policies and exercise all powers of
otherwise management. Hence, they are fiduciaries
provided) of the corp. It does not matter who
elected them. Once elected, they must
Proxy Trustee can be represent the interests of all SHs and of
cannot be director the corp as a whole.
director Directors must act only within the corp
powers. If not, they will be liable for
Revocable Irrevocable, as Revocable by
damages, unless they acted in GF and with
at will, in long as no consent or
due diligence
any manner misconduct or mutual
fraud termination. If
EXC if 1.2 Duty of diligence
unilateral
coupled What are required and expected of
termination,
with an directors:
liable for
interest o To possess at least ordinary knowledge
damages
and skill to enable them to make sound
Max of 5 Max of 5 yrs at business decision
yrs at a a time (unless o To attend directors meetings with
time coterminus with reasonable regularity
loan) o To exercise reasonable care in the
management of the corporation
SEC can pass on validity
o To keep themselves sufficiently
informed about the general condition of
the business
The degree of care and diligence required is
usually that which men prompted by self-
interest, generally exercise in their own
affairs. In determining whether reasonable
diligence has been exercised, the particular
circumstances of each case must be
considered. The nature of the business is
an important factor.

Business judgment rule


GEN RULE: Directors cannot be held liable for
mistakes or errors in the exercise of their
business judgment if they acted in good faith,
with due care & prudence. Contracts intra vires
entered into by the board of directors are
binding upon the corp. & courts will not
interfere.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 33 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

EXCEPTION: If the contracts are so


unconscionable & oppressive as to amount to a 1.3 Duty of loyalty
wanton destruction of the rights of the
minority. The determination as to whether, in a given
case, the duty of loyalty has been violated has
Board of Directors has authority to modify the ultimately to be decided by the court on the
proposed terms of the contracts of the cases own merits. The ff. are more common
corporation for the purpose of making the situations involving such conflict of interests:
terms more acceptable to the other contracting
partiesThe test to be applied is whether the a. Self-dealing director (32)
act in question is the direct and immediate A contract of the corporation with one
furtherance of the corporations business, fairly or more of its directors or trustees is
incidental to the express powers and voidable, at the option of such
reasonably necessary to their exercise. If so, corporation, unless all the following
the corporation has the power to do it; conditions are present:
otherwise not. [Montelibano v. Bacolod Murcia o That the presence of such director
Milling Co. (1962)] or trustee in the board meeting in
which the contract was approved
Steinberg vs. Velasco was not necessary to constitute a
quorum for such meeting;
Steinberg is the receiver of Sibugay Trading. o That the vote of such director or
Velasco (Pres) and other directors, approved trustee was not necessary for the
and authorized unlawful purchases of approval of the contract;
companys stock from Ganzon et al. Accdg to o That the contract is fair and
Steinberg, this diverted funds supposed to be reasonable under the
paid to creditors. circumstances; and
o That in case of an officer, the
Ganzon et al resigned as directors before the contract has been previously
BoD approved the purchase of stocks from authorized by the board of
them, worth 3,300. At that time, corp owed directors.
13K. The corp also declared dividends in favor Where any of the first two conditions
of SHs, to be paid in installments so as not to set forth in the preceding paragraph is
affect financial condition of the corp. A/Rs absent, in the case of a contract with a
which appeared on books were worthless, director or trustee, such contract may
because receiver could not collect them. be ratified by the vote of the
stockholders representing at least two-
HELD: If directors dispose of corp prop or pay thirds (2/3) of the outstanding capital
away its money without authority, they will be stock or of at least two-thirds (2/3) of
required to make good the loss out of their the members in a meeting called for
private estates. the purpose
Full disclosure of the adverse interest of
Directors are not liable for loss to corp from the directors or trustees involved must
want of knowledge, or for mistakes of be made at such meeting provided,
judgment, provided they were honest and fairly however, that the contract is fair and
within the scope of the powers and discretion reasonable under the circumstances
confided to mgt. The contract is voidable whether the
But acceptance of office of director implies a corporation suffered damages or not
competent knowledge of the duties assumed, The burden of proving fairness is on the
and directors cannot excuse imprudence bec of director
their ignorance or inexperience. If they commit
error of judgment through mere recklessness or b. Fixing compensation of directors and
want of ordinary prudence or skill, they may be officers (30)
held liable for consequences. General rule: Directors are only
entitled to per diems, which are
Creditors of corp have right to assume that so reasonable
long as there are outstanding debts and Exception: When AOI, by-laws, or an
liabilities, BoD will not use assets of corp to
advance contract provides for
purchase its own stock, and that it will not
compensation
declare dividends to SHs when corp is insolvent.
Assuming compensation is intended,
Directors held liable. only SHs can fix the amount. In fact,
the SHs should approve the granting of
Stock purchases and dividends were
compensation because this entails a
funded out of remaining assets. But reduction of the amount that could be
assets < liabilities. distributed to them as dividends
Ganzon et al were favored bec they SHs resolution to grant compensation can only
were able to get money ahead of refer to future services (Barreto v La Previsora
creditors Filipina (1932))
Recipients of dividends can be held
liable by receiver. Ratio: SHs are
accessories. Remember, they were
the ones who chose directors.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 34 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Western Institute of Technology v. Salas was not necessary to constitute a


(1997) quorum for such meeting
2. That the vote of such director or
The position of being chairman and Vice-Chairman, trustee was not necessary for the
like that of treasurer and secretary, are not approval of the contract
considered directorship positions but officership 3. That the contract is fair and
positions that would entitle the occupants to reasonable under the circumstances
compensation. Likewise, the limitation placed under 4. That in case of an officer, the
Sect. 30 of the Corporation Code that directors contract with the officer has been
cannot receive compensation exceeding 10% of the previously authorized by the Board
net income of the corporation would not apply to of Directors
the compensation given to such positions since it is
being given in their capacity as officers of the d. Seizing corporate opportunity; Disloyalty
corporation and not a board members. (34)
Where a director, by virtue of his office,
acquires for himself a business
Barreto v La Previsora Filipina (1932) opportunity which should belong to the
corporation, thereby obtaining profits
Barreto, et al. are directors of La Previsora Filipina, to the prejudice of such corporation, he
a mutual building and loan assoc. By-laws provide must account to the latter for all such
compensation of 1% of profits to each director. profits by refunding the same (34)
Compensation to apply retroactively. UNLESS his act has been ratified by a
vote of the stockholders owning or
Held: By-laws do not create a legal obl to pay life representing at least two-thirds (2/3)
gratuity or pension out of its net profits => beyond of the outstanding capital stock.
powers of mutual bldg and loan assoc. o Hence, a majority SH can actually
Corp Law authorizes compensation only for future compete with the corporation if he
services, and cannot authorize continuous owns 2/3 of the OCS
compensation to particular directors after their o This provision shall be applicable,
employment has terminated for past services notwithstanding the fact that the
rendered gratuitously by them to the corp. director risked his own funds in the
venture.
Building and loan associations are founded on strict o Requires prejudice. If theres no
mutuality and equality of benefits and obligations. prejudice to the corporation, the
Any contract or by-law in contravention of a statute director or officer can still be held
is ultra vires and void. There is an implied contract liable under 31.
with members that it shall not divert funds or o 34 covers only directors.
powers to purposes other than for which it was However, according to Campos,
created. All members must participate equally in officers can be held liable under
profits and bear losses. Any diversion of funds to 31 (2nd par.).When a director,
unauthorized purposes violates principle of trustee or officer attempts to
mutuality between members. acquire or acquires, in violation of
his duty, any interest adverse to
Also, there was no valid consideration bec the past
the corporation in respect of any
services were rendered gratuitously.
matter which has been reposed in
him in confidence, as to which
c. Interlocking directors (33) equity imposes a liability upon him
A contract between two or more to deal in his own behalf, he shall
be liable as a trustee for the
corporations having interlocking
corporation and must account for
directors shall not be invalidated on
the profits which otherwise would
that ground alone, except cases of
have accrued to the corporation.
fraud.
The last paragraph of Section 31 and
The contract is fair and reasonable
Section 34 contain the doctrine of
under the circumstances.
corporate opportunity. In case of such
If the interest of the interlocking
conflict of interests, and the director
director in one corporation is
acts against the good of the
substantial and his interest in the other
corporation, he shall be accountable for
corporation or corporations is merely
the profits he obtained, even if he had
nominal, he shall be subject to the
risked his own funds.
provisions of the preceding section
Corporate right , opportunity or
(32) insofar as the latter corporation
expectancy arises only when: (a)
or corporations are concerned.
directors were negotiating on behalf of
Stockholdings exceeding twenty (20%)
the corporation; (b) the corporation
percent of the outstanding capital stock
was in need of the particular business
shall be considered substantial for
opportunity to the knowledge of the
purposes of interlocking directors.
directors, or (c) the business
Requisites of a valid contract between
opportunity was seized and developed
the corporation and one or more of its at the expense and with the facilities of
directors, trustees or officers (32): the corporation. (Litwin v Allen)
1. That the presence of such director
or trustee in the Board meeting in e. Using inside information (Cf 3.8, 23.2, 27,
which the contract was approved 61, 71.2, Securities Regulation Code)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 35 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

The fiduciary position of insiders 3, corporate treasury or otherwise improperly


benefit themselves.
directors, and officers prohibits them
It is fraudulent for a stockholder to buy
from using confidential information
relating to the business of the from another stockholder without disclosing his
corporation to benefit themselves or identity
any competitor corporation in which Principal stockholders are likewise
they may have a mere substantial prohibited from using inside information in the
interest. purchase and sale of equity security
The liability of a director or officer
guilty of using inside information is to 4. Remedies of stockholder in case
the corporation and not to any of mismanagement or abuse of
individual stockholder powers
Since loss and prejudice to the
corporation is not a requirement for Receivership
liability, the corporation has a cause of Injunction if the act has not been done
action as long as there is unfair use of Dissolution if the abuse amounts to a
inside information ground for quo warranto but the Solicitr
It is inside information if it is not General refuses to act
generally available to others and is Derivative suit a complaint filed with
acquired because of the close the RTC
relationship of the director or officer of
the corporation
Uichico, et al. vs. NLRC (1997)
General rule: (Majority view) Directors
owe no fiduciary duty to stockholders The petitioners, who are officers and directors of
but they may deal with them at arms Crispa, Inc., assailed the decision of the NLRC
length. No duty to disclose facts known holding them solidarily liable with Crispa for the
to the director or officer payment of separation pay and backwages to the
Special facts doctrine (Strong v private respondents. It was the contention of the
Repide, 1909) Conceding the petitioners that the award of separation pay and
absence of a fiduciary relationship in backwages is a corporate obligation and must
the ordinary case, courts nevertheless therefore be assumed by Crispa alone.
hold that where special circumstances o
facts are present which make it HELD: While the general rule is that obligations
inequitable for the director to withhold incurred by a corporation, acting through its
information from the stockholder, the directors, officers and employees, are its sole
duty to disclose arises and concealment liabilities, there are times when solidary liabilities
is fraud. may be incurred such as in this case where it is
undisputed that petitioners had a direct hand in the
2. Duties and Liabilities of Officers illegal dismissal of respondent employees. They
were the ones, who as high-ranking officers and
The provisions on seizing corporate opportunity and directors of Crispa, signed he Board resolution
disloyalty (311 and 34) shall also apply to retrenching the private respondents on the feigned
corporate officers ground of serious business losses that had no basis
apart from an unsigned and unaudited profit and
Note: Members of the BOD who are also officers loss statement which had no evidentiary value
are held to a more stringent liability because they whatsoever. This is indicative of bad faith on the
are in-charge of day-to-day activities (Campos). part of petitioners for which they can be held jointly
and severally liable with Crispa for all the money
claims of the illegally terminated respondent
3. Duty of controlling interest employees.
A majority stockholder is subject to the
duty of good faith when he acts by voting at a
stockholders meeting with respect to a matter Tramat Mercantile, Inc. vs. CA (1994)
in which he has a personal interest
Personal liability of a corporate director, trustee or
Controlling stockholders may dispose of
officer along (although not necessarily) with the
their shares at any time and at such price as
corporation may so validly attach, as a rule, only
they choose provided they do not pervert these
when:
prerogatives by transferring office to persons
o He assents (a) to a patently unlawful act of
who are known as intending to raid the
the corporation, or (b) for bad faith or
gross negligence in directing its affairs, or
(c) for conflict of interest, resulting in
3
Insider means: (a) the issuer; (b) a director or officer (or damages to the corporation, its
person performing similar functions) of, or a person stockholders or other persons;
controlling the issuer; (c) a person whose relationship or o He consents to the issuance of watered
former relationship to the issuer gives or gave him access stocks or who, having knowledge thereof,
to material information about the issuer or the security that does not forthwith file with the corporate
is not generally available to the public; (d) a government secretary his written objection thereto;
employee, or director, or officer of an exchange, clearing
o He agrees to hold himself personally and
agency and/or self-regulatory organization who has access
soidarily liable with the corporation; or
to material information about an issuer or a security that is
not generally available to the public; or (e) a person who o He is made, by a specific provision of law,
learns such information by a communication from any of to personally answer for his corporate
the foregoing insiders (3.8, Sec Regulations Code)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 36 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

action o A stock corporation is not precluded


Reiterated in Atrium Management Corp. v. CA, from performing or making transfer of its
2001 own stocks, in which case all the rules and
regulations imposed on stock transfer
agents, except the payment of a license fee
herein provided, shall be applicable.
Chapter IX
THE RIGHT OF INSPECTION Financial statements (75)
o Within ten (10) days from receipt of a
written request of any stockholder or
1. Basis of right member, the corporation shall furnish to
him its most recent financial statement,
Reason of the law for granting stockholders the which shall include a balance sheet as of
right to inspect the records of the corporation: As the end of the last taxable year and a profit
the beneficial owners of the business, the or loss statement for said taxable year,
stockholders have the right to know showing in reasonable detail its assets and
1. The financial condition of the corporation; liabilities and the result of its operations
and o At the regular meeting of stockholders or
2. How the corporate affairs are being managed members, the BOD or BOT shall present to
by their elected directors. such stockholders or members a financial
report of the operations of the corporation
PURPOSE: for the preceding year, which shall include
financial statements, duly signed and
So that if they find the conditions unsatisfactory, certified by an independent certified public
they may be able to take necessary measures to accountant.
protect their investment. o However, if the paid-up capital of the
corporation is less than P50,000.00, the
The right of inspection is financial statements may be certified under
oath by the treasurer or any responsible
1. Preventive to a limited extent may serve officer of the corporation.
as a deterrent to an ill-intentioned
management to know that its acts may be
scrutinized Torres et al v CA (1997)

2. Remedial a dissatisfied stockholder may


resort to the right of inspection as a It is the corporate secretary's duty and obligation
preliminary step to seeking more direct to register valid transfers of stocks and if said
remedies against abuses committed by corporate officer refuses to comply, the transferor-
management (removal of directors or a stockholder may rightfully bring suit to compel
derivative suit). performance.

The right of inspection goes hand-in-hand with the


right to vote. Through the former, the SH can
gather information on how to vote.
3. Extent of and limitations on right

3.1 Limitations as to time and place


2. What records covered; records
required to be kept by corporation a. Only at reasonable hours on business days
(74) By-laws cannot limit inspection to
merely a few days during the year
Books that record all business transactions of chosen by the directors [Pardo vs.
the corporation which shall include contract, Hercules Lumberm, 1924]
memoranda, journals, ledgers, etc; By-laws cannot provide that the
Minute book for meetings of the SHs/members; inspection shall only be upon authority
Minute book for meetings of the of the President of the corporation
board/trustees; previously obtained in each case
Stock and transfer book. (Veraguth v. Isabela Sugar Co., 1932)
However, inspection should be made in
Minutes of meetings without the signature of the such a manner as not to impede the
corporate secretary have no probative value (NATU efficient operations of the corporation
v Sec of Labor, 1981) (Duff v. Mutual Brewing Co., NYLJ, Oct.
3, 1892)
What is a stock transfer agent? By-laws can adopt policies with respect
o A stock transfer agent is one engaged to right to inspect (47(10)-Such other
principally in the business of registering matters as may be necessary for the
transfers of stocks in behalf of a stock proper or convenient transaction of its
corporation. No stock transfer agent shall corporate business and affairs)
be allowed to operate in the Philippines
unless he secures a license from the SEC b. Inspection shall be done in the place where
and pays a fee as may be fixed by the the corporation keep all its records, which,
Commission, which shall be renewable as enjoined by law, is in the principal office
annually

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 37 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Stockholder cannot demand that he be However, the SH of the parent corp can
allowed to take the corporate books look at the books of the latter with respect
outs of the corporations principal office to its investments to the subsidiary.
for the purpose of inspecting them o If they are practically one and the
(Veraguth, Supra) same in so far as management and control
is concerned, and inspection is demanded
because of gross mismanagement of
subsidiary by the parents directors who are
also directors of subsidiary, who are also
directors of the subsidiary, then the latter
3.2 Limitation as to purpose will be treated as a mere agent or
instrumentality of the respondent parent
Is the stockholders purpose material? YES. corporation and the latter may be
There is however a presumption that his compelled to open the subsidiarys books to
purpose is a proper one and the corporation its stockholders (Gokongwei v. SEC, Supra)
cannot refuse to grant him the right on its
mere belief that his motive is improper.
5. Remedies available if inspection
Otherwise, such refusal may open its refused
guilty officers or directors to liability for Mandamus
damages, UNLESS they can successfully o The writ should be directed against
prove in their defense: the corporation, but the secretary
o that the stockholder was not thereof may be joined as party
acting in good faith defendant since he is customarily
o that he improperly used the charged with the custody of all
information obtained in the past corporate records and is
o that he used the information for presumably the parson against
an illegitimate purpose whom the order of the court will be
made affective in case mandamus
is granted.
Gonzales v. PNB (1983) o And even the president of the corp.
may be made respondent if
Section 74 of the Corporation Code has been necessary to the effectuation of the
interpreted by the Supreme Court as no longer courts order (Philpotts v. Phil.
allowing the unqualified right of inspection of Manufacturing Co., 1919)
stockholder of corporate records and that the Injunction
person making the demand has to show that he Action for damages any officer or
is acting in good faith and for a legitimate agent of the corporation who shall refuse to
purpose. allow any director, trustees, stockholder or
member of the corporation to examine and
Burden of proving that the purpose is copy excerpts from its records or minutes, in
improper or illegal is on corporation and accordance with the provisions of this Code,
its officers. shall be liable to such director, trustee,
Good purposes: to investigate acts of stockholder or member for damages
management; to investigate financial File an action to impose a penal offense
conditions; fix value of shares; mailing by fine and/or imprisonment
list for proxies; information for litigation o Any officer or agent of the
Not good and honest purposes: obtain corporation who shall refuse to allow any
corporate secrets (e.g., formula); director, trustees, stockholder or member
nuisance suit; to embarrass the company of the corporation to examine and copy
TEST to determine whether the purpose as excerpts from its records or minutes, in
proved by the corporation or as admitted by accordance with the provisions of this Code
the stockholder is a legitimate one or not? A x x x and in addition, shall be guilty of an
legitimate purpose is one which is germane to offense which shall be punishable under
the interests of the stockholder as such and not Section 144 of the Corporation Code
contrary to the interests of the corporation o If such refusal is made pursuant to
(Gokongwei v. SEC, 1979). a resolution or order of the board of
directors or trustees, the liability under this
section for such action shall be imposed
4. Who may exercise right
upon the directors or trustees who voted
Director, trustee, stockholder, member, for such refusal
personally or through an agent o It shall be a defense to any action
o The right to inspect corporate books may that the person demanding to examine and
be done with the assistance of technical copy has improperly used any information
men (e.g., lawyers and accountants) and secured through any prior examination of
it may be delegated. The right includes the records, or is not acting in good faith or
the right to copy or to take notes. (W.G. for a legitimate purpose in making his
Philpotts v Phililppine Mfg Co., 1919) demand (74, par 3)
The transferor of shares and the voting trustee, o Other valid grounds for denying
in accordance with Section 59 access to books or records: immediately
Stockholders of a parent corporation with prior to the annual SHs meeting; holder of
respect to subsidiary: books is unavailable; the books are being
o If two are legally separate and audited; on-going inventory count;
independent entity, no right of inspection.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 38 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

computerization; moving out or change of the lifetime of the SH (Denison v. Berderger,


business address 1941)
3. Any benefit recovered by the stockholder or
member as a result of bringing the derivative
suit, whether by final judgment, by judicial
compromise or by extra-judicial settlement,
must be accounted for to the corporation, who
is the real party in interest
4. If the suit is successful, the plaintiff is entitled
Chapter X to reimbursement from the corporation for the
DERIVATIVE SUITS reasonable expenses of litigation, including
attorneys fees
1. Nature and Definition of a
Derivative Suit Bitong v CA (1998)

Definition In the absence of a special authority from the


board of directors to institute a derivative suit for
Derivative suit suits of stockholders based on and in its behalf, the managing officer is
wrongful or fraudulent acts of directors or other disqualified by law to sue in her own name. The
persons power to sue and be sued in any court by a
corporation even as a stockholder is lodged in the
Nature and basis/distinguish from other BOD that exercises its corporate powers and not in
suits: the president or officer thereof. But where
corporate directors are guilty of a breach of trust,
INDIVIDUAL suit if wrong done not of mere error of judgment or abuse of
is personal to SH discretion, and intra-corporate remedy is futile or
CLASS suit if wrong done is to a useless, a SH may institute a derivative suit in
group of SH behalf of himself and other SHs and for the benefit
DERIVATIVE suit if wrong done of the corporation, to bring about a redress of the
is to the corporation itself wrong inflicted directly upon the corporation and
o In a derivative suit, the indirectly upon the stockholders.
cause of action belongs to the corporation
and not the stockholders but since the
directors who are charged with Lim vs. Lim-Yu (2001)
mismanagement are the ones who will be The suit of respondent cannot be characterized as
sued or may not be willing to sue, then the derivative, because she was complaining only of
corporation is left without redress, hence, the violation of her preemptive right under Section
SH is given the right to sue on behalf of the 39 of the Corporation Code. She was merely
corporation praying that she be allowed to subscribe to the
additional issuances of stocks in proportion to her
shareholdings to enable her to preserve her
2. Requirements relating to percentage of ownership in the corporation. She
derivative suit was therefore not acting for the benefit of the
corporation. Quite the contrary, she was suing on
1. The stockholder or member bringing the suit her own behalf, out of a desire to protect and
must have exhausted his remedies within the preserve her preemptive rights
corporation (Angeles v. Santos, 1937) (ex. He
has made a demand on the directors or Filipinas Port Services Inc., represented
trustees and they have failed or refused to act by stockholders, Eliodoro C. Cruz v.
on such demand. Note: demand is not Victoriano S. Go, et al.
necessary if it will be futile) GR No. 161886
2. The stockholder or member must have been March 16, 2007
one at the time the transaction or act
complained of took place, or in the case of a Cruz, a stockholder of the corporation, filed a
stockholder, the shares must have devolved derivative suit against the members of the
upon him since by operation of law, unless board questioning the creation of certain
such transaction or act continues and is positions. Cruz thus prayed that the
injurious to the stockholder (Pascual v. Orozco, respondent members of the board of directors
1911) be made to pay Filport, jointly and severally,
Bonafide ownership by stockholder of stock in the sums of money variedly representing the
his own right suffices to invest him with damages incurred as a result of the creation of
standing to bring a derivative action for the the offices/positions complained of and the
benefit of the corporation. The number of aggregate amount of the questioned increased
shares owned by the SH is immaterial since he salaries. The RTC found in his favor initially
is not suing in his own behalf or for the but the CA later dismissed the derivative suit.
protection or vindication of his own particular HELD: T his is a valid derivative suit instituted
right or the redress of a wrong committed by Cruz. the action below is principally for
against him individually but in behalf and for damages resulting from alleged
the benefit of the corp. (San Miguel Corp. v. mismanagement of the affairs of Filport by its
Khan, 1989) directors/officers, it being alleged that the acts
Heirs of a SH can bring a derivative suit of mismanagement are detrimental to the
provided that the transaction took place during interests of Filport. Thus, the injury
complained of primarily pertains to the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 39 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

corporation so that the suit for relief should be There shall always be a class/series of
by the corporation. Besides, the requisites shares which have a COMPLETE VOTING
before a derivative suit can be filed by a RIGHTS
stockholder are present in this case, to wit: EACH SHARE SHALL BE EQUAL IN ALL
RESPECTS TO EVERY OTHER SHARE, except as
a) the party bringing suit should be a otherwise provided in the AOI and as stated in
shareholder as of the time of the act or the certificate of stock
transaction complained of, the number
of his shares not being material; 2.1 Common
b) he has tried to exhaust intra-corporate A stockholder, owner of at least one
remedies, i.e., has made a demand on common share, has the following rights:
the board of directors for the o right to vote at meetings
appropriate relief but the latter has o right to dividends
failed or refused to heed his plea; and o right to examine corporate books
c) the cause of action actually devolves on Most commonly issued
the corporation, the wrongdoing or
Entitles owner to equal pro-rata
harm having been, or being caused to
division of profits after preference
the corporation and not to the
particular stockholder bringing the suit.
2.2 Preferred
Stocks which are given preference by the
3. Requirements under the Interim Rules issuing corporation in dividends and the
of Procedure for Intra-Corporate distribution of assets of the corporation in
Controversies (Rule 8) case of liquidation or such other
preferences as may be stated in the AOI
which are not violative of the Corporation
1. He was a stockholder or member at the time
Code. (6)
the acts or transactions subject of the action
Limitations on preferred shares:
occurred and the time the action was filed;
2. He exerted all reasonable efforts, and alleges o Preferred shares can only be issued
the same with particularity in the complaint, to with par value
exhaust all remedies available under the AOI, o Preferred shares must be:
by-laws, laws or rules governing the a. Stated in the Articles of
corporation or partnership to obtain the relief Incorporation and in the certificate
he desires. of stock or
3. No appraisal rights are available for the act(s) b. May be fixed by the BOD where
complained of; and authorized by the AOI, provided:
4. The suit is not a nuisance or harassment suit. such terms and conditions shall be
effective upon filing of a certificate
Derivative suits are within the jurisdiction of the thereof with the SEC.
RTC (5.2, Securities Regulation Code) Entitles holder to some preferences
in dividends, distribution of assets upon
liquidation or both:
o preference as to dividends
dividends are payable only when profits
Chapter XI are earned and as a general rule, even
if there are existing profits, BOD has
FINANCING THE CORPORATION, discretion to declare dividends or not
a. Participating after getting
their fixed dividend preference
CAPITAL STRUCTURE
ahead of CS, they share with the
CS the rest of the dividends
UNLESS expressly provided, they are
1. Sources of Financing non-participating
b. Cumulative dividends in
3 main sources: arrears accrue, must be paid first
1. Contributions by stockholders (Equity) before common stock dividends are
2. Loans or advances from creditors (Borrrowing) paid.
3. Profits that the business may earn c. Non cumulative contract
makes dividends depend upon
existence of profits for the year
2. Classification of Shares (6) o as to voting
Shares of stock of stock corporations rights usually does not have voting
may be divided into classes or series of shares rights; but unless clearly withheld, PS
or both would have right to vote
Note: even if deprived of voting rights,
Each class or series of shares may have
PS holders are entitled to vote on the
rights, privileges, restrictions, stated in the AOI
matters enumerated under 6
No share may be deprived of voting
o preference upon liquidation in the
rights, except:
absence of provision, participate pro
o Preferred or
rata with common stock
o Redeemable shares, o not a creditor; theres no assurance
o unless otherwise provided by the Code that you will get back investments but
if the corporation profits, you
participate in the profits

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 40 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

unrestricted retained earnings in the books


2.3 Par value of the corporation and upon such terms and
These are shares with a stated conditions stated in the AOI and in the
value set out in the AOI. This remains the certificate of stock (8)
same regardless of the profitability of the Redemption is repurchase, a reacquisition
corporation. This gives rise to financial of stock by a corporation which issued the
stability and is the reason why banks, trust stock in exchange for property, whether or
corporations, insurance companies and not the acquired stock is cancelled, retired
building and loan associations must always or held in the treasury. Essentially, the
be organized with par value shares. corporation gets back some of its stock,
One in the certificate of stock of distributes cash or property to the
which appears an amount in pesos as the shareholder in payment for the stock, and
nominal value of the shares continues in business as before. The
Cant be issued at less than par redemption of stock dividends previously
value. Otherwise, it would become a issued is used as a veil for the constructive
watered stock (65, discussed in Chapter distribution of cash dividends. (CIR v CA,
XII) 1999)
Par value is minimum issue price of While redeemable shares may be
such share in the AOI which must be stated redeemed regardless of the existence of
in the certificate unrestricted retained earnings, this is
subject to the condition that the
2.4 No-par value corporation has, after such redemption,
These are shares without a stated assets in its books to cover debts and
value. The Corporation upon their issuance liabilities inclusive of capital stock.
will set their value, which shall not be less Redemption, therefore, may not be made
than P5. where the corporation is insolvent or if
Shall be deemed fully paid and non- such redemption will cause insolvency or
assessable and the holders of such shares inability of the corporation to meet its
shall not be liable to the corporation or to debts as they mature. (Republic Planters
its creditors in respect thereto (6) Bank v Agana, 1997)
Entire consideration received by the
corporation for its no-par value shares shall 2.7 Treasury
be treated as capital and shall not be These are shares of stock which have
available for distribution as dividends (Ibid) been issued and fully paid for, but
Cannot be issued as Preferred Shares subsequently re-acquired by the issuing
(Ibid) corporation by purchase, redemption,
AOI must state the fact that corp issues donation or through some other lawful
means. Such shares may again be
no-par shares and the number of shares
disposed of for a reasonable price fixed by
Three ways of determining value of no
the BOD. (9)
par value shares (62):
Note: delinquent stocks, which are
o By majority vote of the outstanding
stocks that have not been fully paid, may
shares (issued shares) in a meeting
become treasury stocks upon bid of the
called for the purpose
corporation in absence of other bidders
o By BOD pursuant to authority conferred
(68)
upon it by the AOI
May be sold at less than par, regarded
o By amendment of the AOI
as corporate property
Corporations which cannot issue no-par
In this manner, stocks can be retired
value shares (6):
gradually, even those which arent
o Banks redeemable
o Insurance Companies No limit as to how many shares can be
o Trust Companies retired
o Building and Loan Associations
o Public utilities 2.8 Convertible

2.5 Founders (7) A type of preferred stock that the holder can
Those shares, classified as exchange for a predetermined number of the
such in the AOI, which are given certain corporations common shares at a specified time
rights and privileges not enjoyed by the
owners of other stocks. (7) 2.9 Non-voting shares (6)
Where exclusive right to
vote and be voted for in the election of Shares which have, generally, no
directors is granted, such right must be for voting rights; except in the following
a limited period not to exceed 5 years circumstances:
subject to approval by SEC. 5 year period o Amendment of the AOI
shall commence from date of approval by o Adoption and amendment of by-laws
SEC. (Ibid) o Sale, lease, exchange, other disposition
of all or substantially all of the
2.6 Redeemable corporate property
Those shares, expressly so provided in the o Incurring, creating or increasing
AOI, which may be purchased or taken up bonded indebtedness
by the corporation upon the expiration of a o Increase or decrease of capital stock
fixed period regardless of the existence of o Merger and consolidation

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 41 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

o Investment of corporate funds in Exception: if required by the by-laws


another corporation or business (66)
o Dissolution of the corporation
3.2 Pre-incorporation subscription (61)
CLASSES OF SHARES Pre-incorporation subscription is a
subscription for shares of stock of a
A. Common corporation still to be formed.
It shall be irrevocable for a period of at
least six (6) months from the date of
No-par Par subscription.
It can only be revoked, when:
Multiple par value Single par value o when all of the other subscribers
consent to the revocation, or
o when the incorporation of the
B. Preferred corporation fails to materialize within
six (6) months or within a longer period
as my be stipulated in the contract of
Liquidation Dividends subscription.
After the submission of the AOI to the SEC,
no pre-incorporation subscription may be
Cumulative/non-cumulative Participating/non- revoked.
participating

C. Redeemable 4. Pre-emptive Right to Shares (Cf


39, 102)

With floating coupon rate With guaranteed 4.1 Definition of pre-emptive rights option
coupon rate privilege of an existing stockholder to subscribe to
a proportionate part of shares subsequently issued
D. Convertibles by the corp before the same can be disposed of in
favor of the others; includes all issues and
E. Combo of B+C+D
disposition of shares of any class
All stockholders of a stock corporation
F. Founders shares
shall enjoy pre-emptive right to subscribe
G. Treasury Shares to all issues or disposition of shares of any
class, in proportion to their respective
shareholdings, unless such right is denied
3. Nature of Subscription Contract by the AOI or an amendment thereto
This is to prevent dilution in shareholding
Includes not only new shares in pursuance
of an increase of capital stock but would
3.1 Subscription Contract cover the issue of previously unissued
shares which form part of the existing
Any contract for the acquisition of capital stock as well as treasury shares
unissued stock in an existing or a Where the shares are issued in exchange
corporation still to be formed shall be for property needed for corporate purposes
deemed a subscription contract,
or for debt previously granted, SH cannot
notwithstanding the fact that the parties demand his pre-emptive right for right may
may refer to it as a purchase or some other
prejudice corporate interest (39)
contract. (60)
Transfer for consideration of treasury 4.2 Limitation to exercise of pre-emptive right
shares is a sale by the corporation (not (39):
subscription). A transfer of fully paid a. Such pre-emptive right
shares by a stockholder to a third person is shall not extend to shares to be issued in
a sale. But it seems that assignment by a compliance with laws requiring stock
subscriber of his unpaid subscription would offerings or minimum stock ownership by
require that the requisites for valid release the public;
from subscription must be complied with b. Not extend to shares to
Shareholders are not creditors of the be issued in good faith with the approval of
corporation with respect to their the stockholders representing two-thirds
shareholdings thereto and the principle of (2/3) of the outstanding capital stock, in
compensation or set-off has no application exchange for property needed for corporate
Not necessarily required to be in writing purposes or in payment of a previously
Once subscription contract is perfected, contracted debt
SH becomes the debtor of the corporation. c. Shall not take effect if
He is liable to pay any unpaid portion of denied in the AOI or an amendment
the subscription. He can also be made thereto.
personally liable to the creditors of the
corporation to the extent of his unpaid 4.3 Remedies in case of unwarranted denial:
subscription a. Injunction
General Rule: SH is not liable to pay b. Mandamus
interest on his unpaid subscription. in any case, the suit should be
individual and not derivative because the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 42 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

wrong done is to the stockholders Chapter XII


individually
CONSIDERATION FOR ISSUANCE OF
c. SEC can cancel shares if the third party is
not innocent SHARES

1. Form of consideration (62)


CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS
Stocks shall not be issued for a
(Money + Proprietary rights) consideration less than the par or issued price
thereof.
+ Consideration for the issuance of stock
may be any or a combination of any two or
LOAN ACCOMMODATIONS more of the following:
a) Actual cash paid to the corporation;
b) Property, tangible or intangible,
actually received by the corporation and
necessary or convenient for its use and
lawful purposes at a fair valuation equal to
CORPORATION the par or issued value of the stock issued
o Valuation of consideration other
than actual cash, or consists of
A intangible property such as patents of
a copyrights initially be determined by
the incorporators or the board of
PROPERTY/ASSETS directors, subject to approval by the
SEC.
o Note: Property should not be
encumbered. Otherwise, it would
impair the consideration
c) Labor performed for or services
actually rendered to the corporation (must
LIABILITY:
be capable of being valuated);
d) Previously incurred indebtedness of
the corporation;
e) Amounts transferred from
Obligation to pay:
unrestricted retained earnings to stated
Principal + Interest capital (declaration of stock dividends); and
Security Interest over Property and Assets f) Outstanding shares exchanged for
Preferences vis--vis SH stocks in the event of reclassification or
conversion.
A Prohibited consideration: Shares of stock shall
a not be issued in exchange for promissory notes
or future service (because realization is
uncertain)
Future service may be used as consideration
provided that certificates of stock will be issued
only after the performance of such services.
Same consideration applies for the issuance of
bonds by the corporation.
Fixing of issued price of no-par value shares:
EQUITY INTEREST The issued price of no-par value shares may be
fixed:
(Shares of Stock, Inchoate Rights) a) in the AOI or
b) by the BOD pursuant to authority conferred
Return of Equity Interest: upon it by the AOI or the by-laws, or
c) in the absence thereof, by the SHs
Dividends
representing at least a majority of the
Proceeds realized from sale of shares outstanding capital stock at a meeting duly
Liquidity dividends called for the purpose.
The value of the consideration
received must be equal to the issue price of the
shares of stocks which in no case shall be less
than par

2. Liability on watered stocks

Watered stock shares issued as fully paid-up


CONTROL ECON BENEFITS CLASSIFICATION OF when in fact the consideration agreed to and
SHARES
accepted by the directors of the corporation was
something known to be much less than the par
value or issued value of the shares.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 43 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Water in stock refers to the difference between the by registered mail. At this point, there
fair market value at the time of the issuance and is no need for publication.
the par or issued value of said stock. Subsequent If the stockholder does not pay the
increase in the value of the property used in paying amount on the date designated in the
the stock does not do away with the water in the notice, the Board shall issue, by
stock. The existence of such water is determined resolution, a "notice of delinquency."
at the time of issuance of the stock. Notice of delinquency shall be
served on the non-paying subscriber
Evils: deprives corp of needed capital; dilutes either personally or by registered mail,
proportionate interest of existing and future PLUS publication in a newspaper of
SH; injures present and future creditors general circulation in the province or
because it reduces value of corp assets city where the principal office of the
corporation is located, once a week for
Any director or officer of a corporation two (2) consecutive weeks. The notice
consenting to the issuance of stocks or who, shall state the amount due on each
having knowledge thereof, does not forthwith subscription plus accrued interest, and
express his objection in writing and file the the date, time and place of the sale
same with the corporate secretary (65) which shall not be less than 30 days
o for a consideration less than its par or nor more than 60 days from the date
issued value or the stocks become delinquent.
o for a consideration in any form other than The amount due in the notice must
cash, valued in excess of its fair value, include all expenses: publication, legal,
shall be solidarily liable with the etc.
stockholder concerned to the corporation and o Note: the notices are jurisdictional.
its creditors for the difference between the fair In the public auction, the highest
value received at the time of issuance of the bidder is one who is willing to pay the
stock and the par or issued value of the same. balance of the subscription for the least
number of shares. The corporation will
give the highest bidder the certificate of
3. How Payment of Shares Enforced stock in the number of his bid; the
remaining number will be issued a
3.1 Delinquency sale certificate of stock in favor of the
subscriber as fully paid. If there are no
a. Ho bidders, the corporation must bid for
w do shares become delinquent (67) the whole number of shares regardless
Payment of any unpaid of how much the SH has paid. Such
subscription or any percentage thereof, stocks will pertain to the corporation as
together with the interest accrued, if fully paid treasury stocks.
any, shall be made on the date
specified in the contract of subscription c. When sale may be questioned (69)
or on the date stated in the call made
by the board. No action to recover
Failure to pay on such date delinquent stock sold can be sustained
shall render the entire balance due and upon the ground of irregularity or
payable and shall make the stockholder defect in the notice of sale, or in the
liable for interest at the legal rate on sale itself of the delinquent stock,
such balance, unless a different rate of unless the party seeking to maintain
interest is provided in the by-laws, such action first pays or tenders to the
computed from such date until full party holding the stock the sum for
payment. which the same was sold, with interest
If within thirty (30) days from the date of sale at the legal rate;
from the said date no payment is and
made, all stocks covered by said No such action shall be
subscription shall thereupon become maintained unless it is commenced by
delinquent and shall be subject to sale the filing of a complaint within six (6)
as hereinafter provided, unless the BOD months from the date of sale.
orders otherwise.
Despite the fact that the Issuance of Certificate Once full payment
subscription is partially paid, the entire for the stocks have been tendered to the
subscription becomes delinquent corporation in any of the valid forms of
Subscriber is not barred consideration for the issuance of stocks,
from paying the balance plus the the purchaser or the subscribers entitled to
expenses incurred by the corp before be issued the corresponding certificate of
the date of the delinquency sale (68). stock which evidences their ownership of
shares in a particular corporation (64)
b. Procedure for delinquency sale (68)
The BOD must make a call by Apocada v NLRC
resolution demanding the payment of
the balance of the subscription ("notice Apocada was employed in Intans Phil wherein he
of call"). subscribed to 1500 shares. He subsequently
The notice of call shall be served on resigned and instituted a complaint with NLRC
each stockholder either personally or against corporation for payment of unpaid wages,
COLA, balance of gasoline and representation

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 44 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

expenses, bonus. Corporation applied what is due Subscribers for stock shall pay to the
to Apocada the balance of his unpaid subscription. corporation INTEREST on all unpaid
HELD: Set-off is not proper. Unpaid subscriptions subscriptions from the date of subscription, if
are not yet due and payable. They become due so required by, and at the rate of interest fixed
and payable when a call is made by the in the by-laws. If no rate of interest is fixed in
corporation. There is no such call yet. Set-off the by-laws, such rate shall be deemed to be
against wages is not valid under labor code. the legal rate. (66) General rule: unpaid
subscriptions can not be charged with interest.
Exception: when required by the by-laws.
3.2 Court Action (70) No certificate of stock shall be issued to a
subscriber until the full amount of his
Gen. Rule A valid call is a prerequisite to subscription, together with the interest and
liability where court action is the remedy expenses (in case of delinquent shares) if any
chosen (Da Silva v. Aboitiz, 1923). is due, has been paid. (64)
Exceptions: No shares of stock against which the
corporation holds any unpaid claim shall be
1. the subscription contract specifies a date of transferable in the books of the corporation
payment (63).
2. the corp. has become insolvent all
unpaid subscriptions are immediately Attributes of a subscription contract:
recoverable in a court action by the unconditional (obligation to pay must not be
assignee in insolvency [Velasco vs. Poizat, subject to any contingencies) and indivisible
1918] (as to the amount and transferabilityFua Cun
As a defense to a court action, the SH may v. Summers, 1923)
contend that the subscription was induced by
fraudulent misrepresentation, provided he is
not barred by ratification, or guilty of laches. 6. Issuance of Certificate
Stockholders cannot escape liability on their
unpaid subscription on the ground that these A certificate of stock is the best evidence of the
were induced by an unfulfilled commitment of rights and status of a SH (although not a condition
the President of the Phil. that the Phil. precedent to the acquisition of such rights), and is
government would invest P9.00 for every peso convenient for the purposes of transfer (Campos).
subscribed (PNB v. Bitulok Sawmill Inc., 1968)
Contents of a certificate:
- certifies that the person named is a holder
or owner of a stated number of shares
4. Effect of Delinquency
- kind of shares issued
- date of issuance
a) Any cash dividends due on
- par value, if par value shares
delinquent stock shall first be applied to the
- signed by the proper officer of the corp.
unpaid balance on the subscription plus costs
(usually the pres., and the sec.)
and expenses, while stock dividends shall be
- bears the corporate seal
withheld from the delinquent stockholder until
his unpaid subscription is fully paid. (43)
b) No delinquent stock shall be: Over-issue of shares occurs when certificates are
o voted for or issued for more than the number of shares
o be entitled to vote or to authorized by the articles. Any share certificate w/c
o representation at any stockholder's represents an over-issue would be void. No rights
meeting, or liabilities can arise therefrom in favor or against
o nor shall the holder thereof be the holders and bona fide purchasers would have
entitled to any of the rights of a the right to damages for misrepresentation against
stockholder (71) the corp. but cant acquire the rights of
Except the right to dividends in stockholders.
accordance with the provisions of this
General rule: entire subscription must be paid first
Code,
before the certificates of stock can be issued.
until and unless he pays the amount
Partial payments are to be applied pro rata to each
due on his subscription with accrued
share of stock subscribed. (Nava v Peers Mktg
interest, and the costs and expenses of
Corp and Fua Cun v Summers).
advertisement, if any.
Note that the provision on dividends
pertain to delinquent stock hence a call
must have been made Exception: in the Baltazar v Lingayen Gulf Electric
Power Co case, it was the practice of the corp to
Stock dividends on delinquent shares
issue certificates of stock to its individual SHs for
are not applied but are included in
unpaid shares of stock and to give full voting
delinquency sale wherein it is liquidated
power to shares fully paid.
5. Rights and Obligations of Holders
of Unpaid But Non-Delinquent Stock 7. Lost or Destroyed Certificate (73)

Holders of subscribed shares not fully paid Procedure for re-issuance in case of loss, stolen or
which are not delinquent shall have ALL the destroyed certificates:
rights of a stockholder. (72) 1. The registered owner of certificates of stock or
his legal representative shall file with the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 45 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

corporation an affidvit setting forth as far as o there must be unissued shares


possible: of the corporation. If there are none,
a) the circumstances as to how the certificates there must be an increase in capital
were lost, stolen or destroyed; stock first, which requires an
b) the number of shares represented by each amendment of the AOI
certificate, the serial numbers of the o there must be unrestricted
certificates; retained earnings
c) the name of the corp which issued the same; o cannot be issued to non-
d) such other information and evidence which he stockholders even for services rendered
may deem necessary. (Nielson v. Lepanto Consolidated Mines,
2. The corp shall publish a notice in a newspaper 1968)
of general circulation published in the place where 1.3 PROPERTY Although the corp. may have a
the corp has its principal office, once a week for 3 big amount of earnings available for dividends,
consecutive weeks at the expense of the owner of they may not all be in cash.
the certificate of stock, which has been lost, stolen
or destroyed.
3. After the expiration of one (1) year from the 2. Source of Dividends (43)
date of the last publication and if no contest has
been presented, the corp shall cancel in its books Unrestricted retained earnings (URE) (definition
the certificate of stock and issue in lieu thereof new by the SEC) the undistributed earnings of the corp.
certificates of stock. The right to make such contest w/c have not been allocated for any managerial,
shall be barred after the expiration of the one-year contractual or legal purposes and which are free for
period. distribution to the SHs as dividends.
4. Even before the one year period expires, the The only fund out of w/c dividends can be legally
new certificates may be issued if the registered paid.
owner files a bond or other security, running for a Should there be any capital deficit, subsequent
period of one (1) year for a sum and in such form profits, if any, during succeeding periods must 1 st
and with such sureties as may be satisfactory to be applied to cover the deficit, and only the profits
the BOD. Provided, that if there is a pending remaining after eliminating the deficit, can be
contest regarding the ownership of said certificates, considered as URE.
the issuance of new certificates shall be suspended
until the final decision of the court regarding the Dividends can not be declared out of increase in
ownership of the certificate of stock. valuation of existing assets. This is subject to
o Note: Except in cases of fraud, bad faith, or fluctuation and is not yet realized.
negligence on the part of the corporation and
its officers, no action may be brought against 3. Declaration of Dividends
the corp which shall have issued certificates of
stock in lieu of those lost, stolen or destroyed 3.1 How Dividends are declared
pursuant to the above procedure.
Approval & voting requirement:
a) Approval of BOD
Chapter XIII
b) In case of stock dividend: must be approved by
DIVIDENDS AND PURCHASE OF SHs representing not less than two-thirds (2/3)
CORPORATION OF ITS OWN SHARES of the outstanding capital stock at a regular or
special meeting duly called for the purpose.
1. Form of Dividends (43)
3.2 Dividend Declaration Discretionary with
1.1 CASH most common form. the Board
1.2 STOCK a distribution to the stockholders of
Gen. Rule WON there should be a distribution of
the companys own stock. The corporate profits are
dividends to the SHs in any given year & the form
transferred to capital stock and shares of stock
of such dividends are matters addressed to the
representing the increase in capitalization are
business judgment of the BOD
distributed.
These do not represent income on the part of
Exceptions:
the SH. Investment and proportional interest
1. When the decision is tainted w/ bad faith, fraud
in the corp remain the same
or gross negligence
Lincoln Phil. Life v CA (1998) 2. If the court finds, upon complaint of a SH, that
a surplus was unreasonably accumulated
Stock dividends are in the nature of shares of (profits accumulated in excess of 100% of the
stock, the consideration for which is the corps paid-in capital stock), it may order the
amount of unrestricted retained earnings corp. to distribute dividends
converted into equity in the corporations Exceptions to the exception (43):
books. A stock dividend of a corporation is a a. when justified by
dividend paid in shares of stock instead of definite corporate expansion projects or
cash, and is properly only out of surplus programs approved by the board of
profits. So, a stock dividend is actually two directors; or
things: (1) a dividend: and (2) the enforced b. when the corporation
use of the dividend money to purchase is prohibited under any loan agreement
additional shares of stock at par. with any financial institution or creditor,
whether local or foreign, from declaring
dividends without its/his consent, and such
Limitation on the issue of stock consent has not yet been secured; or
dividends:

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 46 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

c. when it can be clearly a) To eliminate fractional shares arising out of


shown that such retention is necessary stock dividends;
under special circumstances obtaining in b) To collect or compromise an indebtedness
the corporation, such as when there is need to the corporation, arising out of unpaid
for special reserve for probable subscription, in a delinquency sale, and to
contingencies. purchase delinquent shares sold during said
sale; and
c) To pay dissenting or withdrawing
3.3 When Right to Dividends Vests
stockholders entitled to payment for their
General rule: as soon as the same shares under the provisions of this Code
have been lawfully declared by the BOD, (appraisal right, Cf 81).
becomes a debt owing to the SH. No Improper purpose includes: raising of price of
revocation can be made stock by making it appear that it is being
Exceptions: actively traded (prohibited under Sec 24 of the
o not yet announced or Securities Regulations Code) and preferring
communicated to the public, revocable some SHs to the prejudice of other SHs and
before announcement to SHs creditors (may be viewed as early liquidation of
o when stock dividends are the investment of some of the SHs)
declared since these are not distributions Remedies in case of improper purchase:
but merely represent changes in the capital a) Creditors prejudiced by the repurchase can
structure, may be revoked prior to actual go after the selling SHs to recover what
issuance was paid to them
Rights of transferee to dividends b) Directors who were negligent or in BF for
Right to dividends vests upon declaration so approving the repurchase can also be held
whoever owns the stock at time or stockholders personally responsible
of record also owns the dividend. Subsequent c) Prejudiced SH can also go after BOD who
transfer of stock would not carry with it right to approved purchase (when their dividends
dividends UNLESS agreed upon by the parties are reduced, remaining assets cant cover
debts, etc)
A corporation must have unrestricted
3.4 Liability for Illegal Dividends retained earnings in acquiring own shares
Directors not personally liable if unintentionally except:
declare illegal dividends, such as when the a) shares are acquired in the redemption of
directors, in declaring dividends: redeemable shares (8)
- rely on financial statements prepared by a b) shares are re-acquired to effect a decrease
dishonest EE whom they had no reason to in capital stock approved by the SEC (38)
suspect shares are reacquired by a close corporation
- rely on advice of legal counsel that certain pursuant to the order of the SEC acting to arbitrate
proceeds or profits are available for a deadlock (104)
dividends

Directors liable under 31 if found negligent or in


bad faith to the (1) corp; or (2) its creditors, if
insolvent

4. Purchase by the Corporation of its


Own Shares (41)

A stock corporation shall have the power to


purchase or acquire its own shares for a
legitimate corporate purpose or purposes
(treasury shares) provided, that the
corporation has unrestricted retained earnings
in its books to cover the shares to be
purchased or acquired
Treasury shares are shares of stocks which
Chapter XIV
have been issued and fully paid for, but
AMENDMENTS OF CHARTER
subsequently reacquired by the issuing
corporation by purchase, redemption, donation
or through some other lawful means (9) 1. Amendment of the Articles of
Treasury shares have no voting rights as long Incorporation, Generally
as such shares remain in the treasury (57)
May be issued as property dividends provided
that the retained earnings has not been
subsequently impaired by losses
1.1 Procedure for amendment of articles of
Trust Fund doctrine the requirement of
incorporation (16)
unrestricted retained earnings is because
subscription to the capital of a corporation
constitute a fund to which creditors have a a) The amendment must be for a legitimate
right to look for the satisfaction of their claims purpose; and must be approved by a majority
(Phil. Trust Co. v. Rivera, 1923) vote of the Board; and vote (in a meeting) or
Legitimate purpose includes: mere written assent (no meeting) of 2/3 of the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 47 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

outstanding stock, or in case of a non-stock chairman and the secretary of the


corporation, by the members of the stockholders' meeting, setting forth:
corporation. a) That the requirements of voting
Once the amendment is and notice have been complied with;
approved, dissenting stockholders may b) The amount of the increase or
exercise their rights of appraisal if it diminution of the capital stock;
involved diminishing of substantial rights c) If an increase of the capital stock,
previously granted or creating a new set of the amount of capital stock or number
shares with priority rights. of shares of no-par stock thereof
b) The original and amended articles together actually subscribed, the names,
shall contain all provisions required by law to nationalities and residences of the
be set out in the articles of incorporation. Such persons subscribing, the amount of
articles, as amended shall be indicated by capital stock or number of no-par stock
underscoring the change or changes made subscribed by each, and the amount
c) A copy thereof duly certified under oath by the paid by each on his subscription in cash
corporate secretary and a majority of the or property, or the amount of capital
directors or trustees stating the fact that said stock or number of shares of no-par
amendment or amendments have been duly stock allotted to each stock-holder if
approved by the required vote of the such increase is for the purpose of
stockholders or members, shall be submitted to making effective stock dividend
the Securities and Exchange Commission. therefor authorized;
d) The amendment of the Articles of Incorporation d) The amount of stock represented at
will be effective only upon approval of the SEC; the meeting; and
but should no action be taken by the SEC e) The vote authorizing the increase
within 6 months from the date of filing, then or diminution of the capital stock
automatically, the amendment is deemed One of the duplicate certificates
effective, provided that delay is not attributable shall be kept on file in the office of the
to the corporation. corporation and the other shall be filed with
the Securities and Exchange Commission
and attached to the original articles of
incorporation.
1.2 Grounds for disapproving amendment (17)
Approval of SEC
Any
The SEC may disapprove any amendment
increase or decrease in the capital shall
thereto if the same is not in compliance with
require prior approval of the Securities and
the requirements of this Code
Exchange Commission.
The SEC shall give the incorporators a
Decrease of
reasonable time within which to correct or
capital stock: No decrease of the capital
modify the objectionable portions of the articles
stock shall be approved by the Commission
or amendment.
if its effect shall prejudice the rights of
The following are grounds for such disapproval:
corporate creditors
a) Amendment is not substantially
with the form prescribed
Effectivity
b) Purpose or purposes is/are patently
From and after approval by the Securities and
unconstitutional, illegal, immoral, contrary
Exchange Commission and the issuance by the
to government rules and regulations
Commission of its certificate of filing, the
c) Treasurers Affidavit concerning the
capital stock shall stand increased or decreased
amount of capital stock subscribed and/or
paid is false
Treasurers Affidavit:
d) Percentage requirement of
The Securities and Exchange Commission shall
ownership by Filipino citizens as required
not accept for filing any certificate of increase
by the Constitution not complied with
of capital stock unless accompanied by the
sworn statement of the treasurer of the
corporation lawfully holding office at the time of
2. Special Amendments the filing of the certificate, showing that at
least twenty-five (25%) percent of such
increased capital stock (should be understood
2.1 Increase or decrease of capital stock as proposed increase-Campos) has been
(38) subscribed and that at least twenty-five (25%)
percent of the amount subscribed has been
Approval and Voting Requirement paid either in actual cash to the corporation or
a) Approved by a majority vote of the that there has been transferred to the
board of directors corporation property the valuation of which is
b) Two-thirds (2/3) of the outstanding equal to twenty-five (25%) percent of the
capital stock shall favor the increase or subscription
diminution of the capital stock at a meeting
duly called for the purpose Appraisal right (811)
Appraisal right may be exercised where the
Certificate of Filing increase in capital stock results in the creation
A certificate in duplicate must be of shares with preferences superior to those of
signed by a majority of the directors of the existing ones.
corporation and countersigned by the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 48 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Note: Proposing amendments is a way of b) indorsed by the owner or his


easing out the minority stockholders because it attorney-in-fact or other person legally
compels them to exercise their appraisal rights authorized to make the transfer

2.2 Reduction of capit al stock Rural Bank of Salinas v CA

- Although the requirements in Section 38 Clemente, President of Rural Bank of Salinas and
have been met, no reduction of capital owner of shares in said corporation executed a
stock will be approved by the SEC if it will Special Power of Attorney to his wife Melania giving
prejudice the rights of corporate creditors. her full power to sell or otherwise dispose of shares
- There can be no reduction of capital stock of stock of the Bank. Before death of Clemente,
which will in effect release the stockholders Melania, pursuant to said SPA, executed deed of
from the payment of the balance of their Assignment of formers shares. After death of
subscription if it will adversely affect the Clemente, Melania presented to bank deed of
right of he creditors in collecting their assignment for registration which the bank refused.
claims (Phil. Trust Co. vs. Rivera (1923) Mandamus filed by Melania to compel bank to
- Appraisal RightAlthough Section 38 does register the transfer.
not grant the appraisal right in case of
reduction of capital stock, when it has the HELD: Transfer before death valid, stock not yet
effect of altering the rights of any part of estate. Shares of stock are personal
stockholder or class of stockholders, the property and may be transferred by delivery.
appraisal right may be exercised under Registration in corporate books is not necessary.
section 81 (1) (Campos) The transfer effected in this case is valid. The
- Except by decrease of capital stock and as corporation may not impose any restriction on such
otherwise allowed by this Coded, no transfer. The right of transferee/assignee to have
corporation shall distribute any of he assets stocks transferred to his name is inherent right,
or property except upon lawful dissolution duty of the corporation to register the transfer is
and after payment of all its debts and ministerial.
liabilities. (122)
o CamposIt seems that under the Rural Bank of Lipa v. CA (2001)
exception, a reduction surplus may
be distributed as dividends to the For the valid transfer of stocks, there must be strict
stockholders, as long as SEC compliance with the mode of transfer prescribed by
approval has been obtained and the law, which are:
rights of creditors is not prejudiced. a) there must be delivery of the stock certificate;
b) the certificate must be endorsed by the owner or
2.3 Change in corporate term (37) his attorney-in-fact or other persons legally
authorized to make the transfer; and
c) to be valid against third parties, the transfer
Approval and Voting Requirement must be recorded in the books of the corporation.
a) Approved by a majority vote of the board
of directors or trustees and
b) Ratified at a meeting by the stockholders Razon v IAC
representing at least two-thirds (2/3) of the
outstanding capital stock or by at least Chudian was issued 1,500 shares at E Razon Inc
two-thirds (2/3) of the members in case of with the corresponding stock certificate no 3. Said
non-stock corporations. stock certificates were delivered to Enrique Razon
allegedly because it was the latter who paid for all
Conflict in the availability of appraisal right the subscription on the shares of stock in defendant
YES only for extension of corporate term corporation with the understanding that has was
(37) the owner of said shares of stock and was to have
YES for both shortening and extension (81) possession until such time as he was paid by other
nominal incorporators/stockholders. Later on,
parties delivered it for deposit with bank under the
joint custody of the parties. Administrator of the
estate of Chudian filed a complaint against Enrique
Razon et al praying that the said stock certificates
be delivered to estate of Chudian along with all
cash and stock dividends and pre-emptive rights
accruing thereto.

Chapter XV HELD: Chudian is still owner


TRANSFER OF SHARES a) Shares of stock is transferred by delivery
and endorsement of the stock certificate
1. Manner and Effectivity b) Such mode of transfer is not complied with
of Transfer in this case
c) In the books of the corporation, Chudian is
1.2 Indorsement and delivery still the owner of the stocks. He was even
Shares of stock may be elected member of the board which proves
transferred as follows (63): that he is a stockholder
a) delivery of the certificate or d) One who claims ownership should show
certificates and that the same was transferred to him in
accord with the valid mode of transfer.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 49 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

This petitioner failed to show Sunset View Condominium Corp v Campos


Endorsement is a mandatory requirement of law for
an effective transfer Sunset View Condominium corporation filed suit
against Aguilar-Bernares Realty and Lim Siu Leng
Tan v SEC (1992) for collection of assessments levied on their
respective condominium units which they bought
Alfonso Tan is owner of 400 shares in Visayan on installments and had not yet fully paid
Educational Supply Corp evidenced by certificate
No. 2. Alfonso transferred 50 shares to Angel. HELD: Respondents not shareholders of
Certificate No. 2 was cancelled and Certificate No. 6 condominium corporation because they are not yet
was issued to Angel and Certificate No. 8 was fully paid
issued to Alfonso. However, Alfonso did not make a) Sec 5 Condominium Act shareholding in a
the proper endorsement and did not make delivery condominium corporation will be conveyed only
of certificate no. 2. Later on, Alfonso Tan elected in a proper case
to withdraw from the corporation. In exchange for b) Sec 4 of Condominium Act leaves to Master
his shares, he received stocks in trade. Certificate Deed the determination of when shareholding
No. 8 was later on cancelled due to above. After will be transferred to purchaser of a unit
several years, Alfonso Tan filed a case with Cebu c) Master Deed provides that only owner of unit is
SEC questioning the cancellation of his stock a shareholder and that ownership of unit is
certificates despite non-endorsement and lack of acquired by purchaser subject to conditions and
delivery terms of the instrument conveying the unit to
such purchaser.
HELD: Delivery and endorsement under Section 63 d) Deed of Conveyance provide that ownership is
of the corporation code is not mandatory because conveyed only upon full payment of purchase
of the use of the word may. Delivery is not price
essential where it appears that the persons sought e) Sec 10 Condominium Act Membership in
to be held as stockholders are officers of the Condominium corporation shall not be
corporation and have custody of the stock book as transferable separately from condominium unit
in this case. To hold that cancellation of certificate of which it is an appurtenance
of stock of Alfonso is null and void because of lack
of delivery and endorsement of mother certificate Remedy if registration refused Transferee
of stock no. 2 which was deliberately withheld is to may petition the court for a writ of mandamus
prescribe restrictions on the transfer of stock in to compel the corporation to do so (Price v.
violation of corporation law Sulu Development Corp., 1933)

1.2 Registration
Purpose of registration Rivera v Florendo (1986)
a) enable the Rivera is the registered owner of 4899 shares of
transferee to exercise all the rights of a stock of Fujiyama Hotel & Restaurant Inc. It is
stockholder alleged that one Akasako is the real owner of the
b) to inform the 4899 shares under Riveras name, and as such
corporation of any change in share owner he sold 2550 shares to Milagros. Rivera
ownership so that it can ascertain the refused to indorse the certificates to Milagros
persons (a) entitled to the rights (b) despite the assurance he gave to Milagros before
subject to the liabilities of a SH the sale was consummated. The other
c) until registration is incorporators also sold their shares to Milagros and
accomplished, the transfer, though one Jureidini. As regards these transfers, the
valid between the parties, cannot be certificates were properly indorsed by their
effective against the corporation respective owners. Milagros and Jureidini
Effect of lack of registration: attempted to have all the certificates registered in
a) transferee cannot vote their names but the corporation refused to do so.
b) transferee cannot be voted for
c) transferee cannot prevail over HELD: Mandamus will not lie where the shares of
rights of a subsequent attaching stock are not even indorsed by the registered
creditor (Uson v. Diosomito, 1935) owner Rivera who is specifically resisting the
d) transferee not entitled to dividends registration thereof in the books of the corp. Even
e) stockholder on record has the right the shares of stock sold by the other incorporators
to participate in meetings. cannot be also the subject of mandamus on the
strength of the mere indorsement of the supposed
No registration of transfer of unpaid shares owners of said shares in the absence of express
instructions from them. The right of the parties will
If there is any unpaid have to be threshed out in an ordinary action.
balance on the stockholders subscription
there can be no stock certificate on which
indorsement can be made. The shares are
thus not transferable on the corporate
books. (63) 2. Restrictions on Transfer; Close
However, the stockholder Corporations
can still transfer his interest in the
corporation by way of a deed of
assignment. 2.1 General Rule: Free transferability of
shares

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 50 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Shares are personal property Shares of stock cancellation (Hodges v. Lezama, 1965). It is the
so issued are personal property and may be duty of the purchaser to determine that the
transferred (63) indorsement was genuine. But with respect to a
subsequent purchaser in good faith and for value,
the corporation is estopped from denying the
2.2 Exception: In close corporations
validity of the newly issued certificate because by
Considering the special circumstances issuing such, it has represented that the person
attending a close corporation (e.g. formed by named therein is a stockholder of the corporation.
persons who know each other well, thus they Except where recognition of the original and new
would want to choose the persons who will be subscriber will result to an overissue of shares.
allowed in their group), it is justifiable and even The new SH would now have right to damages
imperative for its stockholders to protect against the corporation and the latter against those
themselves from future conflicts by placing who made false representation.
restrictions on the right of each one of them to
transfer his shares to an outsider (97 & 98). 4. Collateral Transfers

Subject to collateral transfers: Shares


Validity of restrictions on transfer of shares of stock being personal property, may be
(98) the subject matter of
Restrictions on the right to transfer a. pledge or
shares must appear in the articles of b. chattel mortgage.
incorporation and in the by-laws as well as Registration in corporate books not
in the certificate of stock; otherwise, the necessary: Such collateral transfers are not
same shall not be binding on any purchaser covered by Sec. 63 of the Code since such
thereof in good faith. provision applies only to absolute transfer
Restrictions shall not be more (Monserrat v. Ceron, 1933). Thus, the
onerous than granting the existing registration in the corporate books of
stockholders or the corporation the option pledges and chattel mortgages of shares
to purchase the shares of the transferring CANNOT have any legal effect.
stockholder with such reasonable terms,
conditions or period stated therein. If upon
the expiration of said period, the existing Lim Tay v CA (1998)
stockholders or the corporation fails to
exercise the option to purchase, the Sy Guiok and Sy Lim pledged their shares in Go Fay
transferring stockholder may sell his shares and Co to Lim Tay. They endorsed their respective
to any third person. share in blank and delivered the same to Lim Tay.
Presumptions: Sy Guiok and Sy Lim failed to pay hence Lim Tay
a. If the stock certificate CONSPICUOUSLY went to the corporate secretary to ask the
shows the restriction, the purchaser or registration of the shares in his name. Corporate
transferee is conclusively presumed to secretary refused. Lim Tay instituted an action for
have notice of the restriction, provided mandamus at SEC to compel corporate secretary to
this appears in the AOI. He cannot register.
prove that he acted in good faith.
Where a conclusive presumption of HELD: Corporates secretary cannot be compelled
notice arises, the corporation may, at to record transfer. The duty of a corporate
its option, refuse to register the secretary to record transfers of stocks is
transfer, unless ministerial. However, he cannot be compelled to
do so when the transferees title to said shares has
(1) all the stockholders have consented
no prima facie validity or is uncertain. Mandamus
to the transfer, or
will not issue to establish a right but only to enforce
(2) the AOI have been properly
one already established. Lim Tay failed to establish
amended to remove the restriction.
a legal right to have the shares registered in his
b. If it appears in the certificate, but NOT
name. Lim Tay failed to establish a legal right. He
CONSPICUOUSLY, then although he
is not owner of the shares without foreclosure and
may be presumed to have notice of the
purchase at auction. He is merely a pledgee.
restriction, he can prove the contrary.

3. Unauthorized Transfers Attachment of shares

Garcia vs. Jomouad, (2000)


3.1 certificates indorsed in blank where the
stockholder indorses his certificate in blank in such
a manner as to clothe whoever may be in FACTS: Dico lost a collection case and the
possession of it with apparent authority to deal Proprietary Ownership Certificate (POC) in the Cebu
with the shares as the latters own, he will be Country Club in his name was levied on and
estopped from claiming the shares as against a scheduled for public auction. Garcia claimed
bonafide purchaser. This is called the theory of ownership over the certificate and filed the action
quasi-negotiability (Santamaria v. Hongkong & for injunction to enjoin the auction. Dico had
Shanghai Bank, 1951) executed a Deed of Transfer in favor of petitioner
which was furnished to The Club but the transfer
3.2 forged transfers if the corporation should was not recorded in the books of the Club because
issue a new certificate pursuant to a forged petitioner failed to present proof of payment of the
transfer, it incurs no liability to the person in whose requisite capital gains tax.
favor it issued it and may demand its return for HELD: The transfer of the subject certificate made

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 51 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

by Dico to petitioner was not valid as to the The


judgment creditors, as the same still stood in the Securities and Exchange Commission
name of Dico, the judgment debtor, at the time of shall thereupon issue the certificate of
the levy on execution. In addition, as correctly dissolution. Thus, except for the
ruled by the CA, the entry in the minutes of the expiration of its term , no dissolution
meeting of the Club's board of directors noting the can be effective without some act of
resignation of Dico as proprietary member thereof the state (Daguhoy Enterprises v.
does not constitute compliance with Section 63 of Ponce, 1954)
the Corporation Code. Said provision of law strictly
requires the recording of the transfer in the books 1.3 Voluntary dissolution when creditors
of the corporation, and not elsewhere, to be valid are affected (119)
as against third parties. Petition for
dissolution shall be filed with the
Securities and Exchange Commission.
Chapter XVI The petition
DISSOLUTION shall be signed by a majority of its
board of directors or trustees or other
officers having the management of its
1. Causes of Dissolution
affairs, verified by its president or
secretary or one of its directors or
1.1 Expiration of original, extended or
trustees, and shall set forth all claims
shortened term
and demands against it, and that its
The term
dissolution was resolved upon by the
within which the corporation is to exist affirmative vote of the stockholders
(which cannot be more than 50 years) representing at least two-thirds (2/3)
must be stated in its AOI. Once such of the outstanding capital stock or by at
period expires, the corporation is least two-thirds (2/3) of the members
automatically dissolved without any at a meeting of its stockholders or
other proceeding and it cannot members called for that purpose.
thereafter be considered a de facto If the
corporation.
petition is sufficient in form and
A voluntary
substance, the Commission shall, by an
dissolution may be effected by order reciting the purpose of the
amending the articles of incorporation petition, fix a date on or before which
to shorten the corporate term pursuant objections thereto may be filed by any
to the provisions of the Code. Upon person, which date shall not be less
approval of the amended articles of than thirty (30) days nor more than
incorporation or the expiration of the sixty (60) days after the entry of the
shortened term, as the case may be, order. Before such date, a copy of the
the corporation shall be deemed order shall be published at least once a
dissolved without any further week for three (3) consecutive weeks in
proceedings (120) a newspaper of general circulation
published in the municipality or city
1.2 Voluntary dissolution when no where the principal office of the
creditors are affected (118) corporation is situated, or if there be no
Dissolution such newspaper, then in a newspaper
may be effected by majority vote of the of general circulation in the Philippines,
board of directors or trustees, and by a and a similar copy shall be posted for
resolution duly adopted by the three (3) consecutive weeks in three
affirmative vote of the stockholders (3) public places in such municipality or
owning at least two-thirds (2/3) of the city.
outstanding capital stock or of at least Upon five
two-thirds (2/3) of the members. (5) day's notice, given after the date on
Meeting to which the right to file objections as
be held upon call of the directors or fixed in the order has expired, the
trustees after publication of the notice Commission shall proceed to hear the
of time, place and object of the petition and try any issue made by the
meeting for three (3) consecutive objections filed; and if no such
weeks in a newspaper published in the objection is sufficient, and the material
place where the principal office of said allegations of the petition are true, it
corporation is located; and if no shall render judgment dissolving the
newspaper is published in such place, corporation and directing such
then in a newspaper of general disposition of its assets as justice
circulation in the Philippines, after requires, and may appoint a receiver to
sending such notice to each stockholder collect such assets and pay the debts of
or member either by registered mail or the corporation
by personal delivery at least thirty (30) In this
days prior to said meeting. method of dissolution, SEC may direct
A copy of the manner in which the liquidation of
the resolution authorizing the the corporate assets should be made
dissolution shall be certified by a by assigning this task to the
majority of the board of directors or corporation itself, or if it deems proper,
trustees and countersigned by the to a receiver appointed by it (Campos).
secretary of the corporation.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 52 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

o Failure to file required reports in


1.4 Dissolution by minority in close appropriate forms as determined by
corporations Voluntary dissolution when the Commission within the
creditors are affected (105) prescribed period
Any stockholder of a close corporation may, Other grounds
by written petition to the Securities and o Sec. 144 BP 68 Violation
Exchange Commissions, compel the by the corporation of any provision
dissolution of such corporation whenever of the Corporation Code
any of the acts of the directors, officers or o Sec. 104 BP 68 In case of
those in control of the corporation is illegal, a deadlock in a close corporation,
or fraudulent, or dishonest, or oppressive and the SEC deems it proper to
or unfairly prejudicial to the corporation or order the dissolution of the
any stockholder or whenever corporate corporation as the only practical
assets are being misapplied or wasted. solution to the dispute

1.5 Failure to organize and commence Quo Warranto Proceedings (Sec. 2, Rule 66
business; cessation of business for 5 years ROC)
(22) When it has offended
Failure to formally organize and against a provision of an Act for its
commence the transaction of its creation and renewal
business or construction of its works When it has forfeited its
within two years its corporate powers privileges and franchises by nonuser
shall cease and the corporation is When it has committed or
deemed dissolved omitted an act which amounts to a
o Transacting surrender of its corporate rights,
business implies a continuity of privileges or franchise
acts or dealings in the When it has misused a
accomplishment of the purpose for
right, privilege, or franchise conferred
which the corporation was formed
upon it by law or when it has exercised
(Mentholatum v. Mangaliman,
a right, privilege or franchise in
1946)
contravention of law
o Formally organize

includes not only the adoption of
the by-laws but also the
establishment of the body which 2. Effects of Dissolution; Winding-Up
will administer the affairs of the and Liquidation
corporation and exercise its powers
Commence 2.1 Loss of juridical personality
d transaction of its business but Corporation loses its
subsequently becomes continuously juridical personality and can no longer
inoperative for a period of at least five lawfully continue its business except for
years ground for suspension or the purpose of winding up. For this
revocation of its corporate franchise or purpose, it may sue and be sued,
certificate of incorporation although upon the expiration of three
years, all pending actions by or against
1.6 Involuntary dissolution the dissolved corporation abate
(National Abaca Corp. vs. Pore, 1961)
Revocation of certificate of registration by cannot even be a de facto
the SEC (121) corporation, hence subject to collateral
A corporation may be dissolved attack (Buenaflor vs. Camarines Sur
by the Securities and Exchange Industry Corp., 1960)
Commission upon filing of a verified cannot enter into new
complaint and after proper notice and contracts which would have the effect
hearing on grounds provided by of continuing the business (Cebu Port
existing laws, rules and regulations Labor Union vs. States Marine Co,
Grounds for revocation (Sec. 6, 1957)
par i, PD 902-A)
o Fraud in procuring its certificate of 2.2 Executory contracts
registration No right or remedy in favor
o Serious misrepresentation as to of or against any corporation, its
what the corporation can or is stockholders, members, directors,
doing to the great prejudice of or trustees, or officers, nor any liability
damage to the general public incurred by any such corporation,
o Refusal to comply or defiance of stockholders, members, directors,
any lawful order of the Commission trustees, or officers, shall be removed
restraining commission of acts or impaired either by the subsequent
which would amount to a grave dissolution of said corporation or by
violation of its franchise any subsequent amendment or repeal
o Continuous inoperation for a period of this Code or of any part thereof.
of at least five years (145)
o Failure to file by-laws within the The prevailing view is that
required period executory contracts are not
extinguished. However, some

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 53 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

authorities make an exception of Code, no corporation shall


contracts for personal services such as distribute any of its assets or
employment contracts of officers and property except upon lawful
employees where the dissolution is dissolution and after payment of all
involuntary or the result of merger or its debts and liabilities.
consolidation in which case the What happens if an asset cannot be
contracts are deemed terminated. distributed to the person entitled to it?
o Upon the winding up of the
2.3 Winding-Up and Liquidation corporate affairs, any asset
Definition: The winding up and turning distributable to any creditor or
assets of corporation into cash for stockholder or member who is
distribution unknown or cannot be found shall
A liquidation proceeding is a proceeding be escheated to the city or
in rem so that all other interested municipality where such assets are
persons whether known to the parties located.
or not may be bound by such Who may undertake the liquidation of a
proceedings (Chua vs. NLRC, 1990) corporate (Methods of Liquidation)?
For how long may the liquidation of a o By the corporation itself through
corporation be undertaken? the board of directors the board
o Every corporation whose charter of directors serve as trustees
expires by its own limitation or is o Conveyance of all corporate assets
annulled by forfeiture or otherwise, to trustees who will take charge of
or whose corporate existence for the liquidation. From and after any
other purposes is terminated in any such conveyance by the corporation
other manner, shall nevertheless be of its property in trust for the
continued as a body corporate for benefit of its stockholders,
three (3) years after the time when members, creditors and others in
it would have been so dissolved interest, all interest which the
o However, in case the corporate corporation had in the property
assets are conveyed to a trustee or terminates, the legal interest vests
a receiver appointed by the SEC, in the trustees, and the beneficial
the three year limitation will not interest in the stockholders,
apply (Sumera v. Valencia, 1939) members, creditors or other
o Although the three year period may persons in interest.
have expired, it does not o Liquidation by a receiver who may
necessarily follow that a creditor have been appointed by the SEC
who was unable to collect his claim upon its decreeing the dissolution
before three years would lose is of the corporation (119). 3-year
rights. It is still possible for him to period does not apply because the
sue the trustee, if there be one, or corporation is substituted by the
if the circumstances so warrant, to receiver (Sumera v. Valencia,
follow the assets in the hands of Supra). However, the mere
the stockholders who nay have appointment of a receiver, without
received the same as liquidating anything more does not result in
dividends (Tan Tiong Bio v. Comm. the dissolution of the corporation
of Int. Rev., 1962) nor bar it from the existence of its
corporate rights (Leyte Asphalt &
Gelano v. CA (1981) Mineral Oil Co. Ltd., v. Block
Johnston & Breenbrawn, 1928)
Even if no trustee is appointed or designated A corporation cannot
during the 3-year period of the liquidation of distribute any of its assets or property
the corporation, a suit pending prior to the except upon lawful dissolution and only
expiration of the period may still be after payment of all its debts and
prosecuted with the counsel of record being liabilities, after which the remaining
considered as the trustee required by law. assets must be distributed to the
Debtors of the corporation may not take stockholders in proportion to their
advantage of the failure of the corporation to interest in the corporation.
transfer its assets to a trustee; otherwise, it Exceptions:
would constitute undue enrichment to dismiss decrease in c/s resulting in a
the case as against the defendant. surplus which can then be
distributed to stockholders provided
What could and should be done during no creditors are prejudiced
the period of liquidation? as otherwise allowed by the
o For the purpose of prosecuting and code:
defending suits by or against it and o Appraisal right
enabling it to settle and close its o Deadlock in a close corporation
affairs, to dispose of and convey its o SH of a close corporation may
property and to distribute its compel corporation to buy his
assets, but not for the purpose of shares at fair value
continuing the business for which it o Corporation repurchases shares for
was established. any legitimate corporate purpose
o Except by decrease of capital stock o Corporation validly distributes
and as otherwise allowed by this dividend

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 54 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

continuance of corporate life and activities in


an effort to restore and reinstate the
corporation to its former position of successful
CLEMENTE, ET. AL. v. CA (1995): operation and solvency.
It is crystal clear that the concept of
liquidation is diametrically opposed or
The termination of the life of a juridical entity does contrary to the concept of rehabilitation, such
not by itself cause the extinction or diminution of that both cannot be undertaken at the same
the rights and liabilities of such entity, nor those of time. To allow the liquidation proceedings to
its owners and creditors. If the three-year extended continue would seriously hinder the
life has expired without a trustee or receiver having rehabilitation of the subject bank.
been expressly designated by the corporation
within that period, the board of directors (or
trustees) itself, may be permitted to so continue as
Chapter XVII
"trustees" by legal implication to complete the
corporate liquidation. Still in the absence of a board CORPORATE COMBINATION
of directors or trustees, those having any pecuniary
interest in the assets, including not only the
shareholders but likewise the creditors of the 1. Merger and Consolidation
corporation, acting for and in its behalf, might
make proper representation with the Securities and
Exchange Commission, which has primary and
sufficiently broad jurisdiction in matters of this 1.1 What is a merger / consolidation?
nature, for working out a final settlement of the
Merger
corporate concerns.
o One of the constituent corporations
remains as an existing juridical
Dissolved corporations capacity to sue: person, whereas the other
corporation shall cease to exist.
Merger is the disappearance of one
Reburiano vs. CA, GR 102965, Jan 21, 1999
of the corporations with the other
corporation acquiring all the assets,
Corporation amended its AoI to shorten its rights of action, and assuming all
corporate existence while the case was pending in the liabilities of the disappearing
court. SEC approved the amendment but the trial corporation.
court was not notified. After the trial court o Of course, there is an arrangement
rendered judgment against corporation, it filed as to the shares of stocks that will
motion to quash writ of execution because the be issued to the former
corporation lacked juridical personality to sue or be stockholders of the two (2)
sued. corporations which were merged.
SC held that it was erroneous to contend that a Said stockholders are now
dissolved and non-existing corporation could no stockholders of the corporation
longer be represented by a lawyer and which survives. The proportion
concomitantly a lawyer could not appear as counsel between the two (2) corporations
for a non-existing judicial person. A corporation will be the basis of the shares of
that has a pending action and which cannot be stocks that will be issued to the
terminated within the three-year period after its stockholders under the surviving
dissolution is authorized under Sec. 78 [now 122] corporation.
of the Corporation Law to convey all its property to Consolidation
trustees to enable it to prosecute and defend suits o If there is consolidation, there will
by or against the corporation beyond the three- be disappearance of both the
year period. Although private respondent did not constituent corporations with the
appoint any trustee, yet the counsel who emergence of a new corporate
prosecuted and defended the interest of the entity, called the consolidated
corporation in the instant case and who in fact corporation, which shall obtain all
appeared in behalf of the corporation may be the assets of the disappearing
considered a trustee of the corporation at least with corporations, and likewise shall
respect to the matter in litigation only. assume all their liabilities.
o Also, the number of shares that will
Liquidation v. Rehabilitation be issued to each of the
stockholders under the new
Phil. Veterans Bank v. Employees Union corporation is determined by the
(2001) ration between the assets of the
two (2) corporations.
Liquidation, in corporation law, connotes a
winding up or setting with creditors and
debtors. It is the winding up of a corporation 1.2 What is a constituent corporation? A
so that assets are distributed to those entitled consolidated corporation? (76)
to receive them. It is the process of reducing
Two or more corporations may merge into
assets to cash, discharging liabilities and
a single corporation which shall be one of
dividing surplus or loss.
the constituent corporations or may
On the opposite end of the spectrum is
consolidate into a new single corporation
rehabilitation which connotes a reopening or
which shall be the consolidated corporation.
reorganization. Rehabilitation contemplates a

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 55 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

1.3 What corporate approvals are Such other provisions with respect to
required? (77) the proposed merger or consolidation
1. Approval by majority vote of each of as are deemed necessary or desirable.
the board of directors or trustees of the
constituent corporations of the plan of 1.5 What are articles of merger or
merger or consolidation. consolidation? (78)
2. Approval by the stockholders or After the approval by the stockholders
members of each of such corporations or members, articles of merger or
in separate meetings. The affirmative articles of consolidation shall be
vote of stockholders representing at executed by each of the constituent
least two-thirds (2/3) of the corporations:
outstanding capital stock of each 1) to be signed by the president or
corporation in the case of stock vice-president and
corporations or at least two-thirds (2/3) 2) certified by the secretary or
of the members in the case of non- assistant secretary of each
stock corporations shall be necessary corporation
for the approval of such plan The articles of merger or consolidation
3. Notice of such meetings shall be given shall set forth:
to all stockholders or members of the 1) The plan of the merger or the plan
respective corporations, at least two of consolidation;
(2) weeks prior to the date of the 2) As to stock corporations, the
meeting, either personally or by number of shares outstanding, or in
registered mail. Said notice shall state the case of non-stock corporations,
the purpose of the meeting and shall the number of members; and
include a copy or a summary of the 3) As to each corporation, the number
plan of merger or consolidation. of shares or members voting for
4. Any dissenting stockholder in stock and against such plan, respectively.
corporations may exercise his appraisal
right in accordance with the Code. 1.6 When is the effectivity of merger or
Provided, that if after the approval by consolidation? (79)
the stockholders of such plan, the Effectivity: Upon issuance by the SEC
board of directors decides to abandon of the certificate of merger and
the plan, the appraisal right shall be consolidation
extinguished. If the Commission is satisfied that the
5. Amendment to the plan of merger or merger or consolidation of the
consolidation may be made by corporations concerned is not
approved of the majority vote of the inconsistent with the provisions of this
respective boards of directors or Code and existing laws, it shall issue a
trustees of all the constituent certificate of merger or of
corporations and ratified by the consolidation, at which time the merger
affirmative vote of stockholders or consolidation shall be effective.
representing at least two-thirds (2/3) The articles of merger or of
of the outstanding capital stock or of
consolidation shall be submitted to the
two-thirds (2/3) of the members of
Securities and Exchange Commission in
each of the constituent corporations.
quadruplicate for its approval.
Such plan, together with any
In the case of merger or consolidation
amendment, shall be considered as the
of banks or banking institutions,
agreement of merger or consolidation.
building and loan associations, trust
companies, insurance companies,
1.4 What is a plan of merger or
public utilities, educational institutions
consolidation? (76)
and other special corporations
The board of directors or trustees of each
governed by special laws, the favorable
corporation, party to the merger or
recommendation of the appropriate
consolidation, shall approve a plan of
government agency shall first be
merger or consolidation setting forth the
obtained.
following:
If, upon investigation, the Securities
The names of the corporations
and Exchange Commission has reason
proposing to merge or consolidate,
to believe that the proposed merger or
hereinafter referred to as the
consolidation is contrary to or
constituent corporations;
inconsistent with the provisions of this
The terms of the merger or
Code or existing laws, it shall set a
consolidation and the mode of carrying
hearing to give the corporations
the same into effect;
concerned the opportunity to be heard.
A statement of the changes, if any, in
Written notice of the date, time and
the articles of incorporation of the place of hearing shall be given to each
surviving corporation in case of constituent corporation at least two (2)
merger; and, with respect to the weeks before said hearing. The
consolidated corporation in case of Commission shall thereafter proceed as
consolidation, all the statements provided in this Code.
required to be set forth in the articles
of incorporation for corporations 1.7 What are the effects of a merger or
organized under this Code; and consolidation? (80)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 56 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

1) The constituent corporations shall Ordinarily, in the merger of two or more existing
become a single corporation which: corporations, one of the combining corporations
In case of merger, shall be the survives and continues the combined business,
surviving corporation designated in while the rest are dissolved and all their rights,
the plan of merger; and properties and liabilities are acquired by the
In case of consolidation, shall be surviving corporation. Although there is dissolution
the consolidated corporation of the absorbed corporations, there is no winding
designated in the plan of up of their affairs or liquidation of their assets,
consolidation; because the surviving corporation automatically
2) The separate existence of the acquires all their rights, privileges and powers, as
constituent corporations shall cease, well as their liabilities.
except that of the surviving or the
consolidated corporation;
3) The surviving or the consolidated 1.8 Procedure for Merger or Consolidation
corporation shall possess all the rights, (Villanueva)
privileges, immunities and powers and 1) Board of each corporation shall draw up
shall be subject to all the duties and a plan of merger or consolidation,
liabilities of a corporation organized setting forth:
under this Code; names of corporations involved
4) The surviving or the consolidated (constituent corporations)
corporation shall thereupon and terms and mode of carrying it out
thereafter possess: statement of changes, if any, in the
all the rights, privileges, immunities present articles of surviving
and franchises of each of the corporation; or the articles of the
constituent corporations; and new corporation to be formed in
all property, real or personal, and case of consolidation.
all receivables due on whatever 2) Plan for merger or consolidation shall
account, including subscriptions to be approved by majority vote of each
shares and other choses in action, board of the concerned corporations at
and all and every other interest of, separate meetings.
or belonging to, or due to each 3) The same shall be submitted for
constituent corporation approval by the stockholders or
these shall be deemed transferred members of each such corporation at
to and vested in such surviving or separate corporate meetings duly called
consolidated corporation without for the purpose. Notice should be
further act or deed; and given to all stockholders or members at
5) The surviving or consolidated least two (2) weeks prior to date of
corporation shall: meeting, either personally or by
be responsible and liable for all the registered mail.
liabilities and obligations of each of 4) Affirmative vote of 2/3 of the
the constituent corporations in the outstanding capital stock in case of
same manner as if such surviving stock corporations, or 2/3 of the
or consolidated corporation had members of a non-stock corporation
itself incurred such liabilities or shall be required.
obligations; and 5) Dissenting stockholders may exercise
any pending claim, action or the right of appraisal. But if Board
proceeding brought by or against abandons the plan to merge or
any of such constituent consolidate, such right is extinguished.
corporations may be prosecuted by 6) Any amendment to the plan must be
or against the surviving or approved by the same votes of the
consolidated corporation. board members of trustees and
The rights of creditors or liens upon stockholders or members required for
the property of any of such the original plan.
constituent corporations shall not 7) After such approval, Articles of Merger
be impaired by such merger or or Articles of Consolidation shall be
consolidation executed by each of the constituent
corporations, signed by president or VP
and certified by secretary or assistant
secretary, setting forth:
Babst v. CA (2001) plan of merger or consolidation
in stock corporation, the number of
shares outstanding; in non-stock,
It is settled that in the merger of two existing the number of members
corporations, one of the corporations survives and as to each corporation, number of
continues the business, while the other is dissolved shares or members voting for and
and all its rights, properties and liabilities are against such plan, respectively
acquired by the surviving corporation. 8) Four copies of the Articles of Merger or
Consolidation shall be submitted to the
SEC for approval. Special corporations
ASSOCIATED BANK v. CA (1998) like banks, insurance companies,
building and loan associations, etc.,
need the prior approval of the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 57 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

respective government agency assets be appropriated for the


concerned. conduct of its remaining business.
9) If SEC is satisfied that the merger or o In non-stock corporations where
consolidation is legal, it shall issue the there are no members with voting
Certificate of Merger or the Certificate rights - the vote of at least a
of Incorporation, as the case may be. majority of the trustees in office
10) If the SEC is not satisfied, it shall set a will be sufficient authorization for
hearing, giving due notice to all the the corporation to enter into any
corporations concerned. (76-79) transaction authorized by this
section.
1.9 Limitation on the right to merge /
consolidate 2.4 Appraisal right: any dissenting
stockholder may exercise his appraisal right
1) Should not create monopolies under the conditions provided in the Code
2) Should not eliminate free and healhty
competition 2.5 Abandonment of the sale, lease -
3) Act 3518 Sec 20 inhibits illegal After such authorization or approval by the
combinations stockholders or members, the board of
directors or trustees may, nevertheless, in its
1.10 Appraisal right any dissenting discretion, abandon such sale, lease, exchange,
stockholder may exercise his appraisal right mortgage, pledge or other disposition of
under the conditions provided in the Code property and assets, subject to the rights of
third parties under any contract relating
thereto, without further action or approval by
2. Sale of substantially all assets the stockholders or members.
(40)
2.6 Compared to merger and consolidation
2.1 Restrictions: Subject to the provisions of
existing laws on illegal combinations and Advantage of merger and consolidation
monopolies over sale:
- furnish a short cut to the
2.2 Scope of power: To sell, lease, exchange, accomplishment of various transactions
mortgage, pledge or otherwise dispose of all or - may avoid the difficulty, delay and
substantially all of its property and assets, expense which usually accompany
including its goodwill, upon such terms and dissolution, winding up and distribution
conditions and for such consideration, which of assets to its SH by a selling corp
may be money, stocks, bonds or other - automatic assumption of liabilities of
instruments for the payment of money or other the absorbed corp (in sale, there must
property or consideration, as its board of be sufficient funds reserved by the
directors or trustees may deem expedient absorbed corp to pay its liabilities,
Meaning of disposition of substantially otherwise the sale may be attacked by
all of the corporate property and Compared the creditors as a fraudulent
assets- if thereby the corporation would conveyance)
be rendered incapable of continuing the - transfer or exchange of shares is
business or accomplishing the purpose exempt from registration under
for which it was incorporated. Securities Act (in sale, registration with
SEC required)
2.3 Approval, voting and notice
requirement: Advantage of sale of substantially all
Majority vote of its board of directors or assets: Where the absorbing corp foresees
trustees, problems in securing stockholders approval
Authorized by the vote of the and in granting the appraisal right of
dissenters, it may decide that its purchase
stockholders representing at least two-
of the assets of the absorbed corp would be
thirds (2/3) of the outstanding capital
more convenient and practical than merger
stock, or in case of non-stock
corporation, by the vote of at least to
two-thirds (2/3) of the members, in a
stockholder's or member's meeting
duly called for the purpose.
Written notice of the proposed action
and of the time and place of the
meeting shall be addressed to each
stockholder or member at his place of
residence as shown on the books of the
corporation and deposited to the
addressee in the post office with
postage prepaid, or served personally
o When SH approval not necessary -
If disposition is necessary in the
usual and regular course of
business of said corporation or if
the proceeds of the sale or other
disposition of such property and

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 58 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

same processed by another entity in


the Phil.
Chapter XVIII
Collecting information in the Phil.
FOREIGN CORPORATIONS
Performing services auxiliary to an
existing contract or sale, which are not
on a continuing basis
1. Definition (123)
Mentholatum Co., Inc., v. Mangaliman
Foreign corporation is one formed, organized or (1941)
existing under any laws other than those of the
Philippines and whose laws allow Filipino No general rule or governing principle can be
citizens and corporations to do business in its laid down as to what constitutes doing or
own country or state. engaging in or transacting business.
Indeed, each case must be judged in the light
of its peculiar environmental circumstances.
The true test, however, seems to be whether
2. Doing business (Sec. 3(d) RA the foreign corporation is continuing the body
7042, Foreign Investments Act of or substance of the business or enterprise for
1991) which it was organized, or whether it has
substantially retired from it and turned it over
Soliciting orders to another. The term implies a continuity of
Service contracts commercial dealings and arrangements, and
Appointing representatives or contemplates to that extent the performance
distributors domiciled in the Philippines or of acts or works or the exercise of the
who in any calendar year stay in the functions normally incident to and in the
country for a period or periods totaling 180 progressive prosecution of the purpose and
days or more object of its organization.
Opening offices, whether called liason
offices or branches Necessity of obtaining a license to do business:
Establishing a factory, workshop or
processing plant The reason for the license is to subject the
Undertaking building construction or foreign corporation doing business in the
erection projects Philippines to the jurisdiction of the courts,
Opening a store, whether wholesale or otherwise a foreign corporation illegally doing
retail without prejudice to the provisions of business here may successfully though unfairly
the Retail Trade Act plead such neglect or illegal act so as to avoid
Maintaining or operating a warehouse service and thereby impugn the jurisdiction of
for business purposes including the the local courts.
storage, display or delivery of its own
products B Van Zuiden Bros. Ltd. V. GTVL
Participating in the management, Manufacturing
supervision or control of any domestic GR No. 147905 May 28, 2007
business, firm, entity or corporation in the Zuiden, a foreign corporation not licensed to do
Philippines business in the Philippines, filed a complaint for
Any other act or acts that imply a sum of money with the RTC of Paranaque
continuity of commercial dealings or against GTVL. The latter filed a motion to
arrangements, and contemplate to that dismiss on the ground that petitioner has no
extent, performance normally incident to , legal capacity to sue and this was granted. The
and in progressive prosecution of, CA sustained the RTC ruling that the
commercial gain or of the purpose and transactions were not isolated hence not falling
object of the business organization within the exception. It relied on Eriks Pte. Ltd.
It shall not include: V. CA where it held that what is material are the
Mere investment as a shareholder by a proponents to the transaction, as well as the
foreign entity in domestic corporations parties to be benefited and obligated by the
duly registered to do business and/or transaction.
the exercise of such rights as such HELD: To be doing or transacting business in
investor the Philippines for purposes of Section 133 of
Having a nominee director or officer to
the Corporation Code, the foreign corporation
represent its interests in such
must actually transact business in the
corporations
Philippines, that is, perform specific business
Appointing a representative or
transactions within the Philippine territory on a
distributor domiciled in the Philippines
continuing basis in its own name and for its own
which transacts business in its own
name and for its own account
account. An essential condition to be
The following acts by themselves shall considered as doing business in the
not be deemed doing business in the Phil: Philippines is the actual performance of specific
The publication of a general commercial acts within the territory of the
advertisement through newspapers, Philippines for the plain reason that the
brochures or other publication media or Philippines has no jurisdiction over commercial
through radio or television acts performed in foreign territories. Here,
Maintaining the stock of goods in the there is no showing that petitioner performed
Phil solely for the purpose of having the within the Philippine territory the specific acts of
doing business mentioned in Section 3(d) of RA

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 59 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

7042. Petitioner did not also open an office stated in the certificate of authority
here in the Philippines, appoint a representative issued by the appropriate
or distributor, or manage, supervise or control a government agency;
local business. While petitioner and respondent o The names and addresses of the
entered into a series of transactions implying a present directors and officers of the
continuity of commercial dealings, the corporation;
perfection and consummation of these o A statement of its authorized
transactions were done outside the Philippines. capital stock and the aggregate
number of shares which the
The series of transactions between petitioner
corporation has authority to issue,
and respondent transpired and were
itemized by classes, par value of
consummated in Hong Kong. The SC found no shares, shares without par value,
single activity which petitioner performed here and series, if any;
in the Philippines pursuant to its purpose and o A statement of its outstanding
object as a business organization. Moreover, capital stock and the aggregate
petitioners desire to do business within the number of shares which the
Philippines is not discernible from the corporation has issued, itemized by
allegations of the complaint or from its classes, par value of shares, shares
attachments. without par value, and series, if
Therefore, there is no basis for ruling that any;
petitioner is doing business in the Philippines. o A statement of the amount actually
The SC categorically stated its disagreement paid in; and
with the Court of Appeals ruling that the o Such additional information as may
proponents to the transaction determine be necessary or appropriate in
whether a foreign corporation is doing business order to enable the Securities and
in the Philippines, regardless of the place of Exchange Commission to determine
delivery or place where the transaction took whether such corporation is entitled
place. To accede to such theory makes it to a license to transact business in
possible to classify, for instance, a series of the Philippines, and to determine
transactions between a Filipino in the United and assess the fees payable.
Attached to the application for license
States and an American company based in the
shall be a duly executed certificate
United States as doing business in the
under oath by the authorized official or
Philippines, even when these transactions are
officials of the jurisdiction of its
negotiated and consummated only within the
incorporation, attesting to the fact that:
United States o The laws of the country or state of
the applicant allow Filipino citizens
3. Requirements for the issuance of a and corporations to do business
license therein
o The applicant is an existing
3.1. Documentary requirements (125) corporation in good standing.
A foreign corporation applying for a If such certificate is in a foreign
license to transact business in the language, a translation thereof in
Philippines shall submit to the SEC: English under oath of the translator
o Copy of its articles of incorporation shall be attached thereto.
and by-laws, certified in accordance The application shall likewise be
with law accompanied by a statement under
o Their translation to an official oath of the president or any other
language of the Philippines, if person authorized by the corporation,
necessary. showing to the satisfaction of the SEC
The application shall be under oath and other governmental agency in the
and, unless already stated in its articles proper cases that the:
of incorporation, shall specifically set o Applicant is solvent and in sound
forth the following: financial condition, and
o The date and term of incorporation; o Setting forth the assets and
o The address, including the street liabilities of the corporation as of
number, of the principal office of the date not exceeding one (1)
the corporation in the country or year immediately prior to the filing
state of incorporation; of the application.
o The name and address of its Foreign banking, financial and
resident agent authorized to accept insurance corporations shall, in addition
summons and process in all legal to the above requirements, comply with
proceedings and, pending the the provisions of existing laws
establishment of a local office, all applicable to them.
notices affecting the corporation; In the case of all other foreign
o The place in the Philippines where corporations, no application for license
the corporation intends to operate; to transact business in the Philippines
o The specific purpose or purposes shall be accepted by the SEC without
which the corporation intends to previous authority from the appropriate
pursue in the transaction of its government agency, whenever required
business in the Philippines: by law.
Provided, That said purpose or
purposes are those specifically 3.2 Deposit requirements (126)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 60 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Upon issuance of the license, such be returned, upon the licensee's


foreign corporation may commence to application therefor and upon proof to
transact business in the Philippines and the satisfaction of the SEC that the
continue to do so for as long as it licensee has no liability to Philippine
retains its authority to act as a residents, including the Government of
corporation under the laws of the the Republic of the Philippines.
country or state of its incorporation,
unless such license is sooner
surrendered, revoked, suspended or 3.3 Appointment of resident agent (128)
annulled in accordance with this Code A resident agent may be either an (
or other special laws. 127):
Within sixty (60) days after the o Individual residing in the Philippines
issuance of the license to transact of good moral character and of
business in the Philippines, the license, sound financial standing
except foreign banking or insurance o Domestic corporation lawfully
corporation, shall deposit with the SEC transacting business in the
for the benefit of present and future Philippines:
creditors of the licensee in the The SEC shall require as a condition
Philippines, securities satisfactory to precedent to the issuance of the license
the SEC, consisting of : to transact business in the Philippines
o Bonds or other evidence of by any foreign corporation that such
indebtedness of the Government of corporation file with the SEC a written
the Philippines, its political power of attorney:
subdivisions and instrumentalities, o Designating some person who must
or of government-owned or be a resident of the Philippines, on
controlled corporations and entities, whom any summons and other
o Shares of stock in "registered legal processes may be served in all
enterprises" as this term is defined actions or other legal proceedings
in Republic Act No. 5186, against such corporation, and
o Shares of stock in domestic o Consenting that service upon such
corporations registered in the stock resident agent shall be admitted
exchange, or and held as valid as if served upon
o Shares of stock in domestic the duly authorized officers of the
insurance companies and banks, or foreign corporation at its home
o Any combination of these kinds of office.
securities, Any such foreign corporation shall
With an actual market value of at least likewise execute and file with the SEC
one hundred thousand (P100,000.) an agreement or stipulation, executed
pesos; by the proper authorities of said
Provided, however, That within six (6) corporation, in form and substance as
months after each fiscal year of the follows:
licensee, the SEC shall require the o "The (name of foreign corporation)
licensee to deposit additional securities does hereby stipulate and agree, in
equivalent in actual market value to consideration of its being granted
two (2%) percent of the amount by by the Securities and Exchange
which the licensee's gross income for Commission a license to transact
that fiscal year exceeds five million business in the Philippines, that if
(P5,000,000.00) pesos. at any time said corporation shall
The SEC shall also require deposit of cease to transact business in the
additional securities if the actual Philippines, or shall be without any
market value of the securities on resident agent in the Philippines on
deposit has decreased by at least ten whom any summons or other legal
(10%) percent of their actual market processes may be served, then in
value at the time they were deposited. any action or proceeding arising out
The SEC may at its discretion release of any business or transaction
part of the additional securities which occurred in the Philippines,
deposited with it if the gross income of service of any summons or other
the licensee has decreased, or if the legal process may be made upon
actual market value of the total the SEC and that such service shall
securities on deposit has increased, by have the same force and effect as if
more than ten (10%) percent of the made upon the duly-authorized
actual market value of the securities at officers of the corporation at its
the time they were deposited. home office."
The SEC may, from time to time, allow Whenever such service of summons or
the licensee to substitute other other process shall be made upon the
securities for those already on deposit SEC, the Commission shall, within ten
as long as the licensee is solvent. Such (10) days thereafter, transmit by mail a
licensee shall be entitled to collect the copy of such summons or other legal
interest or dividends on the securities process to the corporation at its home
deposited. or principal office.
In the event the licensee ceases to do The sending of such copy by the
business in the Philippines, the Commission shall be necessary part of
securities deposited as aforesaid shall and shall complete such service. All

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 61 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

expenses incurred by the Commission


for such service shall be paid in 5. What are the consequence of doing
advance by the party at whose instance business in the Philippines without a
the service is made. license? (133)
In case of a change of address of the No foreign corporation transacting
resident agent, it shall be his or its duty business in the Philippines without a
to immediately notify in writing the SEC license, or its successors or assigns, shall
of the new address. be permitted to maintain or intervene in
any action, suit or proceeding in any court
3.4 Summary: Requisites for the Issuance or administrative agency of the Philippines;
of License Such corporation may be sued or
The SEC will issue a license to the proceeded against before Philippine courts
foreign corporation to do business in or administrative tribunals on any valid
the Philippines, provided the following cause of action recognized under Philippine
conditions are met: laws.
o Appointment of a Resident Agent: In addition, Sec. 134 makes it a ground
Either a Filipino or domestic for revocation of license when a foreign
corporation; and corporation transacts business in the
Power of Attorney to SEC to Philippines as agent of or acting for and in
receive process behalf of any foreign corporation or entity
o Must prove that the foreign not duly licensed to do business in the
corporation's country grants Philippines.
reciprocal rights to Filipinos and Status of Contracts entered into
Philippine corporation. without the requisite license
o Establish an office in the Philippines o The failure to obtain a license by a
o Bring in its assets foreign corporation doing business in
o Undertaking that Filipino creditors the Philippines does not affect the
will be preferred in the event of validity of contracts entered into by
insolvency such foreign corporation, but merely
o Notice of six (6) months should removes its legal standing to sue in
there be desire to terminate local tribunals. However, the defect
operations may be cured by subsequent
o Franchise and patents must remain registration by the foreign corporation
in the Philippine, if this is possible to obtain the necessary license to do
o Must file a bond of P100,000 which business in the Philippines. [Home
may be in the following form: Insurance Co. v. Eastern Shipping
surety bond Lines, 123 SCRA 424 (1983)]
government securities o Although the law does not declare
securities of political as void or invalid the contracts entered
subdivisions into by a foreign corporation with a
shares of stock of registered local corporation without the former
enterprises with the SEC first securing a license or certificate to
shares of stock of any do business in the Philippines, the
corporation being sold at the parties in this case cannot obtain relief
stock exchange on the contracts entered into because
o Provided, that within six (6) they are charged with the knowledge of
months after each fiscal year, the the existing law at the time they
SEC shall require the deposit of entered into such contract and at the
additional securities equivalent to time it is to be operative. [Top-Weld
2% of the amount in excess of Mfg. v. ECED, S.A., 138 SCRA 118
P500,000 of the gross income. (1985)]
[Sec. 125, 126, Corporation Code] o However, in the case of Merrill
Lynch Futures, Inc. v. CA, 211 SCRA
4. What laws are applicable to 824 (1992), the SC held that although
foreign corporations licensed to the foreign corporation has engaged in
transact business in the Philippines? business in the Philippines without a
(129) license, the dismissal of the suit would
not be proper on the ground that if the
local investors knew that the foreign
corporation had no license to do
Any foreign corporation lawfully doing business, then they are estopped from
business in the Philippines shall be bound using the lack of license to avoid their
by all laws, rules and regulations applicable obligations.
to domestic corporations of the same class, Legal standing of foreign corporations
EXCEPT such only as provide for the: to sue on their corporate names, trade
o Creation, formation, organization or names, and trademarks
dissolution of corporations or o A foreign corporation although not
o Those which fix the relations, doing business in the Philippines has a
liabilities, responsibilities, or duties of personality to sue to oppose the
stockholders, members, or officers of registration of a trademark when it is
corporations to each other or to the shown that its products using such
corporation. trademark are being imported and sold

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 62 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

in the Philippines, pursuant to the appropriate government agency in the


terms of RA 166. [General Garments v. proper cases.
Director of Patents, 41 SCRA 50
(1971)] 9. Merger or consolidation involving a
o A foreign corporation has a right to foreign corporation licensed in the
maintain an action in Philippine courts Philippines (132)
even if it is not licensed to do business
and is not actually doing business on its One or more foreign corporations
own therein to protect its corporate and
authorized to transact business in the
trade names, since it is a property right
Philippines may merge or consolidate with
in rem, which it may assert to protect
any domestic corporation or corporations
against all the world, in any of the
if :
courts of the world--even in jurisdiction
o Such is permitted under Philippine
where it does not transact business--
laws and by the law of its incorporation
just the same as it may protect its
o The requirements on merger or
tangible property, against trespass or
consolidation as provided in this Code
conversion. This is in consonance with
are followed
the Convention of the Union of Paris for
Whenever a foreign corporation
the Protection of Industrial Property to
authorized to transact business in the
which the Phils. is a party. Article 8
Philippines shall be a party to a merger or
thereof provides, "A trade name shall
consolidation in its home country or state
be protected in all the countries of the
as permitted by the law of its incorporation,
Union without the obligation of filing or
such foreign corporation shall, within sixty
registration, whether or not it forms
(60) days after such merger or
part of the trademark." The mandate is
consolidation becomes effective, file with
contained in RA 166, or the Trademark
the SEC, and in government agency, a copy
Law. [Converse Rubber Corp. v.
of the articles of merger or consolidation
Universal Rubber Products, 147 SCRA
duly authenticated by the proper official or
154 (1987)]
officials of the country or state under the
laws of which merger or consolidation was
6. Application to existing foreign
effected
corporations (148) Provided, however, that if the absorbed
corporation is the foreign corporation doing
Every foreign corporation which on the date business in the Philippines, the latter shall
of the effectivity of the Code is authorized at the same time file a petition for
to do business in the Philippines under a withdrawal of its license.
license issued to it, shall continue to have
such authority under the terms and
10. Revocation of license (134)
condition of its license, subject to the
provisions of this Code and other special
Without prejudice to other grounds
laws.
provided by special laws, the license of a
foreign corporation to transact business in
7. Amendments to articles of
the Philippines may be revoked or
incorporation or by-laws of foreign suspended by the SEC upon any of the
corporations (130) following grounds:
o Failure to file its annual report or
Within sixty (60) days after the pay any fees as required by this Code;
amendment becomes effective, file with the o Failure to appoint and maintain a
SEC, and in the proper cases with the resident agent in the Philippines as
appropriate government agency, a duly required by this Title;
authenticated copy of the articles of o Failure, after change of its resident
incorporation or by-laws, as amended, agent or of his address, to submit to
indicating clearly in capital letters or by the Securities and Exchange
underscoring the change or changes made, Commission a statement of such
duly certified by the authorized official or change as required by this Title;
officials of the country or state of o Failure to submit to the Securities
incorporation. and Exchange Commission an
The filing thereof shall not of itself enlarge authenticated copy of any amendment
or alter the purpose or purposes for which to its articles of incorporation or by-
such corporation is authorized to transact laws or of any articles of merger or
business in the Philippines. consolidation within the time prescribed
by this Title;
8. Amended license (131) o A misrepresentation of any material
matter in any application, report,
A foreign corporation authorized to affidavit or other document submitted
transact business in the Philippines shall by such corporation pursuant to this
obtain an amended license in the event it : Title;
o Changes its corporate name, or o Failure to pay any and all taxes,
o Desires to pursue in the Philippines imposts, assessments or penalties, if
other or additional purposes any, lawfully due to the Philippine
By submitting an application therefor to Government or any of its agencies or
the SEC, favorably endorsed by the political subdivisions;

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 63 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

o Transacting business in the principle will be applied to prevent a person


Philippines outside of the purpose or contracting with a foreign corporation from later
purposes for which such corporation is taking advantage of its noncompliance with the
authorized under its license; statutes chiefly in cases where such person has
o Transacting business in the received the benefits of the contract.
Philippines as agent of or acting for and
in behalf of any foreign corporation or MR Holdings, Ltd vs. Bajar,( 2002)
entity not duly licensed to do business
in the Philippines; or
o Any other ground as would render The question whether or not a foreign
it unfit to transact business in the corporation is doing business is dependent
Philippines. (n) principally upon the facts and circumstances of
each particular case, considered in the light of the
purposes and language of the pertinent statute or
11. Issuance of certificate of
statutes involved and of the general principles
revocation (135) governing the jurisdictional authority of the state
over such corporations
Upon the revocation of any such license
CAB, the CA categorized as doing business
to transact business in the Philippines, the petitioners participation under the Assignment
Securities and Exchange Commission shall Agreement and the Deed of Assignment. This is
issue a corresponding certificate of simply untenable. The expression doing business
revocation, furnishing a copy thereof to the should not be given such a strict and literal
appropriate government agency in the construction as to make it apply to any corporate
proper cases. dealing. At this early stage and with petitioners
The Securities and Exchange acts or transactions limited to the assignment
Commission shall also mail to the contracts, it cannot be said that it had performed
corporation at its registered office in the acts intended to continue the business for which it
Philippines a notice of such revocation was organized. It may not be amiss to point out
accompanied by a copy of the certificate of that the purpose or business for which
revocation. petitioner was organized is not discernible in the
records. No effort was exerted by the CA to
12. Withdrawal by a foreign establish the nexus between petitioners business
corporation (Section 136) and the acts supposed to constitute doing
business. Thus, whether the assignment contracts
If a foreign corporation duly licensed to were incidental to petitioners business or were
do business desires to withdraw, it must continuation thereof is beyond determination.
file a petition for withdrawal, and must
meet the following requirements:
o All claims accrued in the Philippines
must be settled Chapter XIX
o All taxes must be paid
o Petition must be published once a SPECIAL CORPORATIONS
week for three (3) consecutive weeks.
(136)
1. Close Corporations
Doing business in the Philippines without a license:

Communications Materials vs. CA, (1996)

In determining whether a corporation does


business in the Philippines or not, aside from their
activities within the forum, reference may be made 1.1 What is a close corporation? (96)
to the contractual agreements entered into by it A close corporation is one whose
with other entities in the country. A scrutiny of the articles of incorporation provide that:
different contracts and agreements entered into o All the corporation's issued stock of
with various business contacts in the country all classes, exclusive of treasury
indicate convincingly a purpose to convey to shares, shall be held of record by
customers and the general public that they are not more than a specified number
dealing directly with the foreign corporation, and of persons, not exceeding twenty
that foreign corporation is actively engaging in (20);
business in the country. These agreements also o All the issued stock of all classes
contain provisions which are highly restrictive in shall be subject to one or more
nature, reducing the local signatory to be a mere specified restrictions on transfer
extension or instrument of the foreign corporation. permitted by this Title; and
Hence, the foreign corporation is deemed to be o The corporation shall not list in any
doing business in the Philippines without a license. stock exchange or make any public
Nonetheless, petitioner is estopped from raising offering of any of its stock of any
this fact to bar the foreign corporation from suing. class.
One who has dealt with a corporation of foreign A corporation shall not be deemed a
origin as a corporate entity is estopped to deny its close corporation when at least two-
corporate existence and capacity. And the doctrine thirds (2/3) of its voting stock or voting
of estoppel to deny corporate existence applies to a rights is owned or controlled by another
foreign as well as to domestic corporations. The

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 64 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

corporation which is not a close o If the issuance or transfer of stock


corporation. to any person would cause the
stock to be held by more than such
number of persons.
1.2 What entities may not be If a stock certificate of any close
organized as closed corporations? corporation conspicuously shows a
Any corporation may be incorporated restriction on transfer of stock of the
as a close corporation, except: corporation, the transferee of the stock
o Mining is conclusively presumed to have notice
o Oil companies of the fact that he has acquired stock in
o Stock exchanges violation of the restriction, if such
acquisition violates the restriction.
o Banks
Whenever any person to whom stock of
o Insurance companies
o Public utilities a close corporation has been issued or
o Educational institutions transferred has, or is conclusively
presumed under this section to have,
o Corporations declared to be vested
notice either
with public interest in accordance
o That he is a person not eligible to
with the provisions of this Code.
be a holder of stock of the
corporation, or
o That transfer of stock to him would
1.3 Validity of restrictions on transfer of
cause the stock of the corporation
shares (98)
to be held by more than the
Restrictions on the right to transfer number of persons permitted by its
shares must appear in the: articles of incorporation to hold
o Articles of incorporation stock of the corporation, or
o By-laws o That the transfer of stock is in
o Certificate of stock violation of a restriction on transfer
OTHERWISE, the same shall not be of stock, the corporation may, at its
binding on any purchaser in good faith. option, refuse to register the
Said restrictions shall not be more transfer of stock in the name of the
onerous than granting the existing transferee.
stockholders or the corporation the The provisions of subsection (4) shall
option to purchase the shares of the not be applicable if the transfer of
transferring stockholder with such stock, though contrary to subsections
reasonable terms, conditions or period (1), (2) or (3), has been consented to
stated therein. by all the stockholders of the close
If upon the expiration of said period, corporation, or if the close corporation
the existing stockholders or the has amended its articles of
corporation fails to exercise the option incorporation in accordance with this
to purchase, the transferring Title.
stockholder may sell his shares to any The term "transfer", as used in this
third person. section, is not limited to a transfer for
value.
The provisions of this section shall not
1.4 Effects of issuance or transfer of stock impair any right which the transferee
in breach of qualifying conditions (99) may have to rescind the transfer or to
A person is conclusively presumed to recover under any applicable warranty,
have notice of the fact of ineligibility to express or implied.
be a stockholder:
o If stock of a close corporation is
issued or transferred to any person 1.5 Agreements by stockholders (Section
who is not entitled under any 100)
provision of the articles of 1. Agreements by and among
incorporation to be a holder of stockholders:
record of its stock, and Executed before the formation and
o If the certificate for such stock organization of a close corporation,
conspicuously shows the Signed by all stockholders
qualifications of the persons Shall survive the incorporation of
entitled to be holders of record such corporation and shall continue
thereof to be valid and binding between
A person to whom stock is issued or and among such stockholders, if
transferred is conclusively presumed to such be their intent,
have notice of these facts: To the extent that such agreements
o If the articles of incorporation of a are not inconsistent with the
close corporation states the number articles of incorporation,
of persons, not exceeding twenty irrespective of where the provisions
(20), who are entitled to be holders of such agreements are contained,
of record of its stock, and except those required by this Title
o If the certificate for such stock to be embodied in said articles of
conspicuously states such number, incorporation.
and 2. An agreement between two or more
stockholders, if in writing and signed by

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 65 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

the parties thereto, may provide that in The consequence is that the
exercising any voting rights, the shares business and affairs of the
held by them shall be voted as therein corporation can no longer be
provided, or as they may agree, or as conducted to the advantage of the
determined in accordance with a stockholders generally
procedure agreed upon by them.
3. No provision in any written agreement 2. Resolution of deadlocks
signed by the stockholders, relating to The SEC, upon written petition by
any phase of the corporate affairs, shall any stockholder, shall have the
be invalidated as between the parties power to arbitrate the dispute.
on the ground that its effect is to make In the exercise of such power, the
them partners among themselves. Commission shall have authority to
4. A written agreement among some or all make such order as it deems
of the stockholders in a close appropriate, including an order:
corporation shall not be invalidated on o Cancelling or altering any
the ground that it so relates to the provision contained in the
conduct of the business and affairs of articles of incorporation, by-
the corporation as to restrict or laws, or any stockholder's
interfere with the discretion or powers agreement;
of the board of directors: o Cancelling, altering or enjoining
Provided, That such agreement any resolution or act of the
shall impose on the stockholders corporation or its board of
who are parties thereto the directors, stockholders, or
liabilities for managerial acts officers;
imposed by this Code on directors. o Directing or prohibiting any act
5. To the extent that the stockholders are of the corporation or its board
actively engaged in the management or of directors, stockholders,
operation of the business and affairs of officers, or other persons part
a close corporation, the stockholders to the action;
shall be held to strict fiduciary duties to o Requiring the purchase at their
each other and among themselves. fair value of shares of any
Said stockholders shall be personally stockholder, either by the
liable for corporate torts unless the corporation regardless of the
corporation has obtained reasonably availability of unrestricted
adequate liability insurance. retained earnings in its books,
or by the other stockholders;
o Appointing a provisional
1.6 Amendment of articles of director;
incorporation (103) o Dissolving the corporation; or
Any amendment to the articles of o Granting such other relief as
incorporation which seeks to delete or the circumstances may
remove any provision required by this Title warrant.
to be contained in the articles of
incorporation or to reduce a quorum or
voting requirement stated in said articles of 3. Provisional Director
incorporation shall not be valid or effective An impartial person who is neither
unless approved by the affirmative vote of a stockholder nor a creditor of the
at least two-thirds (2/3) of the outstanding corporation or of any subsidiary or
capital stock, whether with or without affiliate of the corporation, and
voting rights, or of such greater proportion whose further qualifications, if any,
of shares as may be specifically provided in may be determined by the
the articles of incorporation for amending, Commission.
deleting or removing any of the aforesaid A provisional director is not a
provisions, at a meeting duly called for the receiver of the corporation and
purpose. does not have the title and powers
of a custodian or receiver.
A provisional director shall have all
1.7 Deadlocks the rights and powers of a duly
elected director of the corporation,
1. Deadlocks, Defined: including the right to notice of and
to vote at meetings of directors,
Notwithstanding any contrary until such time as he shall be
provisions in the articles of removed by order of the
incorporation or by-laws or Commission or by all the
agreement of stockholders of a stockholders.
close corporation His compensation shall be
The directors or stockholders are so determined by agreement between
divided respecting the management him and the corporation subject to
of the corporation's business and approval of the Commission, which
affairs may fix his compensation in the
The votes required for any absence of agreement or in the
corporate action cannot be obtained event of disagreement between the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 66 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

provisional director and the


corporation.
San Juan Structural and Steel Fabricatiors vs.
CA (1998)

Motorich entered into agreement with San Juan for


the transfer of a parcel of Land to latter. San Juan
already paid downpayment. When San Juan was
ready to pay the balance, Motorich refused to sell.
Motorich contend that Nenita Gruenbergs,
treasurer of Motorich, signature is not sufficient to
bind Motorich, and that the signature of Reynaldo
Gruenberg, president of Motorich is required.
Nenita Gruenberg is the spouse of Reynaldo
Gruenberg and both owns 99.866% of the shares
of stock of the corporation.
HELD: Motorich is not a close corporation. The
mere ownership by a single stockholder or by
another corporation of all or nearly all of the capital
stock of a corporation is not of itself sufficient
ground for disregarding their separate
personalities. A narrow distribution of ownership
does not of itself make a close corporation. There
are exceptional cases where an action by a director
who is singly is the controlling stockholder may be
considered as a binding corporate act and a board
action is a mere formality. However, Nenita is not
the sole controlling stockholder.

CLOSE CORPORATIONS REGULAR CORPORATIONS


1. Management / Board Authority

There can be classification of directors into one There are no classification of board of directors
or more classes, each of whom may be voted
for and elected solely by a particular class of
stock; and
Corporate Powers devolved upon board of
The articles of incorporation of a close directors whose powers are executed by officers.
corporation may provide that the business of Cannot provide that it be managed by
the corporation shall be managed by the stockholders
stockholders of the corporation rather than by a
board of directors. So long as this provision
continues in effect:
Board of directors must be elected in a
1. No meeting of stockholders need be called stockholders meeting
to elect directors
2. Unless the context clearly requires Stockholders of a corporation are separate and
otherwise, the stockholders of the distinct from directors
corporation shall be deemed to be directors
for the purpose of applying the provisions
of this Code
3. The stockholders of the corporation shall be
subject to all liabilities of directors. Officers must be elected by the Board of
Directors
The articles of incorporation may likewise
provide that all officers or employees or that
specified officers or employees shall be elected
or appointed by the stockholders, instead of by
the board of directors.

2. Meetings The directors or trustees shall not act individually


nor separately but as a body in a lawful meeting.
Unless the by-laws provide otherwise, any They will act only after discussion and
action by the directors of a close corporation deliberation of matters before them. Contracts
without a meeting shall nevertheless be entered into without a formal board resolution
deemed valid if: does not bind the corporation except when
ratified or when majority of the board has
1. Before or after such action is taken, written knowledge of the contract and the contract
consent thereto is signed by all the benefited the corporation.
directors; or

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 67 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

CLOSE CORPORATIONS REGULAR CORPORATIONS


Absence of a prompt objection in writing does
2. All the stockholders have actual or implied not ratify acts done by directors without a valid
knowledge of the action and make no meeting. There must be express or implied
prompt objection thereto in writing; or ratification.

3. The directors are accustomed to take Express ratification may consist of a Board
informal action with the express or implied Resolution to that effect
acquiescence of all the stockholders; or
Implied ratification may consist of acceptance of
4. All the directors have express or implied benefits from said unauthorized act while having
knowledge of the action in question and knowledge of said act
none of them makes prompt objection
thereto in writing. Failure to give notice would render a meeting
voidable.
If a director's meeting is held without proper
call or notice, an action taken therein within the Attendance to a meeting despite want of notice
corporate powers is deemed ratified by a will be deemed implied waiver
director who failed to attend, unless he
promptly files his written objection with the All proceedings had and any business transacted
secretary of the corporation after having at any meeting of the stockholders or members,
knowledge thereof. if within the powers or authority of the
corporation, shall be valid even if the meeting be
improperly held or called, provided all the
stockholders or members of the corporation are
present or duly represented at the meeting.
(51)

3. Voting / Quorum No share may be deprived of voting rights,


except Preferred or Redeemable shares, unless
The AOI may provide for a classification of otherwise provided by the Code
directors into one or more classes, each of
which may be voted for and elected solely by a There shall always be a class/series of shares
particular class of stock. which have a COMPLETE VOTING RIGHTS

EACH SHARE SHALL BE EQUAL IN ALL RESPECTS


TO EVERY OTHER SHARE, except as otherwise
provided in the AOI

For Board of directors, the by-laws or AOI can


The AOI may provide for a greater quorum or provide for a greater majority in quorum
voting requirements in meetings of
stockholders or directors than those provided in For stockholders, the AOI can provide for a
this Code. different percentage in quorum

4. Pre-emptive Right Limitations on the exercise of pre-emptive right:

The pre-emptive right of stockholders in close a. Such pre-emptive right shall not extend to
corporations shall extend to all stock to be shares to be issued in compliance with laws
issued, including reissuance of treasury shares, requiring stock offerings or minimum stock
whether for money, property or personal ownership by the public;
services, or in payment of corporate debts,
unless the articles of incorporation provide b. Not extend to shares to be issued in good faith
otherwise. with the approval of the stockholders
representing two-thirds (2/3) of the outstanding
capital stock, in exchange for property needed
for corporate purposes or in payment of a
previously contracted debt

c. Shall not take effect if denied in the Articles of


Incorporation or an amendment thereto.

5. Transferability

Restrictions on the right to transfer shares Restrictions on the right to transfer not allowed
must appear in the AI and in the by-laws as
well as in the certificate of stock otherwise the
same shall not be binding on any purchaser
thereof in good faith

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 68 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

CLOSE CORPORATIONS REGULAR CORPORATIONS


6. Withdrawal Right

Any stockholder of a close corporation may, for Stockholders may require the corporation to
any reason, compel the said corporation to buy-back their shares at fair value when the
purchase his shares at their fair value, which Corporation has unrestricted Retained Earnings:
shall not be less than their par or issued value, a. In case any amendment to the articles of
when the corporation has sufficient assets in its incorporation which has the effect of:
books to cover its debts and liabilities exclusive changing or restricting the rights of
of capital stock any stockholder or class of shares, or
authorizing preferences in any respect
Any stockholder of a close corporation may, by superior to those of outstanding shares
written petition to the SEC, compel the of any class, or
dissolution of such corporation whenever: extending or shortening the term of
Any of acts of the directors, officers or those in corporate existence
control of the corporation is illegal, or b. In case of sale, lease, exchange, transfer,
fraudulent, or dishonest, or oppressive or mortgage, pledge or other disposition of all
unfairly prejudicial to the corporation or or substantially all of the corporate property
any stockholder, or and assets as provided in the Code; and
Corporate assets are being misapplied or c. In case of merger or consolidation
wasted. d. Extension or shortening of the term of the
corporation (37)
e. Diversion of funds of corporation from
primary purpose to secondary purpose
(41)

The corporation may buy-back shares of


stockholders subject to the following limitations
(Treasury shares):
a. There must be unrestricted retained
earnings
b. Must be for a legitimate purpose

2. Educational Corporations
b. StockThe number and erm of directors shall
be governed by the provisions on stock
2.1 Incorporation
corporations.
a. Governing Laws: Special Laws and the
Corporation Code (106)
3. Religious Corporations
b. Pre-requisites to Incorporation: Except upon
3.1 Classes of Religious Corporations ( 109)
favorable recommendation of the (Ministry of
Education and Culture), the SEC shall not accept
a. Corporation Sole
or approve the articles of incorporation and by-
laws of any educational institution (107)
b. Religious Corporationsgoverned by the
Corporation Code and the general provisions on
2.2 Board of Trustees (108)
non-stock corporations insofar as thye may be
applicable.
a. Non-stock

1. Compositionnot less than 5 nor more than


3.2 Corporation Sole ( 110)
15 trustees, but always in multiples of five.
Unless otherwise provided in the articles of
a. Who may formThe chief archbishop, bishop,
incorporation or the by-laws, the board or
priest, minister, rabbi or other presiding elder of
trustees of incorporated schools, colleges, or
such religious denomination, sect or church.
other institutions of learning shall:
(110)
a. So classify themselves that the term
of office of one-fifth (1/5) of their
b. Filling of Vacancies (114)
numbers shall expire every year.
b. Trustees thereafter elected to fill
vacancies, occurring before the 1. The successors in office concerned shall
expiration of a particular term shall hold become the corporation sole on their
office only for the unexpired period accession to office and shall be permitted
c. Trustees elected thereafter to fill to transact business as such on the filing
vacancies caused by expiration of term shall with the Securities and Exchange
hold office for five (5) years Commission of a copy of their
commission, certificate of election, or
2. QuorumMajority of the trustees letters of appointment, duly certified by
Powers and Authority of trustees shall be defined any notary public.
in the by-laws

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 69 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

2. During any vacancy in the office, the rabbi or presiding elder, duly certified to
person or persons authorized and be correct by any notary public.
empowered by the rules, regulations or
discipline of the religious denomination, f. Effect of the Filing of the Articles (112):
sect or church represented by the 1. Such chief archbishop, bishop, priest,
corporation sole to administer the minister, rabbi or presiding elder shall
temporalities and manage the affairs, become a corporation sole.
estate and properties of the corporation
sole during the vacancy shall exercise all 2. All temporalities, estate and properties
the powers and authority of the of the religious denomination, sect or
corporation sole during such vacancy. church theretofore administered or
managed by him as such chief
c. Purpose-- For the purpose of administering archbishop, bishop, priest, minister,
and managing, as trustee, the affairs, property rabbi or presiding elder shall be held
and temporalities of any religious denomination, in trust by him as a corporation sole,
sect or church. (110) for the use, purpose, behalf and sole
benefit of his religious denomination,
d. The Articles of Incorporation must set forth sect or church, including hospitals,
that (111): schools, colleges, orphan asylums,
1. The presiding elder of such religious parsonages and cemeteries thereof.
denomination, sect or church is the chief
archbishop, bishop, priest, minister, g. Acquisition and Alienation of Property (113):
rabbi or presiding elder of his religious 1. Purpose for holding and purchasing the
denomination, sect or church and that real and personal property, or receiving
he desires to become a corporation sole; gifts and bequestsFor its church,
charitable, benevolent or educational
2. The rules, regulations and discipline of purposes.
his religious denomination, sect or
church are not inconsistent with his 2. Conditions for sale or mortgage of real
becoming a corporation sole and do not property held by it:
forbid it; i. By obtaining an order for that
purpose from the Court of First
3. As such chief archbishop, bishop, Instance of the province where
priest, minister, rabbi or presiding elder, the property is situated upon
he is charged with the administration of proof made to the satisfaction of
the temporalities and the management the court that:
of the affairs, estate and properties of *notice of the application
his religious denomination, sect or for leave to sell or
church within his territorial jurisdiction, mortgage has been given
describing such territorial jurisdiction; by publication or
otherwise in such manner
and for such time as said
4. The manner in which any vacancy
court may have directed,
occurring in the office of chief
and *that it is to the
archbishop, bishop, priest, minister,
interest of the corporation
rabbi of presiding elder is required to be
that leave to sell or
filled, according to the rules, regulations
mortgage should be
or discipline of the religious
granted.
denomination, sect or church to which
ii. The application for leave to sell
he belongs; and
or mortgage must be made by
petition, duly verified, by the chief
5. The place where the principal office of archbishop, bishop, priest,
the corporation sole is to be established minister, rabbi or presiding elder
and located, which place must be within acting as corporation sole, and
the Philippines. may be opposed by any member
of the religious denomination, sect
The articles of incorporation may include any or church represented by the
other provision not contrary to law for the corporation sole:
regulation of the affairs of the corporation.
3. When the Intervention of the Courts
e. Filing/submission of the Articles of shall not be necessaryIn cases where
Incorporation (112): the rules, regulations and discipline of the
religious denomination, sect or church,
religious society or order concerned
1. Verification before filing, by affidavit represented by such corporation sole
or affirmation of the chief archbishop, regulate the method of acquiring, holding,
bishop, priest, minister, rabbi or selling and mortgaging real estate and
presiding elder, as the case may be, personal property, such rules, regulations
and discipline shall control.
2. Accompanied by a copy of the
commission, certificate of election or h. Dissolution (115):
letter of appointment of such chief
archbishop, bishop, priest, minister,

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 70 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

1. A corporation sole may be dissolved b. That at least two-thirds (2/3) of its


and its affairs settled voluntarily by membership have given their written
submitting to the Securities and consent or have voted to incorporate, at a
Exchange Commission a verified duly convened meeting of the body;
declaration of dissolution.
c. That the incorporation of the religious
2. The declaration of dissolution shall society or religious order, or diocese,
set forth: synod, or district organization desiring to
incorporate is not forbidden by competent
a. The name of the corporation; authority or by the constitution, rules,
regulations or discipline of the religious
denomination, sect, or church of which it
b. The reason for dissolution and
forms a part;
winding up;

d. That the religious society or religious


c. The authorization for the
order, or diocese, synod, or district
dissolution of the corporation by
organization desires to incorporate for the
the particular religious
administration of its affairs, properties and
denomination, sect or church;
estate;

d. The names and addresses of


e. The place where the principal
the persons who are to supervise
office of the corporation is to be
the winding up of the affairs of
established and located, which place must
the corporation.
be within the Philippines; and

3. Effect of approval of declaration of f. The names, nationalities, and


dissolution by the Securities and residences of the trustees elected by the
Exchange Commissionthe corporation religious society or religious order, or the
shall cease to carry on its operations diocese, synod, or district organization to
except for the purpose of winding up its serve for the first year or such other
affairs. period as may be prescribed by the laws
of the religious society or religious order,
or of the diocese, synod, or district
3.3 Religious Societies ( 116) organization, the board of trustees to be
not less than five (5) nor more than
fifteen (15).
a. Who may form a Religious Society:
d. Purpose of incorporation
Any religious society or religious order, or any
diocese, synod, or district organization of any For the administration of its temporalities or for
religious denomination, sect or church, unless the management of its affairs, properties and
forbidden by the constitution, rules, regulations, estate.
or discipline of the religious denomination, sect
or church of which it is a part, or by competent
authority.

b. Internal Requirement

Upon written consent and/or by an affirmative


vote at a meeting called for the purpose of at
least two-thirds (2/3) of its membership,

c. SEC Requirement

1. Filing with the Securities and


Exchange Commission, articles of
incorporation verified by the affidavit of
the presiding elder, secretary, or clerk or
other member of such religious society
or religious order, or diocese, synod, or
district organization of the religious
denomination, sect or church.

2. The Articles must set forth the ff:

a. That the religious society or religious


order, or diocese, synod, or district
organization is a religious organization of
a religious denomination, sect or church;

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 71 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

b. by the contract in a prearranged,


deliverable grade at a specific date in
the future at a specified price.
THE SECURITIES
REGULATION CODE 2.2 Foreign Exchange Market This
market is an over-the-counter market
(RA 8799) conducted by international banks and does
not have a central location

Security a forward exchange


Chapter I contract
OVERVIEW:
THE FINANCIAL MARKETS
2.3 Options Market It enables an investor
to purchase an option giving him the right to
1. Capital Markets buy or sell a specific number of shares at a
future date, at a specific price. For this right,
The places to go if you want to raise new the investor either pays or receives money but
money (just like in a commodity market) the money
involved is only a fraction of the market value
1.1 Equity Capital for the investor, the of the shares concerned.
stock market provides a variable return
a. Stock Market Security call or put options
Security eg, shares of stock

1.2 Debt Capital for the lender, the Chapter II


money or bond market provides a fixed OVERVIEW OF THE LAW
return

b. Money Market for short term


debts, ie, those normally maturing 1. State Policy (Sec.2)
within 1 year from date of issuance
The State shall establish a socially conscious,
free market that regulates itself, encourages
Security commercial paper (an the widest participation of ownership in
unsecured IOU of a company, enterprises, enhances the democratization of
issued on a discount basis, wealth, promotes the development of the
promising to pay the holder the capital market, protect investors, ensures full
full face value thereof upon and fair disclosure about securities, minimizes
redemption) if not totally eliminates insider trading and
other fraudulent or manipulative devices and
c. Bond Market for long term debts, practices which create distortions in the free
ie, those normally maturing after a market.
year from date of issuance
PSE vs. Court of Appeals (1997)
Security junk bonds (high yield
bonds having high interest rates The Securities Act is designed not only to
and are issued by lower credit provide investors with adequate information
rated companies or companies upon which to base their decision to buy and
with no credit rating) sell securities, but also to protect legitimate
business seeking o obtain capital through
honest representation against competition
2. Non-Capital Markets from crooked promoters and prevent fraud in
sale of securities.
The places to go if you want to hedge or
mitigate the risks attached to holding capital The intended effects of the Securities Act are
assets chiefly the following:
a. Prevention of excesses and fraudulent
2.1 Commodity Market The instruments transactions, merely by requirement
traded in this market are not present assets that their details be revealed;
like shares of stock, commercial papers or b. Placing the market during the early
bonds but future contracts calling for stages of the offering of security a
delivery of an asset ; for this reason, a body of information, which operating
commodity market is usually referred to as a indirectly through investment services
futures market. (eg, agricultural products, and expert investors, will intend to
metals and financial instruments) produce a more accurate appraisal of
a security.
Security a futures contract (one
which entitles the holder to buy or The Code is self-executory, and failure of SEC to
sell a specific amount of the issue rules and regulations shall not in any
underlying commodity represented manner affect its self-executroy nature (Sec.
72.1)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 72 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

should be resolved within 1 year from the


2. Powers and Functions of the SEC enactment of this Code.
(Sec. 5)
The Commission shall retain jurisdiction over
pending suspension of payments/rehabilitation
1. Have jurisdiction and supervision over all
cases filed as of 30 June 2000 until finally
corporations, partnerships or
disposed.
associations who are the grantees of
primary franchises and/or a license or
permit issued by the Government;
2. Formulate policies and 3. Definition of Terms
recommendations on issues concerning
the securities market, advise Congress 3.1 Securities - are shares, participation or
and other government agencies on all interests in a corporation or in a commercial
aspects of the securities market enterprise or profit-making venture and
3. Approve, reject, suspend, revoke or evidenced by a certificate, contract,
require amendments to registration instrument, whether written or electronic in
statements, and registration and character. It includes:
licensing applications;
4. Regulate, investigate or supervise the (a) Shares of stock, bonds, debentures,
activities of persons to ensure notes, evidences of indebtedness,
compliance; asset-backed securities;
5. Supervise, monitor, suspend or take (b) Investment contracts, certificates of
over the activities of exchanges, clearing interest or participation in a profit
agencies and other SROs; sharing agreement, certificates of
6. Impose sanctions for the violation of deposit for a future subscription;
laws, rules, regulations and orders (c) Fractional undivided interests in oil,
issued pursuant thereto; gas or other mineral rights;
7. Prepare, approve, amend or repeal (d) Derivatives like option and warrants;
rules, regulations and orders, and issue (e) Certificates of assignments,
opinions and provide guidance on and certificates of participation, trust
supervise compliance with such rules, certificates, voting trust certificates or
regulations and orders; similar instruments;
8. Enlist the aid and support of and/or (f) Proprietary or non proprietary
deputize any and all enforcement membership certificates
agencies of the Government civil or incorporations; and
military as well as any private (g) Other instruments as may in the
institution, corporation, firm, association future be determined by the
or person; Commission.
9. Issue cease and desist orders to prevent
fraud or injury to the investing public; 3.2 Issuer - the originator, maker, obligor, or
10. Punish for contempt of the Commission, creator of the security.
both direct and indirect;
11. Compel the officers of any registered 3.3 Broker - a person engaged in the
corporation or association to call business of buying and selling securities for
meetings of stockholders or members; the account of others.
12. Issue subpoena duces tecum and
summon witnesses to appear, order the 3.4 Dealer - any person who buys and sells
examination, search and seizure of all securities for his/her own account in the
documents, papers, files and records, ordinary course of business.
tax returns, and books of accounts of
any entity or person under investigation, 3.5 Associated person of a broker or
subject to the provisions of existing dealer - an employee thereof who, directly
laws; exercises control of supervisory authority, but
13. Suspend, or revoke after proper notice does not include a salesman, or an agent or a
and hearing, the franchise or certificate person whose functions are solely clerical or
of registration of corporations, ministerial.
partnerships or associations, upon any
of the grounds provided by law; 3.6 Clearing Agency - any person who acts
14. Such other powers as may be provided as intermediary in making deliveries upon
by law as well as those which may be payment to effect settlement in securities
implied from, or which are necessary or transactions.
incidental to powers which are expressly
granted to the Commission. 3.7 Exchange - an organized marketplace or
facility that brings together buyers and sellers
The Commissions jurisdiction over all cases and executes trades of securities and/or
enumerated under Sec 5 of PD 902-A is commodities.
hereby transferred to the Courts of general
jurisdiction or the appropriate Regional Trial 3.8 Insider
Court. (a) the issuer;
(b) a director or officer (or person
The Commission shall retain jurisdiction over performing similar functions) of, or a
pending cases involving intra-corporate person controlling the issuer;
disputes submitted for final resolution which (c) a person whose relationship or former
relationship to the issuer gives or

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 73 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

gave him access to material the issuer, to be determined by the SEC.


information about the issuer or the Consequently, the absolute reliance on the full
security that is not generally disclosure method is the registration of
available to the public; securities is, therefore, untenable.
(d) a government employee, or director,
or officer of an exchange, clearing Procedure (Sec.12)
agency and/or self-regulatory
organization who has access to 4.1 Filing of Registration Statement
material information about an issuer
or a security that is not generally All securities shall be registered through
available to the public; or the filing by the issuer in the main office
(e) a person who learns such of the Commission, of a sworn registration
information by a communication statement. The registration statement
from any of the foregoing insiders. shall include any prospectus required or
permitted to be delivered.
3.9 Pre-need plans are contracts which
provide for the performance of future The information required for registration
services or the payment of future monetary shall include, among others the effect of
consideration at the time of actual need, for the securities issue on ownership, on the
which planholders pay in cash or installment mix of ownership, especially foreign and
at stated prices, with or without interest or local ownership.
insurance coverage and includes life,
pension, education, interment, and other The registration statement shall be signed
plans which the Commission may from time by
to time approve. the issuers executive officer
principal operating officer
3.10 Promoter - a person who, acting
principal financial officer
alone or with others, takes initiative in
comptroller
founding and organizing the business or
enterprise of the issuer and receives principal accounting officer
consideration therefor. corporate secretary or
persons performing similar
3.11 Registration statement - is the functions
application for the registration of securities
required to be filed with the Commission. Accompanied By a duly verified resolution
of the board of directors of the issuer
3.12 Salesman - a natural person, employed as coporation.
such or as an agent, by a dealer, issuer or
broker to buy and sell securities. The written consent of the expert named
as having certified any part of the
3.13 Uncertified Security a security registration statement or any document
evidenced by electronic or similar records. used in connection therewith shall also be
filed.
3.14 Underwriter - a person who guarantees
on a firm commitment and/or declared best Where the registration statement includes
effort basis the distribution and sale of securities shares to be sold by selling shareholders,
of any kind by another company. a written certification by such selling
shareholders as to the accuracy of any
4. Registration of Securities part of the registration statement
contributed to by such selling
Securities shall not be sold or offered for shareholders shall also be filed.
sale or distribution within the Philippines,
without a registration statement duly filed 4.2 Payment of Fee
with and approved by the Commission. (Sec.
8) The issuer shall pay to the Commission a
fee of not more than 1/10 of 1% of the
PSE vs. Court of Appeals (1997) maximum aggregate price at which such
securities are proposed to be offered. The
Under the policy of full material disclosure, Commission shall prescribe by rule
all companies, listed or applying for listing, are diminishing fees in inverse proportion to
required to divulge truthfully and accurately, the value of the aggregate price of the
all material information about themselves, and offering.
the securities they sell, for the protection of
the investing public, and under the pain of 4.3 Notice of Filing
administrative, criminal and civil sanctions. A
fact is deemed material if it tends to induce or Notice of filing shall be immediately
otherwise effect the sale or purchase or its published by the issuer in 2 newspapers of
securities. general circulation in the Philippines, once
a week for 2 consecutive weeks, or in
A reading of the grounds give for rejection or such other manner as the Commission
registration reveals the intention of Congress shall prescribe, reciting that:
to make the registration and issuance of
securities dependent, to a certain extent, on a registration statement for the sale of
he merits of the securities themselves, and of such security has been filed,

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 74 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

the registration statement, as well registration of the security thereunder


as the papers attached thereto are after due notice and hearing if it finds
open to inspection, that:
copies shall be furnished to
interested parties at such reasonable The issuer:
charge as the Commission may o Has been judicially declared
prescribe. insolvent;
o Has violated any of the provisions
of this Code, the rules
promulgated pursuant thereto, or
any order of the Commission in
4.4 Withdrawal of Registration Statement connection with the offering for
which a registration statement has
A registration statement may be been filed;
withdrawn by the issuer only with the o Has been or is engaged or is about
consent of the Commission. (Sec. 13) to engage in fraudulent
transactions;
4.5 Amendments to Registration Statement o Has made any false or misleading
(Sec. 13) representation of material facts in
any prospectus concerning the
If a registration statement is on its face issuer or its securities;
incomplete or inaccurate in any material o Has failed to comply with any
respect, the Commission shall issue an requirement that the Commission
order directing the amendment of the may impose as a condition for
registration statement. Upon compliance registration
with such order, the amended
registration statement shall become The registration statement is on its
effective upon compliance with the face incomplete or inaccurate in any
procedure in Section 12.6. material respect or includes any untrue
statement of a material fact or omits to
An amendment filed prior to the state a material fact required to be
effective date of the registration stated therein or necessary to make
statement shall recommence the 45 day the statements therein not misleading;
period within which the Commission or
shall act on a registration statement. The issuer, any officer, director or
controlling person of the issuer, or
An amendment filed after the effective
person performing similar functions, or
date of the registration statement shall
any underwriter has been convicted, by
become effective only upon such date as
a competent judicial or administrative
determined by the Commission.
body, upon plea of guilty, or otherwise,
of an offense involving moral turpitude
If any change occurs in the facts set
and/or fraud or is enjoined or
forth in a registration statement, the
restrained by the Commission or other
issuer shall file an amendment thereto
competent judicial or administrative
setting forth the change.
body for violations of securities,
commodities, and other related laws.
4.6 Acceptance or Rejection by SEC
If any issuer shall refuse to permit an
examination to be made by the
Within 45 days after the date of filing of
Commission, its refusal shall be ground
the registration statement, or by such
for the refusal or revocation of the
later date to which the issuer has
registration of its securities.
consented, the Commission shall declare
the registration statement effective or
PSE vs. Court of Appeals (1997)
rejected, unless the applicant is allowed
to amend the registration statement.
The SEC has no power o overturn the decision
of the PSE Board to deny listing of securities.
a) Acceptance
Questions of policy and management are left
to the honest decision of officers an directors
The Commission shall declare the
of a corporation, and courts are without
registration statement to be effective
authority o substitute their judgment for
if it finds that the registration
judgment of the Board of Directors. The Boad
statement together with all the other
is the business manger of the corporation, and
papers and documents attached
as long as it acts in good faith, its orders are
thereto, is on its face complete and
not reviewable by he courts. Also, as the
that the requirements have been
primary market for securities, the PSE has
complied with.
established its name and goodwill, and it has
the right to protect such goodwill by
b) Rejection / Revocation (Sec. 13)
maintaining a reasonable standard of
propriety in the entities who choose to
The Commission may reject a
transact through its facilities. It was
registration statement and refuse
reasonable for PSE, therefore, to exercise its
registration of the security, or
judgment in the manner it deems appropriate
revoke the effectivity of a
for its business identity, as long as no rights
registration statement and the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 75 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

are trampled upon and public welfare is Upon the issuance of the suspension order, no
safeguarded. further offer or sale of such security shall be
made until the same is lifted or set aside by
the Commission. Otherwise, such sale shall be
4.7 Oath of Issuer void.

Upon effectivity of the registration Notice of issuance of such order shall be given
statement, the issuer shall state under to the issuer and every dealer and broker who
oath in every prospectus that all shall have notified the Commission of an
registration requirements have been met intention to sell such security.
and that all information are true and
correct as represented by the issuer or
the one making the statement. 6. Securities and Transactions from
Registration
Any untrue statement of fact or omission
to state a material fact required to be 6.1 Exempt Securities (Sec. 9)
stated or necessary to make the
statement therein not misleading shall (a) Any security issued or guaranteed by
constitute fraud. the Government of the Philippines, or
by any political subdivision or agency
5. Suspension of Offer and Sale thereof, or by any person acting as an
(Sec. 13) instrumentality of said Government.
(b) Any security issued or guaranteed by
If the Commission deems it necessary, it the government of any country with
may issue an order suspending the offer which the Philippines maintains
and sale of the securities pending any diplomatic relations, or by any state,
investigation. The order shall state the province or political subdivision
grounds for taking such actions, but thereof on the basis of reciprocity.
such order of suspension although (c) Certificates issued by a receiver or by
binding upon persons notified thereof, a trustee in bankruptcy duly approved
shall be deemed confidential, and shall by the proper adjudicatory body.
not be published. (d) Any security or its derivatives the sale
If, at any time, the Commission finds or transfer of which is under the
that a registration statement contains supervision and regulation of the
any false statement or omits to state Office of the Insurance Commission,
any fact required to be stated therein or Housing and Land Use Regulatory
necessary to make the statements Board, or the Bureau of Internal
therein not misleading, the Commission Revenue.
may conduct an examination, and, after (e) Any security issued by a bank except
due notice and hearing, issue an Order its own shares of stock.
suspending the effectivity of the
registration statement. (Sec. 14) Union Bank vs. SEC (2001)
Failure of the issuer, underwriter, or any
Although the shares of stock of banking
other person to cooperate, or his
institutions are exempt from registration
obstruction or refusal to undergo an
requirements, a bank whose shares are listed
examination, shall be a ground for the
in the stock market is covered by the RSA and
issuance of a suspension order. (Sec.
the implementing rule on the reportorial
14)
requirements of listed companies. The RSA
If, at any time, the information
exempts from registration the securities
contained in the registration statement
issued by banking or financial institutions, but
filed is or has become misleading,
nowhere does its state or even imply that
incorrect, inadequate or incomplete in
bank as a listed corporation is exempt from
any material respect, or the sale or
complying with reports required by the RS
offering for sale of the security
IRRs.
registered thereunder may work or tend
to work a fraud, the Commission may
The Commission may, by rule or regulation
require from the issuer such further
after public hearing, add to the foregoing any
information necessary to enable the
class of securities if it finds that the enforcement
Commission to ascertain whether the
of this Code with respect to such securities is not
registration of such security should be
necessary in the public interest and for the
revoked. The Commission may also
protection of investors.
suspend the right to sell and offer for
sale such security pending further
6.2 Exempt Transactions (Sec. 10)
investigation. (Sec. 15)
The refusal to furnish information
(a) At any judicial sale, or sale by an
required by the Commission may be a
executor, administrator, guardian or
ground for the issuance of an order of
receiver or trustee in insolvency or
suspension. (Sec. 15)
bankruptcy.
(b) By or for the account of a pledge
The order shall be deemed confidential, and
holder, or mortgagee or similar lien
shall not be published.
holder selling or offering for sale or
delivery in the ordinary course of
business and not for the purpose of

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 76 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

avoiding the provisions of this Code, issuances of shares from already authorized
to liquidate a bona fide debt, a but still unissued capital stock.
security pledged in good faith as
security for such debt. (j) The exchange of securities by the
(c) An isolated transaction in which any issuer with its existing security holders
security is sold, offered for sale, exclusively, where no commission or
subscription or delivery is not being other remuneration is paid.
made in the course of repeated and (k) The sale of securities by an issuer to
successive transactions by the owner fewer than 20 persons in the
or his representative and such owner Philippines during any twelve-month
or representative not being the period.
underwriter of such security. (l) The sale of securities to any of the
(d) The distribution by a corporation to following qualified buyers:
its stockholders or other security Bank;
holders as a stock dividend or other Registered investment house;
distribution out of surplus. Insurance company;
(e) The sale of capital stock of a Pension fund or retirement plan
corporation to its own stockholders maintained by the Government or
exclusively, where no commission or any political subdivision or
other remuneration is paid or given managed by a bank or other
directly or indirectly in connection persons authorized by the Bangko
with the ale of such capital stock. Sentral to engage in trust
(f) The issuance of bonds or notes functions;
secured by mortgage upon real Investment company; or
estate or tangible personal property,
Such other person as the
where the entire mortgage together
Commission determine as
with all the bonds or notes secured
qualified buyers, on the basis of
thereby are sold to a single
such factors as financial
purchaser at a single sale.
sophistication, net worth,
(g) The issue and delivery of any
knowledge, and experience in
security in exchange for any other
financial and business matters, or
security of the same issuer pursuant
amount of assets under
to a right of conversion: Provided,
management.
That the security surrendered has
been registered under this Code or
The Commission may exempt other
was, when sold, exempt, and that
transactions, if it finds that the
the security delivered in exchange, if
requirement of registration is not
sold at the conversion price, would
necessary in the public interest or for the
at the time of such conversion fall
protection of the investors such as by
within the class of securities entitled
reason of the small amount involved or
to registration under this Code.
the limited character of the public
Upon such conversion the par value
offering.
of the security surrendered in such
exchange shall be deemed the price
Any person applying for an exemption of a
at which the securities issued and
transaction shall file with the
delivered in such exchange are sold.
Commission a notice identifying the
(h) Brokers transactions, executed upon
exemption relied upon on such form and
customers orders, on any registered
at such time as the Commission by rule
Exchange or other trading market.
may prescribe and with such notice shall
(i) Subscriptions for shares of the
pay to the Commission a fee equivalent to
capital stock of a corporation prior to
1/10 of 1% of the maximum aggregate
incorporation or in pursuance of an
price or issued value of the securities.
increase in its authorized capital
stock, when no expense is incurred,
or no commission, compensation or
remuneration is paid or given, and 7. Tender Offer and Proxy Solicitation
only when the purpose for soliciting,
giving or taking of such subscriptions 7.1 Tender Offers (Sec. 19)
is to comply with the requirements
of such law as to the percentage of Parties Required to make Tender
the capital stock which should be Offer
subscribed before it can be
registered and duly incorporated, or (a) Any person or group of persons
its authorized capital increased. acting in concert who intends to
acquire at least 15% of any class
Nestle Philippines vs. Court of Appeals of any equity security of a listed
(1991) corporation or of any class of any
equity security of a corporation
The language of the RSA exempting from with assets of at least
registration issuance o additional capital P50,000,000 and having 200 or
stock, must be interpreted to cover only more stockholders with at least
issuance of shares of stock as part of and in 100 shares each or
the course of increasing he authorized capital (b) who intends to acquire at least
stock of a corporation. It does not cover 30% of such equity over a period

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 77 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

of 12 months shall make a


tender offer to stockholders by Unless otherwise provided in the proxy, it
filing with the Commission a shall be valid only for the meeting for
declaration to that effect; and which it is intended. No proxy shall be
furnish the issuer a statement valid and effective for a period longer than
containing such of the 5 years at one time.
information as the Commission
may prescribe. No broker or dealer shall give any proxy,
consent or authorization to a person other
than the customer, without the express
Withdrawal of tender Offer written authorization of such customer.
Securities deposited pursuant to a
tender offer or request or invitation A broker or dealer who holds or acquires
for tenders may be withdrawn by or the proxy for at least 10% or such
on behalf of the depositor at any percentage as the Commission may
time throughout the period that the prescribe of the outstanding share of the
tender offer remains open and if the issuer, shall submit a report identifying
securities deposited have not been the beneficial owner within 10 days after
previously accepted for payment, such acquisition, for its own account or
and at any time after 60 days from customer, to the issuer of the security, to
the date of the original tender offer the Exchange where the security is traded
or request or invitation, except as and to the Commission.
the Commission may otherwise
prescribe. 7.3 Fees for Tender Offers and Certain
Proxy Solicitations (Sec. 21)
At the time of filing with the Commission
of any statement required for any tender
Securities offered exceed
offer or for proxy or consent solicitation,
required quantity
the Commission may require that the
Where the securities offered exceed person making such filing pay a fee of not
that which a person or group of more than 1/10 of 1% of:
persons is bound or willing to take The proposed aggregate purchase
up and pay for, the securities that price in the case of a transaction
are subject of the tender offer shall under Sections 20 or 72.2; or
be taken up as nearly as may be pro The proposed payment in cash, and
rata, disregarding fractions, the value of any securities or property
according to the number of to be transferred in the acquisition,
securities deposited by each merger or consolidation, or the cash
depositor. and value of any securities proposed
to be received upon the sale or
The provisions of this subsection disposition of such assets in the case
shall also apply to securities of a solicitation under Section 20.
deposited within 10 days after notice
of an increase in the consideration
offered to security holders is first
published or sent or given to security
holders.
8. Regulation of Transactions of
Variations of Tender Offer Directors / Officers / Principal
Where any person varies the terms Stockholders (Sec. 23)
of a tender offer or request or
invitation for tenders before the 8.1 Filing of Statement
expiration thereof by increasing the Every person who is directly or indirectly
consideration offered to holders of the beneficial owner of more than 10% of
such securities, such person shall any class of any equity security or
pay the increased consideration to who is a director or an officer of the
each security holder whose issuer of such security,
securities are taken up and paid for
whether or not such securities have shall file, at the time either such requirement
been taken up by such person before is first satisfied or within ten days after he
the variation of the tender offer or becomes such a beneficial owner, director, or
request or invitation. officer, a statement with the Commission and,
if such security is listed for trading on an
7.2 Proxy Solicitations (Sec. 20) Exchange, also with the Exchange, of the
Proxies must be amount of all equity securities of such issuer
in writing of which he is the beneficial owner, and within
signed by the stockholder or his ten (10) days after the close of each calendar
duly authorized representative month thereafter, if there has been a change
and in such ownership during such month, shall
filed before the scheduled also file a statement indicating his ownership
meeting with the corporate at the close of the calendar month and such
secretary. changes as have occurred during such
calendar month.
Period of Validity

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 78 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

8.2 Recovery of Damages for Unfair Use of It shall be unlawful for any person acting
Information for himself or through a dealer or broker,
directly or indirectly:
a. For the purpose of preventing the unfair use
of information which may have been obtained by (a) To create a false or misleading
such beneficial owner, director, or officer by appearance of active trading in any
reason of his relationship to the issuer listed security traded in an Exchange
or any other trading market:
any profit realized by him from any
purchase and sale, or any sale and By effecting any transaction in
purchase, of any equity security of such security which involves no
such issuer within any period of less change in the beneficial ownership
than six (6) months, thereof;
o unless such security was By entering an order or orders for
acquired in good faith in the purchase or sale of such
connection with a debt security with the knowledge that a
previously contracted, simultaneous order or orders of
shall inure to and be recoverable by substantially the same size, time
the issuer, irrespective of any and price, for the sale or purchase
intention of holding the security of any such security, has or will be
purchased or of not repurchasing the entered by or for the same or
security sold for a period exceeding different parties; or
6 months. By performing similar act where
there is no change in beneficial
b. Suit to recover such profit may be instituted ownership.
before the RTC by the issuer, or by the owner of
any security of the issuer in the name and in (b) To effect, alone or with others, a
behalf of the issuer if the issuer shall fail or series of transactions in securities
refuse to bring such suit within 60 days after that:
request or shall fail diligently to prosecute the
same thereafter. But; Raises their price to induce the
No such suit shall be brought more than purchase of a security;
t2 years after the date such profit was Depresses their price to induce the
realized. sale of a security; or
Creates active trading to induce
It shall be unlawful for any beneficial owner, such a purchase or sale through
director, or officer to sell any equity security manipulative devices such as
of such issuer if the person selling the marking the close, painting the
security or his principal: tape, squeezing the float, hype and
dump, boiler room operations and
(a) Does not own the security sold; or such other similar devices.
(b) If owning the security, does not
deliver it against such sale within 20 (c) To circulate or disseminate
days thereafter, or does not within 5 information that the price of any
days after such sale deposit it in the security listed in an Exchange will or is
mails or other usual channels of likely to rise or fall because of
transportation; manipulative market operations of any
one or more persons conducted for
But no person shall be deemed to have the purpose of raising or depressing
violated this subsection if he proves that the price of the security for the
notwithstanding the exercise of good faith purpose of inducing the purchase or
he was unable to make such delivery or sale of such security.
deposit within such time, or that to do so
would cause undue inconvenience or (d) To make false or misleading
expense. statement with respect to any
material fact, which he knew or had
The provisions of Subsection 23. 2 shall not reasonable ground to believe was so
apply to any purchase and sale, or sale and false or misleading, for the purpose of
purchase and the provisions of Subsection inducing the purchase or sale of any
23.3 shall not apply to any sale, of an equity security listed or traded in an
security not then or thereafter held by him Exchange.
in an investment account, by a dealer in the
ordinary course of his business and incident (e) To effect any series of transactions for
to the establishment or maintenance by him the purchase and/or sale of any
of a primary or secondary market, otherwise security traded in an Exchange for the
than on an Exchange, for such security. purpose of pegging, fixing or
stabilizing the price of such security,
9. Prohibitions unless otherwise allowed by this Code
or by rules of the Commission.

9.1 Manipulation of Security Prices


9.2 Insider Trading

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 79 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Parties covered : Insider Trading in Relation to Tender


Insider Offers
insiders spouse or relatives by
affinity or consanguinity within the a.) It shall be unlawful where a tender
second degree, legitimate or offer has commenced or is about to
common-law, commence for:
Any person (other than the tender
It shall be unlawful for an insider to sell offeror) who is in possession of
or buy a security of the issuer, while in material non-public information
possession of material information with relating to such tender offer, to
respect to the issuer or the security that buy or sell the securities of the
is not generally available to the public, issuer that are sought or to be
unless: (Sec. 27) sought by such tender offer if such
person knows or has reason to
(a) The insider proves that the believe that
information was not gained from o the information is non-
such relationship; or public and
(b) If the other party selling to or buying o has been acquired directly
from the insider (or his agent) is or indirectly from the
identified, the insider proves: tender offeror, those acting
that he disclosed the information on its behalf, the issuer of
to the other party, or the securities, or any
that he had reason to believe insider of such issuer; and
that the other party otherwise is Any tender offeror, those acting
also in possession of the on its behalf, the issuer of the
information. securities, and any insider to
communicate material non-public
Presumption information relating to the tender
A purchase or sale of a security of the offer to any other person where
issuer shall be presumed to have been such communication is likely to
effected while in possession of material result in a violation of subsection
non-public information if transacted after 27.4.
such information came into existence
but prior to dissemination of such 10. Regulation of Market
information to the public and the lapse
Professionals and Other Entities
of a reasonable time for the market to
absorb such information
10.1 Registration of Brokers, Dealers,
Salesmen and Associated Persons
This presumption shall be rebutted upon
a showing by the purchaser or seller that
General Rule :
he was not aware of the material non-
o No person shall engage in the
public information at the time of the
purchase or sale. business of buying or selling
securities in the Philippines as a
broker or dealer, or act as a
Material non-public information: salesman, or an associated person
of any broker or dealer unless
(a) It has not been generally disclosed to registered as such with the
the public and would likely affect the Commission.
market price of the security after being o No registered broker or dealer shall
disseminated to the public and the lapse employ any salesman or any
of a reasonable time for the market to associated person, and no issuer
absorb the information; or shall employ any salesman, who is
not registered as such with the
(b) would be considered by a reasonable Commission.
person important under the
circumstances in determining his course o Nicolas vs CA (1998):
of action whether to buy, sell or hold a
security. The futility of petitioner's action
became more pronounced by the
Communication of the Information fact that he traded securities for the
It shall be unlawful for any insider to account of others without the
communicate material non-public necessary license from the SEC.
information about the issuer or the Clearly, such omission was in
security to any person who, by virtue of violation of Section 19 of the
the communication, becomes an insider, Revised Securities Act.
where the insider communicating the
information knows or has reason to The purpose of the statute requiring
believe that such person will likely buy the registration of brokers selling
or sell a security of the issuer while in securities and the filing of data
possession of such information. regarding securities which they
propose to sell, is to protect the
public and strengthen the securities
mechanism.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 80 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

proficiency and knowledge in the


American jurisprudence area of activity for which
emphasizes the principle that: registration
"an unlicensed person may not (b) In the case of a broker or dealer,
recover compensation for services the applicant satisfy a minimum
as a broker where a statute or net capital and provide a bond
ordinance requiring a license is or other security as the
applicable and such statute or Commission may prescribe
ordinance is of a regulatory (c) If located outside of the
nature, was enacted in the Philippines, the applicant files a
exercise of the police power for the written consent to service of
purpose of protecting the public, process upon the Commission
requires a license as evidence of pursuant to Sec. 65 hereof.
qualification and fitness, and
expressly precludes an unlicensed 10.3 SEC Action (Sec. 28.8)
person from recovering
compensation by suit, or at least a. Within 30 days after the filing of any
manifests an intent to prohibit and application, the Commission shall by
render unlawful the transaction of order:
business by an unlicensed person."
(a) Grant registration if it determines
We see no reason not to apply the that the requirements of this
same rule in our jurisdiction. Stock Section and the qualifications for
market trading, a technical and registration have been satisfied;
highly specialized institution in the or
Philippines, must be entrusted to (b) Deny said registration.
individuals with proven integrity,
competence and knowledge, who b. The names and addresses of all
have due regard to the persons approved for registration and
requirements of the law. all orders of the Commission with
respect thereto shall be recorded in a
Exception: Register of Securities Market
The Commission may conditionally Professionals kept in the office of the
or unconditionally exempt any Commission which shall be open to
broker, dealer, salesman, public inspection.
associated person of any broker or
dealer, or any class of the 10.4 Continuing Requirements
foregoing, from registration as it
deems consistent with the public o Every person registered shall file
interest and the protection of with the Commission information
investors. (Sec. 28.3) necessary to keep the application
for registration current and
accurate,.
Procedure (Sec. 28.5): o Every person registered shall pay to
the Commission an annual fee. Upon
o A broker or dealer may apply notice by the Commission that such
for registration by filing with the annual fee has not been paid as
Commission a written application. required, the registration of such
o Registration of a salesman or person shall be suspended until
of an associated person of a payment has been made.
registered broker or dealer may
be made upon written application 10.5 Termination of Registration of
filed with the Commission by such Salesman or Associated Person
salesman or associated person.
For purposes of this action, The registration of a salesman or
salesman shall not include any associated person shall be automatically
employee of an issuer whose terminated upon the cessation of his
compensation is not determined affiliation with said registered broker or
directly or indirectly on sales of dealer, or with an issuer in the case of a
securities of the issuer. salesman employed, appointed or
authorized by such issuer.
10.2 Qualifications of Market
Professionals (Sec. 28.4) The registered broker or dealer, or
issuer, as the case may be, shall file
The Commission shall promulgate with the Commission a notice of
rules and regulations prescribing the separation of such salesman or
qualifications for registration of each associated person.
category of applicant, which shall,
among other things, require as a 10.6 Revocation, Refusal or Suspension
condition for registration that: of Registration of Brokers, Dealers,
Salesmen and Associated Persons (Sec.
(a) If a natural person, the applicant 29)
satisfactorily pass a written
examination as to his

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 81 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

If, after due notice and hearing, the (i) Has been judicially declared
Commission determines the applicant insolvent.
or registrant:
29.4. It shall be sufficient cause for refusal,
(a) Has willfully violated any provision revocation or suspension of a broker's or
of this Code, any rule, regulation dealers registration, if any associated person
or order made hereunder, or any thereof or any juridical entity controlled by
other law administered by the such associated person has committed any act
Commission, or in the case of a or omission or is subject to any disability
registered broker, dealer or enumerated earlier.
associated person has failed to
supervise, with a view to Transactions and Responsibility of Brokers and
preventing such violation, Dealers (Sec. 30)
another person who commits
such violation; a. Prohibition against dealing or otherwise
(b) Has willfully made or caused to be selling or buying, for its account of
made a materially false or customers, securities listed on an
misleading statement in any Exchange issued by any corporation where
application for registration or any stockholder, director, associated
report filed with the Commission person or salesman, or authorized clerk of
or a self-regulatory organization, said broker or dealer and all the relatives
or has willfully omitted to state of the foregoing within the fourth civil
any material fact that is required degree o consanguinity or affinity, is at
to be stated therein; the time holding office in said issuer
(c) Has failed to satisfy the corporation as a director, president, vice-
qualifications or requirements for president, manager, treasurer,
registration and the rules and comptroller, secretary or any office or
regulations; trust and responsibility, or is a controlling
(d) Has been convicted by a person of the issuer.
competent judicial or
administrative authority of an b. Prohibition against effecting any
offense involving moral transaction in securities or induce or
turpitude, fraud, embezzlement, attempt to induce the purchase or sale of
counterfeiting, theft, estafa, any security except in compliance with
misappropriation, forgery, such rules and regulations as the
bribery, false oath, or perjury, or Commission shall prescribe to ensure fair
of a violation of securities, and honest dealings in securities and
commodities, banking, real provide financial safeguards an other
estate or insurance laws; standards for the operation o brokers and
(e) Is enjoined or restrained by a dealers.
competent judicial or
administrative body from
engaging in securities, 11. Regulation of Exchanges
commodities, banking, real
estate or insurance activities or 11.1 Nature of Stock Exchanges
from willfully violating laws
governing such activities; Lopez, et. al vs. Court of Appeals (1988)
(f) Is subject to an order of a
competent judicial or An exchange is a voluntary association or
administrative body refusing, corporation organized for the purpose of
revoking or suspending any furnishing to its members a convenient and
registration, license or other suitable place to transact their business of
permit under this Code, the rules promoting uniformity in the customs and
and regulations promulgated usages of merchants, of inculcating principles
thereunder, any other law of justice and equity in trade, of facilitating
administered by the the speedy adjustment of business disputes,
Commission; of acquiring and dissemination valuable
(g) Is subject to an order of a self- commercial and economic information and
regulatory organization generally of securing to its members the
suspending or expelling him benefits of co-operation in the furtherance of
from membership or their legitimate pursuits.
participation therein or from
association with a member or Carolina Industries vs. CMS Stock
participation thereof; Brokerage (1980)
(h) Has been found by a competent
judicial or administrative The rules and regulations of the Exchange
authority, to have willfully form part of the contract covering securities
violated any provisions of transacted within the facilities of Exchange.
securities, commodities,
banking, real estate or insurance
laws, or has willfully aided,
abetted, counseled, commanded, Sec Opinion #11 (2003)
induced or procured such
violation; or

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 82 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

It is important to stress that the (c) Copies of the rules of the Exchange;
Securities Regulation Code (SRC) treats and
exchanges as a special specie of (d) An undertaking that in the event a
corporation and subjects them to rules member firm becomes insolvent or
not otherwise applicable to regular when the Exchange shall have found
corporations. that the financial condition of its
member firm has so deteriorated
The stock exchange performs a function that it cannot readily meet the
vital to the national economy, a function demands of its customers for the
vested with public interest. It is said that delivery of securities and/or
the economy moves on the basis of the payment of sales proceeds, the
rise and fall of the stocks traded and Exchange shall take over the
thus, the integrity of the exchange operation of the insolvent member
overseeing these transactions can never firm and immediately proceed to
be over emphasized. It is for this reason settle the member firms liabilities to
that the SRC provides for stricter rules its customers.
on exchange regulation. The SRC
devotes a whole chapter on exchanges Registration of an Exchange shall be granted
and other securities trading markets, upon compliance with the following
and it is replete with provisions designed provisions:
to professionalize the exchange,
encourage greater public participation, (a) That the applicant is organized as a
ensure increased transparency, greater stock corporation;
responsibility and improve corporate (b) That the applicant is engaged solely in
governance. These provisions are not the business of operating an
found in the Corporation Code and are exchange: Provided, however, That
meant as additional legal requirements the Commission may, upon
applicable only to exchanges. application, exempti an Exchange
organized as a stock corporation and
It is thus incorrect to argue that the owned and controlled by another
provisions of the Corporation Code alone juridical person from this restriction;
govern the operation of exchanges. (c) Where the Exchange is organized as a
While the Corporation Code applies to stock corporation, that no person
corporations in general, the SRC is a may beneficially own or control,
special law that primarily governs the directly or indirectly, more than 5%
regulation of exchanges. As between a of the voting rights of the Exchange
specific statute and a general statute, and no industry or business group
the former must prevail since it evinces may beneficially own or control
the legislative intent more clearly than a more than 20% of the voting rights
general statute does. of the Exchange: Provided,
however, That the Commission may
Thus the SEC has the power of adopt rules, regulations or issue an
supervision over exchanges. order, upon application, exempting
Supervision entails overseeing or the an applicant from this prohibition
power or authority to see that where it finds that such ownership
subordinate subject performs its duties. or control will not negatively impact
If the latter fails or neglects to fulfill on the exchanges ability to
them the former may take such action or effectively operate in the public
step as prescribed by law to make them interest;
perform its duties. In this specific (d) The expulsion, suspension, or
instance, the SEC can even take over disciplining of a member and
the management of the exchange as persons associated with a member
authorized by the SRC. for conduct or proceeding
inconsistent with just and equitable
11.2 Registration Procedure (Sec. 33) principles of fair trade, and for
violations of provisions of this Code
Any Exchange may be registered as such or the rules of the Exchange;
with the Commission by filing an (e) A fair procedure for the disciplining of
application for registration in such form members and persons associated
and containing such information and with members, the denial of
supporting documents as the membership to any person seeking
Commission by rule shall prescribe, to be a member, the barring of any
including the following: person from association with a
member, and the prohibition or
(a) An undertaking to comply and limitation of any person from access
enforce compliance by its to services offered by the Exchange;
members with the provisions of (f) That the brokers in the board of the
this Code, its implementing rules Exchange shall comprise of not
or regulations and the rules of the more than 49% of such board and
Exchange; shall proportionately represent the
(b) The organizational charts of the Exchange membership in terms of
Exchange, rules of procedure, and volume/value of trade and paid up
a list of its officers and members; capital, and that any natural person
associated with a juridical entity

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 83 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

that is a member shall himself be 11.3 Segregation and Limitation of Functions


deemed to be a member for this of Members, Brokers and Dealers (Sec. 34)
purpose;
(g) For the board of the Exchange to It shall be unlawful for any member-
include in its composition broker of an Exchange to effect any
(i) the president of the Exchange, transaction on such Exchange for:
and
(ii) no less than 51% of the
remaining members of the board its own account,
to be comprised of 3 independent the account of an associated person,
directors and persons who or
represent the interests of issuers, an account with respect to which it or
investors, and other market an associated person thereof exercises
participants, who are not investment discretion
associated with any broker or
dealer or member of the Exchange Provided, however, That this section shall not
for a period of 2 years prior to make unlawful
his/her appointment.
(a) Any transaction by a member-broker
No officer or employee of a acting in the capacity of a market
member, its subsidiaries or maker;
affiliates or related interests shall (b) Any transaction reasonably necessary
become an independent director: to carry on an odd-lot transactions;
Provided, however, That the (c) Any transaction to offset a transaction
Commission may by rule, made in error; and
regulation, or order upon (d) Any other transaction of a similar
application, permit the exchange nature as may be defined by the
organized as a stock corporation to Commission.
use a different governance
structure: Sec Opinion #11 (2003)
The above-quoted Sec. 33.2. of the SRC is not
Provided, further, That the found in the old Revised Securities Act, nor in
Commission is satisfied that the the Corporation Code. Items (c), (f) and (g)
Exchange is acting in the public thereof are all intended to encourage greater
interest and is able to effectively public participation, ensure increased
operate as a self-regulatory transparency, greater responsibility and
organization under this Code. improve corporate governance.

(h) The president and other Subsection (c) mandates that the ownership
management of the Exchange to of the stocks of the exchange be broadened
consist only of persons who are and democratized, thereby ensuring greater
not members and are not public participation.
associated in any capacity, directly
or indirectly with any broker or On the other hand, Subsections (f) and (g)
dealer or member or listed mandate a board composition where no more
company of the Exchange: than 49% of the seats shall be occupied by
Provided, That the Exchange may brokers, and no less than 51% to be
only appoint, and a person may comprised of (3) independent directors and
only serve, as an officer of the persons representing other sectors of the
exchange if such person has not market. With respect to independent
been a member or affiliated with directors, their election in the Board is
any broker, dealer, or member of intended to ensure that the Board will
the Exchange for a period of at faithfully discharge its fiduciary responsibilities
least 2 years prior to such to its stockholders.
appointment;
(i) The transparency of transactions on These provisions aim for a more
the Exchange; representative, democratic, independent
(j) The equitable allocation of Board of Directors that is autonomous from
reasonable dues, fees, and other the control of any sector of the market.
charges among members and
issuers and other persons using
any facility or system which the 12. Independent Directors
Exchange operates or controls;
(k) Prevention of fraudulent and
Any corporation with
manipulative acts and practices,
promotion of just and equitable
a class of equity securities listed for
principles of trade, and, in general,
trading on an Exchange or
protection of investors and the
with assets in excess of P50,000,000.00
public interest; and
and having 200 or more holders, at least
(l) The transparent, prompt and
of 200 of which are holding at least 100
accurate clearance and settlement
shares of a class of its equity securities or
of transactions effected on the
which has sold a class of equity securities
Exchange.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 84 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

to the public pursuant to an effective Corporation Code to the contrary,


registration statement provide that:

Shall have at least 2 independent directors Any registered broker or


or such independent directors shall dealer may become a member
constitute at least 20% of the members of of the association;
such board, whichever is the lesser. There exist a fair
representation of its members
An independent director shall mean a to serve on the Board of
person other than an officer or employee of Directors of the association and
the corporation, its parent or subsidiaries, or in the administration of its
any other individual having a relationship affairs, and that any natural
with the corporation, which would interfere person associated with a
with the exercise of independent judgment juridical entity that is a
in carrying out the responsibilities of a member shall himself be
director. deemed to be a member for
this purpose;
13. Self-Regulatory Organizations The Board of Directors of the
association includes in its
13.1 Scope / Definition (Sec. 39) composition: (a) The president
of the association and (b)
The Commission shall have the power to Persons who represent the
register as a self-regulatory organization interests of issuers and public
organizations whose operations are investors and are not
related to or connected with the associated with any broker or
securities market such as but not limited dealer or member of the
to association; that the president
and other management of the
associations of brokers and dealers, association not be a member or
transfer agents, associated with any broker,
custodians, dealer or member of the
fiscal and paying agents, association;
computer services, For the equitable allocation of
news disseminating services, reasonable dues, fees, and
proxy solicitors, other charges among members
and issuers and other persons
statistical agencies,
using any facility or system
securities rating agencies, and
which the association operates
securities information processors
or controls;
For the prevention of
Which are engaged in the business of:
fraudulent and manipulative
acts and practices, the
(a) Collecting, processing, or preparing
promotion of just and equitable
for distribution or publication, or
principles of trade, and the
assisting, participating in, or
protection of investors and the
coordinating the distribution or
public interest;
publication of, information with
That its members and persons
respect to transactions in or
associated with its members,
quotations for any security; or
be appropriately disciplined for
(b) Distributing or publishing on a
violation of any provision of
current and continuing basis,
this Code;
information with respect to such
That a fair procedure for the
transactions or quotations.
disciplining of members, and
the denial of membership to
13.2 Registration
any person seeking
membership therein, the
An association of brokers and dealers
barring of any person from
may be registered as a securities
becoming associated with a
association by filing with the Commission
member thereof, and the
an application for registration.
prohibition or limitation by the
association of any person with
Such association shall not be registered
respect to access to services
unless the Commission determines that:
offered by the association or a
member thereof.
(a) The association is so organized and
has the capacity to be able to carry
out the purposes of this Code and to
13.3 Denial of Membership / Employment
comply with, and to enforce
(Sec. 39.4)
compliance by its members and
persons associated with its members
(a) A registered securities association
with the provisions of this Code.
shall deny membership to any
(b) The rules of the association,
person who is not a registered
notwithstanding anything in the
broker or dealer.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 85 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

(b) A registered securities association 36 calendar months, but not more


may deny membership to, or than 75% of the current market
condition the membership of, a price.
registered broker or dealer if such
broker or dealer: 14.2 Prohibited Credit Arrangements (Sec.
Does not meet the 48.2)
standards of financial
responsibility, operational No member of an Exchange or broker or
capability, training, dealer shall, directly or indirectly, extend
experience, or competence or maintain credit or arrange for the
that are prescribed by the extension or maintenance of credit to or
rules of the association; or for any customer:
Has engaged, and there is
a reasonable likelihood it (a) On any security unless such credit is
will again engage, in acts or extended and maintained in
practices inconsistent with accordance with the rules and
just and equitable principles regulations which the Commission
of fair trade. shall prescribe;
(c) A registered securities association (b) Without collateral or on any collateral
may deny membership to a other than securities, except
registered broker or dealer not to maintain a credit initially
engaged in a type of business in extended in conformity with
which the rules of the association the rules and regulations of the
require members to be engaged: Commission; and
Provided, however, That no in cases where the extension
registered securities association or maintenance of credit is not
may deny membership to a for the purpose of purchasing
registered broker or dealer by or carrying securities or of
reason of the amount of business evading or circumventing the
done by the broker or dealer. provisions of par (a) of this
(d) A registered securities association subsection.
may bar a salesman or person
associated with a broker or dealer 14.3 Restrictions on Borrowings by
from being employed by a member Members, Brokers, and Dealers (Sec. 49)
or set conditions for the
employment of a salesman or It shall be unlawful for any registered
associated if such person: broker or dealer, or member of an
Does not meet the Exchange, directly or indirectly:
standards of training,
experience, or competence To permit in the ordinary course of
that are prescribed by the business his aggregate indebtedness
rules of the association; or including customers credit balances,
Has engaged, and there is to exceed such percentage of the net
a reasonable likelihood he capital (exclusive of fixed assets and
will again engage, in acts or value of Exchange membership)
practices inconsistent with employed in the business, but not
just and equitable principles exceeding in any case 2,000%, as the
of fair trade. Commission may prescribe.
To pledge, mortgage, or otherwise
encumber any security carried for the
14 Margin Trading account of any customer under
circumstances:
14.1 Margin Requirements (Sec. 48) o That will permit the
commingling of his securities,
For the purpose of preventing the without his written consent, with
excessive use of credit for the purchase the securities of any customer;
or carrying of securities, the o That will permit such
Commission, shall prescribe rules and securities to be commingled with
regulations with respect to the amount the securities of any person other
of credit that may be extended on any than a bona fide customer; or
security. o That will permit such
securities to be pledged,
For the extension of credit, such rules mortgaged or encumbered, or
and regulations shall be based upon the subjected to any lien or claim of
following standard: the pledgee, for a sum in excess
of the aggregate indebtedness of
An amount not greater than whichever is such customers in respect of such
the higher of securities.
To lend or arrange for the lending of
(a) 65% of the current market price of any security carried for the account of
the security; or any customer without the written
(b) 100%)of the lowest market price of consent of such customer or in
the security during the preceding contravention of such rules and

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 86 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

regulations as the Commission shall (e) Any person has refused to permit any
prescribe. lawful examinations into its affairs,

14.4 Enforcement of Margin Requirements The imposition of administrative sanctions


and Restrictions on Borrowing (Sec. 50) shall be without prejudice to the filing of
criminal charges.
To prevent indirect violations of the
margin requirements, the broker or 15.2 Settlement Offers (Sec. 55)
dealer shall require the customer in non-
margin transactions to pay the price of At any time, during an investigation or
the security within such period as the proceeding under this Code, parties being
Commission may prescribe, which shall investigated and/or charged may propose
in no case exceed the prescribed in writing an offer of settlement with the
settlement date. Commission.

Otherwise, the broker shall sell the The Commission may consider the offer
security purchased starting on the next based on timing, the nature of the
trading day but not beyond 10 trading investigation or proceeding, and the public
days following the last day for the interest.
customer to pay such purchase price,
unless such sale cannot be effected The Commission may only agree to a
within said period for justifiable reasons. settlement offer based on its findings that
such settlement is in the public interest.
The sale shall be without prejudice to Any agreement to settle shall have no
the right of the broker or dealer to legal effect until publicly disclosed. Such
recover any deficiency from the decision may be made without a
customer. To prevent indirect violation determination of guilt on the part of the
of restrictions on borrowings under person making the offer.
Section 49, the broker shall, unless
otherwise directed by the customer, pay 16. Civil Liabilities (Sec. 56)
the net sales price of the securities sold
for a customer within the same period as 16.1 On Account of False Registration
above prescribed by the Commission Statement

Provided, That the customer shall be


required to deliver the instruments
evidencing the securities as a condition Who may sue?
for such payment upon demand by the
broker.
Any person
acquiring a security, the registration
15. Administrative Sanctions and
statement of which or any part thereof
Settlement Offers
contains on its effectivity an untrue
statement of a material fact or omits to
15.1 Administrative Sanctions (Sec. 54)
state a material fact required to be
stated therein or necessary to make
If, after due notice and hearing, the
such statements not misleading, and
Commission finds that:
who suffers damage
(a) There is a violation of this Code, its
If the person who acquired the security
rules, or its orders;
did so after the issuer has made generally
(b) Any registered broker or dealer,
available to its security holders an income
associated person thereof has
statement covering a period of at least 12
failed reasonably to supervise
months, then the right of recovery shall
another person subject to
be conditioned on proof that such person
supervision, who commits any
acquired the security relying upon such
such violation;
untrue statement.
(c) Any registrant or other person has,
in a registration statement or in
other reports, applications,
accounts, records or documents Who may be sued?
made any untrue statement of a (a) The issuer and every person who
material fact, or omitted to state signed the registration statement;
any material fact required to be (b) Every person who was a director or a
stated therein or necessary to partner in the issuer at the time of
make the statements therein not the filing of the registration
misleading; statement or any part, supplement
(d) or, in the case of an underwriter, has or amendment thereof;
failed to conduct an inquiry with (c) Every person who is named in the
reasonable diligence to insure that registration statement as being or
a registration statement is about to become a director or a
accurate and complete in all partner;
material respects; or (d) Every auditor or auditing firm named
as having certified any financial
statements used in connection with

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 87 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

the registration statement or communications, reports) more than 5 years


prospectus. after the sale.
(e) Every person who, with his written
consent has been named as having No action shall be maintained to enforce any
prepared or certified any part of liability created under any other provision of
the registration statement, or as this Code unless brought:
having prepared or certified any
report or valuation which is used in within 2 years after the
connection with the registration discovery of the facts constituting
statement. the cause of action and
(f) Every selling shareholder who within 5 years after such cause
contributed to and certified as to of action accrued.
the accuracy of a portion of the
registration statement. 18. Damages to be Awarded (Sec.
(g) Every underwriter with respect to 63)
such security.
18.1 Amounts / Kinds of Damages
Possible Defense :
All suits to recover damages pursuant to
Such person may allege that at the time
Sections 56 (false registration statement),
of such acquisition he knew of no such
57 (false prospectus, communications,
untrue statement or omission:
reports), 58 (fraud in connection with
securities transactions), 59 (manipulation
16.2 On Account of Insider Trading (Sec.
of prices), 60 (commodity futures
61)
contracts and pre-need plans) and 61
(insider trading) shall be brought before
Who may be sued?
the RTC, which shall have exclusive
jurisdiction to hear and decide such suits.
Any insider who violates Subsection 27.1
and any person in the case of a tender
The Court is hereby authorized to award
offer who violates Subsection 27.4 (a)
damages in an amount not exceeding
(i), or any rule or regulation thereunder,
triple the amount of the transaction plus
by purchasing or selling a security while
actual damages.
in possession of material information not
generally available to the public, shall be
Exemplary damages may also be awarded
liable in a suit brought by any investor
in cases of bad faith, fraud, malevolence
who, contemporaneously with the
or wantonness in the violation of this
purchase or sale of securities that is the
Code, and rules and regulations
subject of the violation, purchased or
promulgated hereunder.
sold securities of the same class unless
such insider, or such person in the case
The Court is also authorized to award
of a tender offer, proves that such
attorneys fees not exceeding 30% of the
investor knew the information or would
award.
have purchased or sold at the same
price regardless of disclosure of the
18.2 Persons liable to pay
information to him.
An insider who communicates material
The persons specified in Sections 56, 57,
non-public information, shall be jointly
58, 59, 60 and 61 hereof shall be jointly
and severally liable with and to the same
and severally liable fo he payment of
extent as, the insider, or person in the
damages. However, any person who
case of a tender offer.
becomes liable for the payment of such
damages may recover contribution from
17. Limitation of Actions (Sec. 62) any other person who, if sued separately,
would have been liable to make the same
No action shall be maintained to enforce any payment, unless the former was guilty of
liability created under Section 56 (false fraudulent representation and the latter
registration statement) or 57 (false was not.
prospectus. Communications, reports)
unless brought within 2 years after the All persons, including the issuer, held
discovery of the untrue statement or the liable under the provisions of Sections 56,
omission. 57, 58, 59, 60 and 61 shall contribute
equally to the total liability adjudged
If the action is to enforce a liability created herein.
under Subsection 57.1(a) (registration of
securities), unless brought within 2 years In no case shall the principal stockholders,
after the violation upon which it is based. directors and other officers, recover their
contribution to the liability from the
In no event shall any such action be brought issuer. However, the right of the issuer to
to enforce a liability created under Section recover from the guilty parties the amount
56 or Subsection 57.1 (a) more than 5 years it has contributed shall not be prejudiced.
after the security was bona fide offered to
the public, or under Subsection 57.1 (b)
(sale based on false prospectus, 19. Non-waiver of Provisions

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 88 of 355


CORPORATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Any condition, stipulation, provision binding


any person to waive compliance with any
provision of this Code or of any rule of an
Exchange as well as the waiver itself, shal be
void.

20. Penalties

Any person who violates any of the


provisions of this Code or any person who, in
a registration statement makes any untrue
statement of a material fact or omits to state
any material fact required to be stated
therein or necessary to make the statements
therein not misleading, shall, upon
conviction, suffer

a fine of not less than P50,000.00


nor more than P5,000,000.00 or
imprisonment of not less than 7
years nor more than 21 years, or
both in the discretion of the court.

If the offender is a corporation, partnership


or association or other juridical entity, the
penalty may be imposed upon such juridical
entity and upon the officer or officers of the
corporation, partnership, association or
entity responsible for the violation. If such
officer is an alien, he shall in addition to the
penalties prescribed, be deported.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 89 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

haphazardly or lightly. Nor should it be brushed


aside in order to meet the necessities in a single
Negotiable Instruments Law case
3. Life of a Negotiable Instrument
(Act No. 2031)
1. issue
2. negotiation
Chapter I. 3. presentment for acceptance in certain bills
INTRODUCTION 4. acceptance
5. dishonor by or acceptance
6. presentment for payment
1. The Negotiable Instrument 7. dishonor by nonpayment
8. notice of dishonor
9. protest in certain cases
Written contract for the payment of 10. discharge
money, by its form intended as substitute for
money and intended to pass from hand to hand
to give the HDC the right to hold the same and
collect the sum due. 4. Kinds of Negotiable Instruments
Instruments are negotiable when they conform
to all the requirements prescribed by the NIL 4.1. Promissory note - a promise to pay money
(Act 2031, 03 February 1911). unconditional promise in writing made by
Although considered as medium for payment of one person to another signed by the maker
obligations, negotiable instruments are not engaging to pay on demand, or at a fixed
legal tender (Sec. 60, New Central Bank Act, or determinable future time a sum certain
R.A. 7653); in money to order or to bearer
Negotiable instruments shall produce the effect where a note is drawn to the makers own
of payment only when they have been order, not complete until indorsed by him
encashed or when through the fault of the (Sec. 184, NIL).
creditor they have been impaired. (Art. 1249,
CC) BUT a CHECK which has been cleared and 4.2. Bill of exchange - an order made by one
credited to the account of the creditor shall be person to another to pay money to a third person.
equivalent to a delivery to the creditor of cash. unconditional order in writing addressed by
one person to another signed by the
Negotiable Non-negotiable person giving it
Contains all the Does not contain all requiring the person to whom it is
requisites of Sec. 1 the requisites of Sec. addressed to pay on demand or at a fixed
of the NIL 1 of the NIL or determinable future time a sum certain
Transferred by Transferred by in money to order or to bearer (Sec. 126,
negotiation assignment NIL).
Check: bill of exchange drawn on a
HDC may have Transferee acquires
better rights than rights only of his bank payable on demand.
transferor transferor
Prior parties Prior parties merely Promissory Note Bill of Exchange
warrant payment warrant legality of
title Unconditional Unconditional order
Transferee has Transferee has no promise
right of recourse right of recourse Involves 2 parties Involves 3 parties
against Maker primarily Drawer only
intermediate liable secondarily liable
parties Only 1 presentment Generally 2
- for payment presentments - for
acceptance and for
2. Negotiable Instruments Law payment

o The NIL applies only to instruments which


conform with the requisites laid down by Sec1 5. Parties
of the law. Should any of said requisites be
absent, the instrument would not be negotiable 5.1. As regards promissory note:
and would therefore not be governed by the 1. Promissor/maker
NIL but by the general law on contracts. 2. Payee - person to whom the promise to pay
o TIP: It is advised that one memorizes the two is made.
most important provisions of the NIL : Sec. 1
(Forms of negotiable instruments) and Sec. 52 5.2. As regards bill of exchange:
(What constitutes a holder in due course) 1. Drawer - person who gives the order to
pay.
MICHAEL A. OSMEA v. CITIBANK (2004) 2. Drawee - addressee of the order.
3. Payee - person to whom the payment is to
The Negotiable Instruments Law was enacted for be made.
the purpose of facilitating, not hindering or
hampering transactions in commercial paper.
Thus, the said statute should not be tampered with

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 90 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Indorser - the payee of an instrument who UNCONDITIONAL: Mere


transfers it to another by signing it at the back indication of the particular fund
thereof out of which reimbursement is
Indorsee - person to whom the indorser to be made, or an indication of
negotiates the instrument, who, by such a particular account to be
negotiation, becomes the holder of the debited with the amount
instrument. A statement of the transaction which
gives rise to the instrument.
UNCONDITIONAL: Mere
Chapter II.
recital of the transaction or
NEGOTIABILITY consideration for which the
instrument was issued
1 Requisites of Negotiability4 However, the fact that the
condition appearing on the
1.1. Must be in Writing and Signed by the instrument has been fulfilled
Maker will not convert it into a
1. No person liable on the instrument whose negotiable one.
signature does not appear thereon. But an order or promise to pay out of a
2. One who signs in a trade or assumed particular fund is not unconditional
name liable to same extent as if he had CONDITIONAL: when
signed in his own name. (Sec. 18, NIL) reference to the fund clearly
3. Signature of party may be made by duly indicates an intention that such
authorized agent; no particular form of fund alone should be the source
appointment necessary. (Sec. 19, NIL) of payment
4. "In writing" - includes print; written or
typed METROPOLITAN BANK v. CA (1991)
5. Signature, binding so long it is intended or
adopted as the signature of the signer or The treasury warrants in question are not NIs.
made with his authority. They are payable from a particular fund, to wit,
Fund 501. The indication of Fund 501 as the source
1.2. Must contain an Unconditional Order or of the payment to be made on the treasury
Promise to Pay warrants makes the order or promise to pay "not
unconditional" and the warrants themselves non-
1. ORDER OR PROMISE TO PAY negotiable.
a. PROMISSORY NOTE:
i. PROMISE TO PAY: should be 1.3. Sum Payable must be Certain
express on the face of the 1. Sec. 2, NIL: The sum payable is a sum
instrument certain, even if:
ii. Word "promise" is not absolutely a. With interest;
necessary. Any expression b. By stated installments;
equivalent to a promise is c. By stated installments with acceleration
sufficient. clause;
iii. Mere acknowledgment of a debt d. With exchange, whether at a fixed rate
insufficient or at the current rate; or
b. BILLS OF EXCHANGE: e. With costs of collection or attorney's
i. Order - command or imperative fee.
direction; the instrument, by its 2. A sum is certain if from the face of the
nature, demanding a right. instrument it can be mathematically
ii. Words which are equivalent to an computed.
order are sufficient. 3. A stipulation to pay a higher rate of interest
iii. A mere request or authority to if the note is not paid or a lower rate if it is
pay does not constitute an order. paid on or before maturity does not render
iv. Although the mere use of polite the instrument non-negotiable.
words like "please" does not of
itself deprive the instrument of its 1.4. Must be Payable in Money
characteristics as an order, its 1. Capable of being
language must clearly indicate a transformed into money.
demand upon the drawee to pay. 2. NON NEGOTIABLE: an
instrument which contains an order or
2. UNCONDITIONAL promise to do an act in addition to the
a. The promise or order to pay, to be payment of money
unconditional, must be unqualified. 3. BUT If the order or
b. Sec. 3, NIL: An unqualified order or promise gives the holder an election to
promise to pay is unconditionalthough require something to be done in lieu of
coupled with: payment of money, an instrument
An indication of a particular fund out otherwise negotiable would not be affected
of which reimbursement is to be thereby. (Sec. 5, NIL)
made, or a particular account to be But if the option is with the maker
debited with the amount
or person primarily liable,
4
Suggested Mnemonics: UP MaSCoTS PaWN: instrument is NOT negotiable.
4. Kind of current money
Unconditional order and Promise, payable in Money,
does not affect negotiability. Since the
Signed by maker, Certainty as to Time, Sum and
value of the note can by a simple
Parties, in Writing, include words of Negotiability.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 91 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

mathematical computation be expressed in If option


the value of the lawful money of the latter can be exercised only after the
country (Incitti v Ferrante, 1933, US Jur) happening of a specified event/act
5. Obligations in foreign over which he has no control
currency may be discharged in Philippine (conditional), still NEGOTIABLE.
currency based on the prevailing rate at the If option is
time of payment, pursuant to RA 8183 unconditional, time of payment is
(Asia World Recruitment v NLRC, 1999). rendered uncertain, NOT
negotiable.
1.5. Time of Payment must be Certain o Other instances where instrument still
Purpose: Informing the holder of NEGOTIABLE:
the instrument of the date when he may When
enforce payment thereof. option given to the holder to
An instrument may be payable: accelerate the maturity of an
installment note upon failure of the
1. on demand (Sec. 7. NIL) maker to pay any installment when
1.) Expressed to be payable on demand, or due.
at sight, or on presentation; Acceleration
2.) No time for payment is expressed; , automatic upon default.
3.) Where an instrument is issued, Acceleration
accepted, or indorsed when overdue, it by operation of law.
is, as regards the person so issuing,
accepting, or indorsing it, payable on
5. Provisions extending time of payment
demand.
o General rule: Negotiability not
Demand instruments: Holder may call affected. Effect is similar with that of an
for payment any time; maker has an option acceleration clause at the option of the
to pay at any time, and the refusal of the maker.
holder to accept payment will terminate the Negotiability not affected,
running of interest, if any, but the even if the holder is given the
obligation to pay the note remains. option to extend time of payment
by mere inaction or indulgence
2. at a fixed time for an indefinite time depending on
o Only on the stipulated date, and not his will, because with or without
this provision, the holder may
before, may the holder demand its
always choose to be indulgent.
payment.
o Exception: Where a note with a fixed
o Should he fail to demand payment, the
maturity provides that the maker has
instrument becomes overdue but
the option to extend time of payment
remains valid and negotiable. It is
until the happening of contingency,
merely converted to a demand
instrument NOT negotiable. The time
instrument.
for payment may never come at all.
3. at a determinable future time
1.6. Must be Payable to Order or to Bearer/
Must contain Words of Negotiability
o Determinable future time, if
words of negotiability - serve as an
expressed to be payable (Sec. 4, NIL):
expression of consent that the
instrument may be transferred.
1.) At a fixed period after date of sight;
o But the instrument need not follow
2.) On or before a fixed or
determinable future time specified the language of the law; any term
therein; which clearly indicates an intention
3.) On or at a fixed period after the to conform with the legal
occurrence of a specified event requirements is sufficient.
which is certain to happen, though
the time of happening be uncertain. CALTEX V. CA (1992)

o If payable upon a contingency, both The negotiability or non-negotiability of an


negotiable, and the happening of the instrument is determined from the face of the
event does not cure the defect. instrument itself. The duty of the court in such
case is to ascertain, not what the parties may have
4. Effect of acceleration provisions secretly intended but what is the meaning of the
o If option (absolute or conditional) to words they have used.
accelerate maturity is on the maker,
still NEGOTIABLE. TRADERS ROYAL BANK V. CA (1997)
Maker may pay earlier than the The language of negotiability which characterize a
date fixed but this option, if negotiable paper as a credit instrument is its
exercised, would be a payment in freedom to circulate as a substitute for money.
advance of a legal liability to pay. Hence, freedom of negotiability is the touchtone
It is still payable on the date fixed, relating to the protection of holders in due course,
and holder has no right to and the freedom of negotiability is the foundation
enforce payment against the for the protection which the law throws around a
maker before such date. holder in due course.
o If option to accelerate is on the holder:

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 92 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Postal money order, not negotiable,


because it does not contain words of
negotiability.
Where words "or bearer" printed on a 2 Provisions Not Affecting Negotiability,
check are cancelled by the drawer, (Sec. 5)5
instrument not negotiable.
Bearer instrument may be negotiated by 1. Authorizes sale of collateral securities;
mere delivery. 2. Authorizes confession of judgment if instrument
o When instrument is payable to bearer not paid at maturity;
(Sec. 9, NIL): 3. Waives the benefit of any law intended for the
a. Expressed to be so payable - ex: "I advantage or protection of the obligor; or
promise to pay the bearer the 4. Gives holder election to require something to
sum." be done in lieu of payment of money. (if in
b. Payable to a person named therein addition to money not NI)
or bearer ex. "Pay to A or Negotiability affected, when instrument
bearer." contains a promise or order to do any
c. Payable to the order of a fictitious act in addition to the payment of
person or non-existing person, and money.
such fact was known to the person
making it so payable - ex: "Pay to
John Doe or order." PNB v. MANILA OIL REFINING (1922)
d. Name of payee does not purport to
be the name of any person - ex:
"Pay to cash;" "Pay to sundries." In this case, the note contains a provision that in
e. Only or last indorsement is an case that it would not be paid at maturity, the
indorsement in blank. "maker authorizes any attorney to appear and
confess judgment thereon."
ANG TEK LIAN v. CA (1950) The Court ruled that said judgment note is illegal
and inoperative as such is against public policy. It
noted that it is in derogation of the constitutional
A check drawn payable to the order of cash is safeguards (a day in court). Such judgment note
a check payable to bearer, and the bank may can only be valid if given express legislative
pay it to the person presenting it for payment sanction.
without the drawer's indorsement.
In common law, two kinds of judgment by
A check payable to bearer is authority for confession:
payment to the holder. Where the check is in Judgment by cognovit actionem
the ordinary form and is payable to bearer, Confession relicta verificatione
so that no indorsement is required, a bank,
to which it is presented for payment, need
3. Omissions Not Affecting Negotiability
not have the holder identified, and is not (Sec. 6)
negligent in failing to do so.

Order Instrument, negotiation requires A. Non-dating of the instrument


delivery and indorsement of the transferor. B. Non-specification of value given, or that any
o When instrument is payable to order: value had been given
C. Non-specification of place where it is drawn or
Drawn payable to the order of a
place where it is payable
specified person or to him or his order
D. Bears a seal
(Sec. 8, NIL).
E. Designation of particular kind of currency in
o Without the words "to order" or "to the
which payment is to be made
order of," the instrument is payable
only to the person designated therein
4. Rules of Construction (Sec.17)
and is therefore non-negotiable.
(Campos, as cited in Consolidated
Plywood Industries v IFC Leasing, A. Sum expressed in words takes precedence over
1987) sum in numbers; BUT where words are so
ambiguous or uncertain, reference to the
1.7. Parties must be designated with Certainty figures should be made
a. Maker and drawer B. Where interest is stipulated, without
Sign the instrument at the lower specification of the starting date, the interest
right-hand corner. runs from the date of the instrument, and if
b. Payee undated, from the issue thereof
When negotiating, sign at the back; C. An undated instrument is considered dated as
same with indorsers. of time issued.
a. Drawee D. Written provisions prevail over printed
Name usually at the lower left-hand provisions
corner, or across the top. E. Where the instrument is ambiguous as to
If instrument addressed to drawee, whether it is a note or a bill, the holder may
treat it as either at his election
he must be named or indicated with
reasonable certainty.
If it is not clear in what capacity the person 5
Suggested Mnemonic: WEJy S: Waives, gives
signed, said person is considered an holder Election, confession of Judgment, Sale of
indorser Securities

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 93 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

F. When the capacity of signatory is not clear, he 2. Negotiation


is to be deemed an indorser
G. I promise to pay when signed by two or more
When an instrument is transferred from one
persons is deemed to be jointly and severally
person to another as to constitute the
signed
transferee the holder thereof.
EVANGELISTA V. MERCATOR FINANCE (2003) If payable to BEARER, negotiated by delivery; if
payable to ORDER, negotiated by indorsement
Where two promissory notes, both employing the of holder + delivery (Sec.30, NIL)
terms I promise to pay, were each signed by two
or more persons, a solidary (joint and several) SESBREO v. CA (1993)
liability on each note is created on the part of the
signors. A NI may, instead of being negotiated, ALSO be
assigned or transferred. A non-NI may not be
negotiated; but it may be assigned or
Chapter III. transferred, absent an express prohibition
against assignment or transfer written in the face
TRANSFER
of the instrument.
1. Delivery and Issuance
3. Indorsement
A. Delivery means transfer of possession of
instrument by the maker or drawer, with
intent to transfer title to the payee and The indorsement must be written on the
recognize him as holder thereof. (de la instrument itself or on a paper attached thereto
Victoria v. Burgos) (allonge). The signature of the indorser,
B. NI incomplete and revocable until delivery for without additional words, is sufficient
the purpose of giving effect thereto as indorsement. (Sec.31, NIL)
between (Sec. 16, NIL): Indorser generally enters into two contracts
1. immediate parties (Implied contracts by Indorser):
2. a remote party other than holder in due 1. sale or transfer of instrument
course 2. to pay instrument in case of default of
C. delivery, to be effectual, must be made by or maker
under the authority of the party making / Indorsement must be of entire instrument
drawing / accepting/indorsing (cant be indorsement of only part of amount
D. delivery may be shown to have been payable, nor can it be to two or more indorsees
conditional, or for a special purpose only, and severally. But okay to indorse residue of
not for the purpose of transferring the property partially paid instrument) (Sec. 32, NIL)
in the instrument
E. PRESUMPTION OF DELIVERY
1. Where the instrument is no longer in the
possession of a party whose signature
3.1. Kinds of Indorsements (Sec. 33)
appears thereon, a valid and intentional
delivery by him is presumed until the
contrary is proved 1. as to manner of future method of
2. if it is in the hands of a HDC, the negotiation(Sec. 35, NIL):
presumption is conclusive
3. Camposes: Should an undelivered a. special specifies the person to whom/to
instrument come into the hands of a holder whose order the instrument is to be
in due course, the maker is liable to him payable; indorsement of such indorsee is
regardless of any proof of the lack of valid necessary to further negotiation.
delivery. A special indorser is liable to all
F. PRESUMPTION AS TO DATE
subsequent holders, unless the
1. Date is not an essential element of
instrument is an originally bearer
negotiability
instrument, in which case he is liable
2. An undated instrument is considered to be
only to those who take title through his
dated as of the time it was issued
indorsement (Sec 40, NIL)
b. blank specifies no indorsee, instrument
so indorsed is payable to bearer, and may
be negotiated by delivery
GEMPESAW v CA (1993)
a person who negotiates by mere
delivery is liable only to his immediate
Every contract on a negotiable instrument is
transferee.
incomplete and revocable until delivery of the
instrument to the payee for the purpose of giving the holder may convert a blank
effect thereto. The first delivery of the instrument, indorsement into a special indorsement
complete in form, to the payee who takes it as a by writing over the signature of the
holder, is called issuance of the instrument. indorser in blank any contract
Without the initial delivery of the instrument from consistent with the character of the
the drawer of the check to the payee, there can be indorsement
no valid and binding contract and no liability on the An order instrument may be converted into
instrument. a bearer instrument by means of a blank
indorsement.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 94 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

But a bearer instrument remains as such may disregard the condition, and make
whether it has been indorsed specially or in payment to the indorsee or his
blank. It is the liability of the indorser transferee, whether condition has been
which is affected. fulfilled or not
o Any person to whom an instrument so
indorsed is negotiated will hold the
2. as to kind of title transferred: same/proceeds subject to rights of
person indorsing conditionally
a. restrictive such indorsement either:
1) prohibits further negotiation of b. unconditional
instrument,
o In this kind of restrictive
indorsement, the prohibition to 5. other classifications:
transfer or negotiate must be
written in express words at the a. Absolute One by which the indorser binds
back of the instrument, so that himself to pay, upon no other condition
any subsequent party may be than the failure of prior parties to do so,
forewarned that ceases to be and of due notice to him of such failure
negotiable. However, the restrictive b. Joint - Where instrument payable to the
indorsee acquires the right to receive order of two or more payees or indorsees
payment and bring any action not partners, all must indorse, unless the
thereon as any indorser, but he can one indorsing has authority to endorse for
no longer transfer his rights as such the others (Sec. 41, NIL)
indorsee where the form of the c. Irregular - Where a person, not otherwise a
indorsement does not authorize him party to the instrument, places thereon his
to do so. (Gempesaw v CA 1993) signature in blank before delivery, he is
liable as indorser

2) constitutes indorsee as agent of


indorser, or 3.2. Other Rules on Indorsement
3) vests title in indorsee in trust for
another
o rights of indorsee in restrictive 1. Indorsement by Collecting Bank - holder
deposits check with a bank other than the
ind.:
drawee, would in effect be negotiating the
a) receive payment of inst.
check to such bank, since he would have to
b) Bring any action thereon
indorse the check before the bank will accept it
that indorser could bring
for deposit. In most cases, the bank is acting
c) Transfer his rights as such
as a mere collecting agent.
indorsee, but all
subsequent indorsees
2. Negotiation by Joint or Alternative Payees
acquire only title of first
or Indorsees - all must indorse, unless the
indorsee under restrictive
one indorsing has authority to endorse for the
indorsement
others
b. non-restrictive
3. Unindorsed instruments Sec 49, NIL
3. as to kind of liability assumed by indorser Where holder of instrument transfers for value
a. qualified without indorsing, transfer vests in transferee:
constitutes indorser as mere assignor
of title (eg. without recourse) (Sec. a. such title as transferor had therein, subject
38, NIL). to defenses and equities available to prior
But this does not mean that the parties
transferee only has the rights of an o ex: transferee can sue the transferor,
assignee. Transfer remains a though he does not thereby
negotiation and transferee can still be a automatically become a HDC (Furbee
holder capable of acquiring a title free v. Furbee, 1936)
from defenses of prior parties. b. right to have indorsement of transferor,
It relieves the qualified indorser of his after which, he becomes a holder or
liability to pay the instrument should possibly a HDC
the maker be unable to pay at o For purposes of determining whether or
maturity. not the transferee becomes a HDC after
b. unqualified securing the transferors indorsement,
note that Sec. 52 must be met at the
time of the negotiation, i.e., when
4. as to presence/absence of express limitations indorsement is actually made.
put by indorser upon primary obligors
privileges of paying the holder: BPI vs CA (2007)

a. conditional additional condition annexed The transaction [in Sec. 49, NIL] is an equitable
to indorsers liability. (Sec. 39, NIL) assignment and the transferee acquires the
instrument subject to defenses and equities
available among prior parties. Thus, if the
o Where an indorsement is conditional, a transferor had legal title, the transferee acquires
party required to pay the instrument such title and, in addition, the right to have the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 95 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

indorsement of the transferor and also the right, as


holder of the legal title, to maintain legal action
against the maker or acceptor or other party liable
to the transferor. The underlying premise of this
provision, however, is that a valid transfer of
ownership of the negotiable instrument in question Chapter IV.
has taken place.
Transferees in this situation do not enjoy the HOLDER IN DUE COURSE
presumption of ownership in favor of holders since
they are neither payees nor indorsees of such
1. Holder (Sec. 191)
instruments Thus, something more than mere
possession by persons who are not payees or Definition: Payee or indorsee of a bill or
indorsers of the instrument is necessary to note who is in possession of it, or the
authorize payment to them in the absence of any bearer thereof.
other facts from which the authority to receive RIGHTS OF HOLDER (Sec. 51, NIL)
payment may be inferred. 1.
sue thereon in his own name
4. Cancellation of Indorsements - Holder may 2.
strike out indorsements not necessary to his payment to him in due course discharges
title. The endorser whose endorsement was instrument
struck out, and all endorsers subsequent to
him, are relieved from liability on the
instrument (Sec. 48, NIL) 2. Three Kinds of DUE COURSE Holding
a. HDC under Sec 52
5. Indorsement by Agent - agent should make
b. HDC under Sec 58 : A holder who derives
it plain that he is signing in behalf of a principal
title to the instrument through a HDC has
otherwise he may be made personally liable
all the rights of the latter even though he
(Sec 20, NIL)
himself satisfies none of the requirements
of due course holding (Campos & Campos)
o The Negotiable Instruments Law provides
c. HDC under Sec 59 (presumption): every
that where any person is under obligation
holder is deemed prima facie to be a holder
to indorse in a representative capacity, he
in due course
may indorse in such terms as to negative
personal liability. An agent, when so
signing, should indicate that he is merely 3. Requisites to become a holder in due
signing in behalf of the principal and must course (Sec.52)6
disclose the name of his principal;
otherwise he shall be held personally liable.
(FRANCISCO v CA, 1990)
SALAS v. CA (1990)
6. Presumption as to Indorsement
o Time (Sec.45, NIL) - Every negotiation
The indorsee was a HDC, having taken the
deemed prima facie effected before
instrument under the following conditions: (1) it is
instrument was overdue, except where
complete and regular upon its face; (2) it became
indorsement bears date after maturity of
the holder thereof before it was overdue; (3) it
the instrument.
took the same in good faith and for value; and (4)
o Place (Sec.46, NIL) - Every indorsement is
when it was negotiated to the indorsee, the latter
presumed prima facie made at place where had no notice of any infirmity in the instrument or
instrument is dated defect in the title of the previous indorser.
o Where instrument drawn or indorsed to
person as cashier (Sec.42, NIL) - deemed
prima facie to be payable to the bank or HDC is one who has taken the instrument under
corporation of which he is such officer; may the following conditions:
be negotiated by either the indorsement
(1) of the bank or corporation or (2) of the
officer.
3.1. That it is complete and regular upon its
face
7. Continuation of Negotiable Character - An
NI, although overdue, retains its negotiability 1. COMPLETE
unless it has been paid or restrictively indorsed o An instrument is complete if it contains
to prevent further negotiation (Sec. 47, NIL) all the requisites for making it a
negotiable one, even if it may have
8. Indorsement of bearer inst. blanks as to non-essentials.
o Where an instrument payable to bearer is o It is incomplete when it is wanting in
indorsed specially, it may nevertheless be any material particular or particular
further negotiated by delivery proper to be inserted in a NI without
o Person indorsing specially liable as indorser w/c the same will not be complete.
to only such holders as make title through
his indorsement 6
suggested mnemonics: GROIN: Good faith and
value, complete and Regular, not Overdue, no notice
of Infirmity at time of Negotiation; or GROCI: Good
faith and value, Regular, not Overdue, Complete, no
Infirmity,

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 96 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

2. Material Particulars the title thereto as of the date of delivery.


o What are material particulars? A (Sec.12, NIL)
change in the ff. is considered a
material alteration (Sec. 125, NIL):
3.3. That he took it in good faith AND for
i. The date;
value:
ii. The sum payable, either for
principal or interest; 1. HOLDER FOR VALUE - (a) Where value
iii. The time or place of payment; has at any time been given for the
iv. The number or the relations of the instrument, the holder is deemed a HFV in
parties; respect to all parties who become such
v. The medium or currency in which prior to that time (Sec.26, NIL) and (b)
payment is to be made; Where the holder has a lien on the
vi. Or which adds a place of payment instrument, he is deemed a HFV to the
where no place of payment is extent of his lien (Sec.27, NIL).
specified, a. PRESUMPTION Every NI is deemed
3. Rights of HDC of instrument that has been prima facie issued for valuable
materially altered consideration; and every person whose
o enforce payment thereof according to signature appears thereon to have
its original tenor IF not a party to the become a party thereto for value (Sec.
alteration. (Sec. 124, NIL) 24, NIL)
i. In actions based upon a negotiable
3.2. That he became the holder of it before it instrument, it is unnecessary to
was overdue and without notice that it had aver or prove consideration, for
been previously dishonored, if such was the consideration is imported and
fact presumed from the fact that it is a
negotiable instrument. The
1. OVERDUE
presumption exists whether the
a. The ff. cannot be HDCs: (Sec. 53,
words "value received" appear on
NIL)
the instrument or not (Ong v
i. A holder who became such after
People, 2000)
the date of maturity of the
instrument (instrument is
overdue); BAYANI VS. PEOPLE (2004)
ii. In case of demand instruments, a
holder who negotiates it after an
unreasonable length of time after Under Section 28 of the Negotiable Instruments
its issue Law (NIL), absence or failure of consideration is a
b. Instruments with fixed maturity but matter of defense only as against any person not a
subject to acceleration: ultimate date of holder in due course.
maturity is the date of maturity for the
purpose of determining whether a
purchaser is a HDC Moreover, Section 24 of the NIL provides the
c. Undated instruments: Prima facie presumption of consideration. Such presumption
presumption that it was negotiated cannot be overcome by the petitioners bare denial
before it was overdue (Sec 45) of receipt of the [consideration].
d. NOTE: An overdue instrument is still
negotiable, but it is subject to the 1) Only evidence of the clearest
defense existing at the time of the and most convincing kind will
transfer. suffice for that purpose.
(Travel-On Inc v CA, 1992)

2. DISHONOR
a. Non-acceptance b. VALUE - any consideration sufficient to
i. Occurs when drawee refuses to support a simple contract. An
accept the order of the drawer as antecedent or pre-existing debt
stated in the bill constitutes value, whether the
ii. Applicable only to bills of exchange instrument is payable on demand or at
iii. May occur before the date of a future time. (Sec.25, NIL)
maturity of the bill
b. Non-payment MERCHANTS NATIONAL BANK OF ST. PAUL v.
i. Occurs when the party primarily STA. MARIA SUGAR CO. (1914)
liable fails to pay at the date of
maturity
ii. Date of Maturity The mere discounting of the note and placing the
1) payable after sightdate of amount of said discount to the credit of the HFV
presentment would not then have constituted a transfer for
2) Payable on the occurrence of a value. But if the sum had subsequently been
specified eventdate is fixed checked out, then value would have passed. The
by happening of event general rule as to the application of payments,
3. An instrument is not invalid for the reason there being no special facts to interfere, is that the
only that it is ANTE-DATED OR POST- first payments apply to the oldest debts. The first
DATED provided not done for an illegal or debits are to be charged against the first credits. It
fraudulent purpose. The person to whom an follows therefore, upon the facts as found, that the
instrument so dated is delivered acquires bank was a bona fide HFV without notice, and, in
accordance with the stipulation, judgment should

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 97 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

be entered for the plaintiff upon the note. notwithstanding the


Judgment reversed. SUSPICIOUS
CIRCUMSTANCES, it
== acquired the check in
actual good faith. (De
Bank credit as value - When the holder of a check Ocampo & Co. v.
deposits it with his bank (assuming it is not the Gatchalian)
drawee bank) and the bank credits it to his o Purchase of an
account, is the bank at this stage a HFV? instrument at a
o Majority View first money in DISCOUNT does not,
is presumed to be the first of itself, constitute bad
money paid out faith. However, if the
o Minority View as long as instrument is pruchased
the balance in the depositors at a heavy discount,
account equals or exceeds the this fact together with
amount of the instrument other facts, may be
deposited, the latter cannot be taken into account in
considered as withdrawn for the deciding the issue of
purpose of treating the bank as purchase in good faith.
a HFV. (Ham v. Meritt)
o (So far, there has been no
decision by the SC on this
issue.)
2. GOOD FAITH VICENTE R. DE OCAMPO & CO. v.
a. Holder must have taken the instrument GATCHALIAN, ET. AL. (1961)
in good faith and that at the time it was
negotiated to him he had no notice of In order to show that the defendant had knowledge
any infirmity in the instrument or of such facts that his action in taking the
defect in the title of the person instrument amounted to bad faith, it is not
negotiating it. necessary to prove that the defendant knew the
b. NOT a Holder in GOOD FAITH exact fraud that was practiced upon the plaintiff by
i. Holder acted in bad faith the defendants assignor, it being sufficient to
ii. Holder had NOTICE OF DEFECT show that the defendant had notice that there
1) ACTUAL KNOWLEDGE was something wrong about the assignors
SEC 56. WHAT acquisition of title, although he did not have
CONSTITUTES NOTICE notice of the particular wrong that was committed.
OF DEFECTTo The fact is that it acquired possession of the
constitute notice of an instrument under circumstances that should have
infirmity in the put it to inquiry as to the title of the holder who
instrument or defect in negotiated the check to it. The burden was,
the title of the person therefore, placed upon it to show that
negotiating the same, notwithstanding the suspicious circumstances, it
the person to whom it acquired the check in actual good faith.
is negotiated must have One line of cases had adopted the test of the
had actual knowledge reasonably prudent man and the other that of
of the infirmity or actual good faith. It would seem that it was the
defect, or knowledge of intent of the Negotiable Instruments Act to
such facts that his harmonize this disagreement by adopting the latter
action in taking the test. Negligence on the part of the plaintiff, or
instrument amounted suspicious circumstances sufficient to put a
to bad faith. prudent man on inquiry, will not of themselves
It is therefore sufficient prevent a recovery, but are to be considered
that the buyer of a note merely as evidence bearing on the question of bad
had notice or faith.
knowledge that the
note was in some way STATE INVESTMENT HOUSE v. IAC (1989)
tainted with fraud. It is
not necessary that he A check with 2 parallel lines in the upper left hand
should know the corner means that it could only be deposited and
particulars of the fraud. may not be converted to cash. Consequently, such
2) SUSPICIOUS circumstance should put the payee on inquiry and
CIRCUMSTANCES upon him devolves the duty to ascertain the
a. BAD FAITH - does not holders title to the check or the nature of his
require actual possession. Failing in this respect, the payee is
knowledge of the exact declared guilty of gross negligence amounting to
fraud that was legal absence of good faith and as such the
practiced; knowledge consensus of authority is to the effect that the
that there was holder of the check is not a holder in good faith.
something wrong about
the assignors YANG v. CA (2003)
acquisition of title is
sufficient. Where Mr. A obtained by fraud from Mr. B crossed
b. The burden is upon the checks payable to Mr. C, which Mr. C innocently
defendant to show that receives from Mr. A for value, Mr. C is still a holder

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 98 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

in good faith despite the fact that the checks were NOTE: The instrument in this case was non-
crossed. The crossing of a check does not impair negotiable, so the active participation discussion
the negotiability of an instrument nor necessarily was merely obiter.
preclude its holder from being a holder in due
course. The crossing of a check only means that it
could only be deposited and may not be converted SALAS v. Court of Appeals (1990)
into cash. Thus, such should put the holder on
inquiry and upon him devolves the duty to
ascertain the holders title to the check or nature of Salas defaulted in payments for motor vehicle, the
his possession. purchase of which was financed by Filinvest. On
demand, his defense was that the purchase was
The effects are that: invested with fraud on the sellers part. Filinvest
1. The check may not be encashed but only (the financing company) was held to be a holder in
deposited in the bank. good faith, despite privity to the allegedly
2. The check may be negotiated only once to one fraudulent sale. Salas defenses were good only
who has an account with a bank. against the seller-indorser, and where the note was
3. The act of crossing serves as a warning to the negotiable and validly negotiated to Filinvest, the
holder that the check was issued for a definite latter was a holder in good faith, and may recover
purpose so that he must inquire if he has received from Salas.
the check pursuant to that purpose. Otherwise, he
would not be a holder in due course.
Note: This is the less protective doctrine not so
Where the holder Mr. C, as in this case, did not much favorable to dealers but as compared to
have knowledge of Mr. As fraudulent actions on Consolidated, the rule here was actually in the ratio
Mr. B, and the fact that he was the payee in said decidendi and not mere obiter.
check, he was legally warranted to deposit the
instrument in his account with the drawee bank. 3.4. That at time it was negotiated to him, he
Mr. C was a holder in good faith. had no notice of :
o any infirmity in instrument
iii. FINANCING COMPANY o any defect in title of person
negotiating;
1. title DEFECTIVE when (Sec. 55, NIL):
In installment sales, the buyer usually issues a a. instrument / signature obtained by
note payable to the seller to cover the purchase fraud, duress, force or fear or other
price. unlawful means OR for an illegal
consideration; or
b. instrument is negotiated in breach of
Many times, pursuant to a previous arrangement faith, or fraudulent circumstances
with the seller, a finance company pays the full
price of the property sold and the note is indorsed
to it by the seller, subrogating it to the right to 2. NOTICE of infirmity or defect
collect the price from the buyer. a. actual knowledge of the infirmity or
defect OR knowledge of such facts that
his action in taking the instrument
RULE In such cases, the tendency of the courts amounted to bad faith (Sec.56, NIL)
b. Notice to an AGENT is chargeable
is to protect the buyer against the finance company
in the event that the goods sold turn out to be against the principal.
c. INSUFFICIENT NOTICE
defective. The finance company will be subject to
the defense of failure of consideration and cannot i. CONSTRUCTIVE NOTICE (ex.
recover the purchase price from the buyer. notice of defenses disclosed by
public records, doctrine of lis
pendens) is insufficient to charge a
purchaser of a NI with notice.
CONSOLIDATED PLYWOOD v. IFC (1987)
Just as a purchaser of a
negotiable instrument is not
put on inquiry, neither is he
A FINANCING COMPANY that is the indorsee of a
charged with notice of
note issued by a buyer payable to the seller of
defenses or equities
goods is NOT a holder in good faith as to the
disclosed by public records,
buyer. In case the goods sold turn out to be
nor is he affected by the
defective, it cannot recover the purchase price of
doctrine of lis pendens.
the goods from the buyer. The TEST OF PROXIMITY
However, notice to an
to the transaction was applied in this case. Where
agent is chargeable against
the financing company was privy to the initial
the principal.
transaction, it was bound with notice of the
ii. Notice of an ACCOMODATION
warranties attaching to the transaction. It
PARTY is not notice of a defect.
ACTIVELY PARTICIPATED in the transaction, thus it
Thus, an accomodation
cannot be a holder in good faith. This is the
party (one who has signed
protective doctrine favoring the interests of
the instrument as maker,
individual dealers over those of financing
drawer, acceptor or
companies.
endorser, without
receiveing value therefor,
and for the purpose of

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 99 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

lending his name to some 5. may enforce payment of instrument


other person) is liable on for full amount, against all parties liable
the instrument, (Sec.57, NIL)
notwithstanding the fact
that the holder knew him to
6.2. JUR: BPI v. ALFRED BERWIN & CO.
be an accomodation party.
Only a HDC may enforce payment on the
d. RIGHT of a transferee who receives
PN. In CAB, it is not clear whether A (the
NOTICE of any infirmity or defect
payee) is still the HDC since D (the maker)
BEFORE he has PAID THE FULL
believed that A may have negotiated it. Thus,
amount for the instrument
to compel D to pay would expose him to pay a
i. He will be deemed a HDC only to
second time to the HDC (in case A was no
the extent of the amount therefore
longer one). In short, the drawee may be
paid by him (Sec.54, NIL)
compelled to pay only to a HOLDER of the
instrument.

4. Effect of Qualified, Conditional and


6.3. DISADVANTAGE of being a NON HDC:
Restrictive Indorsements
o The Negotiable Instruments Law does
A. The status of a holder as a HDC is not
not provide that a holder not in due
affected by his taking under a qualified
course can not recover on the
indorsement.
instrument. The disadvantage of not
B. A conditional indorsement does not
being a holder in due course is that the
deprive the conditional indorsee or
negotiable instrument is subject to
subsequent holder of the rights of a HDC.
defenses as if it were non-negotiable.
If he fulfills all the requisites in Sec. 52
One such defense is absence or failure
then he is immune from all the personal
of consideration. (Atrium Mgt v de
defense.
Leon, 2001)
C. A restrictive indorsement which prohibits
further negotiation will not prevent the
indorsee from being a HDC. BUT, if he
further indorses the instrument, then the
subsequent indorsee will not be a due 7. Rights of Purchaser from Holder in Due
course holder. Course (Sec.58)

5. Who is Deemed HDC (burden of proof)


7.1. General Rule: In the hands of any holder
(Sec.59)
other than a HDC, NI is subject to same
A. General Rule: Prima facie presumption in defenses as if it were non-negotiable.
favor of holder
B. Exception: Burden is reversed (burden on
holder to prove that he or some person 7.2. Exception: A holder who derives title
under whom he claims acquired title as through a HDC and who is NOT himself A
HDC) when it is shown that the title of any PARTY TO ANY FRAUD or illegality has all rights
person who has negotiated instrument was of such former holder in respect to all parties
defective prior to the latter EVEN though he himself does
C. Exception to exception: There will be no not satisfy Sec.52
reversal if the party being made liable
became bound prior to the acquisition of
such defective title (i.e., where defense is
not his own) presumption in favor of
holder 8. Presumption in Favor of Due Course
Holding

6. Rights of Holder in Due Course


A. Every holder is deemed prima facie to be a
holder in due course;
6.1. Under the NIL7 1. BURDEN SHIFTS when it is shown that
the title of any person who has
1. to sue on the instrument in his own
negotiated the instrument was
name (Sec. 51, NIL)
defective. Holder MUST PROVE that he
2. to receive payment on the instrument
or some person under whom he claims
discharges the instrument (Sec. 51,
acquired the title as a holder in due
NIL)
course.
3. holds instrument free of any defect of
2. But the last mentioned rule does not
title of prior parties (Sec. 57, NIL)
apply in favor of a party who became
4. free from defenses available to prior
bound on the instrument prior to the
parties among themselves (Sec.57,
acquisition of such defective title.
NIL)
(Sec.59., NIL)
B. However, this presumption arises only in
favor of a person who is a holder as defined
7
Suggested Mnemonics: REFS: Receive and in Section 191 of the Negotiable
Enforce payment, Free from any defect of title and Instruments Law, meaning a payee or
defenses, Sue indorsee of a bill or note, who is in

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 100 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

possession of it, or the bearer thereof. b. PRIMA FACIE presumption of a valid


(Yang v CA, 2003) delivery where the instrument is no
longer in the possession of a party whose
sig appears thereon (Sec. 16, NIL)

3.2. Incomplete, Delivered (sec.14)

Chapter V.
1. This is a personal defense only because
DEFENSES & EQUITIES provision states that if any instrument
so completed is negotiated to a holder
1. Defenses in General in due course, it is valid and effectual
for all purposes
1.1. REAL defense attaches to instrument 2. 2 Kinds of Writings:
on the principle that there was no contract at i. Where instrument is wanting in
all; available against ALL holders including any material particular: person
holders in due course. They are those which in possession has prima facie
attach to the instrument itself and generally, authority to complete it by filing up
disclose an absence of one of the essential blanks therein
elements of a contract. ii. Signature on blank paper
delivered by person making the
1.2. PERSONAL defense grows out of the
signature IN ORDER that the paper
agreement or conduct of a particular person in
may be CONVERTED into a NI
regard to the instrument which renders it
operates as prima facie authority to
inequitable FOR HIM, though holding the legal
fill up as such for any amount
title, to enforce it against the party sought to
3. The authority to fill up is limited by the
be made liable; not available against a
following:
HDC.can be raised only against holders not on
a. When completed, it may be
due course. Here, the true contract appears ,
enforced upon the parties thereto
but for some reason , the defendant is excused
only if it was filled strictly in
from the obligation to perform.
accordance with the authority given
1.3. Equities or Claims of Ownership are of b. The filling up must be within a
2 Kinds reasonable time
1. Legal one who has legal title to the NOTE: If the signature on a paper is
instrument may recover possession given only for autograph purposes
thereof even from holder in due course and the same is converted into a NI,
2. Equitable may only recover from a this will amount to forgery,
holder not in due course constituting thus a valid defense
even against a HDC
2. Real Defenses

4. This provision contemplates delivered


2.1. Incapacity: REAL defense but available
instruments, so the person in possesion
only to the incapacitated party (ex. minor or
cannot be a thief or a finder but a
corporation); the indorsement or assignment
person in lawful possession- one to
of the instrument by a corp. or by an infant
whom the instrument has been
passes the property therein, notwithstanding
delivered.
that from want of capacity, the corp. or infant
5. In order that any such instrument,
may incur no liability thereon. (Sec.22, NIL)
when completed, may be enforced
against any person who became a party
thereto prior to its completion:
2.2. Incomplete, Undelivered Instrument
. must be filled up strictly in
1. Instrument will not, if completed and accordance w/ AUTHORITY given
negotiated without authority, be a valid . within a REASONABLE TIME in
contract in the hands of ANY holder, as determining what is reasonable
against any person whose signature time, regard is to be had to the (1)
was placed thereon before delivery. nature of the instrument, (2) usage
(Sec. 15, NIL) of trade or business (if any) with
2. Who may be estopped from raising the respect to such instruments, and 3)
real defense under Sec 15? A drawee the facts of the particular case
bank whose negligent custody of the 6. BUT if negotiated to HDC, may enforce
checks, after partial execution, it as if it had been filled up properly
contributed to its escape 7. What details may be filled up?
a. Amount, as to a signed blank paper
3. Personal Defenses b. Date (Sec 13 The insertion of a
wrong date does not void the
instrument in the hands of a
3.1. Complete, Undelivered Instrument subsequent holder in due
a. CONCLUSIVE presumption of a valid course)
c. Place of payment
delivery where the instrument is in the
d. Name of payee
hands of a HDC

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 101 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

3.3. Lack of Consideration(Sec. 28) c. No subsequent party can acquire


the right against any party thereto
1. ABSENCE or failure of consideration is a
(prior to the forgery) to:
matter of defense as against any person
i. Retain the instrument
not a HDC.
ii. Give a discharge there for
2. PARTIAL FAILURE of consideration is a
iii. Enforce payment thereof
defense pro tanto whether the failure is an
ascertained and liquidated amount or
otherwise . 2. PERSONAL if the party against whom it
is sought to enforce such right is
PRECLUDED from setting up
3.4. Illegality
forgery/want of authority;
1. In general, a PERSONAL defense even if
CC1409 provides that a contract with an
a. Who are PRECLUDED?
illegal cause is void.
i. parties who make certain
2. REAL when the law expressly provides warranties, like a general
for illegality as a real defense (Statutory indorser or acceptor after
declaration of illegality forgery (Sec. 62, NIL)
ii. estopped / negligent parties
RODRIGUEZ v MARTINEZ (1905) iii. parties who ratify (BUT there
are conflicting views whether
precluded includes
Maker cannot be relieved from the obligation of ratification)
paying the holder the amount of the note alleged
to have been executed for an unlawful
consideration. (Illegality is personal, so defense b. One view holds that a forged
only against a holder not in due course) signature cannot be ratified
because ratification involves the
The holder paid the value of the note to its relation of agency and a forger
former holder. He did so without being aware of does not assume to act for another.
the fact that the note had an unlawful origin. He
accepted note in good faith, believing the note
was valid and absolutely good. The maker even 3. ACCEPTANCE AND PAYMENT of a forged
assured the holder before the purchase that the instrument
note was good and that he would pay it at a When there is acceptance and payment
discount . of a forged instrument, the rights and
liabilities of the parties depend on
whether the forgery pertains to the
3.5. Duress drawer/makers signature or merely
1. In general, PERSONAL defense. of an indorsement.
a. Drawer/Makers signature
2. REAL if duress so serious as to give i. PRICE v NEAL, The drawee who
rise to a real defense for lack of had paid an accepted bill as
contractual intent well as a non-accepted bill,
3. CAMPOS: There may be cases where each of which was forged, could
the duress employed is so serious that NOT recover the money paid
it will give rise to a real defense out on the bill. The neglect was
because of the lack of contractual on the part of the drawee.
intent . Although the signer may know
what he is signing, there may be PNB v QUIMPO (1988)
wanting the intent or willingness to be
bound. Then it becomes a real defense. A bank is bound to know the signatures of its
depositors. If bank pays a forged check it must
be considered as making the payment out of its
4. Sometimes Real, Sometimes Personal own funds and cannot charge the account of the
depositor whose signature was forged.

4.1. Forgery (Sec. 23): made without SAMSUNG CONSTRUCTION CO., INC. VS. FAR
authority of person whose signature it purports EAST BANK AND TRUST CO. AND CA (2004)
to be
Consequently, if a bank pays a forged check, it
must be considered as paying out of its funds and
cannot charge the amount so paid to the account
1. In general, a REAL defense:
of the depositor. A bank is liable, irrespective of
Effect
its good faith, in paying a forged check.

a. signature is wholly inoperative


ii. Extensions Of The Price v Neal
b. no right to retain instrument, or
Doctrine: The bar to recovery
give discharge, or enforce payment
(Price v Neal doctrine) is
against any party thereto, can be
extended to overdrafts and
acquired through or under such
stop payment orders
signature (unless forged signature
unnecessary to holders title)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 102 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

1) Overdraft occurs when a forgery, due to his own negligence in entrusting


check is issued for an to his secretary his credit cards and checkbook
amount more than what including the verification of his statements of
the drawer has in deposit account.
with the drawee bank.
RULE: The drawee who SAMSUNG CONSTRUCTION CO., INC. VS. FAR
pays the holder of the bill EAST BANK AND TRUST CO. AND CA (2004)
cannot recover from the
holder what he paid under The general rule remains that the drawee who
mistake has paid upon the forged signature bears the
2) Stop Payment Order is loss.
one issued by the drawer of The exception to this rule arises only when
a check countermanding negligence can be traced on the part of the
his first order to the drawer whose signature was forged, and the
drawee bank to pay the need arises to weigh the comparative negligence
check. RULE: The drawee between the drawer and the drawee to determine
bank is bound to follow the who should bear the burden of loss.
order, provided it is Still, even if the bank performed with utmost
received prior to its diligence, the drawer whose signature was forged
certification or payment of may still recover from the bank as long as he or
the check she is not precluded from setting up the defense
3) SOME EXCEPTIONS: of forgery. After all, Section 23 of the Negotiable
o If the payment to holder is Instruments Law plainly states that no right to
a legitimate debt of the enforce the payment of a check can arise out of a
drawer which the holder in forged signature. Since the drawer, Samsung
due course could have Construction, is not precluded by negligence from
recovered from the drawer setting up the forgery, the general rule should
anyway. apply.
o If the stop order comes
after the bank has certified b. Indorsement:
or accepted the check, the i. When it is the signature of
bank is under the legal duty the indorser that is forged,
to pay the holder and will the drawee and drawer CAN
not be liable to the drawer recover vs holder
for doing so. 1) The drawee can recover the
amount paid by him in
iii. Effect Of Negligence Of cases where only an
Depositor - If proximate cause indorsement has been
of loss, the bank (drawee) is forged . This is because
not liable drawee makes no warranty
as to the genuineness of
1) It is the duty of the any indorsement.
depositor/drawer to 2) Generally, the drawee may
carefully examine banks only recover from the
statements, cancelled holder. Should he fail to do
checks, his check stubs, so(for instance due to
and other pertinent records insolvency) he cannot
within a reasonable time recoup his loss by charging
and to report any errors it to the drawers account
without unreasonable 3) Although a
delay. depositor/drawer owes a
2) If a drawer/depositors duty to his drawee bank to
examine his cancelled
negligence and delay
checks, he has no similar
should cause a bank to
duty as to forged
honor a forged check,
indorsements.
drawer cannot later
4) The drawer, as soon as he
complain should bank
comes to know of the a
refuse to recredit his
forged indorsement should
account.
promptly notify the drawee
bank
ILUSORIO vs CA (2002)

True, it is a rule that when a signature is forged REPUBLIC v EBRADA


or made without the authority of the person
whose signature it purports to be, the check is Drawee can recover. It is not supposed to be the
wholly inoperative. duty of the drawee to ascertain whether the
However, the rule does provide for an exception, signatures of the payee or indorsers are genuine
namely: unless the party against whom it is or not.
sought to enforce such right is precluded
from setting up the forgery or want of
authority. In the instant case, it is the ii. When drawee may recover
exception that applies. Petitioner is precluded from DRAWER
from setting up the forgery, assuming there is

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 103 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

1) Where the instrument is 3) In presenting the checks for


originally a bearer clearing the collecting
instrument, because the agent, made an express
indorsement can be guarantee on the validity of
disregarded as being all the prior
unnecessary to the holders endorsements. ( BDO v
title Equitable bank)
2) Indorsement forged by an 4) The drawee bank is not
employee or agent of the similarly situated as the
drawer collecting bank because the
3) If due to the drawers former makes no warranty
negligence/delay, the as to the genuineness of
forgery is not discovered any indorsement. The
until it is too late for the drawee banks duty is but
bank to recover from the to verify the genuineness of
holder or the forger the drawers signature and
not of the indorsement
GEMPESAW v CA, PBC because the drawer is its
client.
While there is no duty resting on the drawer to look 5) Where the negligence of
for forged indorsements on his cancelled checks, a the drawee bank is the
depositor is under a duty to set up an proximate cause of the
accounting system and business procedure as collecting banks payment
are reasonably calculated to prevent or render of a check with a forged
the forgery of indorsements difficult, indorsement, the drawee
particularly by the depositors own employees. bank may be held liable to
As a rule the drawee bank who has paid the check the collecting bank .
with forged indorsement, cannot charge the 6) When both are guilty of
drawers account for the amount of the said check. negligence, the degree of
An exception to this rule is where the drawer is negligence of each will be
guilty of such negligence which causes the bank to weighed in considering the
honor the check. amount of loss which each
should bear. (refer to BPI v
CA, 1992)
iii. When drawee may not
recover from holder
GREAT EASTERN LIFE v HONGKONG &
SHANGHAI BANK (1922)
1) Where the instrument is
originally a bearer Where a check is drawn payable to the order of
instrument , because the one person and is presented to a bank by another
indorsement can be and purports upon its face to have been duly
disregarded as being indorsed by the payee of the check , it is the duty
unnecessary to the holders of the bank to know that the check was duly
title indorsed by the original payee and where the bank
2) If drawee fails to act pays the amount of the check to a 3 rd person , who
promptly , if he delays in has forged the signature of the payee , the loss
informing the holder whom falls upon the bank who cashed the check , and its
he paid remedy is against the person to whom it paid the
money.

iv. Between Drawee Bank and


Collecting Bank BPI v CA (1992)
1) Collecting bank only liable
for forged indorsements Section 23 of the NIL has 2 parts. The first part
and not forgeries of the states the general rule that a forged signature is
drawer or makers wholly inoperative and payment made through or
signature. (PNB v CA, under such signature is ineffectual. The second part
1968) admits of exception. In this jurisdiction, the
2) The collecting bank or last negligence of the party invoking the forgery is an
indorser generally suffers exception to the general rule.
the loss because it has the Both drawee and collecting bank were
duty to ascertain the negligent in the selection and supervision of their
genuineness of all prior employees resulting in the encashment of the
indorsements considering checks by the impostor. Both banks were not able
that the act of presenting to overcome the presumption of negligence in the
the check for payment to selection and supervision of their employees
the drawee is an assertion Considering the comparative negligence of the
that the party making the parties, the demands of substantive justice are
presentment had done its satisfied by allocating the loss and the costs on a
duty to ascertain the 60-40 ratio.
genuineness of the
indorsements. (BPI v CA,
ASSOCIATED BANK v CA (1996)
1992)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 104 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

By reason of the statutory warranty of a general ii. A material alteration is one


indorser in Section 66 of the Negotiable which changes the items which
Instruments Law, a collecting bank which indorses are required to be stated under
a check bearing a forged indorsement and presents Section 1 of the Negotiable
it to the drawee bank guarantees all prior Instruments Law. (Metrobank v
indorsements, including the forged indorsement. It Cabilzo, 2006)
warrants that the instrument is genuine, and that it
is valid and subsisting at the time of his
3. IMMATERIAL ALTERATION
indorsement. Because the indorsement is a forgery,
a. Campos: Any other alteration would
the collecting bank commits a breach of this
be non-material and would not
warranty and will be accountable to the drawee
affect the liability of any prior party
bank. This liability scheme operates without regard
. Note that #7 is a catch-all
to fault on the part of the collecting/presenting
provision such that sec 125 may
bank. Even if the latter bank was not negligent, it
still have broad applicability.
would still be liable to the drawee bank because of
b. Alterations of the
its indorsement.
serial numbers do not constitute
material alterations on the
PCIB v. CA (2001) checks... [It] is not an essential
requisite for negotiability under
A bank which cashes a check drawn upon Section 1 of the Negotiable
another bank, without requiring proof as to the Instruments Law. The
identity of persons presenting it, or making aforementioned alteration did not
inquiries with regard to them, cannot hold the change the relations between the
proceeds against the drawee when the proceeds of parties. The name of the drawer
the checks were afterwards diverted to the hands and the drawee were not altered.
of a third party. In such cases the drawee bank The intended payee was the same.
has a right to believe that the cashing bank (or the The sum of money due to the
collecting bank) had, by the usual proper payee remained the same. (PNB v
investigation, satisfied itself of the authenticity of CA, 1996; Intl Corporate Bank v
the negotiation of the checks. CA, 2006)
Thus, one who encashed a check which had been c. EFFECT: an
forged or diverted and in turn received payment innocent alteration (generally,
thereon from the drawee, is guilty of negligence changes on items other than those
which proximately contributed to the success of the required to be stated under Sec. 1,
fraud practiced on the drawee bank. N. I. L.) and spoliation (alterations
done by a stranger) will not avoid
the instrument, but the holder
may enforce it only according to its
4.2. Material Alteration (Sec.124) original tenor. (PNB v CA, citing J.
Vitug)
1. As a DEFENSE:
a. PERSONAL defense when used to 4. EFFECT OF MATERIAL ALTERATION
deny liability according to the tenor
of the instrument a. General Rule: Where NI materially
b. REAL defense when relied on to altered w/o the assent of all parties
deny liability according to the liable thereon it is AVOIDED,
altered terms. except as against:
2. What constitutes material alteration? i. party who has himself made,
a. Statutory: Review Sec.125, NIL authorized or assented to
i. change date alteration
ii. sum payable, either for ii. subsequent indorser because
principal or interest by indorsement he warrants
iii. time or place of payment that the instrument is in all
iv. number/relations of parties respects what it purports to be
v. medium/currency of payment, and that it was valid and
vi. adds place of payment where subsisting at the time of his
none specified, indorsement (Secs. 65 and
vii. other change/addition altering 66, NIL)
effect of b. As to a HOLDER in DUE COURSE
viii. instrument in any respect i. When an instrument that has
been materially altered is in the
b. Jurispridence hands of a HDC not a party to
i. An alteration is said to be the alteration, HDC may
material if it changes the effect enforce payment thereof
of the instrument. It means according to orig. tenor
that an unauthorized change in ii. Alteration must NOT be
an instrument that purports to apparent on the face of the
modify in any respect the instrument for the holder then
obligation of a party or an would not be a holder in due
unauthorized addition of words course
or numbers or other change to iii. Where the interest rate is
an incomplete instrument altered , the holder in due
relating to the obligation of a course can recover the principal
party. (PNB v CA, 1996)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 105 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

sum with the original rate of a drawee bank may


interest return a spurious
c. When alteration is of the amount or check
the interest rate is altered, the b. but if holder is
holder can recover the ORIGINAL guilty of negligence
AMOUNT/interest rate. which proximately
contributed to the
5. DRAWERS NEGLIGENCE erroneous payment
a. The general rule is that the drawee by drawee, holder
cannot charge against the drawers liable (PCIB v CA,
account the amount of an altered 2001)
check.
b. BUT, the drawers negligence, MONTINOLA v PNB (1951)
before or after the alteration, may
estop him from setting up The insertion of the words Agent Philippine
alteration as a defense. National Bank converted the bank from a mere
c. However, the drawer is not bound drawee to a drawer and therefore changes its
to so prepare the check that liability, constitutes material alteration of the
nobody else can successfully instrument without consent of the parties liable
tamper with it (ex. a drawer cannot thereon and so discharges the instrument.
be expected to foresee that his Drawee bank is not liable.
clerk will use acid to alter his
checks, Critten v. Chemical Natl HONGKONG & SHANGHAI BANK v PEOPLES
Bank) BANK (1970)8
d. Where the negligence of the drawer
consists in failing to discover The failure of the drawee bank to call the
alterations previously made which attention of the collecting bank as to such
he could have discovered by a alteration until after the lapse of 27 days would
comparison of the cancelled checks negate whatever right it might have had. The
and check stubs or by diligent remedy of the drawee bank is against the party
observation of his records and responsible for the forgery or alteration.
could thus have prevented the
drawee bank from subsequently REPUBLIC BANK v CA (1991)
cashing other altered checks , the
drawee can charge the subsequent The collecting bank is protected by the24-hour
check against the negligent clearing house rule from the liability to refund the
drawers account. amount paid by the drawee bank. [Note: A
much recent Circular changed the point of
6. EFFECT OF DRAWEES ACCEPTANCE OF reckoning for the return of the altered check from
ALTERED CHECKS within 24 hours from the clearing to within 24
a. Where the interest rate is altered, hours from the discovery of the alteration]
the HDC can recover the principal
sum with the original rate of ASSOCIATED BANK v CA (1996)
interest. The rule mandates that the checks be returned
i. EXCEPT: A subsequent within twenty-four hours after discovery of the
indorser, because by the forgery but in no event beyond the period fixed
indorsement he warrants that by law for filing a legal action. The rationale of
the instrument is in all the rule is to give the collecting bank (which
respects what it purports to indorsed the check) adequate opportunity to
be and that it was valid and proceed against the forger. If prompt notice is
subsisting at the time of his not given, the collecting bankmaybe prejudiced
indorsement (Sec 65 and 66) and lose the opportunity to go after its depositor.
b. RECOVERY after acceptance or
payment by the drawee bank
i. FROM HOLDER ii. FROM DRAWER: drawee has no
1) Prevailing view - Yes, bec. right to seek reimbursement
of (1) payment under from drawer for its erroneous
mistake, (2) Sec. 124 and payment
(3) Sec.62 in relation to
Sec. 132 METROBANK v CABILZO (2006)
2) Minority view No, bec. of
(1) estoppel, (2) stability of In addition, the bank on which the check is drawn,
transactions and (3) bank is known as the drawee bank, is under strict liability
in a better position to to pay to the order of the payee in accordance with
shoulder the loss. the drawers instructions as reflected on the face
3) SC: and by the terms of the check. Payment made
a. adopted the under materially altered instrument is not payment
minority view but done in accordance with the instruction of the
on a different basis drawer.
the Central Bank When the drawee bank pays a materially altered
Circular regulating check, it violates the terms of the check, as well as
clearing of checks its duty to charge its clients account only for bona
and limiting the
period within which 8
Affirmed the minority view that drawee cannot recover

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 106 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

fide disbursements he had made. Since the legal nature of the paper he
drawee bank, in the instant case, did not pay is executing
according to the original tenor of the instrument, as
directed by the drawer, then it has no right to claim
reimbursement from the drawer, much less, the
right to deduct the erroneous payment it made
from the drawers account which it was expected to
treat with utmost fidelity.

BPI v BUENAVENTURA (2005)

It [the bank] should be able to detect alterations, Chapter VI.


erasures, superimpositions or intercalations
thereon, for these instruments are prepared, LIABILITY OF PARTIES
printed and issued by itself, it has control of the
drawer's account, and it is supposed to be familiar 1. In General
with the drawer's signature. It should possess
appropriate detecting devices for uncovering 1.1. Parties primarily liable:
forgeries and/or alterations on these
instruments 1. person who by the terms of the instrument
There is nothing inequitable in such a rule for if in is absolutely required to pay the same.
the regular course of business the check comes to a. Maker of promissory note
the drawee bank which, having the opportunity to b. Acceptor of bill of exchange
ascertain its character, pronounces it to be valid 2. unconditionally liable; duty bound to pay
and pays it, as in this case, it is not only a question the holder at date of maturity, WON holder
of payment under mistake, but payment in neglect demands payment from him, and he is not
of duty which the commercial law places upon it, relieved from liability even if the instrument
and the result of its negligence must rest upon it. should become overdue due to failure of
holder to make such demand.

c. REMEDY: Unless a forgery or 1.2. Parties secondarily liable:


alteration is attributable to the fault
or negligence of the drawer 1. SECONDARY PARTIES:
himself, the remedy of the drawee a. Indorsers, both note and bill
bank that negligently clears a b. Drawer of bill
forged and/or altered check for 2. Conditionally liable; not bound to pay unless
payment is against the party the following has been fulfilled
responsible for the forgery or
alteration, otherwise, it bears the a. Due presentment or demand from
loss. (BPI v Buenaventura, 2005) primary party for payment or acceptance;
b. Dishonor by such party; and
4.3. Fraud
c. Taking of proceedings required by law
after dishonor.
1. REAL DEFENSE
a. fraud in execution / fraud in
2. Primary Parties
factum: did not know that paper
was a NI when it was signed
b. not liable to ANY holder 2.1. PAYMENT: Presentment and Tender
2. PERSONAL DEFENSE 1. Presentment for payment not necessary
a. Fraud in inducement: knows it is NI to charge primary party
but deceived as to value/terms 2. if the instrument is, by its terms, payable
i. Available as a defense against at a special place, and he is able and willing
non-HDC to pay it there at maturity, such ability and
b. Fraud in factum accompanied by willingness are equivalent to a tender of
NEGLIGENCE of maker or signer payment upon his part. (Sec. 70, NIL)
i. Where the signor does not
know the nature of the 2.2. Liability of MAKER
instrument he signs, but where, 1. Promises to pay it according to its tenor
by the exercise of ordinary 2. Admits existence of payee and his then
care, he could have discovered capacity to indorse.
it.
ii. Three factors are typically used a. Therefore, PRECLUDED from setting up
in determining the existence of the following defenses:
negligence: i. the payee is a fictitious person
1) legal character of the ii. the payee was insane, a minor, or a
instrument which the corporation acting ultra vires
signer thinks he is signing
2) the physical condition of 2.3. DRAWEE and ACCEPTOR
the signer and his ability to 1. Drawee
read a. A person on whom a bill of
3) whether the signer had the exchange or check is drawn and
opportunity at the time of who is ordered to pay it
signing, to ascertain the b. Liability of DRAWEE to:

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 107 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

2. Holder Civil Code for any damages she incurred resulting


1) Not liable on the instrument therefrom.
until he accepts it and even a
HSBANKs actions, or lack thereof, prevented
holder in due course cannot sue
Catalan from seeking further redress with Thomson
him on the instrument before
for the recovery of her claim while the latter was
his acceptance
alive.
2) A bill/check of itself does not
operate as an assignment of
the funds in the hands of the
drawee/bank (Sec 189, NIL), 3. Acceptor: Liability
and the drawee/bank is NOT a. (Sec.62, NIL) Drawee is not liable
LIABLE on the bill unless and unless he accepts the bill and in doing
UNTIL he/it ACCEPTS (or so, he engages to pay the bill according
certifies) the same. (Sec. 127, to the tenor of his acceptance, and
NIL) admits the following:
3. Drawer i. existence of drawer
1) Payment despite Stop Payment ii. genuineness of his signature
Order iii. his capacity and authority to draw
a) Before payment or the instrument
certification by the bank, iv. existence of payee and his then
the drawer may capacity to endorse
countermand the order, b. Meaning of "according to the tenor
and payment thereafter to of his acceptance"
the payee by the bank is i. Majority and prevailing view:
wrongful. Where alteration consists in raising
b) Since a check is not an the amount payable, acceptor liable
assignment of the drawers to HDC only as to its original
fund, the bank is liable for amount; if the alteration of payee's
paying it in disregard of the name, paying banks cannot charge
countermand. drawer's account with the amount
c) Moreover, drawee can no of the check because its duty is to
longer recover what it pay only according to the order of
voluntarily paid to the the drawer.
holder of the uncertified ii. Common law rule: Acceptor of
and unaccepted instrument. altered check not liable to innocent
2) Refusal to Accept holder except for the original
a) Under some circumstances, amount
the drawee who refuses to
accept may be made liable for 2.4. Acceptance
breach of contract or for
damages based on a tort either 1. IN GENERAL:
to the drawer (refer to Araneta a. Definition:
v. Bank of America) or to the i. "Acceptance" means an acceptance
holder (refer to HSBC v. completed by delivery or notification
Catalan) (Sec. 19, NIL)
ii. The signification by the drawee of his
ARANETA V. BANK OF AMERICA(1971) assent to the order of the drawer (Sec
132, NIL)
b. REQUISITES for a valid acceptance
This was an action by a depositor against a bank (Sec 132, NIL)
for damages resulting from the wrongful dishonor i. It must be in writing and signed by
of the depositor's checks. HELD: Araneta's claim for the drawee;
temperate damages is legally justified because of 1) Thus there is no valid or
the adverse reflection on the financial credit of a implied acceptance except as
businessman, a prized and valuable asset, w/c provided by Sec. 137 relating
constitutes material loss. to constructive acceptance
ii. It must not express that the drawee
will perform his promise by any other
HSBC VS. CATALAN (2004) means than the payment of money.
iii. does not change the implied
promise of acceptor to pay only in
HSBC is not being sued on the value of the check money
itself but for how it acted in relation to Catalans c. MANNER of acceptance
claim for payment despite the repeated directives i. Campos: Usually made by writing
of the drawer Thomson to recognize the check the the word accepted and signing
latter issued. immediately below
1) BUT, drawees signature alone
Her allegations in the complaint that the gross is sufficient (Campos citing
inaction of HSBC on Thomsons instructions, as well Lawless v. Temple)
as its evident failure to inform Catalan of the ii. Sec 133, NIL: The holder of a bill
reason for its continued inaction and non-payment presenting the same for acceptance
of the checks, smack of insouciance on its part, are may require that the acceptance be
sufficient statements of clear abuse of right for written on the bill and if such
which it may be held liable under Article 19 of the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 108 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

request is denied, may treat the bill expressly accepting or refusing it; two
as dishonored views:
1) Effect: holder may go against
i. Constitutes constructive notice
the partys secondarily liable
the drawer and the indorsers ii. Constitutes dishonor because
iii. Acceptance of an INCOMPLETE bill Sec.137, NIL uses the word "refuses"
(Sec 138, NIL)
1) A bill may be accepted: d. Acceptance, if given, will retroact to date
a) before it has been signed of presentation.
by the drawer, or
b) while otherwise incomplete, SUMCAD v. PROVINCE OF SAMAR (1956)
or
c) when it is overdue, or There was implied acceptance in view of the
d) after it has been dishonored circumstances of the case (furnishing of
by a previous refusal to photostatic copies, presentment for
accept, or by non payment certification) by voluntary assuming the
2) But when a bill payable after obligation of holding so much deposit as would
sight is dishonored by non- be sufficient to cover the amount of the check.
acceptance and drawee
subsequently accepts it, the 3. ACCEPTANCE ON A SEPARATE
holder, in the absence of diff INSTRUMENT
agreement, is entitled to have
bill accepted as of date of the e. Extrinsic acceptance - acceptance is
1st presentment. written on a paper other than the bill
a) Sec. 138, NIL allows itself; doesnt bind the acceptor except
acceptance to be made in favor of a person to whom it is
while the bill is shown and who, on the faith thereof,
incomplete. receives the bill for value. (Sec. 134,
b) The bill may be accepted NIL); acceptance of an existing bill
even after it is overdue or f. Virtual acceptance - unconditional
dishonored, since an promise in writing to accept a bill
instrument DOES NOT before it is drawn; deemed an actual
LOSE ITS NEGOTIABILITY acceptance in favor of every person
by the mere fact that its who, upon the faith thereof, receives
maturity date has passed or the bill for value. (Sec. 135, NIL);
the drawees refusal to acceptance of future bill
accept or pay it. g. In both cases, the acceptance must
d. PERIOD within which to accept clearly and unequivocally identify
i. The drawee is allowed 24 hours the bill to which the acceptance refers.
after presentment to decide WON
he will accept the bill; the 4. KINDS OF ACCEPTANCE: An
acceptance, if given, dates as of acceptance is either (1) general or (2)
the day of presentation. (Sec. 136, qualified.
NIL) a. GENERAL - assents without
ii. Effect of non-acceptance within the qualification to the order of the drawer.
prescribed period (Sec.139, NIL); Includes acceptance
1) Where bill is duly presented to pay at a particular place; unless
and is not accepted within expressly states that bill is to be paid
prescribed time, the person there only and not elsewhere. (Sec.
presenting it must treat the bill 140, NIL)
as dishonored by non- b. QUALIFIED - in express terms varies
acceptance or he loses right of the effect of the bill as drawn. (Sec.
recourse against the drawer 139, NIL)
and indorsers. (Sec. 150, NIL) i. Conditional; payment by the
acceptor dependent on the
2. CONSTRUCTIVE ACCEPTANCE: occurs in fulfillment of a condition therein
the following circumstances stated;
ii. Partial; to pay part only of the
a. SEC 137, NIL: Where the drawee amount for which the bill is drawn;
iii. Local; to pay only at a particular
i. destroys the bill, or
place;
ii. refuses within 24hrs or such other iv. Qualified as to time;
period as the holder may allow, to v. The acceptance of some, one or
return the bill accepted or non- more of the drawees but not of all.
accepted to the holder (Sec. 141, NIL)
1) The holder may refuse to take
b. Under the clearing house rules, the
a qualified acceptance; may
drawee banks failure to return within the
treat the bill as dishonored by
prescribed time will be deemed payment or
non-acceptance.
acceptance of the check.
2) Where a qualified acceptance is
c. If there is not demand for the return of taken, the drawer and indorsers
the bill and the drawee keeps it until after are discharged from liability
the expiration of said period without on the bill unless they have
authorized the holder to take

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 109 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

a qualified acceptance, or
subsequently assent thereto.
Demand drafts have not been presented either
3) When the drawer or an indorser
for acceptance or for payment, thus the bank never
receives notice of a qualified
had any chance of accepting or rejecting them; as
acceptance, he must, within a
such, these cannot be subject of escheat.
reasonable time, express his
dissent to the holder or he will Cashier's check is the substantial equivalent of a
be deemed to have assented certified check and is thus subject to escheat.
thereto. (Sec. 142, NIL) Telegraphic transfers are likewise subject to
c. TRADE - a draft or bill of exchange escheat because upon making payment complete
with a definite maturity, drawn by a the transaction insofar as he is concerned, though
seller on a buyer for the purchase price insofar as the remitting bank is concerned, the
of goods, bearing across its face the contract is executory until the credit is established.
acceptance of the buyer; always states
upon its face the transaction from
which it arose. PAL V. CA (1990)
d. BANKER'S acceptance - a negotiable
time draft or bill of exchange drawn on
and accepted by a commercial bank. A check, whether a manager's check or ordinary
check, and an offer of a check in payment of a debt
2.5. CHECKS : acceptance and certification is not a valid tender of payment and may be
1. Definition: A check is an instrument in the refused receipt by the obligee or creditor.
form and nature of a BE, but an unlike an The issuance of the check to a person authorized to
ordinary bill, always payable on demand and receive it operates to release the judgment debtor
always drawn on a bank. from any further obligations on the judgment.
2. Kinds:
a. Cashier's or manager's - drawn by a
bank on itself and its issuance has the
effect of acceptance; since the drawer and
drawee are the same, the holder may treat INTERNATIONAL CORPORATE BANK v GUECO
it is either a BE or PN. (2001)
b. Memorandum check - where the word
"memorandum" or "memo" is written A managers check is one drawn by the banks
across its face, signifying that the drawer manager upon the bank itself. It is similar to a
will pay the holder absolutely, without need cashiers check both as to effect and use. A
of presentment. cashiers check is a check of the banks cashier on
c. Traveler's check - upon which the his own or another check. In effect, it is a bill of
holder's signature must appear twice -- exchange drawn by the cashier of a bank upon the
first when it is issued, and again when it is bank itself, and accepted in advance by the act of
cashed. its issuance. It is really the banks own check and
d. Crossed when the name of a may be treated as a promissory note with the bank
particular banker or a company is written as a maker. The check becomes the primary
between the parallel lines drawn. obligation of the bank which issues it and
constitutes its written promise to pay upon
STATE INVESTMENT HOUSE V. IAC demand. The mere issuance of it is considered
an acceptance thereof. If treated as promissory
Crossed check should put the payee on inquiry to note, the drawer would be the maker and in which
ascertain the holders title to the check or the case the holder need not prove presentment for
nature of his possession. Failing this, the payee is payment or present the bill to the drawee for
declared guilty of gross negligence to the effect acceptance
that the holder of the check is not a holder in good
faith. Effects of a crossed check: EPCIB v ONG (2006)
(a) the check may not be encashed but only
deposited in the bank; A managers check is an order of the bank to pay,
(b) the check may be negotiated only once to drawn upon itself, committing in effect its total
one who has an account with the bank; and resources, integrity and honor behind its issuance.
(c) the act serves as a warning to the holder By its peculiar character and general use in
that the check has been issued for a commerce, a managers check is regarded
definite purpose so that he must inquire if substantially to be as good as the money it
he has received the check pursuant to that represents.
purpose, otherwise, he is not a HDC.
3. Clearing
BATAAN CIGAR & CIGARETTE FACTORY, INC. a. Clearing - check collection process
v. CA b. Clearing house - where
representatives of different banks meet
The negotiability of a check is not affected by its every afternoon of every business day to
being crossed, whether specially or generally. It receive the envelopes containing checks
may legally be negotiated as long as the one who drawn against the bank he represents for
encashes the check with the drawee bank is examination and clearance.
another bank, or if it is especially crossed, by the
bank mentioned between the parallel lines. 4. Certification
a.Definition
RP v. PNB (1961)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 110 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

i. an agreement by which a bank the rule enunciated under Section 639 of the
promises to pay the check at any Central Bank Act to the effect that a check which
time it is presented for payment has been cleared and credited to the account of the
ii. When check certified by bank on creditor shall be equivalent to a delivery to the
which it is drawn, equivalent to creditor in cash in an amount equal to the amount
acceptance credited to his account shall apply in this case x x
b. Requisites for a Valid Certification x.
i. Must be in writing
ii. Made on the check or another
instrument 5. Surrender of Check
iii. Check must be payable a. The surrender of the check by the
1) Checks cannot be certified holder to the drawee bank upon its
before payable payment is not negotiation. By
c. Liability paying the check, the drawee bank
i. Bank which certifies extinguishes it as a negotiable
1) Becomes liable as an instrument and converts it into a mere
acceptor voucher.
2) REFUSAL to certify a check b. Distinction between surrender of check
doesnt constitute dishonor; the upon payment thereof and negotiation
holder at that stage cannot exercise i. The delivery of the check by the
his right of recourse against the holder to the drawee bank upon its
drawer and the indorsers payment is not negotiation. By
ii. If procurement by: paying the check, the drawee bank
1)Holder extinguishes it as a negotiable
a) The bank becomes the instrument and converts it into a
solidary debtor, and mere voucher.
b) The drawer and all ii. In the case of a deposit of a check
indorsers discharged from by the holder thereof in a bank
all liability (versus ordinary other than the drawee bank, the
bill of exchange not signature at the back of the check
discharged) would constitute an indorsement,
2) Drawer unless otherwise indicated. The
a) secondary parties not holder in negotiating the check to
released the depositary bank, which in turn
will collect on the check from the
ROMAN CATHOLIC BISHOP V. IAC (1990) drawee bank, through the
clearinghouse.

A certified personal check is not legal tender nor is


BPI vs CA (2000)
it the currency stipulated, and therefore cannot
constitute valid tender of payment.

In depositing the check in his name, private


respondent did not become the outright owner of
NEW PACIFIC TIMBER v. SENERIS (1980)
the amount stated therein. He was merely
(as cited in EPCIB v. Ong, Sept. 2006) designating petitioner as the collecting bank. This is
in consonance with the rule that a negotiable
instrument, such as a check, whether a managers
[S]ince the said check had been certified by the check or ordinary check, is not legal tender.
drawee bank, by the certification, the funds
As such, after receiving the deposit, under its own
represented by the check are transferred from the
rules, petitioner shall credit the amount in private
credit of the maker to that of the payee or holder,
respondents account or infuse value thereon only
and for all intents and purposes, the latter becomes
after the drawee bank shall have paid the amount
the depositor of the drawee bank, with rights and
of the check or the check has been cleared for
duties of one in such situation. Where a check is
deposit.
certified by the bank on which it is drawn, the
certification is equivalent to acceptance. Said Again, this is in accordance with ordinary banking
certification implies that the check is drawn upon practices and with this Courts pronouncement that
sufficient funds in the hands of the drawee, that "the collecting bank or last endorser generally
they have been set apart for its satisfaction, and suffers the loss because it has the duty to ascertain
that they shall be so applied whenever the check is the genuineness of all prior endorsements
presented for payment. It is an understanding that considering that the act of presenting the check for
the check is good then, and shall continue good, payment to the drawee is an assertion that the
and this agreement is as binding on the bank as its party making the presentment has done its duty to
notes circulation, a certificate of deposit payable to ascertain the genuineness of the endorsements."
the order of depositor, or any other obligation it The rule finds more meaning in this case where the
can assume. The object of certifying a check, check involved is drawn on a foreign bank and
as regards both parties, is to enable the
holder to use it as money. When the holder 9
SEC. 63. Legal character . Checks representing deposit
procures the check to be certified, the check money do not have legal tender power and their acceptance in the
operates as an assignment of a part of the payment of debts, both public and private, is at the option of the
funds to the creditors. Hence, the exception to creditor: Provided, however, that a check which has been
cleared and credited to the account of the creditor shall be
equivalent to a delivery to the creditor of cash in an amount
equal to the amount credited to his account.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 111 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

therefore collection is more difficult than when the clearing with the drawee bank, contrary to normal
drawee bank is a local one even though the check banking practice. HELD: Drawer (embassy) not
in question is a managers check liable. BA is guilty of negligence in giving B special
treatment as a privileged client, in disregard of
elementary principles of prudence that should
attend banking transactions. Hence, it should
3. Secondary Parties suffer the loss. BA could not have been a HDC.

3.1. Liability of DRAWER NOTE: The Camposes note that the drawer
1. Sec. 61, NIL was not held liable because the decision was
a. Admits existence of payee and his then based on 23 on forgery instead of 124 on
capacity to endorse material alteration. If BA had been a HDC,
b. Engages that on due presentment the Embassy could have been held liable for
instrument will be accepted, or paid, or the original amount of the checks
both, according to its tenor
c. That if it be dishonored + necessary 3. CRIMINAL LIABILITY FOR BOUNCING
proceedings on dishonor duly taken, CHECK
will pay the amount thereof to the a. Under BP 22
holder or to a subsequent indorser who
may be compelled to pay it PEOPLE v NITAFAN(1992)
2. Limiting Liability: drawer may insert in the
instrument an express stipulation Lim issued a memorandum check which was
negativing / limiting his own liability to subsequently dishonored for insufficiency of funds.
holder A memorandum check has the same effect as an
ordinary check and within the ambit of BP 22.
PNB v. PICORNELL (1922) What the law punishes is the issuance itself of a
bouncing check & not the purpose for which it was
Picornell obtained money from PNB Cebu to issued nor the terms & conditions relating to its
purchase tobacco to be shipped to Manila. Picornell issuance.
then drew a bill of exchange drawn against his
principal, Hyndman, Tavera & Ventura (HTV), in b. Estafa under the RPC
favor of PNB or his order. Upon presentation of the
bill, HTV accepted it. However, HTV subsequently PACHECO v CA (1999)
refused to pay the bill because some of the tobacco
shipped were damaged. The essential elements in order to sustain a
HELD: conviction under the above paragraph are:
A. Liability of Acceptor (HTV) 1. that the offender postdated or issued a check in
PNB is a holder in due course and the payment of an obligation contracted at the time the
partial want of consideration does not exist check was issued;
with respect to the bank who paid full value 2. that such postdating or issuing a check was
for the bill of exchange. done when the offender had no funds in the bank,
The want of consideration between the or his funds deposited therein were not sufficient to
acceptor and drawer does not affect the cover the amount of the check;
rights of the payee who is a remote party. 3. deceit or damage to the payee thereof.
The payee or holder gives value to the
drawer, and if he is ignorant of the equities PEOPLE v REYES (2005)
between the drawer and acceptor, his is in
the position of a bona fide indorsee. There is no estafa through bouncing checks when it
B. Liability of Drawer (Picornell) is shown that private complainant knew that the
As drawer of the bill, he warranted that it drawer did not have sufficient funds in the bank at
would be accepted upon proper the time the check was issued to him. Such
presentment & paid in due course. As it knowledge negates the element of deceit and
was not paid, he became liable to the constitutes a defense in estafa through bouncing
payment of its value to PNB. checks.
The fact that Picornell was an agent of HTV
in the purchase of the tobacco does not
necessarily make him an agent of HTV in 3.2. Liability of INDORSERS:
drawing the bill of exchange. These are 2
1. Indorser
different contracts. He cannot claim
exemption from liability by invoking the a. Sec. 63, NIL: A person placing his
existence of agency. signature upon an instrument other than as
Drawer received notice of protest in a maker, drawer, or acceptor unless he
fulfillment of the condition set by law for indicates by appropriate words his intention
his liability to arise. to be bound in some other capacity
Drawer's liability is only secondary as the
liability of the acceptor is primary. i SAPIERA vs CA (1999). It is
undisputed that the four (4) checks
BANCO ATLANTICO v AUDITOR GENERAL issued by de Guzman were signed
(1978) by petitioner at the back without
any indication as to how she should
B fraudulently altered checks payable to her drawn be bound thereby and, therefore,
by the Embassy by increasing the amounts. B she is deemed to be an indorser
negotiated these checks by indorsement to BA w/c thereof.
paid the full amount of the checks without first

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 112 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

b. Sec. 67, NIL: A person, who places his After an instrument is dishonored by nonpayment,
signature on an instrument negotiable by indorsers cease to be merely secondarily liable;
delivery, incurs all the liabilities of an they become principal debtors whose liability
indorser. becomes identical to that of the original obligor.
The holder of a negotiable instrument need not
c. Sec 64, NIL: Irregular Indorser
even proceed against the maker before suing the
iWhen a person not otherwise a
indorser.
party to an instrument, places
thereon his signature in blank
before delivery, he is liable as an
3.3. Accomodation Party
indorser, in accordance w/ these
rules: 1. Accomodation Party: one who signed
1) Instrument payable to order of instrument as maker/drawer/acceptor/ indorser
3rd person: liable to payee and w/o receiving value thereof, for the purpose of
to all subsequent parties lending his name to some other person
2) Instrument payable to the
order of maker/drawer, or 2. Liability : Liable on the instrument to HFV
payable to bearer: liable to all even if holder knew he was only an AP
parties subsequent to
maker/drawer MAULINI v. SERRANO (1914)
3) Signs for accommodation of In accommodation indorsement, the indorser
payee, liable to all parties makes the indorsement for the accommodation of
subsequent to payee the maker. Such an indorsement is generally for
2. WARRANTIES: the purpose of better securing the payment of the
a. Every person negotiating an instrument note, i.e. he lends his name to the maker not to
by delivery or by a qualified indorsement the holder. An accommodation note is one which
warrants: (Sec. 65, NIL) the accommodation party has put his name,
without consideration, for the purpose of
ii Instrument genuine, in all respects accommodation some other party who is to use it
what it purports to be and is expected to pay it.
iii He has good title to it Note: Campos disagrees with this ruling, referring
iv All prior parties had capacity to to the case of Goodman v Gaul where an
contract accommodation indorsement may be made for the
v He has no knowledge of any fact accommodation of the payee or holder.
w/c would impair validity of
instrument or render it valueless ANG TIONG v. TING (1968)
vi in case of negotiation by delivery
only, warranty only extends in It is not a valid defense that the accommodation
favor of immediate transferee party did not receive any valuable consideration
b. General or Unqualified Indorser: when he executed the instrument. Nor is it correct
Every person who indorses without to say that the holder for value is not a holder in
qualification, warrants to all subsequent due course merely because at the time he acquired
HDCs: (Sec. 66, NIL) the instrument, he knew that the indorser was only
an accommodation party.
i. instrument genuine, good title,
The fact that the accommodation party stands only
capacity of prior parties
as a surety in relation to the maker is a matter of
ii. instrument is at time of indorsement concern exclusively between accommodation
valid and subsisting indorser & accommodated party. It is immaterial
to the claim of a holder for value. The liability of
iii. eon due presentment, it shall be
the accommodation party remains primary &
accepted or paid, or both, according to
unconditional.
tenor
iv. if it is dishonored, and necessary
proceedings on dishonor be duly taken,
he will pay the amt. To holder, or to
any subsequent indorser who may be SADAYA v. SEVILLA (1967)
compelled to pay it
The solidary accommodation maker who made
3. Order of Liability among Indorsers (Sec. 68, payment has the right of contribution from his co-
NIL): accommodation maker. This right springs from an
a. among themselves: liable prima facie in implied promise between the accommodation
the order they indorse, but proof of another makers to share equally the burdens that may
agreement admissible ensue from their having consented to stamp their
signatures on the promissory note. The following
b. but holder may sue any of the indorsers, are the rules on reimbursement:
regardless of order of indorsement 1. A solidary accommodation maker of a note may
c. joint payees/indorsees deemed to demand from the principal debtor
indorse jointly and severally reimbursement for the amount he paid to the
payee; and
2. A solidary accommodation maker who pays on
TUAZON v RAMOS (2005) the note may directly demand reimbursement
from his co-accommodation maker without first
directing his action against the principal debtor
provided that :

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 113 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

(a) he made the payment by virtue of a behalf of a principal, not liable if he was
judicial demand or duly authorized
(b) the principal debtor is insolvent.
b. WHEN LIABLE:
TRAVEL-ON, INC. v. CA i. mere addition of words describing
him as an agent without disclosing his
Travel-On was entitled to the benefit of the principal
statutory presumption that it was a HDC, that the
ii. Where a broker or agent negotiates
checks were supported by valuable consideration.
an instrument without indorsement, he
The only evidence private respondent offered was
incurs all liabilities in Sec. 65, unless he
his own testimony that he had issued the checks to
discloses name of principal and fact
Travel-On as payee to "accommodate" its General
that hes only acting as agent. (Sec.
Manager; this claim was in fact a claim that the
69, NIL)
checks were merely simulated, that private
respondent did not intend to bind himself thereon.
Only evidence of the clearest and most convincing INSULAR DRUG v. PNB
kind will suffice for that purpose.
The right of an agent to indorse commercial paper
CRISOLOGO-JOSE v. CA. will not be lightly inferred. A salesman with
authority to collect money does not have the
Section 29 of the NIL does not apply to implied authority to indorse checks received in
corporations which are accommodation parties payment. Any person taking checks made payable
because the issue or indorsement of negotiable to a corporation does so at his peril & must abide
paper by a corporation without consideration is by the consequences if the agent who indorses the
ultra vires. Hence, one who has taken the same is without authority.
instrument with knowledge of the accommodation
cannot recover against a corporation - PBC v ARUEGO (1981)
accommodation party EXCEPT if the officer or
agent of the corp. was specifically authorized to Aruego obtained a credit accommodation from PBC.
execute or indorse the paper for the For every printing of the publication, the printer
accommodation of a third person. collected the cost of printing by drawing a draft
against PBC, which will later be sent to Aruego for
Corporate officers, such as the president and vice- acceptance. PBC seeks recovery on these drafts.
president, have no power to execute for mere Aruego invokes the defense that he signed the
accommodation a NI of the corporation for their document in his capacity as President of the Phil.
individual debts or transactions in which the Education Foundation & only as an accommodation
corporation has no legitimate concern. It is the party.
signatories thereof that shall be personally liable HELD: Aruego is personally liable because nowhere
therefor. in the draft did he disclose that he was signing as a
representative of the Phil Education Foundation.
Neither did he disclose his principal.
AGRO CONGLOMERATES v CA (2000)
As an accommodation party, Aruego is liable on the
instrument to a holder for value, notwithstanding
An accommodation party is a person who has
such holder, at the time of the taking of the
signed the instrument as maker, acceptor, or
instrument knew him to be only an accommodation
indorser, without receiving value therefor, and for
party. Aruego signed as a drawee/acceptor. As
the purpose of lending his name to some other
drawee, he is primarily liable for the drafts.
person and is liable on the instrument to a holder
for value, notwithstanding such holder at the time
of taking the instrument knew (the signatory) to be
an accommodation party. He has the right, after
4. Presentment
paying the holder, to obtain reimbursement from
the party accommodated, since the relation
between them has in effect become one of
principal and surety, the accommodation party 4.1. Definition:
being the surety.
1. the production of a BE to the drawee for his
ACCEPTANCE, or to the drawer or acceptor
for PAYMENT; or
3.4. Liability of an AGENT
2. the production of a PN to the party liable
1. AGENCY: for payment

a. Signature of any party may be made by


duly authorized agent, established as in 4.2. Presentment for Acceptance
ordinary agency
1. When necessary (Sec. 143, NIL)
b. Signature per procuration operates as
a. bill payable after sight, or in other
notice that the agent has limited authority
cases where presentment for
to sign, and the principal is bound only in
acceptance necessary to fix maturity
case the agent in so signing acted within
b. where bill expressly stipulates that it
the actual limits of his authority
shall be presented for acceptance
2. LIABILITY c. where bill is drawn payable elsewhere
than at residence / place of business of
a. GEN RULE: Where person adds to his drawee
signature words indicating that he signs on

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 114 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

d. In no other case is presentment for a. Dishonor by nonacceptance:


acceptance necessary in order to i When duly presented for
render any party to the bill liable. acceptance acceptance is refused
or can not be obtained; or
ii When presentment for acceptance
2. Effect of non-presentment [w/in reasonable
is excused bill is not accepted.
time] (Sec. 144, NIL) - discharges the drawer
(Sec. 149, NIL)
and all indorsers.
b. NON ACCEPTANCE of the bill
a. Reasonable Time: considerations i Duty of holder: must treat the bill
as dishonored by nonacceptance or
i nature of instrument he loses the right of recourse
iiusage of trade or business with against the drawer and indorsers.
respect to instrument (Sec. 150, NIL)
iii facts of each case ii Right of holder: immediate right
3. How made (Sec. 145, NIL) of recourse against the drawer and
a. BY or ON BEHALF of the holder indorsers and no presentment for
b. AT a reasonable hour, payment is necessary. (Sec. 151,
c. ON a business day and before the bill is NIL)
overdue, c. NOTICE OF DISHONOR
d. TO the drawee or some person i Recipient- (Sec.89, NIL) Except
authorized to accept or refuse as herein otherwise provided,
acceptance on his behalf; and 1) to the drawer and
i bill addressed to drawees not 2) to each indorser,
partners, MUST be made to them ii Effect of omission to give notice
all unless one has authority to of non-acceptance
accept or refuse acceptance for all; 1) any drawer or indorser to
ii drawee is dead, MAY be made to whom such notice is not given
his personal representative; is discharged
iii drawee has been adjudged a 2) does not prejudice the rights of
bankrupt or an insolvent or has a HDC subsequent to the
made an assignment for the benefit omission. (Sec. 117, NIL)
of creditors, MAY be made:
1) to him or
2) to his trustee or assignee. 4.3. Presentment for Payment
1. IN GENERAL
4. When made (Sec. 146, NIL) on any day
a. NECESSARY in order to charge the
on which NIs may be presented for
drawer and indorsers(Sec. 70, NIL)
payment under:
a. Sec. 72, NIL at a reasonable hour on b. NOT necessary
a business day
i. to charge the person primarily liable
i Instruments falling due or
on the instrument (Sec. 70, NIL)
becoming payable on Saturday -
next succeeding business day ii. to charge the drawer where he has
ii EXCEPT instruments payable on no right to expect or require that the
demand [at the option of the drawee or acceptor will pay the
holder] before twelve o'clock instrument. (Sec. 79, NIL)
noon on Saturday WHEN that entire
day is not a holiday. iii. to charge an indorser where the
b. Sec. 85, NIL instrument was made or accepted for
i at the time fixed therein without his accommodation and he has no
grace. reason to expect that the instrument
c. Where the holder has no time, with the will be paid if presented. (Sec. 80,
exercise of reasonable diligence, to NIL)
present the bill for acceptance before iv. Excused:
presenting it for payment, delay is
excused and doesnt discharge the 1) Where, after the exercise of
drawers and indorsers. (Sec. 147, reasonable diligence,
NIL) presentment cannot be made;
2) Where the drawee is a fictitious
person;
5. When Excused (Sec. 148, NIL) Bill may 3) By waiver of presentment,
be treated as dishonored by non- express or implied.
acceptance: v. when a bill is dishonored by
a. Where the drawee is (1) dead, (2) nonacceptance immediate right to
absconded, (3) fictitious, (4) does not recourse accrues to holder (Sec. 151,
have capacity to contract by bill. NIL)
b. Where, after the exercise of reasonable
diligence, presentment can not be vi. in case of waiver of protest, whether
made. in the case of a foreign bill of exchange
c. Where, although presentment has been or other NI deemed to be a waiver
irregular, acceptance has been refused not only of a formal protest but also of
on some other ground. presentment and notice of dishonor.
(Sec. 111, NIL)

6. Dishonor and Effects

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 115 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

PAPA v A.U. VALENCIA (1998)


2. Date and time of presentment
Granting that petitioner had never encashed
a. bearing fixed maturity / not payable the check, his failure to do so for more than ten
on demand on the day it falls due (10) years undoubtedly resulted in the impairment
of the check through his unreasonable and
iiiif day of maturity falls on Sunday unexplained delay.
or a holiday, the instruments falling While it is true that the delivery of a check
due or becoming payable on produces the effect of payment only when it is
Saturday are to be presented for cashed, the rule is otherwise if the debtor is
payment on the next succeeding prejudiced by the creditors unreasonable delay in
business day (Sec.85, NIL) presentment. The acceptance of a check implies
b. payable on demand within a an undertaking of due diligence in presenting it for
reasonable time after its issue, payment, and if he from whom it is received
iv at the option of the holder, may be sustains loss by want of such diligence, it will be
presented for payment before held to operate as actual payment of the debt or
twelve o'clock noon on Saturday obligation for which it was given.
when that entire day is not a It has, likewise, been held that if no
holiday (Sec. 85, NIL) presentment is made at all, the drawer cannot be
c. demand bill of exchange within a held liable irrespective of loss or injury unless
reasonable time after the last negotiation. presentment is otherwise excused. This is in
(Sec. 71, NIL) (NOTE: though reasonable harmony with Article 1249 of the Civil Code under
time from last negotiation, it may be which payment by way of check or other negotiable
unreasonable time from issuance thus instrument is conditioned on its being cashed,
holder may not be HDC under sec. 71) except when through the fault of the creditor, the
instrument is impaired. The payee of a check would
d. Check - must be presented for payment be a creditor under this provision and if its non-
within reasonable time after its issue or payment is caused by his negligence, payment will
drawer will be discharged from liability be deemed effected and the obligation for which
thereon to extent of loss caused by delay the check was given as conditional payment will be
i.How time computed. When discharged.
payable at a (1) fixed period after date,
(2) after sight, or (3) after that 3. Where DELAY excused - when the delay is
happening of a specified event, exclude caused by circumstances beyond the control of
day from which the time is to begin to the holder and not imputable to his default,
run, include date of payment. (Sec. misconduct, or negligence; when the cause of
86, NIL) delay ceases to operate, presentment must be
made with reasonable diligence (Sec. 81,NIL)
ii.Where the day, or the last day for
payment falls on a Sunday or on a
holiday may be done on the next 4. Manner of Presentment
succeeding secular or business day.
(Sec. 194, NIL)
a. The instrument must be exhibited; when
paid, must be delivered up to the party
PNB v. SEETO (1952) paying it. (Sec. 74, NIL)

On 13 March, Seeto indorsed to PNB-Surigao a b. What constitutes a sufficient


bearer check dated 10 March drawn against PBC- presentment. (Sec. 72, NIL)
Cebu. PNB-Surigao mailed the check to its Cebu i.BY WHOM: the holder, or by some
branch on 20 March & was presented to the drawee person authorized to receive payment
bank on 09 April. The check was dishonored for on his behalf;
insufficient funds because the delay in presentment
cause the exhaustion of the drawer's funds.
Indorser Seeto asked that the suit be deferred
CHAN WAN v. TAN KIM(1960)
while he made inquiries. He assured PNB that he
would refund the value in case of dishonor.
Tan Kim drew specially crossed checks payable to
HELD: The indorser is discharged from liability by
bearer. Chan Wan presented the checks for
reason of the delay in the presentment for
payment to the drawee bank but they were
payment, under 84.
dishonored due to insufficient funds. Chan Wan
Drawer had enough funds when he issued the
seeks recovery on these checks.
check because his subsequent checks drawn
HELD: Checks crossed specially to China Banking
against the same bank had been encashed.
should have been presented for payment by that
The assurances of refund by the indorser are the
bank, not by Chan Wan. Inasmuch as Chan Wan
ordinary obligation of an indorser which are
presented them for payment himself, there was no
discharged by the unreasonable delay in
proper presentment & the liability did not attach to
presentation of the check.
the drawer.
NOTE: Camposes note that the discharge of the
But there was due presentment as clearance
indorser should have been based on 66 & 71 on
endorsements by China Bank can be found at the
presentment as a condition to the indorser's
back of the checks. However, some of the checks
liability & presentment for payment of a demand
were stamped account closed.
bill made within a reasonable time from its last
As Chan Wan failed to indicate how the checks
negotiation.
reached his hands, the court held him not to be a
holder in due course who can still recover on the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 116 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

checks but subject to personal defenses, such as reasonable diligence (Sec.


lack of consideration. 76, NIL)
NOTE: Camposes note that despite the addition of 3) where persons primarily
the words "non-negotiable" on the specially liable are partners and no
crossed checks, the Court considered the checks as place of payment is
negotiable instruments. A check on its face specified, presentment for
normally has all the requisites of negotiability, and - to any one of them, even
the addition of the above words should not change though there has been a
its character as a negotiable instrument. dissolution of the firm.
(Sec. 77, NIL)
ASSOCIATED BANK v. CA & REYES (1992) 4) joint debtors and no place
of payment is specified - to
Different department stores issued crossed checks them all (Sec. 78, NIL)
bearing "for payee's account only" payable to iv. TO WHOM: (1) person primarily
Melissa's RTW. Sayson, acting without authority, liable on the instrument, or if he is
deposited & encashed the checks with Associated absent or inaccessible, (2) to any
Bank. person found at the place where
HELD: Citing State Invt House v IAC, the effects of the presentment is made.
crossing a check are:
1. check may not be encashed but only
deposited in the bank;
2. check may be negotiated only one -- to one 5. Dishonor by Nonpayment
who has an account with a bank; and
3. the act of crossing the check serves as a a. Sec 83, NIL The instrument when:
warning to the holder that the check has i. duly presented for payment and
been issued for a definite purpose so that payment refused or cannot be
he must inquire if he has received the obtained; or
check pursuant to that purpose.
The effects of crossing a check relate to the mode ii. presentment is excused and the
of presentment for payment. instrument is overdue and unpaid.
The law imposes a duty of diligence on the b. Effect:: [subject to NIL provs] an
collecting bank to scrutinize checks deposited with immediate right of recourse to all parties
it, for the purpose of determining their genuineness secondarily liable accrues to the holder.
& regularity. (Sec. 84, NIL)
i. Dishonor is a condition precedent to
ii. TIME: reasonable hour on a business the enforcement of the liability of
day; secondary parties.
1) where instrument payable at ii. This is conditioned upon the giving of
bank. must be made during due notice of dishonor
banking hours, UNLESS the
person to make payment has iii. An indorser whose liability has
no funds there to meet it at any become fixed by demand and notice is,
time during the day, in which as to holder, a principal debtor.
case presentment at any hour
before the bank is closed on
that day is sufficient (Sec. 75, 5. Notice of Dishonor
NIL)
iii. PLACE: proper place as herein
defined: (Sec. 73, NIL) 5.1.Definition
1) place of payment specified at
place of payment; 1. To bring either verbally or by writing, to the
2) no place of payment specified knowledge of the drawer or indorser of an
but address of the person to instrument, the fact that a specified NI,
make payment is given in the upon proper proceedings taken, has not
instrument at the address been accepted or has not been paid, and
given; that the party notified is expected to pay it
3) no place of payment and no 2. General rule: MUST be given to drawer
address is given at the usual and to each indorser, and any drawer or
place of business or residence indorser to whom such notice is not given
of the person to make is discharged
payment;
1) in any other case
5.2. When necessary
wherever person to make
1. Sec 89, NIL Except as herein provided,
payment can be (1) found,
when a negotiable instrument has been
or if presented (2) at his
dishonored by non-acceptance or non-
last known place of
payment, notice of dishonor must be given to
business or residence
the drawer and to each indorser
2) where principal debtor is
2. Parties entitled to notice:
dead and no place of
a. Drawer
payment is specified to
b. Indorser
his personal representative,
c. Accomodation Indorsers
IF any AND IF he can be
found with the exercise of

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 117 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

i Joint maker excluded if not an 1. Notice may be given as soon as the


indorser instrument is dishonored and within the time
3. Acceleration Clause fixed by NIL, unless delay excused (Sec. 102,
a. If clause is optional on holder: NIL)
i The bringing of an action against
2. NOTICE to SUBSEQUENT PARTY: Each party
the maker and indorsers constitutes
who receives a notice is given the same period
a valid exercise of option and a
of time within which to notify prior indorsers
valid notice of dishonor
that the last holder had. (Sec. 107)
b. Clause is automatic:
i Notice of dishonor must be givem 3. TIME FIXED BY THE NIL:
at once
ii Not sufficient to give it upon a. Where parties reside in same place
commencement of action (Sec. 103, NIL): Must be given w/in the
ff. times:
GULLAS v. PNB (1935) ii If given at the place of business of
the person to receive notice -
A notice of dishonor is necessary to charge an before the close of business hours
indorser & that the right of action against him does on the day following
not accrue until the notice is given. iii If given at his residence - before
As a general rule, a bank has a right of set off of the usual hours of rest on the day
the deposits in its hands for the payment of any following
indebtedness to it on the part of a depositor. iv If sent by mail - deposited in the
However, prior to the mailing of notice of dishonor post office in time to reach him in
& without awaiting any action by Gullas, the bank usual course on the day following.
made use of the money standing in his account to b. Where parties reside in different places
make good for the treasury warrant. Gullas was (Sec. 104, NIL).:
merely an indorser & notice should actually have
been given to him in order that he might protect i. If sent by mail - deposited in the post
his interests. office in time to go by mail the day
following the day of dishonor, or if
there be no mail at a convenient hour
on last day, by the next mail thereafter

5.3. Form and Contents (Sec 96) ii. Convenient hour: depends on the
usual hours of opening of business
1. Form of Notice: houses and the post-office
a. may either be in writing, or oral iii. If given otherwise - within the time
that notice would have been received in
b. Campos: must be in a language that will
due course of mail, if it had been
inform the addressed party that the
deposited in the post office within the
instrument has been duly presented
time specified above
2. Contents must contain any terms which
sufficiently
c. Delay (Sec. 113, NIL)
a.identify the instrument, and
i. Excused: when the delay is caused by
b. indicate that it has been dishonored by
circumstances beyond the control of
non-acceptance or non-payment;
the holder and not imputable to his
3.Mode of delivery default, misconduct, or negligence
a. Personal service ii. But, when the cause of delay ceases
to operate, notice must be given with
i. There must be actual personal
reasonable diligence.
service, or
ii. An ordinary intelligent and diligent
effort to make personal service 4. Sender deemed to have given due notice
(Sec. 105, NIL)
b. Through the mails
a. Where notice of dishonor is duly
c. Campos: Through the telephone
addressed and deposited in the post office,
i Party to be notified must be fully
identified as the party at the i. deposit in post office when
receiving end of the line deposited in any branch post office or
4.The ff. notice still sufficient: (Sec. 95, NIL) in any letter box under the control of
the post-office department. (Sec. 106,
a. a written notice, not signed
NIL)
b. insufficient written notice, supplemented
b. notwithstanding any miscarriage in the
and validated by verbal communication
mails
c. instrument suffering from misdescription
UNLESS the party to whom the notice is
given is in fact misled thereby. 4. Place where notice must be sent (Sec.
108, NIL)
a. to the address, if any, added by the
5.4.Time and Place party to his signature; if address not
given:

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 118 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

i to the post-office nearest to his 1. when given by/on behalf of holder: inures to
place of residence or where he is benefit of (Sec. 92, NIL)
accustomed to receive his letters;
a. all subsequent holders and
or
ii If he lives in one place and has his b. all prior parties who have a right of
place of business in another, to recourse vs. the party to whom its given
either place; or
iii If he is sojourning in another place, 2. where notice given by/on behalf of a party
to the place where he is so entitled to give notice: inures for benefit (Sec.
sojourning. 93, NIL)
b. Notice sent to place not in accord with a. holder
NIL, still SUFFICIENT
i Where the notice is actually b. all parties subsequent to party to whom
received by the party within the notice given
time specified in this Act,

5.8. When rule requiring notice not applied


5.5. By Whom Given
1. In general
1. Sec. 90, NIL
a. Sec 112: notice of dishonor is dispensed
a. By or on behalf of the holder or with when after the exercise of reasonable
b. any party to the instrument who may be diligence, it cannot be given to or does not
compelled to pay it to the holder, and who, reach the parties sought to be charged
upon taking it up, would have a right to b. Reasonable diligence depends upon the
reimbursement from the party to whom the circumstance of the case
notice is given
2. When notice of non-acceptance is already
2. Agent given
a. Notice of dishonor may be given by an a. Sec 116: Where due notice of dishonor
agent either in his own name or in the by non-acceptance has been given, notice
name of any party entitled to give notice, of a subsequent debtor by non-payment is
whether that party be his principal or not not necessary, unless in the meantime the
(Sec. 91, NIL) instrument has been accepted
b. Where instrument has been dishonored b. Ratio for the rule: dishonor by non-
in hands of agent, he may either himself acceptance confers upon the holder an
give notice to the parties liable thereon, or immediate right against all secondary
he may give notice to his principal (within parties
the same time as if agent were holder)
(Sec. 94, NIL) 3. Waiver
a. Waiver of notice may be made either:

5.6. To whom notice MAY be given i before the time of giving notice has
arrived or
1. If given by an agent ii after the omission to give due
a. to his principal, in case of an notice; may be expressed or
instrument dishonored in the hands of implied. (Sec. 109, NIL)
an agent (Sec. 94, NIL), or b. Parties affected by waiver
b. to the parties liable thereon
c. ex: collecting bank i. Dependent upon where the waiver is
2. IN GENERAL (Sec. 97) written
a. Party himself ii. Where the waiver is embodied in the
b. Or his agent in that behalf instrument itself - binding upon all
3. If party is dead and death known to the parties;
party giving notice (Sec. 98, NIL)
a. MUST be given to a personal iii. where written above the signature of
representative, if there be one, and if an indorser - binds him only. (Sec.
with reasonable diligence, he can be 110, NIL)
found;
b. If no personal representative MAY be
sent to the last residence or last place 5.9. When Notice Not Necessary
of business of the deceased.
1.When not necessary to charge drawer
4. To partners : to any one partner, even
(Sec. 114, NIL)
though there has been a dissolution. (Sec.
99, NIL) a. drawer/drawee same person
5. To joint parties(Sec. 100, NIL)
a. to each of the party b. drawee fictitious, incapacitated
b. unless one of them has authority to c. drawer is person to whom instrument is
receive such notice for the others. presented for payment
6. to bankrupt (Sec. 101, NIL)
a. to the party himself or d. drawer has no right to expect/require
b. to his trustee or assignee that drawee/acceptor will honor instrument
e. drawer countermanded payment
5.7. In whose favor notice operates

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 119 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

STATE INVESTMENT HOUSE v CA (1993) 2. EXCEPT bill drawn payable at the place of
business or residence of person other than
Moulic issued 2 checks to Victoriano as security for the drawee has been dishonored by
pieces of jewelry to be sold on commission. nonacceptance,
Victoriano negotiated these checks to State a. it must be protested for non-payment
Investment. As Moulic failed to sell the jewelry, at the place where it is expressed to be
she returned them to Victoriano. However, she payable, and
failed to retrieve her checks. Moulic withdrew her b. no further presentment for payment to,
funds from the drawee bank. Upon presentment, or demand on, the drawee is
the checks were dishonored. necessary. (Sec. 156, NIL)
HELD: State Investment is a holder in due course H. Protest for better security against the
& is not subject to the personal defense of lack of drawer and indorsers where the acceptor has
consideration. been adjudged a bankrupt or an insolvent or
There is no need to serve the drawer a notice has made an assignment for the benefit of
of dishonor because she was responsible for creditors before the bill matures (Sec. 158,
the dishonor of her checks. After withdrawing NIL)
her funds, she could not have expected her checks I. Delay excused
to be honored. 1. Requisites:
a. when caused by circumstances beyond
2. Where not necessary to charge indorser the control of the holder, and
(Sec. 115, NIL) b. not imputable to his default,
misconduct, or negligence.
a. drawee fictitious, incapacitated, and
2. When the cause of delay ceases to operate,
indorser aware of the fact at time of
the bill must be noted or protested with
indorsement
reasonable diligence.;
b. indorser is person to whom instrument J. When protest dispensed with - by any
presented for payment circumstances which would dispense with
notice of dishonor. (Sec. 159, NIL)
c. instrument made/accepted for his K. Waiver of protest: deemed to be a waiver not
accommodation only of a formal protest but also of
presentment and notice of dishonor. (Sec.
111, NIL)
7. Protest
TAN LEONCO v GO INQUI(1907)

A. Definition: testimony of some proper person In exchange for the abaca from Tan Leonco's
that the regular legal steps to fix the liability of plantations, Go Inqui drew a bill of exchange
drawer and indorsers have been taken against Lim Uyco. Upon presentment of the
B. When necessary: draft, it was refused payment due to a stop
1. In case of a FOREIGN BILL appearing on its order from the drawer. The bill was not
face to be such; protested.
2. protest for non-acceptance if dishonored by HELD: The action is not brought upon the bill
nonacceptance & of exchange which was used only as evidence
3. protest for nonpayment if not previously of the indebtedness. Under these conditions,
dishonored by nonpayment. protest & notice of nonpayment are
4. Effect of failure to protest: the drawer and unnecessary in order to render the drawer
indorsers are discharged. (Sec. 152, NIL) liable.
C. Form
1. annexed to the bill or must contain a copy NOTE: The ruling of the Court on protest is
thereof, and merely obiter dictum.
2. must be under the hand and seal of the
notary making it;
D. Contents 8. Acceptance or Payment for Honor
1. The time and place of presentment;
2. The fact that presentment was made and
the manner thereof; A. Acceptance
3. The cause or reason for protesting the bill; 1. Practice of accepting for honor is obsolete
4. The demand made and the answer given, if 2. When bill may be accepted for honor.
any, or the fact that the drawee or acceptor When a BE has been (1) protested for
could not be found. (Sec. 153, NIL). dishonor by non-acceptance or protested
E. By whom for better security and (2) is not overdue
1. A notary public; or any person not being a party already liable
2. any respectable resident of the place where may, with the CONSENT of the holder,
the bill is dishonored, in the presence of intervene and accept the bill supra protest
two or more credible witnesses. (Sec. 154, for the honor of any party liable thereon or
NIL) for the honor of the person for whose
F. Time account the bill is drawn.
1. on the day of its dishonor unless delay is 3. The acceptance for honor may be for part
excused; only of the sum for which the bill is drawn;
2. when duly noted, the protest may be 4. where there has been an acceptance for
subsequently extended as of the date of honor for one party, there may be a further
the noting. (Sec. 155, NIL); acceptance by a different person for the
G. Place honor of another party. (Sec. 161, NIL)
1. at the place where it is dishonored,

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 120 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

5. Referee in case of need person whose E. Acceptance - may be written on any part
name is inserted by the drawer of a bill and and it must be written on one part only. If
any indorser to whom the holder may the drawee accepts more than one part and
resort in case bill is dishonored by non- such accepted parts negotiated to different
acceptance or non-payment; option of the holders in due course, he is liable on every
holder to resort to the referee (Sec. 131, such part as if it were a separate bill. (Sec.
NIL) 181, NIL)
B. PAYMENT FOR HONOR - any person may F. Payment - When the acceptor of a bill
intervene and pay bill protested for non- drawn in a set pays it without requiring the
payment supra protest (Sec. 171, NIL) part bearing his acceptance to be delivered
up to him, and the part at maturity is
outstanding in the hands of a holder in due
6.3 INSTRUMENTS PAYABLE AT BANK
course, he is liable to the holder thereon.
(Sec. 182, NIL)
Sec 87: Where the instrument is made payable at a G. Effect of discharging one of a set.
bank, it is equivalent to an order to the bank ton Except as herein otherwise provided, the
pay the same for the account of the principal whole bill is discharged. (Sec. 183, NIL)
debtor therein

BINGHAMPTON PHARMACY v FIRST


NATIONAL BANK (1915) Chapter VII
There is a distinction between the drawer of a DISCHARGE
check & the maker of a note payable at a bank:
Note payable at Check 1. Definition: Discharge
bank
maker of a note drawer of a check
is primarily liable is only liable after The release of all parties, whether primary or
on the dishonor secondary, from the obligation on the instrument;
instrument renders the instrument non-negotiable
Law excuses requires
presentment of presentment within
the instrument a reasonable time 2. Discharge of the INSTRUMENT
at the peril of
discharging the
drawer 2.1. How discharged: (Sec 119)10
obligation of the Breach of the duty 1. By Payment in due course
maker of a note of the holder of a a. Sec. 88: Payment is made in due
is not a check to present course when it is made:
conditional for payment at the i at or after the maturity of the
promise to pay place where it is payment
only at a special payable at a o if payment is made before
place, but is a reasonable time
maturity and the note is
promise to pay discharges the
negotiated to a HDC, the latter
generally, even drawer from
may recover on the instrument.
though a place of liability to the
ii to the holder thereof
payment extent he is
o payment to one of several
damaged by the
payees or indorsees in the
breach.
alternative discharges the
instrument,
o but payment to one of several
9. Bills in Set
joint payees or joint indorsers
is not a discharge. The party
receiving payment must have
A. composed of various parts being been authorized by others to
numbered, and containing a reference to receive payment.
the other parts, all of which parts constitute iii in good faith and without notice
one bill of lading that his title is defective
B. Bills in set constitute one bill. (Sec. 178, b. By whom made:
NIL) i payment in due course by or on
C. Right of HDCs where different parts are behalf of principal debtor
negotiated. the holder whose title first ii payment in due course by party
accrues is the true owner of the bill. But accommodated where party is
nothing in this section affects the right of a made/ accepted for accommodation
person who, in due course, accepts or pays c. When check deemed paid by drawee
the parts first presented to him. (Sec. bank
179., NIL) i Once the holder receives the cash
D. Liability of holder who indorses two or ii If the bank credits the amt of the
more parts of a set to different persons. check to the depositors account
liable on every such part, and every
indorser subsequent to him is liable on the
part he has himself indorsed, as if such 10
Suggested Mnemonics: PICk ROAD: Payment in
parts were separate bills. (Sec. 180, NIL) due course, Intentional Cancellation, Renunciation,
any Other Act, Debtor becomes holder.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 121 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

iii Where the drawee bank charges 2. where instrument is paid by party
the check to the account, indicating secondarily liable, its not discharged, but
intention to honor the check a. the party so paying it is remitted to his
2. intentional cancellation by holder former rights as regard to all prior
a. if unintentional or under mistake or parties
without authority of holder, b. and he may strike out his own and all
inoperative; subsequent indorsements, and again
b. where instrument or signature appears negotiate instrument, except
to have been cancelled, burden of proof i where its payable to order of 3rd
on party which alleges it was party and has been paid by drawer
unintentional, etc. (Sec. 123, NIL) ii where its made/accepted for
3. any other act which discharges a simple accommodation and has been paid
contract for payment of money by party accommodated
a. ex. issuance of a renewal note
novation Chapter VIII
b. Refer to Art 1231 of the Civil Code
4. principal debtor becomes holder of OTHER FORMS OF COMMERCIAL
instrument at or after maturity in his own PAPER
right
5. renunciation of holder: (Sec. 122, NIL) 1. In General
a. holder may expressly renounce his
rights vs. any party to the instrument,
before or after its maturity 1.1. Commercial papers
b. absolute and unconditional renunciation 1. also Negotiable instruments;
of his rights against PRINCIPAL 2. merely special forms of either PNs or BEs;
DEBTOR made at or after maturity 3. also governed by the NIL
discharges the instrument
c. renunciation does not affect rights of 1.2. Quasi-negotiable includes commercial paper
HDC w/o notice. which though not governed by the NIL, have
d. Renunciation must be in writing unless certain attributes of negotiability.
instrument delivered up to person
primarily liable thereon 2. Bonds and Debentures
material alteration review Sec. 125, NIL: 2.1. Bonds
what constitutes material alteration (Sec. 124,
NIL: material alteration w/o assent of all 1. evidences of indebtedness, in the nature of
parties liable avoids instrument except as a PNs
against party to alteration and subsequent 2. usually accompanied by a mortgage of the
indorsers) property of the issuer
3. issued by the government (municipal &
other public corporations) & private
3. OF SECONDARY PARTIES (Sec. corporations;
120, NIL)11 a. though not to mature for a long time,
assure some regular income to
bondholders in the form of interest*,
A. by discharge of instrument
usually payable annually
B. intentional cancellation of signature by holder
b. bonds and interest coupons (evidences
C. discharge of prior party
interest obligations)*
D. valid tender of payment by prior party
E. release of principal debtor, unless holders right may be negotiable in form,
of recourse vs. 2ndary party reserved therefore governed by NIL (Sec
F. any agreement binding upon holder to extend 65);
time of payment, or to postpone holders right both are actually promissory
to enforce instrument, UNLESS notes
1. made with assent of party secondarily c. they run for long periods of time, and
liable, or are often sold to the public in general
2. right of recourse reserved. d. funds generated by such bonds are
G. Failure to make due presentment (Secs. 70, used to finance corporate projects and
144, NIL) public works;
H. failure to give notice of dishonor e. there is no warranty on the part of such
I. certification of check at instance of holder indorser or negotiator that prior parties
J. reacquisition by prior party had capacity to contract. The qualified
1. where instrument negotiated back to a indorser & negotiator by delivery of a
prior party, such party may reissue and bond do not warrant therefore that the
further negotiate, but not entitled to corporation which issued the bonds has
enforce payment vs. any intervening party any judicial capacity to act. A general
to whom he was personally liable indorser thereof however would be
liable for such want of capacity.

11
Suggested Mnemonics: CuPID CRRAFFT:
intentional Cancellation, Prior Party and Instrument
Discharge, Certification, Release, Reacquisition, any
Agreement, Failure to make due presentment,
Failure to give notice of dishonor, valid Tender of
payment.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 122 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

2.2. Debentures of the goods, or any other person


1. similar to bonds except that they are whomsoever.
usually for a shorter tem and may or may b. The independent nature of the letter of
not be accompanied by a mortgage. credit may be: (a) independence in
2. they are often issued on the general credit toto where the credit is independent
of the issuer corporation from the justification aspect and is a
separate obligation from the underlying
3. Drafts and Letters of Credit agreement like for instance a typical
standby; or (b) independence may be
only as to the justification aspect like in
3.1. Drafts and Letters of Credit - The draft and a commercial letter of credit or
the letter of credit are generally used together to repayment standby, which is identical
effect payment in international transactions. with the same obligations under the
3.2. Draft a form of BE generally used to facilitate underlying agreement. In both cases
the transactions between persons physically remote the payment may be enjoined if in the
from each other. light of the purpose of the credit the
3.3. Letters of Credit payment of the credit would constitute
1. one person requests some other person to fraudulent abuse of the credit.
advance money or give credit to a third (Transfield vs. Luzon Hydro)
person, and promises that he will repay the 5. Pertinent Code of Commerce provisions:
same to the person making the a. Art 567. Letters of credit - issued by
advancement, or accept bills drawn upon one merchant to another for the
himself for the like amount. purpose of attending to a commercial
2. must be issued in favor of a definite transaction.
person, and not to order. b. Art 568. The essential conditions of
3. under our law, a letter of credit cannot be a letter of credit shall be:
negotiable instrument because (a) it may i issued in favor of a definite person,
not contain the words of negotiability; (b) and not to order.
may be issued for an undetermined ii limited to a fixed and specified
amount. See Art 568 Code of Commerce. amount, or to one or more
4. INDEPENDENCE PRINCIPLE: Credits, by undetermined amount, but all
their nature, are separate transactions from within a maximum the limit of
the sales or other contract(s) on which they which has to be stated exactly.
may be based and banks are in no way Note: Those which do not have any of
concerned with or bound by such these last circumstances shall be
contract(s), even if any reference considered as mere letters of
whatsoever to such contract(s) is included recommendation.
in the credit. Consequently, the c. Art 569. The drawer of a letter of
undertaking of a bank to pay, accept and credit shall be liable to the person on
pay draft(s) or negotiate and/or fulfill any whom it was issued, for the amount
other obligation under the credit is not paid by virtue thereof, within the
subject to claims or defenses by the maximum fixed therein.
applicant resulting from his relationships Letters of credit may not be protested
with the issuing bank or the beneficiary. A even if not be paid; bearer cannot
beneficiary can in no case avail himself of acquire any right of action by reason of
the contractual relationships existing non-payment against the person who
between the banks or between the issued it.
applicant and the issuing bank. The person paying has right to demand
a. Thus, the engagement of the issuing the proof of the identity of the person
bank is to pay the seller or beneficiary in whose favor the letter of credit was
of the credit once the draft and the issued.
required documents are presented to d. Art 570. The drawer of a letter of
it. This principle assures the seller or credit may annul it, informing the
the beneficiary of prompt payment bearer and the person to whom it is
independent of any breach of the main addressed
contract and precludes the issuing bank e. Art 571. The bearer of a letter or
from determining whether the main credit shall pay the amount received to
contract is actually accomplished or the drawer without delay. Should he
not. Under this principle, banks not do so, an action involving execution
assume no liability or responsibility for may be brought to recover it, with legal
the form, sufficiency, accuracy, interest and the current exchange in
genuineness, falsification or legal effect the place where it is repaid.
of any documents, or for the general f. Art 572. If the bearer of a letter of
and/or particular conditions stipulated credit does not make use thereof within
in the documents or superimposed the (1) period agreed upon with the
thereon, nor do they assume any drawer, or in default of a period fixed,
liability or responsibility for the (2) within 6 months, counted from its
description, quantity, weight, quality, date, in any point in the Philippines,
condition, packing, delivery, value or and within 12 months anywhere
existence of the goods represented by outside thereof, it shall be void in fact
any documents, or for the good faith or and in law.
acts and/or omissions, solvency,
performance or standing of the BPI v. DE RENY FABRIC (1970)
consignor, the carriers, or the insurers

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 123 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

The company and its officers cannot shift the A. or share certificate is the customary and
burden of loss to the bank because of the terms of convenient evidence of the holders interest in
their Commercial Letter of Credit Agreement with the corporation which issues it.
the bank provides that latter shall not be B. not a NI, but is included in the term securities
responsible for the any difference in character or bec does not contain any promise or order to
condition of the property. Furthermore, the bank pay money;
was able to prove the existence of a custom in C. described as Quasi-Negotiable bec
international banking and financing circles negating oftentimes, by application of the principles of
any duty of the bank to verify whether what has estoppel, and to effectuate the ends of justice
been described in letters of credits or drafts or and the intention of the parties, the courts
shipping documents actually tallies with what was decree a better title to the transferee than
loaded aboard ship. Banks, in providing financing actually existed in his transferor, and is the
in international business transactions do not deal same as would be reached if the certificate
with the property to be exported or shipped to the were negotiable.
importer, but deal only with documents. D. When the shareholder signs the back of
certificates of stock without filling in the blanks
LEE v CA (2002) (for the name of the transferee and attorney-
in-fact) and the certificate is delivered to
Modern letters of credit are usually not made another, the latter appears to be the owner
between natural persons. They involve bank to thereof. A bona fide purchaser of value without
bank transactions. Historically, the letter of credit notice, will be protected in his acquisition,
was developed to facilitate the sale of goods although such third person has diverted the
between, distant and unfamiliar buyers and sellers. certificate from the purpose for which he was
It was an arrangement under which a bank, whose entrusted therewith. (Principle of Estoppel)
credit was acceptable to the seller, would at the E. The same rule is applicable if the certificate is
instance of the buyer agree to pay drafts drawn on in bearer form.
it by the seller, provided that certain documents F. The rule is applicable where the certificate is
are presented such as bills of lading accompanied lost or stolen while signed in blank. Even a
the corresponding drafts. Expansion in the use of purchaser in good faith cannot acquire title as
letters of credit was a natural development in against the true owner. (?)
commercial banking. Parties to a commercial letter G. At common law, stock certificates are given the
of credit include: attributes of negotiability only where the owner
(a) the buyer or the importer, thereof has entrusted the wrongdoer with the
(b) the seller, also referred to as possession of such certificate and clothed him
beneficiary, with apparent ownership thereof.
(c) the opening bank which is usually the
buyers bank which actually issues the SANTAMARIA v HONGKONG & SHANGHAI
letter of credit, BANK (1951)
(d) the notifying bank which is the
correspondent bank of the opening bank Plaintiff, in failing to take the necessary precaution
through which it advises the beneficiary of upon delivering the certificate of stock to her
the letter of credit, broker, was chargeable with negligence in the
(e) negotiating bank which is usually any transaction which resulted to her own prejudice,
bank in the city of the beneficiary. The and as such, she is estopped from asserting title to
services of the notifying bank must always it as against the defendant bank.
be utilized if the letter of credit is to be A certificate of stock, indorsed in blank, is deemed
advised to the beneficiary through cable, quasi-negotiable, and as such the transferee
(f) the paying bank which buys or discounts thereof is justified in believing that it belongs to the
the drafts contemplated by the letter of holder and transferor.
credit, if such draft is to be drawn on the
opening bank or on another designated DE LOS SANTOS, McGRATH (1955)
bank not in the city of the beneficiary. As a
rule, whenever the facilities of the opening Although a stock certificate is sometimes regarded
bank are used, the beneficiary is supposed as quasi-negotiable, in the sense that it may be
to present his drafts to the notifying bank transferred by endorsement, coupled with delivery
for negotiation and it is well settled that the instrument is non-
(g) the confirming bank which, upon the negotiable, because the holder thereof takes it
request of the beneficiary, confirms the without prejudice to such rights or defense as the
letter of credit issued by the opening bank. registered owner or credit may have under the law,
except in so far as such rights or defenses are
TRANSFIELD VS. LUZON HYDRO (2004) subject tot eh limitations imposed by the principles
governing estoppel.
Can the beneficiary invoke the independence
principle? Yes. CAPCO v. MACASAET (1990)
To say that the independence principle may only be
invoked by the issuing banks would render Certificates of stocks are considered as quasi-
nugatory the purpose for which the letters of credit negotiable instruments. When the owner or
are used in commercial transactions. As it is, the shareholder signs the printed form of sale or
independence doctrine works to the benefit of both assignment at the back of every stock certificates
the issuing bank and the beneficiary. without filling in the blanks provided for the name
of the transferee as well as for the name of the
Certificate of Stock attorney-in-fact, the said owner or shareholder, in
effect, confers on another all the indicia of
ownership of the said stock certificates.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 124 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

person, then it should be indorsed by such


person, either specially or in blank.
4. Negotiable Documents of Title 3. If the goods are deliverable to bearer, or the
document has been indorsed in blank, then
5.1. In General negotiation may be by mere delivery.
1. as distinguished from negotiable
instruments, refer to goods and not to 5.4. Rights of a Holder
money; the sale of goods covered is 1. When free from personal defense
effected by the transfer of said document a. Under Art 1518 Civil Code, a holder
2. not governed by the NIL but by the Civil of a negotiable document of title in
Code. good faith, for value and without notice
3. includes any bill of lading, dock warrant, is placed on the same level as a HDC of
quedan, or warehouse receipt or order for a negotiable instrument i.e., personal
the delivery of goods, or any other defenses enumerated in said article are
document used in the ordinary course of not available against him. Personal
business in the sale or transfer of goods, as defenses include: negotiation was a
proof of the possession or control of the breach of duty on the part of the
goods, or authorizing or purporting to person making the negotiation, owner
authorize the possessor of the document to of the document was deprived of the
transfer or receive, either by indorsement possession of the same by loss, theft,
or by delivery, goods represented by such fraud, accident, mistake, duress or
document. conversion.
4. Documents of title negotiable when goods b. Note Art 1518s conflict with Art 1512.
represented thereby are deliverable to a (see p 915)
specified person , to order or to bearer. 2. What title acquired (NOTE: see Arts
5. valuable in commerce because it facilitates 1513, 1514 and 1519 Civil Code)
the sale and delivery of goods. a. A person to whom a negotiable
document of title has been duly
5.2. Kinds negotiated acquires the title of the
1. Warehouse receipts an agreement by a person NEGOTIATING it as well as the
warehouseman to store goods and deliver title of the ORIGINAL BAILOR or
them to a named person or his order or to depositor of the goods.
bearer. ex. if the original bailor had no
2. Bill of Lading a similar contract by a authority from such owner to deposit
carrier to ship goods and deliver them to the goods, then the holder of the
the person named therein or his order or to negotiable document, even if the
bearer; negotiable bill of lading is useful negotiation to him was valid, cannot
not only as evidence of the receipt of the acquire title to the goods; AND even if
goods by the carrier but as evidencing title the original bailor had authority, if the
to goods covered by it. It also facilitates negotiation to the present holders
the purchase of goods by one person from transferor was not valid, such holder,
another who is physically remote and even if in good faith and for value, does
probably unknown to him. not acquire any right to the goods.
a. straight bill where the goods are to the holders remedy if any, is against
be delivered to a specified person, it is his transferor and/or the guilty party.
not negotiable and is called a straight i Thus, if the original bailor or
bill. Otherwise, it is referred to as an depositor of the goods was not the
order bill. owner thereof or had no authority
from such owner to deposit the
3. Certificate of Deposita receipt of a bank for goods, then the holder of the
certain sum of money received upon negotiable document, even if the
deposit; generally framed in such FORM as negotiation to him was valid,
to constitute a promissory note, payable to cannot acquire title to the goods.
the depositor, or to the depositor or order, ii On the other hand, even if the
or to bearer. original bailor or depositor was the
a. it is taken when depositor does not owner or had authority from the
need his money for some extended owner, if the negotiation to the
period of time and wants it to earn present holders transferor was not
interest; more of an investment paper valid, such holder, even if in good
than a commercial paper because it is faith and for value, does not
not attendant to a commercial acquire any right to the goods.
transaction the way a check or a iii In both cases, the holders remedy
promissory note is. if any, is against his transferor
b. it is negotiable if it meets all the and/or the guilty party.
requirements of Sec 1 NIL b. The person to whom the document has
been negotiated acquires the
5.3. Negotiation - same as those used in NIs; to obligation of the bailee to make
order=delivery + indorsement, to bearer = delivery delivery to him, as if they had
1. The means of negotiating a document of title contracted directly with each other.
are the same as those used in negotiable i By issuing a negotiable document
instruments. of title, such bailee had given in
2. If by the terms of the document, the goods advance his consent to hold the
are deliverable to the order of a specified goods for any person to whom such
document is negotiated.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 125 of 355


NEGOTIABLE INSTRUMENTS LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

ii If document non-negotiable, notice


of any transfer should be given to
the bailee otherwise bailee or any
other person other than the
transferor not bound
iii Thus, the transferees rights may
be defeated by a levy of
attachment on the goods or by a
notification to the bailee of a sale of
the goods to another purchaser.
iv A sale of the goods without the
document will not prejudice a
subsequent purchaser who takes
the document in good faith and for
value.
v The bailees delivery to the legal
holder of the document would
relieve him of any further
responsibility for the goods.

5.5. Liability of Indorser


1. The indorsement of a negotiable document
of title carries with it certain implied warranties
by the indorser.
2. As to the document, his warranty covers its
genuineness, his legal right to negotiate it and
his lack of knowledge of any fact which would
impair its validity.
3. As to the goods, he warrants that he has
the right to transfer title thereto and that they
are merchantable.
4. However, unlike the indorser of a NI who is
liable if the primary party fails to pay, the
indorser of a negotiable document of title is not
liable for the failure of the bailee to fulfill his
obligation to deliver the goods.

ROMAN v ASIA BANKING CORP. (1922)

A warehouse receipt must be interpreted


according to its evident intent and it is obvious
that the deposit evidenced by the receipt in this
case was intended to be made subject to the
order of the depositor and therefore negotiable.
The indorsement in blank of the receipt with its
delivery which took place on the date of the
issuance of the receipt demonstrate the intent to
make the receipt negotiable. Furthermore, the
receipt was not marked non-negotiable.

SIY CONG BIENG v. HSBC

If the owner of the goods permits another to


have the possession or custody of negotiable
warehouse receipts running to the order of the
latter, or to bearer, it is a representation of title
upon which bona fide purchasers for value are
entitled to reply, despite breaches of trust or
violations of agreement on the part of the
apparent owner.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 126 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

Gercio vs. Sunlife


Insurance Code (PD 1460)
Facts: On January 1910, the Sun Life assurance
Chapter I. INTRODUCTION Co., of Canada issued a 20-year endowment
policy on the life of Hilario Gercio. The insurance
company agreed to insure the life of Gercio for
P2, 000, to be paid to him on February 1, 1930,
or if the insured should die before said date, then
1. Laws on Insurance
to his wife, should she survive him; otherwise, to
the executors, administrators, or assigns of the
1.1. Sources of Insurance Law in the insured. The policy did not include any provision
Philippines reserving to the insured the right too change the
During the Spanish period, all the provisions beneficiary. When the policy was issued, Andrea
concerning insurance in the Philippines were Zialcita was the lawful wife of Hilario. In 1919,
found in Title 7 of Book 2 and Section 3 of Title she was convicted of adultery. In 1920, a decree
3 of Book 3 of the Code of Commerce, and in of divorce was issued in a civil case completely
Chapters 2 and 4 of Title 12 of Book 4 of the dissolving the bonds of matrimony between
old Civil Code of 1889. Gercio and Zialcita. In 1922, Fercio formally
When Act # 2427, enacted on December 11, notified Sun Life that he had revoked his
1914, otherwise known as the Insurance Act, donation in favor of Zialcita, and that he had
took effect on July 1 1915 during the American designated in her stead his present wife, Adela
Regime, the provisions of the Code of Garcia de Gercio, as the beneficiary of the policy.
Commerce on insurance were expressly Gercio requested Sun Life to eliminate Zialcita as
repealed. beneficiary. This the insurance company has
refuse to do and still refuses to do.
Ang Giok vs. Springfields Held: The Code of Commerce, the Civil Code or
the Insurance Act does not contain any provision
Facts: Ang Giok insured the contents of his either permitting or prohibiting the insured to
warehouse with three insurance companies for change the beneficiary. We must perforce
60K. The warehouse and its contents were conclude that whether the case be considered in
destroyed by fire while the policies were in force. the light of the Code of Commerce, the Civil
The plaintiff instituted action in the CFI of Manila Code, or the Insurance Act, the deficiencies in
against one of the insurers to recover a the law will have to be supplemented by the
proportional part of the loss coming to P8, 170. general principles prevailing on the subject. To
59. Four special defenses were interposed by the that end, we have gathered the rules which
insurer, one being planted on a violation of follow from the best considered American
warranty F fixing the amount of hazardous goods authorities. In adopting these rules, we do so
which might be stored in the insured building. with the purpose of having the Philippine Law of
Securely pasted on the left hand margin of the Insurance conform as nearly as possible to the
policy reading in part as follows: It is agreed modern Law of Insurance as found in the United
that during the currency of this policy no States. The beneficiary has an absolute vested
hazardous goods be stored in the building interest in the policy from the date of its issuance
exceeding in all 3 percent of the total value of the and delivery. So when a policy of life insurance
whole merchandise contained in said warehouse. is taken out by the husband in which the wife is
Held: The rider or slip containing said warranty named the beneficiary, she has a subsisting
F attached to the policy in question and referred interest in the policy.
to therein as making part of the two forms
provided in said Section 65 of the Insurance Law. When RA 386, otherwise known as the Civil
The law says that every express warranty must Code of the Philippines, took effect on August
be contained in the policy itself. The word 30, 1950, those provisions of the old Civil Code
contained, according to the dictionaries, means on insurance were also expressly repealed.
included, enclosed, embraced, comprehended Presidential Decree # 612, as amended, which
etc. When therefore, the courts speak of a rider ordained and instituted the Insurance Code of
attached to the policy, and thus embodied the Philippines, was promulgated on December
therein, or of a warranty incorporated into the 18, 1974 during the period of martial law. It
policy, it is believed that the phrase contained in repealed Act # 2427, as amended. Before
the policy itself must necessarily include such Presidential Decree 612, amendments to the
ride and warranty. As to the alternative relating Act were made by PDs # 63, 123, 317.
to another instrument as here used could not Presidential Decree # 1460, consolidated all
mean a mere slip of paper like a rider, but insurance laws into a single code known as the
something akin to the policy itself. The word Insurance Code of 1978. Basically, it reenacted
instrument has a well defined definition in Presidential Decree # 612, as amended. It has
California, and as used in the Codes invariably been amended by Presidential Decree # 1814
means some written paper or instrument signed and Batas Pambansa Blg. 874.
and delivered by one person to another,
transferring the title to, or giving a lien, on
property, or giving a right to debt or duty. The
rider, warranty F, is contained in the policy itself,
because by the contract agreed to by the parties
is made to form part of the same, but is not
another instrument signed by the insured and
referred to in the policy as forming a part of it. 1.2. Laws Governing Insurance
The rider is therefore valid and binding.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 127 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

Insurance Code of 1978


The law on insurance is contained now in
the Insurance Code of 1978 (PD # 1460, as
amended) and special laws and partly, in 1. Definitions
the pertinent provisions of the Civil Code.
The Insurance Code primarily governs the 1.1. Section 2, Insurance Code
different types of insurance contracts and
those engaged in insurance business in the Sec. 2. Whenever used in this Code, the following
Philippines. It took effect on June 11, terms shall have the respective meanings
1978, the date of its promulgation without hereinafter set forth or indicated, unless the
prejudice, however, to the effectivity dates context otherwise requires:
of various laws, decrees and executive (1) A "contract of insurance" is an agreement
orders which have so far amended the whereby one undertakes for a consideration to
provisions of the Insurance Code of the indemnify another against loss, damage or liability
Philippines (PD 612) arising from an unknown or contingent event.
A contract of suretyship shall be deemed to be an
Civil Code insurance contract, within the meaning of this
The provisions of the Civil Code dealing on Code, only if made by a surety who or which, as
insurance are found in articles 739 and such, is doing an insurance business as hereinafter
2012 (void donations), Article 2011 provided.
(applicability of the Civil Code), Articles (2) The term "doing an insurance business" or
2021-2027 (life annuity contracts), Article "transacting an insurance business", within the
2186 (compulsory motor vehicle liability meaning of this Code, shall include (a) making or
insurance), and Article 2207 (right of proposing to make, as insurer, any insurance
subrogation). contract; (b) making or proposing to make, as
surety, any contract of suretyship as a vocation
Special laws and not as merely incidental to any other legitimate
The Insurance Code of 1978 (PD 1460) business or activity of the surety; (c) doing any
The Revised Government Service kind of business, including a reinsurance business,
Insurance Act of 1977 (PD 1146, as specifically recognized as constituting the doing of
amended), with respect to insurance of an insurance business within the meaning of this
government employees Code; (d) doing or proposing to do any business in
The Social Security Act of 1954 (RA substance equivalent to any of the foregoing in a
1161, as amended) with respect to manner designed to evade the provisions of this
insurance of employees in private Code.
employment In the application of the provisions of this Code the
fact that no profit is derived from the making of
Others insofar as the Civil Code is insurance contracts, agreements or transactions or
concerned, the Code of Commerce is that no separate or direct consideration is received
considered a special law therefore, shall not be deemed conclusive to show
RA 656 (as amended by PD 245), that the making thereof does not constitute the
known as the Property Insurance doing or transacting of an insurance business.
Law, dealing with government (3) As used in this code, the term
property "Commissioner" means the "Insurance
RA 4898 (as amended by RA 5756) Commissioner".
providing life, disability and accident
insurance coverage to barangay
officials 1.2. Contract of Insurance
EO 250 (July 25, 1987) increases, An agreement by which one party (insurer)
integrates and rationalizes the for a consideration (premium) paid by the
insurance benefits of barangay official other party (insured), promises to pay
sunder RA 4898 and members of money or its equivalent or to do some act
Sangguniang Panlalawigan, valuable to the latter (or his nominee),
Sangguniang Panlungsod, and upon the happening of a loss, damage,
Sangguniang Bayan under PD 1147. liability, or disability arising from an
The insurance benefits are extended by unknown or contingent event.
the GSIS.
RA 3591 (as amended) establishes the White Gold Marine Services vs. Pioneer
Philippine Deposit Insurance (2005)
Corporation which insures the deposits
of all banks which are entitled to the An insurance contract is a contract is a contract of
benefits of insurance under this Act indemnity wherein one undertakes for a
consideration to indemnify another against loss,
damage, or liability arising from an unknown or
contingent event. Regulation by the state through
a license or certification of authority is necessary
since a contract of insurance involves public
interest.

Chapter II 1.3. Doing an Insurance Business


General Rule: An insurance business consists of
THE CONTRACT OF INSURANCE undertaking, for a consideration, to indemnify

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 128 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

another against loss, damage or liability arising insurance, may be required by


from an unknown or contingent event law in certain circumstances
such as for motor vehicles, or
Supplementary Rule: The fact that an employees (Labor Code Art.
establishment is not formally designated as one 168-184) or as a condition to
of insurance does not preclude its being granting a license to conduct a
deemed to be engaged in an insurance business or calling affecting
business if it undertakes any of the following public safety or welfare
(even if not for profit or for any independent Social insurance for members
consideration): of GSIS and for employees of
Making or proposing to make, as insurer, the private sector covered by
any insurance contract the SSS is also established by
Making or proposing to make, as surety, law
any contract of surety ship as a vocation
Doing any king of business, including a 3.3. Aleatory
reinsurance business, specifically
recognized as constituting the doing of an Art. 2010. By an aleatory contract, one of the
insurance business with the meaning of this parties or both reciprocally bind themselves to give
Code or to do something in consideration of what the
Doing or proposing to do any business in other shall give or do upon the happening of an
substance equivalent to any of the event which is uncertain, or which is to occur at an
foregoing in a manner designed to evade indeterminate time.
the provisions of the Insurance Code

It depends upon some contingent event


Not a contract of chance although the
2. Elements event against the occurrence of which it is
intended to provide may never occur
It means one of the parties or both
2.1. Insurable interest
reciprocally bind themselves to give or to
The insured has an insurable interest in the
do something in consideration of what the
thing or the life of the insured
other shall give or do upon the happening

of the event which is uncertain, or which is
2.2. Risk of Loss or Damage / Designated to occur at an indefinite time
Peril as Cause Each party must take a risk
The happening of the designated events, Insurer - being compelled upon the
either unknown or contingent, past or happening of the contingency, to
future, will subject such interest to some pay the entire sum agreed upon
loss, whether in the form of injury, Insured parting with the amount
damage, or liability required as premium without
receiving anything in case the
2.3. Consideration: Premium contingency does not happen
The insurer undertakes to assume the except what is ordinarily termed
risk of such a loss for a consideration protection which is itself is a
called the premium to be paid by the valuable consideration
insured
3.4. Executory (insurer) and executed
2.4. Risk Distributing Scheme (insured)
This assumption of risk is part of a general Executory on the part of the insurer in the
scheme to distribute the loss among a large sense that it is not executed until payment
number of persons exposed to similar risks for a loss
It is executed as to the insured after
payment of the premium
3. Characteristics/Nature of It is a unilateral contract imposing legal
Insurance Contracts duties only on the insurer who promises to
indemnify in case of loss
3.1. Consensual
Perfected by the meeting of the minds of 3.5. Conditional
the parties It is subject to conditions the principal one
If an application for insurance has not been of which is the happening of the event
either accepted or rejected, there is no insured against
contract as yet The contract usually includes many other
conditions, such as payment of premium or
3.2. Voluntary performance of some other act, which must
It is not compulsory and the parties may be complied with as precedent to the right
incorporate such terms and conditions as of the insured to claim benefit under it
they may deem convenient which will be
binding provided they do not contravene
any provision of law and are not opposed to
public policy
Though generally a voluntary 3.6. A contract of indemnity (except life
contract, the carrying of and accident insurance where the result
insurance, particularly liability is death)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 129 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

The promise of the insurer is to make good interest not the property that is
only the loss of the insured being reimbursed
Any contract that contemplates a possible Life insurance GENERALLY
gain to the insured by the happening of any ASSIGNABLE as they are in the
event upon which the liability of the insurer nature of property and do not
becomes fixed is contrary to the nature of represent a personal agreement
insurance between insured and insurer
No person may secure insurance upon
property in which he has no interest. 3.9. A contract of adhesion
If the insured has no insurable interest, the Policy is presented to the insured already in
contract is void and unenforceable as being its printed form
contrary to public policy because it affords Take it or leave it
a temptation to the insured to wish or bring
about the happening of the loss 3.10. Of highest degree of good faith
Each party is enjoined by law to deal with
3.7. An investment (life insurance) each other in good faith
Measure of economic security for the Disclosure or the duty to disclose
insured during life, and beneficiary after Violation of the duty gives the other party
death the right to rescind the contract
Financial assistance during financial crisis
Liability of insurer is face value of the policy 3.11. It is property in legal contemplation
and not the earning capacity of the insured
at the time of death
4. Requisites of a valid contract of
3.8. A personal contract insurance
Each party having in view the credit,
character and conduct of another A subject matter in which the insurer has
As a rule, the insured cannot assign, before an insurable interest
the happening of the loss, his rights under Event or peril insured against which may
a property policy without the consent of the be any (future) contingent or unknown
insurer. The obligation of the insurer to event, past or future (Sec. 3), and a
pay does not attach or run with the duration for the risk thereof
property whether it be real property or A promise to pay or indemnify in a fixed
personal or ascertainable amount
If a person whose property is A consideration for the promise known as
insured sells it to another, the
a premium
buyer cannot be his successor in
A meeting of the minds of the parties
the contract of insurance unless, of
upon all of the foregoing essentials
course, the sale is with the consent
The parties must be competent to enter
of the insurer or unless by express
into the contract
stipulation of the parties, the
Under Sec. 226, no policy of insurance
contract is made to run with the
property of the transferee shall be issued or delivered within the
Where the insurance is on account Philippines unless in the form previously
of the owner or for whom it may approved by the Insurance Commissioner
concern or where the loss is The purpose must not be contrary to law
payable to bearer, the subsequent or public policy
transferees or owners become by
the terms of the contract, the real
parties to the contract of insurance.
All insurance contracts share a common
trait of personal-ness
Personal insurance (includes life,
health, accident, and disability
insurance) applies only to a
particular individual, and it is not
possible, for example, for the
insured unilaterally declaring that
his health insurance policy shall
now be deemed to cover the health
of someone else
Liability insurance each person
purchases coverage for his own (or
a group of related persons)
potential liability to others. The
insurer prices the coverage
depending on the characteristics
and traits of the particular insured
Property insurance - the insurance
is on the insureds interest in the
property, not on the property itself.
It is the damage to the personal

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 130 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

5. Contracts for Contingent Services; Pre- Court upheld the Attorney Generals contention
need Plans and Similar Arrangements and issued an injunction holding that the
contract had all the elements of an insurance
5.1. Contracts for Contingent Personal contract. Whether this clause in the contract is
Services ancillary to defendants chief business or is
It does not necessarily follow that a mainly for advertising ends was held irrelevant
contract containing the abovementioned in view of the prohibition against the making of
elements would be an insurance contact insurance contracts by companies not
The primary purpose of the parties making authorized by law.
the contract may negate the existence of It would seem, however, that the purpose of
an insurance contract the stipulation, taken with its effects in case of
A law firm which enters into contracts the death of the buyer, did not warrant a
with clients in consideration of holding that the furniture company should first
periodical payments, where it promises secure a license to engage in the insurance
to represent such clients in all suits for business. Although all the elements of an
or against them, is not engaged in an insurance contract may seem to be present,
insurance business. Its contracts are yet the furniture buyer and/or his heirs did not,
simply for the purpose of rendering under the circumstances, need the protection
personal services which the law aims to give the insuring public
A contract by which a consideration of by the requirement of a prior license.
a stipulated amount, agrees at its own
expense to defend a physician against First of all, when the buyer purchased the
all suits for damages for malpractice is furniture, he must have seen and examined it
one of insurance, and the corporation and must have believed that it was worth the
will be deemed as engaged in the amount he agreed to pay for it. Secondly, the
business of insurance furniture was delivered to him at the time of
Unlike the lawyers retainer contract, the contract and used by him thereafter. Upon
the essential purpose of such a contract his death, his heirs continued enjoying the use
is not to render personal services, but of the furniture. Therefore, the buyer and/or
to indemnify against loss or damage his heirs stood to lose nothing by the
resulting from the defense of actions questioned stipulation, and if at all, stood to
for malpractice. gain by it.
A corporation which enters into
contracts with car owners and agrees
to engage and pay for the services of a 5.3. Pre-need Plans
lawyer to handle any damage case
arising from collision of their cars, is
engaged in the insurance business and
Philamcare Health Systems vs. CA
must therefore comply with the laws
relative to the transaction of insurance
business and should be licensed as Ratio: Section 3 of the Insurance Code states that
such before it can lawfully transact any contingent or unknown event, whether past or
such business future, which may damnify a person having an
Such contracts do not provide for the insurable interest against him, may be insured
payment of any sum directly to the against. Every person has an insurable interest in
contractee, but it does provide for the the life and health of himself. Section 10 provides:
relief of the contractee from the Every person has an insurable interest in the life
expenses of employing an attorney and health (1) for himself, of his spouse and of his
It would be immaterial that the children; (2) of any person on whom he depends
contract states on its face that it is not wholly or in part for education or support, or in
a contract of insurance, for the nature whom he has a pecuniary interest; (3) of any
of the contract cannot be changed by person under a legal obligation to him for the
such a declaration payment of the money, respecting property or
service, of which death or illness might delay or
5.2. Contracts with Contingent Incidental prevent the performance; and (4) of any person
Benefit upon whose life any estate or interest vested in
In the case of Attorney General ex rel Monk vs. him depends. In the case at bar, the insurable
C.E. Osgood Co., the defendant company was interest of respondents husband in obtaining the
engaged in the business of selling household health care agreement was on his own health. The
furniture on the installment plan. Under the health care agreement was in the nature of non-life
contracts with its customers, although delivery insurance, which is primarily a contract of
would be made at the time of the contract, title indemnity. Once the member incurs hospital,
to the furniture would not pass until all medical or any other expense arising from
payments have been completed. Said sickness, injury or other stipulated contingent, the
contracts also provided that should the buyer health care provider must pay for the same to the
die before full payment of the agreed price, the extent agreed upon under the contracts.
unpaid balance would be remitted to the extent
of $500. 6. Classification under the Code
6.1. Life - defined as a mutual agreement by
The Insurance Commissioner, through the Atty. which a party agrees to pay a given sum on the
Gen., claiming that this last provision made it happening of a particular event contingent on the
an insurance contract brought suit to restrain duration of human life, in consideration of the
the defendant from pursuing its business payment of a smaller sum immediately, or in
without first securing the proper license. The periodical payments by the other party

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 131 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

The suicide is committed after the


a) Individual life policy has been in force for a period
of 2 years from date of its issue or
of its reinstatement;
Sec. 179. Life insurance is insurance on
The suicide is committed after a
human lives and insurance appertaining thereto or
shorter period provided in the
connected therewith.
policy although within the 2-year
period;
The suicide is committed in the
Sec. 180. An insurance upon life may be
state of insanity regardless of the
made payable on the death of the person, or on his
date of commission, unless suicide
surviving a specified period, or otherwise
is an excepted risk.
contingently on the continuance or cessation of life.
*Note that the policy cannot provide a
Every contract or pledge for the payment of
period longer than 2 years. So, if the policy
endowments or annuities shall be considered a life
provides for a 3-year period and suicide is
insurance contract for purpose of this Code
committed within the period but after 2
In the absence of a judicial guardian, the father, or
years, insurer is liable.
in the latter's absence or incapacity, the mother, or
When not liable:
any minor, who is an insured or a beneficiary under
Suicide is not by
a contract of life, health or accident insurance, may
reason of insanity and is committed
exercise, in behalf of said minor, any right under
within the 2-year period.
the policy, without necessity of court authority or
Suicide is by reason
the giving of a bond, where the interest of the
of insanity but is not among the
minor in the particular act involved does not
risks assumed by the insurer
exceed twenty thousand pesos. Such right may
regardless of the date of
include, but shall not be limited to, obtaining a
commission.
policy loan, surrendering the policy, receiving the
Insurer can show
proceeds of the policy, and giving the minor's
that the policy was obtained with
consent to any transaction on the policy.
the intention to commit suicide
even in the absence of any suicide
exclusion in the policy.
Sec. 180-A. The insurer in a life insurance contract
shall be liable in case of suicides only when it is
b) Group life
committed after the policy has been in force for a
period of two years from the date of its issue or of
its last reinstatement, unless the policy provides a Sec. 50. The policy shall be in printed form
shorter period: Provided, however, That suicide which may contain blank spaces; and any word,
committed in the state of insanity shall be phrase, clause, mark, sign, symbol, signature,
compensable regardless of the date of commission. number, or word necessary to complete the
(As amended by Batasang Pambansa Blg. 874) contract of insurance shall be written on the blank
spaces provided therein.
Any rider, clause, warranty or endorsement
Sec. 181. A policy of insurance upon life or purporting to be part of the contract of insurance
health may pass by transfer, will or succession to and which is pasted or attached to said policy is not
any person, whether he has an insurable interest or binding on the insured, unless the descriptive title
not, and such person may recover upon it whatever or name of the rider, clause, warranty or
the insured might have recovered. endorsement is also mentioned and written on the
blank spaces provided in the policy.
Unless applied for by the insured or owner, any
Sec. 182. Notice to an insurer of a transfer or rider, clause, warranty or endorsement issued after
bequest thereof is not necessary to preserve the the original policy shall be countersigned by the
validity of a policy of insurance upon life or health, insured or owner, which countersignature shall be
unless thereby expressly required. taken as his agreement to the contents of such
rider, clause, warranty or endorsement.
Group insurance and group annuity policies,
Sec. 183. Unless the interest of a person however, may be typewritten and need not be in
insured is susceptible of exact pecuniary printed form.
measurement, the measure of indemnity under a
policy of insurance upon life or health is the sum May be typewritten and need not be in
fixed in the policy.
printed form
Members usually a cohesive group
Insurance on human lives and insurance Pay a uniform premium
appertaining thereto or connected Usually no medical
therewith examination
Made payable on the death of a person, or Normally requires a
on his surviving a specified period, or specified number of persons insured
otherwise contingently on the continuance before policy is issued
or cessation of life
one insures ones life or that of another
against death or sickness
Effect of suicide of insured
Liability of insurer in case of suicide
When liable:

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 132 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

c) Industrial life
a) Marine
Sec. 229. The term "industrial life insurance" Sec. 99. Marine Insurance includes:
as used in this Code shall mean that form of life (1) Insurance against loss of or damage to:
insurance under which the premiums are payable (a) Vessels, craft, aircraft, vehicles, goods,
either monthly or oftener, if the face amount of freights, cargoes, merchandise, effects,
insurance provided in any policy is not more than disbursements, profits, moneys, securities, choses
five hundred times that of the current statutory in action, evidences of debts, valuable papers,
minimum daily wage in the City of Manila, and if bottomry, and respondentia interests and all other
the words "industrial policy" are printed upon the kinds of property and interests therein, in respect
policy as part of the descriptive matter. to, appertaining to or in connection with any and all
An industrial life policy shall not lapse for non- risks or perils of navigation, transit or
payment of premium if such non-payment was due transportation, or while being assembled, packed,
to the failure of the company to send its crated, baled, compressed or similarly prepared for
representative or agent to the insured at the shipment or while awaiting shipment, or during any
residence of the insured or at some other place delays, storage, transhipment, or reshipment
indicated by him for the purpose of collecting such incident thereto, including war risks, marine
premium; Provided, That the provisions of this builder's risks, and all personal property floater
paragraph shall not apply when the premium on risks;
the policy remains unpaid for a period of three (b) Person or property in connection with or
months or twelve weeks after the grace period has appertaining to a marine, inland marine, transit or
expired. transportation insurance, including liability for loss
of or damage arising out of or in connection with
the construction, repair, operation, maintenance or
Form of life insurance under which the
use of the subject matter of such insurance (but
premiums are payable either monthly or not including life insurance or surety bonds nor
oftener insurance against loss by reason of bodily injury to
Face amount of insurance provided in any any person arising out of ownership, maintenance,
policy is not more than five hundred times or use of automobiles);
that of the current statutory minimum daily (c) Precious stones, jewels, jewelry, precious
wage in the City of Manila metals, whether in course of transportation or
Shall not lapse for non-payment of otherwise;
premium if such non-payment was due to (d) Bridges, tunnels and other instrumentalities
the failure of the company to send its of transportation and communication (excluding
representative or agent to the insured at buildings, their furniture and furnishings, fixed
the residence of the insured or at some contents and supplies held in storage); piers,
other place indicated by him for the wharves, docks and slips, and other aids to
purpose of collecting such premium navigation and transportation, including dry docks
This shall not apply when the premium and marine railways, dams and appurtenant
on the policy remains unpaid for a facilities for the control of waterways.
period of three months or twelve weeks (2) "Marine protection and indemnity
after the grace period has expired. insurance," meaning insurance against, or against
legal liability of the insured for loss, damage, or
6.2. Non-life include policies covering risks to expense incident to ownership, operation,
which property may be exposed, as well as those chartering, maintenance, use, repair, or
which cover the risk of liability to third persons. It construction of any vessel, craft or instrumentality
covers a specified period of time (not more than 1 in use of ocean or inland waterways, including
year) and has a definite period of coverage. liability of the insured for personal injury, illness or
death or for loss of or damage to the property of
another person.

Ocean marine insurance an insurance


against risk connected with navigation, to
which a ship, cargo, freightage, profits or
other insurable interest in movable
property, may be exposed during a certain
voyage or a fixed period of time
Inland marine insurance it is of
comparatively recent origin and covers
primarily the land or over the land
transportation perils of property shipped by
railroads, motor trucks, airplanes, and
other means of transportation. It also
covers risks of lake, river, or other inland
waterway transportation and other
waterborne perils outside of those risks
that fall definitely within the ocean marine
category

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 133 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

The terms of which the premiums are


payable only during a limited period of
b) Fire years, usually ten, fifteen, or twenty
When the specified number of premium
Sec. 167. As used in this Code, the term "fire
insurance" shall include insurance against loss by payments have been made, the insurance
fire, lightning, windstorm, tornado or earthquake is fully paid for
and other allied risks, when such risks are covered It is like whole life policies in that it is
by extension to fire insurance policies or under payable only at the death of the insured
separate policies. If the insured should die within the
specified period, his beneficiary is entitled
to all the proceeds of the policy without any
c) Casualty or Liability Insurance liability for the unpaid premiums
Sec. 174. Casualty insurance is insurance Because of the limited number of payments
covering loss or liability arising from accident or to be made by the insured, the premiums
mishap, excluding certain types of loss which by are proportionately higher
law or custom are considered as falling exclusively c) Term plan
within the scope of other types of insurance such One which provides coverage only of the
as fire or marine. It includes, but is not limited to, insured dies during a limited period
employer's liability insurance, motor vehicle liability It is an insurance for a fixed or a specific
insurance, plate glass insurance, burglary and theft term, such as two, five, or ten years
insurance, personal accident and health insurance If the insured dies within the period
as written by non-life insurance companies, and specified, the policy is paid to the
other substantially similar kinds of insurance. beneficiary
If he survives the period, the contract
terminates
The premium paid is levied during the
d) Suretyship
specified terms and increases with each
renewal term or the amount of the
Sec. 175. A contract of suretyship is an coverage declines, and this is because as a
agreement whereby a party called the surety person ages, the risk of death increases
guarantees the performance by another party The premium is lower than in the case of
called the principal or obligor of an obligation or whole life policies because of the possibility
undertaking in favor of a third party called the that the insurer may not be obliged to pay
obligee. It includes official recognizances, anything in proceeds whatsoever if the
stipulations, bonds or undertakings issued by any insured survives the term
company by virtue of and under the provisions of d) Pure endowment plan
Act No. 536, as amended by Act No. 2206. Insured pays premium for a specified
period and should he survive the period,
the insurance company pays him the face
Sec. 176. The liability of the surety or value of the policy
sureties shall be joint and several with the obligor If he should die within the period the
and shall be limited to the amount of the bond. It is insurance company is released from any
determined strictly by the terms of the contract of liability and unless provided in the contract,
suretyship in relation to the principal contract need not reimburse any part of the
between the obligor and the obligee. (As amended premiums paid
by Presidential Decree No. 1455) e) Endowment plan
The terms of which the insurer binds
himself to pay a fixed sum to the insured if
he survives for a specified period (maturity
Sec. 178. Pertinent provisions of the Civil date stated in the policy), or if he dies
Code of the Philippines shall be applied in a within such period, to some other person
suppletory character whenever necessary in indicated
interpreting the provisions of a contract of The premium is higher because the cash
suretyship. values of the policy grow more rapidly.
This kind of policy differs from the limited
A contract of suretyship shall be deemed to payment life policy in that in the case of
be an insurance contract, only if made by a the latter, the policy is paid only upon the
surety who or which is doing an insurance death of the insured
business The insured stands a chance of being paid
the proceeds of the policy while still alive
6.3. Variations in Life Insurance Contracts The proceeds on maturity can be paid
either in a lump sum or as an annuity
a) Whole life plan
The terms of which the insured is required 7. Construction / Interpretation of
to pay a certain fixed premium annually or Insurance Contracts
at more frequent intervals throughout life
and the beneficiary is entitled to receive 7.1. Where there is Ambiguity or Doubt
payment under the policy only after the As a general rule, contracts of insurance
death of the insured are to be construed liberally in favor of the
The ultimate payment of the insurance insured and strictly against the insurer,
proceeds is as certain as death itself resolving all ambiguities against the latter,
b) Limited payment plan so as to effect its dominant purpose of

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 134 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

indemnity or payment to the insured, Ty vs. First National


especially were a forfeiture is involved
An insurance contract should be so Facts: Ty was a mechanic foreman in the
interpreted as to carry out the purpose for Broadway Cotton Factory. A fire broke out which
which the parties entered into the contract totally destroyed the factory. As Ty was fighting
which is to insure against risk of loss, his way out of the factory, he injured his left
damage or liability on the part of the hand, causing temporary total disability due to
insured fractures o his index, middle, and fourth fingers.
The insurer is under the duty to make its He filed a notice of accident and claim to recover
meaning clear if it desires to limit or restrict indemnity from First National Surety $ assurance
the operation of the general provisions of Co. Inc., pursuant to his insurance policy which
its contract by special proviso, exception or provides: the loss of a hand shall mean the
exemption loss by amputation through the bones of the
A policy of insurance which contains wrist The insurance company rejected Tys
exceptions or conditions tending to work a claim saying that since there was no severance
forfeiture of the policy shall be interpreted by amputation of the hand, the disability suffered
most favorably toward those against whom by him was not covered under the policy.
they are intended to operate and most Held: The insurance company is not liable to
strictly against the insurance company or indemnify Ty. We cannot go beyond the clear
the party for whose benefit they are and express conditions of the insurance policies,
inserted all of which define partial disability as loss of
Where restrictive provisions are open to either hand by amputation through the bones of
two interpretations, that which is most the wrist There was no amputation in this case.
favorable to the insured is adopted. The agreement contained in the insurance
Limitations of liability must be construed in policies is the law between the parties. An
such a way as to preclude the insurer from interpretation that would include the mere
non compliance with its obligations fracture or other temporary disability not covered
by the policies would certainly be unwarranted.
7.2. Where Terms are Clear
The cardinal principle of insurance law of Misamis Lumber vs. Capital Inc.
interpreting insurance contracts favorably
to the insured is applicable only in cases of Facts: Misamis Lumber Corporation, insured its
doubt, not when the intention of the policy motor car for the amount of P14,000. The
is clear or the language is sufficiently clear insured car, passed over a water whole which the
to convey the meaning of the parties driver did not see because an oncoming car did
The court is bound to adhere to the not dim its lights. The car was later towed and
repaired by Morosi Motors at a total cost of
insurance contract as the authentic
P302.27. Capital Insurance refused to pay for
expression of the intention of the parties,
the total cost of towage and repairs.
and it must be construed and enforced
Held: The insurance company is not liable for
according to the sense and meaning of the
the payment of the repairs in excess of P150.
terms which the parties themselves have
The insurance policy stipulated in paragraph 4
used.
that if the insured authorizes the repair, the
If such terms are clear and certain, they
liability of the insurer is limited to P150. The
must be taken in their plain and ordinary
literal meaning of this stipulation must control, it
sense
being the actual contract, expressly and plainly
Obligations arising from contracts have the
provided for in the policy. The policy is also drew
force of law between the contracting out not only the limits of the insurers liability but
parties and should be complied with in
also the mechanics that the insured had to follow
good faith to be entitled to full indemnity of repairs. The
option to undertake the repairs is accorded to the
7.3. Literal or Strict Interpretation insurance company per paragraph 2. The said
company was deprived of the option because the
First Quezon City Insurance vs. CA insured took it upon itself to have the repairs
made, and only notified the insurer when the
Facts: Del Rosario fell off a De Dios Marikina repairs were done. As a consequence, paragraph
Transportation Co. Inc. bus. Del Rosario was
4, which limits the companys liability to P150
brought to the hospital and stayed there for 40 applies.
days. The cost for the hospitalization amounted
to P69,444 while unearned salary due to Sun Insurance vs. CA
confinement amounted to P7,500. Del Rosario
filed a complaint against DMTC and its insurance Facts: Tan took from Sun Insurance a property
company, First Quezon City Insurance Company.
insurance worth 300K to insure his interest in the
Held: The insurance companys liability should electrical supply store of his brother housed in a
be limited to P12,000 only. The insurance policy
building in Iloilo City. Four days after, the
clearly placed the maximum limit of First Quezon building was burned down including the insured
Citys liability for damages arising from death or
store. When Tan filed a claim with the insurance
bodily at P12,000 per passenger and its company, the same was denied, after which he
maximum liability per accident at P50,000. This
asked for reconsideration which was again
means that the insurers maximum liability for denied. It is stipulated in the insurance policy
any single accident will not exceed 50K
that any action should be filed with the Insurance
regardless of the number of the passengers killed Commission or any court of competent
or injured.
jurisdiction within 12 months after receipt by the
insured of a rejection of his claim and failure to

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 135 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

do so would constitute abandonment of claim and stand. Also, except for the fact that the victims
can no longer be recoverable. were not fare-paying passengers, their status as
Held: The 12-month prescriptive period beneficiaries under the policy is recognized.
commenced upon receipt by Tan of the Even assuming there was an ambiguity,
rejection/denial of his claim by Sun Insurance ambiguities or obscurities must be strictly
and does not stop upon filing of the motion for interpreted against the party that caused them.
reconsideration. The words of the provisions in This rigid application of the rule of ambiguities
the insurance policy is clear and free from any has become necessary in view of current
doubt or ambiguity whatsoever and thus must be business practices.
taken and understood in its plain, ordinary and
popular sense. Malayan Ins. vs. CA

Fortune Insurance vs. CA Facts: TKC Marketing Corp. was the


owner/consignee of some 3,189.171 metric tons
Facts: An armored car of Producers Bank, while of soya bean meal which was loaded on board
in the process of transferring cash in the sum of the ship MV Al Kaziemah. Said cargo was insured
725K, was robbed of the said cash. After an against the risk of loss by Malayan Insurance
investigation by police authorities, the driver and Corporation. While the vessel was docked in
the guard were charged with Violation of PD 532, South Africa on September 1989 enroute to
the Anti-Highway Robbery Law. Demands were Manila, the civil authorities arrested and detained
made by the bank upon the insurance company it because of a lawsuit on a question of
to pay the amount of 725K, but the latter refused ownership and possession. TKC notified the
to pay as the loss is excluded from the coverage insurance company of the arrest of the vessel
of the insurance policy which reads: The and made a formal claim for the amount of
company shall not be liable under this policy in US$916,886.66. Malayan replied that the arrest
respect of . . . any loss caused by any dishonest, of the vessel by civil authority was not a peril
fraudulent or criminal act of the insured or any covered by the policies.
officer, employee, partner, director, trustee or Held: Malayan insurance should be held liable
authorized representative of the insured whether for the payment of the insurance claim. Since
acting alone or in conjunction with others what was also excluded in the deleted F.C. & S.
Held: The insurance company is not liable. It is Clause was "arrest" occasioned by ordinary
clear that insofar as Fortune is concerned, it was judicial process, logically, such "arrest" would
its intention to exclude and exempt from now become a covered risk under subsection 1.1
protection and coverage losses arising from of Section 1 of the Institute War Clauses,
dishonest, fraudulent, or criminal acts of persons regardless of whether or not said "arrest" by civil
granted or having unrestricted access to the authorities occurred in a state of war. It has
banks money or payroll. When it used the term been held that a strained interpretation which is
employee, it must have in mind any person unnatural and forced, as to lead to an absurd
who qualifies as such as generally and conclusion or to render the policy nonsensical,
equivocally understood, or jurisprudentially should, by all means, be avoided. Likewise, it
established in light of the determination of the must be borne in mind that such contracts are
ER-EE relationship. It is settled that the terms of invariably prepared by the companies and must
the policy constitute the measure of the insurers be accepted by the insured in the form in which
liability. In the absence of statutory prohibition they are written. Exceptions to the general
to the contrary, insurance companies have the coverage are construed most strongly against the
same rights as individuals to limit their liability company. Even an express exception in a policy
and to impose whatever conditions they deem is to be construed against the underwriters by
best upon their obligations not inconsistent with whom the policy is framed, and for whose benefit
public policy the exception is introduced.

7.4. Liberal Interpretation; Reasonable Western Guaranty vs. CA


Expectations
Facts: De Dios Transportation Inc. Figured in an
Fieldmans Inc. vs. Vda. De Songco accident when it struck Rodriguez who was
crossing the pedestrian lane on Airport Road.
Facts: Songco owned a private jeepney. He The driver ignored the stop signal given by a
was induced by an agent of Fieldmens Insurance traffic enforcer. Rodriguez was thrown to the
to apply for a Common Carriers Insurance Policy, ground and hit her head and resulted to her face
which is applicable to public utility vehicles. The getting permanently disfigured. De Dios
policy provides: the company will, subject to Transportation filed a complaint against Western
the limits of liability and under terms of this Guaranty since they were insured by Western
policy, indemnify the insured in the event of under a Master Policy which provided protection
accident caused by or arising out of the use of against third party liability.
motor vehicle against all sums which will become Held: Western Guaranty is liable to pay for the
liable to pay in respect of death or bodily injury damage caused to the victim including loss of
to any fare-paying passenger. During the earnings, moral damages and attorneys fees.
effectivity of the policy, the insured vehicle The Schedule of Indemnities does not purport to
collided with another car killing Songcos son and limit or exhaustively enumerate the species of
wounding his wife. bodily injury to the list found in the Schedule of
Held: Doctrine of estoppel applies. After leading Indemnities since an accident may result to an
Songco to believe that he could qualify under the injury to internal organs not necessarily to a loss
common carrier policy and to enter into the of limb (amputation of the leg, arm, finger, hand)
contract of insurance paying the premiums due, but such injuries are certainly covered by the
Fieldmens cannot be permitted to change its Master Plan since they constituted bodily injuries.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 136 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

Also, the Schedule of Indemnities also does not respondent, Country Bankers Insurance
purport to restrict the kind of damages that may Corporation. The policy contained the following
be paid by the insurer once liability has arisen, condition: 3. The insured shall give notice to
under the Liability to Third Party clause, and does the Company of any insurance or insurances
not say that the limit is subject to the list already effected, or which may subsequently be
indicated in the Schedule of Indemnities. All effected, covering any of the property or
other types of damages may be awarded against properties consisting of stocks in trade Fire of
the insurer once liability is shown to have arisen. accidental origin broke out at the public market
A contract of insurance is a contract of adhesion of San Francisco, Agusan del Sur. Geagonias
and must be construed strictly against the party insured stocks-in-trade were completely
which prepared the contract. destroyed prompting him to file with CBIC a
claim under the policy. The company denied the
Qua Chee Gan vs. Law Union claim and the basis of which was the petitioner's
alleged violation of Condition 3 of the policy.
Facts: This case involved a claim on a fire Held: Geagonia is not precluded from recovering
insurance policy which contained a provision as from Country Bankers. Condition 3 of the policy
to the installation of fire hydrants the number of is a condition which is not proscribed by law. Its
which depended on the height of the external incorporation in the policy is allowed by Section
wall perimeter of the bodega that was insured. 75 of the Insurance Code which provides that
When it was determined that the bodega should "[a] policy may declare that a violation of
have eleven fire hydrants in the compund as specified provisions thereof shall avoid it,
required by the terms of the policy, instead of otherwise the breach of an immaterial provision
only two that it had, the claim under the policy does not avoid the policy." Its violation would
was resisted on that ground. thus avoid the policy. However, in order to
Held: The said deviation from the terms of the constitute a violation, the other insurance must
policy did not prevent the claim under the same. be upon the same subject matter, the same
We are in agreement with the trial Court that the interest therein, and the same risk. As to a
appellant is barred by waiver (or rather estoppel) mortgaged property, the mortgagor and the
to claim violation of the so called fire hydrants mortgagee have each an independent insurable
warranty, for the reason that knowing fully that interest therein and both interests may be
the number of hydrants demanded therein never covered by one policy, or each may take out a
existed from the very beginning, the appellant separate policy covering his interest, either at the
nevertheless issued the policies in question same or at separate times. . It is a cardinal
subject to such warranty, and received the principle of law that forfeitures are not favored
corresponding premiums. It would be perilously and that any construction which would result in
received the corresponding premiums. It would the forfeiture of the policy benefits for the person
be perilously close to conniving at fraud upon the claiming, will be avoided, if it is possible to
insured to allow the appellant to claim now as construe the policy in a manner which would
void ab initio the policies that it had issue to the permit recovery, as, for example, by finding a
plaintiff without warning of their fatal defect, of waiver for such forfeiture. Provisions, conditions
which it was informed, and after it had misled the or exceptions in policies which tend to work a
defendant into believing that the policies were forfeiture of insurance policies should be
effective. When the policy contains a condition construed most strictly against those for whose
which renders it voidable at its inception, and this benefits they are inserted, and most favorably
result is known to the insurer, it will be presumed toward those against whom they are intended to
to have intended to waive the conditions and to operate.
execute a binding contract, rather than to have
deceived the insured into thinking he is insured Sun Insurance vs. CA
when in fact he is not, and to have taken his
money without consideration. The insurance Facts: Sun Insurance issued a Personal Accident
company is liable on the insurance contract. Policy to Lim with a face value of 200K. Two
months later he was dead with a bullet wound on
Del Rosario vs. Equitable Insurance his head. Lims death was caused when he was
playing with his handgun which accidentally fired.
Facts: The insurer has bound itself under the His wife sought payment on the policy but her
policy to pay P1,000-3,000 as indemnity for the claim was rejected. The contention of Sun
death of the insured for bodily injury, the policy Insurance was that Lim willfully exposed himself
containing specific amounts that may be to needless peril and thus removed himself from
recovered. The policy, however, does not the coverage of the insurance policy. Under the
positively state any definitive amount that may exceptions clause of the policy, the insurance
be recoverable in case of death by drowning, company shall not be liable when the insured
although it is a ground for recovery apart from person attempting to commit suicide or willfully
death for bodily injury. exposing himself to needless peril except in an
Held: There is an ambiguity in this respect in attempt to save human life.
the policy, which ambiguity must be interpreted Held: The cause of Lims death was an accident
in favor of the insured and strictly against the within the limits set forth in the policy and
insurer to allow a greater indemnity, that is, therefore not exempt from the liability of the
P3,000. insurer. The definition of an accident is an event
which happens without any human agency or, if
Geagonia vs. CA happening through human agency, an event
which under the circumstances, is unusual to and
Facts: Geagonia is the owner of Norman's Mart not expected by the person to whom it
located in the public market of San Francisco, happens Contrary to the contention of Sun
Agusan del Sur. He obtained from the private Insurance, Lim did not intentionally expose

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 137 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

himself to danger, as testified by his secretary,


he removed the magazine of the gun to ensure i. Delay in Acceptance; Tort Theory
that it would not fire and pointed it to his temple Situation where applicant submits
in the belief that it is safe to do so. application for insurance, but due to
negligence of company, w/c takes an
unreasonably long time before
Rizal Surety vs. CA processing the application, the
applicant dies before the application is
Facts: Rizal Surety issued a fire insurance policy processed, thus, the contract is not
for Transworld Knitting Mills. A fire broke out in perfected.
the compound of Transworld, razing the middle REMEDY: Insurer liable for damages
portion of the four-span building and partly (Tort Theory) in the amount of the face
gutting the left and right sections. It also value of the policy, w/c is given to the
destroyed the two-storey annex building where estate of the deceased applicant. (not
fun and amusement machines and spare parts to beneficiary because contract not
were stored. Transworld filed insurance claim perfected. Also, no contractual liability
with Rizal but to no avail. Rizals contention is also bec. no contact)
that the policy covered only the contents of the Why Tort Theory - because Insurance
four-span building which was only partly burned business is affected w/ public interest.
and not the damage caused to the two-storey It is thus, the duty of insurer, w/c
annex building. derives its authority to act as such from
Held: The annex building and the contents are the State (when it applies to get license
covered under the policy. The so called annex to be in the insurance business), to act
formed an integral and inseparable part of the w/ reasonable promptness in either
four-span building. It was a [permanent rejecting or accepting the application.
structure which adjoined the 4-storey building In case of unreasonable delay and
described in the policy and consequently, the applicant dies, applicant would have
things stored therein were covered by the been deprived of opportunity to secure
insurer. Considering that the annex was already insurance from another source.
existing when the insurance policy was
contracted, Rizal should have specifically ii. Delivery of the Policy
excluded it from the coverage of the fire Delivery the act of putting the
insurance if it wanted to but it did not. Doubt insurance policy the physical
should be resolved against Rizal who drafted the document into the possession of the
insurance policy contract. This is because the insured.
insured usually has no voice in the selection or Individual life insurance contracts
arrangement of the words employed and that the usually stipulate that:
language of the contract is selected with great Premium be paid and
care and deliberation by experts and legal Policy be delivered to the
advisers employed by, and acting exclusively in insured while he is alive and in
the interest of the insurance companies. good health. Concurrence of both is
necessary. (see Perez v CA case)
Gulf Resorts vs Philippine Charter Insurance Actual delivery of the policy is not
Corporation (2005)
essential unless the parties have so
agreed in clear language. Constructive
Intention of parties is shown by provisions of
delivery may be sufficient. (See Vda.
contracts and the amount of premium paid since
De Sindayen case)
premium is the consideration paid for the risk
WoN policy was delivered after its
undertaken by the insurer. When there is an
issuance depends not upon manual
apparent change of the wording of an insurance
possession by the insured but rather
contract but no corresponding change in the
upon the intention of the parties as
amount of premium paid, it will be interpreted to
manifested in their acts or agreements.
mean that there was no intended change at all.
WON Delivery to agent is delivery to
An assumption of additional risk is presumed to
insured is a question over w/c there
cause a commensurate additional premium
because the premium, not the mere wording of has been many conflicting opinions.
the policy, is a more accurate indication of such Effect of Delivery:
an assumption of additional risk. Where delivery is conditional
Non-performance of Condition
precedent prevents contract from
8. Perfection of the Contract of Insurance
taking effect
Where delivery is unconditional if
8.1. Offer and Acceptance; consensuality
corresponding terms of application,
Applicant usually makes the offer to the
ordinarily consummates the
insurer. contract and policy as delivered
Submission of application, even w/ becomes final contract between the
payment is a mere offer on the part of the parties. Where parties so intend,
applicant, it does not bind the insurer. insurance becomes effective at the
Approval of the application by the insurer is same time as delivery
necessary to perfect contract. If made: Where premium still unpaid after
- w/ payment of premium policy unconditional delivery Policy will
becomes effective lapse if premium unpaid at time
- w/o payment effective upon and manner specified in the policy,
payment of premium in the absence of any clear

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 138 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

agreement that insurer will extend Held: NO. Under the CC, Consent is shown by the
credit. Insurer cannot be presumed concurrence of offer and acceptance. An
to have extended credit from the acceptance shall not bind the person making the
mere fact of unconditional delivery offer except from the time it came to his
of the policy w/o prepayment of knowledge.
premium, and even if such
presumption may be inferred, there 8.2. Premium Payment
must be a clear and express Sec. 77 &78; 64
acceptance by insured of the
insurers offer to extend credit.
Sec. 7712 An Insurer is entitled to payment of the
premium as soon as the thing insured is exposed to
Perez v CA
the peril insured against. Notwithstanding any
agreement to the contrary, no policy or contract of
Facts: Perez, already previously insured with BF
insurance issued by an insurance company is valid
Lifeman Insurance Co. applied for additional
and binding unless and until the premium thereof
coverage. He paid premium and was issued a
has been paid, except in the case of a life or an
receipt by the agent of BF Lifeman. However, he
industrial life policy whenever the grace period
died before his application papers were transmitted
provision applies.
to the head office of BF Lifeman.
Issue: WON the insurance policy was perfected
Held: No. There was no acceptance of the offer. Premium the agreed price for assuming
The perfection of the contract was conditioned and carrying the risk, that is, the
upon compliance with the provision in the consideration paid an insurer for undertaking
application form w/c stated that perfection only lies to indemnify the insured against the specified
when the applicant pays and the premium and peril.
receives and accepts the policy while still in good - if only one premium is paid for
health. Thus, the assent of BF Life was not given several things not separately valued or
when it merely received the application form of separately insured, the contract is indivisible
Perez in its provincial office. Also, delivery to Perez or entire, not divisible or severable, as to
would be impossible as he is already dead. So long items insured.
as an application for insurance has not been SIR: WORST SECTION of the Insurance
accepted or rejected by the insurer, it is merely an Code. This is the cash-and-carry provision
offer or proposal to make a contract. The contract (see below for explanation why)
to be binding from date of application must have Why it raises several questions (Campos):
been a completed contract that leaves nothing to --Is it intended to apply to all classes of
be done, passed upon or determined, before it shall insurance, or does the word thing limit it to
take effect.. property insurance? As to exception, it only
applies to life policies w/in the grace period
Vda. De Sindayen v Insular Life Assurance Co. w/c does not support the theory that it
applies only to property insurance.
FACTS Dec. 1932 Arturo Sindayen had partially - As to grace period, grace period in life
paid his agent the first premium for a life insurance insurance applies only to premiums
policy. Agent and Sindayen agreed that policy, subsequent to the first, therefore, how can
when and if issued, should be delivered to this be an exception to the rule?
Sindayens aunt who will complete the payment of - With respect to non-life policies, the first
the first annual premium. Jan. 16, 1933 agent sentence gives the insurer the right to
received approved policy and delivered it to demand the payment of the premium as
Sindayens aunt on Jan. 18. However, before the soon as the thing insured is exposed to
policy was given to Arturo himself, he died on Jan. peril insured against This assumes the
19. contract is binding even before the
ISSUE: WON Insular Life assumed the risk covered payment of the premium meaning the
by Sindayens policy contract is perfected when the applicants
HELD: YES. Delivery to the insured in person is not offer is accepted by the insurer. This
necessary, and may be made by mail or duly assumption is inconsistent w/ the next
constituted agent (in this case, Sindayens aunt). sentence w/c says that no policy can be
Insurance company is bound by the acts of its binding w/o premium payment.
agent. In this case, the agent is not a mere - Also, Sec. 77 and 78 seem contradictory.
automaton and is vested w/ some discretion in - However, Sir says above does not apply
deciding WON the condition as to the health of the to life insurance because Life Insurance
applicant has been complied with. Once he decides lapses upon non-payment.
that it has and delivers the policy, then, in the Present provision came from Sec 72 of the
absence of fraud, the insurance company is old Insurance Code. However, Sec. 77 has
estopped from claiming the policy has no effect. omitted the portion of Sec. 72 w/c permitted
credit extension of the premium due
Enriquez v Sun Life Assurance Co. (meaning, extension of period to pay the
premium). Apparently, the intention is to put
Facts: Herrer applied for insurance and paid the the contract of insurance on a cash-and-
premium, however, he died before he received the carry basis meaning the premium must be
notice of acceptance (of his application) sent by paid in cash as a condition precedent for a
Sun Life from its Montreal head office. non-life insurance policy to be valid and
Issue: WON the insurance contract was perfected binding, and an agreement to grant the
w/o the notice of acceptance coming to the
knowledge of the applicant 12
This was asked 2006, 1978, and 1977. Note the
effects of non-payment of premiums.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 139 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

insured credit extension of the premium is


(f) a determination by the Commissioner
void. However, Makati Tuscany v CA and the
that the continuation of the policy would violate
second UCPB case says otherwise. Hence,
or would place the insurer in violation of this
credit extension agreements may be valid.
Code
EXCEPTIONS to Sec. 77:
In the case of a life or an industrial policy Cancellation right to rescind, abandon or cancel
whenever the grace period provision a contract of insurance, termination of policy
applies (Sec. 77) before its expiration.
Article 78 (see below) Premium referred to in 64(a) refers to payment
Agreement to grant the insured credit after effective date of the policy because Sec.
extension for the payment of the 77 ordains that insurance policy is valid and
premium binding unless and until premium has been paid.
When there is an agreement allowing the Conditions under w/c above exercised:
insured to pay premium in installment Prior notice of
and partial payment has been made at cancellation to insured
the time of the loss (See Makati Tuscany Notice must be based
v CA) on the occurrence, after the effective date of
the policy, of one or more of the grounds
mentioned
BPI vs. Posadas, 56 Phil. 215 It must be in writing,
If the premiums are paid out of the conjugal funds, mailed or delivered to the named insured at
the proceeds are considered conjugal. If the the address shown in the policy. In this
beneficiary is other than the insureds estate, the regard, proof of actual receipt of the notice is
source of premiums would not be relevant. necessary for it to take effect; mere proof
that the insurer mailed the notice is not
sufficient to effect the cancellation.
Philippine Pryce Assurance Corp. vs. CA, 230 It must state w/c of
SCRA 164 (1994) the ground set forth is relied upon.
Generally, premium is also necessary in order for It is the duty of the
the contract of suretyship or bond to be binding. insurer upon written request of the insured to
However, where the oblige has accepted the bond, furnish the facts in which the cancellation is
it is binding even if the premium has not been paid based.
subject to the right of the insurer to recover the If there was no premium paid at all, the action
premium from its principal. appropriate would be a declaration of nullity,
based on Section 77 which provides that no
Sec. 78 An acknowledgment in a policy or contract policy or contract of insurance issued by an
of insurance of receipt of premium is conclusive insurance company is valid and binding unless
evidence of its payment, so far as to make the and until the premium thereof has been paid
policy binding, notwithstanding any stipulation
therein that it shall not be binding until the Tibay v CA
premium is actually paid
Facts: Fortune Life issued a fire insurance policy
in favor of Tibay on a bldg in Makati, together w/
Effect of acknowledgment of receipt of all their personal effects therein. Violeta paid part
premium in property Insurer cannot deny the of the total premium. 2 mos. Afer, a fire
truth of the receipt of the premium even if it is completely destroyed the bldg. 2 days after the
unpaid. fire, Tibay paid the balance of the premium.
Law established a legal fiction of payment Fortune denied Tibays claim for violation of
(prima facie evidence of payment). Thus insurer Sec77 of Insurance Code.
presumed to have waived the condition of Issue: WON a fire insurance policy is already
prepayment. valid, binding and enforceable upon mere partial
SC has decided that above is an exception payment of premium
to Sec. 77 Held: NO Sec. 77 applies. Since acceptance of
partial payment is not mentioned among the
exceptions provided in Sec 77 and 78 of the
Sec. 64 No policy of insurance other than life shall
Insurance Code, no policy of insurance can ever
be cancelled by the insurer except upon prior
pretend to be efficacious until premium has been
notice thereof to the insured, and no notice of
fully paid.
cancellation shall be effective unless it is based on
- The policy contained a condition w/c said that
the occurrence, after the effective date of the
The policy including any renewal thereof is not in
policy, of one or more of the following:
force until the premium has been fully paid x x x
(a) non-payment of premium;
Clearly, the Policy provides for payment of
(b) conviction of a crime arising out of acts
premium in full.
increasing the hazard insured against;
Dissent: (IMPT) The insurance coverage should
(c) discovery of fraud or material
become effective from the day that the partial
misrepresentation
payment is accepted by the insurer, any
(d) discovery of willful or reckless acts or
stipulation in the policy to the contrary
omissions increasing the hazard insured
notwithstanding. Partial payment is enough to
against;
establish the juridical relation between the two
(e) physical changes in the property
parties. The law does not require a specific
insured which result in the property becoming
amount of premium payment in order to create
uninsurable; or
the juridical tie.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 140 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

- If the contract is automatically cancelled upon that the fire took place before the tender of
the non-payment in full by the insured, then the premium payment under the renewed policy.
efficacy of the contract will be fully dependent on (Note: This is a motion for reconsideration from
his will. This violates the principle of mutuality of previous SC decision declaring that there was no
contracts. renewal of the policy and that UCPB not liable)
Issue: WON Sec 77 of the Insurance Code must
be strictly applied despite its practice of granting
a 60-90 day credit term for payment of premium
Held: NO There are exceptions to Sec 77:
a.) The first is provided by Sec. 77 itself and
Makati Tuscany v CA that is, in case of a life or industrial life policy
whenever the grace period applies
Facts: American Home Assurance (AHAC) issued b.) Sec 78: An acknowledgment in a policy or
in favor or Makati Tuscany an insurance policy on contract of insurance of the receipt of premium is
the latters bldg for 1 year. It was renewed over conclusive evidence of its payment, so far as to
the course of 3 years. In 1982, the total make the policy binding, notwithstanding any
premiums were paid in four installments but in stipulation therein that it shall not be binding
1983, Tuscany paid only 2 installments and until premium is actually paid.
refused to pay the remaining balance. Reason for c.) Sec. 77may not apply if the parties have
discontinuation: policy contained a reservation agreed to the payment in installments of the
wherein Acceptance of payment by AHAC will premium and partial payment has been made at
not waive any of the company rights to deny the time of the loss.
liability on any claim under the policy arising d.) The insurer may grant credit extension for
before such payments or after the expiration of the payment of the premium
the credit clause of the policy, and Subject to no e.) It would be unjust and inequitable if
loss prior to premium payment. If there be any recovery on the policy would not be permitted
loss, such is not covered. AHAC filed a suit to against UCPB, w/c consistently granted the 60-90
recover the remaining balance. Makati Tuscany day credit term for the payment of the premiums
filed counterclaim for the total amount of despite its full awareness of Sec. 77. Estoppel
premiums it had paid during the previous years. bars it from taking refuge under the action, since
Issue: WON payment by installment of Masagana relied on good faith on such a practice
premiums due on an insurance policy invalidates Dissent (Vitug):
the contract of insurance -Estoppel cannot create a contract of insurance
Held: NO The policies are valid even if the neither can it be invoked to create a PRIMARY
premiums paid in installments because the LIABILITY. So essential is the premium payment
records clearly show that the two parties to the creation of the vinculum juris that it would
intended the policies to be binding and effective be doubtful to have that payment validly excused
notwithstanding the staggered payment of the even for a fortuitous event
premiums. Te acceptance of the installment Dissent (Pardo):
payments over the period of 3 years speak loudly - Masagana tried to pay the overdue premiums
of intention of insurer to honor the policies it before giving written notice that a fire has razed
issued to Makati Tuscany. the property. This shows the fraudulent character
- Sec 77 merely prohibits the parties from of the claim. Failure to give notice is was a
stipulating that the policy is valid even if material misrepresentation affecting the risk
premiums were not paid, but it does not insured against.
expressly prohibit an agreement granting credit - Estoppel cannot give validity to an act that is
extensions. Sec. 78 also allows the insurer to prohibited by law or against public policy. Actual
waive the condition of full payment by payment of premiums is a condition precedent to
acknowledging in the policy that there has been the validity of an insurance contract other than
receipt of premium despite the fact that premium the insurance policy. Any agreement to the
is actually unpaid. If the Code allows a waiver contrary is VOID as against the law and public
when no actual payment has been made, then a policy.
waiver should also be allowed in this case where
the insurer has already acknowledged receipt of
partial payment.
NOTE: Difference with Tibay case: In Tibay, there
was an express stipulation w/c said that payment
shall be made in full. In this case, the policy was
binding because of the prior agreement to allow
installment payments, hence full payment under
Sec.77 deemed waived.

UCPB Gen. Ins. v Masagana Telemart

Facts: Masagan Telemart obtained insurance


policies on its properties from UCPB. The policies
had the effectivity term of May 1991 May 1992.
On June 1992, Masagans properties were razed
by a fire. On the same day, Masagana tenedered,
and UCPB accepted renewal premium payments.
The next day, Masagana filed a claim for the
burned insured bldgs. UCPB rejected the claims
on the ground that the polices exprired on May
1992 and were not renewed for another term and

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 141 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

Cash Surrender Value


The amount the insured, in case of
default, after the payment of at least 3
full annual premiums, is entitled to
receive if he surrenders the policy and
releases his claims upon it. It is the
portion of reserve on a life policy.
Nature of CSV: Premium is uniform
throughout lifetime of policy, so during
8.3. Premium default in life insurance (Sec the earlier years of the policy, the
227, h & j); options; lapsed policy premium charges will be more than the
actual cost of the protection against the
risk in order to meet the higher cost of
Sec. 227 In the case of individual life or
risk during the latter years of the policy
endowment insurance, the policy shall contain in
when the insured is older. Reserve
substance the following conditions: x x x
Value - Surrender Charge = Cash
(h) A table showing in figures cash surrender
Surrender Value
values and paid-up options available under the
The more premiums he has paid, the
policy each year upon default in premium
greater will be the CSV but the value is
payments, during at least twenty years of the
always a lesser sum than the total amt
policy beginning with the year in which the values
of premiums paid.
and options first become available, together with a
CSV is the amount company holds in
provision that in the event of the failure of the
trust for insured deliverable upon
policy-holder to elect one of the said options within
demand. So long as the policy remains
the time specified in the policy, one of the said
in force, the company has practically no
options shall automatically take effect and no
beneficial interest in it except as its
policyholder shall ever forfeit his right to same by
custodian; this is the practical, though
reason of his failure to so elect.
not the legal, relation of the company
x x x x x x x x x x x x
to this fund.
(j)A provision that the policy shall be entitled to
EFFECT: Surrender policy; terminates
have the policy reinstated at any time within 3
the contract of insurance
years from the date of default of premium payment
Extende
unless tha cash surrender value has been duly
d
paid, or the extension period has expired, upon
Insuran
production of evidence of insurablility satisfactory
ce
to the company and upon payment of all overdue
EFFECT: Policy continues in force from
premiums and any indebtedness to the company
upon said policy, with interest rate not exceeding date of default, for a period either
stated or equal to the amount of the
that which would have been applicable to said
premiums and indebtedness in athe policy years cash surrender value, taken as a single
premium, will purchase; the insured is
prior to reinstatement x x x
given the right, upon default, after the
payment of at least three full annual
NON-LIFE premiums to have the policy continued
(Refer to Sec.77) Seems to say that policy is in in force from the date of default for a
effect as soon as the thing is exposed to risk time either stated or equal to the
even if the premium has not been paid yet. amount as the net value of the policy
Where contract covers a period of 1 year, there taken as a single premium, will
would normally be only one premium payment purchase Also called term insurance,
for the period. temporary insurance or paid-up
If parties agreed to pay in installments, and extended insurance
there is a failure to pay any installment when it Depends on availability of CSV.
falls due insurer may: During extended period: If insured
- cancel policy after due notice dies, beneficiary can recover face
- compel the payment of installments amount of policy. Insured can also
reinstate the policy w/in this period.
LIFE Beyond extended period: If he survives
Intended to be in force for a period longer than No benefits. He cannot even reinstate
a year; involves several periodical premium the policy by paying past premiums;
payments (annual, semi-annual, etc) has to purchase new policy
Contract not binding until first periodical Better option if insured not in good
premium payment. After first payment, insured health or geriatric
under no legal obligation to pay subsequent Paid-up Insurance
premium. Amount of Insurance that the
Insurance Code grants grace period within CSV, applied as a single premium, can
which to pay subsequent premiums. If policy purchase.
becomes a claim during the grace period but EFFECT: Policy continues in force
before overdue premium is paid, overdue may from date of default for the whole
be deducted from proceeds of policy period and under the same conditions
Failure to pay w/in grace period = automatic of the original contract w/o further
lapse payment of premiums. However, in
Exception: Insured has paid three full annual case of death of insured, he may
recover only the paid-up value of the
premiums. Entitled to the following Options
policy w/c is much less than the
upon default:
original amount agreed upon. (In other

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 142 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

words, na-reduce yung original


insurance contract to one with a lower
Sec. 49 The written instrument in which a contract
value)
of insurance is set forth is called a policy insurance.
Better option if insured is still
young and in good health because
unlike extended insurance, he may
Sec. 50 The policy shall be in printed form which
later reinstate policy if he wishes.
may contain blank spaces; and any word, phrase,
Automatic Premium Loan
clause, mark, sign, symbol, signature, number, or
Upon default,
word necessary to complete the contract of
insurer lends/advances to the
insurance shall be written on the blank spaces
insured without any need of
provided therein.
application on his part, amount
Any rider, clause, warranty, or
necessary to pay overdue premium,
endorsement purporting to be part of the contract
but not to exceed the CSV of the policy.
of insurance and which is pasted or attached to
Only applies if
said policy is not binding on the insured, unless the
requested in writing by the insured
descriptive title or name of the rider, clause,
either in the application or at any time
warranty, or endorsement is also mentioned and
before the expiration of the grace
written on the black spaces provided in the policy.
period.
Unless applied for by the insured or owner,
EFFECT: Insurance
any rider, clause, warranty or endorsement issued
continues in force for period covered by
after the original policy shall be countersigned by
the payment. After period, if insured
the insured or owner, which countersignature shall
still does not resume paying his
be taken as his agreement to the contents of such
premiums, policy lapses, unless there
rider, clause, warranty, or endorsement.
remains CSV.
Group insurance and group annuity
If there is still CSV,
policies, however, may be typewritten and need
auto premium loan continues until it is
not be in printed form.
exhausted.
Advantageous to
the insured because it helps to continue
Sec 51. A policy of insurance must specify:
the contract and all its features in full
(a) The parties between whom the contract is
force and effect.
made;
Insured under no
(b) The amount to be insured except in the
legal obligation to repay loan
cases of open or running policies;
Reinstatem
(c) The premium, or if the insurance is of a
ent (Sec j)
character where the exact premium is only
EFFECT: Does not
determinable upon the termination of the
create a new contract, merely REVIVES
contract, a statement of the basis and rates
the old policy. Thus, insurer cannot
upon which the final premium is to be
require higher premium than amount
determined;
stipulated in the contract.
(d) The property or life insured;
Required by
(e) The interest of the insured in property
Insurance Code for every individual and
insured, if he is not he absolute owner thereof;
industrial life policy
(f) The risks insured against; and
Not required that 3
(g) The period during which the insurance is
annual premiums have been paid
to continue
REQUISITES:
exercised w/in 3 years from
default The Insurance Code does not require a
insured must present evidence of particular form for the validity of the
insurability satisfactory to the contract. However, the policy must contain
company the enumeration in Art. 51 (see above)
pay all back premiums and all The policy is different from the contract
his indebtedness to the insurance itself.
company Policy - written instrument embodying
CSV has not been duly paid nor the terms and stipulations of a contract of
the extension period expired insurance. Not essential to the validity of
Insurability does not mean that the contract as long as all the essential
insured is in good health. Other factors elements for the existence of contract are
affect insurability like nature of work, age, present. (Consent, object, consideration,
etc. competent parties)
Application for reinstatement Other stipulations not required by law
must be filed during the insureds lifetime. may be included as long as they are not
prohibited or inconsistent with the law.
Other Effect: Missing provisions required does not void
Forfeiture Absolute policy. Missing provisions will be read into
forfeiture of all insured rights. Generally the policy and will substitute those w/c are
not favored. Due to liberal spirit in the in conflict w/ the law.
conduct of life insurance, insurers instead, Stipulations not in the exact terms of the
give the insurer the benefit of the reserve statute, if more favorable to the insured,
value of the policy. will be enforced.
SIR (on oral contracts): In some
8.4. Form and contents of policy jurisdictions of the US, oral contract is

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 143 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

valid, provided that all the terms are In case of conflict between rider and
agreed upon. In our Insurance Code, printed stipulation, the rider prevails as
although written form not required for being a more deliberate expression of the
validity, some provisions say that a agreement of the contracting parties.
PRINTED POLICY is best evidence of Warranty inserted or attached to a
contract. SC has not ruled categorically on policy to eliminate specific potential
this matter. increases of hazard during the policy term
The following are required to appear in owing to: 1) actions of the insured or 2)
insurance policies: condition of the property.
The policy, which must be in Clause an agreement between the
printed form (except group insurance insurer and the insured on certain matters
policies which may be typewritten), may relating to the liability of the insurer in case
contain blank spaces; any word, phrase, of loss.
clause, mark, sign, symbol, signature, Endorsement any provision added to an
number, or word necessary to complete insurance contract altering its scope or
the contract of insurance shall be written application. Ex. Endorsements extending
on the blank spaces provided. the perils covered. Most times, they are
Any rider, clause, warranty, or merely typewritten additions to the
endorsement may only be deemed part contract, changing its amount, rate, or
of the insurance policy if, after having term.
been attached to the policy itself, its
descriptive title or name is also
mentioned and written in the blank
spaces in the policy.
Required clauses in the policy:
The parties between whom
the contract is made; ii. Cover Notes or binding receipts
The amount to be
insured except in the cases of
open or running policies; Sec 52. Cover notes may be issued to bind
The premium, or if the insurance temporarily pending the issuance of the
insurance is of a character where policy. Within sixty days after issue of a cover note,
the exact premium is only a policy shall be issued in lieu thereof, including
determinable upon the termination within its terms the identical insurance bound
of the contract, a statement of the under the cover note and the premium therefore.
basis and rates upon which the final Cover notes may be extended or renewed
premium is to be determined; beyond such sixty days with the written approval of
The property or life the Commissioner if he determines that such
insured; extension is not contrary to and is not for the
The interest of the purpose of violating any provisions of this Code.
insured in property insured, if he The Commissioner may promulgate rules and
is not the absolute owner thereof; regulations governing such violation and may be
The risks insured such rules and regulations dispense with the
against; and requirement of written approval by him in the case
The period during which of extension in compliance with such rules and
the insurance is to continue. regulations (n)
Express warranties
must also be contained in the policy, or in Cover notes/Binders a written
another instrument signed by the insured memorandum of the most important items of a
and referred to in the policy as making a preliminary ocntract intended to give
part of it. temporary protection (to insured) pending the
investigation of the risk by the insurer, or until
i. Riders, clauses, endorsements the issue of the formal policy, provided it is
If parties wish to include special later determined that the applicant was
stipulations, may attach riders, insurable at the time it was given.
endorsements, warranties. It is a binding contract and has full force
Rider a printed or typed stipulation and effect during its duration.
contained on a slip of paper attached to the Insurer not obliged to give cover notes but
policy and forming an integral part of the many do so in order to gain goodwill.
policy. Usually contain only the bare essentials of
To be binding: an insurance contract: i.e. the name of the
-Must be attached/pasted to the policy parties, risk insured against, amount of
- Descriptive title or name of the rider, insurance, premium, property/life insured.
clause, warranty, or endorsement is Issuance of cover notes is ordinarily a
mentioned and written on the blank spaces conclusive evidence of making a contract
provided in the policy. The issuance and effectivity of cover notes
Countersignature by insured are governed by the following rules:
General Rule: Not necessary if rider 1) May be issued temporarily, pending
attached to the policy when issued. issuance of policy
Exception: Necessary when added AFTER 2) Deemed a contract of insurance
policy is issued. REASON: To prevent an insurer within meaning of 1[1]
from adding or inserting provisions w/o the
consent of the insured.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 144 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

3) No cover note may be issued or renewed 2) Value of the thing insured


unless in the Codes previously prescribed - In the absence of fraud or mistake, the agreed
form value of the thing insured will be paid in case of
4) Cover notes are valid and binding for total loss of the property, unless the insurance is
a period not over 60 days from date of for a lower amount
issuance, whether or not premium - In case of loss, parties may claim that value of
therefor has been paid, but it may only be insured property is more or less than agreed upon.
cancelled by either party upon at least 7 - The liability of the insurer in a life policy is
days notice to other party measured by the face value of the policy (because
5) If it is not cancelled, policy shall, the value of a human life cannot be measured in
within 60 days after issuance of cover actual monetary terms).
note, be issued in lieu thereof. Policy will
include within its terms the identical Running Policy
insurance bond under the cover note and - Intended to provide indemnity for property w/c
the premium therefor cannot well be covered by a valued policy because
6) Cover note may be extended or of its frequent change of location and quantity, or
renewed beyond the 60-day period for property of such a nature as not to admit of a
with the written approval of the gross valuation. Also denotes insurance over a
Insurance Commission, provided that class of property rather than any particular thing.
the written approval may be dispensed with Ex. Insurance over constantly changing stock of
upon the certificate of the Pres, VP, or goods
general manager of the company that the - In reality, these are open policies.
risks involved, the values of such risks - Contemplates successive insurances.
and/or premiums therefor have not as yet - Advantages of a running policy
been determined or established and that 1) Neither underinsured nor
such extension or renewal is not contrary overinsured at any time, premium being
to and is not for the purpose of violating based on monthly values reported;
any provisions of the Insurance Code, or of 2) Avoids cancellations otherwise
any of the rulings, instructions, circulars, necessary to keep insurance adjusted to
orders or decisions of the Insurance the things value at each location and for
Commissioner which cancellations the inured would be
7) Companies may impose on cover notes a charged the expensive short rate;
deposit premium equivalent to at least 3) Saves trouble of watching the
25% of the estimated premium of the insurance and danger of being
intended insurance coverage but never less underinsured in spite of care, through
than 500 pesos. oversight or mistake;
4) Rate is adjusted to 100% insurance,
iii. Open and Valued Policies (non-life) whereas valued policies requiring insurance
only up to, say 80% of value, give either a
small, if any, reduction for amounts of
Sec 59. A policy is either open, valued or running.
insurance above this figure.
Sec 60. An open policy is one in which the value of
the thing insured is not agreed upon, but is left to
be ascertained in case of loss. 9. Parties

Sec 61. A valued policy is one which expresses on Essential Requisites for a person to be a party
its face an agreement that the thing insured shall in an insurance contract:
be valued at a specified sum. Must be COMPETENT to enter (has
capacity)
Sec. 62. A running policy is one which Must possess INSURABLE INTEREST
contemplates successive insurances, and which Must NOT be a PUBLIC ENEMY13
provides that the object of the policy may be from
time to time defined, especially as to the subjects 9.1. Insurer
of insurance, by additional statements or
indorsements.
Sec. 6. Every person, partnership, association, or
corporation duly authorized to transact insurance
8.5. Kinds of insurance policies: business as elsewhere provided in this Code, may
be an insurer. (a)
Open or Unvalued Policy
- One in which a certain agree sum is written on
the face of the policy not as the value of the Sec 184 For purposes of this Code, the term
property insured, but as the maximum limit of the insurer or insurance company shall include all
insurers liability (i.e. face value) in case of individuals, partnerships, associations, or
destruction by the peril insured against. corporations, including government-owned or
- Insurer only pays the actual cash value of the controlled corporations or entities, engaged as
property as determined at the time of loss. principals in the insurance business, excepting
mutual benefit associations. Unless the context
Valued Policy otherwise requires, the term shall also include
- One in which the parties expressly agree on the professional reinsurers, defined in Section 280.
value of the subject matter of the insurance. Domestic company shall include companies
-Two values:
1) Face value of the policy w/c is the max amt 13
Who is a public enemy and the prohibition was
insurer pays in case of loss asked in 2002.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 145 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

formed, organized or existing under the laws of the Art. 110 (Family Code) The spouses retain the
Philippines. Foreign company when used without ownership, possession, administration and
limitation shall include companies formed, enjoyment of their exclusive properties.
organized, or existing under any laws other than
those in the Philippines. Either spouse may, during the marriage, transfer
the administration of his or her exclusive property
to the other by means of a public instrument,
Sec 185 Corporations formed or organized to save which shall be recorded in the registry of property
any person or persons or other corporations of the place the property is located. (137a, 168a,
harmless from loss, damage, or liability arising 169a)
from any unknown or future or contingent event, or
to indemnify or to compensate any person or
persons or other corporations for any such loss, Art. 111 (Family Code) A spouse of age may
damage, or liability, or to guarantee the mortgage, encumber, alienate or otherwise dispose
performance of or compliance with contractual of his or her exclusive property, without the
obligations or the payment of debts or others shall consent of the other spouse, and appear alone in
be known as insurance corporations court to litigate with regard to the same. (n)
The provisions of the Corporation Law (BP
Blg 68) shall apply to all insurance corporations
now or hereafter engaged in business in the Art. 1390 (Civil Code). The following contracts
Philippines insofar as they do not conflict with the are voidable or annullable, even though there may
provisions of this Chapter. have been no damage to the contracting parties:
(1) Those where one of the parties is incapable of
giving consent to a contract;
Insurer party who assumes or accepts the
risk of loss and undertakes for a consideration
(2) Those where the consent is vitiated by mistake,
to indemnify the insured or to pay him a
violence, intimidation, undue influence or fraud.
certain sum on the happening of a specified
contingency or event; This can be an individual,
These contracts are binding, unless they are
a corporation, an association, even the State,
annulled by a proper action in court. They are
as long as it is authorized to engage in a
susceptible of ratification.
business of insurance.
Summary of 184 and 185:
184: What term insurer includes Insured the party in whose favor the
185: What Insurance Corporations are contract is operative and who is indemnified
regulated by the State: To engage in the against, or is to receive a certain sum upon the
business of insurance, required to get happening of a specified contingency or event.
certificate of authority from the Insurance He is the person whose loss is the occasion for
Commissioner, and must possess sufficient the payment of the proceeds by the insurer;
capital assets. (Will not include other But the proceeds need not go to him but the
requirements, medyo technical. We only need designated beneficiary or someone the insured
to know defn of insurer and insurance assigns the proceeds to.
corporations); Banking institutions are not As in all other contracts, only persons who
allowed to engage in insurance business have the capacity to enter into a contract may
(General Banking Act 173) be insured.
Policy must specify the parties between whom
9.2. Insured the contract is made. (Sec. 51)
Public enemy citizen or subject of a nation
Sec. 7 Anyone except a public enemy must be at war with the Philippines. Does not include
insured robbers, thieves, criminals.
- a private corporation may be deemed an
enemy corporation if controlled by enemy
Sec. 56 When the description of the insured in a aliens.
policy is so general that it may comprehend any
person or any class of persons, only he who can 9.3. Beneficiaries
show that it was intended to include him can claim
the benefit under the policy. Sec 11 The insured shall have the right to change
the beneficiary he designated in the policy, unless
he has expressly waived this right in said policy.
RA 6809 - Lowered the age of EMANCIPATION
AND AGE OF MAJORITY
Art. 234. Emancipation takes place by the Refers to the person who designated in a
attainment of majority. Unless otherwise provided, contract of life, health or accident insurance as
majority commences at the age of eighteen years. the one who is to receive the benefits which
(as amended by RA 6809) become payable, according to the terms of the
contract, upon the death of the insured.
Art. 236. Emancipation for any cause shall Words used in designating the beneficiaries of a
terminate parental authority over the person and life policy will not be given their technical
property of the child who shall then be qualified significance but will be construed broadly.
and responsible for all acts of civil life, save the Chosen exclusively by insured who may
exceptions established by existing laws in special designate anyone (irrespective of lack of
cases. x x x (as amended by RA 6809) insurable interest) so long as s/he not
disqualified by law.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 146 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

Proceeds of life insurance policy become the would not have intended to extend such
exclusive property of the beneficiary upon the provision of funds to the heirs/ assignees of
death of the insured. the beneficiary.
Cestui que vie
- Person on whose life the policy was In designating the
taken. beneficiaries, words used will not be given
- Must be a risk acceptable to the insurer their technical significance but will be
Kinds of beneficiaries either insured himself broadly construed so that the benefit shall
or his personal representatives or someone be received by those intended by the
other than the insured. If others are recipients, insured as the object of his bounty.
their relations to the insured may be:
The interest of a
Insured himself one who bought beneficiary in a life insurance policy shall be
the policy and paid the premiums. forfeited when the beneficiary is the
Such is an immediate party to the principal, accomplice, or accessory in
contract and is usually called the willfully bringing about the death of the
assured (creditor insures debtors insured. In this case, the nearest relative of
life). the insured shall receive the proceeds of
said insurance if not otherwise disqualified
Third person who paid a
consideration - as when insured The right to receive the
took up the policy for the benefit of proceeds of life insurance policies shall
the creditor or to secure some follow the order of intestate succession in
other obligation; or the Civil Code in default of any specific
designation in the policy:
Third person through mere bounty
of insured no consideration paid a. Legitimate children;
but made beneficiary (may be the b. Father and mother, if living;
insureds estate or a third party). c. Grandfather and grandmother; or
ascendants nearest in degree, if living;
In the 2nd and 3rd cases, beneficiary is not a party d. Illegitimate children;
to the contract. In all 3 cases, proceeds of a life e. Surviving spouse; and
insurance policy become the exclusive property of f. Collateral relatives, to wit:
the beneficiary upon insureds death. So if insured f.a. brothers and sisters of the full
was judicially insolvent before he died, proceeds to blood;
go to the beneficiary and not to the assignee in f.b. brothers and sisters of the half-
insolvency. blood; and
f.c. nephews and nieces
Rules governing beneficiaries g. In default of above, State is entitled to
Selection of the receive the proceeds
beneficiary must be in good faith and
without intent to make the transaction a General Rule: The
cover for a forbidden wagering contract. person designated in the policy as the
insured or the beneficiary shall be the only
General Rule: The insured may change one entitled to recover the proceeds of the
the designated beneficiary without the consent policy.
of the latter and retain the right to receive the Exception: A third person may recover
cash value of the policy, to take out loans from the policy as against the insured if
against the cash value, to assign the policy or there has been a prior contract of express
to surrender it without the beneficiarys or implied trust between the insured and
consent. However, this right belongs only the third person. A third person may
personally to the insured and cannot be recover from the policy as against the
exercised by his representatives or assignees insurer only if such person has been
upon his death. specifically given the right of recovery in
Exception: If there has been an express the insurance policy.
waiver of the right to change the beneficiary
without the latters consent, the beneficiary i. Statutory Limitations on life insurance
acquires an absolute vested interest to all
benefits under the policy. A new beneficiary Art. 2012 (Civil Code) Any person who is
cannot be added to the original one/s because forbidden from receiving any donation under Article
such would amount to the diminution of the 739 cannot be named beneficiary of a life insurance
original benefits. The insured also loses the policy by the person who cannot make any
power to destroy the policy because the donation to him, according to said article. (n)
beneficiary can pay the premiums himself to
ensure the continued effectivity of the contract.
Art. 739 (Civil Code) The following donations
DE LEON is inclined to shall be void:
believe that, in case the beneficiary dies
before the insured, the proceeds shall go to (1) Those made between persons who were guilty
the estate of the insured, rather than to the of adultery or concubinage at the time of the
estate of the beneficiary. He believes that donation;
the purpose of the insured in taking out the
policy is to provide a fund for the benefit of
those he is accustomed to supporting. He

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 147 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

(2) Those made between persons found guilty of


FACTS: Plaintiff and Defendant are siblings. Prior
the same criminal offense, in consideration thereof;
to their fathers death, he took out a life
insurance policy and made the Def the sole
(3) Those made to a public officer or his wife,
beneficiary.
descedants and ascendants, by reason of his office.
ISSUE: WON the insurance proceeds belong
exclusively to the DEF who was the sole
In the case referred to in No. 1, the action for
beneficiary
declaration of nullity may be brought by the spouse
HELD: YES The proceeds of an insurance policy
of the donor or donee; and the guilt of the donor
belong exclusively to the beneficiary and not to
and donee may be proved by preponderance of
the estate of the person whose life was insured,
evidence in the same action. (n)
and that such proceeds are the separate and
individual property of the beneficiary.
In the first case (adultery/ concubinage),
no need of criminal conviction to void policy. 9.4. Other parties to an insurance contract
Enough if there is a preponderance of evidence.
In the second case however, the CC uses Assignee of the thing insured -----
the words found guilty hence criminal General Rule: If the thing insured is assigned to
conviction necessary. another, the policy is not deemed transferred with
Public Enemies also disqualified from being the thing. The policy is instead deemed suspended
beneficiary. until the assignee also becomes the owner of the
policy. The assignor, on the other hand, cannot
Insular Life Assurance Co v Ebrado recover on the policy after the transfer since he has
already lost insurable interest over the thing.
FACTS Ebrado took out a life insurance policy and Exceptions: The general rule on suspension of
named his common-law partner, Carponia, his policy is not applicable in the following cases:
beneficiary. Upon his death, his lawful wife also a. In life, health and accident insurance
filed a claim w/ Insular Life as the widow. RTC (20)
disqualified Carponia from claiming benefits b. A change of interest in the thing
under the policy insured after an injury occurs resulting in
ISSUE: WON Carponia disqualified from claiming a loss (21);
insurance proceeds because of her illicit relation c. A change of interest in one or more
with the insured. of several things, separately insured by
HELD: YES. (SC applied CC) Since the Insurance one policy (22);
Code does not contain any specific provision on d. A change of interest by will or
rules respecting who may be named beneficiary, succession on the death of the insured
the CC will apply. Art 2012 states that any (23);
person forbidden from receiving donations under e. A transfer of interest by one of several
Art 739 cannot be named beneficiary of a life persons, joint owners or owners in
insurance policy Art. 739 declares void common, jointly insured, to the others
donations made between persons who are guilty (24);
of adultery or concubinage at the time of the f. When a policy will inure to the
donation. Hence, Carponia is disqualified from benefit of the one who may become
being named a beneficiary. the new owner of the interest insured
during the continuance of the risk (57);
Vda. de Consuegra v GSIS and
g. When there is an express prohibition
FACTS: Jose Consuegra contracted two against alienation in the policy, alienation
marriages, to Diaz and Berdin. After his death, will cause the contract to be avoided, not
the proceeds of his life insurance w/ the GSIS suspended (Article 1306, 24, Civil Code)
went to Berdin. However, he was also entitled to
retirement benefits to which he did not designate Agent or trustee -----
any beneficiary. If an agent or trustee takes out an insurance policy
ISSUE: WON Berdin should be considered the for the benefit of his principal or beneficiary, he
sole beneficiary of the retirement benefits being shall state that the latter is the real party in
the beneficiary of the life insurance policy interest by designating himself as an agent or
HELD: NO. Life Insurance and retirement trustee in the insurance policy itself. He can also
insurance are separate and distinct funds. Life signify his designation by some other general
Insurance is paid to whoever is named the words in the policy.
beneficiary and may not necessarily be the heir
of the insured. Retirement benefits on the other Valenzuela vs CA (1990)
hand, are primarily intended for the benefit of the
ee to provide for his old age, incapacity, etc. If The general rule that the principal reserves the
the ee reaches the age retirement, he gets the right to terminate the agent-principal relationship
benefits even to the exclusion of the beneficiary at its will admits of an exception: when the agency
named in the policy. The beneficiary of the has been given not only for the interests of the
retirement insurance can only claim the proceeds principal but of 3rd persons or for the mutual
of the retirement insurance if the ee dies before interest of agent and principal. Also, an insurance
retirement. IF there is no beneficiary designated agent cant be held liable for all uncollected
in the policy, benefits will accrue to the estate, premiums under his account because the remedy
hence Diaz is also entitled to the retirement for non-payment of premiums is the termination of
benefits. any insurance policy.

Del Val v Del Val Partner or co-owner -----

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 148 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

Insurable interest in the property of a partnership subrogation to the insurer to the extent of
exists in both the partnership and the partners and the insurance money paid.
a partner has an insurable interest in the firm
property which will support the policy taken out c. Change of creditor payment of the
thereon for his own benefit. But a partner who insurance to the mortgagee due to loss
takes out the policy in own name limits the does not extinguish the principal obligation
coverage to his individual share unless the terms but only changes the creditor. The
clearly show the policy was meant to cover all the mortgagee cant claim both the insurance
shares. and the debt.

Mortgagor/ mortgagee ----- Insurance taken out by mortgagor


General Rule: When a mortgagor takes out an
insurance policy on his own name but stipulates a. For his own benefit, as owner proceeds
that the proceeds shall be payable to the wont go to the mortgagee who has no
mortgagee, or assigns the said policy to the greater right than unsecured creditors.
mortgagee, the insurance shall be deemed to be
upon the insurable interest of the mortgagor. b. For the mortgagees benefit loss is
Consequently, three rules apply: (1) any act of the payable to the mortgagee (usual practice),
mortgagor prior to the loss, which would otherwise to the extent of the credit. Upon payment
avoid the insurance, shall have the same effect of the proceeds to the extent of the credit,
even if the property insured is in the hands of the the debt is extinguished. The mortgagee
mortgagee (2) any act which would have to be can be made the beneficial payee by:
performed by the mortgagor may be performed by
the mortgagee, with the same effect as if it were 1. Becoming the assignee of the
performed by the former (3) if an insurer assents policy with insurers consent;
to the transfer of an insurance from a mortgagor to 2. Becoming the mere pledge
a mortgagee, and, at the time of his assent, without such consent;
imposes further obligation on the assignee, making 3. A rider (50), making the policy
a new contract with him, the act of the mortgagor payable to the Mortgagee as his
cannot affect the rights of said assignee. interest may appear , may be
attached;
SUPPLEMENTARY RULES: 4. A standard mortgage clause
On the insurable interest of mortgagor and containing a collateral independent
mortgagee: contract between the two parties
may be attached; or
a. Separate insurable interests each has 5. The policy, though by its terms
his own insurable interest in the mortgaged payable to the mortgagor, may
property which is kept separate from each have been procured by a mortgagor
other. The benefits of such belongs to the under a contract duty to insure for
insured alone and if the two insure the the mortgagees benefit, where the
same property or take out a policy covering latter acquires an equitable line
their respective interests, this is not double upon the proceeds.
insurance.

b. Extent of insurable interest of mortgagor


the owner-mortgagor has an interest to
the extent of the propertys value even if
the mortgage debt equals it since the loss
or destruction of the insured property will
not extinguish his debt.

c. Extent of insurable interest of mortgagee


he or his assignee has an interest to the
extent of the debt secured, the property
used as security. His interest is prima facie
the value mortgaged, only as to the
amount owed, not exceeding the value of
the property.

d. Extent of amount of recovery


Mortgagor: only up to full amount of loss;
Mortgagee: up to the amount of credit at
the time of the loss or the value of the
property.

Insurance by mortgagee of his own interest

a. Right in case of loss the mortgagee is


entitled to proceeds if loss happens before
payment of mortgage.

b. Subrogation of insurer to the right of the


mortgagee mortgagees claim passes by

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 149 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

The insured has an interest in the


destruction rather than the
preservation of a subject matter.
It tempts or induces the insured, with
nothing to lose and everything to gain,
to bring about the event upon the
happening of which the policy becomes
payable.
As a measure of limit of recovery in
contracts to pay indemnity, the insurable
interest will be the measure of the upper
limit of his provable loss under the
contract. The policy should not provide the
insured with the means of making a net
profit from the happening of the event
insured against.
Difference between life and non-life insurance
(pertaining to interest):
LIFE - basically a contract of INVESTMENT;
can only recover face amount of the policy
NON-LIFE based on principle of INDEMNITY
for exact pecuniary value; can only recover on
the policy the value of the actual loss

Chapter III

INSURABLE INTEREST 14 2. Insurable Interest in life/health

1. Definition and Purpose Sec 10 Every person has an insurable interest in


the life and health:

Sec 21 A change on interest in a thing insured,


after the occurrence of an injury which results in a
a) Of himself, of his spouse and of his
loss does not affect the right of the insured to
children;
indemnity for the loss.
b) On any person on whom he
depends wholly or in part for education or
support, or in whom he has a pecuniary
Sec 25 Every stipulation in a policy of insurances
interest;
for the payment of loss whether the person insured
c) Of any person under a legal
has or has not any interest n the property insured,
obligation to him for the payment of money,
or that the policy shall be received as proof of such
or respecting property or services of which
interest, and every policy executed by way of
death or illness might delay or prevent the
gaining or wagering, is void.
performance, and
d) Of any person upon whose life any
Insurable interest interest which the law estate or interest vested in him depends.
requires policy owner to have in the person or thing
Person may take out insurance on own life or
insured.
someone elses life provided insurable interest
- A person is said to have an insurable interest
exists.
in the subject matter insured where he has a
Cestui que vie must consent.
relation or connection with, or concern in it that he
Sec. 10 provides the test of presence of
will derive pecuniary benefit or advantage from its
preservation and will suffer pecuniary loss or insurable interest. Said section does not require
damage from its destruction, termination, or injury the consent of the person being insured for the
by the happening of the event insured against. policy to be effective. The policy is valid as long
Essential element of an insurance contract. as the presence of insurable interest can be
adequately shown.
Not legally possible to waive requirement
Rationale for requiring insurable interest:
2.1. In ones own life/health
As deterrence to the insured public policy
holds wager policies invalid for being
against public interest and demoralizing in Sec 11 The insured shall have the right to change
that: the beneficiary he designated in the policy, unless
he has expressly waived this right in said policy.

14
This topic came out in 2002, 2001, 2000, 1997, Sec 12 The interest of a beneficiary in a life
1996, 1994, 1984, 1983, 1982, 1980, 1979 and insurance policy shall be forfeited when the
1977. Note the difference between insurable interest beneficiary is the principal, accomplice, or
in property versus insurable interest in life insurance; accessory in willfully bringing about the death of
insurable interest in bank deposits; and existing the insured, in which event, the nearest relative of
interest in property insurance.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 150 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

both the owner and beneficiary must have


the insured shall receive the proceeds of said
an insurable interest in the life of the cestui
insurance if not otherwise disqualified.
que vie. If the insurable interest
requirement is satisfied, a life policy is
Insured is the cestui que vie assignable regardless of whether the
As a rule, each has unlimited insurable interest assignee has an insurable interest in the
in his own life, whether the insurance is for the life of the cestui que vie. In our law,
benefit of himself or another insurable interest in anothers life must be
In insuring ones own life for anothers benefit, one of those mentioned in 10. Being
insurable interest is only needed as evidence of engaged with one another is not such
good faith of the parties; it is contrary to interest.
human experience that a person will insure his
own life for the benefit of another for the CLOSE RELATIVES
purpose of speculation, to take his own life to Spouse and children (minor or not, married or
secure payment to another, or designate as a unmarried dependent or not)
beneficiary, a person interested in the - Law presumes natural affection existing
destruction, not the continuance of the between spouses, parents and children.
insureds life. Thus, Law recognizes a parents insurable
The nearest relative of the insured shall receive interest in childs life but is silent as to
the proceeds of said insurance if not otherwise whether or not a child has insurable
disqualified interest in the parents life.
GENERAL RULE: Beneficiary is the choice of - Child entitled to support required by law,
the insured regardless of WoN beneficiary has whether or not he/she is financially
an insurable interest in insureds life independent sufficient to constitute
Assumption: Insured would not designate as pecuniary interest.
his beneficiary a person whom he would not Other close relatives (brothers and sisters) not
trust with his own life expressly covered by law (but look at Art 195,
EXCEPTIONS FC)
Waiver Blood relationship or relationship by affinity is
Irrevocable beneficiary (right to IMMATERIAL when relative is source of support
proceed vests) (where no legal obligation exists)
- There is insurable interest both ways
2.2. In the life/health of others
OTHER RELATIVES and STRANGERS
Must prove that he has some pecuniary interest
Art 195 (Family Code). Subject to the provisions in the life of the cestui que vie otherwise policy
of the succeeding articles, the following are obliged is void
to support each other to the whole extent set forth Mere relationship will not suffice
in the preceding article:
The requirements of insurable interest cannot
(1) The spouses;
be circumvented by an agreement between the
(2) Legitimate ascendants and descendants;
insured (cestui que vie) and a 3 rd person who
(3) Parents and their legitimate children and the
has no interest, whereby the latter, having
legitimate and illegitimate children of the latter;
induced the insured to take out a policy,
(4) Parents and their illegitimate children and the
promises to pay of premiums if the policy is
legitimate and illegitimate children of the latter;
assigned to him.
and
The intention to take out policy is
(5) Legitimate brothers and sisters, whether of full
clearly not to insure life but rather to
or half-blood (291a)
circumvent the requirement
Is different from taking a policy out
Insured is not the cestui que vie but is the on self and then later assigning it to
beneficiary someone who has no insurable interest,
When person names himself the beneficiary in because law allows policy to transfer
a policy taken out on the life of another, he whether or not there is insurable interest
must have insurable interest in the life of the
other person (his interest must show some
Sec 181 A policy of insurance upon life or health
pecuniary interest and it exists whenever the
may pass by transfer, will or succession to any
relation between the assured and the insured,
person, whether he has an insurable interest or
whether by blood, marriage or commercial
not, and such person may recover upon it whatever
intercourse)
the insured might have recovered.
Mere love and affection NOT insurable interest

CESTUI QUE VIE: person upon whose life


Sec 182 Notice to an insurer of a transfer or
insurance is taken out on
bequest thereof is not necessary to preserve the
Must agree to the taking out of insurance
validity of a policy of insurance upon life or health,
No law saying you dont need his consent unless thereby expressly required.
public policy demands consent be obtained
Exception: Parent taking policy out on
minor child Insurable interest of assignee in life
No amount of consent can make up for lack insurance not required - since it is not a
on surable interest contract of indemnity. Life insurance is one
When the owner of the policy insures the of the best recognized forms of investment
life of anotherthe cestui que vieand and self-compelled savings. So far as
designates a third party as beneficiary, reasonable safety permits, it is desirable to

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 151 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

give life policies the ordinary characteristics Policy not indemnifying loss but
of property. To require insurable interest in rather giving financial security to insured or
assignee is to diminish the investment to beneficiaries
value of the contract to the owner. Law gives insured the right to
No insurable interest is required where convert policy into cash by selling it to a 3 rd
policy is procured by the person whose life person who doesnt have any insurable
is insured on his own initiative. Since interest in his life.
anyone can be named beneficiary, an Policy is an investment
assignment would not be invalidated by the Exceptions: (cases where interest of the
lack of insurable interest of the assignee. insured is capable of exact pecuniary benefit)
Assignment is distinguished from a change Creditor who takes insurance out
in the designated beneficiary. on life of debtor to secure debt
Once debt has been paid insurable
COMMERCIAL or CONTRACT RELATIONS interest disappears
Creditor may take out insurance on life of his No liability to pay proceeds because
debtor there is not longer anything to
The extent of the creditors interest indemnify
is only as to the amount of debt and cost of If debt already been paid should be
carrying the insurance on debtors life. The denied recovery on the policy
total value must not make the policy a Debtor should have the right to
wagering or speculative one. This kind of take over the policy from creditor after
policy is not taken out for the benefit of the the termination of relationship prevent
debtor. The debtor cannot claim the the premium paid from going to waste.
proceeds because the creditor does not act Company takes out
as an agent of the former. insurance on life of employee
Employee leaves
company
Policy is to
indemnify employee for losses upon
death of employee not resigning
Sec 183 Unless the interest of a person insured is Company cannot
susceptible of exact pecuniary measurement, the recover on life of employee who has
measure of indemnity under a policy of insurance already left/resigned there is nothing
upon life or health is the sum fixed in the policy. to indemnify
Relationship slightly
Debtor may insure self and name creditor as different because no esact pecuniary
beneficiary value dan be given. BUT same principle
Creditor is entitled to full proceeds holds that the cannot recover.
of policy just as any other beneficiary when
debtor dies even if his credit is much less. 3. Insurable Interest In property
Debtor assigns policy to creditor as collateral
security 3.1. Definition
Creditor can only recover amount
of his credit
Sec 13 Every interest in property, whether real or
Balance will go to designated
personal, or any relation thereto, or liability in
beneficiary
respect thereof, of such nature that a contemplated
peril might directly damnify the insured, is an
EMPLOYER/BUSINESS ASSOCIATE
insurable interest.
May take out policy on life of business partner
Interest exists death of partner
results in interruption of operations which Contract of indemnity - measure of insurable
can lead to financial losses. interest in property is the extent to which the
Firm may take out policy on officers/employees insured might be indemnified by loss or injury.
Services are valuable to the
business
Proceeds of policy not taxable 3.2. In what it may consist of
income because it serves as indemnity to
the employee for the loss the business Sec 14 An insurable interest in property may
suffers upon the death of the valued officer consist in:
of employee. a) an existing interest;
b) An inchoate interest founded on an existing
2.3. Time when it should exist interest; or
c) An expectancy, coupled with an existing interest
Sec 19 An interest in property insured must exist in that out of which the expectancy arises
when the insurance takes effect, and when the loss
occurs, but need not exist in the meantime and
interest in the life or health of a person insured Sec 16 A mere contingent or expectant interest in
must exist when the insurance takes effect, but anything, not founded on an actual right to the
need not exist thereafter or when the loss occurs. thing, nor upon any valid contract for it, is not
insurable.
General Rule: insurable interest must exist
only at inception

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 152 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

Insurable interest deemed to exist as long as - Interest does not rise to the dignity of
such interest, relation or liability is of such a title yet he stands in such a relation to
nature that a contemplated part might directly such corporate property to vest him with
damnifty the insured an inchoate right to dividends in case of
Even without legal or equitable title as long as profits and to share in the assets upon
it can be shown that the insured will be liquidation
benefited by propertys continued existence or - Interest not measured by value of
will suffer pecuniary loss by its destruction. what is destroyed
FORMS OR INSURABLE INTEREST - Interest is to share in the distribution
INTEREST in the property itself, of the proceeds only after payment of
whether such property be real or personal corporations debts
ex. Ownership of or a lien on property - Must prove actual injury, otherwise
any RELATION to such property cannot recover more than nominal
ex. interest of a commission agent on damages
goods he is selling
LIABILITY in respect thereof GENERAL CREDITOR
ex. interest of carrier on cargo which he No insurable interest in the property of
ought to carry safely to destination the debtor
NATURE OF INSURABLE INTEREST No right to posses, no lien, no relation
An existing interest that would cause him direct damage
may arise from Cannot take out policy on debtors
legal title (ex. mortgagor of the property
property mortgaged; lessor of the Cannot recover as appointee or
property leased; assignee of property beneficiary on policy taken out by
for the benefit of creditors, etc.); debtor
clearly definably based on some legal
title JUDGEMENT CREDITOR
may also be from Sufficient interest in debtors property
equitable title (ex. Purchaser of because given right to levy (general
property before delivery; builders in the lien)
building under construction or upon In order to recover must show debtor
completion of building) has no other property with which to
An satisfy debt
inchoate interest founded on an existing May insure debtors property due to
interest pecuniary interest
must be founded on
an existing contract but not yet clearly MORTGAGE CREDITOR
defined or identified (Ex. A stockholder Has insurable interest (general lien)
has an inchoate interest in the property Direct prejudice if there is loss
of the corporation w/c is founded on an
Recognized by insurance Code (SEC8)
existing interest arising from his
ownership shares)
3.4. When it should exist
A partner has an
insurable interest in the firms property
which will support a separate policy for Sec 19 An interest in property insured must exist
his benefit when the insurance takes effect, and when the loss
An expectancy, coupled with an occurs, but need not exist in the meantime; and
existing interest in that out of which the interest in the life or health of a person insured
expectancy arises must exist when the insurance takes effect, but
such must be coupled with an need not exist thereafter or when the loss occurs.
existing interest in that our of which
such expectancy arises. (Ex. Farmer
General Rule: Interest must exist at inception and
insuring future crops if it be grown on
at time of loss, but not in the meantime
land owned by him at the time of the
PROPERTY must exist when the insurance takes
issuance of the policy)
effect and when the loss occurs but not exist in
the meantime.
3.3. Measure of interest in property
Nature of contract as indemnity
Mere transfer of thing does not carry transfer of
Sec 15 A carrier or depository of any kind has an policy
insurable interest in a thing held by him as such, to Doesnt own it anymore cannot recover
the extent of his liability but not to exceed the New owner not a party to contract cannot
value thereof. recover
Can recover if valid assignment to buyer
made, notation of contract
Sec 17 A mere contingent or expectant interest in Transfer suspends the contract until same
anything, not founded on an actual right to the person owns thing and policy
thing, not upon any valid contract for it, is not Exception:
insurable. (21) A CHANGE IN INTEREST IN A THING
INSURED. After occurrence of an injury which
Other Interests
results in a loss does not affect the right of the
STOCKHOLDER/PARTNER to FIRM
insured to indemnify for the loss
- Has sufficient interest in property of
corporation

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 153 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

insured of the policy, after fire may sell Lenders generally


remains of property without prejudicing do not like open mortgages because the
his right to recovery early pay-off reduces the interest they earn
(22) A change of interest IN ONE OR MORE Acts of mortgagor
SEVERAL DISTINCT THINGS, SEPARATELY invalidates the insurance
INSURED by one policy does not avoid the b) Union Mortgage standard mortgage clause
insurance as to the others. Mortgagee may
Single fire policy covers several pieces of perform the acts of mortgagor
furniture and appliances, insurance value Clause included
of each on indicated, sale of one item will wherein the insurance interest of
not prevent insured from recovering on mortgagee shall not be invalidated by any
items he did not sell act of the mortgagor or owner of property
(23) A change on interest by WILL or SUCESSION at the time.
on the death of the insured, does not avoid an Protects
insurance and his interest in the insurance passes mortgagees interest from invalidation due
to the person taking his interest in the thing to mortgagors acts
insured
Fire insurance on building owned by 3.6. Change of interest; instances of
father, father dies, son inherits building automatic transfer of interest
and the fire insurance
(24) A transfer of interest by one of SEVERAL
PARTNERS, JOINT OWNERS, or OWNERS IN Sec 21 A change on interest in a thing insured,
COMMON WHO ARE JOINTLY INSURED to the after the occurrence of an injury which results in a
others, does not avoid an insurance even though loss does not affect the right of the insured to
it has been agreed that the insurance shall cease indemnity for the loss.
upon an alienation of the thing insured
Acquiring co-owner has the same
interest, interest merely increases upon Sec 22 A change of interest in one or more of
acquiring other co-owners interest several distinct things, separately insured by one
Although there may be a stipulation that policy, does not affect the right of the insured to
insurance ceases upon alienation indemnity for the loss.
Law allows policy to be framed in such a
way that it will inure to the benefit of
whomever during the continuance of the Sec 23 A change of interest, by will or succession,
risk may become owner of the interest on the death of the insured, does not avoid an
insured. insurance; and his interest in the insurance passes
Sale of property will not suspend the to the person taking his interest in the thing
policy or render it ineffective. insured.

3.5. Special Provisions on mortgagor and


mortgagee

Sec 8 Unless the policy otherwise provides, where


a mortgagor of property effects insurance in his Sec 24 A transfer of interest by one of several
own name providing that the loss shall be payable partners, joint owners, or owners in common, who
to the mortgagee, or assigns a policy of insurance are jointly insured, to the others, does not avoid an
to a mortgagee, the insurance is deemed to be insurance even though it has been agreed that the
upon the interest of the mortgagor, who does not insurance shall cease upon an alienation of the
cease to be a party to the original contract, and thing insured.
any of his , prior to the loss which would otherwise
avoid the insurance, will have the same effect,
although the property is in the hands of the Sec 53 The insurance proceeds shall be applied
mortgagee, but any act which , under the contract exclusively to the proper interest of the person in
of insurance, is to be performed by the mortgagor, whose name or for whose benefit it is made unless
may be performed by the mortgagee therein otherwise specified in the policy.
named, with the same effect as it had bee
performed by the mortgagee.
Sec 57 A policy may be so framed that it will
insure to the benefit of whomever, during the
Sec 9 If an insurer assents to the transfer of an continuance of the risk, may become the owner of
insurance from a mortgagor to a mortgagee, and at the interest insured.
the time of this assent imposes further obligations
on the assignee, making a new contract with him,
the acts of the mortgagor cannot affect the rights General Rule: If the thing insured is
of said assignee. assigned to another, the policy is not
deemed transferred with the thing. The
policy is instead deemed suspended until
See part IV-C
the assignee also becomes the owner of the
Open policy. The assignor, on the other hand,
mortgage clause and union mortgage cannot recover on the policy after the
a) Open Mortgage (Sec 8) mortgage that can transfer since he has already lost insurable
be paid-off to maturity w/o penalty; mortgagee is interest over the thing. When there has
the beneficiary for insurance taken by mortgagor been a change of interest in a property

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 154 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

insured collectively with others in one 2. Two or more insurers insuring


policy and paid for with a gross premium, separately
the policy is suspended. If, however, the 3. Same subject matter
change of interest affects only one property 4. Same interest insured
insured together with others under a 5. Same Risk or peril insured
divisible contract of insurance, the
suspension takes effect only with regard to OVER INSURANCE when amount insured is
the property affected. over the value of the property the insured is
Exceptions: The general rule on over insured by double insurance
suspension of policy is not applicable in the The insured may claim payment from the
following cases: Secs. 20 to 24, 57, Art insurers in such order as he may select,
1306, 24, Civil Code up to the amount for which the insurers
are severally liable under their respective
3.7. Several interests; double insurance (cf. contracts.
over insurance) Valued policy the insured must give
credit as against the valuation for any
sum received by him under any other
Sec 93 A double insurance exists where the same
policy without regard to the actual value
person is insured by several insurers separately in
of the subject matter insured.
respect in the same subject and interest.
Unvalued policy he must give credit, as
against the full insurable value, for any
Prohibition against additional insurance When a sum received by him under any policy
policy contains a prohibition against additional Insured receives any sum in excess he
insurance on the property insured without the must hold such sum in trust for the
insurers consent, such provision being valid and insurers, according to their right of
reasonable, a violation thereof by the insured contribution among themselves.
avoids the policy. (Sta. Ana vs. Commercial Each insurer is bound as between
Union Assurance Co. 55 Phil 329). himself and the other insurers, to
contribute RATABLY to the loss in
proportion to the amount for which he is
Sec 94 Where this insured is over insured by
liable under the contract.
double insurance:
Cannot get above value of property
minus that of proceeds from other
(a) The insured, unless the policy otherwise
policies
provides, may claim payment from the insurers
Cannot be more than loss because that
in such order as he may select, up to the
would be wagering
amount for which the insurers are severally
liable under their respective contracts;
(b) Where the policy under which the insured
claims is a valued is a valued policy, the
insured must give credit as against, the
valuation for any sum received by him under
any other policy without regard to the actual
value of the subject matter insured.
(c) Where the policy under which the insured
claims is an unvalued policy he must give credit Double Over-insurance
, as against the full insurable value, for any insurance
sum received by him under any other policy. Amount of the There may be no
(d) Where the insured receives any sum in excess insurance is over-insurance as
of the valuation in the case of valued policies, beyond the value when the sum total
and the insurable value in the case of unvalued of the insureds of the amounts of
policies, and the insurable value in the case of insurable interest the policies issued
unvalued policies, he must hold such sum in does not exceed the
trust for the insurers, according to their right of insurable interest of
contribution among themselves. the insured.
(e) Each insurer is bound, as between himself and There may be only There are always
the other insurers, to contribute ratably to the one insurer several insurers
loss in proportion to the amount for which he is involved
liable under the contract.

DOUBLE INSURANCE when one gets several


policies to cover against the same danger/peril
- exists where the same person is insured
by several insurers separately in respect to
the same subject and interest- may recover
from insurer, insurer who pays may collect
from other insurers
- a co-insurance by two or more insurers.
Double insurance, additional insurance
and other insurance are sometimes used
interchangeably, although there is a technical
difference in their meaning.
- Requisites of double insurance
1. Same person insured

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 155 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

2. DEVICES FOR ASCERTAINING AND


CONTROLLING RISK AND LOSS

2.1. CONCEALMENT & REPRESENTATION


Developed for the purpose of enabling the
insurer to secure the same information with
respect to the risk that was possessed by
the applicant for insurance so that he may
be equally capable of forming a just
estimate of its quality.

2.2. AFFIRMATIVE WARRANTIES &


CONDITIONS
Deals with conditions existing at the
inception of the contract, and operates to
make more definite and certain the general
words used to describe the risk the insurer
undertook to bear.
It involve facts the existence of which
shows the risk to be greater than that
intended to be assumed and operates to
create in the insurer the power to
extinguish, if he so desires, the legal
relations already created.
Ex.. Where an insured is required to
warrant something and when found guilty
of concealment or misrepresentation,
operates to void the contract.

2.3. EXCEPTIONS
Makes more definite the coverage indicated
by the general description of the risk by
excluding certain specified risks that
otherwise could have been included under
the general language describing the risk
assumed.

2.4. EXECUTORY WARRANTIES &


CONDITIONS
Are used to enable the insurer to rescind
Chapter IV the contract in case subsequent events
increased the risk to such an extent that he
CONCEALMENT,
is no longer willing to bear. That is,
MISREPRESENTATION & BREACH undertakings that certain conditions should
OF WARRANTIES 15 or should not exist in the future.

2.5. CONDITIONS PRECEDENT


A contract of insurance is:
Used by the insurer to protect himself
UBERRIMAE FIDAE - A contract of utmost good
against fraudulent claims of loss; these are
faith
conditions requiring immediate notice of
loss or injury and detailed proofs of loss
1. PRIMARY CONCERNS OF PARTIES TO
within a limited period.
AN INSURANCE CONTRACT

The following are affected by an act of concealment


3. CONCEALMENT
1. Correct estimation of the risk which enables
the insurer to decide whether he is willing 3.1. Definition
to assume it, and if so at what rate of
premium Sec. 26. A neglect to communicate that which a
2. The precise delimitation of the risk which party knows and ought to communicate,
determines the extent of the contingent is called a concealment.
duty to pay undertaken by the insurer
3. Control of the risk after it is assumed as
will enable the insurer to guard against the 3.2. Requisites of concealment:
increase of the risk because of change in 1. A party knows the fact which he
conditions neglects to communicate or disclose to
4. Determining whether a lost occurred and if the other
so, the amount of such loss. 2. the fact concealed is material to the risk
3. such party is duty bound to disclose such
fact to the other
4. the other party has not the means of
15
The effects of concealment was asked in 1997, ascertaining the fact concealed
5. such party makes no warranty of the
1993, 1989, 1987, 1983, 1980, 1979, 1977, 1976,
fact concealed. (If a warranty is made of
and 1975.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 156 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

the fact concealed, the non-disclosure of


Sec. 30. Neither party to a contract of insurance is
such fact is not concealment but
bound to communicate information of the mattes
constitutes a violation of the warranty)
following, except in answer to the inquiries of the
others:
Sec. 27. A concealment whether intentional or
unintentional, entitles the injured party to rescind (a) Those which the other knows;
a contract of insurance. (As amended by BP Blg. (b) Those which, in the exercise of ordinary
874) care, the other ought to know, and of which
the former has no reason to suppose him
ignorant;
The effect of concealment on the part
(c) Those of which the other waives
of the insured makes the contract
communication;
VOIDABLE at the insurers option
(d) Those which prove or tend to prove the
Insurer NEED NOT PROVE FRAUD in
existence of a risk excluded by a warranty,
order to rescind a contract on the
and which are not otherwise material; and
grounds of concealment.
(e) Those which relate to a risk excepted from
The duty of communication is the policy, and which are not otherwise
independent of the intention and is material.
violated by the mere fact of
concealment even when there is no
design to deceive. Sec. 32. Each party to a contract of insurance is
Section 27 must be read in relation to bound to know all the general causes which are
Section 29. open to his inquiry, equally with that of the other,
and which may affect the political or material perils
Sec. 28 Each party to a contract of insurance contemplated; and all general usages of trade.
must communicate to the other, in good faith, all
facts within his knowledge which are material to
Sec. 33. The right to information of material facts
the contract, and which the other has not the
may be waived, either by the terms of insurance or
means of ascertaining, and as to which he makes
by neglect to make inquiries as to such facts where
no warranty
they are distinctly implied in other facts of which
information is communicated.
3.3. Matters that Must Be Communicated Even
in the Absence of Inquiry:
1. Matters material to the contract Sec. 34. Information of the nature or amount of
2. Matters which the other has not the the interest of one insured need not be
means of ascertaining the said facts communicated unless in answer to an inquiry,
3. Matters as to which the party with the duty except as prescribed by section 51.
to communicate makes no warranty.

TEST: If the applicant is aware of the existence of Sec. 35. Neither party to a contract of insurance is
some circumstance which he knows would bound to communicate, even upon inquiry,
influence the insurer in acting upon his application, information of his own judgment upon the matters
good faith requires him to disclose that in question.
circumstance, though unasked.
Sections 30, 32 35 pertains to
3.4. Fraudulent Intent matters which need not be disclosed
Exception found in Sec. 30 last phrase
Sec. 29. An intentional and fraudulent omission, of first sentence: except in answer to
on the part of one insured, to communicate the inquiries of the other
information of matters proving or tending to prove
the falsity of a warranty, entitles the insured to Matters Which Need Not Be Disclosed:
rescind. 1. Mattes already known to the insurer
2. Matters of which the insurer waives
communication he is in estoppel.
3. Matters that concern only risks
excepted, either expressly or by warranty,
from the liability assumed under the
When Fraudulent Intent Necessary: policy. **Important Note: The undisclosed
fact must NOT BE MATERIAL otherwise the
Under section 29, concealment relates to insured is still bound to make disclosure.
the falsity of a warranty. 4. Information of the nature or amount of
For the section to operate it is necessary the interest of one insured except if
that the nondisclosure be intentional and inquired upon by the insurer.
fraudulent before the contract may be 5. Matters each party are bound to know
rescinded. such as public events, general information
The concealment refers to matters proving etc.
or tending to prove the falsity of the 6. The right to information of material
warranty. fact may be waived either expressly, by
the terms of insurance or impliedly by
3.5. MATTERS WHICH NEED NOT BE neglecting to make inquiry as to the facts
DISCLOSED already communicated.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 157 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

7. If the interest of the insured to the The duty of disclosure ends with the
property being insured is absolute then completion and effectivity of the contract.
there is no necessity to disclose the
extent of his interest, if not then he is Sunlife Assurance vs CA,
required to disclose under Section 51 245 SCRA 268 (1995)
8. Matters of opinion.
Insured need not die of the disease he had failed to
3.6. MATERIALITY disclose to the insurer. It is sufficient that his
nondisclosure misled the insurer in forming his
estimates of the risks of the proposed policy or in
Sec. 31. Materiality is to be determined not by the making inquiries.
event, but solely by the probable and reasonable
influence of the fact upon the party to whom the 4. MI SREPRES EN TA TI ON
communication is due, in forming his estimate of
the disadvantages of the proposed contract, or in 4.1. Definition
making his inquiries.
Sec. 36. A representation may be oral or written
Test of Materiality: The effect which the
knowledge of the fact in question would have on 4.2. Representation vs. Misrepresentation
the making of the contract. To be material, a fact
need not increase the risk or contribute to any loss Representation:
or damage suffered. IT IS SUFFICIENT IF THE factual statements made by the insured at
KNOWLEDE OF IT WOULD INFLUENCE THE PARTY the time of, or prior to, the issuance of the
IN MAKING THE CONTRACT. policy to give information to the insurer and
otherwise induce him to enter into the
Materiality is to be determined not by the insurance contract. They may also be made
event, but solely by the probable and by the insurer but cases nearly always refer
reasonable influence of the facts upon the to representations made by the insured.
party to whom the communication is due,
in forming his estimate of the Misrepresentation:
disadvantages of the proposed contract, or a statement (a) as a fact of something
in making his inquiries. HOWEVER, matters which is untrue; (b) which the insured
that may be deemed immaterial in other stated with knowledge that it is untrue and
respects will be deemed material if made with an intent to deceive, or which he
the subject of an inquiry. states positively as true without knowing it
The DUTY TO COMMUNICATE is to the to be true and which has a tendency to
extent that, in good faith, all facts within mislead; (c) where such fact in either case
the knowledge of either party which are is material to the risk
material to the contract and as to which he
makes no warranty, and which the other
has not the means of ascertaining, must be
communicated. The EXCEPTION to this
rule is that both parties are charged with 4.3. Distinguished from Concealment
the knowledge of the general causes which
are open to his inquiry, equally with that of In concealment, the insured maintains
the other, and which may affect the silence when he ought to speak, while in
political or material perils contemplated; misrepresentation, the insured makes a
and all general usages of trade. The statement of fact which is not true active
Insurance Code exempts a party from the form of concealment.
duty to communicate with regard to
matters which are deemed of public
Sec. 37. A representation may be made at the
knowledge and which a prudent man
time of, or before, issuance of the policy (a)
engaged in the insurance business ought to
know.
GENERALLY, the right to information of Sec. 38. The language of a representation is to be
material facts may be waived, either by the interpreted by the same rules as the language of
terms of the insurance or by neglect to contracts in general.
make inquiry as to such facts, PROVIDED
they are distinctly implied in other facts of
which information is communicated. 4.4. Construction of Representations:
Concealment must take place at the time o Construed liberally in favor of the
the contract is entered into in order that insured and are required to be only
the policy may be avoided. Information substantially true.
obtained after the perfection of the contract
is no longer necessary to be disclosed by Sec. 39. A representation as to the future is to be
the insured, even if the policy has not been deemed a promise, unless it appears that I was
issued (**Exception is when the contract is merely a statement of belief or expectation.
to be effective only upon the issuance of
the policy the insured is still duty bound
to disclose to the insurer any material fact 4.5. Kinds of Representation:
which comes to his knowledge.) 1. Oral or Written (Sec. 36)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 158 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

2. Made at the time of issuing the policy or withdrawn before the contract actually
before (Sec. 37) takes effect but not afterwards since the
3. Affirmative or promissory (Sec. 39 insurer has already been led by the
& 42) representation in assuming the risk
contemplated.
Affirmative Representation:
Is any allegation as to the existence or
Sec. 42. A representation must be presumed to
non-existence of a fact when the contract refer to the date on which the contract goes in
begins. effect.

Promissory Representation:
Is any promise to be fulfilled after the NO FALSE REPRESENTATION IF:
contract has come into existence or any If it is true at the time the contract
statement concerning what is to happen takes effect although false at the time
during the existence of the insurance. A it was made/represented.
promise representation is substantially a
condition or warranty. THERE IS FALSE REPRESENTATION IF:
If it is true at the time it was
made/represented but false at the time
4.6. When Representation Deemed a Mere the contract takes effect.
Expression of Opinion:
Sec. 43. When a person insured has no personal
General Rule: a representation of the
knowledge of a fact, he may nevertheless repeat
expectation, belief, opinion, or judgment of the
information which he has upon the subject, and
insured, although false, will not avoid the policy,
which he believes to be true, with the explanation
even if such was material to the risk.
that he does so on the information of others; or he
Exception: Such representation will avoid
may submit the information, in its whole extent, to
the policy if there is a concurrence of materiality
the insurer; and in neither case is he responsible
and fraudulence or intent to deceive. However, if
for its truth, unless it proceeds from an agent of
the representation is one of fact, the insurer need
the insured, whose duty is to give the information.
only prove the materiality of the representation,
because in such cases the intent to deceive is
presumed.
Art. 44. A representation is to be deemed false
ILLUSTRATION: The statement I am an
when the facts fail to correspond with its
intelligent student will produce the following
assertions or stipulations.
effects:

a. Even if intelligence is material, if there Sec. 44 defines misrepresentation


was no intent to deceive and the Representations are not required to be
insured was merely relying on his own literally true (unlike warranties); they need
assessment of his abilities, the policy only be SUBSTANTIALLY TRUE
will not be avoided.
b. If intelligence is material and it was
Sec. 45. If a representation is false in a material
proven that there was intent on the
point, whether affirmative or promissory, the
part of the insured to mislead the
injured party is entitled to rescind the contract
insurer as to his intelligence, the policy
from the time when the representation becomes
will be avoided.
false. The right to rescind granted by this Code to
c. If the statement was actually a
the insurer is waived by the acceptance of
statement of fact and not mere
premium payments despite knowledge of the
judgment, the policy will be avoided, as
grounds for rescission. (As amended by BP Blg.
when the insured was not even a
474)
student to begin with (student is a
fact, intelligence is an opinion).
Fraudulent intent in this case is General Rule: Any misrepresentation on a
presumed. material point entitles the injured party to rescind
the contract from the time the representation
Sec. 40. A representation cannot qualify an becomes false.
express provision in a contract of insurance; but it Exceptions: The right to rescind on the
may qualify an implied warranty ground of misrepresentation is deemed waived
when the insurer accepts premium payments
despite knowledge of the misrepresentation.
A representation cannot qualify an express However, a person cannot be held liable for any
provision or an express warranty in a misrepresentation that he may apparently have
contract of insurance because a committed if (1) he has no personal knowledge of
representation is not a part of the contract the matter in question, (2) he relies on the
but only a collateral inducement to it. It information of others and (3) he believes such
may however qualify an implied warranty. information to be true based on such external
source, or if he submits the information from an
Sec. 41. A representation may be altered or external source in its entirety to the insurer. The
withdrawn before the insurance is effected, but not EXCEPTION to this rule is when the information
afterwards. relied upon proceeds from an agent of the insured,
whose duty it is to give the information

o A representation, not being a part of the Fraud or intent to misrepresent facts not
contract of insurance, may be altered or essential to entitle the injured party to

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 159 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

rescind a contract of insurance on the


ground of false representation. Canilang vs. CA, 223 SCRA 443 (1993)
To be deemed false, it is sufficient if the
representation fails to correspond with the Facts: The insured failed to disclose to the
facts in a material point. insurer that he was diagnosed to be suffering
from sinus tachycardia and that he had
consulted with a doctor. He died of congestive
Sec. 46. The materiality of a representation is
heart failure. His wife, as the beneficiary filed a
determined by the same rules as the materiality of
claim with the insurer who denied the same.
a concealment.
Ratio: The information the insured failed to
disclose was material to the ability of the insurer
to estimate the probable risk he presented as a
4.7. CONCEALMENT vs. MISREPRESENTATION subject of life insurance, had he disclosed it, it
may be reasonably assumed that the insurer
CONCEALMENT MISREPRESENTATION
would have made further inquires and would
Insured makes have probably refused to issue a non-medical
Insured erroneous statements of insurance policy or at the very least required a
withholds facts with the intent of higher premium for the same coverage.
information of inducing the insurer to Materiality is the probable and reasonable
material facts enter into the insurance influence of the facts upon the party to whom the
from the insurer contract communication should have been made, in
assessing the risk involved, in making or omitting
Determined by the same rules as to to make further inquires and in accepting the
materiality application for insurance.
Same effects on the part of the insured;
insurer has right to rescind Yu v CA
Injured party is entitled to rescind a
contract of insurance on ground of Facts: The insured applied for a life insurance
concealment or false representation, with private respondent insurance company. He
whether intentional or not concealed a material/important fact in his
application form when he failed to disclose that
Rules on concealment and representation
he had consulted a doctor prior to his application
apply likewise to the insurer as insurance
and that he was suffering from certain
contract is one of utmost good faith
symptoms. Insured died and his brother, the
petitioner in the case filed a claim which was
Sec. 47. The provisions of this chapter apply as denied by the insurer.
well to a modification of a contract of insurance as Ratio: The insured is guilty of concealment as
to its original formation. the fact which he failed to disclose to the
insurance company deprived the respondent of
the opportunity to make the necessary inquiry as
Ng v Asian Crusaders to the nature of his past illness so that it may
form its estimate relative to the approval of his
Facts: The insured applied for a 20-year application. A neglect to communicate that
endowment insurance on his life and named his which a party knows and ought to communicate,
wife as beneficiary. Upon application he gave is called concealment and Whether intentional
information regarding a previous operation (that or unintentional, the concealment entitles the
a tumor was taken out). Insured died of liver insurer to rescind the contract of insurance.
cancer. The insurer denied the claim of the Insurer is relieved from liability.
beneficiary claiming misrepresentation since the
operation which the insured undertook was for Pacific Banking v CA
peptic ulcer and not removal of a tumor.
Ratio: Concealment exist where the insured had Facts: The insured, Paramount is in the business
knowledge of a fact material to the risk, and of shirt manufacturing, it took out a fire
honesty, good faith and fair dealing requires that insurance policy with Oriental Insurance for 61K.
he should communicate it to the insurer, but he Because of its indebtedness to Pacific Banking
intentionally withhold the same. The insured Corp., the policy was endorsed to Pacific as
informed the medical examiner that the tumor he mortgagee/trustor. The property insured was
was operated on was associated with ulcer of the gutted by fire. Pacific made a claim on the
stomach. In the absence of evidence that the insurance policy which was denied by Oriental
insured had sufficient medical knowledge as to because it appeared that Paramount failed to
enable him to distinguish between peptic ulcer disclose co-insurance with 3 other insurance
and tumor his statement was an expression companies (only declared 3 others) in violation of
made in good faith of his belief as to the nature Policy Condition # 3.
of his ailment and operation. If the operation Ratio: By reason of the unrevealed co-
and ailment of the insured had such an important insurances, the insured had been guilty of a
bearing on the assumption of risk by the insurer, false declaration; a clear misrepresentation and a
it should have made further inquires on the vital one because where the insured had been
matter or required copies of the hospital records asked to reveal but did not, that was deception.
before approving the application. As provided by Had the insurer known that there were many co-
Section 32 where the right to material insurers, it could have hesitated or plainly
information may be waived by neglect to make desisted from entering into such contract.
inquires as to such facts where they are distinctly Hence, the insured was guilty of clear fraud. The
implied in other facts of which information is insurance policy against fire expressly required
communicated that notice should be given by the insured of

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 160 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

other insurance upon the same property, the Ratio: The insurer is deemed estopped from
total absence of such notices nullifies the policy. claiming that the insured is disqualified. She did
not conceal nor misrepresent her age and the
Eguaras v Great Eastern insurance corporation has been given sufficient
information to know that the insured is over 60
Facts: The insured applied for a life insurance years of age, yet they continued to accept the
policy with defendant and named beneficiary his premium payment and issued her the policy.
mother-in-law, the petitioner in the case.
Insured falsely answered questions on the New Life Enterprise v Court of Appeals
application form regarding his health and medical
history. Also, when he the insurance companys Facts: The insured contracted 3 insurance
physician conducted a physical examination, policies from 3 different insurance companies for
another person pretending to be the insured was the stocks-in-trade of New Life Enterprises. It
presented. Insured died of intestinal occlusion. was undisputed that the plaintiff failed to indicate
Ratio: The insured permitted fraud to be any co-insurance in any of the three policies.
committed against the insurance company in the When the building occupied by the insured
fact that he allowed a healthy and robust person enterprise was gutted and the stocks-in-trade
to substitute in his place since he knew that he insured against were burned, the plaintiff filed
was in bad health. It is immaterial the cause of claims with the 3 insurers which were all denied.
death since at the time he applied for the The reason was that the insured violated the
insurance on his life he was affected by a malady terms of policy in relation to co-insurance.
that would have been sufficient cause for the Ratio: The terms of the contract are clear and
rejection of his application by the insurance unambiguous. The insured is specifically required
company. The contract of insurance is null and to disclose to the insurer any other insurance and
void because it is false, fraudulent and illegal. its particulars which he may have effected on the
same subject. The excuse of the plaintiff that the
Great Pacific Life v CA (1999) agent of the insurance company was aware of the
other insurers or that he failed to read the terms
Facts: A group life insurance was executed of the policies cannot be accepted when the
between GrePaLife and DBP for mortgagors of words and language of the documents are clear
DBP to the amount of debt to DBP. The insured and plain or readily understandable by an
in this case was one such mortgagor to DBP. ordinary reader. There is absolute no room for
GrePaLife granted insurance and a couple of interpretation or construction and the courts are
months later, insured died of massive cerebral not allowed to make contracts for the parties.
hemorrhage. Upon DBPs claim GrePaLife The parties must abide by the terms of the
denied claiming non-disclosure of insured that he contract because such terms constitute the
was suffering from hypertension at the time of measure of the insurers liability and compliance
application for the insurance based on the therewith is a condition precedent to the
testimony of a doctor who declared that the insureds right to recovery from the insurer.
cause of death was possible hypertension
several years ago American Home v CA
Ratio: GrePaLife failed to establish that the
insured concealed a material fact as the medical Facts: The insured took out a fire insurance
findings were not conclusive since the doctor who policy to cover the stocks-in-trade of his business
gave the testimony did not conduct an autopsy from the plaintiff insurer. When a fire gutted the
on the insured nor had he any knowledge of business, he filed a claim against plaintiff insurer
insureds previous hospital confinements. The and several other insurance companies for which
death certificate only stated that hypertension as he also had a policy for the same stocks-in-trade.
possible cause of death. Concealment exist The plaintiff insurer refused payment claiming
where the assured had knowledge of a fact that the insured violated the policy in several
material to the risk, and honesty, good faith and instances for our purposes the violation was the
fair dealing requires that he should communicate failure of the insured to disclose co-insurance.
it to the assurer, but he intentionally withholds However, during trial, the trial court found that
the same. Fraudulent intent on the part of the although the insured failed to disclose co-
insured must be established to entitle the insurer insurance, the loss adjuster of the insurance
to rescind the contract. Misrepresentation as a company had previous knowledge of the co-
defense of the insurer to avoid liability is an insurance prior to the claim.
affirmative defense and the duty to establish Ratio: The insurer is estopped from claiming
such defense rests upon the insurer. exemption from liability due to the violation of
the policy on non-disclosure. It cannot be said
Edillon v Manila Bankers Life that petitioner was deceived by respondent by
the latters non-disclosure of the other insurance
Facts: The insured applied for a 90-day contracts when petitioner actually had prior
insurance coverage against accident and injuries. knowledge as petitioners loss adjuster had
She clearly indicated in the application form that known all along of the other existing insurance
her date of birth was July 11, 1904 (which made contracts. The loss adjuster being an employee
her almost 65 at the time of application). The of petitioner is deemed a representative of the
insurer accepted her premium payment and latter whose awareness of the other insurance
issued her a certificate of insurance. Under the contracts binds the petitioner and thus there was
insurance policy, there contained a provision no violation of the other insurance clause by
which excludes the company from any liability to the respondent and petitioner is liable to pay its
pay claims when the insured is under 16 or over share of the loss.
60. Insured died of a vehicular accident during
the effectivity of the insurance coverage.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 161 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

Life insurance policy wording that provides 1. The policy is a life insurance policy
a time limit on the insurers right to dispute
2. It is payable on the death of the
a policys validity based on material
insured
misstatements in the application.
Incontestability means that after the 3. It has been in force during the
requisites are shown to exist, the insurer lifetime of the insured for a period of
shall be estopped from contesting the at least two years from the date of
policy or setting up any defense, except as issue or its last reinstatement. This
is allowed, on the ground of public policy two-year period may be shortened but
it cannot be extended by stipulation.
Sec. 48. Whenever a right to rescind a contract of The period of two years for contesting a life
insurance is given to the insurer by any provision insurance policy by the insurer may be
of this chapter, such right must be exercised shortened but it cannot be extended by
previous to the commencement of an action on the stipulation.
contract.
.After a policy of life insurance made payable on
Sec. 227 In the case of individual life or
the death of the insured shall have been in force
endowment insurance, the policy shall contain in
during the lifetime of the insured for a period of
substance the following conditions:
two years from the date of its issue or of its last
reinstatement, the insurer cannot prove that the
(b) A provision that the policy shall be
policy is void ab initio or is rescindable by reason
incontestable after it shall have been in force
of the fraudulent concealment or
during the lifetime of the insured for a period of
misrepresentation of the insured or his agent.
two years from its date of issue as shown in the
policy, or date of approval of last reinstatement,
5. RESCISSION except for non-payment of premium and except for
violation of the conditions of the policy relating to
5.1. Grounds military or naval service in time of war.
1. Concealment
2. False representation misrepresentation
3. Breach of Warranty
Defenses Not Barred by Incontestable Clause:
5.2. When Insurer Must Exercise Right to 1. That the person taking the insurance
Rescind: lacked insurable interest as required by
law.
Non-Life Policy 2. That the cause of the death of the
Must be exercised prior to the insured is an excepted risk.
commencement of an action on the 3. That the premiums have not been paid.
contract. The insurer is no longer entitled 4. That the conditions of the policy
to rescind a contract of insurance after the relating to military or naval service
insured has filed an action to collect the have been violated.
amount of the insurance. 5. That the fraud is of a particularly
**However, it has been held that where vicious type, as where the policy was
taken out in furtherance of a scheme to
any of the material representations is false,
murder the insured, or where the insured
the insurers tender of the premiums and
substitutes another person for the medical
notice that the policy is cancelled before
examination, or where the beneficiary
commencement of the suite, operates to
feloniously kills the insured.
rescind a contract of insurance
6. That the beneficiary failed to furnish
proof of death or to comply with any
Life Policy
conditions imposed by the policy after
The defense is available only during the
the loss has happened.
first two years of a life insurance policy. Or
7. That the action was not brought within
upon the first two years after
the time specified.
reinstatement.
Argente v West Coast Life Ins. Co.
5.3. Incontestability clauses16
The principle of incontestability states that,
Facts: The insured spouses signed an application
after the requisites are shown to exist, the for joint insurance which was accepted by the
insurer shall be estopped from contesting insurer. The wife died of cerebral apoplexy a
the policy or setting up any defense, except couple of month after the effectivity of the policy.
as is allowed, on the grounds of public When the husband filed a claim, the insurer denied
policy. In life insurance policies, the the claim due to fraud and misrepresentation of the
incontestability begins after two years from insured. It appeared that the answers the spouses
the time the policy took effect. After this gave in their medical examinations with regard to
period, the insurer is no longer allowed to their health and previous illnesses and medical
declare the policy void or file an action for attendance were untrue.
rescission on the grounds of concealment of Ratio: The spouses were guilty of concealment.
misrepresentation of the insured. It has the As to the issue of the application of section 47 (now
following requisites: sec. 48) on the time the insurer must exercise the
right to rescind, the court held that a failure to
16
This was covered in 1998, 1997, 1994, 1991, and exercise the right of rescission cannot prejudice
1984. Take note of the 2 year period and the date of any defense to the action which the concealment
issuance and their relevance. may furnish. Where any of the material

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 162 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

representations are false, the insurers tender of contract to the contract


the premium and notice that the policy is cancelled,
before the commencement of suit thereon, operate Always written on the May be written in a
to rescind the contract of insurance, and are a face of the policy, totally disconnected
sufficient compliance with the law. actually or by reference paper or may be oral

6. WARRANTIES Must be strictly Only substantial truth is


complied with required.
6.1. Definition
Falsity or non- Falsity of a
Is a statement or promise set forth in the policy fulfillment of a warranty representation renders
itself or incorporated in it by proper reference, the operates as a breach of the policy void on the
untruth or non-fulfillment of which in any respect contract ground of fraud.
and without reference to whether the insurer was
in fact prejudiced by such untruth or non- Presumed material Insurer must show the
fulfillment, renders the policy voidable by the materiality of a
insurer. A warranty may also be made by an representation in order
insurer. to defeat an action on
the policy.
Sec. 67. A warranty is either expressed or
implied. Sec. 70. Without prejudice to section fifty-one,
every express warranty, made at or before the
execution of a policy, must be contained in the
6.2. Kinds of Warranties: policy itself, or in another instrument signed by the
insured and referred to in the policy as making a
1. Express Warranty (Sec 67 & 71) is an part of it.
agreement contained in the policy or clearly
incorporated whereby the insured stipulates
that certain facts relating to the risk are or In order that a stipulation may be
shall be true or certain acts relating to the considered a warranty, it must not only be
same subject have been or shall be done. clearly shown that the parties intended it as
2. Implied Warranty (marine insurance such but it must also form a part of the
only) is a warranty which from the very contract itself or if contained in another
nature of the contract or from the general instrument, it must be signed by the
tenor of the words, although no express insured and referred to in the policy as
warranty is mentioned, is necessarily making a part of it. Mere reference alone
embodied in the policy as a part thereof is not sufficient to give this effect.
and which binds the insured as though The designation or non-designation of a
expressed in the contract. (There is an clause as a warranty is not controlling.
implied warranty that the ship is seaworthy What is essential is the intent of the
when the policy attaches) contracting parties to create a warranty,
3. Affirmative Warranty (Sec. 68) is one regardless of the form of words used.
which asserts the existence of a fact or
condition at the time it is made Sec. 71. A statement in a policy, of a matter
4. Promissory warranty or Executory relating to the person or thing insured, or to the
Warranty (Sec. 72 & 73) is one where risk, as a fact, is an express warranty thereof.
the insured stipulates that certain facts or
conditions pertaining to the risk shall exist
or that certain things with reference thereto Sec. 72. A statement in a policy, which imports
shall be done or omitted. It is in the nature that it is intended to do or not to do a thing which
of a condition subsequent. materially affects the risk, is a warranty that such
act or omission shall take place.
**Warranties are either affirmative or
promissory and expressed or implied so it
comes in pairs you can have an implied Section 72 refers to promissory warranty.
affirmative warranty or an expressed Breach of promises or agreements as to
affirmative warranty.. future acts will not avoid a policy unless the
**A warranty is presumed to be affirmative promises are material to the risk.
unless the contrary intention appears Express warranties regarding the person,
thing, or risk must refer to a statement of
fact. If it is a mere belief, it will not
constitute a warranty as far as the policy is
Sec. 68. A warranty may relate to the past, the
concerned, but merely a warranty that the
present, the future, or to any or all of these.
statement is his honest opinion or
judgment.
Sec. 69. No particular form of words is necessary
to create a warranty. Sec. 73. When, before the time arrives for the
performance of a warranty relating to the future, a
loss insured against happens, or performance
becomes unlawful at the place of the contract, or
6.3. Warranties v Representation
impossible, the omission to fulfill the warranty
does not avoid the policy.
WARRANTY REPRESENTATION
Considered part of the Collateral inducement

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 163 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

Sec. 169. An alteration in the use or condition of a


6.4. When Breach of Warranty does not avoid
thing insured from that to which it is limited by the
policy:
policy, which does not increase the risk, does not
1. When loss occurs before time for
affect a contract of fire insurance.
performance
2. When performance becomes unlawful
3. When performance becomes impossible Requisites Alteration to Entitle Insurer to
(legal & physical impossibility) Rescind:
4. When insurer waives the warranty, 1. The use or condition of the thing is
impliedly or expressly. specifically limited or stipulated in the
policy.
2. Such use or condition as limited by the
6.5. Materiality and Fraud in Warranty policy is altered.
3. The alteration is made without the
Sec. 74. The violation of a material warranty, or consent of the insurer
other material provision of a policy, on the part of 4. The alteration is made by means within
either party thereto, entitles the other to rescind. the control of the insured
5. The alteration increases the risk.

Sec. 75. A policy may declare that a violation of Increase of Risk or Hazard in General
specified provision thereof shall avoid it, otherwise Increase of hazard takes place whenever
the breach of an immaterial provision does not the insured property is put to some new
avoid the policy. use, and the new use increases the chance
of loss.

Sec. 76. A breach of warranty without fraud, Premise: Every insurance policy is made in
merely exonerates an insurer from the time that it reference to the conditions surrounding the subject
occurs, or where it is broken in its inception, matter of the risk and the premium is fixed with
prevents the policy from attaching to the risk. reference thereto. There is thus an implied promise
or undertaking on the part of the insured that he
Fraud is not essential to entitle the insurer will not change the premises or the character of the
business carried there, or to be carried on there, so
to rescind a contract for breach of
as to increase the risk of loss by fire.
warranty.
Falsity, not fraud, is the basis of liability in
General Rule: Insurer is not liable if there was
warranty.
an increase in the risk or hazard. There is increase
If the breach of the warranty was
in hazard when the new use increases the chance
WITHOUT FRAUD insured is entitled to: of loss. The increase of the risk of loss must in all
1. Return of premium paid at a pro-rata cases be of a substantial character.
rate from the time of breach if it occurs Exceptions: (Alterations which will not warrant
after the inception of the contract the avoidance of the policy):
2. To all the premiums if it is broken 1. The use of the property is changed but it did
during the inception of the not in any way increased the risk of loss
contract. In this case the contract is 2. The use of materials prohibited from being
void ab initio and never became used as per the policy if such materials are
binding. necessary or ordinarily used in the insureds
If the breach of the warranty was WITH business.
FRAUD policy is void ab initio and the 3. Increase in risks brought about by the
insured is not entitled to the return of the undertaking of necessary repairs in the
premium paid premises
4. Increase in risks due to negligent acts
6.6. Warranties in Fire Insurance temporarily endangering the property, or
temporary acts or conditions which have
Sec. 167. As used in this Code, the term fire ceased prior to the occurrence of the loss.
insurance shall include insurance against loss by 5. Alteration made by accident or without the
fire, lightning, windstorm, tornado or earthquake knowledge of the insured.
and other allied risks, when such risks are covered Qualifier: However, the acts of the insureds
by extension to fire insurance policies or under tenants which cause alterations are deemed
separate policies. (a) presumptively known to the insured.
Exception to the exception: Under Section
75, the breach of an immaterial provision will not
A fire insurance is a contract of indemnity
avoid the policy, but the insurer is given the right
by which the insurer, for consideration, to insert terms which, if violated, would avoid it.
agrees to indemnify the insured against The increase in risk brought by an alteration is
loss of, or damage to, property by fire. therefore irrelevant if there is already a provision in
the policy which stipulates that ANY alteration, of
Sec. 168. An alteration in the use or condition of a whatever nature and effect, shall avoid the policy.
thing insured from that to which it is limited by the For sec. 168 to operate, entitling the
policy made without the consent of the insurer, by insurer the right to rescind, there must
means within the control of the insured, and be an actual increase of risk and while
increasing the risk, entitles an insurer to rescind a it is not necessary that the increased
contract of fire insurance. risk should have cause or contributed
to the loss, it is necessary that the
increase be of a substantial character.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 164 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

In case of partial loss, the full amount of


Sec. 170. A contract of fire insurance is not the partial loss (but should not exceed the
affected by any act of the insured subsequent to valuated amount)
the execution of the policy, which does not violate Total loss exists when the result of the fire
its provisions, even though it increases the risk is such as to render the property wholly
and is the cause of a loss. unfit for use.
If the thing is insured under two or more
policies, each policy shall contribute pro-
If the policy does not contain any rata to the payment of such whole or
prohibition limiting the use or condition of partial loss.
the thing insured, an alteration in said use The insured is not a co-insurer under a fire
or condition does not constitute a violation insurance policy in the absence of
of the policy. The contract is not affected stipulation unlike in marine insurance.
by such alteration even though it increases
the risk and is the cause of the loss. Co-Insurance Clause
Is a clause requiring the insured to
Sec. 171. If there is no valuation in the policy, the maintain insurance to an amount equal to a
measure of indemnity in an insurance against fire specified percentage of the value of the
is the expense it would be to the insured at the insured property under penalty of becoming
time of the commencement of the fire to replace co-insurer to the extent of such deficiency.
the thing lost of injured in the condition in which it Many property owners realizing the
was at the time of the injury; but if there is a possibility of total destruction is slight,
valuation in a policy of fire insurance, the effect merely take out a small percentage of the
shall be the same as in a policy of marine value of the building or goods. To prevent
insurance. the insured from taking out such small
amount of insurance, and thereby reduce
premium payments the insurers often
Sec. 172. Whenever the insured desires to have a insert as a rider to the standard fire policy
valuation named in his policy, insuring any building a so called co-insurance clause which
or structure against fire, he may require such results in reducing the recovery in case of
building or structure to be examined by an partial loss to but a portion of the sum
independent appraiser and the value of the named in the policy though in case of total
insureds interest therein may then be fixed as loss, the insurer is liable for the amount
between the insurer and the insured. The cost of named in the policy.
such examination shall be paid for by the insured.
A clause shall be inserted in such policy stating Option to rebuild clause
substantially that the value of the insureds The insurer is given the option to reinstate
interest in such building or structure has been thus the property damaged or destroyed or any
fixed. In the absence of any change increasing the part thereof, instead of paying the amount
risk without the consent of the insurer or of fraud of loss or damage. If the insurer chooses to
on the part of the insured, then in case of a total rebuild, he has to completely undertake it
loss under such policy, the whole amount so no matter how much it will cost him, unless
insured upon the insureds interest in such building the policy expressly states that any repair
or structure, as stated in the policy upon which the shall only be to the extent of the amount of
insurers have received a premium, shall be paid, the insurance.
and in case of a partial loss, the full amount of the
partial loss shall be so paid, and in case there are
two or more policies covering the insureds interest Sec. 173. No policy of fire insurance shall be
therein, each policy shall contribute pro rata to the pledged, hypothecated, or transferred to any
payment of such whole or partial loss. But in no person, firm or company who acts as agent for or
case the insurer be required to pay more than the otherwise represent the issuing company, and any
amount thus stated in such policy. This section such pledge, hypothecation, or transfer hereafter
shall not prevent the parties from stipulating in made shall be void and of no effect insofar as it
such policies concerning the repairing, rebuilding may affect other creditors of the insured.
or replacing of buildings or structures wholly or
partially damaged or destroyed. Effect of Pledge of Fire Insurance Policy
After a loss has occurred, the insured MAY
Measure of Indemnity Under an Open Policy pledge, hypotheticate or transfer a fire
Entitled to recover amount of actual loss insurance policy or rights thereunder.
sustained (burden of establishing the What is being transferred is not the policy
amount of loss by a preponderance of itself but the right to claim against the
evidence is upon the insured) insurer.
This right however is subject to the
Measure of Indemnity Under a Valued Policy prohibition of Section 173.
The valuation in the policy of fire insurance
is conclusive between the parties in the Pioneer v Yap
adjustment of either partial or total loss if
the insured has an insurable interest and Facts: The insured was the owner of a store
was not guilty of fraud selling bags and footwear, she took out a fire
In case of total loss, the insured can insurance from petitioner insurance company
recover the whole amount so insured as covering her stocks, office furniture, fixtures and
stated in the policy (the valuated amount) fittings of every kind and description. A condition
was set which required the insured to disclose to

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 165 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

the insurer of any insurance or insurances


already effected, or which may be subsequently Intends to limit the liability of the insurer
effected. It further stipulated that unless such under certain circumstances.
notice be given and the particulars of such
insurance or insurances be stated in or endorsed Musngi v West Coast Insurance Co. Inc.
on this Policy by or on behalf of the Company
before the occurrence of any loss or damage, all Facts: The insured took out two life insurance
benefits under this Policy shall be forfeited. The policies with defendant insurer designating as his
insured failed to inform the insurer of another co- beneficiaries the plaintiffs in the case. In his
insurance. Fire broke out, gutted the store of application the insured untruthfully answered
insured. Upon filing of claim, petitioner insurance questions regarding his health particularly about
company denied the claim for violation of having consulted any physician regarding an
condition in the policy. illness or ailment. It appeared that prior to his
Ratio: By the plain terms of the policy, other application for insurance, the insured had been
insurance without the consent of petitioner would treated for a number of ailments including peptic
ipso facto avoid the contract. It required not ulcer, TB etc. The insured died, and upon his
affirmative act of election on the part of the death his beneficiaries filed a claim with
company to make operative the clause avoiding defendant insurance company who denied the
the contract, wherever the specified conditions claim.
occur. Its obligation ceases, unless, being Ratio: The insured is guilty of concealment and
informed of the fact, it consented to the thus relieves the insurer from paying the claim.
additional insurance. Furthermore, the court The insured knew that he had suffered from a
quoting Justice Bengson (Gen Insurance & Surety number of ailment before subscribing the
Corp v Ng Hua) said that and considering the application, yet he concealed them and omitted
terms of the policy which required the insured to the hospital where he was confined as well as the
declare other insurances, the statement in name of his physician who treated him. The
question must be deemed to be a statement concealment and false statement constituted
(WARRANTY) binding on both insurer and fraud, since this caused the defendant insurer to
insured, that there were no other insurance on accept the risk when it would have otherwise
the property.the annotation then, must be refused. Such concealment of the insured
deemed to be a warranty that the property was rendered the policy null and void (as held also in
not insured by any other policy. Violation thereof Argente v West Coast).
entitled the insured to rescind.
Filipinas Cia de Seguros v Nava
Young v Midland Textile Insurance
Facts: On February 1939, plaintiff Nava and
Facts: The insured, an owner of a candy and defendant Filipinas Life Assurance entered into 17
fruit store took out a fire insurance policy from separate contracts of life insurance for which the
the defendant insurance company to insure his insured issued 17 life insurance policies for which
residence and his bodega. Under the policy, a the insurer issued 17 life insurance policies, one
condition was set as "warranty B" which of said policies having a face value of P10,000
stipulates that no hazardous goods be stored or while the rest a face value of P5,000 each, or a
kept for sale and no hazardous trade or process total of P90K. Each and every policy contains a
shall be carried in the building. During the policy loan clause. On April 1948, plaintiff
enforcement of the insurance policy, the insured applied for a loan of P5,000 in line with the loan
kept 3 boxes of fire crackers. Sometime later a clause but defendants refused citing certain
fire broke out which partially destroyed the regulations issed by the Insurance Commissioner
building but it appeared that the fire crackers on May 1946.
were not the cause of the fire as they were found Held: Defendants refusal to give the loan
in an area not burned. Upon claim insurer denied applied for by the plaintiff violated the loan
payment. clause embodied in each of the life insurance
Ratio: The terms of the contract constitute the policies. This violation of the loan clause in the
measure of the insurer's liability. If the contract policy entitled plaintiff to rescind all policies
has been terminated by a violation of its terms under Section 69 of the Insurance Act, which
on the part of the insured, there can be no provides: the violation of a material warranty, or
recovery. Compliance with the terms of the other material provision of a policy, on the part of
contract is a condition precedent to the right of either party thereto, entitles the other to
recovery. A violation of the terms of a contract of rescind. Our Insurance Law does not contain an
insurance, by either party, will constitute the express provision as to what the court should do
basis for a termination of the contractual in cases of rescission of an insurance policy under
relations, at the election of the other (in this case Section 69, the provision that should apply is that
the insurer). The right to terminate the embodied in Art. 1295 of the old civil code, as
contractual relations exist even though the postulated in Art. 16 of the same Code, which
violation was not the direct cause of the loss, provides that on matters which are not governed
since the deposit of the hazardous goods in the by special laws the provision of said Code shall
building insured was a violation of the terms of supplement its deficiency. The CA was correct in
the contract. The insurer is relieved from his ordering defendant to refund to plaintiff all
liability since the deposit of the hazardous premiums paid by him up to the filing of the
materials created a new risk not included in the action amounting to P34,644.60.
terms of the contract. The insurer had neither
been paid, nor had he entered into a contract to GROUNDS AND EXERCISE OF RIGHT OF
cover the increased risk. RESCISSION

EXCEPTIONS/& EXCLUSION

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 166 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

Sec. 48. Whenever a right to rescind a contract of (a) non payment of premium;
insurance is given to the insurer by any provision (b) conviction of a crime arising out of acts
of this chapter, such right must be exercised increasing the hazard insured against
previous to the commencement of an action on the (c) discovery of fraud or material
contract. misrepresentation;
After a policy of life insurance made payable on (d) discovery of willful or reckless acts or
the death of the insured shall have been in force omissions increasing the hazard insured
during the lifetime of the insured for a period of against;
two years from the date of its issue or of its last (e) physical changes in the property insured
reinstatement, the insurer cannot prove that the which results in the property becoming
policy is void ab initio or is rescindable by reason uninsurable; or
of the fraudulent concealment or (f) a determination by the Commissioner that
misrepresentation of the insured or his agent. the continuation of the policy would violate
or would place the insurer in violation of
this Code.
Sec. 63. A condition, stipulation, or agreement, in
any policy of insurance, limiting the time for
commencing an action thereunder to a period of Sec. 65. All notices of cancellation mentioned in
less than one year from the time when the cause the preceding section shall be in writing, mailed or
of action accrues is void. delivered to the named insured at the address
shown in the policy and shall state:

When Cause of Action Accrues (a) which of the grounds set forth in section
The right of the insured to the payment of 64 is relied upon; and
his loss accrues from the happening of the (b) that, upon written request of the named
loss. insured, the insurer will furnish the facts
The cause of action in an insurance on which the cancellation is based.
contract does not accure UNTIL THE
INSUREDS CLAIM IS FINALLY REJECTED
BY THE INSURER, because before such final Form and Sufficiency of Notice of Cancellation
rejection, there is no real necessity for 1. There must be prior notice of
binging suit. cancellation to the insured.
The period is to be computed not from the 2. The notice must be based on the
time the loss actually occurs but from the occurrence, after the effective of the
time when the insured has a right to bring policy, of one or more of the grounds
an action against the insurer. mentioned in section 64.
**Cause of Action requires as essential 3. It must be in writing, mailed or
elements not only a legal right of the plaintiff delivered to the named insured at the
and a correlative obligation of the defendant address shown in the policy.
but also AN ACT OR OMISSION OF THE 4. It must state which of the grounds set
DEFENDANT IN VIOLATION OF SAID LEGAL forth is relied upon
RIGHT, the cause of action in favor of the 5. It is the duty of the insurer upon
insured does not accrue until the insurer written request of the insured to
refuses expressly or impliedly to comply with furnish the facts in which the
his duty to pay the amount of the loss. cancellation is based. The premium
referred to in Section 64 must be a
General Rule: a clause in the policy to the premium subsequent to the first, because it
effect that an action upon the policy must be speaks of non-payment after the effective
brought within a certain period is valid and will date of the policy. If there was no
prevail over the general law on limitations of premium paid at all, the action appropriate
actions as prescribed by the Civil Code, if not would be a declaration of nullity, based on
contrary to Sec. 63, IC. Section 77 which provides that no policy
Exceptions: In industrial life insurance or contract of insurance issued by an
policies, the period cannot be less than 6 years insurance company is valid and binding
after the cause of action accrues. unless and until the premium thereof has
been paid
Jacqueline Jiminez Vda. De Gabriel vs. CA,
G.R. No. 103883 (November 14, 1996) Sec. 170. A contract of fire insurance is not
Under 384 of the Insurance Code, notice of claim affected by any act of the insured subsequent to
must be filed within six months from the date of the execution of the policy, which does not violate
accident, otherwise teh claim shall be deemed its provisions, even though it increases the risk
waived. Action or suit must be brought to proper and is the cause of a loss.
cases, with the Commission of the court within one
year from the denial of claim, otherwise, the
claimants right of action shall prescribe. Sec. 227 In the case of individual life or
endowment insurance, the policy shall contain in
Sec. 64. No policy of insurance other than life substance the following conditions:
shall be cancelled by the insurer except upon prior
notice thereof to the insured and no notice of (b) A provision that the policy shall be
cancellation shall be effective unless it is based on incontestable after it shall have been in force
the occurrence, after the effective date of the during the lifetime of the insured for a period of
policy, of one or more of the following: two years from its date of issue as shown in the
policy, or date of approval of last reinstatement,

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 167 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

except for non-payment of premium and except for builder's risks, and all personal property floater
violation of the conditions of the policy relating to risks;
military or naval service in time of war. (b) Person or property in connection with or
appertaining to a marine, inland marine, transit or
transportation insurance, including liability for loss
Sec. 380. No cancellation of the policy shall be of or damage arising out of or in connection with
valid unless written notice thereof is given to the the construction, repair, operation, maintenance or
land transportation operator or owner of the use of the subject matter of such insurance (but
vehicle and to the Land Transportation Commission not including life insurance or surety bonds nor
at least fifteen days prior to the intended effective insurance against loss by reason of bodily injury to
date thereof. any person arising out of ownership, maintenance,
Upon receipt of such notice, the Land or use of automobiles);
Transportation Commission, unless it receives (c) Precious stones, jewels, jewelry, precious
evidence of a new valid insurance or guaranty in metals, whether in course of transportation or
cash or surety bond as prescribed in this Chapter, otherwise;
or an endorsement of revival of the cancelled one, (d) Bridges, tunnels and other instrumentalities
shall order the immediate confiscation of the plates of transportation and communication (excluding
of the motor vehicle covered by such cancelled buildings, their furniture and furnishings, fixed
policy. The same may be reissued only upon contents and supplies held in storage); piers,
presentation of a new insurance policy or that a wharves, docks and slips, and other aids to
guaranty in cash or surety bond has been made or navigation and transportation, including dry docks
posted with the Commissioner and which meets and marine railways, dams and appurtenant
the requirements of this chapter, or an facilities for the control of waterways.
endorsement or revival of the cancelled one. (As (2) "Marine protection and indemnity
amended by PD No. 1455) insurance," meaning insurance against, or against
legal liability of the insured for loss, damage, or
expense incident to ownership, operation,
chartering, maintenance, use, repair, or
construction of any vessel, craft or instrumentality
in use of ocean or inland waterways, including
liability of the insured for personal injury, illness or
death or for loss of or damage to the property of
another person.

1.1. Navigational Exposure basic concept


in definition.
Dean says that since the IC (Insurance
Code) does not really define what marine
insurance is, most important is to just point
out that NAVIGATIONAL EXPOSURE is the
common thread that runs through the
enumeration in Sec. 99
Related to Navigation of the ship

Definition of marine insurance under the IC


and under the Insurance Act (Law w/c IC
amended)
Chapter V: MARINE INSURANCE 17 Campos: the IC gives the terms of marine
insurance a very wide coverage including
1. DEFINITION property exposed to risks not connected
with navigation.
The simple clear definition in the IA was
Sec. 99. Marine Insurance includes: better: Marine insurance is an insurance
(1) Insurance against loss of or damage to: against risks connected with navigation to
(a) Vessels, craft, aircraft, vehicles, goods, which a ship, cargo, freightage, profits, or
freights, cargoes, merchandise, effects, other insurable interest in movable
disbursements, profits, moneys, securities, choses property may be exposed during a certain
in action, evidences of debts, valuable papers, voyage or a fixed period of time.
bottomry, and respondentia interests and all other
kinds of property and interests therein, in respect
to, appertaining to or in connection with any and all Insurance Act Insurance Code
risks or perils of navigation, transit or (old definition) (present defn)
transportation, or while being assembled, packed, Marine insurance Covers property
crated, baled, compressed or similarly prepared for covers all kinds of exposed to risks of
shipment or while awaiting shipment, or during any movable property, navigation and even
delays, storage, transhipment, or reshipment but it operated only those exposed to
incident thereto, including war risks, marine if such property is risks not connected
exposed to risks with navigation, like
17 connected with risks connected with
This was asked in 2005, 2002, 1992, and 1982.
navigation. all other means of
Note the definition of constructive total loss, total transportation,
loss, and notice of abandonment. Also know implied including overland
warranties and instances when vessel may proceed and perhaps even
to a port other than its port of destination.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 168 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

air transportaion. instrument of transportation, or


is a movable type of goods
Criticism of IC defn: Its confusing impractical which is often at different
and unrealistic to apply provision intended locations.
specifically and only for risks of navigation (w/c - Divisions of inland marine
came down to us from the usages and customs insurance:
of merchants) to risks connected with land and 1. Property in transit the insurance provides
air transportation. protection to property frequently exposed
IC definition also didnt serve any legal purpose to loss while it is in transportation from one
by widening the scope of the definition since location to another
most of the special provisions in the IC relating 2. Bailee liability the insurance provides
to marine insurance can properly apply only to protection to persons who have temporary
ships or other property exposed to navigational custody of the goods or personal property
risks. of others, such as carriers, laundrymen,
Everything covered by the new definition would warehousemen, garagekeepers
anyway be necessarily governed by the general 3. Fixed transportation property the
provisions of the IC, even if the old definition insurance covers bridges, tunnels, and
had just been retained. other instrumentalities of transportation
Transportation insurance is concerned with the and communication, although as a matter
perils of property in transit as opposed to perils of fact they are fixed property. They are
at a generally fixed location. insured because they are essential to the
transportation system. Marine policies must
Major divisions of transportation (marine) exclude buildings, their furniture, fixtures,
insurance fixed contents, and supplies held in
1) OCEAN MARINE INSURANCE. An storage. They invariably extend to cover
insurance against risk connected with more perils than those included in the usual
navigation, to which a ship, cargo, fire policy. In order for a risk to qualify for
freightage, profits or other insurable a marine contract, there must be included
interest in movable property may be some additional marine peril such as
exposed during a certain voyage or a fixed collapse, collision, flood, etc.
period of time. 4. Floater in inland marine insurance, the
- Scope of ocean marine term is used in the sense that it provides
insurance: it provide protection insurance to follow the insured property
for: (a) ships or hulls, (b) goods wherever it may be located, subject always
or cargoes; (c) earnings such as to territorial limits of the contract. Although
freight, passage money, the basis for eligibility is the fact that
commissions, or profits; (d) transportation or movement of property is
liability incurred by the owner or often present, the condition need not
any party interested in or necessarily occur. Floaters have been
responsible for the insured issued covering property that is seldom
property by reason of maritime moved.
perils.
- All risks or losses may be Property covered by marine policy
insured against, except such as A marine policy may cover any property or
are repugnant to public policy or interest therein which may be subjected to
positively prohibited. A general the risks of navigation. Definition in policy
marine insurance policy which may be modified or enlarged by riders,
does not state the risks assured warranties, or indorsements attached to
is valid and covers the usual the policy.
marine risks; and in a marine Term goods and merchandise usually
policy, the general enumeration found in a marine policy includes all articles
of all other perils, etc. extends which are carried on the ship for
only to marine damage of like COMMERCIAL purposes. (Does not incl ex.
kind to those enumerated. To Clothing of crew, food, etc). Expected
sustain recovery on a marine profits from the sale of such goods may
policy, the loss must have been also be protected.
proximately caused by the risk Freight or Freightage all benefits
or peril insured against. derived by the owner, either from
2) INLAND MARINE INSURANCE. Covers chartering (borrowing the entire ship) of
primarily the land or over the land the ship or its employment for the carriage
transportation perils of property shipped by of his own goods or those of others. This is
railroads, motor trucks, airplanes, and not covered unless expressly stated in the
other means of transportation. It also policy.
covers risks of lake, river, or other inland Freight Insurance doesnt cover passage
waterway transportation and waterborne money payable by passenger at the
perils outside of those risks that fall completion of the voyage unless expressly
definitely within the ocean marine category. provided.
- to be eligible for inland marine
contract, the risk must involve Risks which may be insured against
an element of transportation. Insurer is liable for all losses PROXIMATELY
Either the property is actually in caused by the perils covered by the marine
transit held by persons who are policy
not its owners, or at a fixed Usually enumerated
location but an important

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 169 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

Barratry - willful and intentional act on the


1.2. Perils of the Sea and Perils of the part of the master or crew, in pursuance of
Ship some unlawful or fraudulent purpose,
o Peril of the Sea without the consent of the owner, and to
- includes only casualties arising from the prejudice of his interest; Neither honest
the violent action of the elements and error or judgment nor mere negligence.
does not cover ordinary wear and - May be covered by policy
tear like the silent, natural and gradual
action of the elements on the vessel Taking at sea, arrests, restraints, and
itself, or other damage usually incident detainments of all kings, princes and
to the voyage. people - extraordinary acts by a
- It also does not include (1) an injury sovereign authority in time of war, or under
due to the violence of some marine other unusual international conditions like
force if such violence was not unusual blockades and embargoes. Acts done in the
or unexpected; (2) loss of a sail during course of regular proceedings not included
a tempest, for neither events are (i.e. vessel libeled and detained for non-
unusual (but carrying away of a mast payment of debt) since there is nothing
or loss of an anchor will be covered, for fortuitous about the situation.
in such cases the storms violence is - Includes not only arrests caused by
definitely unusual and not to be political acts of a seizing state but also
expected as incident to navigation) by ordinary legal processes such as a
- Fortuitous and unusual lawsuit on ownership and possession of
- Must be connected with maritime goods. (see Malayan Insurance Corp v
navigation CA case)
- It is a relative term and the meaning
may vary with the circumstances. All other perils, losses and misfortunes
- It embraces all kinds of marine casualty - covers risks which are of like kind with
such as (1) shipwreck, foundering, the particular risks which are enumerated
stranding, collision, and damages done in the preceding part of the same clause of
to the ship or goods at sea by violent the contract
action of wind and waves; (2) loses
occasioned by the jettisoning of cargo if La Razon Social Go Tiaoco y Hermanos v
it is made for the purpose of saving a Union Insurance Society of Canton Ltd.
vessel rendered unworthy during the
voyage, not through the fault of the Facts: A drain pipe passing through the hold
captain; (3) barratry, or any willful where the insured rice was stowed had become
misconduct on the part of the master or corroded in course of time, w/c created a hole in
crew in pursuance of some unlawful or the pipe. An attempt was made to cement the
fraudulent purpose without the consent hole and cover it with a strip of iron but due to
of the owners, and to the prejudice of the loading of the ship, this part of the pipe was
the owners interest. Barratry requires submerged in water during the trip and was
a willful and intentional act in its washed out. Water flowed into the hold and
commission. No honest error of damaged the rice.
judgment or mere negligence, unless Issue: WON the insurer was liable
criminally gross, can be barratry. Held: NO. A loss which in the ordinary course of
- The meaning of perils of the sea events, results from the natural and inevitable
varies with circumstances. FOR action of the sea, from the ordinary wear and
EXAMPLE, a vessel designed for inland tear of the ship, or from the negligent failure of
waters was insured. It was towed in the the ships owner to provide the vessel with
Gulf of Mexico. The insurer was aware proper equipment to convey the cargo under
of the hazardous nature of the journey ordinary conditions, is not a peril of the sea, but
and charged extra premium. If any loss rather a peril of the ship. In such a case, the
occurs, it will be held to be due to perils remedy of the insured shipper or consignee is not
of the sea although a sea-going vessel against the insurer but against the shipowner.
would not have been damaged by the
moderate waves encountered. Cathay Insurance v CA

Peril of the Ship Facts: Remington Industrial Sales filed for the
- Loss which in the ordinary course of recovery of losses incurred due to the rusting of
events results from (a) the Natural steel pipes it imported from Japan while it was in
and inevitable action of the sea; (b) transit. Cathay Insurance refused payment
ordinary Wear and Tear of the ship; claiming that the rusting was not due to a peril of
(c) the negligent failure of the the sea since it was not a casualty which could
ships owner to provide the vessel not be foreseen.
with proper equipment to convey the Held: There is no question that rusting of steel
cargo under ordinary conditions pipes in the course of voyage is a peril of the
- The insurer does not undertake to sea in view of the toll on the cargo by wind,
insure against perils of the ship. water and salt conditions. (HANGLABO! But in
any case, the SC decided through construction)
Note: Everything that happens thru the inherent We would fail to observe a cardinal rule in the
vice of the thing, or by the act of the owner, interpretation of contracts, namely, that any
master or shipper shall not be reputed a peril if not ambiguity therein should be construed against
otherwise borne in the policy the issuer/drafter, namely, the insurer.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 170 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

Malayan Insurance Corp v CA (1997) General Rule: there can be no valid


marine insurance unless supported by an
Facts TKC Marketing was the owner/consignee of insurable interest in the thing insured.
soya bean meal shipped from Brazil to Manila. It Exception: in certain cases of marine
was insured by Malayan Insurance. While the insurance, the insurer will still be held liable
vessel was in South Africa it was arrested and if he agreed to insure a ship or cargo lost
detained due to a lawsuit questioning its or not lost, that is, he agreed to be bound
ownership and possession. As a result, TKC in any case, even if it would later on be
Marketing filed a claim with Malayan for the non- proved that the insured had nothing to
delivery of the cargo. insure when the contract was made.
Issue WoN the arrest of the vessel by the civil
authority was a peril of the sea
Sec. 101. The insurable interest of the owner
Held The arrest caused by ordinary judicial
of the ship hypothecated by bottomry is only the
process is deemed included among the covered
excess of its value over the amount secured by
risks. (Decision detailed the history of the Free
bottomry.
from Capture and Seizure clause) Although the
Free from Capture and Seizure clause was
originally inserted in marine policies to protect
against risks of war, its interpretation in recent
years to include seizure or detention by civil
authorities seems consistent with the general
Sec. 102. Freightage, in the sense of a policy
purposes of the clause.
of marine insurance, signifies all the benefits
derived by the owner, either from the chartering of
Filipino Merchants Insurance Co v CA
the ship or its employment for the carriage of his
own goods or those of others.
Facts A shipment of fishmeal insured by Filipino
Merchants Co. was found to be damaged upon
its unloading in the Port of Manila. The
owner/consignee filed action to recover the Sec. 103. The owner of a ship has an
amount represented by the damages based on insurable interest in expected freightage which
the all risks clause of the policy but according to the ordinary and probable course of
Fil.Merchants refused claiming that there must be things he would have earned but for the
some casualty or accidental cause to which the intervention of a peril insured against or other peril
loss is attributable. incident to the voyage.
Held An all risks policy should be read literally
(not technically) as meaning all risks whatsoever
and covering all losses by an accidental cause of Sec. 104. The interest mentioned in the last
any kind. It has evolved to grant a greater section exists, in case of a charter party, when the
protection than that afforded by the perils ship has broken ground on the chartered voyage.
clause in order to assure that no loss can happen If a price is to be paid for the carriage of goods it
through the incident of a cause neither insured exists when they are actually on board, or there is
against nor creating liability in the ship. The some contract for putting them on board, and both
insured under an all risks policy has the initial ship and goods are ready for the specified voyage.
burden of proving that the cargo was damaged
when unloaded from the vessel, thereafter, the
burden then shifts to the insurer to show the Sec. 105. One who has an interest in the
exception to the coverage. Under this policy it is thing from which profits are expected to proceed
sufficient to show that there was damage has an insurable interest in the profits.
occasioned by some accidental cause of any kind
and there is no necessity to point to any
particular cause. Sec. 106. The charterer of a ship has an
insurable interest in it, to the extent that he is
2. INSURABLE INTEREST liable to be damnified by its loss.

Sec. 100. The owner of a ship has in all cases In Ship


an insurable interest in it, even when it has been Bottomry Loan one given on the
chartered by one who covenants to pay him its security of the ship, on condition that the
value in case of loss: Provided, That in this case loan be repaid only if the ship arrives safely
the insurer shall be liable for only that part of the at the port of destination; money given in
loss which the insured cannot recover from the advance; if ship sinks, bottomry loan
charterer. extinguished and owner doesnt have to
pay it.
Bottomry loans and marine insurance can
Owner of Vessel has insurable interest in share protection and coverage of same
the vessel even if he has mortgaged it. risks; but cannot coextend with each other.
However, if ship is chartered and charterer Where a vessel is hypothecated by way of
agrees to pay him its value in case of loss, bottomry, the owner has an insurable
it is only liable for that part of the loss interest only in the excess of the vessels
which the insured cannot recover from the value over the amount of the bottomry
charterer. loan. This is so because when the vessel
Insurable interest of insured in marine bottomed is lost, the owner need not pay
insurance the loan and is therefore benefited to the
extent of the amount of the load obtained

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 171 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

and the loss he actually suffers is only the


difference bet the actual value of the vessel

In Ship In Goods Shipped In Freightage


and Profits
Owner of -Has insurable interest Interest in goods ship -Has insurable interest in
the Ship in ALL cases even if carries to the extent expected freightage w/c
the ship has been that he may be liable accdg to the ordinary
chartered by one who for their loss, but NOT and probable course of
has agreed to pay, its TO EXCEED THE VALUE things he would have
value in case of loss. thereof earned but for the
In this case, insurers intervention of a peril
(of the ship owner) insured against or other
liability is limited to the peril incident to the
part of the loss which voyage
insured cannot recover - If Freight is Payable
from the charterer. upon the Completion of
- If ship is subjected to voyage- OWNER has
bottomry loan, insurable interest
Owners interest is
only in excess of value
over amount secured
by bottomry.
Charterer May take out policy Has insurable interest Freight PAID in
/ covering insurable in goods since they will ADVANCE Charterer or
Shipper interest, which can be suffer damage in case Shipper has insurable
only to the extent that of loss interest
he may be damnified
by the loss
and the bottomry.
The lender in bottomry is entitled to receive
a high rate of interest to compensate him
for the risk of losing his loan.

3. CONCEALMENT Sec. 109. A


person insured by a
Sec. 107. In marine contract of marine
insurance each party is insurance is presumed
bound to communicate, to have knowledge, at
in addition to what is the time of insuring, of
required by section a prior loss, if the
twenty-eight, all the information might
information which he possibly have reached
possesses, material to him in the usual mode
the risk, except such as of transmission and at
is mentioned in Section the usual rate of
thirty, and to state the communication.
exact and whole truth
in relation to all
matters that he
represents, or upon Sec. 110. A
inquiry discloses or concealment in a
assumes to disclose. marine insurance, in
respect to any of the
following matters, does
Sec. 108. In not vitiate the entire
marine insurance, contract, but merely
information of the exonerates the insurer
belief or expectation of from a loss resulting
a third person, in from the risk
reference to a material concealed:
fact, is material.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 172 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

exonerated whether the


from a third
(a) The national from liability. vessel was
person.
character of the The insurer, overloaded, or
In marine
insured; however, where the
insurance: the
(b) The liability of remains liable insurer did not
insured is
the thing insured to to pay for rely thereon,
bound to
capture and detention; damage or loss have been held
communicate
(c) The liability to brought by to be
the beliefs/
seizure from breach of other perils of immaterial.
opinions and
foreign laws of trade; the sea. Effect of falsity
expectations of
(d) The want of of
third persons,
necessary documents; REPRESENTATION representation
as long as the
(e) The use of false as to
information is
and simulated papers. expectation:
in reference to Sec. 111. If a
Representations of
a material fact. representation by a
expectations are
Concealment in Presumptive person insured by a
statements of future
marine knowledge by contract of marine
facts or events which
insurance is the insured of prior insurance, is
are in their nature
failure to loss: Sec. 109 intentionally false in
contingent and which
disclose any establishes a any material respect, or
the insurer is bound to
material fact or rebuttable in respect of any fact
know that the insured
circumstance presumption of on which the character
could not have
which in fact or knowledge of and nature of the risk
intended to state as
law is within, or prior loss on depends, the insurer
known facts, but as
which ought to the part of the may rescind the entire
mere expectations or
be, within the insured, on the contract.
intentions. Unless made
knowledge of recognition of
with fraudulent intent,
one party and the fact that
failure of the fulfillment
of which the communication Sec. 112. The
of a representation of
other has no s technology eventual falsity of a
expectation is not a
actual or nowadays representation as to
ground for rescission.
presumptive makes it expectation does not,
They must be carefully
knowledge. possible for the in the absence of fraud,
distinguished from
The rules are insured to be avoid a contract of
promissory warranties.
stricter than in apprised of the marine insurance.
the case of fire loss of his (Note: Will be void if
Special Rule in
insurance vessel there is fraud)
Marine Insurance
because, in the immediately
Substantial
latter, the after it occurs.
Applicability of truth of any
insurer can The insured is
rules on material
easily obtain not bound,
representation statement is
information however, to use
to marine NOT sufficient
regarding the all accessible
insurance: Law requires
property means of
The rules on the insured to
insured. In information at
representation are state the exact
marine the very last
applicable to marine and whole truth
insurance, the instant of time
insurance, like the rules in relation to all
vessels insured to ascertain the
on distinction between matters that he
are often condition of the
representations and represents, or
absent or property
warranties, upon inquiry,
afloat. Under insured.
construction of discloses or
Section 107, it When
representations, and assumes to
is sufficient that concealment
avoidance of the policy disclose.
the insured is in does not vitiate
based on a substantial Due to nature
possession of entire contract
misrepresentation of of contract
the material General
any material fact or
fact concealed Rule in
circumstance. The test
although he insurance:
of materiality of
may not be concealment of
representations also
aware of it. a material fact
applies in marine Rules on
Opinions or entitles the
insurance. Concealment and
expectations of injured party to
Anything which Misrepresentation
third persons: rescind.
concerns the are STRICTER in
General In marine
state of the marine insurance.
Rule in insurance: if
vessel at any Why?
insurance: the loss happens
particular Failure to
insured is not under any of
period of her disclose any
bound to the conditions
voyage are material fact or
communicate in Section 110
material. circumstance
information of and such was
Statements of which in law or
his own concealed, the
the nature and fact is within,
judgment and insurer is
amount of or which ought
what he learns merely
cargo, or to be within the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 173 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

knowledge of Negros to Manila using


(a) Those which voyage contemplated
one party and Coastwise Lighterage
the other knows; by the parties to the
of which the Corps open barges.
(b) Those which, in policy.
other has no However, one of the
the exercise of ordinary
actual or barges sank when it hit
care, the other ought to
presumptive an unknown sunken
know, and of which the Sec. 115. An
knowledge. object while
former has no reason implied warranty of
Failure to approaching Manila Bay
to suppose him seaworthiness is
disclose the ff. Port. Because of this,
ignorant; complied with if the
will give the Pag-Asa rejected the
(c) Those of which ship be seaworthy at
insurer the shipment as a total loss
the other waives the time of the of
right to and Phil. General
communication; commencement of the
rescincd (No Insurance Company
(d) Those which risk, except in the
more liability). paid for the loss.
prove or tend to prove following cases:
- Material PhilGen then filed an
the existence of a risk (a) When the
facts within action against
excluded by a insurance is made for a
knowledge Coastwise Lighterage
warranty, and which specified length of
of party seeking to recover the
are not otherwise time, the implied
- All amount it paid Pag-asa.
material; and warranty is not
informatio Coastwise claims that it
(e) Those which complied with unless
n he was unaware of the
relate to a risk the ship be seaworthy
posessess hidden danger in its
excepted from the at the commencement
which are path, thus it became
policy and which are of every voyage it
material to impossible for
not otherwise material. undertakes during that
risk, except Coastwise to avoid it,
time;
as is even with the exercise
(b) When the
mentioned TEST of Materiality: of extraordinary
insurance is upon the
in Sec. 30 Whether the concealed diligence.
cargo which, by the
(cf with fact caused the loss Held: Coastwises
terms of the policy,
Sec. 28 and not its probable assertion is belied by
description of the
which only influence on the other the evidence. The
voyage, or established
require party in deciding patron of the vessel
custom of the trade, is
communica whether or not to enter which sank admitted
to be transhipped at an
tion of facts the contract. that he was not
intermediate port, the
which are licensed thus, it cannot
implied warranty is not
material to Representations: safely claim to have
complied with unless
the contract Insured must state the exercised extraordinary
each vessel upon which
as to which exact and whole truth diligence by placing a
the cargo is shipped, or
he makes in relation to all person whose
transhipped, be
no matters that he navigational skills are
seaworthy at the
warranty) represents of upon questionable at the
commencement of each
- Beliefs and inquiry discloses or helm of the vessel w/c
particular voyage.
expectation assumes to disclose. met the accident.
s of 3rd Logically, a person w/o
persons in False license to navigate
lacks not just the skill Sec. 116. A
reference to representations:
to do so, but also the warranty of
a material 1. Any
familiarity with the seaworthiness extends
fact. misrepresentati
usual and safe routes not only to the
on of a material
taken by seasoned and condition of the
fact made with
Sec. 28. Each legally authorized structure of the ship
fraudulent
party to a contract of persons. itself, but requires that
intent
insurance must it be properly laden,
2. The character
communicated to the 4. IMPLIED and provided with a
and nature of
other, in good faith, all WARRANTIES competent master, a
the risk
facts within his sufficient number of
depends on
knowledge which are competent officers and
the fact
material to the contract Sec. 113. In seamen, and the
misrepresent
and as to which he every marine insurance requisite appurtenances
ed
makes no warranty, upon a ship or freight, and equipment, such as
Effect: Insurer may
and which the other or freightage, or upon ballasts, cables and
RESCIND the contract
has not the means of any thing which is the anchors, cordage and
Exception: Eventual
ascertaining. subject of marine sails, food, water, fuel
falsity of a
insurance, a warranty and lights, and other
representation as to
is implied that the ship necessary or proper
expectation, in the
Sec. 30. Neither is seaworthy. stores and implements
absence of fraud, does
party to a contract of for the voyage.
not avoid the contract.
insurance is bound to
communicate Sec. 114. A ship
information of the is seaworthy when Sec. 117. Where
Coastwise v CA
matters following, reasonably fit to different portions of the
except in answer to the perform the service and voyage contemplated
inquiries of the other: Facts: Pag-Asa Sales to encounter the by a policy differ in
had molasses ordinary perils of the respect to the things
transported from

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 174 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

ships be raised
liability for the
requisite to make the structure, but by the
risks assumed
ship seaworthy requires insurer
in every
therefor, a warranty of - ship to be without
insurance upon
seaworthiness is properly showing
any marine
complied with if, at the laden concealmen
venture
commencement of each - competent t or
whether of
portion, the ship is master misreprese
vessel, cargo,
seaworthy with - sufficient ntation by
or freight.
reference to that number of the insured.
portion. competent b. The
4.1. Implied
officers admission
warranties in marine
and crew may mean:
insurance
Sec. 118. When - requisite (1) that the
a) Seaworthiness
the ship becomes appurtena warranty
b) Deviation
unseaworthy during the nces and of
c) Other Implied
voyage to which an equipment seaworthi
Warranties:
insurance relates, an (ballasts, ness is to
- Carry the
unreasonable delay in cables, be taken
requisite
repairing the defect anchors, as
documents to
exonerates the insurer cordage, fulfilled;
show
on ship or shipowner's sails, food, or
nationality or
interest from liability water, fuel, (2) that the
neutrality
from any loss arising lights, risk of
- Not engage
therefrom. necessary/p unseawort
in any illegal
Sec. 119. A ship roper stores hiness is
venture
which is seaworthy for and assumed
d) it is also
the purpose of an implements by the
impliedly warranted
insurance upon the ship for the insurer
that the insured
may, nevertheless, by voyage) c. Insertion of
has an insurable
reason of being unfitted - In a fit waiver
interest in the
to receive the cargo, be state as to clauses in
subject matter
unseaworthy for the repair, cargo
insured
purpose of the equipment, policies is in
insurance upon the crew and in recognition
General
cargo. all other of the
provisions on realistic
respects to
warranties also fact that
perform the
apply to marine cargo
Sec. 120. Where voyage
insurance owners
the nationality or insured and
ONLY marine cannot
neutrality of a ship or to
insurance has encounter control the
cargo is expressly
IMPLIED the state of the
warranted, it is implied
WARRANTIES ordinary vessel.
that the ship will carry
provided by law perils of Wh
the requisite
documents to show navigation ere
a) Seaworthiness: - Must also unseaworthines
such nationality or
Meaning be in a s unknown to
neutrality and that it
Ship is suitable owner of cargo
will not carry any
seaworthy condition insured:
documents which cast
reasonable suspicion when to carry a. SUBJECT
reasonably fit the cargo MATTER IS
thereon.
to perform the put on CARGO: the
services and to board or implied
Warranty, in encounter the intended to warranty of
marine ordinary perils be put on seaworthine
insurance, has of the voyage board ss attaches
been defined as contemplated Such warranty to whoever
a stipulation, by the parties can be is insuring
either to the policy. excluded only the cargo,
expressed or NOT absolute by clear WON he is
implied, guarantee that provisions of the
forming part of vessel will the policy shipowner.
the policy as to safely meet all Where b. Lack of
some fact, possible perils knowledge
seaworthiness
condition or CIRCUMSTANC by the
admitted by
circumstance ES determine insured is
insurer:
relating to the WON vessel is immaterial
a. Admission
risk. reasonably in ordinary
is stipulated
Implied seaworthy marine
in the
Warranties - Seaworthiness contract: insurance
conditions upon extends not the issue of and is not a
the only to seaworthine defense in
underwriter's condition of ss cannot order to

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 175 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

recover on simply for It is not cargo which


the policy. being necessary that by the
c. Since the engaged in the cargo itself terms of
law "public shall be the policy,
provides for services." seaworthy. description
an implied f. Because of of the
warranty, it the implied When warranty voyage, or
becomes warranty of deemed complied established
the seaworthine with; exceptions custom of
obligation ss, shippers Implied the trade,
of a cargo are not warranty of is to be
owner to expected, seaworthiness transshippe
look for a when is deemed d18 at an
reliable transacting complied with if intermediat
common with ship is e port;
carrier common seaworthy AT each
which carriers, to THE TIME OF vessel
keeps its inquire into THE upon which
vessels in the vessel's COMMENCEME the cargo is
seaworthy seaworthine NT OF THE shipped
condition. ss, RISK; What must be
Shipper genuinenes matters is that seaworthy
may have s of its at the start of at the
no control licenses the voyage commence
over the and insured, ship is ment of
vessel but compliance seaworthy. each
he has full with all Assured makes particular
control in maritime no warranty voyage
the choice laws. that vessel will - (117) In
of the Seaworthiness continue to be case of
common is a relative seaworthy, or Voyage
carrier that term depending that the crew policy
will upon the wont be contemplati
transport nature of ship negligent ng a
his goods. (must be in a - Principle voyage in
d. Cargo fit state as to Behind this: If different
owner may repair, vessel, crew, stages
also enter equipment, and equipment ship must
into a crew and in all be originally be
contract of other respects sufficient, the seaworthy
insurance to perform the assured has at the
which voyage insured done all that he commence
specifically and encounter contracted to ment of
provides the ordinary do (not each
that the perils; suitable anymore portion;
insurer condition to responsible for stages
answers carry cargo), future must be
not only for nature of deficiency). separate
the perils of voyage Exceptions:
the sea but (determines Secs. 115a, 18
Transshipment - the act of
also WON vessel is 115b, 117 taking cargo out of one ship
provides for well-fitted), - (115a) In and loading it in another or the
coverage of nature of case of transfer of goods from the
perils of the service (nature TIME policy vessel stipulated in the
ship. of cargo should insurance contract of affreightment to
e. A charterer be determined; another vessel before the
made for a place of destination named in
of a vessel the vessel specified the contract has been reached
has no should be length of or the transfer for further
obligation reasonable time, ship transportation from one ship
before capable of must be or conveyance to another.
transportin safely carrying Fact of transshipment is not
seaworthy dependent upon the
g its cargo the cargo to the at the ownership of the transporting
to ensure port of commence conveyances but rather on the
that the destination). ment of fact of actual physical transfer
vessel Failure of a every or cargoes from one vessel to
complied common carrier another. Transshipment of
voyage
with all the freight without legal excuse,
to maintain in she may however competent and safe
legal seaworthy undertake the vessel into which the
requiremen condition the - (115b) in transfer is made, is an
ts. The duty vessel is a clear case of infringement on the right of the
rests upon breach of its Cargo shipper and subjects the
the carrier to liability if the freight
duty prescribed policy is lost even by a cause
common in Article 1755, Insurance otherwise excepted.
carrier CC. is upon the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 176 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

and distinct relieved of Insurance. However, paid Caltex


in order to liability but the the barge sank. It representing the
have a contract of was found that the insured value of the
different insurance is not barge was not lost cargo. American
degree of affected as to seaworthy (one of Home, exercising its
seaworthine any other risk the hatches was left right of subrogation,
ss for or loss covered open, there was a demanded of Delsan
particular and not caused leak in the barge). the same amt it paid
parts. or increased by Pioneer refused to to Caltex but Delsan
such particular pay damages refused. It was found
Scope of defect. because of the that the chief mate of
Seaworthiness of 2. Benefit of breach of the implied the vessel was not
vessel exoneration is warranty on qualified under the
1. INSURANCE ON given only to seaworthiness. Phil. Merchant Marine
CARGO: it must be an "insurer on Roques defense is Rules.
properly loaded, ship or that as a mere Issue: WON the
stowed, dunnaged, and shipowner's shipper of cargo, they payment made by
secured so as not to interest." have no control of American Home to
imperil the navigation the ship therefore Caltex amounted to
of the vessel to cause Due diligence not a seaworthiness has admission that the
injury to the vessel or defense nothing to do with vessel was seaworthy
cargo. Warranty the matter of Held: NO. The
2. INSURANCE ON precludes any insurance over the payment made by
VESSEL: ship is not defense that logs. American Home
unseaworthy because insured had Issue: WON the operates as a waiver
of some defect in exercised due implied warranty of of its right to enforce
loading or stowage diligence to seaworthiness also the term of the
which is easily curable make the ship applies to marine implied warranty
by those on board, and seaworthy. insurance on cargo. against Caltex under
was cured before the SHIP MUST Held: YES For every the insurance policy.
loss. ACTUALLY BE contract of insurance However, the same
3. DECK CARGO: SEAWORTHY which is a subject of cannot be validly
carrying it raises a marine insurance, a interpreted as an
presumption of Seaworthiness as to warranty is implied automatic admission
unseaworthiness which cargo that the ship will be of the vessels
can be overcome only Ship may be seaworthy. Since the seaworthiness by
by showing seaworthy for law provides for an American home as to
affirmatively that the purpose of implied warranty of foreclose recourse
deck cargo was not insurance on seaworthiness in against Delsan for
likely to interfere with the ship, but every contract of any liability under its
the due management may still be marine insurance, it contractual obligation
of the vessel. unseaworthy becomes the as a common carrier.
for purpose of obligation of a cargo The fact of payment
Where ship becomes insurance of owner to look for a grants the private
unseaworthy during the cargo (ex. reliable common respondent
voyage Ship with carrier which keeps subrogatory right w/c
General Rule: porthole only 1 its vessels in enables it to exercise
There is no implied foot above seaworthy condition. legal remedies that
warranty that the waterline may The shipper of the would otherwise be
vessel will remain in a be fit to travel cargo may have no available to Caltex as
seaworthy condition the sea, but not control over the owner of the lost
throughout the life of fit to carry vessel but he has full cargo..
the policy. wheat or rice control in the choice
1. When the because water of the common b) Voyage and
vessel becomes will go into the carrier that will Deviation
unseaworthy ship via the transport his goods.
during the porthole and Sec. 121. When
voyage, it is damage the Delsan Transport v
the voyage
the duty of the cargo) CA
contemplated by a
master, as the
marine insurance policy
shipowner's Roque v IAC Facts: Caltex entered
is described by the
representative, into a contract of
places of beginning and
to exercise due Facts: Manila Bay affreightment with
ending, the voyage
diligence to Lighterage Corp, a Delasan Transport
insured in one which
make it common carrier, Lines to transport
conforms to the course
seaworthy entered into a Caltexs fuel oil from
of sailing fixed by
again, and if contract w/ Roque its refinery to
mercantile usage
loss should whereby Manila Bay different parts of the
between those places.
occur because Lighterage would country. However,
of his carry on board its the ship to
negligence in barge Roques logs Zamboanga which
Sec. 122. If the
repairing the from Palawan to was insured by
course of sailing is not
defect, the Manila. The logs were American Home Corp.
fixed by mercantile
insurer is insured by Pioneer sank. American Home

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 177 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

increased risk property is not


2. Ports of
usage, the voyage or not justified, unless
destination
insured by a marine WHY does it is to save
3. Intermediate
insurance policy is that improper another
ports of call
way between the places deviation vessel in
Names: 1. Voyage insured is the one distress, a
specified, which to a exonerate?
1. Ports of which conforms to course deviation for
master of ordinary skill Because
departure of sailing fixed by the purpose
and discretion, would insured
2. Ports of mercantile usage between of saving life
mean the most natural, novated
destination - ports (Sec. 121) does not
direct and contract
Several routes 2. constitute a
advantageous. without consent
to destination breach of
of insurer!
TEST: WON warranty.
Sec. 123. deviation was Justification
Deviation is a proper or not rests on ground
departure from the (NOT WON risk of humanity.
course of the voyage was increased
insured, mentioned in or diminished) Deviation to repair
Rule: damaged ship
the last two sections,
- Fixed Route If during
or an unreasonable General Rule:
- Usual Custom
delay in pursuing the when the voyage voyage, vessel
- Discretionary (most
voyage or the covered by the policy is becomes so
natural)
commencement of an described by the places damaged as to
entirely different of beginning and render it unsafe
Deviation (Sec. 123) without
voyage. ending, the voyage
Is any undergoing
insured is the one
unexcused which conforms to the repairs, insurer
Sec. 124. A departure course of sailing fixed is not relieved
deviation is proper: from the by mercantile usage by deviation
(a) When caused regular course between the places, or from the ships
by circumstances over or route of the in absence of the latter, course in order
which neither the insured voyage the way between the to make the
master nor the owner or any other act places that to a master nearest port for
of the ship has any which of ordinary skill and such repairs
control; substantially discretion would mean (can fall under
(b) When alters the risk the most natural, direct avoid peril)
necessary to comply constitutes a and advantageous Master must
with a warranty, or to deviation route. The insurer is consider
avoid a peril, whether Departure not liable for a loss distance,
or not the peril is from course of after an improper facilities of
insured against; ship deviation from the port, quickness
(c) When made in Unreasonable usual course or the new material
good faith, and upon delay in best course [terms in can be
reasonable grounds of pursuing quotation mine]. procured, etc.
belief in its necessity to voyage Exception: the (not necessarily
avoid a peril; or Commencemen insurer is not nearest port,
(d) When made in t of entirely exonerated from but must be
good faith, for the different liability for loss most proper
purpose of saving voyage happening after proper port for repair).
human life or relieving deviation. The effect is Once repair is
another vessel in Proper and Improper as if there was no made, ship
distress. Deviation deviation. must pursue
PROPER new course
deviation When deviation is without
Sec. 125. Every those allowed proper deviation in
deviation not specified by law (Sec. No vitiation of shortest and
in the last section is 124) the policy if the most
improper. IMPROPER deviation is expeditious
deviation all justified or manner
other deviation caused by (otherwise, this
Sec. 126. An not mentioned actual is deviation and
insurer is not liable for in Sec. 124; necessity will absolve
any loss happening to any loss which is equal insurer)
the thing insured suffered by in importance
subsequent to an thing insured to such Waiver of warranty
improper deviation. subsequent to deviation. against improper
improper Such deviation
deviation compulsory Done by
What Voyage exonerates deviations are expressly
Insured insurer from risks impliedly permitting
Policy What ship must do
liability, assumed by the waiver in policy
Names: Vessel insured MUST follow
regardless of underwriter. at a PREMIUM
1. Ports of course SPECIFIED
whether While deviation to be hereafter
depature deviation to save arranged,

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 178 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

provided DUE warranty 3) Proper


heard of. The length of
NOTICE be extends to papers must be
time which is sufficient
given by insured's produced when
to raise this
insured upon interest in necessary to
presumption depends
recipt of advice all the prove
on the circumstances of
of such property ownership.
the case.
deviation. intended to Production not
Requirement: be covered excused
EXPRESSED in by the because the
Sec. 133. When a
policy. policy, but papers were
ship is prevented, at an
PREMIUM paid, not to the lost by the fault
intermediate port, from
NOTICE given interest of a of the master.
completing the voyage,
third
by the perils insured
c) Other Implied person not
against, the liability of
Warranties covered by 5. LOSS a marine insurer on the
When the policy.
cargo continues after
Nationality or A warranty of
5.1. Kinds covered, they are thus
Neutrality of national Actual and reshipped.
ship or cargo is character may Constructive Loss Nothing in this section
expressly be gathered
shall prevent an insurer
warranted, its from the
from requiring an
implied ship will language of the Sec. 127. A loss
additional premium if
carry policy although may be either total or
the hazard be increased
requisite an exception partial.
by this extension of
documents has been made
liability.
showing where the fact
nationality or recited could Sec. 128. Every
neutrality and have no loss which is not total is
Sec. 134. In
will not carry relation to the partial.
addition to the liability
documents that risk.
mentioned in the last
will cause Implied that
section, a marine
reasonable ship will not Sec. 129. A total
insurer is bound for
suspicion engage in any loss may be either
damages, expenses of
- Nationality venture which actual or constructive.
discharging, storage,
- doesnt is illegal under
reshipment, extra
mean that the laws of the
freightage, and all
the ship country where Sec. 130. An
other expenses
was built in contract is actual total loss is
incurred in saving
such made or before cause by:
cargo reshipped
country, whose courts (a) A total
pursuant to the last
but that the question may destruction of the thing
section, up to the
property come; CANNOT insured;
amount insured.
belongs to be waived since (b) The
Nothing in this or in the
a subject rule of public irretrievable loss of the
preceding section shall
thereof policy. thing by sinking, or by
render a marine insurer
- Neutrality Implied being broken up;
liable for any amount in
property warranty to (c) Any damage to
excess of the insured
insured carry requisite the thing which renders
value or, if there be
belongs to documents: it valueless to the
none, of the insurable
neutrals; a 1) Warranty of owner for the purpose
value.
warranty of nationality also for which he held it; or
neutrality requires that (d) Any other event
imports the vessel be which effectively
Sec. 135. Upon
that the conducted and deprives the owner of
an actual total loss, a
property documented as the possession, at the
person insured is
insured is of such nation, port of destination, of
entitled to payment
neutral in a breach of the thing insured.
without notice of
fact, and in warranty in
abandonment.
appearance either particular
and will avoid the Sec. 131. A
conduct, policy. constructive total loss
Sec. 136. Where
that the 2) Warranty is is one which gives to a
it has been agreed that
property a continuing person insured a right
an insurance upon a
shall belong one, change of to abandon, under
particular thing, or
to neutrals, nationality is a Section one hundred
class of things, shall be
that no act breach of the thirty-nine.
free from particular
of insured warranty, but
average, a marine
or his agent warranty is not
insurer is not liable for
shall be broken by a Sec. 132. An
any particular average
done which contract for actual loss may be
loss not depriving the
can legally sale and presumed from the
insured of the
compromis transfer to an continued absence of a
possession, at the port
e its alien at a future ship without being
of destination, of the
neutrality; date.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 179 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

Insured has may have come


deprives owner of
whole of such thing, or ABSOLUTE right to the hands of
possession, at the
class of things, even to claim whole the insured.
port of destination
though it becomes amount of
of thing insured.
entirely worthless; but insurance even Why differentiate
5. Under Section 130,
such insurer is liable for without notice between the 2
the complete
his proportion of all of types of total loss:
physical destruction
general average loss abandonment. the kind of loss is
of the subject
assessed upon the Once he the basis for the
matter as in the
thing insured. receives application of the
case of fire is not
amount, it doctrine of
essential to
takes the place abandonment
constitute an actual
Sec. 137. An of the vessel (Section 138, 139).
total loss ([b], [c],
insurance confined in and must be In actual total loss,
[d]). Such loss may
terms to an actual loss used to pay for no abandonment
exist where the
does not cover a any damage for necessary; but if
form and specie of
constructive total loss, which it be held loss merely
the thing is
but covers any loss, liable. constructively total,
destroyed although
which necessarily an abandonment
the materials of
results in depriving the b. Constructive (or becomes necessary
which it consisted
insured of the Technical) total loss; to recover as for a
still exist (Pan
possession, at the port Abandonment (refer total loss.
Malayan v. CA
of destination, of the to the next few Stipulation of
[91]). For example,
entire thing insured. sections) actual total loss
when repairs would
Loss, although only strictly
be more expensive
than the original not actually construed: an
KINDS of LOSS
cost of the vessel loss, is of insurance against
and effective character that total loss only
1) Total underwriter
deprivation of use the insured is covers any total
is liable for the whole of
and possession of entitled, if he loss, actual or
the amount insured
property. thinks fit, to constructive,
- may be actual
treat it as total although there is
or absolute OR
Presumed from by authority to the
constructive or
abandonment. contrary. If against
technical continued
Gives the absolute or
absence of ship
insured the actual total loss,
2) Partial (refer to gen. without being
right to insurer not liable
and part average) heard of (for
abandon the for constructive
TOTAL LOSS (any length of time
thing insured loss.
loss not total is sufficient to
raise such by relinquishing
partial)
to the insurer Liability of insurer in
presumption)
his interest in case of partial loss of
a. Actual Total Loss
such a thing, ship or its equipment
1. Total destruction General Rule:
entitling him to There is a
thing insured if a vessel is not heard
2. Irretrievable loss of at all within a recover for a deduction from the
reasonable time after total loss cost of repairs of
of thing by
sinking or by being sailing or for a thereof one third new for
reasonable time after Right to old, on the theory
broken up
3. Any damage to she was last seen, she abandon that the new
will be presumed to granted by law materials render
thing which renders
it valueless to have been lost from a if the peril the vessel much
peril insured against. insured against more valuable than
owner for the
purpose for which How causes a loss of it was before the
presumption is more than loss. When repairs
the owner held it
established: Plaintiff the value of the are made, one-
Loss by sinking
must prove that vessel thing insured. third of the cost of
may not be
left the port of outfit for Insurer the repair is laid
irretrievable,
the voyage insured. acquires all upon the insured as
but theres still
Then, he must show rights over the his burden, and the
actual total loss
that the vessel was not thing insured implied agreement
if thing
heard of at port of If abandonment under the policy is
becomes
departure after sailing, is not proper or that in case of
valueless to
without calling properly made, damage to the ship
owner for
witnesses from port of the insurer by a peril within the
purpose for
destination to show she would still be policy, the loss
which he held it
never arrived there. No liable as upon shall be estimated
TOTAL LOSS is
rule as to the time after the Actual total at two-thirds of the
cost of
which missing vessel is loss, deducting cost of repairs fairly
RETRIEVAL
presumed lost from the executed or one-
equal to or
depends on the amount any third new for old,
more than
circumstances of the proceeds from as is commonly
original value
case. the thing expressed.
4. Any other event
which effectively insured which

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 180 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

IF VOYAGE CANT BE discharging, against which is not a Applies only


COMPLETED (See Sec. storage, general average loss when it is
133) reshipment, out of the ordinary use SUCCESSFUL
In Insurance extra of the thing Includes all
Act (Sec.126), freiathage, and Not everyone damages and
if ship is all other benefits. expenses which
prevented from expenses Not are deliberately
leaving an incurred in intentionally caused in order
intermediate saving cargo caused to to save the
port by perils reshipped prevent a vessel, its
insured against, such liability, common cargo or both
the master however, danger at the same
must make cannot exceed Insurer liable time, from a
every exertion the amount of for the real and known
to procure, in insurance (Sec particular risk
the same or 134) average unless Therefore,
contiguous policy excludes when everyone
port, another General Rule: it. benefits,
ship for the if the original ship be Liability is everyone has to
purpose of disabled, and the limited to the spend for it, so
conveying the master, acting with a proportion of the person
cargo to its wise discretion, as the the contribution whose cargo
destination and agent of the merchant attaching to his was sacrificed
the liability of a and the shipowner, policy value cannot recover
marine insurer forwards the cargo in where this is everything
thereon another ship, such less than the because part of
continues after necessary and contributing that will go to
they are thus justifiable change of value of the the pro-rata
reshipped. ship will not discharge thing insured. damage to save
However, such the underwriter on the Liability for the majority
an obligation goods from liability for particular General
was deleted any loss which may insurance average
from the take place on goods General Rule: contribution is
Insurance after such reshipment. an insurer is liable for a device for a
Code. Campos Exception: both general and limited
says that this the general rule is not particular average loss. distribution of
may be either obligatory if the crew Exception: loss. Loss is
an had to procure a vessel parties can stipulate, as pro tanto made
unintentional from distant places and it often happens in up by
omission/error there are serious marine insurance, that proportionate
or intentional. impediments in the way the insurer will not be or general
In any case, in of putting the cargo on liable for loss, partial or average
case of board. total, arising from contributions
reshipment, Subsidiary perils of the sea, of a from owners of
the insurer is Rule: additional certain class of goods interests
liable: premium may be which are perishable or benefited by
1. For any loss required if the hazard is peculiarly subject to the sacrifice.
which may take increased by extension damage. A principle of
place on goods of liability. Exception: customary law,
until they are they may also agree to independent of
reshipped if LIABILITY OF exempt particular contract
voyage cannot INSURER IN CASE OF average. Then, insurer Ex. Entering
be completed in AVERAGE is liable only for general another port for
any insurance Average any average and not for repairs,
upon cargo extraordinary or particular average rehandling of
insurer may accidental expenses EXCEPT if the particular cargo, and
required incurred during the average loss has the jettisoning of
additional voyage for the effect of depriving goods to
premium if the preservation of the insured of possession lighten vessel
hazard be vessel, cargo or both at the port of in case of
increased by and all damages to the destination of the danger of
the extension vessel and cargo from whole of the thing shipwreck
of liability (Sec. the time it is loaded insured. Gives rise to
133) and the voyage
right of owner
2. Insurer also commenced until it b. General Average to contribution
liable for ends and the cargo common benefit (to form those
expenses unloaded everyone) benefited
necessary to INTENTIONAL thereby or from
complete the Two kind of damage to save the insurer
transportaion of Averages (Under majority thing Formalities in
cargo Admiralty Law): (something is Art. 813 and
reshipped; a. Particular Average sacrificed). 814 of the Code
damages, partial loss caused by
of Commerce
expenses of the peril insured

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 181 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

must be is The above provision is loss, the insurer, Ins.


complied with sacrific mandatory in terms, Society of Canton
to incur ed and insurers, whether refused it and
expenses and deliber for vessel, cargo or required that the ship
cause damages ately freightage, are bound be salvaged. After
corresponding 3. From to contribute to the several futile
to gross the indemnity of the attempts, the ship
average. expens general average. This was finally raised
Liability of es or places insurer on same about two months
Insurer: If damag footing as others who later and was
owner is es have an interest in the repaired. The cost of
insured, he has caused vessel or cargo, at time salvage and repair
the alternative follows of occurrence of the was substantially
of seeking from the general average and equal to the original
his insurer, saving who are compelled to cost of the vessel.
subrogating the of the contribute. Issue: WON
latter to his vessel Insurance Society
said right of and Formula for can be held for total
contribution. He cargo computing loss of the vessel
loses this 4. That liability of even after its
alternative, the insurer recovery
however, if he expens Held: YES. Insurer
neglects or es or Amt of liable for total loss
waives his right damag insurance____ x because while the
to such es General Aveage = ship was in the
contribution should Proportion of GAL for bottom of the sea, it
Exception: have Total amt or value was of no value to
There can be been involved Loss the owner. To render
no recovery for incurre (GAL) which it valueless to the
general d or insurer is liable insured, it is no
average loss inflicte necessary that there
against the d after Limit as to be an actual or total
insurer: taking liability of loss or destruction of
1. After the insurer for all the different parts
the proper general of the entire vessel.
separati legal average loss
on of steps. It is limited to the Choa v CA
the 5. Made proportion of
interest by the contribution attaching Facts: Choa
s liable master to his policy value imported some
to the or upon where this is less than lactose crystals from
contrib his the contributing value Holland. The goods
ution authorit of the thing insured. In were insured with
2. When y other words, the Filipino Merchants
the 6. Not liability of the insurer against all risks.
insured caused shall be less than the Upon arrival in
has by any proportion of the Manila, it was found
neglect fault of general average loss that out of the 600
ed or party assessed upon the bags, 403 were in
waived asking thing insured where its bad order. Choa filed
his for contributing value is a claim for the loss
right to contrib more than the amount but Fil. Mer rejected.
contrib ution of the insurance. In Issue: WON an all
ution. 7. Necess such a case, the risks coverage
Requisites for ary insured is liable to covers only losses
Gen. Ave to Liability of contribute ratably with occasioned by
exist insurer for the insurer to the fortuitous events
1. There general indemnity of the Held: NO. An all risk
must be average general average: insurance policy
commo insures against all
n cause Limit
Amount of insurance __ X Proportion of general of ofconceivable
liability
Art. 859, Code of Value of thePhilippine
thing loss = oforinsurer damage
average loss assessed
danger Commerce. The insured upon thing insured
to ship Manufacturing Co v except as otherwise
underwriters of the excluded in the policy
and Insurance Society
vessels, of the or due to fraud. The
cargo of Canton Ltd.
freightage and of the terms of the policy
2. For cargo shall be obliged
commo Facts: The insured are clear and require
to pay for the no interpretation. An
n vessel owned by Phil.
indemnity of the gross all risks provision
safety, Manufacturing Co.
average in so far as is creates a special type
part of sand due to a
required of each one of of insurance w/c
the typhoon. Despite the
these objects extends coverage to
vessel offer of Phil Man. To
respectively. risks not usually
or abandon the vessel
cargo as an absolute total contemplated and

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 182 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

avoids putting upon aboard the barges of even if some of the


without incurring either
the insured the Transpacific Towage rice seeds was
an expense to the
burden of Inc. It was insured recovered.
insured of more than
establishing that with Oriental Held: YES. The
three-fourths the value
insurer can avoid Assurance Corp and complete physical
of the thing abandoned
coverage upon loaded on 2 barges. destruction of the
or a risk which a
demonstrating that a However, during the subject matter is not
prudent man would not
specific provision voyage, 497 pieces of essential t oconstitute
take under the
expressly excludes the 598 pieces loaded an actual total loss.
circumstances; or
the loss from on one of the barges Such a loss may exist
(d) If the thing
coverage. was lost. where the form and
insured, being cargo or
Issue: WON Panama specie of the thing is
freightage, and the
can demand payment destroyed although
voyage cannot be
for constructive loss the materials which it
performed, nor another
of the logs on one of consisted still exist.
ship procured by the
Aboitiz Shipping v the barges Of the 34,122 bags of
master, within a
PHILAMGEN Held: NO. The logs rice seeds shipped,
reasonable time and
involved, although 27,922 bags were
with reasonable
Facts: Marinduque placed in two barges, determined to be
diligence, to forward
Mining Industrial were not separately lost/damaged (78%
the cargo, without
Crop had shipped valued by the policy, of cargo damaged).
incurring the like
from the US a nor separately
expense or risk
shipment of one skid insured. Resultantly,
mentioned in the
carton parts for the logs lost in the
preceding sub-
valves. When cargo barge in relation to
paragraph. But
arrived in Manila, it the total number of
freightage cannot in
was deposited in the logs loaded on the
any case be abandoned
office of Aboitiz same barge can not 6. ABANDONMENT unless the ship is also
Shipping Corp for be made the basis for
abandoned.
transshipment to determining 6.1. Requisites and
Nonoc Island. constructive total Conditions
However, before it loss. The logs having
Sec. 140. An
was transshipped, been insured as one
Sec. 138. abandonment must be
said cargo was inseparate unit, the
Abandonment, neither partial nor
pilfered. Marinduque correct basis for
in marine insurance, is conditional.
filed a claim against determining the
Aboitiz in the amount existence of the act of the insured
of the pilfered cargo. constructive total loss by which, after a
It also filed for the is the totality of the constructive total loss, Sec. 141. An
same amount against shipment of logs. he declares the abandonment must be
Philippine American (OF the 1,208 logs, relinquishment to the made within a
General Insurance Co only 497 pieces were insurer of his interest in reasonable time after
(Phil-Am), its insurer. lost or 41% therefore the thing insured. receipt of reliable
Issue: WON Aboitiz it cannot fall under information of the loss,
should be held liable constructive total but where the
for the pilfered cargo. loss) Sec. 139. A information is of a
Held: YES. The person insured by a doubtful character, the
questioned shipment Pan Malayan contract of marine insured is entitled to a
is covered by a Insurance v CA insurance may abandon reasonable time to
continuing open the thing insured, or make inquiry.
insurance coverage Facts: The barge any particular portion
from the time it was carrying a shipment thereof separately
loaded in the US to of certified rice seeds valued by the policy, or Sec. 142. Where
the time it was to Kampuchea sank. otherwise separately the information upon
delivered to the The owner of the rice insured, and recover which an abandonment
possession of Aboitiz seeds, the Food and for a total loss thereof, has been made proves
in its Manila office. Agricultural when the cause of the incorrect, or the thing
Aboitizs contention is Organization of the loss is a peril insured insured was so far
that it could not be U.N. (FAO) filed its against: restored when the
held liable for the claim under a marine (a) If more than abandonment was
pilferage as it was insurance policy with three-fourths thereof in made that there was
stolen even before it Pan Malayan. Later, it value is actually lost, or then in fact no total
was loaded on the was informed by would have to be loss, the abandonment
vessel. This is Luzon Stevedoring expended to recover it becomes ineffectual.
untenable as the logs Corporation, the from the peril;
were in its possession carrier, that the (b) If it is injured
before it was pilfered. shipment was to such an extent as to Sec. 143.
recovered, hence FAO reduce its value more Abandonment
Oriental Assurance filed a claim w/ Luzon than three-fourths; is made by giving
v CA Stevedoring for (c) If the thing notice thereof to the
compensation fo insured is a ship, and insurer, which may be
Facts: Panama damages of its cargo. the contemplated done orally, or in
Sawmill Co had logs Issue: WoN FAO can voyage cannot be writing; Provided, That
shipped from Palawan recover for total loss lawfully performed if the notice be done

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 183 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

constructive a risk which a


orally, a written notice Sec. 150. The total loss, he prudent man
of such abandonment acceptance of an declares the would not take
shall be submitted abandonment may be relinquishment under the
within seven days from either express or to the insurer circumstances
such oral notice. implied from the of his interest 4. If the thing
conduct of the insurer. in the thing insured, being
The mere silence of the insured. The cargo or
Sec. 144. A notice insurer for an insured chooses freightage, and
of abandonment must unreasonable length of to take the the voyage
be explicit, and must time after notice shall proceeds in cant be
specify the particular be construed as an place of the performed, nor
cause of the acceptance. remaining parts another ship
abandonment, but need of the thing, procured by
state only enough to which is ceded the master,
show that there is Sec. 151. The to the within a
probable cause acceptance of an insurer. reasonable
therefor, and need not abandonment, whether Right to time and with
be accompanied with express or implied, is abandon is reasonable
proof of interest or of conclusive upon the granted by law diligence, to
loss. parties, and admits the to the insured if fowrward the
loss and the sufficiency peril insured cargo, without
of the abandonment. against causes incurring the
Sec. 145. An a loss of more like expense or
abandonment can be than the risk mentioned
sustained only upon the Sec. 152. An thing insured, in the
cause specified in the abandonment once or where its preceding sub-
notice thereof. made and accepted is value is paragraph. But
irrevocable, unless the reduced by freightage
ground upon which it more than cannot in any
Sec. 146. An was made proves to be Remember: case be
abandonment is unfounded. 75% loss = abandoned
equivalent to a transfer Constructive unless the ship
by the insured of his Loss which is also
interest to the insurer, Sec. 153. On an entitles abandoned.
with all the chances of accepted abandonment recovery of Requirements:
recovery and of a ship, freightage the full amount 1. There must be
indemnity. earned previous to the in the policy. actual
loss belongs to the Does not mean relinquishmen
insurer of said that recovery is t by the person
Sec. 147. If a marine freightage; but only up to insured of his
insurer pays for a loss freightage 75%. interest in the
as if it were an actual subsequently earned When Constructive thing insured
total loss, he is entitled belongs to the insurer TOTAL loss exists: (138)
to whatever may of the ship. Rule (Sec. 139) 2. There must be
remain of the thing 1. If more than constructive
insured, or its proceeds thereof in total loss
or salvage, as if there Sec. 154. If an value is (139). Any
had been a formal insurer refuses to actually lost, particular
abandonment. accept a valid or would have portion of the
abandonment, he is to be thing insured
liable as upon actual expended to separately
Sec. 148. Upon an total loss, deducting recover from valued by the
abandonment, acts from the amount any peril policy may be
done in good faith by proceeds of the thing 2. If it is injured separately
those who were agents insured which may to such an abandoned as it
of the insured in have come to the extent as to is deemed
respect to the thing hands of the insured. reduce its separately
insured, subsequent to value more insured
the loss, are at the risk than 3. It must be
of the insurer and for Sec. 155. If a 3. IF the thing total and
his benefit. person insured omits to insured is a absolute (140)
abandon, he may ship, and the 4. It must be
nevertheless recover contemplated within a
Sec. 149. Where notice his actual loss. voyage cant reasonable
of abandonment is be lawfully time after the
properly given, the performed w/o receipt of
ABANDONMENT incurring either reliable
rights of the insured
Abandonment, an expense to information of
are not prejudiced by
in marine the insured or the loss (141)
the fact that the insurer
insurance, is more than 5. It must be
refuses to accept the
the act of the the value of factual (142)
abandonment.
insured by the thing 6. It must be
which, after a abandoned or made by giving

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 184 of 355


INSURANCE CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

notice thereof
to the insurer
which may be
done orally or
in writing (143)
7. Notice must
be explicit
and must
specify the
particular
cause of the
abandonment
(144)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 185 of 355


Ineffective abandonment
Abandonme Equivalent to transfer by ACCEPTANCE NO ABAN-DON-
nt can be the insured of his interest to Express or Implied MENT
sustained the insurer, with all the from conduct of Insured still
only upon chances of recovery and insurer entitled to recover
cause indemnity actual loss
specified IF proper and notice is Mere silence for
If cause is properly given, refusal to unreasonable Same rule applies
unfounded accept abandonment does length of time may where abandon-
and info not prejudice insured. be deemed ment wasnt proper
upon which Insured still liable for actual acceptance or where it wasnt
it was made total loss, minus amount any properly made
proves proceeds of thing insured
incorrect which may have come to the
Thing hands of the insured.
insured was IF insurer accepts
so far abandonment, its
restored conclusive between the
when the parties and admits the loss
abandonme and the sufficiency of the
nt was abandonment
made that Irrevocable unless grounds
there was in prove to be unfounded
fact no total
loss

Necessity for abandonment Philippine rule insured many not abandon


TECHNICAL TOTAL LOSS: insured cant unless loss/damage is more than of
claim the whole insurance without showing value as indicated in 139.
due regard to the interest the underwriter Abandonment where insurance divisible and
may take in the abandoned property. If where indivisible
underwriter can save some parts, he is Things separately valued by the policy may
entitled to timely notice of abandonment be separately abandoned because they are
and he cant be liable for a total loss separately insured (Section 139) This is a
without it. But there is no obligation to question of intention to be determined by
abandoninsureds choice. He still recovers the language used
actual loss even if he doesnt abandon
(155). Criterion as to extent of loss
International Rule: General Rule: The extent of injury to the
right of abandonment of vessels, as a legal vessel is considered with reference to the general
limitation of a ship owners liability, does market value immediately before the disaster. The
not apply where injury or average was rule is said to apply even though the policy is
caused by ship owners own fault. Art.587 valued but some think otherwise. If the policy is
(Code of Commerce) refers only to cases of expressly provides that the valuation will be used,
captains fault or negligence. If owner is it should be followed. The expenses incurred or to
also at fault, Civil Code provisions on be incurred by the insured recovering the thing
Common Carriers apply. insured are also considered (ex. cost for refloating
When there is constructive total loss the ship).
Notice of abandonment must be explicit
Abandonment must be absolute Notice cannot just be inferred from some
General Rule: To cover the whole interest equivocal acts. There must be an intention
insured, abandonment must be unconditional. to abandon, apparent from the
Exception: if only part of the thing is communication.
covered by the insurance, the insurer need only The use of the word abandon is not
abandon that part. necessary.
There is no abandonment although the
Abandonment must be made within a insured has given notice of an intention to
reasonable time abandon if he continues to claim and use
Once the insured received the notice of the property as his own.
loss, he must choose within a reasonable
time WON he will abandon to the insurer. If Notice of abandonment must specify
he chooses to do so, he must give notice so particular cause thereof
that the insurer may not be prejudiced by The grounds must be stated with such
the delay and may take immediate steps particularity as to enable the insurer to
for the preservation of the property. determine WON he is bound to accept the
Reasonable time - depending on the facts offer.
and circumstances in each case. If the first Probable cause of abandonment contained
notice is not clearly made, the insured must in the notice is sufficient.
have sufficient time to ascertain the facts. Proof of interest or of loss is not necessary
He cannot wait an undue length of time to in the notice.
see if it will be more profitable to abandon
or claim for partial loss. Proof of other causes not admissible
Sufficient grounds for abandonment must
Abandonment must be factual be stated to make the abandonment valid.
1. Existence of loss at time of abandonment - He cannot avail himself of any ground other
the right of the insured to choose between than those he stated.
abandonment or recovery for total loss
depends on the facts at the time of the Form of acceptance of abandonment
offer to abandon and not upon the state Need not be express. It may be implied by
disclosed by the information received or
conduct, as from an act of the insurer in
state of loss before the time of offer
consequence of an abandonment, which
2. Effect of subsequent events - none. Once
can only be justified under a right derived
the abandonment is made good the rights
from the abandonment (ex. when the
of the parties become fixed. The same is
insurer took possession of the ship and
true when the abandonment is not made
made repairs already followed by retention
good. Subsequent events will not affect it
for an unreasonable amount of time)
as to retroactively impart validity.
Silence, if not for an unreasonable amount
a. Insured cannot abandon when the thing
of time will not operate as an acceptance
is safe or when he knew at the time he
made the offer that the vessel had
Right of the insurer to freightage
been repaired and is continuing
General Rule: a validly made
voyage.
abandonment passes to the insurer the interest
b. If after abandonment, the thing is
that the insured has over the thing
recovered, insured may not withdraw.
Subsidiary Rule, as to a ship: the
3. Instances justifying abandonment - insured
insurer, after abandonment, becomes the owner
may abandon for a total loss in case of
thereof and his title becomes vested as of the time
capture, seizure, or detention of the ship or
of the loss.
cargo; restraint by blockade or embargo;
Subsidiary Rule, as to freightage:
funds for repair cannot be raised w/o fault
depends upon when such freightage was earned. If
of owner; where voyage absolutely lost;
subsequent to the loss, it belongs to the insurer of
where sale made by master of the vessel
the ship. If previously earned, to the insurer of the
because of urgent necessity.
freightage who is subrogated to the rights of the
insured up to the time of the loss.
Information need not be direct or positive
Direct or positive information not necessary
Effects of acceptance of abandonment
(ex. newspaper report, letter from an
1. Upon receiving notice of abandonment, the
agent)
insurer may accept or reject
The information must be of such facts and
abandonment.
circumstances as to render it highly 2. Insurer becomes liable for whole
probable that a constructive total loss has amount of insurance and becomes
occurred, and facts sufficient to constitute a entitled to all the rights which the
total loss must exist. But the facts and insured has over the thing
information need not be the same. 3. The parties rights become fixed.
4. The insurer may no longer rely on any
Form of notice of abandonment insufficiency in the form, time or right
General Rule: no particular form of giving of abandonment. WON the insured has a
notice of abandonment is required by law. It may right to abandon is immaterial where offer
be made orally unless the policy requires that it be is already accepted and there is no fraud.
made in writing. Notice by telegraph may be 5. EXCEPTION to the general effects of
sufficient. acceptance: when the ground upon which it
Subsidiary Rule: if notice is done orally, was made proves to be unfounded.
the insured must submit to the insurer a written 6. Abandonment can be sustained only
notice w/in 7 days from the oral notice upon the ground specified in the notice.
cost cannot be ascertained, its market value at the
Effect of refusal to accept a valid
time and place of lading, adding the charges
abandonment on insurers liability
incurred in purchasing and placing it on board, but
General Rule: the insureds right to
without reference to any loss incurred in raising
abandon is absolute when it is justified by
money for its purchase, or to any drawback on its
circumstances. Acceptance is not necessary to
exportation, or to the fluctuation of the market at
validate it.
the port of destination, or to expenses incurred on
the way or on arrival;
(Actual Loss)
- (Proceeds the insurer (c) The value of freightage is the gross
might have received freightage, exclusive of primage, without reference
from the damaged to the cost of earning it; and
property)_________
(d) The cost of insurance is in each case to be
(Liability of insurer)
added to the value thus estimated.
Subsidiary Rule: upon proper
abandonment, insured may still recover to the
extent of the damage proved
Sec. 162. If cargo insured against partial loss
arrives at the port of destination in a damaged
7. MEASURE OF INDEMNITY condition, the loss of the insured is deemed to be
the same proportion of the value which the market
7.1. Open and Valued Policy price at that port, of the thing so damaged, bears
to the market price it would have brought if sound.

Sec. 156. A valuation in a policy of marine


insurance in conclusive between the parties thereto Sec. 163. A marine insurer is liable for all the
in the adjustment of either a partial or total loss, if expenses attendant upon a loss which forces the
the insured has some interest at risk, and there is ship into port to be repaired; and where it is
no fraud on his part; except that when a thing has stipulated in the policy that the insured shall labor
been hypothecated by bottomry or respondentia, for the recovery of the property, the insurer is
before its insurance, and without the knowledge of liable for the expense incurred thereby, such
the person actually procuring the insurance, he expense, in either case, being in addition to a total
may show the real value. But a valuation loss, if that afterwards occurs.
fraudulent in fact, entitles the insurer to rescind the
contract.
Sec. 164. A marine insurer is liable for a loss
falling upon the insured, through a contribution in
Sec. 157. A marine insurer is liable upon a respect to the thing insured, required to be made
partial loss, only for such proportion of the amount by him towards a general average loss called for by
insured by him as the loss bears to the value of the a peril insured against; provided, that the liability
whole interest of the insured in the property of the insurer shall be limited to the proportion of
insured. contribution attaching to his policy value where this
is less than the contributing value of the thing
insured.
Sec. 158. Where profits are separately
insured in a contract of marine insurance, the
insured is entitled to recover, in case of loss, a Sec. 165. When a person insured by a
proportion of such profits equivalent to the contract of marine insurance has a demand against
proportion which the value of the property lost others for contribution, he may claim the whole
bears to the value of the whole. loss from the insurer, subrogating him to his own
right to contribution. But no such claim can be
made upon the insurer after the separation of the
Sec. 159. In case of a valued policy of marine interests liable to the contribution, nor when the
insurance on freightage or cargo, if a part only of insured, having the right and opportunity to
the subject is exposed to the risk, the evaluation enforce the contribution from others, has neglected
applies only in proportion to such part. or waived the exercise of that right.

Sec. 160. When profits are valued and Sec. 166. In the case of a partial loss of ship
insured by a contract of marine insurance, a loss of or its equipment, the old materials are to be
them is conclusively presumed from a loss of the applied towards payment for the new. Unless
property out of which they are expected to arise, otherwise stipulated in the policy, a marine insurer
and the valuation fixes their amount. is liable for only two-thirds of the remaining cost of
repairs after such deduction, except that anchors
must be paid in full.
Sec. 161. In estimating a loss under an open
policy of marine insurance the following rules are to
A. Valued Policy
be observed:
Valuation fixes in advance the value of the
(a) The value of a ship is its value at the property and thus avoids the necessity of
beginning of the risk, including all articles or proving its actual value in case of loss
charges which add to its permanent value or which Valuation is conclusive between the parties
are necessary to prepare it for the voyage insured; in the adjustment of either a total or partial
(b) The value of the cargo is its actual cost to loss.
the insured, when laden on board, or where the
Exception: If there is FRAUD on the part of from the loss of the property and the
the insured, insurer would have the right to valuation agreed upon in the policy
RESCISSION fixes the amount of recovery.
The change in a vessels value after a long
period of voyage cannot bind the parties, B. Open Policy
as the insured value stated in the policy is Loss is estimated in accordance with
conclusive upon them. certain rules laid down in the code (refer to
Neither party can give evidence of the real table below)
value of the thing insured. But when the Cost of insurance must be added to the
thing has been hypothecated by bottomry value of ship, cargo, or freightage as the
or respondentia before its insurance and case may be
without the knowledge of the person who However, maximum recovery may only be
actually procured the insurance, the insurer up to the face value of the policy
may show the real value but he is not
entitled to rescind the contract unless he
can prove that the valuation was in fact
fraudulent. WHAT VALUE in OPEN POLICY
When insured a co-insurer in marine Ship Value at beginning of risk (incl
insurance all articles which add to its
- In marine insurance, the insured is permanent value or which are
expected to cover by insurance the full necessary to prepare if for the
value of the property insured. If the voyage insured), not the value
value of his interest exceeds the at time she was built
amount of the insurance, he is Cargo Actual cost when laden on
considered the co-insurer for an board.
amount determined by the difference IF actual cost cant be
between the insurance taken out and determined, market value at
the value of the property: time and place of lading, PLUS
expenses incurred in
_ (partial) Loss___ Amount Amount purchasing and placing them on
value of thing X of Profits = of Recovery board.
insured
Expected profits are not
considered since they can be
- Section 157 applies only if (1) the loss is separately isnured.
partial and (2) the amount of insurance is Freightage Gross freightage without
less than the insured entire insurable reference to cost of earning it
interest in the property insured.
Loss of profits separately insured The cost of insurance is added in
- If the profits to be realized are calculating the value of the ship, cargo, or
separately insured from the vessel or
freightage of other subject matter in an
cargo, the insured is entitled to open policy.
recover, in case of loss, such proportion
Where cargo insured against partial loss is
of the profits as the value of the
damaged
property lost bears to the value of the
- Section 162 is applicable if the cargo
whole property:
is insured against a partial loss and it
suffers damage as a result of which its
Value of property lost____ Amount of Amount of market value at the port of destination
Value of the whole property X profits = recovery is reduced:
insured

Market price in sound state


- If policy is valued, loss of such profits Less: Market price in damaged state_
is conclusively presumed from a loss of = Reduction in value (depreciation)
the property out of which they are
expected to arise, and the valuation
fixes their amount. Reduced in value X amount of = amount
Where only part of a cargo or freightage Market price in insurance of
insured exposed to risk sound state recovery
- The valuation will be reduced
proportionately. The insurer is bound to C. Total Loss
return such portion of the premium as In case of open policy:
corresponds with the portion of the Value of total loss will be computed in rules
cargo which had been exposed to the stated above
risk. Insurer liable for total loss, but it cant
exceed face amount of policy
Presumption of loss of profits In case of valued policy:
- Where profits are separately insured Insurer must pay valuation fixed in the
from the property out of which they are policy without any right to argue against its
expected to arise, the insured, in case correctness except on basis of fraud
of partial loss of the property, is Liability cant exceed amount in policy
entitled merely to partial indemnity for
the profits lost. D. Partial Loss; Co-Insurance
- If the property is totally lost, pro tanto In both open and valued policies, in case of
the total profits are also lost. Such loss partial loss, the insured is deemed by law
of the profits is conclusively presumed as co-insurer if the value of the insurance is
less than the value of the property or the insured or by the person entitled to the
interest insured, even in the absence of any benefit without unnecessary delay.
agreement to that effect. It has been held however that formal notice
However, law does not prevent parties from of loss is not necessary if insurer has actual
stipulating otherwise notice of loss already.
Difference with Fire Insurance: Policy
should expressly provide for co- Proof of Loss is the formal evidence given the
insurance otherwise, insurer is liable for insurance company by the insured or claimant
the full amount of the partial loss. In under a policy of the occurrence of the loss, the
marine insurance, co-insurance is particulars and the data necessary to enable the
mandated by law. company to determine its liability and the amount.
Example of Co-Insurance: Is not tantamount to proof or evidence under the
Ship: $100 M law on evidence.
Insurance: $80M
Loss: $50M Proof of loss is distinct from notice of loss
What does insured get? $40M and intended to:
- only gets proportion 1. give the insurer information by which
he may determine the extent of his
E. Other Expenses Chargeable to Insurer liability
If ship has to make port for repairs, marine 2. afford him a means of detecting any
insurer must bear the attendant expenses fraud that may have been practiced
Insurer also liable for expenses for upon him.
recovery of the property if policy imposed
upon the insured the duty of such recovery, The law does not stipulate any requirement
such expenses being additional to total loss as to the form in which notice or proof of
loss must be given. However according to
F. Franchise Clause De Leon, it is advisable to give the notice in
Franchise = Designated Percentage writing for the protection of the insured or
Sometimes, policy on cargo may provide his beneficiary. Notice may be an informal
that unless damage reaches a designated or provisional claim containing a minimum
percentage of the value of such cargo, no of information as distinguished from a
amount will be paid by insurer. formal claim which contains full details of
If loss reaches such percentage, insured the loss, computations of the amounts
claimed, and supporting evidence, together
will be entitled to full amount of loss
with a demand or request for payment.

Nature of notice and proof of loss


Although they are in the form of conditions
precedent, they are in the nature of
conditions subsequent the breach of which
Chapter VI affects a right that has already accrued
CLAIMS, SETTLEMENT & (before the loss, insurers liability is
contingent but with the happening of the
SUBROGATION loss, his liability becomes properly fixed).
These conditions are intended merely for
1. NOTICE AND PROOF OF LOSS evidentiary purposes and do not form any
part of the conditions of liability and are
Title 10 Notice and Proof of Loss construed with much less strictness than
those conditions that operate prior to loss.
Sec. 88. In case of loss upon an insurance
against fire, an insurer is exonerated, if notice Sec. 90. All defects in a notice of loss; or in
thereof be not given to him by an insured, or preliminary proof thereof, which the insured
some person entitled to the benefit of the might remedy, and which the insurer omits to
insurance, without unnecessary delay. specify to him, without unnecessary delay, as
grounds of objection, are waived.
Sec. 89. When a preliminary proof of loss is
required by a policy, the insured is not bound to Sec. 91. Delay in the presentation to an insurer
give such proofs as would be necessary in a of notice or proof of loss is waived if caused by
court of justice; but it is sufficient for him to any act of him, or if he omits to take objection
give the best evidence3 which he has in his promptly and specifically upon that ground
power at the time.
Delay in the presentation of notice and
Notice of Loss the formal notice given the insurer proof of loss is deemed waived when due to
by the insured or claimant under a policy of the an act of the insurer, by failure to take
occurrence of the loss insured against. objection promptly and specifically upon
The purpose is to apprise the insurance that ground.
company so that it may make proper If the insured attempted to comply and the
investigation and take such action as may company made objections, the insured will
be necessary to protect its interest. be allowed a reasonable time after he is
It is necessary as the insurer cannot be appraised within which to remedy the
liable to pay a claim unless he receives defects regardless of the time prescribed by
notice of that claim. the policy for furnishing proofs. Delay as a
Under Sec. 88 insurer is exonerated if ground for resisting a claim places the
notice of loss is not given to the insurer by insurer on duty to inquire when the loss
took place, so that it could determine unfair claim settlement practices. Any
whether delay would be a valid ground to of the following acts by an insurance
object to a claim. company, if committed without just
cause and performed with such
Sec. 92. If the policy requires, by way of frequency as to indicate a general
preliminary proof of loss, the certificate or business practice, shall constitute unfair
testimony of a person other than the insured, it claim settlement practice:
is sufficient for the insured to use reasonable
diligence to procure it, and in case of the refusal (a) knowingly misrepresenting to
of such person to give it, then to furnish claimants pertinent facts or
reasonable evidence to the insurer that such policy provisions relating to
refusal was not induced by any just grounds of coverages at issue;
disbelief in the facts necessary to be certified or (b) failing to acknowledge with
testified. reasonable promptness pertinent
communications with respect to
Certificate or Testimony of Person other than claims arising under its policies;
Insured as Preliminary Proof (c) failing to adopt and implement
reasonable standards for the
May be required by the policy prompt investigation of claims
Sufficient that he insured use reasonable arising under its policies;
diligence to procure it (d) not attempting in good faith to
If person refuses to give it, it is sufficient to effectuate prompt, fair and
furnish reasonable evidence to the insurer equitable settlement of claims
that such refusal was not induced by any submitted in which liability has
grounds of DISBELIEF in the facts become reasonably clear; or
necessary to be certified. (e) compelling policyholders to
institute suits to recover
General Rule: Insured must give, by way of amounts due under its polices by
preliminary proof of loss, the certificate or offering without justifiable
testimony of a person other than the insured when reason substantially less than
required by the policy. the amounts ultimately
Supplementary Rules: It is sufficient for the recovered in suites brought by
insured to use reasonable diligence to procure it. them.
In case of the refusal of such person to give it,
insured must furnish reasonable evidence to the (2) Evidence as to the numbers and types of
insurer that such refusal was not induced by any valid and justifiable complaints to the
just grounds of disbelief in the facts necessary to Commissioner against an insurance
be certified or testified, but because of other company, and the Commissioners
grounds. This requirement must be liberally complaint experience with other
construed in favor of the insured. insurance companies writing similar lines
of insurance shall be admissible in
evidence in an administrative or judicial
proceeding brought under this section.
Phil. Am. Life v CA & Pulido
(3) If it is found, after notice and an
Facts: The insured Florence Pulido took out a opportunity to be heard, that an
non-medical life insurance policy from Philamlife insurance company has violated this
in the amount of 100K and the policy was issued section, each instance of non compliance
on Feb. 11, 1989. She died on Sept. 10, 1991 with paragraph (1) may be treated as a
and her beneficiary, her sister Eliza Pulido filed a separate violation of this section and
claim which was denied by Philamlife on the shall be considered sufficient cause for
ground of fraud claiming that at the time the the suspension or revocation of the
insured applied for the policy, she was already companys certificate of authority.
actually dead.
Ratio: There was no fraud, the death certificates
and notes by the municipal health officer
prepared in the regular performance of duties are Sec. 242. The proceeds of a life insurance
prima facie evidence of facts. A duly-registered policy shall be paid immediately upon maturity
death certificate is considered a public document of the policy, unless such proceeds are made
and the entries found therein are presumed payable in installments or as an annuity, in
correct, unless the party who contests its which case the installments, or annuities shall
accuracy can produce positive evidence to be paid as they become due: Provided,
establish otherwise which in the case at bar however, That in the case of a policy maturing
Philamlife failed to do. by the death of the insured, the proceeds
thereof shall be paid within sixty days after
2. GUIDELINES ON CLAIMS SETTLEMENT presentation of the claim and filing of the proof
of the death of the insured. Refusal or failure to
Title 11 Claims Settlement pay the claim within the time prescribed herein
will entitle the beneficiary to collect interest on
the proceeds of the policy for the duration of
Sec. 241.
the delay at the rate of twice the ceiling
(1) No insurance company doing business in
prescribed by the Monetary Board, unless such
the Philippines shall refuse, without just
failure or refusal to pay is based on the ground
cause, to pay or settle claims arising
that the claim is fraudulent.
under coverages provided by its policies,
The proceeds of the policy maturing by the
nor shall any such company engage
death of the insured payable to the beneficiary
shall include the discounted value of all than the amounts ultimately
premiums paid in advance of their due dates, recovered in suites brought by
but are not due and payable at maturity. them.

Sec. 243. The amount of any loss or damage 2.2. Civil Code Rules on Presumption of Death
for which an insurer may be liable, under any
policy other than life insurance policy, shall be
paid within thirty days after proof of loss is Art. 390. After an absence of seven years, it
received by the insurer and ascertainment of being unknown whether or not the absentee still
the loss or damage is made either by lives, he shall be presumed dead for all
agreement between the insured and the insurer purposes except for those of succession.
or by arbitration; but if such ascertainment is The absentee shall not be presumed dead for
not had or made within sixty days after such the purpose of opening his succession till after
receipt by the insurer of the proof of loss, then an absence of ten years. If he disappeared
the loss or damage shall be paid within ninety after the age of seventy-five years, an absence
days after such receipt. Refusal or failure to of five years shall be sufficient in order that his
pay the loss or damage within the time succession may be opened. (n)
prescribed herein will entitle the assured to
collect interest on the proceeds of the policy for Art. 391. The following shall be presumed dead
the duration of the delay at the rate of twice the for all purposes, including the division of the
ceiling prescribed by the Monetary Board, estate among the heirs:
unless such failure or refusal to pay is based on (1) A person on board a vessel lost during a
the ground that the claim is fraudulent. sea voyage, or an aeroplane which is
missing, who has not been heard of for
four years since the loss of the vessel or
Sec. 244. In case of any litigation for the aeroplane;
enforcement of any policy or contact of (2) A person in the armed forces who has
insurance, it shall be the duty of the taken part in war, and has been missing
Commissioner or the Court, as the case may be, for four years;
to make a finding as to whether the payment of (3) A person who has been in danger of
the claim of the insured has unreasonably death under other circumstances and
denied or withheld; and in the affirmative case, his existence has not been known for
the insurance company shall be adjudged to pay four years. (n)
damages which shall consist of attorneys fees
and other expenses incurred by the insured Art. 392. If the absentee appears, or without
person by reasons of such unreasonable denial appearing his existence is proved, he shall
or withholding of payment plus interest of twice recover his property in the condition in which it
the ceiling prescribed by the Monetary Board of may be found, and the price of any property
the amount of the claim due the insured, from that may have been alienated or the property
the date following the time prescribed in Section acquired therewith; but he cannot claim either
two hundred forty-two or in Section two fruits or rents. (194)
hundred forty-three, as the case may be, until
the claim is fully satisfied; Provided, That the
failure to pay any such claim within the time Londres v National Life Insurance Co.
prescribed in said section shall be considered
prima facie evidence of unreasonable delay in Facts: National Life issued a life insurance policy
payment. on the life of Jose C. Londres in the amount of
Php3,000.00 on April 14, 1943 (during the war
period). He died on Feb. 7, 1945. His beneficiary
2.1. Unfair Claims Settlement filed a claim which National denied claiming that
there was a lack of proof of death and a slew of
Sec. 241 (1) provides instances of unfair claims other special defenses, including the payment
settlement done by an insurance company: should be made based on the Ballantyne scales.
Ratio: National must pay the beneficiary of the
(a) knowingly misrepresenting to insured the amount of the policy (3,000.00) as the
claimants pertinent facts or policy agreement was that the obligation will be made in
provisions relating to coverages at the currency prevailing at the end of the stipulated
issue; period which in this case is the Philippine currency.
(b) failing to acknowledge with The proof of death was substantially made by the
reasonable promptness pertinent claimant and was not properly disproved by
communications with respect to National.
claims arising under its policies;
(c) failing to adopt and implement Fernandez v National Life Insurance Co.
reasonable standards for the prompt
investigation of claims arising under Facts: National insured the life of Juan Fernandez
its policies; for the period of July 15, 194 to July 14, 1945.
(d) not attempting in good faith to Juan died on Nov. 2, 1944. His beneficiaries filed
effectuate prompt, fair and their claim 7 years after his death or on Aug. 1,
equitable settlement of claims 1952. The dispute is WON the Ballantyne scale is
submitted in which liability has applicable in computing the amount which should
become reasonably clear; or be paid to the beneficiaries. The CFI rendered
(e) compelling policyholders to institute judgment that National should pay the proceed of
suits to recover amounts due under PHp 500.00 Ballantyne scale applicable.
its polices by offering without
justifiable reason substantially less
Ratio: CFI correct. Ballantyne scale is applicable rate of twice the ceiling prescribed by the
since in life insurance, the policy matures upon the Monetary Board and Sec. 244. In case of any
expiration of the term set forth therein in this litigation for the enforcement of any policy or
case upon the death of Juan. The obligation of contract of insurance, it shall be the duty of the
National arose as of that date and not at the time Commissioner or the Court, as the case may
of the claim. Since the National could have paid his be to make a finding as to whether the
obligation at any time during the Japanese payment of the claim of the insured has been
occupation. Payment after liberation must be unreasonably denied or withheld; and in the
adjusted in accordance with the Ballantyne affirmative case, the insurance company shall be
schedule. adjusted to pay damages which shall consist of
attorneys fees and other expenses incurred
by the insured person by reason of such
Tio Khe Chio v CA & Eastern Assurance unreasonable denial or withholding of
payment plus interest of twice the ceiling
Facts: Tio Khe Chio imported fishmeal. These prescribed by the Monetary Board of the
were insured with Eastern Assurance. The vessel amount of claim due the insured.
used to ship the fishmeal was Far Eastern Shipping
Co. When the goods reached Manila, they were
found to be damaged and therefore useless. The Noda v Cruz-Arnaldo
issue is WON the interest to be paid by Eastern
Assurance is 12% or 6%? Facts: Noda obtained from Zenith 2 fire insurance
Ratio: 6% only, as Sec. 243 and 244 of the policies for 2 of his properties. Both was destroyed
Insurance Code is not applicable to the case as by fire. When Noda filed a claim, it was denied by
these provisions apply only when the court finds an Zenith due to premiums not paid and the other one
unreasonable delay or refusal in the payment of was settled only for 15K++. IC denied Noda to
the claims. The applicable law according to SC is claim full amount due to insufficient proof of the
Art. 2209 of the Civil Code which stipulates that in value of his losses.
the absence of stipulation the legal interest Ratio: Noda was able to prove sufficient losses,
applicable is 6% since the document offered by Noda were offered
by Zenith itself to proof the amount of its liability
Cathay v CA being 1/6th of the total loss only. Thus could very
well be considered as an admission of its liability up
Facts: Lugay insured against fire with the 6 to the amount recommended.
insurance companies named as petitioner in this
case for the total sum of 4 million her printing
press which was razed by fire on December 15, Finman General v CA
1982. She filed a claim submitting all the required
proof of loss. After nearly 10 months of waiting for Facts: USIPHIL obtained a fire insurance policy
her claim to be paid she filed a suit to collect her from FINMAN. The property insured was loss due
claim. After the trial on the merits, the TC rendered to fire and USIPHIL filed a claim. H.H. Bayne was
judgment in favor of Lugay and directed the 6 appointed by FINMAN to undertake evaluation.
insurance companies to pay their share in the USIPHIL submitted all the required proof of losses
insurance and further made them pay plaintiff substantially. Despite all these, FINMAN refused to
interest at the rate of 2x the ceiling being pay USIPHILS claim due to failure to comply with
prescribed by the Monetary board from the time Condition 13 of the policy. TC and CA rule din
when the case was filed. Upon appeal to the CA, favor of USIPHIL and ordered FINMAN to pay +
the CA affirmed the decision of the TC. double the interest (24%)
Ratio: The award made by the TC of double Ratio: Substantial compliance, not strict
interest is justified under Sections 243 and 244 of compliance with the requirements will be deemed
the Insurance Code which provides that Sec. 243. sufficient. The double interest of 24% is authorized
Refusal or failure to pay the loss or damage by Sections 243 and 244 of the Insurance Code.
within the time prescribed herein will entitle the
assured to collect interest on the proceeds of
the policy for the duration of the delay at the

Delsan Transport v CA (supra)

CLAIMS LIFE INSURANCE NON-LIFE INSURANCE


Maturity 1. Upon death of the person Upon happening of event insured
insured; against
2. Upon his surviving a specific
period Event must occur within the period
3. Otherwise contingently on specified in policy, otherwise insurer
the continuance or cessation has no liablity
of life (Sec. 180)

Delivery of Proceeds GENERAL RULE: Within 30 days after


Immediately upon maturity (1) Proof of loss is received by
of policy. insurer; and
(2) Ascertainment of loss or damage
EXCEPTION: is made either by agreement
If payable in INSTALLMENTS between the insured and insurer
or as an ANNUITY, when or by arbitration
such installments or
annuities become due If ascertainment not made within 60
days after such receipt by insurer of
IF MATURITY IS UPON DEATH: proof of loss, loss or damage shall be
Within 60 days after paid within 90 days after such
presentation of claim and receipt.
filing of proof of death of
insured.

Effect of Refusal or Failure to pay Entitles beneficiary to collect Entitles beneficiary to collect
claim within time prescribed: interest on the proceeds of interest on the proceeds of policy
policy for the duration of the for the duration of the delay at
In case of litigation, it is delay at rate of twice ceiling rate of twice ceiling prescribed by
the duty of the prescribed by the monetary the monetary board (unless
Commissioner or the board (unless refusal to pay refusal to pay is based on ground
Court to determine WON is based on ground that that claim in fraudulent)
claim has been claim in fraudulent)
unreasonably denied of In case damages awarded, this
withheld. In case damages awarded, includes attorneys fees and other
this includes attorneys fees expenses incurred due to delay
Failure to pay any such and other expenses incurred (plus the interest)
claim within the time due to delay (plus the
prescribed shall be interest)
considered prima facie
evidence of unreasonable
delay in payment.

3. PRESCRIPTION OF ACTION 3. An act or omission of the defendant in


violation of the legal right of plaintiff.
3.1. Title 6 The Policy
The cause of action in an insurance
Sec. 63. A condition, stipulation, or agreement policy therefore does not accrue
in any policy of insurance, limiting the time for until the insurer refuses expressly
commencing an action thereunder to a period of or impliedly to comply with his duty
less than one year from the time when the to pay the amount of the loss.
cause of action accrues, is void.
3.3. Compulsory Motor Vehicle Liability
Insurance
A clause in an insurance policy to the effect
Sec. 384. Any person having any claim upon
that an action upon the policy by the
insured must be brought within a certain the policy issued pursuant to this chapter shall,
without any unnecessary delay, present to the
period is VALID and will prevail over the
general law on limitations of actions. insurance company concerned a written notice
of claim setting forth the nature, extent and
HOWEVER, if the period fixed is less than
duration of the injuries sustained as certified by
one year from the time the cause of action
a duly licensed physician. Notice of claim must
accrues, it is VOID.
be filed within six months from date of the
Nature of condition limiting period for filing
accident, otherwise, the claim shall be deemed
claim:
waived. Action or suit for recovery of damage
It is not merely a procedural
due to loss or injury must be brought, in proper
requirement. It is essential for the
cases, with the Commissioner or the Courts
prompt settlement of claims as it
within one year from the denial of the claim,
demands for suits to be brought while
otherwise the claimants right of action shall
the evidence as to the origin and cause
prescribe (As amended by PD No. 1814 and BP
of the loss or destruction has not yet
Blg. 874.)
disappeared. It is a condition
precedent to the insurers liability or a
resolutory cause in case the action is
not filed by the insured within the Compulsory Motor Vehicle Liability Insurance
stipulated period. (CPTL) The Insurance Code makes it unlawful
Insurance Code empowers the Insurance for any land transportation operator or owner of
Commissioner to adjudicate disputes motor vehicle to operate the same in public
relating to an insurance companys liability highways unless there is an insurance or guaranty
to an insured under a policy. A complaint or to indemnify the death or bodily injury of a third
claim filed with such official is considered party or passenger arising from the use thereof.
an action or suit the filing of which
would have the effect of tolling the Rules of CPTL
suspending the running of the prescriptive 1. Registration of any vehicle will not
period. be made or renewed without
complying with the requirement.
Cause of Action The violation of a legal right 2. The protection may be complied
committed knowingly; An act or omission of one with using any of the following:
party in violation of the legal right/s of the other. Insurance policy
Surety bond
3.2. Requisites/Essential Elements: Cash bond
1. A legal right of the plaintiff
2. A correlative obligation of the defendant
First Integrated Bonding and Ins. Co., Inc. vs. impleaded party or parties in accordance
Hernando, 199 SCRA 746 with and pursuant to the provisions of the
The purpose of CPTL is to give immediate financial Rules of Court.
assistance to victims of motor vehicle accidents The authority to adjudicate granted to the
and/or their dependents, especially if they are poor Commissioner under this section shall be
regardless of the financial capability of motor concurrent with that of the civil courts, but
vehicle owners or operators responsible for the the filing of a complaint with the
accident. Commissioner shall preclude the civil
courts from taking cognizance of a suit
involving the same subject matter.
3.4. Civil Code Prescription Any decision, order or ruling rendered by
the Commissioner after a hearing shall
Art. 1144. The following action must be have the force and effect of a judgment.
brought within ten years from the time the right Any party may appeal from a final order,
of action accrues: ruling or decision of the Commissioner by
(1) Upon a written contract; filing with the Commissioner within thirty
(2) Upon an obligation created by law days from receipt of copy of such order,
(3) Upon a judgment. (n) ruling or decision a notice of appeal to the
Intermediate Appellate Court in the manner
General Rules on Prescription: provided for in the Rules of Court for
10 Years (CC) appeals from the Regional Trial Court to
the Intermediate Appellate Court. (As
Exceptions to the General Rule: amended by Batas Pambansa Blg. 874).
Stipulation in the contract (Sec. As soon as a decision, order or ruling has
63) a clause in an insurance policy become final and executory, the
limiting the period for which an Commissioner shall motu proprio or on
action upon the policy bay be motion of the interested party, issue a writ
brought is valid provided it be not of execution requiring the sheriff or the
less than one year. proper officer to whom it is directed to
Motor Vehicle Insurance One execute said decision, order or award,
(1) year only pursuant to Rule thirty-nine of the Rules of
Court.
For the purpose of any proceeding under
4. THE INSURANCE COMMISSIONER
this section, the Commissioner, or any
ADMINISTRATIVE AND ADJUDICATORY officer thereof designated by him,
POWERS empowered to administer oaths and
Sec. 416. The Commissioner shall have the affirmation, subpoena witnesses, compel
power to adjudicate claims and complaints their attendance, take evidence, and
involving any loss, damage or liability for require the production of any books,
which in insurer may be answerable under papers, documents, or contracts or other
any kind of policy or contract of insurance, records which are relevant or material to
or for which such insurer may be liable the inquiry. In case of contumacy by, or
under a contract of suretyship, or for which refusal to obey a subpoena issued to any
a reinsurer may be sued under any person, the Commissioner may invoke the
contract of reinsurance it may have aid of any court of first instance within the
entered into; or for which a mutual benefit jurisdiction of which such proceeding is
association may be held liable under the carried on, where such person resides or
membership certificates it has issued to its carries on his own business, in requiring
members, where the amount of any such the attendance and testimony of witnesses
loss, damage or liability, excluding interest, and the production of books, papers,
cost and attorney's fees, being claimed or documents, contracts or other records. And
sued upon any kind of insurance, bond, such court may issue an order requiring
reinsurance contract, or membership such person to appear before the
certificate does not exceed in any single Commissioner, or officer designated by the
claim one hundred thousand pesos. Commissioner, there to produce records, if
The insurer or surety may, in the same so ordered or to give testimony touching
action file a counterclaim against the the matter in question. Any failure to obey
insured or the obligee. The insurer or such order of the court may be published
surety may also file a cross-claim against a by such court as a contempt thereof.
party for any claim arising out of the A full and complete record shall be kept of
transaction or occurrence that is the all proceedings had before the
subject matter of the original action or of a commissioner, or the officers thereof
counterclaim therein. designated by him, and all testimony shall
With leave of the Commissioner, an insurer be taken down and transcribed by a
or surety may file a third-party complaint stenographer appointed by the
against its reinsurers for indemnification, Commissioner.
contribution, subrogation or any other A transcribed copy of the evidence and
relief, in respect of the transaction that is proceeding, or any specific part thereof, of
the subject matter of the original action any hearing taken by a stenographer
filed with the Commissioner. appointed by the Commissioner, being
The party filing an action pursuant to the certified by such stenographer to be a true
provisions of this section thereby submits and correct transcript of the testimony on
his person to the jurisdiction of the this hearing of a particular witness, or of a
Commissioner. The Commissioner shall specific proof thereof, carefully compared
acquire jurisdiction over the person of the by him from his original notes, and to be a
correct statement of evidence and providing for the submission of a bond are built
proceeding had in such hearing so into all bonds tendered under that statue even
purporting to be taken and subscribed, through not printed therein. Finman may be held
may be received as evidence by the liable, if it is solidarily liable with Pan Pacific
Commissioner and by any court with the under the terms of the bond, it must follow that it
same effect as if such stenographer were is also liable to both Inocencio et.al and POEA.
present and testified to the facts so sorry guys I dont get how prescription figures
certified. (As amended by Presidential into this case!!!
Decree No. 1455).

Eagle Star v Chin Yu

Facts: Chin Yu consigned 14 bales of


4.1. Jurisdiction of Insurance Commission underwear. Insured with Eagle Star. Upon
Includes the following as long as any SINGLE arrival to Manila, 4 bales were lost and 3 were
CLAIM does NOT EXCEED 100,000.00: damages. Chin Yu filed claim for the lost and
(1) Claims and complaints involving liability of damages bales against he carrier and then with
insurer under any kind of policy or the insurer. Both denied liability.
contract Ratio: Action has not prescribed under Sec. 61-
(2) Suretyship A, the period of prescription starts to run when
(3) Reinsurance the cause of action accrues and the cause of
(4) Mutual Benefit membership certificates action accrues only upon the rejection of the
insurer of the claim and not upon the filing of the
2. Relation to RTC claim.
The RTC and IC have concurrent
jurisdiction. HOWEVER, filling a complaint
with the IC PRECLUDES civil courts from ACCFA v Alpha Ins
taking cognizance of suit involving the
same subject. Facts: FACOMA took out a fidelity bond of
Php5,000.00 to insure its funds from Alpha
Insurance which it later assigned to ACCFA. The
Lopez v Filipinas funds were misappropriated upon which ACCFA
immediately notified Alpha of the loss and
Facts: Lopez insured with FCS his Biederman presented proof of loss within the period fixed,
truck tractor and Winter Weils trailer from loss or but despite repeated demands, the surety
damages. It appeared that Lopez concealed company refused and failed to pay. It filed a suit
some material fact with regard to questions against Alpha. Alpha moved to dismiss claiming
asked by FCS. The vehicles figured in an that ACCFAs right of action has prescribed since
accident. Lopez filed a claim which FCS denied. it filed an action one year after it filed its notice
Lopez filed a complaint with IC less than 2 of loss -- claiming that ACCFAs right of action
months after the denial and a complaint with the accrued upon submission of notice of loss as
Court 17 months after the denial when FCS told stipulated under Condition 8 of the contract.
the IC that it refused to subject itself to Ratio: The action does not accrue until the party
arbitration. FCS claimed prescription. obligated refuses, expressly or implied to comply
Ratio: The right of action has prescribed. There with its duty (in this case refusal of Alpha to pay
is nothing in the Insurance Law, nor in any of its the amount of the bond). The year for instituting
allied Legislations which empower the IC to the action in court must be reckoned from the
adjudicate on disputes relating to an insurance time of Alpha refused to comply with its bond and
companys liability to an insured under a policy not from the creditors filling of the claim of loss
issued by the insurer to an insured. The validity (since the creditor does not know yet upon filling
of an insureds claim under a specific policy, its that the claim would be denied or refused).
amount, and all such other matters as might Therefore, condition #8 which required action to
involve the interpretation and construction of the be filed within one year from the filling of the
insurance policy, are issues which only a regular claim for loss contradicts the public policy
court of justice may resolve and thus the expressed in Sec. 61-A of the Philippine
complaint filed by Lopez with the IC could not Insurance Act and is thus null and void
have been an action or suit. The prescription
period started to run on August 28, 1960 when
FCS rejected the claim of Lopez and the Ang v Fulton
commencement of an action was filed only on
September 19, 1961with the CFI of Manila, Facts: Ang insured his property against fire for 1
nearly 17 months after the claim was rejected. year with Fulton through its agent Paramount. .
Thus the action has already prescribed. 12.27.1973 -- Store was destroyed through fire
(3 days later, Ang filed claim)
1.13.1955 Ang charged with arson, acquitted
Finman v Inocencio 4.6.1956 Fulton denied Angs claim
4.19.1956 Ang received Fulton denial
Facts: Pan Pacific obtained a surety bond from 5.1956 Ang instituted claim against Paramount
Finman in compliance with POEA rules. Inocencio which was dismissed w/o prejudice on 9.1957
et.al filed complaint against Pan Pacific. POEA 5.5.1958 Ang instituted present action against
ordered Pan Pacific and Finman jointly and Fulton.
severally to pay the claim of Inocencio et.al. According to CFI, action not yet prescirbed
Ratio: POEA has jurisdiction over the surety Ratio: Action already prescribed. The action of
bonds as it is a well settled doctrine that the Ang against Paramount does not have any legal
conditions of a bond specified in the statute effect except that of notifying the agent and
serves no other purpose. It did not stop the Loss Due to Wrongful Act or Breach of
prescription from running. The filing of a claim Contract by Third Person, NOT APPLICLABLE
within one year after rejection is a condition TO LIFE INSURANCE.
precedent to the liability of the insurer a Options available to insured when through
resolutory cause, the purpose of which is to wrongful act or breach of contract
terminate all liabilities in case action is not filed committed by 3rd person, insured property
within the said period. suffers loss:
(1) Collect from insurer if insurer pays,
insurer subrogates insured under Civil
Travellers Insurance v CA Code
o Right of subrogation exist even
Facts: A 78 year old woman was hit by a taxi if no express agreement
cab, died. Her son (Vicente) filed a claim against recognizing it since its under
the owner of the Lady Love taxi cab, the driver the CC
and Travellers as the compulsory insurer o Arises only after insurer pays
Ratio: Travellers cannot be held jointly and insured.
severally liable with the owner and driver of the (2) Demand payment from wrongdoer
Lady Love taxi cab as Vicente failed to attach a Since Life Insurance is not contract of
copy of the insurance contract to his complaint, INDEMNITY, subrogation obviously cannot
there could be no basis to apprise the real nature apply.
and pecuniary limits of Travellers liability.
Further, he also failed to file a written notice of When May Liability to Subrogee be Limited:
claim with Traveller, which is an indispensable Bill of Lading (St. Paul v Macondray)
requirement thus his cause of action did not Contributory Negligence (Tabacalera v NFS)
accrue.

Sun Insurance v CA (supra) Effect of Voluntary Payment


Right of Subrogation does not exist in favor
5. SUBROGATION of mere volunteer
If insurer has right to rescind, but still pays
5.1. Civil Code Provisions insured, there is still subrogation the 3 rd
party has no privity.
Obligations & Contracts Extinguishment of Where the insurer pays the insured for a
Obligations loss or liability which is not a risk covered
by the policy, it will be considered as a
Art. 1236. The creditor is not bound to accept volunteer with no right of subrogation.
payment or performance by a third person who HOWEVER, insurer may still recover under
has no interest in the fulfillment of the Art. 1236 of the Civil Code to the extent
obligation, unless there is a stipulation to the that the debtor had been benefited.
contrary. If insured gets amount of policy not as
payment but as a LOAN, repayable to the
Whoever pays for another may demand from extent of any recovery from the 3 rd party
the debtor what he has paid, except that if he responsible, there can be no subrogation.
paid without the knowledge or against the will
of the debtor, he can recover only insofar as the In Case of General Averages:
payment has been beneficial to the debtor 1. Demand contributions directly from
(1158a) different persons liable.
2. Clam whole loss from the insurer insurer
Damages subrogates right of contribution.

Art. 2207. If the plaintiffs property has been Coastwise v CA (supra)


insured, and he has received indemnity from
the insurance company for the injury or loss Maglana v Concolacion (supra)
arising out of the wrong or breach of contract
complained of, the insurance company shall be
subrogated to the rights of the insured against
Cebu Shipyard v Willaim Lines
the wrongdoer or the person who has violated
the contract. If the amount paid by the
insurance company does not fully cover the Facts: William Lines, Inc contracted the services of
injury or loss, the aggrieved party shall be CSEW for its ships annual dry-docking and repairs.
entitled to recover the deficiency from the The vessel was insured with Prudential for 45
person causing the loss or injury. million for hull and machinery. The coverage
included an Additional Perils clause covering loss
of or damage to the vessel through the negligence
According to sir there is only subrogation of ship repairman. The vessel caught fire and sank
in property insurance. resulting to its eventual total loss. Prudential paid
William Lines the total amount of the insurance
5.2. Concept: policy and sued CSEW, as subrogee to the rights of
Process of legal substitution (insurer steps William Lines.
into shoes of insured) Ratio: Since it has already been resolved that the
Reason: EQUITY to prevent the insured cause of the fire which gutted MV Manila City was
from receiving more than his actual loss, the negligence act of CSEW, the proof of payment
while at the same time makes the person made by Prudential to William Lines, Inc operated
who caused loss legally responsible. to properly subrogate Prudential to the rights of
William Lines under Art. 2207 of the Civil Code
Pioneer Insurance v CA liability, TC dismissed complaint due to no cause of
action.
Facts: Jacob Lim purchased 2 aircrafts from JDA Ratio: Firestone no longer has cause of action
using funds from Bormaheco, the Cervantes and since it has already been paid by Firemans Fund.
Maglana. Insured it with Pioneer as surety. Lim Firemans Fund however has a cause of action as
failed to pay, Pioneer paid (Pioneer reinsured the this falls under Art. 2207 under the doctrine of
surety with an unnamed reinsurer) and collected subrogation.
from the reinsurer. Also foreclosed aircraft, sold it
and collected proceeds.
Ratio: Pioneer no longer has any claim since it has Tabacalera v North Front Shipping
already collected the proceeds of the reinsurance
on its bond. Under the principle of Art. 2207 of the Facts: Sacks of corn grain valued at over 3M were
CC, the reinsurer, on payment of a loss acquires consigned to RFM under a bill of lading and insured
the same rights by subrogation as are acquired in with Tabacalera et al. The vessel was owned by
similar cases where the original insurer pays a loss. North Front. Prior to leaving port, the vessel was
inspected and was deemed fit to carry
merchandise. When it arrived, it advised RFM who
Manila Mahogany v CA did not immediately commence unloading without
any apparent reason. When unloaded, there was
Facts: Manila Mahogany insured its Mercedez shortage and the rest were moldy, rancid and unfit
Benz with Zenith. Car was bumped and damaged for its purpose. RFM rejected cargo and demanded
by SMC truck. Zenith paid Mahogany in amicable from North Front payment for damages which was
settlement. Zenith then demanded reimbursement denied. Tabacalera et.al paid, then sued North
from SMC, but it appeared that SMC already paid Front. TC and CA dismissed case.
Mahogany evidenced by a Release of Claim. Ratio: North Point is liable since it is a common
Ratio: By the act of Manila Mahogany issuing a carrier and as such is required to observe
release claim to SMC, the right of Zenith against extraordinary diligence in its vigilance over the
SMC is nullified since the insurer can be goods it transports. When goods placed in its care
subrogated to only such rights as the insured may are lost or damaged, the carrier is presumed to
have, should the insured, after receiving payment have been at fault or to have acted negligently.
from the insurer, release the wrongdoer who North Front has burden of proving it observed
causes the loss, the insurer loses his rights against extraordinary diligence in order to avoid
him. But in such a case the insurer will be entitled responsibility which it failed to do. However since
to recover from the insured whatever it has paid, RFM was guilty of contributory negligence, they
unless it was made with the consent of the insurer. should share at least 40% of the loss. North Point
ordered to pay Tabacalera et al 60% of the total
amount it paid to RFM.

Pan Malayan v CA & Fabie


Philamgen v CA
Facts: The driver of Erlinda Fabie hit the insured
Mitsubishi Colt Lancer owned by the Canlubang Facts: Coca-Cola Bottlers Philippines, Inc. (CCBPI)
Automotive Resources Corporation. The vehicle loaded on board MV Asilda 7,500 cases of 1-liter
was insured with PANMALAY who paid the amount Coke to be transported from Zamboanga City to
insured under the own damage coverage of the Cebu City. The vessel was owned and operated by
insurance policy. PANMALAY then demanded from FELMAN. The shipment was insured with
Fabie the payment of whatever amount it paid PHILAMGEN. The vessel sank. CCBPI filed a claim
claiming that they were subrogated to the rights of with FELMAN for recovery of damages which was
Canlubang. denied and thus CCBPI filed an insurance claim
Ratio: Art. 2207 of the Civil Code apply in the case with PHILAMGEN which paid its claim for
at bar, under the principle of subrogation. If the PHp755,250.00. Claiming its right of subrogation,
insured property is destroyed or damaged through PHILAMGEN sought recourse against FELMAN who
the fault or negligence of a party other than the disclaimed any liability from the lost.
assured, then the insurer, upon payment to the Ratio: Clearly falls under Art. 2207 of the Civil
assured will be subrogated to the rights of the Code. The payment by the assurer to the assured
assured to recover from the wrongdoer to the operates as an equitable assignment to the assurer
extent that the insurer has been obligated to pay. of all the remedies which the assured may have
Payment by the insurer to the assured operates as against the third party whose negligence or
an equitable assignment to the former of all wrongful act caused the loss. The right of
remedies which the latter may have against the subrogation is not dependent upon, nor does it
third party whose negligence or wrongful act grow out of any privity of contract. It accrues
caused the loss. The right of subrogation is not simply upon payment by the insurance company of
dependent upon, nor does it grow out of, any the insurance claim.
privity of contract or upon written assignment of
claim. It accrues simply upon payment of the
insurance claim. St Paul v Macondray

Firemans Fund v Jamila & Co. Facts: Winthrop Products consigned to Winthrop
Stearns drugs and medicines (from NY to Mla)
Facts: Firestone loss some properties due to the through Macondray & Co. Insured with St. Paul
acts of its employees and the security guards Fire. Arrastre services provided by Mla. Port
provided by the security agency of Jamila & Co. Services. Upon arrival to Manila one drum and
Firemans Fund, the insurer of Firestone paid the several cartons arrived in bad condition. Winthrop
loss and proceeded against Jamila and Jamilas Stearms filed a claim for damages. St. Paul paid
insurer First Quezon City Ins. Co. Both denied claim. St. Paul then proceeded against the Arrastre
Service who resisted action which claimed it 2. Pooling the resources of many
delivered goods in same condition it received from companies also extends greater coverage of
the carrier (Macondray). Macondray denied liability insurance protection, extended even among
claiming liability ceased upon discharge of goods APPLICANTS requiring large amounts and those not
from ships tackle. Note: there is a bill of lading eligible for insurance at standard rates.
which stipulated that the amount of the liability 3. UNDERWRITERS benefit through the
should only be Php1K++, but St. Paul paid amount placing of additional insurance in an
US$1k++ expanded market.
Ratio: St. Paul should receive the amount 4. The insurance INDUSTRY benefits by
according to the bill of lading. The purpose of the reducing the waste arising out of policies
bill of lading is to provide for the rights and which are applied for but not issued.
liabilities of the parties. The stipulation in the bill 5. The REINSURER benefits through the
of lading limiting the common carriers liability to acquisition of business which is expected to
the value of the goods appearing in the bill is valid prove profitable in the long run.
and binding. St. Paul after paying the claim of the
insured for damages under the policy is subrogated
merely to the rights of the assured as subrogee, it 4. BENEFITS OF REINSURANCE TO THE
can recover only the amount that is recoverable by INSURED
the latter. Since the right of Winthrop in case of
1. It gives insurance companies greater
loss or damage to the goods is limited or restricted
financial stability and thus makes the
by the provision in the bill of lading, a suit by St.
insureds individual policy more reliable.
Paul as subrogee is necessarily subject to like
2. If a large amount of insurance is needed,
limitations and restrictions.
the insured may obtain it without
negotiating with numerous companies.
3. It enables the insured to obtain
Chapter VII protection promptly, without the delay
REINSURANCE that would be required to divide and
distribute the amount among many
companies.
Title 12 Reinsurance 4. All the insurance can be written under
identical contract provisions, whereas
Sec. 95. A contract of reinsurance is one by otherwise these might vary with the
which an insurer procures a third person to different companies among whom the
insure him against loss or liability by reason of insurance is divided.
such original insurance. 5. Small companies are encouraged to
divide large exposures for safety and
enabled to accept a wide variety of
1. DEFINITION OF REINSURANCE applicants.

5. NATURE OF CONTRACT OF
It is a contract whereby one party, the
reinsurer, agrees to indemnify another, the REINSURANCE
reinsured, either in whole or in part, The subject of the contract of reinsurance is the
against loss or liability which the latter may primary insurers risk and not the property insured
sustain or incur during a separate and under the original policy.
original contract of insurance with a third 1. CONTRACT OF INDEMNITY AGAINST
party, the original insured. LIABILITY. The reinsurer agrees to
A contract of reinsurance is an insurance of indemnify the insurer, not against actual
an insurance or when insurance business is payment made but against liabilities
transferred from one insurance company to incurred. It is not necessary that the
another. Sometimes called treaties. insurer first pay the loss accruing to
demand payment from reinsurer.
2. CONTRACT SEPARATE FROM ORIGINAL
INSURANCE POLICY. Contracts of insurance
2. RATIONALE OF REINSURANCE and reinsurance are independent from each
other. The practice is for the reinsurer to
It is one type of liability insurance. pay the insurer even before the latter has
It represents a further extension of the indemnified the original insured.
fundamental idea of insurance, that is, 3. CONTRACT BASED ON ORIGINAL POLICY.
distribution among many of the risks The reinsurance policy is necessarily based
resting upon one. on the original contract, and the rights of
Where an insurer desires to entirely relieve the parties in the reinsurance are greatly
himself of liability under contracts made affected by the latters terms and
and reinsures all his risks. conditions. The reinsured risk must be the
Contracts/treaties of reinsurance are plainly same as that covered by the original policy.
beneficial to the public inasmuch as they 4. INSURABLE INTEREST REQUIREMENT
promote both efficiency and stability in the APPLICABLE. The doctrine of insurable
conduct of the insurance business. interest used in the original policy is also
applicable to reinsurance. Hence, the
primary insurer is not entitled to contract
3. BENEFITS OF REINSURANCE TO THE for reinsurance exceeding the limits of the
INSURER policy ceded to the reinsurer.
5. RULE ON SUBROGATION AVAILABLE. In
1. Insurers are able to issue policies in
general, a reinsurer, on payment of a loss,
excess of such retention limits or the
acquires the same rights by subrogation as
maximum claim it wishes to pay out of its own
resources.
are acquired in similar cases where the reinsurer is obligated to accept a fixed share of the
original insurer pays a loss. risk which has to be reinsured under the contract.

6. REINSURANCE VS DOUBLE INSURANCE Facultative Reinsurance Treaties there is no


DISTINGUISHED19 obligation either to cede or to accept participation
in the risk insured, each party having a free choice.
Reinsurance Double Insurance Advantage to the insurer - The advantage of the
Insurer becomes the Insurer remains as the automatic method is avoidance of delay in issuing
insured, insofar as the insurer of the original the insurers policy. The advantage of the
reinsurer is concerned insured facultative method is that it receives the reinsurers
The subject of the The subject of the underwriting opinion before the policy is issued.
insurance is the insurance is the
original insurers risk property being insured Protection to the reinsurer - By agreeing to
Insurance of a Insurance of the same accept business automatically, the reinsurer is
different interest interest relying on the underwriting judgment of the insurer
Original insured has no Insured is the party in and is bound to accept a case even though it may
interest in the contract interest in all the not agree with the underwriting decision. The
of reinsurance which is contracts insurer is protected by the requirement that the
independent of the original insurer retains its full retention limit, which
original contract of assures a measure of self-interest
insurance
History: In the 1950s, domestic insurers ceded
Consent of the original The insured has to give
risks to foreign reinsurers because there was no
insured is not his consent.
reinsurance company in the Philippines. Although,
necessary
today even when there are domestic reinsurance
companies operating in the country, domestic risks
Sec. 96. Where an insurer obtains reinsurance, are still ceded to foreign reinsurance companies
except under automatic reinsurance treaties, he since the Philippines is a CALAMITY PRONE country.
must communicate all the representations of
the original insured, and also all the knowledge Limitation
and information he possesses, whether Code limits risk which a non-life insurer
previously or subsequently acquired, which are may retain on any one subject of insurance
material to the risk. to 20% of its net worth.
Any reinsurance ceded by it is deducted in
determining the risk retained.
The reinsured has the duty to disclose all
material facts to the reinsurer (since the
risk insured against in a contract of Sec. 97. A reinsurance is presumed to be a
reinsurance is the probability that the contract of indemnity against liability, and not
original insurer may be compelled to merely against damage.
indemnify form the loss under the policy
issued by him), the duty imposed is similar
Sec. 98. The original insured has no interest in
to persons seeking an original insurance
a contract of reinsurance.
that of the strictest good faith.

When called TREATIES where the insurer insures 8. RELATIONSHIP OF INSURED TO


all or a substantial portion of its risk with one REINSURER
insurer General Rule
Original insured has NO INTEREST in the
7. REINSURANCE TREATIES VS reinsurance contract
REINSURANCE POLICIES Whatever the reinsurer pays the insurer
upon the happening of the loss becomes
Reinsurance Reinsurance part of the insurers assets, and all its
Treaty Policy creditors share equal rights with the
Merely an Contract for insured to demand payment from such
agreement between indemnity one funds.
two insurance insurer makes with
companies where another to protect Exceptions:
one agrees to cede the first insurer Contract may expressly bind the reinsurer
and the other to from risk it has to pay directly to the original owner any
accept reinsurance already assumed loss for which the original insurer may be
business pursuant liable.
to provisions o Insured may choose to sue either
specified in the insurer, reinsurer or BOTH.
treaty However, total recovery cannot be
Contracts for Contracts of more than the actual loss.
insurance insurance o Liability of reinsurer to original
insured would not be affected by
Automatic Reinsurance Treaties the ceding any defense which the reinsurer
company (reinsured) is bound to cede and the may have against the original
insurer.
o No novation which discharges
19
This was asked in 2005. Note when double original policy original policy
insurance occurs and the nature of the liabilities of remains in full force and original
the various insurers. insured has right to demand that all
its terms and conditions be to be ceded under the terms of this Agreement
complied with. which are not cancelled in the ordinary course of
If insured agreed with insurer and reinsurer business shall continue in full force until
that he will look only to reinsurer for their expiry unless the COMPANY (Asian)
indemnity in case of loss shall, prior to the 31st of December next
o Novation discharged original insurer following such notice, elect to withdraw the
o Technically not a reinsurance. existing cessions. Thus insofar as the 2
reinsurance agreements as concerned, the
9. LIABILITY OF REINSURER TO express stipulations did not ipso facto terminate
REINSURED all reinsurance cessions. Such cessions
Reinsurer is entitled to avail himself of every continued to be in full force until their respective
defense which the reinsured might urge in an dates of expiration. Since it was under one of
action by the person originally insured. Thus, the said agreements, namely, the Facultative
reinsurer is not liable to the reinsured for a loss Obligatory Reinsurance Treaty-Fire, that the
under an original policy if the latter is not liable to reinsurance cessions corresponding to the GSIS
the original insured or for an amount more than the policy had been made, FIELDMENS cannot avoid
sum actually paid to the insured. liability which arouse by reason of the burning of
the insured property.

Philam v Auditor
Coquia v Fieldmens Insurance
Facts: Philamlife had a reinsurance treaty with
AIRCO with an agreement to pay reinsurance Facts: Fieldmens issued to Manila Yellow
premiums on an annual basis. The Central Bank Taxicab a common carrier accident insurance
collected foreign exchange margin on the policy which will indemnify the insured in the
remittances of Philamlife to AIRCO. Philamlife event of accident caused by or arising out of the
filed for refund contending that the reinsurance use of Motor Vehicle against all sums which the
premiums remitted were paid pursuant to the insured will become legally liable to pay in
reinsurance treaty and therefore were pre- respect of: death or bodily injury to any fare-
existing obligations expressly exempt fro the paying passenger including the driver, conductor
margin fee. and/or inspector While policy was in force,
Ratio: Philamlife is not entitled to refund. Carlito Coquia driving the insured vehicle met an
Reinsurance treaties and reinsurance policies are accident and died. His heirs field complaint
not one and the same. Reinsurance treaties are against Fieldmens
contracts FOR insurance while reinsurance Ratio: Heirs of Coquia have cause of action
policies are contracts OF insurance. Philamlifes against Fieldmens under Art. 1311 of the Civil
obligation to remit reinsurance premiums (contracts pour autrui). This rule is the exception
becomes fixed and definite only upon the to the general rule that only parties to a contract
execution of the reinsurance policy, because it is may bring an action. Under this exception, third
only after a reinsurance policy is made that parties may demand the enforcement of the
payment of reinsurance premiums may be contract which was made for his benefit.
exacted as it is only after Philamlife seeks to
remit the reinsurance premiums that the Eternal Gardens Memorial Park Corp. v. The
obligation to pay the margin fee arises. Phil. American Life Insurance Co.
April 9, 2008

Facts: This was a complaint of Eternal Gardens


Fieldmans v Asian Surety
Memorial Park Corp. (Eternal) seeking to claim on a
group life policy under which the clients of Eternal
Facts: Fieldmans and Asian entered into a who purchased burial lots from it on installment
reinsurance treaty wherein Asian will cede to basis would be insured by Philippine American Life
Fieldmens a specified portion of the amount of Insurance Company (Philamlife). One such client
insurance underwritten by ASIAN. The contract died one year and eight months after Eternal had
stipulates that if either party wishes to terminate submitted his application to Philamlife, which did
or cancel the agreement, they must give at least not act on the application. Philamlife, however,
3 moths notice by registered mail to the other denied Eternals insurance claim. Eternal filed the
party and the cancellation was to take effect as case before the Makati RTC, which had ordered
of the 31st of December of the year in which the Philamlife to pay the proceeds of the policy. On
notice was given. Sometime in September 1961 appeal, the CA reversed the RTC, dismissing the
Fieldmens gave notice to Asian which Asian did case.
not reply to, Fieldmens gave 2 other notices.
During this time, one of the reinsurance contracts
Held: The Court noted that the group life policy
GSIS property was razed by fire. Asian filed a
was ambiguous as to whether the insurance
claim with Fieldmens who denied liability
coverage of Eternals clients became effective upon
pointing out that they have already terminated
contracting a loan with Eternal or upon Philamlifes
the reinsurance treaty.
approval. Emphasizing that an insurance contract is
Ratio: The Facultative-Obligatory Reinsurance
a contract of adhesion which must be construed
Treaty Fire (part of the reinsurance
liberally in favor of the insured and strictly against
contract/treaty) provides that in the event of
the insurer, which was the party which prepared
termination of this Agreement x x x, the liability
and had exclusive control over the terms and
of the Fieldmens under current cessions shall
phraseology of the insurance contract, the
continue in full force and effect until their
Supreme Court interpreted the ambiguity to mean
natural expiry x x x. and On the termination
that upon a partys purchase of a memorial lot on
of this Agreement from any cause whatever, the
installment from Eternal, an insurance contract
liability of the REINSURER (Fieldmens) under
covering the lot purchaser is created and the same
any current cession including any amounts due
is effective until terminated by Philamlifes Held: Filipinas Life, as the principal, is liable for
disapproval of the application. The Court likewise obligations contracted by its agent Valle. By the
found that Philamlifes receipt of a letter, the contract of agency, a person binds himself to
contents of which state that attached thereto are render some service or to do something in
insurance forms for a list of burial lot owners representation or on behalf of another, with the
including the disputed application, is an admission consent or authority of the latter. The general rule
of Philamlife against its own interest, as well as an is that the principal is responsible for the acts of its
acknowledgement of the receipt of the letter agent done within the scope of its authority, and
together with the attachments. Such receipt, the should bear the damage caused to third persons.
Court said, shifted the burden of evidence to When the agent exceeds his authority, the agent
Philamlife to prove that the letter did not contain becomes personally liable for the damage. But even
the disputed application. Having failed to do so, when the agent exceeds his authority, the principal
Philamlife is deemed to have received the is still solidarily liable together with the agent if the
insurance application. The Court thus ordered principal allowed the agent to act as though the
Philamlife to pay Eternal PhP100,000 representing agent had full powers. In other words, the acts of
the proceeds of the insurance policy, in addition to an agent beyond the scope of his authority do not
legal interest and attorneys fees. bind the principal, unless the principal ratifies
them, expressly or impliedly. Filipinas Life cannot
Yolanda Signey v. Social Security System profess ignorance of Valles acts. Even if Valles
January 28, 2008 representations were beyond his authority as a
debit/insurance agent, Filipinas Life expressly and
Facts: The deceased in this case had 2 common- knowingly ratified Valles acts. It cannot even be
law wives, petitioner and Gina, and one legal wife, denied that Filipinas Life benefited from the
Editha. Petitioner had filed a claim with the SSS investments deposited by Valle in the account of
alleging that she was the legal wife and that her Filipinas Life. In our considered view, Filipinas Life
husband had a common-law wife, Gina. Gina, had clothed Valle with apparent authority; hence, it
however, filed the same claim with the SSS, is now estopped to deny said authority. Innocent
alleging that both she and petitioner were third persons should not be prejudiced if the
common-law wives and that deceased had a legal principal failed to adopt the needed measures to
wife. The SSS had denied petitioners claim stating prevent misrepresentation, much more so if the
that the marriage between she and the deceased principal ratified his agents acts beyond the latters
was not valid as it was executed during a prior authority.
existing marriage of the deceased against Editha,
that deceaseds only legitimate child had Blue Cross Health Care v. Neomi and Danilo
predeceased him, that deceaseds 4 children with Olivares
petitioner were all over 21 years of age and hence February 12, 2008
cannot qualify as dependents, and declared
deceaseds 2 children with Gina as primary Facts: Neomi suffered a stroke and applied for
beneficiaries. reimbursement of her medical bills from petitioner,
her health care provider. Petitioner refused until a
Held: Whoever claims entitlement to the benefits certification could be issued that her stroke was not
provided by law should establish his or her right due to pre-existing conditions. Dr. Saniel, her
thereto by substantial evidence. Since petitioner is physician, however, was not able to issue such a
disqualified to be a beneficiary and because the certification, stating that because the patient
deceased has no legitimate child, it follows that the invoked the doctor-patient confidentiality, such
dependent illegitimate minor children of the information could not be given ot the petitioner.
deceased shall be entitled to the death benefits as The issue is whether petitioner was able to prove
primary beneficiaries. The SSS Law is clear that for that Neomis stroke was caused by pre-existing
a minor child to qualify as a dependent, the only conditions and was therefore outside the coverage
requirements are that he/she must be below 21 of her plan.
years of age, not married nor gainfully employed. Held: It is an established rule in insurance
In this case, the minor illegitimate children Ginalyn contracts that when their terms contain limitations
and Rodelyn were born on 13 April 1996 and 20 on liability, they should be construed strictly
April 2000, respectively. Had the legitimate child of against the insurer. These are contracts of
the deceased and Editha survived and qualified as adhesion the terms of which must be interpreted
a dependent under the SSS Law, Ginalyn and and enforced stringently against the insurer which
Rodelyn would have been entitled to a share prepared the contract. This doctrine is equally
equivalent to only 50% of the share of the said applicable to health care agreements. Petitioner
legitimate child. Since the legitimate child of the never presented any evidence to prove that
deceased predeceased him, Ginalyn and Rodelyn, respondent Neomi's stroke was due to a pre-
as the only qualified primary beneficiaries of the existing condition. It merely speculated that Dr.
deceased, are entitled to 100% of the benefits. Saniel's report would be adverse to Neomi, based
on her invocation of the doctor-patient privilege.
Filipinas Life Assurance Company v. Clemente This was a disputable presumption at best. Suffice
N. Pedroso, et al. it to say that this presumption does not apply if the
February 4, 2008 suppression is an exercise of a privilege. Here,
respondents' refusal to present or allow the
Facts: The respondents were duped by an agent presentation of Dr. Saniel's report was justified. It
(Valle) of the petitioner into investing in a was privileged communication between physician
promotional investment program offering 8% and patient. Furthermore, limitations of liability on
prepaid interest a month for certain deposits made the part of the insurer or health care provider must
on a monthly basis. Basically, the issue is whether be construed in such a way as to preclude it from
or not the insurance company should be held evading its obligations. Accordingly, they should be
solidarily liable, or whether it should hold only the scrutinized by the courts with extreme jealousy
agent solely liable to the respondents. and care and with a jaundiced eye. Since
petitioner had the burden of proving exception to
liability, it should have made its own assessment of the Commission before it is implemented. This
whether respondent Neomi had a pre-existing procedure would enable the Commission to inquire
condition when it failed to obtain the attending into the propriety of the condonation and to
physician's report. It could not just passively wait determine whether the same will not prejudice the
for Dr. Saniel's report to bail it out. The mere governments interest, consistent with COAs
reliance on a disputable presumption does not constitutional mandate to examine, audit and settle
meet the strict standard required under our all accounts of the government, its subdivisions,
jurisprudence. agencies and instrumentalities, including
government-owned and controlled corporations.
Furthermore, PDICs authority to condone under its
Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation v.
charter is circumscribed by the phrase to protect
COA
the interest of the Corporation. This authority does
February 22, 2008
not include the power to condone a liability that
arises from a violation of law. With greater reason,
Facts: The former Finance Secretary, Mr.
the condonation of a liability that arise from a
Roberto de Ocampo, in his capacity as ex-
violation of no less than the Constitution, as in this
officio Chairman of the Philippine Deposit
case, is not encompassed by PDICs charter. It is
Insurance Corporation (PDIC) Board for the
not in the interest of PDIC to forego audit
years 1994-1996 received a total amount
disallowances as it is neither its mandate nor its
of P440,068.62 representing Business
task to perpetuate breaches of law.
Policy Development and Enforcement
Gloria Sondayon v. P.J. Lhullier, Inc and
Expenses (BPDEE) and Christmas gift
Ricardo Diago
checks. The Auditor thereat issued Notice
February 27, 2008
of Disallowance disallowing in audit the
payment of said expenses on the ground
Facts: Petitioner had pledged her P250K watch to
that it partook of the nature of additional
respondent pawnshop. The pawnshop was robbed,
compensation or remuneration in violation
and among the items seized was petitioners watch.
of the rule on multiple positions proscribed
Petitioner tried to recover the watch but
under Section 13, Article VII of the
respondent argued that the robbery was a
Philippine Constitution and Section 2(9),
fortuitous event, hence, they were not liable.
Republic Act No. 3591, as amended. PDIC
sought reconsideration of the subject
Held: Had respondent company insured the
disallowance but the same was denied by
articles pledged against burglary, petitioner would
COA. The SC affirmed with finality said COA
have been compensated for the loss from the
decision and resolution. The Final Order of
burglary. Respondent companys failure to insure
Adjudication (FOA) was issued to PDIC for
the article is, therefore, a contributory cause to
enforcement of the decision. However,
petitioners loss. Considering, however, that
instead of complying with the Order, PDIC
petitioner agreed to a valuation of P15,000 for the
condoned the amount of P413,866.62
article pledged in case of a loss, the replacement
invoking its power to condone under
value for failure to insure is likewise limited to
Section 8, paragraph 12 of its charter.
P15,000. Nevertheless, this Court, taking into
Held: It is a fundamental rule that when a
account all the circumstances of this case, deems it
judgment becomes final and executory it becomes
fair and just to award exemplary damages against
immutable and unalterable, the prevailing party
respondent company for its failure to comply with
can have it executed as a matter of right, and the
the rule and regulation requiring it to insure the
issuance of a writ of execution becomes a
articles pledged against fire and burglary, in the
ministerial duty of the court. The writ of execution
amount of Twenty Five Thousand (P25,000) Pesos.
must conform to the judgment to be executed and
This is without prejudice to appropriate proceedings
adhere strictly to the very essential particulars.
to recover any excess value of the article pledged
Following this rule, PDIC should have reasonably
from amounts that may be or have been awarded
expected that an order directing the payment or
payable by third parties answerable for the loss
refund of the disallowed amount was forthcoming
arising from the robbery.
in accordance with the COA Rules as, in fact, a
Final Order of Adjudication was issued. Whatever
may have been the reason for the dismissal of Philippine Deposit Insurance
PDICs petition, the fact remains that the decision Corporation Act
upholding the audit disallowance had become final
and executory. At the risk of sounding trite, the (RA 3591 as amended by RAs 6037, 7400,
decision is now unalterable and immutable. It is no 8791 and 9302 and PDs 120, 1094, 1451 and
longer subject to any revision, modification or 1935)
appeal.
In dismissing the petition and affirming the audit
disallowance, this Court effectively declared that 1. Basic Policy
the payment of the BPDEE to Secretary De Ocampo
is prohibited as it violates the rule against double To insure the deposits of all banks which are
compensation. This declaration necessarily also entitled to the benefits of insurance under this
means that condonation of the same payment in Act
favor of the same person is likewise prohibited. To To promote and safeguard the interests of the
settle the matter once and for all, the audit depositing public by way of providing
disallowance is not subject to condonation following permanent and continuing insurance coverage
the principle that what is prohibited directly is also on all insured deposits.
prohibited indirectly. The audit disallowance
cannot be circumvented and legitimized by
resorting to condonation. The authority of PDIC to
2. PDIC Functions
condone applies only to ordinary receivables,
penalties and surcharges and must be submitted to
Can lend money to banks before closure
Insurer of deposits against bank closures community maintain financial
Acts as receiver for banks stability in the economy.
The PDIC Act is not applicable to Offshore
Banking Units Insured banks that have already
Nature of insurance function: compulsory closed
insurance on all bank deposits The authority to extend financial assistance may
also be exercised in the case of a closed insured
Administrative Functions: bank if the Corporation finds that
the resumption of operations of
2.1. Authority to Examine Banks such bank is vital to the interests of
The PDIC has the power to conduct examination of the community, or
banks with prior approval of the Monetary Board: a severe financial climate exists
which threatens the stability of a
Provided, No examination can be conducted number of banks possessing
within 12 months from the last examination significant resources
date.
Entities acquiring /merging with
2.2. Authority to Underwrite and Advance closed / closing insured banks
Legal Fees and Litigation Expenses The Corporation may provide any corporation
acquiring control of
Who are covered? merging with
The Corporation shall underwrite or advance consolidating with
litigation costs and expenses, or provide legal acquiring the assets of
assistance to its directors, officers, employees or an insured bank in danger of closing in order to
agents in connection with any civil, criminal, prevent such.
administrative or any other action or proceeding, to
which such director, officer, employee or agent is Closure of entities that may produce
made a party by reason of the exercise of authority systemic consequences
or performance of functions and duties under this When the Monetary Board has determined that
Act. there are systemic consequences of a probable
closure of an insured bank, the Corporation may
Directors, officers, employees or agents who shall grant financial assistance in such amount as may
resign, retire, transfer to another agency or be be necessary to prevent its failure or closure and/
separated from the service, shall continue to be or restore the insured bank to viable operations.
provided with such legal protection in connection
with any act done or omitted to be done by them in A systemic risk refers to the possibility that
good faith during their tenure or employment. failure of one bank to settle net transactions with
other banks will trigger a chain reaction, depriving
This shall not apply to any civil, criminal, other banks of funds leading to a general shutdown
administrative or any action or proceeding initiated of normal clearing and settlement activity. It also
by the Corporation against such director, officer, means the likelihood of a sudden, unexpected
employee or agent. collapse of confidence in a significant portion of the
banking or financial system with potentially large
What fees / expenses are covered? real economic effects.
Litigation costs and expenses, including legal
fees and other expenses of external counsel, or What are PDICs powers with regard to
providing legal assistance financial assistance?
Legal assistance shall include the grant or
advance of reasonable legal fees to enable the It is authorized to
employee to engage counsel of his choice. make loans
In the event of a settlement or compromise, purchase the assets
indemnification shall be provided only when the assume liabilities
Corporation is advised by counsel that the make deposits
persons to be indemnified did not commit any Provide financial assistance which may take the
negligence or misconduct. form of equity or quasi-equity of the insured
The costs and expenses incurred may be paid bank Provided That the Corporation shall
by the Corporation in advance of the final dispose of such equity as soon as practicable.
disposition upon receipt of an undertaking by
the employee to repay the amount advanced The Corporation, prior to the exercise of its powers,
should it ultimately be determined by the Board shall determine that actual payoff and liquidation
of Directors that he is not entitled to be will be more expensive than the exercise of this
indemnified. power.

2.3. Authority to Provide Financial The Corporation may not use its authority to
Assistance purchase the voting or common stock of an insured
bank but it can enter into and enforce agreements
What entities are covered? that it determines to be necessary to protect its
financial interests.
Insured banks in danger of closing
When the Corporation has determined that 3. Concept of Insured Deposits
an insured bank is in danger of
closing The term insured deposit means the amount
the continued operation of such due to any depositor for deposits in an insured
bank is essential to provide bank net of any obligation of the depositor to the
adequate banking service in the
insured bank as of the date of closure, but not to The Corporation shall publish the notice once a
exceed P250,000.00. week for at least 3 consecutive weeks in a
newspaper of general circulation or, when
In determining such amount due to any depositor, appropriate, in a newspaper circulated in the
there shall be added together all deposits in the community or communities where the closed bank
bank maintained in the same right and capacity for or its branches are located.
his benefit either in his own name or in the name of
others. 4.4. Calculation of Liability
(See Part III)
A joint account regardless of whether the
conjunction and, or, and/or is used, shall be Special Provisions for Joint Accounts (PDIC Bulletin
insured separately from any individually-owned 2004-04)
deposit account:
1. A joint account regardless of whether the
Provided, That conjunction and, or or and/or is used,
a. If the account is held jointly by two or more shall be insured separately from an
natural persons, or by two or more juridical individually-owned deposit account.
persons or entities, the maximum insured 2. If the account is held jointly by two or more
deposit shall be divided into as many equal natural persons, or by two or more juridical
shares as there are individuals, juridical persons or entities, the maximum insured
persons or entities, unless a different deposit shall be divided into as many equal
sharing is stipulated in the document of shares as there are individuals, juridical
deposit and persons or entities, unless a different
b. If the account is held by a juridical person sharing is stipulated in the document of
or entity jointly with one or more natural deposit.
persons, the maximum insured deposit
shall be presumed to belong entirely to Document of deposit referred to in the
such juridical person or entity preceding paragraph pertains to joint
c. The aggregate of the interests of each co- account agreements, account ledgers,
owner over several joint accounts, whether certificate of time deposits, passbooks or
owned by the same or different other evidence of deposits, specimen
combinations of individuals, juridical signature cards, corporate resolutions,
persons or entities, shall likewise be contracts or similar instruments, copies of
subject to the maximum insured deposit of which must be in the custody or possession
P250,000.00 of the bank upon takeover by PDIC.

No owner/holder of any negotiable certificate of 3. If the account is held by a juridical person


deposit shall be recognized as a depositor or entity jointly with one or more natural
entitled to the rights provided in this Act unless persons, the maximum insured deposit
his name is registered as owner/holder thereof shall be presumed to belong entirely to the
in the books of the issuing bank. juridical person or entity.
4. The aggregate of the interests or total
4. Liability to Depositors share of each co-owner over several joint
accounts, whether owned by the same or
4.1. Commencement of Liability different combinations of individuals,
Liability commences when an insured bank is juridical persons or entities, shall likewise
closed by the Monetary Board pursuant to Sec 30 be subject to the maximum insured deposit
of R.A. 7653. of P250,000.00.

4.2. Extent of Liability 5. The amount of insurance due to any


Liability covers the amount due to any depositor for depositor for deposits in an insured bank
deposits in an insured bank net of any obligation of shall be net of any matured or unmatured
the depositor to the insured bank as of the date of obligation of the depositor to the insured
closure, but not to exceed P250,000.00. bank as of date of closure. In case of joint
deposit accounts where only one of the co-
4.3. Determination of Insured Deposits depositors has an obligation to the closed
The Corporation shall commence the determination bank, the following shall apply:
of insured deposits upon its actual takeover of the
closed bank.
a. Where the deposit is a joint
and/or or or account which is
In order that a claim for deposit insurance with the
covered by a hold-out agreement,
PDIC may prosper, the law requires that a
the obligation secured by the hold-
corresponding deposit be placed in the insured
out agreement shall be deducted
bank. A deposit as defined in Section 3(f), may be
from the balance of the joint
constituted only if money or the equivalent of
account, regardless of the fact that
money is received by a bank:
only one of the co-depositors in the
joint account is indebted to the
(f) The term "deposit" means the unpaid
closed bank.
balance of money or its equivalent received
by a bank in the usual course of business
and for which it has given or is obliged to b. When the deposit is a joint and
give credit to a commercial, checking, account which is covered by a hold-
savings, time or thrift account or which is out agreement, the obligation
evidenced by passbook, check and/or secured by the hold-out agreement
certificate of deposit (PDIC vs CA, 1997) shall be deducted only from the
share in the joint account of the
depositor who is indebted to the
closed bank, unless his co- 4.9. Failure of Depositor to Claim Insured
depositor is himself a co-signatory Deposit
to the hold-out agreement. Unless otherwise waived by the Corporation, if the
depositor in the closed bank shall fail to claim his
c. Where the deposit is either a joint insured deposits with the Corporation
and, or or and/or account within 2 years from actual takeover of the
which is not covered by a hold-out closed bank by the receiver, or
agreement, the obligation of the within 2 years after the two-year period to
depositor who is indebted to the file a claim,
closed bank shall be deducted only all rights of the depositor against the Corporation
from his share in the balance of the shall be barred.
joint deposit account.
However, all rights of the depositor against the
closed bank and its shareholders or the
4.5. Mode of Payment
receivership estate to which the Corporation may
Payment of the insured deposits shall be made by
have become subrogated, shall revert to the
the Corporation as soon as possible either
depositor.
by cash or
by making available to each depositor a
5. Restriction on Payment of Dividends by
transferred deposit in another insured.
Insured Bank
The term transfer deposit means a deposit in
an insured bank made available to a depositor by 5.1. General Rule:
the Corporation as payment of insured deposit of No insured bank shall pay any dividend on its
such depositor in a closed bank and assumed by capital stock or interest on its capital notes or
another insured bank. debentures (if such interest is required to be paid
only out of net profits) or distribute any of its
4.6. Conditions that may be imposed prior to capital assets while it remains in default in the
payment payment of any assessment due to the Corporation
The Corporation, in its discretion, may
require proof of claims to be filed before 5.2. Exception:
paying the insured deposits If such default is due to a dispute between the
Where the Corporation is not satisfied as to insured bank and the Corporation over the
the viability of a claim for an insured amount of such assessment and Bank deposits
deposit, it may require final determination security satisfactory to the Corporation for
of a court of competent jurisdiction before payment upon final determination
paying such claim

4.7. Effect of Payment of Insured Deposit


PDIC is discharged from obligations 6. Prohibition against Splitting of
Payment of an insured deposit to any Deposits
person by the Corporation shall
discharge the Corporation The penalty of prision mayor or a fine of not less
Payment of a transferred deposit by the than P50,000 but not more than P2,000,000 or
new bank or by an insured bank in both shall be imposed upon any director, officer,
which a transferred deposit has been employee or agent of a bank for :
made available shall discharge the xxx
Corporation and such new bank or 5) splitting of deposits or creation of fictitious loans
other insured bank or deposit accounts.
PDIC is subrogated to depositors rights xxx
The Corporation, upon payment of any
depositor shall be subrogated to all
rights of the depositor against the 7. Prohibition against Issuance of TROs
closed bank. But the depositor shall
retain his claim for any uninsured No court, except the CA, shall issue any TRO,
portion of his deposit. preliminary injunction or preliminary mandatory
All payments by the Corporation of injunction against the Corporation.
insured deposits in closed banks This prohibition shall apply in all cases, disputes
partake of the nature of public funds, or controversies instituted by a private party, the
and must be considered a preferred insured bank, or any shareholder.)
credit similar to taxes due to the The Supreme Court may issue a restraining order
National Government. or injunction when
o the matter is of extreme urgency involving a
4.8. Failure to settle claim of insured constitutional issue
depositor o grave injustice and irreparable injury will
Failure to settle the claim, within 6 months from arise
the date of filing of claim for insured deposit, where o The party applying shall file a bond in an
such failure was due to grave abuse of discretion, amount to be fixed by the Supreme Court
gross negligence, bad faith, or malice, shall subject
the directors, officers or employees responsible to Effects of issuing TRO:
imprisonment from 6 months to 1 year. Any restraining order or injunction issued in
violation of this Section is void and of no force
The period shall not apply if the validity of the
and effect
claim requires the resolution of issues of facts and
or law by another office, body or agency.
Any judge who has issued the same shall suffer
the penalty of suspension of at least 60 days
without pay
TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

TRANSPORTATION LAW passenger, or both with or without fixed route and


whether may be its classification, freight or carrier
service of any class, express service, steamboat or
I. General Considerations steamship line, pontines, ferries, and water craft,
engaged in the transportation of passengers or
A. Public Utilities freight or both, shipyard, marine railways, marine
repair shop, [warehouse] wharf or dock, ice plant,
ice-refrigeration plant, canal, irrigation system,
1987 Constitution, Article XII
gas, electric light, heat and power water supply and
Section 11
power, petroleum, sewerage system, wire or
wireless communications system, wire or wireless
No franchise, certificate, or any other form of broadcasting stations and other similar public
authorization for the operation of a public utility services: Provided, however, That a person
shall be granted except to citizens of the Philippines engaged in agriculture, not otherwise a public
or to corporations or associations organized under service, who owns a motor vehicle and uses it
the laws of the Philippines, at least sixty per personally and/or enters into a special contract
centum of whose capital is owned by such citizens; whereby said motor vehicle is offered for hire or
nor shall such franchise, certificate, or compensation to a third party or third parties
authorization be exclusive in character or for a engaged in agriculture, not itself or themselves a
longer period than fifty years. Neither shall any public service, for operation by the latter for a
such franchise or right be granted except under the limited time and for a specific purpose directly
condition that it shall be subject to amendment, connected with the cultivation of his or their farm,
alteration, or repeal by the Congress when the the transportation, processing, and marketing of
common good so requires. The State shall agricultural products of such third party or third
encourage equity participation in public utilities by parties shall not be considered as operating a
the general public. The participation of foreign public service for the purposes of this Act.
investors in the governing body of any public utility WHAT IS A PUBLIC UTILITY?
enterprise shall be limited to their proportionate Kilusang Mayo Uno Labor Center v. Garcia
share in its capital, and all the executive and (1994)
managing officers of such corporation or Public utilities are privately owned and operated
association must be citizens of the Philippines. businesses whose services are essential to the
general public. They are enterprises which specially
Section 17 cater to the needs of the public and conduce to
In times of national emergency, when the public their comfort and convenience. As such, public
interest so requires, the State may, during the utility services are impressed with public interest
emergency and under reasonable terms prescribed and concern. When, therefore, one devotes his
by it, temporarily take over or direct the operation property to a use in which the public has an
of any privately-owned public utility or business interest, he, in effect grants to the public an
affected with public interest. interest in that use, and must submit to the control
Agan, Jr. vs. PIATCO, 402 SCRA 612 (2003) by the public for the common good, to the extent
The Constitution envisions a situation wherein the of the interest he has thus created.
exigencies of the times necessitated the Albano v. Reyes (1989)
government to temporarily take over or direct the Franchises issued by Congress are not required
operation of any privately owned public utility or before each and every public utility may operate.
business affected with public interest. Since the A public utility is a business or service engaged in
State, in this case, is merely exercising its police regularly supplying the public with some
power, such exercise must not be unreasonably commodity or service of public consequence, such
hampered nor can it be a source of obligation, in as electricity, gas, water, transportation, telephone
the absence of damage due to arbitrariness. Also, or telegraph services. Apart from statutes which
requiring, the government pay reasonable define public utilities that are within the purview of
compensation for the reasonable use of the such statutes, it would be difficult to construct a
property pursuant to the operation of the business definition of a public utility which would fit every
contravenes the Constitution. conceivable case. As its name indicates, however,
Section 18 the term public utility implies a public use and
The State may, in the interest of national welfare service to the public.
or defense, establish and operate vital industries
and, upon payment of just compensation, transfer WHEN IS A BUSINESS A PUBLIC UTILITY?
to public ownership utilities and other private When it involves a commodity or service of
enterprises to be operated by the Government. public consequence.
Section 19
The State shall regulate or prohibit monopolies 2 CONCEPTS OF PUBLIC UTILITY UNDER THE 1987
when the public interest so requires. No CONSTITUTION:
combinations in restraint of trade or unfair 1. A public utility is a partly nationalized business
competition shall be allowed. endeavor
The Public Service Law, CA 146, as amended 2. It is a business affected with the public interest.
Sec. 13(b) (national emergency; general welfare;
The term "public service" includes every person common good)
that now or hereafter may own, operate, manage,
or control in the Philippines, for hire or 2 TESTS FOR DETERMINING PUBLIC UTILITY:
compensation, with general or limited clientele, 1. Is it engaged in regularly supplying the public
whether permanent, occasional or accidental, and with some commodity or service (per definition
done for general business purposes, any common in Albano v. Reyes below)
carrier, railroad, street railway, traction railway, 2. If #1 is uncertain, is it a public service as
sub-way motor vehicle, either for freight or defined in the Public Service Law under CA 146

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 208 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Sec 13(b)? If it falls under any one of the however, the term public utility implies a public use
examples given under CA 146 Sec 13(b), then it and service to the public.
is a public utility. Tatad v Garcia
What constitutes a public utility is not their
WHAT DOES REGULARLY SUPPLYING THE PUBLIC ownership but their use to serve the public.
MEAN?
The utility must hold itself out to the public as a PAL v. Civil Aeronautics Board (1997)
public utility by demand and as a matter of right, WON certificates of Public Convenience and
and not by permission. To determine what Necessity (franchise required) as used in RA 776
constitutes regularity, look at it from the to authorize the Board is different from
perspective of the public, and not the operator. Certificates of Public Convenience (no franchise
It is a service or a readiness to serve an indefinite required)? No
portion of the population subject only to the There is no authoritative basis in
limitations of the service as given by the grant such distinguishing a Certificate of Public Convenience
that [the utility] incurs a liability as a violation of and Necessity (franchise required) and a Certificate
its duty if it refuses, such that the availment of the of Public Convenience (no franchise required)
service has become, through time, a matter of based only on the use of the words convenience
right and not of mere privilege. (also in US v. Tan and necessity. The use of the word necessity in
Piaco) conjunction with public convenience in a
certificate of authorization to a public service entity
ARE ALL PUBLIC UTILITIES COMMODITIES OR SERVICE to operate, does not in any way modify the nature
OF PUBLIC CONSEQUENCE? of such certification, or the requirements for the
Yes. All public utilities have a public consequence. issuance of the same. It is the law which
But not all businesses bearing public consequence determines the requisites for the issuance of such
are public utilities. This is because almost all types certification, and not the title indicating the
of business have some form of regulation from the certificate.
State.
WHAT IS THE DIFFERENCE BETWEEN A
TO WHOM DOES PUBLIC REFER TO? IS THE WORD PUBLIC UTILITY AND A PUBLIC SERVICE?
PUBLIC IN PUBLIC UTILITY THE SAME IN PUBLIC
SERVICE? For all intents and purposes, they are the
There are three senses of the word public in same and are used interchangeably.
Transportation Law: a) public utility; b) public However, public utility is a broader concept
service; and c) definition of a common carrier that embraces public service. A public service is
under Art. 1732 of the Civil Code. necessarily a public utility, but not all public utilities
To determine a public utility, the two tests above & are public services.
the definition under Albano v. Reyes apply.
WHEN IS A PUBLIC UTILITY NOT A PUBLIC
WHAT IS A PUBLIC SERVICE? SERVICE?

Kilusang Mayo Uno Labor Center v. Garcia Jr. If it is not included in the enumeration in the
(1994) Public Service Act (CA 146 Sec. 13(b)) and Albano
In determining public need, the presumption v. Reyes.
of need for a service shall be deemed in favor of
the applicant. The burden of proving that there is HOW DO THEY DIFFER IN CONSTITUTIONAL
no need for a proposed service shall be with the RESTRICTIONS AND REQUIREMENTS?
oppositor(s).
Public convenience and necessity exists when If a business is a public utility, then it is
the proposed facility or service meets a reasonable subject to the limitations and restrictions provided
want of the public and supply a need which the for in the 1987 Constitution (Art 12 Secs.
existing facilities do not adequately supply. The 11,17,18,19) Since a public service is necessarily a
existence or nonexistence of public convenience public utility, therefore public services are subject
and necessity is therefore a question of fact that to the same Constitutional limitations and
must be established by evidence, real and/or restrictions.
testimonial; empirical data; statistics and such If a public utility is not a public service, it is
other means necessary, in a public hearing still subject to the same Constitutional limitations
conducted for that purpose. The object and and restrictions.
purpose of such procedure, among other things, is
to look out for, and protect, the interests of both Therefore, public utility = Constitution
the public and the existing transport operators. public service = Constitution + Public
Service Act
Albano v. Reyes (1989)
Franchises issued by Congress are not B. Transportation
required before each and every public utility may DEFINITION
operate. The movement of goods or persons from one
A public utility is a business or service place to another, by a carrier. (Blacks Law
engaged in regularly supplying the public with Dictionary)
some commodity or service of public consequence, A contract of transportation is one whereby a
such as electricity, gas, water, transportation, certain person or association of persons obligate
telephone or telegraph services. Apart from themselves to transport persons, things, news from
statutes which define public utilities that are within one place to another for a fixed price. It is the
the purview of such statutes, it would be difficult to removal of goods or persons from one place to
construct a definition of a public utility which would another.
fit every conceivable case. As its name indicates,

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 209 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

NOTE: to render a decision or issue an order in any case is


Art. 1766 In all matters not regulated by this not present, or in the event of a tie vote among the
Code, the rights and obligations of common carriers Commissioners, the Secretary of Justice may
shall be governed by the Code of Commerce and by designate such number of Judges of the Courts of
special laws. First Instance, or such number of attorneys of the
legal division of the Commission, as may be
PUBLIC NATURE necessary to sit temporarily as Commissioners in
It is for public use, which means that the the Public Service Commission.
use is not confined to privileged individuals, but is The Public Service Commission shall sit individually
instead open to an indefinite public. It is this or as a body en banc or in two divisions of three
indefinite or unrestricted quality that gives it its Commissioners each. The Public Service
public character. The true criterion by which to Commissioner shall preside when the Commission
judge the character of the use is whether the public sits en banc and in one division. In the other
may enjoy it by right or by permission. There must division, the Associate Commissioner with seniority
be, in general, a right under the law which compels of appointment in that division shall preside. Five
the owner to give the service for the general public. Commissioners shall constitute a quorum for
PUBLIC SERVICE ACT sessions en banc and two Commissioners shall
THE PUBLIC SERVICE LAW (CA 146) constitute a quorum for the sessions of a division.
(As amended, and as modified particularly by PD In the absence of a quorum, the session shall be
No. 1, Integrated Reorganization Plan and EO 546) adjourned until the requisite number is present.
CHAPTER I All the powers herein vested upon the Commission
ORGANIZATION shall be considered vested upon any of the
SECTION 1 Commissioners, acting either individually or jointly
This Act shall be known as the "Public Service Act." as hereinafter provided. The Commissioners shall
SECTION 2 equitably divide among themselves all pending
There is created under the Department of Justice a cases and those that may hereafter be submitted
commission which shall be designated and known to the Commissioner, in such manner and form as
as the Public Service Commission, composed of one they may determine, and shall proceed to hear and
Public Service Commissioner and five Associate determine the case assigned to each or to their
Commissioners, and which shall be vested with the respective divisions, or to the Commission en banc
powers and duties hereafter specified. Whenever as follows: uncontested cases, except those
the word "Commission" is used in this Act, it shall pertaining to the fixing of rates, shall be decided by
be held to mean the Public Service Commission, one Commissioner; contested cases and all cases
and whenever the word "Commissioner" is used in involving the fixing of rates shall be decided by the
this Act it shall be held to mean the Public Service Commission in division and the concurrence of at
Commissioner or anyone of the Associate least two Commissioners in the division shall be
Commissioners. The Public Service Commissioner necessary for the promulgation of a decision or
and the Associate Public Service Commissioners non-interlocutory order in these cases: Provided,
shall be natural born citizens and residents of the however, That any motion for reconsideration of a
Philippines, not under thirty years of age; members decision or non-interlocutory order of any
of the Bar of the Philippines, with at least five years Commissioner or division shall be heard directly by
of law practice or five years of employment in the the Commission en banc and the concurrence of at
government service requiring a lawyer's diploma; least four Commissioners shall be necessary for the
and shall be appointed by the President of the promulgation of a final decision or order resolving
Philippines, with the consent of the Commission on such motion for reconsideration. (As amended by
Appointments of the Congress of the Philippines: Republic Act Nos. 723 and 2677)
Provided, however, That the present Commissioner SECTION 4
and the personnel of the Commission shall continue The Public Service Commissioner shall receive an
in office without the necessity of re-appointment. annual compensation of thirteen thousand pesos;
The Commissioners shall have the rank and and each of the Associate Commissioners an annual
privilege of retirement of Judges of the Courts of compensation of twelve thousand pesos. The
First Instance. (As amended by Republic Act Nos. Commissioners shall be assisted by one chief
178 and 2677) attorney, one finance and rate regulation officer,
SECTION 3 one chief utilities regulation engineer, one chief
The Commissioner and Associate Commissioners accountant, one transportation regulation chief,
shall hold office until they reach the age of seventy one secretary of the Public Service Commission,
years, or until removed in accordance with the and three public utilities advisers who shall receive
procedures prescribed in section one hundred and an annual compensation of not less than ten
seventy-three of Act Numbered Twenty-seven thousand eight hundred pesos each; five assistant
hundred and eleven, known as the Revised chiefs of division who shall receive an annual
Administrative Code: Provided, however, That upon compensation of not less than nine thousand six
retirement any Commissioner of Associate hundred pesos each; twelve attorneys who shall
Commissioner shall be entitled to all retirement receive an annual compensation of not less than
benefits and privileges for Judges of the Courts of nine thousand pesos each; and a technical and
First Instance or under the retirement law to which confidential staff to be composed of two certified
he may be entitled on the date of his retirement. In public accounts, two electrical engineers, two
case of the absence, for any reason, of the Public mechanical or communication engineers, and two
Service Commissioner, the Associate Commissioner special assistants who shall receive an annual
with seniority of appointment shall act as compensation of not less than seven thousand two
Commissioner. If on account of absence, illness, or hundred pesos each. (As amended by Republic Act
incapacity of any of three Commissioners, or Nos. 723, 2677 and 3792)
whenever by reason of temporary disability of any SECTION 5
Commissioner or of a vacancy occurring therein, The Public Service Commissioner, the Associate
the requisite number of Commissioners necessary Public Service Commissioners, and all other officers

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 210 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

and employees of the Public Service Commission of profit or trust with the Government of the
shall enjoy the same privileges and rights as the Philippines.
officer and employees of the classified civil service SECTION 10
of the Government of the Philippines. They shall The Commission shall have its office in the City of
also be entitled to receive from the Government of Manila or at such other place as may be
the Philippines their necessary travelling expenses designated, and may hold hearings on any
while travelling on the business of the Commission, proceedings at such times and places, within the
which shall be paid on proper voucher therefor, Philippines, as it may provide by order in writing:
approved by the Secretary of Justice, out of funds Provided, That during the months of April and May
appropriated for the contingent expenses of the of each year, at least three Commissioners shall be
Commission. on vacation in such manner that once every two
When the exigency of the service so requires and years at least three of them shall be on duty during
with the approval of the Secretary of Justice, and April and May: Provided, however, That in the
subject to the provisions of Commonwealth Act interest of public service, the Secretary of Justice
Numbered Two hundred forty-six, as amended, may require any or all the Commissioners not on
funds may be set aside from the appropriations duty to render services and perform their duties
provided for the Commission and/or from the fees during the vacation months. (As amended by
collected under Section forty of this Act to defray Republic Act Nos. 176 and 3792)
the expenses to be incurred by the Public Service SECTION 11
Commissioner or any of the Associate The Commission shall have the power to make
Commissioners, officers or employees of the needful rules for its Government and other
Commission to be designated by the Commissioner, proceedings not inconsistent with this Act and shall
with the approval of the Secretary of Justice, in the adopt a common seal, and judicial notice shall be
study of modern trends in supervision and taken for such seal. True copies of said rules and
regulation of public services. (As amended by other amendments shall be promptly furnished to
Republic Act No. 3792) the Bureau of Printing and shall be forthwith
published in the Official Gazette.
SECTION 13
SECTION 6 (a) The Commission shall have jurisdiction,
The Secretary of Justice, upon recommendation of supervision, and control over all public services and
the Public Service Commissioner, shall appoint all their franchises, equipment, and other properties,
subordinate officers and employees of the and in the exercise of its authority, it shall have
Commission as may be provided in the the necessary powers and the aid of the public
Appropriation Act. The Public Service Commissioner force: Provided, That public services owned or
shall have general executive control, direction, and operated by government entities or government-
supervision over the work of the Commission and owned or controlled corporations shall be regulated
of its members, body and personnel, and over all by the Commission in the same way as privately-
administrative business. (As amended by Republic owned public services, but certificates of public
Act Nos. 178 and 3792) convenience or certificates of public convenience
SECTION 7 and necessity shall not be required of such entities
The Secretary of the Commission, under the or corporations: And provided, further, That it shall
direction of the Commissioner, shall have charge of have no authority to require steamboats, motor
the administrative business of the Commission and ships and steamship lines, whether privately-
shall perform such other duties as may be required owned, or owned or operated by any Government
of him. He shall be the recorder and official controlled corporation or instrumentality to obtain
reporter of the proceedings of the Commission and certificate of public convenience or to prescribe
shall have authority to administer oaths in all their definite routes or lines of service.
matters coming under the jurisdiction of the (b) The term "public service" includes every
Commission. He shall be the custodian of the person that now or hereafter may own, operate,
records, maps, profiles, tariffs, itineraries, reports, manage, or control in the Philippines, for hire or
and any other documents and papers filed with the compensation, with general or limited clientele,
Commission or entrusted to his care and shall be whether permanent, occasional or accidental, and
responsible therefor to the Commission. He shall done for general business purposes, any common
have authority to designate from time to time any carrier, railroad, street railway, traction railway,
of his delegates to perform the duties of Deputy sub-way motor vehicle, either for freight or
Secretary with any of the Commissioners. passenger, or both with or without fixed route and
SECTION 8 whether may be its classification, freight or carrier
The Commission shall furnish the Secretary such of service of any class, express service, steamboat or
its findings and decisions as in its judgment may be steamship line, pontines, ferries, and water craft,
of general public interest; the Secretary shall engaged in the transportation of passengers or
compile the same for the purpose of publication in freight or both, shipyard, marine railways, marine
a series of volumes to be designated "Reports of repair shop, [warehouse] wharf or dock, ice plant,
the Public Service Commission of the Philippines," ice-refrigeration plant, canal, irrigation system,
which shall be published in such form and manner gas, electric light, heat and power water supply
as may be best adapted for public information and and power, petroleum, sewerage system, wire or
use, and such authorized publications shall be wireless communications system, wire or wireless
competent evidence of the reports and decisions of broadcasting stations and other similar public
the Commission therein contained without any services: Provided, however, That a person
further proof or authentication thereof. engaged in agriculture, not otherwise a public
SECTION 9 service, who owns a motor vehicle and uses it
No member or employee of the Commission shall personally and/or enters into a special contract
have any official or professional relation with any whereby said motor vehicle is offered for hire or
public service as herein defined, or hold any office compensation to a third party or third parties
engaged in agriculture, not itself or themselves a

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 211 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

public service, for operation by the latter for a proper notice and hearing in accordance with the
limited time and for a specific purpose directly rules and provisions of this Act, subject to the
connected with the cultivation of his or their farm, limitations and exceptions mentioned and saving
the transportation, processing, and marketing of provisions to the contrary:
agricultural products of such third party or third (a) To issue certificates which shall be known as
parties shall not be considered as operating a certificates of public convenience, authorizing the
public service for the purposes of this Act. operation of public service within the Philippines
(c) The word "person" includes every individual, whenever the Commission finds that the operation
co-partnership, joint-stock company or of the public service proposed and the
corporation, whether domestic or foreign, their authorization to do business will promote the public
lessees, trustees, or receivers, as well as any interest in a proper and suitable manner. Provided,
municipality, province, city, government-owned or That thereafter, certificates of public convenience
controlled corporation, or agency of the and certificates of public convenience and necessity
Government of the Philippines, and whatever other will be granted only to citizens of the Philippines or
persons or entities that may own or possess or of the United States or to corporations, co-
operate public services. (As amended by Com. Act partnerships, associations or joint-stock companies
454 and RA No. 2677) constituted and organized under the laws of the
SECTION 14 Philippines; Provided, That sixty per centum of the
The following are exempted from the provisions of stock or paid-up capital of any such corporations,
the preceding section: co-partnership, association or joint-stock company
(a) Warehouses; must belong entirely to citizens of the Philippines
(b) Vehicles drawn by animals and bancas moved or of the United States: Provided, further, That no
by oar or sail, and tugboats and lighters; such certificates shall be issued for a period of
(c) Airships within the Philippines except as more than fifty years.
regards the fixing of their maximum rates on (b) To approve, subject to constitutional
freight and passengers; limitations any franchise or privilege granted under
(d) Radio companies except with respect to the the provisions of Act No. Six Hundred and Sixty-
fixing of rates; seven, as amended by Act No. One Thousand and
(e) Public services owned or operated by any twenty-two, by any political subdivision of the
instrumentality of the National Government or by Philippines when, in the judgment of the
any government-owned or controlled corporation, Commission, such franchise or privilege will
except with respect to the fixing of rates. (As properly conserve the public interests, and the
amended by Com. Act 454, RA No. 2031, and RA Commission shall in so approving impose such
No. 2677) conditions as to construction, equipment,
SECTION 15 maintenance, service, or operation as the public
With the exception of those enumerated in the interests and convenience may reasonably require,
preceding section, no public service shall operate in and to issue certificates of public convenience and
the Philippines without possessing a valid and necessity when such is required or provided by any
subsisting certificate from the Public Service law or franchise.
Commission known as "certificate of public (c) To fix and determine individual or joint rates,
convenience," or "certificate of public convenience tolls, charges, classifications, or schedules thereof,
and necessity," as the case may be, to the effect as well as commutation, mileage, kilometrage, and
that the operation of said service and the other special rates which shall be imposed
authorization to do business will promote the public observed and followed thereafter by any public
interests in a proper and suitable manner. service: Provided, That the Commission may, in its
The Commission may prescribe as a condition for discretion, approve rates proposed by public
the issuance of the certificate provided in the services provisionally and without necessity of any
preceding paragraph that the service can be hearing; but it shall call a hearing thereon within
acquired by the Republic of the Philippines or any thirty days, thereafter, upon publication and notice
instrumentality thereof upon payment of the cost to the concerns operating in the territory affected:
price of its useful equipment, less reasonable Provided, further, That in case the public service
depreciation; and likewise, that the certificate shall equipment of an operator is used principally or
be valid only for a definite period of time; and that secondarily for the promotion of a private business,
the violation of any of these conditions shall the net profits of said private business shall be
produce the immediate cancellation of the considered in relation with the public service of
certificate without the necessity of any express such operator for the purpose of fixing the rates.
action on the part of the Commission. (d) To fix just and reasonable standards,
In estimating the depreciation, the effect of the use classifications, regulations, practices,
of the equipment, its actual condition, the age of measurement, or service to be furnished, imposed,
the model, or other circumstances affecting its observed, and followed thereafter by any public
value in the market shall be taken into service.
consideration. (e) To ascertain and fix adequate and serviceable
The foregoing is likewise applicable to any standards for the measurement of quantity,
extension or amendment of certificates actually in quality, pressure, initial voltage, or other condition
force and to those which may hereafter be issued, pertaining to the supply of the product or service
to permit to modify itineraries and time schedules rendered by any public service, and to prescribe
of public services, and to authorizations to renew reasonable regulations for the examination and
and increase equipment and properties. test of such product or service and for the
SECTION 1620 measurement thereof.
Proceedings of the Commission, upon notice and (f) To establish reasonable rules, regulations,
hearing. - The Commission shall have power, upon instructions, specifications, and standards, to
secure the accuracy of all meters and appliances
20
The powers of the Public Service Commission for measurements.
were asked in 1993.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 212 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

(g) To compel any public service to furnish safe, (n) To suspend or revoke any certificate issued
adequate, and proper service as regards the under the provisions of this Act whenever the
manner of furnishing the same as well as the holder thereof has violated or willfully and
maintenance of the necessary material and contumaciously refused to comply with any order
equipment. rule or regulation of the Commission or any
(h) To require any public service to establish, provision of this Act: Provided, That the
construct, maintain, and operate any reasonable Commission, for good cause, may prior to the
extension of its existing facilities, where in the hearing suspend for a period not to exceed thirty
judgment of said Commission, such extension is days any certificate or the exercise of any right or
reasonable and practicable and will furnish authority issued or granted under this Act by order
sufficient business to justify the construction and of the Commission, whenever such step shall in the
maintenance of the same and when the financial judgment of the Commission be necessary to avoid
condition of the said public service reasonably serious and irreparable damage or inconvenience
warrants the original expenditure required in to the public or to private interests.
making and operating such extension. (o) To fix, determine, and regulate, as the
(i) To direct any railroad, street railway or traction convenience of the state may require, a special
company to establish and maintain at any junction type for auto-busses, trucks, and motor trucks to
or point of connection or intersection with any be hereafter constructed, purchased, and operated
other line of said road or track, or with any other by operators after the approval of this Act; to fix
line of any other railroad, street railway or traction and determine a special registration fee for auto-
to promote, such just and reasonable connection buses, trucks, and motor trucks so constructed,
as shall be necessary to promote the convenience purchased and operated: Provided, That said fees
of shippers of property, or of passengers, and in shall be smaller than more those charged for auto-
like manner direct any railroad, street railway, or busses, trucks, and motor trucks of types not made
traction company engaged in carrying regulation under the subsection.
merchandise, to construct, maintain and operate, SECTION 18
upon reasonable terms, a switch connection with It shall be unlawful for any individual, co-
any private sidetrack which may be constructed by partnership, association, corporation or joint-stock
any shipper to connect with the railroad, street company, their lessees, trustees or receivers
railway or traction company line where, in the appointed by any court whatsoever, or any
judgment of the Commission, such connection is municipality, province, or other department of the
reasonable and practicable and can be out in with Government of the Philippines to engage in any
safety and will furnish sufficient business to justify public service business without having first secured
the construction and maintenance of the same. from the Commission a certificate of public
(j) To authorize, in its discretion, any railroad, convenience or certificate of public convenience
street railway or traction company to lay its tracks and necessity as provided for in this Act, except
across the tracks of any other railroad, street grantees of legislative franchises expressly
railway or traction company or across any public exempting such grantees from the requirement of
highway. securing a certificate from this Commission as well
(k) To direct any railroad or street railway as concerns at present existing expressly
company to install such safety devices or about exempted from the jurisdiction of the Commission,
such other reasonable measures as may in the either totally or in part, by the provisions of section
judgment of the Commission be necessary for the thirteen of this Act.
protection of the public are passing grade crossing SECTION 19
of (1) public highways and railroads, (2) public Unlawful Acts. - It shall be unlawful for any public
highways and streets railway, or (3) railways and service:
street railways. (a) To provide or maintain any service that is
(l) To fix and determine proper and adequate rates unsafe, improper, or inadequate or withhold or
of depreciation of the property of any public service refuse any service which can reasonably be
which will be observed in a proper and adequate demanded and furnished, as found and determined
depreciation account to be carried for the by the Commission in a final order which shall be
protection of stockholders, bondholders or creditors conclusive and shall take effect in accordance with
in accordance with such rules, regulations, and this Act, upon appeal of otherwise.
form of account as the Commission may prescribe. (b) To make or give, directly or indirectly, by itself
Said rates shall be sufficient to provide the or through its agents, attorneys or brokers, or any
amounts required over and above the expense of of them, discounts or rebates on authorized rates,
maintenance to keep such property in a state of or grant credit for the payment of freight charges,
efficiency corresponding to the progress of the or any undue or unreasonable preference or
industry. Each public service shall conform its advantage to any person of corporation or to any
depreciation accounts to the rates so determined locality or to any particular description of traffic or
and fixed, and shall set aside the moneys so service, or subject any particular person or
provided for out of its earnings and carry the same corporation or locality or any particular description
in a depreciation fund. The income from of traffic to any prejudice or disadvantage in any
investments of money in such fund shall likewise respect whatsoever; to adopt, maintain, or enforce
be carried in such fund. This fund shall not be any regulation, practice or measurement which
expended otherwise than for depreciation, shall be found or determined by the Commission to
improvements, new construction, extensions or be unjust, unreasonable, unduly preferential or
conditions to the properly of such public service. unjustly discriminatory in a final order which shall
(m) To amend, modify or revoke at any time be conclusive and shall take effect in accordance
certificate issued under the provisions of this Act, with the provisions of this Act, upon repeal or
whenever the facts and circumstances on the otherwise.
strength of which said certificate was issued have (g) To sell, alienate, mortgage, encumber or lease
been misrepresented or materially changed. its property, franchises, certificates, privileges, or
rights or any part thereof; or merge or consolidate

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 213 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

its property, franchises privileges or rights, or any


part thereof, with those of any other public service. When must the approval of the DOTC be secured?
The approval herein required shall be given, after Before or after the execution of the contract.
notice to the public and hearing the persons What if the transferree is an alien?
interested at a public hearing, if it be shown that VOID. An alien cannot own more than 40% of
there are just and reasonable grounds for making the stock of a public utility.
the mortgaged or encumbrance, for liabilities of What is a Certificate of Public Convenience? (CPC)
more than one year maturity, or the sale, The Public Service Law, Sec. 15
alienation, lease, merger, or consolidation to be With the exception of those enumerated in the
approved, and that the same are not detrimental preceding section, no public service shall operate in
to the public interest, and in case of a sale, the the Philippines without possessing a valid and
date on which the same is to be consummated subsisting certificate from the Public Service
shall be fixed in the order of approval: Provided, Commission known as "certificate of public
however, that nothing herein contained shall be convenience," or "certificate of public convenience
construed to prevent the transaction from being and necessity," as the case may be, to the effect
negotiated or completed before its approval or to that the operation of said service and the
prevent the sale, alienation, or lease by any public authorization to do business will promote the public
service of any of its property in the ordinary course interests in a proper and suitable manner.
of its business. The Commission may prescribe as a condition for
(h) To sell or register in its books the transfer or the issuance of the certificate provided in the
sale of shares of its capital stock, if the result of preceding paragraph that the service can be
that sale in itself or in connection with another acquired by the Republic of the Philippines or any
previous sale, shall be to vest in the transferee instrumentality thereof upon payment of the cost
more than forty per centum of the subscribed price of its useful equipment, less reasonable
capital of said public service. Any transfer made in depreciation; and likewise, that the certificate shall
violation of this provision shall be void and of no be valid only for a definite period of time; and that
effect and shall not be registered in the books of the violation of any of these conditions shall
the public service corporation. Nothing herein produce the immediate cancellation of the
contained shall be construed to prevent the holding certificate without the necessity of any express
of shares lawfully acquired. (As amended by Com. action on the part of the Commission.
Act No. 454.) A CPC is any authorization to operate a public
(i) To sell, alienate or in any manner transfer service issued by the PSC (now DOTC).
shares of its capital stock to any alien if the result It is an authorization issued by the
of that sale, alienation, or transfer in itself or in Commission for the operation of public services for
connection with another previous sale shall be the which no franchise, either municipal or
reduction to less than sixty per centum of the legislative, is required by law) e.g. motor
capital stock belonging to Philippine citizens. Such vehicles
sale, alienation or transfer shall be void and of no It constitutes neither a franchise nor a
effect and shall be sufficient cause for ordering the contract, it does not confer property rights, and is a
cancellation of the certificate. mere license or privilege. (Pantranco v. PSC) Such
privilege is forfeited when the grantee fails to
Y Transit v. NLRC comply with his commitments to serve the public
The sale, alienation or other encumbrance of a and public necessity. However, these certificates
public service operators properties requires the represent property rights to the extent that if the
previous approval and authorization of the rights which any public utility is exercising pursuant
Commission. to the lawful orders of the PSC (now DOTC) has
been invaded by another public utility, in
NOTE: The Public Service Commission does not appropriate cases, actions may be maintained by
exist anymore. It is now the Department of the complainant public utility.
Transportation and Communications. Which public utilities are exempted from getting a
CPC?
THE CERTIFICATE OF PUBLIC CONVENIENCE (CPC);
The Public Service Law, Sec. 14
THE CERTIFICATE OF PUBLIC CONVENIENCE &
The following are exempted from the provisions of
NECESSITY (CPCN) AND THE PRIOR OPERATOR RULE
the preceding section:
(a) Warehouses;
Does the sale of a CPC, CPCN or other properties of
(b) Vehicles drawn by animals and bancas moved
the public utility have to be approved before it is
by oar or sail, and tugboats and lighters;
sold to a third person?
(c) Airships within the Philippines except as
No. The approval of the sale of CPCs, CPCNs or
regards the fixing of their maximum rates on
other properties does not affect the validity
freight and passengers;
(perfection) of the sale between the parties as long
(d) Radio companies except with respect to the
as all the elements of a contract are met. This only
fixing of rates;
affectes the relation of the parties to the DOTC or
(e) Public services owned or operated by any
to 3rd parties. If there is no approval, then the sale
instrumentality of the National Government or by
does not bind the DOTC or 3rd parties. The
any government-owned or controlled corporation,
controlling factor therefore is the registration.
except with respect to the fixing of rates. (As
amended by Com. Act 454, RA No. 2031, and RA
If a stockholder of a public utility transfers his
No. 2677)
stock to the 3rd person, is there a need to obtain
What is a Certificate of Public Convenience &
the approval of the DOTC?
Necessity? (CPCN)
It is a certificate issued by the PSC to a public
It depends. If the transfer results in the transferee
service to which any political subdivision has
owning more than 40% of the stock of the public
granted a franchise under RA 667 after the
utility, then the approval of the DOTC is needed.
PSC has approved the same under Sec. 16(b).

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 214 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

It is an authorization issued by the PSC for the or her investment is protected by not allowing a
operation of public services for which a franchise subsequent operator to be granted a license for the
is required by law. (e.g. electric, telephone) same route. The rationale for this rule is for the
What is the difference between a CPC & a CPCN? preservation of public convenience and to prevent
A CPCN requires a franchise from Congress. ruinous competition.
The public utility cannot be issued a CPCN and What are some of the instances where the prior
cannot operate, therefore, without a franchise from operator rule does NOT apply?
Congress The prior operator rule does not apply when
A CPC does not. the CPC or CPCN granted to the applicant is a
What is a franchise? maiden franchise that covers a new route, even if it
It is a legislative grant from Congress or a overlaps with the route of the prior operator.
local legislative body. If it is of nationwide The prior operator rule is inapplicable where
application (e.g. Philippine Air Lines), then it must the corporate existence of the prior operator has
take the form of a Republic Act. expired.
How does one get a franchise? Regular operators are preferred over irregular
It is the same procedure for any law (file a bill, operators.
3 readings in Congress, etc) The applicant must The Commission cannot grant a CPC or CPCN
a)prove that he or she is a Filipino citizen; b) that comprises a larger territory than that applied
demonstrate financial capacity, and c) must show for.
that he or she is applying for a business of public How do you know whether there is ruinous
convenience, that the public shall benefit from the competition enough for the prior operator rule to
grant of the franchise. take effect?
Is a franchise enough in order to operate? Ruinous competition means that there is
No. All public utilities require either a CPC or actual ruin of the business of the operator; that the
CPCN to operate. Those public utilities for which existing operator will not gain enough profits if
franchises have been granted still require a CPCN another person is allowed to enter the business;
in order to operate. Those public utilities that did that which will result in the deprivation of sufficient
not require a franchise for there creation still gain in respect of reasonable return of investment,
require a CPC in order to operate. therefore the oppositor, alleging this, must show
Raymundo v. Luneta Motor Corporation that he will be deprived of a reasonable return on
(1933) his investment.
The Public Service Law, Act No. 3108, as The mere possibility of reduction in the
amended, authorizes certificates of public earnings of the business or the deterioration in the
convenience to be secured by public service income of his business is not sufficient to prove
operators from the PSC. A CPC granted to the ruinous competition. It must be shown that the
owner or operator of public service motor vehicles business would not have sufficient gains to pay a
grants a right in the nature of a limited franchise. fair rate of interest on his capital investments.
The Code of Civil Procedure establishes the Does the prior operator rule create a monopoly?
general rule that "property, both real and personal, Legally speaking, there cannot be a monopoly
or any interest therein of the judgment debtor, not when a property is operated as a public utility. The
exempt by law, and all property and rights of prior operator rule does not encourage a monopoly
property seized and held under attachment in the because the theory is that one operator keeps the
action, shall be liable to execution." The statutory prices low.
exemptions do not include franchises or Batangas Transportation Co. v. Cayetano
certificates; of public convenience. The word Orlanes (1928)
"property" as used in section 450 of the Code of
Civil Procedure comprehends every species of title, So long as the 1 st licensee keeps and performs
inchoate or complete, legal or equitable. The TEST the terms and conditions of its license and complies
to determine whether or not property can be with the reasonable rules and regulations of the
attached and sold upon execution is whether the Commission and meets the demands of the public,
judgment debtor has such a beneficial interest it should have more or less of a bested and
therein that he can sell or otherwise dispose of it preferential right over a person who seeks to
for value. acquire another and a later license over same
Now the Public Service Law permits the PSC to route. Otherwise, the first licensee would not have
approve the sale, alienation, mortgaging, protection on his investment and would be subject
encumbering, or leasing of property, franchises, to ruinous competition and this defeat the very
privileges, or rights or any part thereof (sec. 16 purpose and intent for the PSC was created.
[h]), and in practice the purchase and sale of San Pablo v. Pantranco (1987)
certificates of public convenience has been Before private respondent may be issued a
permitted by the PSC. If the holder of a CPC can franchise or CPC for the operation of the said
sell it voluntarily, there is no valid reason why the service as a common carrier, it must comply with
same certificate cannot be taken and sold the usual requirements of filing an application,
involuntarily pursuant to court process. payment of the fees, publication, adducing
CPCs secured by public service operators are liable evidence at a hearing and affording the oppositors
to execution, and the Public Service Commission is the opportunity to be heard, among others, as
authorized to approve the transfer of the provided by law. Considering the environmental
certificates of public convenience to the execution circumstances of the case, the conveyance of
creditor. passengers, trucks and cargo from Matnog to Allen
is certainly not a ferry boat service but a coastwise
or interisland shipping service. Under no
What is the prior operator rule? circumstance can the sea between Matnog and
The prior operator rule works to protect the Allen be considered a continuation of the highway,
prior operator if it maintains an adequate service Matnog and Allen are separated by an open sea. Its
and is able to meet the demands of the public. His CPC as a bus transportation cannot be merely

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 215 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

amended to include this water service under the news to be transported, or to present his own
guise that it is a mere private ferry service. person or those of other or others in the case of
transportation of passengers
What is an example of the kabit system?21 Carrier or conductor - one who binds himself to
A, a grantee of a CPC from the LTFRB, is given transport person, things, or news, as the case may
the authority to operate 10 units of taxis. B, a non- be, or one employed in or engaged in the business
grantee, wishes to operate as a common carried of carrying good for others for hire
and kabits with the CPC of A who will obtain Consignee - the party to whom the carrier is to
approval from the LTFRB to operate another taxi. deliver the things being transported; to whom the
The taxi will be registered in the name of A, who carrier may lawfulyy make delivery in accordance
will be paid by B. with its contract of carriage. The shipper and the
Assume that A executed a deed of sale in consignee may be the same person.
favor of B in case B decides not to go on with the
arrangement, in order to safeguard the rights of B.
However, in case of injury to a passenger of the
taxi actually operated by B (and previously sold to
B as well) it is still A who will be liable. The illegal
contract of sale between A & B cannot be put up as
a defense.
A does not have a cause of action against B
either. They are in pari delicto.

Teja Marketing v. IAC (1987)


Parties operated under an arrangement, commonly
known as the "kabit system" whereby a person who
has been granted a certificate of public
convenience allows another person who owns
motor vehicles to operate under such franchise for
a fee. A certificate of public convenience is a
special privilege conferred by the government.
Although not outrightly penalized as a criminal
offense, the kabit system is invariably recognized
as being contrary to public policy and, therefore,
void and in existent under Article 1409 of the Civil
Code.

PRIVATE NATURE; RIGHTS AND OBLIGATIONS


OF PARTIES ARISING FROM TRANSACTIONS
RELATING TO TRANSPORTATION

ABSENT A TRANSPORTATION CONTRACT

Lara v. Valencia (1958)


The owner and driver of a vehicle owes to
accommodation passengers or invited guests
merely the duty to exercise reasonable care so that
they may be transported safely to their destination.
Thus, The rule is established by the weight of
authority that the owner or operator of an
automobile owes the duty to an invited guest to
exercise reasonable care in its operation, and not
unreasonably to expose him to danger and injury
by increasing the hazard of travel. Valencia
therefore is only required to observe ordinary care,
and is not in duty bound to exercise extraordinary
diligence as required of a common carrier by our
law (Art. 1755 & 1756, new CC)

ARISING FROM A TRANSPORTATION CONTRACT

Contract of transportation, defined;


A contract of transportation is one whereby
a certain person or association of persons obligate
themselves to transport persons, things, or news
from one to another for a fixed price.

Contract of transportation, elements;


Parties to the contract:
Shipper - one who gives rise to the contract of
transportation by agreeing to deliver the things or

21
This was asked in 2005. Know the definition of the
Kabit System and the liability of the party.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 216 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Bills of lading or tickets in the case of


III. Code of Commerce Provisions on transportation of passengers may be different, one
for persons and another for baggage, but all of
Overland Transportation them shall contain the name of the carrier, the date
of shipment, the points of departure and arrival,
(unless otherwise indicated, reference is to Code of the price, and with regard to baggage, the number
Commerce) and weight of the packages, with any other
indications which may be considered necessary in
What does the Code of Commerce cover? order to easily identify them.
It governs over overland transporation and What is a bill of lading?
maritime admiralty. It governs only commercial It may be defined as a written acknowledgment of
contracts. the receipt of goods and an agreement to transport
and to deliver them at a specified place to a person
Commercial contracts involving common carriers named or on his order. It comprehends all methods
refer first to the Civil Code, then to the Code of of transportation.
Commerce Each bill of lading is a contract in itself and the
parties are bound by its terms. A bill of lading is
Private carriers involved in commercial contracts also a receipt, and it is likewise a symbol of the
refer first to the Code of Commerce, then to the goods covered by it. It is also a document of title.
Civil Code, but excluding the Civil Code provisions Who are the parties to a bill of lading?
on common carriers 1. shipper
2. consignee
3. carrier
A. Scope of Overland Transportation FORM, CONTENTS

ARTICLE 350
What is overland transport?
The shipper as well as the carrier of merchandise
Overland transport applies to transport on land and
and goods may mutually demand of each other the
on small bodies of water, waterways, both natural
issue of a bill of lading in which there shall be
and artificial, including transport on rivers which
stated:
are not very large. (If it is transport at sea, then it
1. The name, surname, and domicile of the
is admiralty)
shipper.
2. The name, surname, and domicile of the
carrier.
B. Nature of Contract
3. The name, surname and domicile of the
ARTICLE 349 person to whom or to whose order the goods are
A contract for all kinds of transportation over land addressed, or whether they are to be delivered to
or river shall be considered commercial: the bearer of the said bill.
1. When it involves merchandise or any 4. A description of the goods, stating their
commercial goods. generic character, their weight, and the external
2. When, no matter what its object may be, marks or signs of the packages containing the
the carrier is a merchant or is customarily engaged same.
in making transportation for the public. 5. The cost of the transportation.
6. The date on which the shipment is made.
7. The place of the delivery to the carrier.
C. Effect of Civil Code 8. The place and time at which the delivery is
to be made to the consignee.
Art 1766 9. The damages to be paid by the carrier in
In all matters not regulated by this Code, the rights case of delay, if any agreement is made on this
and obligations of common carriers shall be point.
governed by the Code of Commerce and by special
laws. ARTICLE 351
In shipments made over railroads or by other
Art. 2270 enterprises which are subject to schedules or the
The following laws and regulations are hereby time fixed by regulations, it shall be sufficient that
repealed: the bills of lading or declarations of shipment
(1) Those parts and provisions of the Civil Code of furnished by the shipper refer, with regard to the
1889 which are in force on the date when this new rate, terms, and special conditions of the
Civil Code becomes effective: transportation, to the schedules and regulations,
(2) The provisions of the Code of Commerce the application of which is requested; and should
governing sales, partnership, agency, loan, deposit no schedule be determined the carrier must apply
and guaranty; the rate of the merchandise paying the lowest, with
(3) The provisions of the Code of Civil Procedure on the condition inherent thereto, always including
prescription as far as inconsistent with this Code; such statement or reference in the bill of lading
and delivered to the shipper.
(4) All laws, Acts, parts of Acts, rules of court, Is the form material?
executive orders, and administrative regulations No. As long as it contains an acknowledgment by
which are inconsistent with this Code. (n) the carrier of the receipt of goods for transporation,
it is in legal effect, a bill of lading.
D. Contract of Carriage FUNCTION
ARTICLE 353
1. BILL OF LADING
The legal basis of the contract between the shipper
DEFINITION, SUBJECT MATTER
and the carrier shall be the bills of lading, by the
ARTICLE 352
contents of which all disputes which may arise with

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 217 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

regard to their execution and fulfillment shall be statement or reference to them in the bill of lading
decided without admission of other exceptions than which he delivers to the shipper.
forgery or material errors in the drafting thereof.
After the contract has been complied with the bill of Is a bill of lading essential to a contract of
lading issued by the carrier shall be returned to transportation?
him, and by virtue of the exchange of this No. While under Art. 350 the shipper and the
certificate for the article transported, the respective common carrier may mutually demand that a bill of
obligations and actions shall be considered as lading be made, it is not obligatory. The fact that a
canceled, unless in the same act the claims which bill of lading is not issued does not preclude the
the contracting parties desired to reserve are existence of a contract of transportation.
reduced to writing, exception being made of the Where no bill of lading is issued, the disputes
provisions of Article 366. between the parties shall be decided according to
If in case of loss or for any other reason the rules laid down in Art. 354.
whatsoever, the consignee can not return upon
receiving the merchandise the bill of lading E. Responsibility of the carrier
subscribed by the carrier, he shall give said carrier 1. WHEN IT COMMENCES
a receipt for the goods delivered, this receipt ARTICLE 355
producing the same effects as the return of the bill The liability of the carrier shall begin from the
of lading. moment he receives the merchandise, in person or
through a person intrusted thereto in the place
indicated for their reception.
2. REFUSAL TO TRANSPORT
ARTICLE 356 2. ROUTE
Carrier may refuse to accept packages which ARTICLE 359
appear unfit for transportation; and if said If there should be an agreement between the
transportation is to be made by railway and the shipper and the carrier with regard to the road over
shipment is insisted on, the company shall carry which the transportation is to be made, the carrier
them, being exempt from all liability if its can not change the route, unless obliged to do so
objections are so stated in the bill of lading. by force majeure; and should he do so without
being forced to, he shall be liable for any damage
3. DOUBTFUL DECLARATION OF which may be suffered by the goods transported
CONTENTS for any other cause whatsoever, besides being
ARTICLE 357 required to pay the amount which may have been
If the carrier by reason of well-founded suspicions stipulated for such a case.
as to the correctness of the declaration of the When on account of the said force majeure the
contents of a package should determine to examine carrier is obliged to take another route, causing an
it, he shall do so before witnesses, in the presence increase in the transportation charges, he shall be
of the shipper or of the consignee. reimbursed for said increase after presenting the
Should the shipper or consignee to be cited not formal proof thereof.
appear, the examination shall be made before a
notary, who shall draft a certificate of the result of 3. CARE OF GOODS
the examination, for the proper purposes. ARTICLE 361
If the declaration of the shipper should be correct, Merchandise shall be transported at the risk and
the expenses caused by the examination and those venture of the shipper, if the contrary was not
of carefully repacking the packages shall be expressly stipulated.
defrayed by the carrier, and in a contrary case by Therefore, all damages and impairment suffered by
the shipper. the goods during the transportation, by reason of
accident, force majeure, or by virtue of the nature
or defect of the articles, shall be for the account
and risk of the shipper. cdta
The proof of these accidents is incumbent on the
carrier.
4. NO BILL OF LADING
ARTICLE 354 ARTICLE 362
In the absence of a bill of lading the respective The carrier, however, shall be liable for the losses
claims of the parties shall be decided by the legal and damages arising from the causes mentioned in
proofs that each one may submit in support of his the foregoing article if it is proved that they
claims, in accordance with the general provisions occurred on account of his negligence or because
established in this Code for commercial contracts. he did not take the precautions usually adopted by
careful persons, unless the shipper committed
ARTICLE 351 fraud in the bill of lading, making him believe that
In transporation made by railroads or other the goods were of a class or quality different from
enterprises which are subject to schedules or the what they really were.
time fixed by regulations, it shall be sufficient that If, notwithstanding the precaution referred to in
the bills of lading or the declarations of shipment this article, the goods transported run the risk of
furnished by the shipper refer, with respect to the being lost on account of the nature or by reason of
rate, terms, and special conditions of the an unavoidable accident, without there being time
transportation, to the schedules and regulations, for the owners of the same to dispose thereof, the
the application of which he requests, and should no carrier shall proceed to their sale, placing them for
schedule by determined, the carrier must apply the this purpose at the disposal, of the judicial
rate of the merchandise paying the lowest, with the authority or the officials determined by special
conditions inherent therein, always including such provisions.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 218 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Art 1734 Within the twenty-four hours following the receipt


Common carriers are responsible for the loss, of the merchandise a claim may be brought against
destruction, or deterioration of the goods, unless the carrier on account of damage or average found
the same is due to any of the following causes therein on opening the packages, provided that the
only: indications of the damage or average giving rise to
(1) Flood, storm, earthquake, lightning, or other the claim can not be ascertained from the exterior
natural disaster or calamity; of said packages, in which case said claim would
(2) Act of the public enemy in war, whether only be admitted on the receipt of the packages.
international or civil; After the periods mentioned have elapsed, or after
(3) Act of omission of the shipper or owner of the the transportation charges have been paid, no
goods; claim whatsoever shall be admitted against the
(4) The character of the goods or defects in the carrier with regard to the condition in which the
packing or in the containers; goods transported were delivered.
(5) Order or act of competent public authority.
ARTICLE 367
Art. 1735. In all cases other than those mentioned If there should occur doubts and disputes between
in Nos. 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5 of the preceding article, if the consignee and the carrier with regard to the
the goods are lost, destroyed or deteriorated, condition of goods transported at the time of their
common carriers are presumed to have been at delivery to the former, the said goods shall be
fault or to have acted negligently, unless they examined by experts appointed by the parties, and
prove that they observed extraordinary diligence as a third one, in case of disagreement, appointed by
required in Article 1733. the judicial authority, the result of the examination
being reduced to writing; and if the persons
interested should not agree to the report of the
4. DELIVERY experts and could not settle their disputes, said
CONDITION OF GOODS judicial authority shall order the deposits of the
ARTICLE 363 merchandise in a safe warehouse, and the parties
With the exception of the cases prescribed in the interested shall make use of their rights in the
second paragraph of Article 361, the carrier shall proper manner.
be obliged to deliver the goods transported in the TO WHOM DELIVERY MADE
same condition in which, according to the bill of ARTICLE 368
lading, they were at the time of their receipt, The carrier must deliver to the consignee without
without any detriment or impairment, and should any delay or difficulty the merchandise received by
he not do so, he shall be obliged to pay the value him, by reason of the mere fact of being
of the goods not delivered at the point where they designated in the bill of lading to receive it; and
should have been and at the time the delivery should said carrier not do so he shall be liable for
should have taken place. the damages which may arise therefrom.
If part of the goods transported should be delivered JUDICIAL DEPOSIT
the consignee may refuse to receive them, when he ARTICLE 369
proves that he can not make use thereof without Should the consignee be not found at the domicile
the others. indicated in the bill of lading, or should refuse to
pay the transportation charges and expenses, or to
ARTICLE 364 receive the goods, the deposit of said goods shall
If the effect of the damage referred to in Article be ordered by the municipal judge, where there is
361 should be only a reduction in the value of the no judge of first instance, to be placed at the
goods, the obligation of the carrier shall be reduced disposal of the shipper or sender, without prejudice
to the payment of the amount of said reduction in to a person having a better right, this deposit
value, after appraisal by experts. having all the effects of a delivery.
Art. 1752
Even when there is an agreement limiting the
liability of the common carrier in the vigilance over
ARTICLE 365 the goods, the common carrier is disputably
If, on account of the damage, the goods are presumed to have been negligent in case of their
rendered useless for purposes of sale or loss, destruction or deterioration.
consumption in the use for which they are properly WHEN TO BE MADE
destined the consignee shall not be bound to ARTICLE 370
receive them, and may leave them on the hands of If a period has been fixed for the delivery of the
the carrier, demanding payment therefor at current goods, it must be made within the same, and
market prices. otherwise the carrier shall pay the indemnity
If among the goods damaged there should be some agreed upon in the bill of lading, neither the
in good condition and without any defect shipper nor consignee being entitled to anything
whatsoever, the foregoing provision shall be else.
applicable with regard to the damaged ones, and Should no indemnity have been agreed upon and
the consignee shall receive those which are sound, the delay exceeds the time fixed in the bill of
this separation being made by distinct and separate lading, the carrier shall be liable for the damages
articles, no object being divided for the purpose, which may have been caused by the delay.
unless the consignee proves the impossibility of
conveniently making use thereof in this form. ARTICLE 358
The same provision shall be applied to merchandise Should no period within which goods are to be
in bales or packages, with distinction of the delivered be previously fixed, the carrier shall be
packages which appear sound. under the obligation to forward them in the first
shipment of the same or similar merchandise which
ARTICLE 366 he may make to the point of delivery; and should

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 219 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

he not do so, the damages occasioned by the delay contents of a package should determine to examine
shall be suffered by him. it, he shall do so before witnesses, in the presence
TWO OR MORE CARRIERS of the shipper or of the consignee.
ARTICLE 373 Should the shipper or consignee to be cited not
A carrier who delivers merchandise to a consignee appear, the examination shall be made before a
by virtue of agreements or combined services with notary, who shall draft a certificate of the result of
other carriers shall assume the obligations of the the examination, for the proper purposes.
carriers who preceded him, reserving his right to If the declaration of the shipper should be correct,
proceed against the latter if he should not be the expenses caused by the examination and those
directly responsible for the fault which gives rise to of carefully repacking the packages shall be
the claim of the shipper or of the consignee. defrayed by the carrier, and in a contrary case by
The carrier making the delivery shall also assume the shipper.
all the actions and rights of those who may have
preceded him in the transportation. ARTICLE 353
The sender and the consignee shall have an The legal basis of the contract between the shipper
immediate right of action against the carrier who and the carrier shall be the bills of lading, by the
executed the transportation contract, or against the contents of which all disputes which may arise with
other carriers who received the goods transported regard to their execution and fulfillment shall be
without reserve. decided without admission of other exceptions than
The reservations made by the latter shall not forgery or material errors in the drafting thereof.
exempt them, however, from the liabilities they After the contract has been complied with the bill of
may have incurred by reason of their own acts. lading issued by the carrier shall be returned to
OBLIGATION TO KEEP REGISTRY him, and by virtue of the exchange of this
ARTICLE 378 certificate for the article transported, the respective
Transportation agents shall be obliged to keep a obligations and actions shall be considered as
special registry, with the formalities required by canceled, unless in the same act the claims which
Article 36, in which there shall be entered, in the contracting parties desired to reserve are
progressive order of numbers and dates, all the reduced to writing, exception being made of the
goods the transportation of which is undertaken, provisions of Article 366.
stating the circumstances required by Articles 350 If in case of loss or for any other reason
et seq. for the responsive bills of lading. whatsoever, the consignee can not return upon
receiving the merchandise the bill of lading
subscribed by the carrier, he shall give said carrier
COMPLIANCE WITH ADMINISTRATIVE REGULATIONS a receipt for the goods delivered, this receipt
ARTICLE 377 producing the same effects as the return of the bill
The carrier shall be liable for all the consequences of lading.
arising from noncompliance on his part with the AMOUNT OF DAMAGES FOR LOSS
formalities prescribed by the laws and regulations ARTICLE 372
of the public administration during the entire The appraisement of the goods which the carrier
course of the trip and on the arrival at the point of must pay in case of their being lost or mislaid shall
destination, except when his omission arises from be fixed in accordance with what is stated in the bill
his having been induced into error by false of lading, no proofs being allowed on the part of
statements of the shipper in the declaration of the the shipper that there were among the goods
merchandise. declared therein articles of greater value, and
If the carrier has acted in accordance with a formal money.
order received from the shipper or consignee of the Horses, vehicles, vessels, equipment, and all the
merchandise both shall incur liability. other principal and accessory means of
transportation, shall be especially obligated in favor
of the shipper, although with relation to railroads
said obligation shall be subordinated to the
F. Rights and Obligations of Shipper and/or provisions of the laws of concession with regard to
Consignee property and to those of this Code with regard to
the manner and form of making attachments and
retentions against the said companies.
1. RIGHTS TO DAMAGES
Art. 1744
CONDITION IMPOSED ON RIGHT
A stipulation between the common carrier and the
ARTICLE 366
shipper or owner limiting the liability of the former
Within the twenty-four hours following the receipt
for the loss, destruction, or deterioration of the
of the merchandise a claim may be brought against
goods to a degree less than extraordinary diligence
the carrier on account of damage or average found
shall be valid, provided it be:
therein on opening the packages, provided that the
(1) In writing, signed by the shipper or owner;
indications of the damage or average giving rise to
(2) Supported by a valuable consideration other
the claim can not be ascertained from the exterior
than the service rendered by the common carrier;
of said packages, in which case said claim would
and
only be admitted on the receipt of the packages.
(3) Reasonable, just and not contrary to public
After the periods mentioned have elapsed, or after
policy.
the transportation charges have been paid, no
AMOUNT OF DAMAGES FOR DELAY
claim whatsoever shall be admitted against the
ARTICLE 371(3).
carrier with regard to the condition in which the
Should the abandonment not occur the indemnity
goods transported were delivered.
for loss and damages on account of the delays can
not exceed the current price of the goods
ARTICLE 357
transported on the day and at the place where the
If the carrier by reason of well-founded suspicions
delivery was to have been made. The same
as to the correctness of the declaration of the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 220 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

provision shall be observed in all cases where this 3. RIGHT TO CHANGE CONSIGNMENT
indemnity is due. ARTICLE 360
The shipper may, without changing the place where
the delivery is to be made, change the
2. RIGHT TO ABANDON consignment of the goods delivered to the carrier,
ARTICLE 371 and the latter shall comply with his orders,
In cases of delay on account of the fault of the provided that at the time of making the change of
carrier, referred to in the foregoing articles, the the consignee the bill of lading subscribed by the
consignee may leave the goods transported on the carrier be returned to him, if one were issued,
hands of the carrier, informing him thereof in exchanging it for another containing the novation
writing before the arrival of the same at the point of the contract.
of destination. The expenses arising from the change of
When this abandonment occurs, the carrier shall consignment shall be defrayed by the shipper.
satisfy the total value of the goods, as if they had
been lost or mislaid. aisadc 4. OBLIGATION TO PAY
Should the abandonment not occur the indemnity TRANSPORTATION CHARGES
for loss and damages on account of the delays can
not exceed the current price of the goods ARTICLE 374
transported on the day and at the place where the The consignees to whom the remittance may have
delivery was to have been made. The same been made can not defer the payment of the
provision shall be observed in all cases where this expenses and transportation charges on the goods
indemnity is due. that they received after twenty-four hours have
elapsed from the time of the delivery; and in case
ARTICLE 360 of delay in making this payment, the carrier may
The shipper may, without changing the place where request the judicial sale of the goods he
the delivery is to be made, change the transported to a sufficient amount to cover the
consignment of the goods delivered to the carrier, transportation charges and the expenses incurred.
and the latter shall comply with his orders,
provided that at the time of making the change of ARTICLE 375
the consignee the bill of lading subscribed by the The goods transported shall be specifically
carrier be returned to him, if one were issued, obligated to answer for the transportation charges
exchanging it for another containing the novation and for the expenses and fees caused by the same
of the contract. during their transportations, or until the time of
The expenses arising from the change of their delivery.
consignment shall be defrayed by the shipper. This special right shall be limited to eight days
after the delivery has been made, and after said
ARTICLE 363 prescription the carrier shall have no further right
With the exception of the cases prescribed in the of action than that corresponding to an ordinary
second paragraph of Article 361, the carrier shall creditor.
be obliged to deliver the goods transported in the
same condition in which, according to the bill of
lading, they were at the time of their receipt, ARTICLE 376
without any detriment or impairment, and should The preference of the carrier to the payment of
he not do so, he shall be obliged to pay the value what is due him for the transportation and
of the goods not delivered at the point where they expenses of the goods delivered to the consignee
should have been and at the time the delivery shall not be affected by the bankruptcy of the
should have taken place. latter, provided the action is brought within the
If part of the goods transported should be delivered eight days mentioned in the foregoing article.
the consignee may refuse to receive them, when he Art. 2241
proves that he can not make use thereof without With reference to specific movable property of the
the others. debtor, the following claims or liens shall be
preferred:
ARTICLE 365 (9) Credits for transportation, upon the goods
If, on account of the damage, the goods are carried, for the price of the contract and incidental
rendered useless for purposes of sale or expenses, until their delivery and for thirty days
consumption in the use for which they are properly thereafter;
destined the consignee shall not be bound to
receive them, and may leave them on the hands of 5. OBLIGATION TO RETURN BILL OF
the carrier, demanding payment therefor at current LADING
market prices. ARTICLE 353. (2) (3)
If among the goods damaged there should be some After the contract has been complied with the bill of
in good condition and without any defect lading issued by the carrier shall be returned to
whatsoever, the foregoing provision shall be him, and by virtue of the exchange of this
applicable with regard to the damaged ones, and certificate for the article transported, the respective
the consignee shall receive those which are sound, obligations and actions shall be considered as
this separation being made by distinct and separate canceled, unless in the same act the claims which
articles, no object being divided for the purpose, the contracting parties desired to reserve are
unless the consignee proves the impossibility of reduced to writing, exception being made of the
conveniently making use thereof in this form. provisions of Article 366.
The same provision shall be applied to merchandise If in case of loss or for any other reason
in bales or packages, with distinction of the whatsoever, the consignee can not return upon
packages which appear sound. receiving the merchandise the bill of lading
subscribed by the carrier, he shall give said carrier
a receipt for the goods delivered, this receipt

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 221 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

producing the same effects as the return of the bill irrespective of whether the causes of action arose
of lading. out of the same or different transactions;

G. Applicability of Provisions
ARTICLE 379
The provisions contained in Articles 349 et seq. C. Vessels
shall also be understood as relating to persons 1. MEANING
who, although they do not personally effect the Vessels are those engaged in navigation,
transportation of commercial goods, contract to do whether coastwide or on the high seas, including
so through others, either as contractors for a floating docks, pontoons, dredges, scows, and any
special and fixed transaction or as freight and other floating apparatus destined for the services of
transportation agents. the industry or maritime commerce.
In either case they shall be subrogated to the place Vessels engaged in the business of carrying
of the carriers with regard to the obligations and or transporting passengers or goods for
liability of the latter, as well as with regard to their compensation, offering their services to the public,
right. are common carriers, and are governed primarily
by the Civil Code and suppletorily by the Code of
Commerce and special laws.

2. NATURE AND ACQUISITION OF


IV. Admiralty and Maritime Lopez v. Duruelo
Commerce The word vessel used in the section was not
intended to include all ships, craft or floating
structures of every kind without limitation, and the
A. Sources of Maritime/Admiralty Laws in the
provision of that section should not be held to
Philippines
include minor craft engaged only in river or bay
Main source of law: Code of Commerce traffic. Vessels of a minor nature, such as river
If common carrier, apply Civil Code first, boats and those carrying passengers from ship to
then Code of Commerce and special laws. shore, are governed as to their liability in
Maritime law includes coastwise, oceanwise passengers by the Civil Code.
and commercial laws.
ARTICLE 573
B. Concept of Admiralty; jurisdiction over Merchant vessels constitute property which may be
admiralty cases acquired and transferred by any of the means
recognized by law. The acquisition of a vessel must
Admiralty is distinguished from overland be included in a written instrument, which shall not
transportation on the size of the vessel and size produce any effect with regard to third persons if
of the body of water over which a vessel not recorded in the mercantile registry.
traverses. However, it is now the amount of the The ownership of a vessel shall also be acquired by
claim that is relevant, and not whether it is the possession thereof in good faith for three
an admiralty or maritime claim. years, with a good title duly recorded.
In the absence of any of these requisites,
BP 129 Sec 19 uninterrupted possession for ten years shall be
Jurisdiction in civil cases. Regional Trial Courts necessary in order to acquire ownership.
shall exercise exclusive original jurisdiction: A captain can not acquire by prescription the ship
(3) In all actions in admiralty and maritime of which he is in command.
jurisdiction where he demand or claim exceeds One
hundred thousand pesos (P100,000.00) or , in ARTICLE 574
Metro Manila, where such demand or claim exceeds The builders of vessels may employ the material
Two hundred thousand pesos (200,000.00); and with regard to their construction and rigging
Section 33. Jurisdiction of Metropolitan Trial may follow the system which is most convenient to
Courts, Municipal Trial Courts and Municipal Circuit their interests. Ship agents and seamen shall be
Trial Courts in civil cases. Metropolitan Trial subject to the provisions of the laws and
Courts, Municipal Trial Courts, and Municipal Circuit regulations of the public administration on
Trial Courts shall exercise: navigation, customs, health, safety of the vessels,
(1) Exclusive original jurisdiction over civil actions and other similar provisions.
and probate proceedings, testate and intestate,
including the grant of provisional remedies in ARTICLE 585
proper cases, where the value of the personal For all purposes of law not modified or restricted by
property, estate, or amount of the demand does the provisions of this Code, vessels shall continue
not exceed One hundred thousand pesos to be considered as personal property.
(P100,000.00) or, in Metro Manila where such
personal property, estate, or amount of the Art. 712
demand does not exceed Two hundred thousand Ownership is acquired by occupation and by
pesos (P200,000.00) exclusive of interest damages intellectual creation.
of whatever kind, attorney's fees, litigation Ownership and other real rights over property are
expenses, and costs, the amount of which must be acquired and transmitted by law, by donation, by
specifically alleged: Provided, That where there are estate and intestate succession, and in
several claims or causes of action between the consequence of certain contracts, by tradition.
same or different parties, embodied in the same They may also be acquired by means of
complaint, the amount of the demand shall be the prescription.
totality of the claims in all the causes of action,

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 222 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

D. Persons Participating in Maritime ARTICLE 591


Commerce All the part owners shall be liable, in proportion to
their respective ownership, for the expenses of
1. SHIPOWNERS AND SHIPAGENTS22 repairs to the vessel, and for other expenses which
are incurred by virtue of a resolution of the
Owners of Vessels and Ship Agents majority.
They shall likewise be liable in the same proportion
ARTICLE 586 for the expenses of maintenance, equipment, and
The owner of a vessel and the agent shall be civilly provisioning of the vessel, necessary for
liable for the acts of the captain and for the navigation.
obligations contracted by the latter to repair, equip,
and provision the vessel, provided the creditor ARTICLE 592
proves that the amount claimed was invested The resolutions of the majority with regard to the
therein. repair, equipment, and provisioning of the vessel in
By agent is understood the person intrusted with the port of departure shall bind the majority unless
the provisioning of a vessel, or who represents her the partners in the minority renounce their
in the port in which she happens to be. participation therein, which must be acquired by
the other part owners after a judicial appraisement
of the value of the portion or portions assigned.
ARTICLE 587 The resolutions of the majority relating to the
The agent shall also be civilly liable for the dissolution of the association and sale of the vessel
indemnities in favor of third persons which arise shall also be binding on the minority.
from the conduct of the captain in the care of the The sale of the vessel must take place at a public
goods which the vessel carried; but he may exempt auction, subject to the provisions of the law of civil
himself therefrom by abandoning the vessel with all procedure unless the part owners unanimously
her equipments and the freight he may have agree otherwise, the right of option to purchase
earned during the voyage. and to withdraw mentioned in Article 575 being
always reserved in favor of said part owners.
ARTICLE 588
Neither the owner of the vessel nor the agent shall ARTICLE 593
be liable for the obligations contracted by the The owners of a vessel shall have preference in her
captain if the latter exceeds his powers and charter to other persons, offering equal conditions
privileges which are his by reason of his position or and price. If two or more of the former should
have been conferred upon him by the former. claim said right the one having greater interest
However, if the amounts claimed were made use of shall be preferred, and should they have an equal
for the benefit of the vessel, the owner or agent interest it shall be decided by lot.
shall be liable.
ARTICLE 594
ARTICLE 589 The part owners shall elect the manager who is to
If two or more persons should be part owners of a represent them in the capacity of agent.
merchant vessel, an association shall be presumed The appointment of director or agent shall be
as established by the part owners. revocable at the will of the members.
This association shall be governed by the
resolutions of a majority of the members. ARTICLE 595
A majority shall be the relative majority of the The agent, be he at the same time an owner of a
voting members. vessel or a manager for an owner or for an
If there should be only two part owners, in case of association of co-owners, must be qualified to trade
disagreement the vote of the member having the and must be recorded in the merchant's registry of
largest interest shall be decisive. If the interests the province.
are equal, it shall be decided by lot. The agent shall represent the ownership of the
The representation of the smallest part in the vessel, and may in his own name and in such
ownership shall have one vote; and proportionately capacity take judicial and extrajudicial steps in all
the other part owners as many votes as they have that relates to commerce.
parts equal to the smallest one. aisadc
A vessel can not be detained, attached or levied
upon execution in her entirety for the private debts
of a part owner, but the proceedings shall be
limited to the interest the debtor may have in the ARTICLE 596
vessel, without interfering with her navigation. The agent may discharge the duties of captain of
the vessel, subject, in every case, to the provisions
contained in Article 609.
If two or more co-owners request the position of
ARTICLE 590 captain, the disagreement shall be decided by a
The owners of a vessel shall be civilly liable in the vote of the members; and if the vote should result
proportion of their contribution to the common in a tie, the position shall be given to the part
fund, for the results of the acts of the captain, owner having the larger interest in the vessel.
referred to in Article 587. If the interest of the petitioners should be the
Each part owner may exempt himself from this same, and there should be a tie, the matter shall
liability by the abandonment before a notary of the be decided by lot.
part of the vessel belonging to him.
ARTICLE 597
The agent shall select and come to an agreement
22
The liabilities of shipowners and shipagents were with the captain, and shall contract in the name of
asked in 1989, 1984, and 1981. the owners, who shall be bound in all that refers to

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 223 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

repairs, details of equipment, armament, fulfillment of their contracts, except for reasons of
provisions, fuel, and freight of the vessel, and, in insubordination in serious matters, robbery, theft,
general, in all that relates to the requirements of habitual drunkenness, and damage caused to the
navigation. vessel or to its cargo by malice or manifest or
proven negligence.
ARTICLE 598
The agent can not order a new voyage, nor make ARTICLE 606
contracts for a new charter, nor insure the vessel, If the captain should be a part owner in the vessel,
without the authority of her owner or by virtue of a he can not be discharged without the agent
resolution of the majority of the co-owners, unless returning him the amount of his interest therein,
these privileges were granted him in the certificate which, in the absence of an agreement between the
of his appointment. parties, shall be appraised by experts appointed in
If he should insure the vessel without authority the manner established in the law of civil
therefor he shall be secondarily liable for the procedure.
solvency of the underwriter.
ARTICLE 607
ARTICLE 599 If the captain who is a part owner should have
The managing agent of an association, shall give obtained the command of the vessel by virtue of a
his co-owners an account of the results of each special agreement contained in the articles of co-
voyage of the vessel, without prejudice to always partnership, he can not be deprived thereof except
having the books and correspondence relating to for the reasons mentioned in Article 605.
the vessel and to its voyages at the disposal of the
same. ARTICLE 608
In case of the voluntary sale of the vessel, all
ARTICLE 600 contracts between the agent and captain shall
After the account of the managing agent has been terminate, the right to proper indemnity being
approved by a relative majority, the co-owners reserved in favor of the captain, according to the
shall satisfy the expenses in proportion to their agreements made with the agent.
interest, without prejudice to the civil or criminal They vessel sold shall remain subject to the
actions which the minority may deem fit to institute security of the payment of said indemnity if, after
afterwards. the action against the vendor has been instituted,
In order to enforce the payment, the managing the latter should be insolvent.
agent shall have a right of action to secure
execution, which shall be instituted by virtue of a ARTICLE 618
resolution of the majority, and without further The captain shall be civilly liable to the agent, and
proceedings than the acknowledgment of the the latter to the third persons who may have made
signatures of the persons who voted the resolution. contracts with the former
1. For all the damages suffered by the vessel
ARTICLE 601 and his cargo by reason of want of skill or
Should there be any profits, the co-owners may negligence on his part. If a misdemeanor or crime
demand of the managing agent the amount due has been committed he shall be liable in
them, by means of an executory action without accordance with the Penal Code. cda
further requisites than the acknowledgment of the 2. For all the thefts committed by the crew,
signatures of the instrument approving the reserving his right of action against the guilty
account. parties.
3. For the losses, fines, and confiscations
ARTICLE 602 imposed an account of violation of the laws and
The agent shall indemnify the captain for all the regulations of customs, police, health, and
expenses he may have incurred from his own funds navigation.
or from those of other persons, for the benefit of 4. For the losses and damages caused by
the vessel. mutinies on board the vessel, or by reason of faults
committed by the crew in the service and defense
ARTICLE 603 of the same, if he does not prove that he made full
Before a vessel goes out to sea the agent shall use of his authority to prevent or avoid them.
have at his discretion, a right to discharge the 5. For those arising by reason of an undue use
captain and members of the crew whose contract of powers and non-fulfillment of the obligations
did not state a definite period nor a definite which are his in accordance with Articles 610 and
voyage, paying them the salaries earned according 612.
to their contracts, and without any indemnity 6. For those arising by reason of his going out
whatsoever, unless there is a special and specific of his course or taking a course which he should
agreement in respect thereto. not have taken without sufficient cause, in the
opinion of the officers of the vessel, at a meeting
ARTICLE 604 with the shippers or supercargoes who may be on
If the captain or any other member of the crew board.
should be discharged during the voyage, they shall No exception whatsoever shall exempt him
receive their salary until the return to the place from this obligation.
where the contract was made, unless there are 7. For those arising by reason of his
good reasons for the discharge, all in accordance voluntarily entering a port other than his
with Articles 636 et seq. of this Code. destination, with the exception of the cases or
without the formalities referred to in Article 612.
ARTICLE 605 8. For those arising by reason of the non-
If the contracts of the captain and members of the observance of the provisions contained in the
crew with the agent should be for a definite period regulations for lights and evolutions for the purpose
or voyage, they can not be discharged until the of preventing collisions.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 224 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Standard Oil v. Castelo (1921) ARTICLE 837


In considering the question now before us it is The civil liability contracted by the shipowners in
important to remember that the owner of the ship the cases prescribed in this section, shall be
ordinarily has vastly more capital embarked upon a understood as limited to the value of the vessel
voyage than has any individual shipper of cargo. with all her appurtenances and all the freight
Moreover, the owner of the ship, in the person of earned during the voyage.
the captain, has complete and exclusive control of
the crew and of the navigation of the ship, as well Yangco v. Laserna et al (1941)
as of the disposition of the cargo at the end of the If the shipowner or agent may in any way be held
voyage. It is therefore proper that any person civilly liable at all for injury to or death of
whose property may have been cast overboard by passengers arising from the negligence of the
order of the captain should have a right of action captain in cases of collisions or shipwrecks, his
directly against the ship's owner for the breach of liability is merely co-extensive with his interest in
any duty which the law may have imposed on the the vessel such that a total loss thereof results in
captain with respect to such cargo. To adopt the its extinction. In arriving at this conclusion, the fact
interpretation of the law for which the appellant is not ignored that the ill-fated S. S. Negros, as a
contends would place the shipowner in a position to vessel engaged in interisland trade, is a common
escape all responsibility for a general average of carrier, and that the relationship between the
this character by means of the delinquency of his petitioner and the passengers who died in the
own captain. This cannot be permitted. The evident mishap rests on a contract of carriage. But
intention of the Code, taken in all of its provisions, assuming that petitioner is liable for a breach of
is to place the primary liability upon the person contract of carriage, the exclusively "real and
who has actual control over the conduct of the hypothecary nature" of maritime law operates to
voyage and who has most capital embarked in the limit such liability to the value of the vessel, or to
venture, namely, the owner of the ship, leaving the insurance thereon, if any. In the instant case it
him to obtain recourse, as it is very easy to do, does not appear that the vessel was insured.
from other individuals who have been drawn into Art. 587 of the Code of Commerce appears to deal
the venture as shippers. only with the limited liability of shipowners or
agents for damages arising from the misconduct of
RESPONSIBILITIES AND LIABILITIES the captain in the care of the goods which the
Yu Con v. Ipil (1916) vessel carries, but this is a mere deficiency of
As to the shipowner: Estasen, makes the language and in no way indicates the true extent of
following remarks: It is well and good that the such liability.
shipowner be not held criminally liable for such Whether the abandonment of the vessel sought by
crimes or quasi crimes; but the cannot be excused the petitioner in the instant case was in accordance
from liability for the damage and harm which, in with law or not is immaterial. The vessel having
consequence of those acts, may be suffered by the totally perished, any act of abandonment would be
third parties who contracted with the captain, in his an idle ceremony. Judgment is reversed and
double capacity of agent and subordinate of the petitioner is hereby absolved of all the complaints,
shipowner himself. In maritime commerce, the without costs.
shippers and passengers in making contracts with
the captain do so through the confidence they have ABUEG vs. SAN DIEGO(1946)
in the shipowner who appointed him; they presume The real and hypothecary nature of the liability of
that the owner made a most careful investigation the shipowner or agent embodied in the provisions
before appointing him, and, above all, they of the Maritime Law, Bk III, Code of Commerce,
themselves are unable to make such an had its origin in the prevailing continues of the
investigation, and even though they should do so, maritime trade and sea voyages during the
they could not obtain complete security, inasmuch medieval ages, attended by innumerable hazards
as the shipowner can, whenever he sees fir, and perils. To offset against these adverse
appoint another captain instead. conditions and encourage shipbuilding and
maritime commerce, it was deemed necessary to
DOCTRINE OF LIMITED LIABILITY AND EXCEPTIONS23 confine the liability of the owner or agent arising
ARTICLE 587 from the operation of a ship to the vessel,
The agent shall also be civilly liable for the equipment, and freight, or insurance, if any, so
indemnities in favor of third persons which arise that if the shipowner or agent abandoned the ship,
from the conduct of the captain in the care of the equipment, and freight, his liability was
goods which the vessel carried; but he may exempt extinguished.
himself therefrom by abandoning the vessel with all If an accident is compensable under the Workmen's
her equipments and the freight he may have Compensation Act, it must be compensated even
earned during the voyage. when the workman's right is not recognized by or is
in conflict with other provisions of the Civil Code or
ARTICLE 590 the Code of Commerce. The reason behind this
The owners of a vessel shall be civilly liable in the principle is that the Workmen's Compensation Act
proportion of their contribution to the common was enacted by the Legislature in abrogation of the
fund, for the results of the acts of the captain, other existing laws.
referred to in Article 587.
Each part owner may exempt himself from this SPECIFIC RIGHTS AND PREROGATIVES
liability by the abandonment before a notary of the ARTICLE 575
part of the vessel belonging to him. Part owners of vessels shall enjoy the right of
option of purchase and withdrawal in the sales
23
The definition and exceptions of the Doctrine of made to strangers; but they can only exercise it
Limited Liability were asked in 2000, 1999, 1997, within the nine days following the record of the sale
1994, 1989, 1985, and 1982. in the registry and by delivering the price at once.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 225 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

against discipline, holding a preliminary


ARTICLE 593 investigation on the crimes committed on board the
The owners of a vessel shall have preference in her vessel on the high seas, which shall be turned over
charter to other persons, offering equal conditions to the authorities, who are to take cognizance
and price. If two or more of the former should thereof, at the first port touched.
claim said right the one having greater interest 4. To make contracts for the charter of the
shall be preferred, and should they have an equal vessel in the absence of the agent or of her
interest it shall be decided by lot. consignee, acting in accordance with the
instructions received and protecting the interests of
ARTICLE 594 the owner most carefully.
The part owners shall elect the manager who is to 5. To adopt all the measures which may be
represent them in the capacity of agent. necessary to keep the vessel well supplied and
The appointment of director or agent shall be equipped, purchasing for the purpose all that may
revocable at the will of the members. be necessary, provided there is no time to request
instructions of the agent.
ARTICLE 596 6. To make, in similar urgent cases and on a
The agent may discharge the duties of captain of voyage, the repairs to the hull and engines of the
the vessel, subject, in every case, to the provisions vessel and to her rigging and equipment which are
contained in Article 609. absolutely necessary in order for her to be able to
If two or more co-owners request the position of continue and conclude her voyage; but if she
captain, the disagreement shall be decided by a should arrive at a point where there is a consignee
vote of the members; and if the vote should result of the vessel, he shall act in concurrence with the
in a tie, the position shall be given to the part latter.
owner having the larger interest in the vessel.
If the interest of the petitioners should be the ARTICLE 611
same, and there should be a tie, the matter shall In order to comply with the obligations mentioned
be decided by lot. in the foregoing article, the captain, when he has
no funds and does not expect to receive any from
ARTICLE 601. Should there be any profits, the co- the agent, shall procure the same in the successive
owners may demand of the managing agent the order stated below:
amount due them, by means of an executory action 1. By requesting said funds of the consignees
without further requisites than the acknowledgment or correspondents of a vessel.
of the signatures of the instrument approving the 2. By applying to the consignees of the cargo
account. or to the persons interested therein.
3. By drawing on the agent.
4. By borrowing the amount required by
means of a bottomry bond.
2. CAPTAINS AND MASTERS 5. By selling a sufficient amount of the cargo
QUALIFICATIONS AND LICENSING to cover the amount absolutely necessary to repair
the vessel, and to equip her to pursue the voyage.
ARTICLE 609 In the two latter cases he must apply to the judicial
Captains and masters of vessels must be Spaniards authority of the port, if in Spain * and to the
* having legal capacity to bind themselves in Spanish * consul, if in a foreign country; and where
accordance with this Code, and must prove that there should be none, to the local authority,
they have the skill, capacity, and qualifications proceeding in accordance with the prescriptions of
required to command and direct the vessel, as Article 583, and with the provisions of the law of
established by marine laws, ordinances, or civil procedure.
regulations, or by those of navigation, and that ARTICLE 622
they are not disqualified according to the same for If while on a voyage the captain should learn of the
the discharge of the duties of that position. cdt appearance of privateers or men of war against his
If the owner of a vessel desires to be the captain flag, he shall be obliged to make the nearest
thereof and does not have the legal qualifications neutral port, inform his agent or shippers, and
therefor, he shall limit himself to the financial await an occasion to sail under convoy, or until the
administration of the vessel, and shall intrust her danger is over or he has received express orders
navigation to a person possessing the qualifications from the ship agent or the shippers.
required by said ordinances and regulations. ARTICLE 624
A captain whose vessel has gone through a
POWERS AND DUTIES hurricane or who believes that the cargo has
ARTICLE 610 suffered damages or averages, shall make a
The following powers are inherent in the position of protest thereon before the competent authority at
captain or master of a vessel: the first port he touches, within 24 hours following
1. To appoint or make contracts with the crew his arrival and shall ratify it within the same period
in the absence of the agent and propose said crew, when he arrives at his destination, immediately
should said agent be present; but the agent shall proceeding with the proof of the facts, and he may
not be permitted to employ any member against not open the hatches until after this has been done.
the captain's express refusal. The captain shall proceed in the same manner, if,
2. To command the crew and direct the vessel the vessel having been wrecked; he is saved alone
to the port of its destination, in accordance with the or with part of his crew, in which case he shall
instructions he may have received from the agent. appear before the nearest authority, and make a
3. To impose, in accordance with the sworn statement of facts.
agreements and the laws and regulations of the The authority or the consul shall verify the said
merchants marine, on board the vessel, facts receiving sworn statements of the members
correctional punishment upon those who do not of the crew and passengers who may have been
comply with his orders or who conduct themselves saved; and taking such other steps as may assist in

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 226 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

arriving at the facts he shall make a statement of A captain who borrows money on bottomry, or who
the result of the proceedings in the log book and in pledges or sells merchandise or provisions in other
that of the sailing mate, and shall deliver to the cases and without the formalities prescribed in this
captain the original records of the proceedings, Code, shall be liable for the principle, interest, and
stamped and folioed, with a memorandum of the costs, and shall indemnify for the damages he may
folios, which he must rubricate, in order that it may cause.
be presented to the judge or court of the port of The captain who commits fraud in his accounts
destination. shall reimburse the amount defrauded, and shall be
The statement of the captain shall be accepted if it subject to the provisions contained in the Penal
is in accordance with those of the crew and Code.
passengers; if they disagree, the latter shall be
accepted, always saving proof to the contrary. ARTICLE 583
ARTICLE 625 If the ship being on a voyage the captain should
The captain, under his personal responsibility, as find it necessary to contract one or more of the
soon as he arrives at the port of destination, should obligations mentioned in Nos. 8 and 9 of Article
get the necessary permission from the health and 580, he shall apply to the judge or court if he is in
customs officers, and perform the other formalities Spanish * territory, and otherwise to the consul of
required by the regulations of the administration, Spain, * should there be one, and, in his absence
delivering the cargo without any defalcation, to the to the judge or court or to the proper local
consignee, and in a proper case, the vessel, rigging authority, presenting the certificate of the registry
and freightage to the ship agent. of the vessel treated of in Article 612, and the
instruments proving the obligation contracted.
If by reason of the absence of the consignee or on The judge or court, the consul or the local authority
account of the nonappearance of a legal holder of as the case may be, in view of the result of the
the bills of lading, the captain should not know to proceedings instituted, shall make a temporary
whom he is to legally make the delivery of the memorandum in the certificate of their result, in
cargo, he shall place it at the disposal of the proper order that it may be recorded in the registry when
judge or court or authority, in order that he may the vessel returns to the port of her registry, or so
determine what is proper with regards to its that it can be admitted as a legal and preferred
deposit, preservation and custody. obligation in case of sale before the return, by
PROHIBITED ACTS AND TRANSACTIONS reason of the sale of the vessel by virtue of a
declaration of unseaworthiness.
ARTICLE 613 The lack of this formality shall make the captain
A captain who navigates for freight in common or personally liable to the creditors who may be
on shares can not make any transaction for his prejudiced through his fault.
exclusive account, and should he do so the profit
shall belong to the other persons in interest, and 3. OTHER OFFICERS AND CREW
the losses shall be for his own exclusive account. CONTRACTS AND FORMALITIES
ARTICLE 634
ARTICLE 614 The captain may make up his crew with the
A captain who, having made an agreement to make number he may consider advisable, and in the
a voyage, fails to perform his undertaking, without absence of Spanish * sailors he may ship foreigners
being prevented by fortuitious accident or force residing in the country, the number thereof not to
majeure, shall indemnify for all the losses which he exceed one-fifth of the total crew. If in foreign
may cause, without prejudice to the criminal ports the captain should not find a sufficient
penalties which may be proper. number of Spanish * sailors, he may make up the
crew with foreigners, with the consent of the consul
ARTICLE 615 or marine authorities.
Without the consent of the agent, the captain can The agreements which the captain may make with
not have himself substituted by another person; the members of the crew and others who go to
and should he do so, besides being liable for all the make up the complement of the vessels, to which
acts of the substitute and bound to the indemnities reference is made in Article 612, must be reduced
mentioned in the foregoing article, the substitute to writing in the account book without the
as well as the captain may be discharged by the intervention of a notary public or clerk, signed by
agent. the parties thereto, and vised by the marine
authority if they are executed in Spanish *
ARTICLE 617 territory, or by the consuls or consular agents of
The captain can not contract loans on Spain * if executed abroad, stating therein all the
respondentia, and should he do so the contracts obligations which each one contracts and all the
shall be void. rights they acquire, said authorities taking care
Neither can he borrow money on bottomry for his that these obligations and rights are recorded in a
own transactions, except on the portion of the concise and clear manner, which will not give rise
vessel he owns, provided no money has been to doubts or claims. cd
previously borrowed on the whole vessel, and The captain shall take care to read to them the
provided there does not exist any other kind of lien articles of this Code, which concern them, stating
or obligation thereon. When he is permitted to do that they were read in the said document.
so, he must necessarily state what interest he has If the book includes the requisites prescribed in
in the vessel. Article 612, and there should not appear any signs
In case of violation of this article the principal, of alterations in its clauses, it shall be admitted as
interest, and costs shall be charged to the private evidence in questions which may arise between the
account of the captain, and the agent may captain and the crew with regard to the
furthermore have the right to discharge him. agreements contained therein and the amounts
paid on account of the same.
ARTICLE 621

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 227 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Every member of the crew may request a copy of competent authority is proper in the first port
the captain, signed by the latter, of the agreement touched, which will be obligatory on the captain.
and of the liquidation of his wages, as they appear
in the book.

DUTIES AND LIABILITIES ARTICLE 638


ARTICLE 635 If, the crew having been engaged, the voyage is
A sailor who has been contracted to serve on a revoked by the will of the agent or of the
vessel can not rescind his contract nor fail to charterers before or after the vessel has put to sea
comply therewith except by reason of a legitimate or if the vessel is in the same manner given a
impediment which may have occurred. different destination than that fixed in the
Neither can he pass from the service of one vessel agreement with the crew, the latter shall be
to another without obtaining the written consent of indemnified because of the rescission of the
the vessel on which he may be. contract according to the case, viz:
If, without obtaining said permission, the sailor 1. If the revocation of the voyage should be
who has signed for one vessel should sign for decided before the departure of the vessel from the
another one, the second contract shall be void, and port, each sailor engaged shall be given one
the captain may choose between forcing him to month's salary, besides what may be due him in
fulfill the service to which he first bound himself or accordance with his contract, for the services
look for a person to substitute him at his expense. rendered to the vessel up to the date of the
Said sailor shall furthermore lose the wages earned revocation.
on his first contract to the benefit of the vessel for 2. If the agreement should have been for a
which he may have signed. fixed amount for the whole voyage, there shall be
A captain who, knowing that a sailor is in the graduated what may be due for said month and
service of another vessel, should have made a new days, calculating the same in proportion to the
agreement with him, without having requested the estimated duration of the voyage, in the judgment
permission referred to in the foregoing paragraphs, of experts, in the manner established in the law of
shall be personally liable to the captain of the civil procedure; and if the proposed voyage should
vessel to which the sailor first belonged for that be of such short duration that it is calculated at one
part of the indemnity, referred to in the third month more or less, the indemnity shall be fixed
paragraph of this article, which the sailor could not for fifteen days, discounting in all cases the sums
pay. advanced.
3. If the revocation should take place after the
RIGHTS vessel has put to sea, the sailors engaged for a
ARTICLE 636 fixed amount for the voyage shall receive the
Should a fixed period for which a sailor has signed salary which may have been offered them in full as
not be stated, he can not be discharged until the if the voyage had terminated, and those engaged
end of the return voyage to the port where he by the month shall receive the amount
enrolled. corresponding to the time they might have been on
board and to the time they may require to arrive at
ARTICLE 637 the port of destination, the captain being obliged,
Neither can the captain discharge a sailor during furthermore, to pay said sailors the passage to the
the time of his contract except for sufficient cause, said port or to the port of sailing of the vessel, as
the following being considered as such: may be convenient for them.
1. The perpetration of a crime which disturbs 4. If the agent or the charterers of the vessel
order on the vessel. should give said vessel a destination other than
2. Repeated offenses of insubordination, that fixed in the agreement, and the members of
against discipline, or against the fulfillment of the the crew should not agree thereto, they shall be
service. given by way of indemnity half the amount fixed in
3. Repeated incapacity or negligence in the case No. 1, besides what may be owed them for
fulfillment of the service to be rendered. the part of the monthly wages corresponding to the
4. Habitual drunkenness. days which have elapsed from the date of their
5. Any occurrence which incapacitates the agreements.
sailor to carry out the work under his charge, with If they accept the change, and the voyage, on
the exception of the provisions contained in Article account of the greater distance or for other
644. reasons, should give rise to an increase of wages,
6. Desertion. the latter shall be privately regulated, or through
The captain may, however, before setting out on a amicable arbitrators in case of disagreement. Even
voyage and without giving any reason whatsoever, though the voyage may be to a nearer point, this
refuse to permit a sailor he may have engaged shall not give rise to a reduction in the wages
from going on board and may leave him on land, in agreed upon.
which case he will be obliged to pay him his wages If the revocation or change of the voyage should
as if he had rendered services. originate from the shippers or charterers, the agent
This indemnity shall be paid from the funds of the shall have a right to demand of them the indemnity
vessel if the captain should have acted for reasons which is justly due.
of prudence and in the interest of the safety and
good service of the former. Should this not be the ARTICLE 639
case, it shall be paid by the captain personally. If the revocation of the voyage should arise from a
aisadc just cause independent of the will of the agent or
After the vessel has sailed, and during the voyage charterers, and the vessel should not have left the
and until the conclusion thereof, the captain can port, the members of the crew shall not have any
not abandon any member of his crew on land or on other right than to receive the wages earned up to
the sea, unless, by reason of being guilty of some the day on which the revocation took place.
crime, his imprisonment and delivery to the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 228 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

ARTICLE 640 A sailor who falls sick shall not lose his right to
The following shall be just causes for the revocation wages during the voyage, unless the sickness is the
of the voyage: result of his own fault. At any rate, the costs of the
1. A declaration of war or interdiction of attendance and cure shall be defrayed from the
commerce with the power to whose territory the common funds, in the form of a loan.
vessel was bound. If the sickness should be caused by an injury
2. The blockade of the port of destination or received in the service or defense of the vessel the
the breaking out of an epidemic after the sailor shall be attended and cured from the
agreement. common funds, there being deducted before
3. The prohibition to receive in said port the anything else from the proceeds of the freight, the
goods which make up the cargo of the vessel. cost of the attendance and cure.
4. The detention or embargo of the same by
order of the Government, or for any other reason
independent of the will of the agent.
5. The inability of the vessel to navigate. ARTICLE 645
If a sailor should die during the voyage his heir
ARTICLE 641 shall be given the wages earned and not received,
If, after a voyage has been begun, any of the first according to his engagement and the reason for his
three causes mentioned in the foregoing article death, namely
should occur, the sailors shall be paid at the port If he should have died a natural death and should
the captain may deem it advisable to make for the have been engaged on wages there shall be paid
benefit of the vessel and cargo, according to the what may have been earned up to the date of his
time they may have served thereon; but if the death.
vessel is to continue the voyage, the captain and If the engagement had been made for a fixed sum
the crew may mutually demand the enforcement of for the whole voyage there shall be paid half the
the contract. amount earned if the sailor died on the voyage out,
In case of the occurrence of the fourth cause, the and the whole amount if he died on the return
crew shall continue to be paid half wages, if the voyage.
agreement is by month but if the detention should And if the engagement had been made on shares
exceed three months, the engagement shall be and the death should have occurred after the
rescinded and the crew shall be paid what they voyage was begun, the heirs shall be paid the
should have earned, according to the contract, if entire portion due the sailor; but should the latter
the voyage had been made. And if the agreement have died before the departure of the vessel from
had been made for a fixed sum for the voyage, the the port, the heirs shall not be entitled to claim
contract must be complied within the terms agreed anything.
upon. If the death should have occurred in the defense of
In the fifth case, the crew shall not have any other the vessel, the sailor shall be considered as living,
right than be entitled to recover the wages earned; and his heirs shall be paid, at the end of the
but if the disability of the vessel should have been voyage, the full amount of wages or the full part of
caused by the negligence or lack of skill of the the profits due him as to the others of his grade.
captain, engineer, or sailing mate, they shall The sailor shall likewise be considered as present in
indemnify the crew for the loss suffered, always the event of his capture when defending the vessel,
reserving the criminal liability which may be in order to enjoy the same benefits as the rest; but
proper. should he have been captured on account of
carelessness or other accident not related to the
ARTICLE 642 service, he shall only receive the wages due up to
If the crew has been engaged to work on shares the day of his capture.
they shall not be entitled, by reason of the
revocation, delay, or greater extension of the ARTICLE 646
voyage, to anything but the proportionate part of The vessel with her engines, rigging, equipment,
the indemnity paid into the common funds of the and freights shall be liable for the wages earned by
vessel by the persons liable for said occurrences. the crew engaged per month or for the trip, the
liquidation and payment ought to take place
ARTICLE 643 between one voyage and the other.
If the vessel and her freight should be totally lost, After a new voyage has been undertaken, credits
by reason of capture or wreck, all rights of the crew such as the former shall lose their right of
to demand any wages whatsoever shall be preference.
extinguished, as well as that of the agent for the
recovery of the advances made. ARTICLE 647
If a portion of the vessel or freight should be The officers and the crew of the vessel shall be
saved, or part of either, the crew engaged on exempted from all obligations contracted, if they
wages, including the captain, shall retain their deem it proper, in the following cases:
rights on the salvage, so far as they go, on the 1. If, before the beginning of the voyage, the
remainder of the vessel as well as value of the captain attempts to change it, or there occurs a
freightage or the cargo saved; but sailors who are naval war with the power to which the vessel was
engaged on shares shall not have any right destined.
whatsoever to the salvage of the hull, but only on 2. If a disease should break out and be
the portion of the freightage saved. If they should officially declared epidemic in the port of
have worked to collect the remainder of the ship- destination.
wrecked vessel, they shall be given an award in 3. If the vessel should change owner or
proportion to the efforts made and to the risks captain.
encountered in order to accomplish the salvage.

ARTICLE 644

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 229 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

merchandise is placed on the wharf, and any other


4. SUPERCARGOES expenses common to navigation shall be
considered ordinary expenses to be defrayed by
ARTICLE 649 the shipowner, unless there is a special agreement
Supercargoes shall discharge on board the vessel to the contrary.
the administrative duties which the agent or
shippers may have assigned them; they shall keep ARTICLE 808
an account and record of their transactions in a Averages shall be:
book which shall have the same conditions and 1. Simple or particular.
requisites as required for the accounting book of 2. General or gross.
the captain, and shall respect the latter in his
duties as chief of the vessel. cdta i. Simple or Particular
The powers and liabilities of the captain shall
cease, when there is a supercargo, with regard to (a) Defined
that part of the administration legitimately
conferred upon the latter, but shall continue in ARTICLE 809
force for all acts which are inseparable from his Simple or particular averages shall be, as a general
authority and office. rule, all the expenses and damages caused to the
vessel or to her cargo which have not redounded to
ARTICLE 650 the benefit and common profit of all the persons
All the provisions contained in the second section of interested in the vessel and her cargo, and
Title III, Book II, with regard to qualifications, especially the following:
manner of making contracts, and liabilities of 1. The damages suffered by the cargo from
factors shall be applicable to supercargoes. the time of its embarkation until it is unloaded,
either on account of the nature of the goods or by
ARTICLE 651 reason of an accident at sea or force majeure, and
Supercargoes can not, without special authorization the expenses incurred to avoid and repair the
or agreement, make any transaction for their own same.
account during the voyage, with the exception of 2. The damages suffered by the vessel in her
the ventures which, in accordance with the custom hull, rigging, arms, and equipment, for the same
of the port of destination, they are permitted to do. causes and reasons, from the time she puts to sea
Neither shall they be permitted to invest in the from the port of departure until she anchored in the
return trip more than the profits from the ventures, port of destination.
unless there is a special authorization thereto from 3. The damages suffered by the merchandise
the principals. loaded on deck, except in coastwise navigation, if
What is a supercargo? the marine ordinances allow it.
He or she is an agent of the owner of goods 4. The wages and victuals of the crew when
shipped as cargo on a vessel, who has charge of the vessel should be detained or embargoed by a
the cargo on board, sells the same to the best legitimate order or force majeure, if the charter
advantage in the foreign markets, buys cargo to be should have been for a fixed sum for the voyage.
brought back on the return voyage of the ship, and 5. The necessary expenses on arrival at a
comes home with it. port, in order to make repairs or secure provisions.
6. The lowest value of the goods sold by the
captain in arrivals under stress for the payment of
E. Accidents and Damages in Maritime provisions and in order to save the crew, or to
Commerce cover any other requirement of the vessel against
which the proper amount shall be charged.
1. AVERAGES24 7. The victuals and wages of the crew during
the time the vessel is in quarantine.
NATURE AND KINDS 8. The damage suffered by the vessel or cargo
by reason of an impact or collision with another, if
ARTICLE 806 it were accidental and unavoidable. If the accident
For the purposes of this Code the following shall be should occur through the fault or negligence of the
considered averages: captain, the latter shall be liable for all the damage
1. All extraordinary or accidental expenses caused.
which may be incurred during the navigation for 9. Any damage suffered by the cargo through
the preservation of the vessel or cargo, or both. the faults, negligence, or barratry of the captain or
2. All damages or deterioration the vessel of the crew, without prejudice to the right of the
may suffer from the time she puts to sea from the owner to recover the corresponding indemnity from
port of departure until she casts anchor in the port the captain, the vessel, and the freight.
of destination, and those suffered by the
merchandise from the time it is loaded in the port (b) Effects
of shipment until it is unloaded in the port of
consignment. ARTICLE 810
The owner of the goods which gave rise to the
ARTICLE 807 expense or suffered the damage shall bear the
The petty and ordinary expenses of navigation, simple or particular averages.
such as pilotage of coasts and ports, lighterage and ii. Gross or General
towage, anchorage dues, inspection, health,
quarantine, lazaretto, and other so-called port (a) Defined
expenses, costs of barges, and unloading, until the
ARTICLE 811
24
General averages, requisites and jettison were General or gross averages shall be, as a general
asked in 2000, 1983, and 1982. rule, all the damages and expenses which are

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 230 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

deliberately caused in order to save the vessel, her In order to incur the expenses and cause the
cargo, or both at the same time, from a real and damages corresponding to gross average, a
known risk, and particularly the following: previous resolution of the captain, adopted after
1. The goods or cash invested in the deliberation with the sailing mate and other officers
redemption of the vessel or cargo captured by of the vessel, and with a hearing of the persons
enemies, privateers, or pirates, and the provisions, interested in the cargo who may be present, shall
wages, and expenses of the vessel detained during be required.
the time the arrangement or redemption is taking If the latter shall object, and the captain and
place. officers, or a majority, or the captain, if opposed to
2. The goods jettisoned to lighten the vessel, the majority, should consider certain measures
whether they belong to the vessel, to the cargo, or necessary, they may be executed under his
to the crew, and the damage suffered through said liability, without prejudice to the freighters
act by the goods kept. exercising their rights against the captain before
3. The cables and masts which are cut or the judge or court of competent jurisdiction, if they
rendered useless, the anchors and the chains which can prove that he acted with malice, lack of skill, or
are abandoned in order to save the cargo, the negligence.
vessel, or both. If the persons interested in the cargo, being on the
4. The expenses of removing or transferring a vessel, should not be heard, they shall not
portion of the cargo in order to lighten the vessel contribute to the gross average, which contribution
and place her in condition to enter a port or shall be paid by the captain, unless the urgency of
roadstead, and the damage resulting therefrom to the case should be such that the time necessary for
the goods removed or transferred. previous deliberation was lacking.
5. The damage suffered by the goods of the
cargo through the opening made in the vessel in ARTICLE 814
order to drain her and prevent her sinking. The resolution adopted to cause the damages
6. The expenses caused through floating a which constitute a general average must
vessel intentionally stranded for the purpose of necessarily be entered in the log book, stating the
saving her. motives and reasons therefor, the votes against it,
7. The damage caused to the vessel which it and the reasons for the disagreement should there
is necessary to break open, scuttle, or smash in be any, and the irresistible and urgent causes
order to save the cargo. which moved the captain if he acted of his own
8. The expenses of curing and maintaining the accord.
members of the crew who may have been wounded In the first case the minutes shall be signed by all
or crippled in defending or saving the vessel. the persons present who could do so before taking
9. The wages of any member of the crew action if possible, and if not at the first opportunity;
detained as hostage by enemies, privateers, or in the second case by the captain and by the
pirates, and the necessary expenses which he may officers of the vessel.
incur in his imprisonment, until he is returned to In the minutes and after the resolution there shall
the vessel or to his domicile, should he prefer it. be stated in detail all the goods cast away, and
10. The wages and victuals of the crew of a mention shall be made of the injuries caused to
vessel chartered by the month during the time it those kept on board. The captain shall be obliged
should be embargoed or detained by force majeure to deliver one copy of these minutes to the
or by order of the Government, or in order to repair maritime judicial authority of the first port he may
the damage caused for the common good. make within twenty-four hours after his arrival, and
11. The loss suffered in the value of the goods to ratify it immediately by an oath.
sold at arrivals under stress in order to repair the
vessel because of gross average. ARTICLE 860
12. The expenses of the liquidation of the If, notwithstanding the jettison of the merchandise,
average. breakage of masts, ropes, and equipment, the
vessel should be lost running said risk, no
ARTICLE 817 contribution whatsoever by reason of gross
If in lightening a vessel on account of a storm, in average shall be proper.
order to facilitate her entry into a port or The owners of the goods saved shall not be liable
roadstead, part of her cargo should be transferred for the indemnity of those jettisoned, lost, or
to lighters or barges and be lost, the owner of said damaged.
part shall be entitled to indemnity, as if the loss
has originated from a gross average, the amount MAGSAYSAY INC. vs AGAN (1955)
thereof being distributed between the entire vessel REQUISITES FOR GENERAL AVERAGE:
and cargo which caused the same. 1. There must be a common danger. This
If, on the contrary, the merchandise transferred means, that both the ship and the cargo, after it
should be saved and the vessel should be lost, no has been loaded, are subject to the same danger,
liability can be demanded of the salvage. whether during the voyage, or in the port of
loading or unloading; that the danger arises from
ARTICLE 818 the accidents of the sea, dispositions of the
If, as a necessary measure to extinguish a fire in a authority, or faults of men, provided that the
port; roadstead; creek, or bay, it should be decided circumstances producing the peril should be
to sink any vessel, this loss shall be considered ascertained and imminent or may rationally be said
gross average, to which the vessels saved shall to be certain and imminent. This last requirement
contribute. exclude measures undertaken against a distant
peril.
(b) Essential Requisites 2. That for the common safety, part of the
vessel or of the cargo or both is sacrificed
ARTICLE 813 deliberately.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 231 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

3. That from the expenses or damages caused In the absence of agreements, the following rules
follows the successful saving of the vessel and shall be observed:
cargo. 1. The proof of the average shall take place in
4. That the expenses or damages should have the port where the repairs are made, should any be
been incurred or inflicted after taking proper legal necessary, or in the port of unloading.
steps and authority 2. The liquidation shall take place in the port
of unloading should it be a Spanish * port.
(c) Effects 3. Should the average have occurred outside
of the waters under the jurisdiction of the
ARTICLE 812 Philippines or the cargo should have been sold in a
In order to satisfy the amount of the gross or foreign port by reason of an arrival under stress,
general averages, all the persons having an the liquidations shall be made in the port of
interest in the vessel and cargo therein at the time arrival.
of the occurrence of the average shall contribute. 4. If the average should have occurred near
the port of destination, so that said port can be
(d) Jettison made, the proceedings treated of in Rules 1 and 2
shall be held there.
ARTICLE 815
The captain shall supervise the jettison, and shall ARTICLE 847
order the goods cast overboard in the following In case of making the liquidation of the averages
order: privately by virtue of agreement, as well as when a
1. Those which are on deck, beginning with judicial authority takes part therein at the request
those which embarrass the handling of the vessel of any of the parties interested who do not agree
or damage her, preferring, if possible, the heaviest thereto, all of them shall be cited and heard, should
ones and those of least utility and value. cda they not have renounced this right.
2. Those in the hold, always beginning with Should they not be present or not have a legitimate
those of the greatest weight and smallest value, to representative, the liquidation shall be made by the
the amount and number absolutely indispensable. consul in a foreign port, and where there is none,
by the judge or court of competent jurisdiction,
ARTICLE 816 according to the laws of the country, and for the
In order that the goods jettisoned may be included account of the proper person.
in the gross average and the owners thereof be When the representative is a person well known in
entitled to indemnity, it shall be necessary in so far the place where the liquidation takes place, his
as the cargo is concerned that their existence on intervention shall be admitted and produce legal
board be proven by means of the bill of lading; and effects, even though he be authorized only by a
with regard to those belonging to the vessel, by letter of the shipowner, freighter, or underwriter.
means of the inventory made up before the
departure, in accordance with the first paragraph of ARTICLE 848
Article 612. Claims for averages shall not be admitted if they do
not exceed 5 per cent of the interest which the
claimant may have in the vessel or cargo if it is
(e) Jason Clauses (York - Antwerp Rules, gross average, and 1 per cent of the goods
Rule D) damaged if particular average, deducting in both
cases the expenses of appraisal, unless there is an
Rights to contribution in general average shall not agreement to the contrary.
be affected, though the event which gave rise to
the sacrifice or expenditure may have been due to ii. Appraisal of general average
the fault of one of the parties to the adventure; but
this shall not prejudice any remedies which may be ARTICLE 850
open against that party for such fault. If by reason of one or more accidents of the sea
particular and gross averages of the vessel or the
What are the York-Antwerp Rules and the cargo, or of both, should take place on the same
Jason Clause? voyage, the expenses and damages corresponding
The York-Antwerp Rules is an international system to each one shall be determined separately in the
of rules (they are not law or international treaties, port where the repairs are made or where the
but are just widely in use) for the liquidation and cargo is discharged, or sold, or the merchandise is
payment of average to avoid the problem of benefited.
characterization. For this purpose the captains shall be obliged to
demand of the expert appraisers and of the
The Jason Clause is a standard provision in contractors making the repairs, as well as of those
maritime contracts. It provides for uniform rules on appraising and taking part in the unloading, repair,
adjustment, proof and liquidation of avergaes in sale, or the benefiting of the merchandise, that
maritime accidents to address various systems of they separate and detail exactly in their
determining the same. appraisements or estimates and accounts all the
expenses and damages belonging to each average,
PROOF AND LIQUIDATION OF AVERAGES and in those of each average those corresponding
to the vessel and to the cargo, stating also
i. Modes separately whether there are or not any damages
proceeding from the nature of the goods, and not
ARTICLE 846 by reason of a sea accident; and in case there
The persons interested in the proof and liquidation should be expenses common to the different
of averages may mutually agree and bind averages and to the vessel and her cargo, there
themselves at any time with regard to the liability, must be calculated the amount corresponding to
liquidation, and payment thereof. cdt each and stated distinctly.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 232 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

3. If the merchandise should be damaged, it


SECTION II shall be appraised at its true value.
Liquidation of Gross Averages 4. If the voyage should be interrupted, the
ARTICLE 851 merchandise having been sold in a foreign port and
At the instance of the captain, the adjustment, the average can not be estimated, there shall be
liquidation, and distribution of gross averages shall taken as the contributing capital the value of the
be held privately, with the consent of all the parties merchandise in the port of arrival, or the net
in interest. proceeds obtained at the sale thereof.
For this purpose, within forty-eight hours following 5. Merchandise lost, which should constitute
the arrival of the vessel at the port, the captain the gross average, shall be appraised at the value
shall call all the persons interested, in order that merchandise of its kind may have in the port of
they may decide as to whether the adjustment or unloading, provided its kind and quality appears in
liquidation of the gross average is to be made by the bill of lading; and should this not be the case,
experts and liquidators appointed by themselves, in the invoices of the purchase issued in the port of
which case this shall be done should the persons shipment shall be taken as a basis, adding to its
interested agree. value the expenses and freights subsequently
Should an agreement not be possible, the captain arising. cd
shall apply to the judge or court of competent 6. The masts cut down, the sails, cables, and
jurisdiction, who shall be the one of the port where other equipment of the vessel rendered useless for
these proceedings are to be held in accordance the purpose of saving her, shall be appraised at the
with the provisions of this Code, or to the consul of current value, deducting one-third by reason of the
Spain, * should there be one, and otherwise to the difference between new and old.
local authority when they are to be held in a This deduction shall not be made in regard
foreign port. cdta to anchors and chains.
7. The vessel shall be appraised at her real
value in her condition at the time.
ARTICLE 852 8. The freights shall represent 50 per cent by
way of contributing capital.
If the captain should not comply with the provisions
contained in the foregoing article, the shipowner or ARTICLE 855
agent or the freighters shall demand the The merchandise loaded on the upper deck of the
liquidation, without prejudice to the action they vessel shall contribute to the gross average should
may bring to demand indemnity from him. it be saved; but there shall be no right to indemnity
if it should be lost by reason of being jettisoned for
ARTICLE 853 general safety, except when the marine ordinances
After the experts have been appointed by the allow its shipment in this manner in coastwise
persons interested, or by the judge or court, before navigation.
the acceptance, an examination of the vessel and The same shall take place with that which is on
of the repairs required shall be made, as well as an board and is not included in the bills of lading or
estimate of their cost, separating these losses and inventories, according to the cases.
damages from those arising from the natural vice In any case the shipowner and the captain shall be
of the thing. liable to freighters for the loss of the jettison, if the
The experts shall also declare whether the repairs storage on the upper deck took place without the
can be made immediately, or whether it is consent of the latter.
necessary to unload the vessel to examine and
repair her. ARTICLE 857
With regard to the merchandise, if the average After the appraisement of the goods saved has
should be visible at a mere glance, the examination been concluded by the experts, as well as that of
thereof must be made before it is delivered. Should the goods lost which constitute the gross average,
it not be visible at the time of unloading, said and after the repairs have been made to the
examination may be held after the delivery vessel, should any have to be made, and in such
provided it is done within forty-eight hours from case after the approval of the accounts of the same
the unloading and without prejudice to the other by the persons interested or by the judge or court,
proofs which the experts may deem necessary. the entire record shall be turned over to the
liquidator appointed, in order that he may proceed
ARTICLE 854 with the distribution of the average.
The appraisement of the goods which are to
contribute to the gross average, and that of those iii. Liquidation of general averages
which constitute the average, shall conform to the
following rules: ARTICLE 858
1. The merchandise saved which is to In order to effect the liquidation the liquidator shall
contribute to the payment of the gross average examine the sworn statement of the captain,
shall be valued at the current price thereof at the comparing it, if necessary, with the log book and all
port of unloading, deducting the freights, customs the contracts which may have been made between
duties, and charges for unloading, as may appear the persons interested in the average, the
from a material inspection of the same, not taking appraisements, expert examinations, and accounts
into consideration the bills of lading, unless there is of repairs made. If, as a result of this examination,
an agreement to the contrary. he should find any defect in this procedure which
2. If the liquidation is to take place in the port might injure the rights of the persons interested or
of sailing, the value of the merchandise loaded affect the liability of the captain, he shall call
shall be fixed by the purchase price, including the attention thereto in order that it be corrected, if
expenses until they are put on board, excluding the possible, and otherwise he shall include it in the
insurance premium. preliminaries of the liquidation.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 233 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Immediately thereafter he shall proceed with the provisions, well founded fear of seizure, privateers
distribution of the amount of the average, for which or pirates, or by reason of any accident of the sea
purpose he shall fix: disabling her to navigate, he shall assemble the
1. The contributing capital, which he shall officers and shall call the persons interested in the
determine by the value of the cargo, in accordance cargo who may be present, and who may attend
with the rules established in Article 854. the meeting without the right to vote; and if, after
2. That of the vessel in her actual condition, examining the circumstances of the case, the
according to a statement of experts. reasons should be considered well founded, it shall
3. The 50 per cent of the amount of the be decided to make the nearest and most
freight, deducting the remaining 50 per cent for convenient port drafting and entering in the log
wages and maintenance of the crew. book the proper minutes, which shall be signed by
After the amount of the gross average has been all.
determined in accordance with the provisions of The captain shall have the deciding vote and the
this Code, it shall be distributed pro rata among the persons interested in the cargo may make the
goods which are to cover the same. objections and protests they may deem proper,
which shall be entered in the minutes in order that
ARTICLE 865 they may make use thereof in the manner they
The distribution of the gross average shall not be may consider advisable.
final until it has been agreed to, or in the absence
thereof, until it has been approved by the judge or ARTICLE 820
court after an examination of the liquidation and a The arrival under stress shall not be considered
hearing of the persons interested who may be legal in the following cases:
present, or of their representatives. 1. If the lack of provisions should arise from
the failure to take the necessary provisions for the
ARTICLE 866 voyage, according to usage and custom, or if they
After the liquidation has been approved it shall be should have been rendered useless or lost through
the duty of the captain to collect the amount of the bad stowage or negligence in their care.
distribution, and he shall be liable to the owners of 2. If the risk of enemies, privateers, or pirates
the goods averaged for the losses they suffer should not have been well known, manifest, and
through his delay or negligence. based on positive and justifiable facts.
3. If the injury to the vessel should have been
ARTICLE 867 caused by reason of her not being repaired, rigged,
If the contributors should not pay the amount of equipped, and arranged in a convenient manner for
the assessment within the third day after having the voyage, or by reason of some erroneous order
been requested to do so, the goods saved shall be of the captain.
attached, at the request of the captain, and shall 4. Whenever malice, negligence, want of
be sold to cover the payment. foresight, or lack of skill on the part of the captain
is the reason for the act causing the damage.
ARTICLE 868
If the persons interested in receiving the goods FORMALITIES
saved should not give security sufficient to answer
for the amount corresponding to the gross average, ARTICLE 819
the captain may defer the delivery thereof until If the captain during the navigation should believe
payment has been made. aisadc that the vessel can not continue the voyage to the
port of destination on account of the lack of
SECTION III provisions, well founded fear of seizure, privateers
Liquidation of Ordinary Averages or pirates, or by reason of any accident of the sea
disabling her to navigate, he shall assemble the
ARTICLE 869 officers and shall call the persons interested in the
The experts which the judge or court or the cargo who may be present, and who may attend
persons interested may appoint, according to the the meeting without the right to vote; and if, after
cases, shall proceed with the appraisement and examining the circumstances of the case, the
examination of the averages in the manner reasons should be considered well founded, it shall
prescribed in Article 853 and in Article 854, Rules 2 be decided to make the nearest and most
to 7, in so far as they are applicable. convenient port drafting and entering in the log
book the proper minutes, which shall be signed by
iv. Liquidation of particular average all.
The captain shall have the deciding vote and the
ARTICLE 869 persons interested in the cargo may make the
The experts which the judge or court or the objections and protests they may deem proper,
persons interested may appoint, according to the which shall be entered in the minutes in order that
cases, shall proceed with the appraisement and they may make use thereof in the manner they
examination of the averages in the manner may consider advisable.
prescribed in Article 853 and in Article 854, Rules 2
to 7, in so far as they are applicable. ARTICLE 822
If in order to make repairs to the vessel or because
2. ARRIVALS UNDER STRESS there should be danger of the cargo suffering
damage it should be necessary to unload, the
CAUSES captain must request authorization of the judge or
court of competent jurisdiction to lighten the
ARTICLE 819 vessel, and do so with the knowledge of the person
If the captain during the navigation should believe interested or representative of the cargo, should
that the vessel can not continue the voyage to the there be one.
port of destination on account of the lack of

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 234 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

In a foreign port, it shall be the duty of the Spanish The captain shall answer for the damages caused
* consul, where there is one, to give the by his delay, if the reason for the arrival under
authorization. stress having ceased, he should not continue the
In the first case, the expenses shall be defrayed by voyage.
the ship agent or owner, and in the second, they If the reason for said arrival should have been the
shall be for the account of the owners of the fear of enemies, privateers, or pirates, before
merchandise, for whose benefit the act took place. sailing, a discussion and resolution of a meeting of
If the unloading should take place for both reasons, the officers of the vessel and persons interested in
the expenses shall be defrayed in proportion to the the cargo who may be present shall take place, in
value of the vessel and that of the cargo. accordance with the provisions contained in Article
819.
EXPENSES
3. COLLISIONS
ARTICLE 821
The expenses caused by the arrival under stress NOTE:
shall always be for the account of the shipowner or
agent, but the latter shall not be liable for the Collision the impact of two vessels both of which
damage which may be caused the shippers by are moving.
reason of the arrival under stress, provided the
latter is legitimate. Allision the striking of a moving vessel agains
Otherwise, the shipowner or agent and the captain one that is stationary.
shall be jointly liable.
CLASSES AND EFFECTS
ARTICLE 822
If in order to make repairs to the vessel or because i. Fortuitous
there should be danger of the cargo suffering
damage it should be necessary to unload, the ARTICLE 830
captain must request authorization of the judge or If a vessel should collide with another by reason of
court of competent jurisdiction to lighten the an accident or through force majeure, each vessel
vessel, and do so with the knowledge of the person and her cargo shall be liable for their own damage.
interested or representative of the cargo, should
there be one. ARTICLE 831
In a foreign port, it shall be the duty of the Spanish If a vessel should be forced to collide with another
* consul, where there is one, to give the one by a third vessel, the owner of the third vessel
authorization. shall indemnify for the losses and damages caused,
In the first case, the expenses shall be defrayed by the captain thereof being civilly liable to said
the ship agent or owner, and in the second, they owner.
shall be for the account of the owners of the
merchandise, for whose benefit the act took place. ARTICLE 832
If the unloading should take place for both reasons, If, by reason of a storm or other cause of force
the expenses shall be defrayed in proportion to the majeure, a vessel which is properly anchored and
value of the vessel and that of the cargo. moored should collide with those in her immediate
vicinity, causing them damage, the injury
RESPONSIBILITY OF THE CAPTAIN occasioned shall be looked upon as particular
average to the vessel run into.
ARTICLE 823
The care and preservation of the cargo which has ii. Culpable
been unloaded shall be in charge of the captain,
who shall be responsible for the same, except in ARTICLE 826
cases of force majeure. If a vessel should collide with another through the
fault, negligence, or lack of skill of the captain,
ARTICLE 824 sailing mate, or any other member of the
If the entire cargo or part thereof should appear to complement, the owner of the vessel at fault shall
be damaged, or there should be imminent danger indemnify the losses and damages suffered, after
of its being damaged, the captain may request of an expert appraisal. aisadc
the judge or court of competent jurisdiction or the
consul, in a proper case, the sale of all or of part of
the former, and the person taking cognizance of ARTICLE 827
the matter shall authorize it after an examination If both vessels may be blamed for the collision,
and declaration of experts, advertisements, and each one shall be liable for his own damages, and
other formalities required by the case and an entry both shall be jointly responsible for the losses and
in the book, in accordance with the provisions of damages suffered by their cargoes.
Article 624.
The captain shall, in a proper case, justify the ARTICLE 831
legality of the procedure, under the penalty of If a vessel should be forced to collide with another
answering to the shipper for the price the one by a third vessel, the owner of the third vessel
merchandise would have brought if it should have shall indemnify for the losses and damages caused,
arrived at the port of its destination in good the captain thereof being civilly liable to said
condition. owner.

iii. Inscrutable Fault25

ARTICLE 825 25
See footnote 12. Distinguish inscrutable fault with
the doctrine of last clear chance and with the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 235 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

LIABILITIES26
ARTICLE 828
The provisions of the foregoing article are i. Shipowner or agent
applicable to the case in which it can not be
decided which of the two vessels was the cause of ARTICLE 837
the collision. The civil liability contracted by the shipowners in
the cases prescribed in this section, shall be
PRESUMPTION OF LOSS BY COLLISION understood as limited to the value of the vessel
with all her appurtenances and all the freight
ARTICLE 833 earned during the voyage.
A vessel shall be presumed as lost thru a collision
which, upon being run into, sinks immediately, and ARTICLE 838
also any vessel which is obliged to make a port to When the value of the vessel and her
repair the damages caused by the collision should appurtenances should not be sufficient to cover all
be lost during the voyage, or should be obliged to the liabilities, the indemnity due by reason of the
be stranded in order to be saved. death or injury of persons shall have preference.

ii. Captain, pilot, others

ARTICLE 829
In the cases above mentioned the civil action of the
owner against the person liable for the damage is
reserved, as well as the criminal liabilities which
may be proper.

ARTICLE 834
If the vessels colliding should have pilots on board
discharging their duties at the time of the collision,
their presence shall not exempt the captains from
the liabilities they incur; but the latter shall have
the right to be indemnified by the pilots without
prejudice to the criminal liability which the latter
may incur.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 236 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

iii. Conditions, protest27 If several vessels navigate under convoy, and any
of them should be wrecked, the cargo saved shall
Maritime Protest a written statement under be distributed among the rest in the proportion to
oath, made by the master of a vessel, after the the amount each one can receive.
occurrence of an accident or disaster in which the If any captain should refuse, without sufficient
vessel or cargo is lost or injured, with respect to cause, to receive what may correspond to him, the
the circumstances attending such occurrence. It is captain of the wrecked vessel shall enter a protest
usually intended to show that the loss or damage against him before two sea officials of the losses
resulted from a peril of the sea, or from some other and damages resulting therefrom, ratifying the
cause for which neither the master nor owner was complaint within twenty-four hours after arrival at
responsible, and conludes with the protestation the first port, and including it in the proceedings he
against any liability of the owner for such loss or must institute in accordance with the provisions
damage. contained in Article 612.
Should it not be possible to transfer to the other
ARTICLE 835 vessels the entire cargo of the one wrecked, the
The action for the recovery of losses and damages goods of the highest value and smallest volume
arising from collisions can not be admitted if a shall be saved first, the designation thereof being
protest or declaration is not presented within made by the captain, in concurrence with the
twenty-four hours to the competent authority of officers of his vessel.
the point where the collision took place, or that of
the first port of arrival of the vessel, if in Spain, *
and to the consul of Spain * if it should have F. Special Contracts of Maritime Commerce
occurred in a foreign country.
1. CHARTER PARTIES28
ARTICLE 836
In so far as the damages caused to persons or to DEFINITION
the cargo are concerned, the absence of a protest A charter party is a contract by virture of which the
can not prejudice the persons interested who were owenr or agent of a vessel binds himself to
not on board or were not in a condition to make transport merchandise or persons for a fixed price.
known their wishes. It is a contract by which the owner or agent of the
vessel leases for a certain price the whole or
ARTICLE 839 portion of a vessel for the transportation of the
If the collision should occur between Spanish * goods or persons from one port to another. Towage
vessels in foreign waters, or if it should take place is not a charter party. It is a contract for the hire of
in open waters, and the vessels should make a services by which a vessel is engaged to tow
foreign port, the Spanish * consul in said port shall another vessel from one port to another for
hold a summary investigation of the accident, consideration.
forwarding the proceedings to the captain-general
of the nearest department * for continuation and KINDS
conclusion.
As to extent of vessel hired:
4. SHIPWRECKS
Total
ARTICLE 840
Partial - charterer as a rule does not
The losses and deteriorations suffered by a vessel
acquire the right to fix the date
and her cargo by reason of shipwreck or stranding
when the vessel
shall be individually for the account of the owners,
should depart, unless such right is
the part of the wreck which may be saved
expressly granted in
belonging to them in the same proportion.
the contract
ARTICLE 841
As to time:
If the wreck or stranding should arise through the
malice, negligence, or lack of skill of the captain, or
Until a fixed day or for a determined
because the vessel put to sea insufficiently repaired
number of days or months
and prepared, the owner or the freighters may
For a voyage
demand indemnity of the captain for the damages
caused to the vessel or cargo by the accident, in
As to freightage:
accordance with the provisions contained in Articles
For a fixed amount for the whole cargo
610, 612, 614, and 621.
ARTICLE 842 For a fixed rate per ton
The goods saved from the wreck shall be specially For so much per month
liable for the payment of the expenses of the
respective salvage, and the amount thereof must Coastwise Lighterage Corp vs. CA and Phil.
be paid by the owners of the former before they Gen. Insurance Co. (1995)
are delivered to them, and with preference to any The distinction between the two kinds of charter
other obligation, if the merchandise should be sold. parties (i.e. bareboat or demise and contract of

ARTICLE 843
28
The topic was covered in 2004, 2003, 1991, and
doctrine of limited liabilities. 1989. Take note of the definition and kinds of a
26
See footnote 15. charter party, who should bear the loss of cargo in
27
Take note of the concept of maritime protest, and case of death of crewmembers, validity of stipulation
when and where it should be file. This was asked in exempting owner from liability, and owner pro hac
2007, 1988, 1978, and 1977. vice.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 237 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

affreightment) is more clearly set out in the case of the cargo consists, or in any other manner
Puromines, Inc. vs. Court of Appeals: whatsoever agreed upon.
Under the demise or bareboat charter of the vessel, 9. The amount of primage to be paid to the
the charterer will generally be regarded as the captain.
owner for the voyage or service stipulated. The 10. The days agreed upon for loading and
charterer mans the vessel with his own people and unloading.
becomes the owner pro hac vice, subject to liability 11. The lay days and extra lay days to be
to others for damages caused by negligence. To allowed and the rate of demurrage.
create a demise, the owner of a vessel must
completely and exclusively relinquish possession, ARTICLE 653
command and navigation thereof to the charterer, If the freight should be received without the
anything short of such a complete transfer is a charter party having been signed, the contract shall
contract of affreightment (time or voyage charter be understood as executed in accordance with what
party) or not a charter party at all. appears in the bill of lading, which shall be the only
A contract of affreightment is one in which the instrument with regard to the freight to determine
owner of the vessel leases part or all of its space to the rights and obligations of the owner, of the
haul goods for others. It is a contract for special captain, and of the charterer. cdt
service to be rendered by the owner of the vessel
and under such contract the general owner retains ARTICLE 654
the possession, command and navigation of the The charter parties executed with the intervention
ship, the charterer or freighter merely having use of a broker, who certifies to the authenticity of the
of the space in the vessel in return for his payment signatures of the contracting parties made in his
of the charter hire. presence, shall be full evidence in court; and if said
Although a charter party may transform a common signatures should not agree the ones identical with
carrier into a private one, the same however is not the signatures the broker must keep in his registry,
true in a contract of affreightment on account of if kept in accordance to law, shall be final.
the aforementioned distinctions between the two. The contracts shall also be admitted as evidence,
Thus, Coastwise, by the contract of affreightment, even though a broker has not taken part therein, if
was not converted into a private carrier, but the contracting parties acknowledge the signatures
remained a common carrier and was still liable as to be the same as their own.
such. Should no broker have taken part in the charter
party and should the signatures not have been
Owner Pro Hac Vice demise charter to whom acknowledged, doubts shall be decided by what is
the owner of the vessel has completely and provided for in the bill of lading, and in the absence
exclusively relinquished possession, command and thereof by the proofs submitted by the parties.
navigation of the vessel. In this kind of charter,
the charterer mans and equips the vessel and ARTICLE 655
assumes all responsibility for navigation, Charter parties executed by the captain in the
management and operation. He thus acts as the absence of the agent shall be valid and efficient,
owner of the vessel in all important aspects during even though in executing them he should have
the duration of the charter. acted in violation of the orders and instructions of
the agent or shipowner; but the latter shall have a
FORMS AND EFFECTS right of action against the captain to recover
damages.
Charter Parties
1. Forms and Effects of Charter Parties ARTICLE 656
If in the charter party the time in which the loading
ARTICLE 652 and unloading is to take place is not stated, the
A charter party must be drawn in duplicate and customs of the port where these acts take place
signed by the contracting parties, and when either shall be observed. After the period stipulated or the
does not know how or can not do so, by two customary one has passed, and should there not be
witnesses at their request. in the freight contract an express clause fixing the
The charter party shall include, besides the indemnification for the delay, the captain shall be
conditions unrestrictedly stipulated, the following entitled to demand demurrage for the usual and
statements: extra lay days which may have elapsed in loading
1. The kind, name, and tonnage of the vessel. and unloading.
2. Her flag and port of registry.
3. The name, surname, and domicile of the ARTICLE 657
captain. If during the voyage the vessel should be rendered
4. The name, surname, and domicile of the unseaworthy the captain shall be obliged to charter
agent, if the latter should make the charter party. another one at his expense, in good condition, to
5. The name, surname, and domicile of the take the cargo to its destination, for which purpose
charterer, and if he states that he is acting by he shall be obliged to look for a vessel not only at
commission, that of the person for whose account the port of arrival but in the other ports within a
he makes the contract. distance of 150 kilometers.
6. The port of loading and unloading. If the captain should not furnish a vessel to take
7. The capacity, number of tons or weight, or the cargo to its destination, either through
measure which they respectively bind themselves indolence or malice, the freighters, after a demand
to load and transport, or whether it is the total of the captain to charter a vessel within an
cargo. unextendible period, may charter one and apply to
8. The freightage to be paid, stating whether the judicial authority requesting that the charter
it is to be a fixed amount for the voyage or so party which may have been made be immediately
much per month, or for the space to be occupied, approved.
or for the weight or measure of the goods of which

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 238 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

The same authority shall judicially compel the If, on the contrary, there should be several charter
captain to confirm the charter made by the parties, and by reason of the want of space all the
shippers for his account and under his cargo contracted for can not be received, and none
responsibility. of the charterers desires to rescind the contract,
If the captain, notwithstanding his efforts, should preference shall be given to the person who has
not find a vessel to charter, he shall deposit the already loaded and arranged the freight in the
cargo at the disposal of the freighters, to whom he vessel, and the rest shall take the place
shall communicate the facts on the first opportunity corresponding to them in the order of the dates of
presenting itself, the charter being regulated in their contracts.
such cases by the distance covered by the vessel, Should there be no priority, the charterers may
there being no right to any indemnification load, if they wish, pro rata of the amounts of
whatsoever. weight or space they may have engaged, and the
person from whom the vessel was chartered shall
Is there a valid contract if there was no be obliged to indemnify them for the loss and
charter party and bill of lading? damage.
If we take Art. 653 literally, no. However, if we
take into account the fact that delivery of the cargo ARTICLE 670
does not constitute the making of a contract but If the person from whom the vessel is chartered,
rather the partial performance thereof, the mere after receiving a part of the freight, should not find
fact of delivery and receipt of such cargo, the good sufficient to make up at least three-fifths of the
faith and mutual consent with which they have amount which the vessel can hold, at the price he
been made, should be a better substitute for the may have fixed, he may substitute for the
chater party than the bill of lading which is nothing transportation another vessel inspected and
more than proof of such delivery. declared suitable for the same voyage, the
expenses of transfer being defrayed by him, as well
What is primage? as the increase, should there be any, in the price of
It was formerly a small allowance or compensation the charter. Should he not be able to make this
payable to the master and marines of a ship, to the change, the voyage shall be undertaken at the time
former for the use of his cables and ropes to agreed upon; and should no time have been fixed,
discharge the goods of the merchant; to the latter within fifteen days from the time of beginning to
for the lading and unlading in any port of haven. load, should nothing to the contrary have been
Today, it is no longer a gratuity but is included in stipulated.
the freight rate. If the owner of the part of the freight already
loaded should procure some more at the same
What is demurrage? price and under similar or proportionate conditions
It is the sum fixed by the contract of carriage, or to those accepted for the freight received, the
which is allowed, as remuneration to the owner of a person from whom the vessel is chartered or the
ship for the detention of his vessel beyond the captain can not refuse to accept the rest of the
number of days allowed by the charter party for cargo; and should he do so, the freighter shall have
loading and unloading of for sailing. It is an a right to demand that the vessel put to sea with
extended freight or reward to the vessel in the cargo she may have on board.
compensation for the earnings she is improperly
caused to lose. ARTICLE 671
After three-fifths of the vessel is loaded, the person
What are lay days? from whom she is chartered can not, without the
Lay days are days allowed to charter parties for consent of the charterers or freighters substitute
loading and unloading the cargo. the vessel designated in the charter party by
another one, under the penalty of making himself
RIGHTS AND OBLIGATIONS OF SHIPOWNERS thereby liable for all the losses and damages
occurring during the voyage to the cargo of the
2. Rights and Obligations of Owners person who did not consent to the change.
ARTICLE 669
The owners or the captain shall observe in charter ARTICLE 672
parties the capacity of the vessel or that expressly If the vessel has been chartered in whole, the
designated in the registry of the same, a difference captain can not, without the consent of the person
greater than 2 per cent between that stated and chartering her, accept freight from any other
her true capacity not being permissible. person; and should he do so, said charterer may
If the owners or the captain should contract to oblige him to unload it and require him to
carry a greater amount of cargo than the vessel indemnify him for the losses suffered thereby.
can hold, in view of her tonnage, they shall
indemnify the freighters whose contracts they do ARTICLE 673
not fulfill for the losses they may have caused them The person from whom the vessel is chartered shall
by reason of their default, according to the cases, be liable for all the losses caused the charterer by
viz: reason of the voluntary delay of the captain in
If the vessel has been chartered by one freighter putting to sea, according to the rules prescribed,
only, and there should appear to be an error or provided he has been requested to put to sea at
fraud in her capacity, and the charterer should not the proper time through a notary or judicially.
wish to rescind the contract, when he has a right to
do so, the charter should be reduced in proportion ARTICLE 674
to the cargo the vessel can not receive, the person If the charterer should carry to the vessel more
from whom the vessel is chartered being freight than that contracted for, the excess may be
furthermore obliged to indemnify the charterer for admitted in accordance with the price stipulated in
the losses he may have caused. the contract, if it can be well stowed without
injuring the other freighters, but if in order to stow

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 239 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

said freight it should be necessary to stow it in consider most convenient, without the captain
such manner as to throw the vessel out of trim the being allowed to refuse to receive on board the
captain must refuse it or unload it at the expense freight delivered by the second charterers,
of its owner. provided the conditions of the first charter are not
The captain may likewise, before leaving the port, changed, and that the person from whom the
unload the merchandise placed on board vessel is chartered be paid the full price agreed
clandestinely, or transport it, if he can do so and upon even though the full cargo is not embarked,
keep the vessel in trim, demanding by way of with the limitation established in the next article.
freightage the highest price which may have been cdtai
stipulated for said voyage.
ARTICLE 680
ARTICLE 675 A charterer who does not make up the full cargo he
If the vessel has been chartered to receive the bound himself to ship shall pay the freightage of
cargo in another port, the captain shall appear the amount he fails to ship, if the captain did not
before the consignee designated in the charter take other freight to make up the cargo of the
party, and, should the latter not deliver the cargo vessel, in which case he shall pay the first
to him, he shall inform the charterer and await his charterer the difference should there be any.
instructions, and in the meantime the lay days
agreed upon shall begin to run, or those allowed by ARTICLE 681
custom in the port, unless there is a special If the charterer should ship goods different from
agreement to the contrary. those indicated at the time of executing the charter
Should the captain not receive an answer within party, without the knowledge of the person from
the time necessary therefor, he shall make efforts whom the vessel was chartered or of the captain,
to find freight; and should he not find any after the and should thereby give rise to losses, by reason of
lay days and extra lay days have elapsed, he shall confiscation, embargo, detention, or other causes,
make a protest and return to the port where the to the person from whom the vessel was chartered
charter was made. or to the shippers, the person giving rise thereto
The charterer shall pay the freightage in full, shall be liable with the value of his shipment and
discounting that which may have been earned on furthermore with his property, for the full
the merchandise which may have been carried on indemnity to all those injured through his fault.
the voyage out or on the return trip, if carried for
the account of third persons. ARTICLE 682
The same shall be done if a vessel, having been If the merchandise shipped should have been for
chartered for the round trip, should not be given the purpose of illicit commerce, and was taken on
any cargo for her return. board with the knowledge of the person from whom
the vessel was chartered or of the captain, the
ARTICLE 676 latter, jointly with the owner of the same, shall be
The captain shall lose the freightage and shall liable for all the losses which may be caused the
indemnify the charterers if the latter should prove, other shippers, and even though it may have been
even against the certificate of inspection, should agreed, they can not demand any indemnity
one have taken place at the port of departure, that whatsoever of the charterer for the damage caused
the vessel was not in a condition to navigate at the the vessel.
time of receiving the cargo.
ARTICLE 683
ARTICLE 677 In case of making a port to repair the hull,
The charter party shall be enforced if the captain machinery, or equipment of the vessel, the
should not have any instructions from the freighters must wait until the vessel is repaired,
charterer, and a declaration of war or a blockade being permitted to unload her at their own expense
should take place during the voyage. should they deem it advisable.
In such case the captain shall be obliged to make If, for the benefit of the cargo subject to
the nearest safe and neutral port, and request and deterioration, the freighters or the court, or the
await orders from the freighter; and the expenses consul, or the competent authority in a foreign land
incurred and salaries earned during the detention should order the merchandise to be unloaded, the
shall be paid as general average. expenses of loading and unloading shall be for the
If, by orders of the freighter, the cargo should be account of the former.
discharged at the port of arrival, the freight for the
voyage out shall be paid in full. ARTICLE 684
If the charterer, without the occurrence of any of
ARTICLE 678 the cases of force majeure mentioned in the
If the time necessary, in the opinion of the judge or foregoing article, should wish to unload his
court, in which to receive orders from the freighters merchandise before arriving at the port of
should have elapsed without the captain having destination, he shall pay the full freight, the
received any instructions, the cargo shall be expenses of the stop made at his request, and the
deposited, and it shall be liable for the payment of losses and damages caused the other freighters,
the freight and expenses incurred by reason of the should there be any.
delay which shall be paid from the proceeds of the
part first sold. ARTICLE 685
In charters for transportation of general freight any
OBLIGATIONS OF CHARTERERS of the freighters may unload the merchandise
before the beginning of the voyage, by paying one-
3. Obligations of Charterers half the freight, the expense of stowing and
ARTICLE 679 restowing the cargo, and any other damage which
The charterer of an entire vessel may subcharter may be caused the other shippers.
the whole or part thereof for the amounts he may

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 240 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

ARTICLE 686 In such case the charterer must pay half the freight
After the vessel has been unloaded and the cargo stipulated besides the demurrage for the lay days
placed at the disposal of the consignee, the latter and extra lay days elapsed.
must immediately pay the captain the freight due 2. If the person from whom the vessel was
and the other expenses to which he may be liable chartered should sell her before the charterer has
for said cargo. begun to load her and the purchaser should load
The primage must be paid in the same proportion her for his own account.
and at the same time as the freight, all the In such case the vendor shall indemnify the
changes and modifications to which the latter charterer for the losses he may suffer.
should be subject also governing the former. If the new owner of the vessel should not load her
for his own account the charter party shall be
ARTICLE 687 respected, and the vendor shall indemnify the
The charters and freighters can not abandon purchaser if the former did not inform him of the
merchandise damaged on account of the inherent charter pending at the time of making the sale.
vice of the goods or by reason of an accidental
case, for the payment of the freight and other ARTICLE 690
expenses. aisadc The charter party shall be rescinded and all action
The abandonment shall be proper, however, if the arising therefrom shall be extinguished if, before
cargo should consist of liquids and should they the vessel puts to sea from the port of departure,
have leaked out, there not remaining in the any of the following cases should occur:
containers more than one-quarter of their contents. 1. A declaration of war or interdiction of
commerce with the power to whose ports the
RESCISSION vessel was going to sail.
2. A condition of blockade of the port of
4. Total or Partial Rescissions of Charter destination of said vessel, or the breaking out of an
Parties epidemic after the contract was executed.
ARTICLE 688 3. The prohibition to receive the merchandise
A charter party may be annulled at the request of of the vessel at the said port.
the charterer: 4. An indefinite detention, by reason of an
1. If before loading the vessel he should embargo of the vessel by order of the government
abandon the charter, paying half of the freightage or for any other reason independent of the will of
agreed upon. the agent.
2. If the capacity of the vessel should not 5. The impossibility of the vessel to navigate,
agree with that stated in the certificate of the without fault of the captain or agent.
tonnage, or if there is an error in the statement of The unloading shall be made for the account of the
the flag under which she sails. charterer.
3. If the vessel should not be placed at the ARTICLE 691
disposal of the charterer within the period and in If the vessel can not put to sea on account of the
the manner agreed upon. closing of the port of departure, or any other
4. If, after the vessel has put to sea, she temporary cause, the charter shall be in force
should return to the port of departure, on account without any of the contracting parties having a
of risk of pirates, enemies, or bad weather, and the right to claim damages.
freighters should agree to unload her. The subsistence and wages of the crew shall be
In the second and third cases the person from considered as general average.
whom the vessel was chartered shall indemnify the During the interruption the charterer may, at the
charterer for the losses he may suffer. proper time and for his own account, unload and
In the fourth case the person from whom the load the merchandise, paying demurrage if the
vessel was chartered shall have a right to the reloading should continue after the reason for the
freightage in full for the voyage out. detention has ceased.
If the charter should have been made by the
months, the charterers shall pay the full freightage ARTICLE 692
for one month, if the voyage were to a port in the A charter party shall be partially rescinded, unless
same waters, and two months, if the voyage were there is an agreement to the contrary, and the
to a port in different waters. captain shall only be entitled to the freight for the
From one port to another of the Peninsula and voyage out, if, by reason of a declaration of war,
adjacent islands, the freightage for one month only closing of ports, or interdiction of commercial
shall be paid. relations during the voyage, the vessel should
5. If a vessel should make a port during the make the port designated for such a case in the
voyage in order to make urgent repairs and the instructions of the charterer.
freighters should prefer to dispose of the 2. LOANS ON BOTTOMRY AND
merchandise. RESPONDENTIA29
When the delay does not exceed thirty days, the
freighters shall pay the full freight for the voyage Ordinary Loan Loan on Bottomry or
out. Respondentia
Should the delay exceed thirty days, they shall only
pay the freight in proportion to the distance Collateral is not Collateral required
covered by the vessel. required
Collateral may be any Collateral must be a
ARTICLE 689 property, real or vessel or cargo subject
At the request of the person from whom the vessel personal to maritime risks
is chartered the charter party may be rescinded: Absolutely repayable Depends upon the safe
1. If the charterer at the termination of the
extra lay days does not place the cargo alongside 29
The definitions of loan on bottomry and loan on
the vessel. respondentia were asked in 1980 and 1975.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 241 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

arrival at the port of made in the commercial registry, the contracts


the collateral of the made during the voyage of a vessel shall not have
loan any effect with regard to third persons, except from
Subject to usury law Not subject to usury the day and date of their entry.
law In order that the bonds of the contracts celebrated
Need not be in writing Must be in writing in accordance with No. 2 may have legal force,
except the interest they must conform to the registry of the broker
Need not be registered Must be registered in who took part therein. In those celebrated in
to be binding on third the registry of vessels accordance with No. 3 the acknowledgment of the
persons of the port of entry of signature must precede.
registry of the vessel Contracts which are not reduced to writing shall not
Loss of collateral does Loss of collateral be the basis for a judicial action.
not extinguish the extinguishes the same
same ARTICLE 721
In a bottomry or respondentia bond there must be
LOAN ON BOTTOMRY, DEFINED stated:
It is a contract in the nature of a mortgage, by 1. The kind, name, and registry of the vessel.
which the owner of the ship borrows money for the 2. The name, surname, and domicile of the
use, equipment and repair of the vessel for a captain.
definite term, and pledges the ship as a security for 3. The names, surnames, and domicile of the
its repayment, with maritime or extraordinary person giving and of the person receiving the loan.
interest on account of the maritime risks to be 4. The amount of the loan and the premium
borne by the lender, it being stipultaed that if the stipulated.
ship be lost in the course of the specific voyage or 5. The time for repayment.
during the limited time, by any of the perils 6. The goods pledged to secure repayment.
enumerated in the contract, the lender shall also 7. The voyage for which the risk is run.
lose his money.
ARTICLE 722
LOAN ON RESPONDENTIA, DEFINED The bonds may be issued to order, in which case
It is a contract made on the goods laden on board they shall be transferable by indorsement, and the
the hsip, and which are to be sold or exchanged in assignee shall acquire all the rights and run all the
the course of the voyage, the borrowers personal risks corresponding to the indorser.
responsibility being deemed the principal security
for the performance of the contract. The lender ON WHAT CONSTITUTED
must be paid his principal and interest, though the
ship perishes, provided that the goods are saved. ARTICLE 724
The loans may be constituted jointly or separately:
CHARACTER OF LOAN, ART. 719 1. On the hull of the vessel.
2. On the rigging.
ARTICLE 719 3. On the equipment, provisions, and fuel.
A loan on bottomry or respondentia shall be 4. On the engine, if the vessel is a steamer.
considered that which the repayment of the sum 5. On the cargo.
loaned and the premium stipulated, under any If the loan is constituted on the hull of the vessel,
condition whatsoever, depends on the safe arrival there shall be understood as also subject to the
in port of the goods on which it is made, or of their liability of the loan, the rigging, equipment and
value in case of accident. other goods, provisions, fuel, steam engines, and
the freight earned during the voyage subject to the
FORMS AND REQUISITES loan. cdta
If the loan is made on the cargo, all that
ARTICLE 720 constitutes the same shall be subject to the
Loans on bottomry or respondentia may be repayment; and if on a particular object of the
executed: vessel or of the cargo, the object exclusively and
1. By means of a public instrument. specifically mentioned only shall be liable.
2. By means of a bond signed by the
contracting parties and the broker who took part ARTICLE 725
therein. cdt No loans can be made on the salaries of the crew,
3. By means of a private instrument. nor on the profits which it is expected to earn.
Under whichever of these forms the contract is
executed, it shall be entered in the certificate of the AMOUNT
registry of the vessel and shall be recorded in the
commercial registry, without which requisites the ARTICLE 723
credits originating from the same shall not have, Loans made be made in goods and in merchandise,
with regard to other credits, the preference which, fixing their value in order to determine the principal
according to their nature, they should have, of the loan.
although the obligation shall be valid between the
contracting parties. ARTICLE 726
The contracts made during a voyage shall be If the lender should prove that he loaned a larger
governed by the provisions of Articles 583 and 611, amount than the value of the article liable for the
and shall be effective with regard to third persons bottomry loan, by reason of fraudulent measures
from the date of their execution, if they should be employed by the borrower the loan shall only be
recorded in the commercial registry of the port of valid for the amount at which said object is
registry of the vessel before eight days have appraised by experts.
elapsed from the date of her arrival. If said eight
days should elapse without the record having been

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 242 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

The surplus principal shall be returned with legal If while on voyage the captain should find it
interest for the whole period of the duration of the necessary to contract one or more obligations
disbursement. mentioned in subdivisions 8 and 9 of Article 580,
he shall apply to the judge or court if he is in
ARTICLE 727 Philippine territory, and otherwise to the consul of
If the full amount of the loan contracted to load the the Republic of the Philippines, should there be
vessel should not be made use of for the cargo, the one, and in his absence, to the judge or court or
surplus shall be returned before clearing. proper local authority, presenting the certificate of
The same procedure shall be observed with regard the registration sheet treated of in Article 612 and
to the goods taken as a loan if they could not all the instruments proving the obligation contracted.
have been loaded.
The judge or court, the consul, or the local
ARTICLE 728 authority, as the case may be, in view of the result
The loan which the captain takes at the point of of the proceedings instituted, shall make a
residence of the owners of the vessel shall only temporary memorandum of their result in the
affect that part of the latter which belongs to the certficate, in order that it may be recorded in the
captain, if the other owners or their agents should registry when the vessel returns to the port of its
not have given their express authorization thereto registry, or so that it can be admitted as a legal
or should not have taken part in the transaction. and preferred obligation in case of sale before its
If one or more of the owners should be requested return, by reason of the sale of the vessel on
to furnish the amount necessary to repair or account of a declaration of unseaworthiness.
provision the vessel, and should not do so within
twenty-four hours, the interest which the parties in EFFECTS OF CONTRACT
default may have in the vessel shall be liable for
the loan in the proper proportion. ARTICLE 719
Outside of the residence of the owners the captain A loan on bottomry or respondentia shall be
may contract loans in accordance with the considered that which the repayment of the sum
provisions of Articles 583 and 611. loaned and the premium stipulated, under any
condition whatsoever, depends on the safe arrival
BY WHOM in port of the goods on which it is made, or of their
value in case of accident.
ARTICLE 611
In order to comply with the obligations mentioned ARTICLE 726
in the foregoing article, the captain, when he has If the lender should prove that he loaned a larger
no funds and does not expect to receive any from amount than the value of the article liable for the
the agent, shall procure the same in the successive bottomry loan, by reason of fraudulent measures
order stated below: employed by the borrower the loan shall only be
1. By requesting said funds of the consignees valid for the amount at which said object is
or correspondents of a vessel. appraised by experts.
2. By applying to the consignees of the cargo The surplus principal shall be returned with legal
or to the persons interested therein. interest for the whole period of the duration of the
3. By drawing on the agent. disbursement.
4. By borrowing the amount required by
means of a bottomry bond. ARTICLE 727
5. By selling a sufficient amount of the cargo If the full amount of the loan contracted to load the
to cover the amount absolutely necessary to repair vessel should not be made use of for the cargo, the
the vessel, and to equip her to pursue the voyage. surplus shall be returned before clearing.
In the two latter cases he must apply to the judicial The same procedure shall be observed with regard
authority of the port, if in Spain * and to the to the goods taken as a loan if they could not all
Spanish * consul, if in a foreign country; and where have been loaded.
there should be none, to the local authority,
proceeding in accordance with the prescriptions of ARTICLE 729
Article 583, and with the provisions of the law of Should the goods on which money is taken not be
civil procedure. subjected to any risk, the contract shall be
considered an ordinary loan, the borrower being
ARTICLE 617 under the obligation to return the principal and
The captain can not contract loans on interest at the legal rate, if the interest stipulated
respondentia, and should he do so the contracts should not have been lower.
shall be void.
Neither can he borrow money on bottomry for his ARTICLE 730
own transactions, except on the portion of the Loans made during the voyage shall have
vessel he owns, provided no money has been preference over those made before the clearing of
previously borrowed on the whole vessel, and the vessel, and they shall be graduated by the
provided there does not exist any other kind of lien inverse order to that of their dates.
or obligation thereon. When he is permitted to do The loans for the last voyage shall have preference
so, he must necessarily state what interest he has over prior ones.
in the vessel. Should several loans have been made at a port
In case of violation of this article the principal, made under stress and for the same purpose, all of
interest, and costs shall be charged to the private them shall be paid pro rata.
account of the captain, and the agent may
furthermore have the right to discharge him.

ARTICLE 583

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 243 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

G. Bill of Lading30 from an examination of the cargo that they are


1. CONTENTS correct.
The expenses arising from the examination of the
ARTICLE 706 cargo shall be defrayed by the agent, without
The captain and the freighter of the vessel are prejudice to the right of action of the latter against
obliged to draft the bill of lading, in which there the first captain, if he ceased to be such through
shall be stated: his own fault. Should said examination not be
1. The name, registry, and tonnage of the made, it shall be understood that the new captain
vessel. accepts the cargo as it appears from the bills of
2. The name of the captain and his domicile. lading issued.
3. The port of loading and that of unloading.
4. The name of the shipper. 2. PROBATIVE VALUE
5. The name of the consignee, if the bill of
lading is issued to order. ARTICLE 709
6. The quantity, quality, number of packages, A bill of lading drawn up in accordance with the
and marks of the merchandise. provisions of this title shall be proof as between all
7. The freight and the primage stipulated. those interested in the cargo and between the
The bill of lading may be issued to bearer, to order, latter and the underwriters, proof to the contrary
or in the name of a specific person, and must be being reserved by the latter.
signed within twenty-four hours after the cargo has
been received on board, the freighter being able to ARTICLE 710
request the unloading thereof at the expense of the Should the bills of lading not agree, and there
captain should he not sign it, and in every case should not be observed any correction or erasure in
indemnity for the losses and damages suffered any of them, those possessed by the freighter or
thereby. consignee signed by the captain shall be proof
against the captain or agent in favor of the
ARTICLE 707 consignee or freighter; and those possessed by the
Four true copies of the original bill of lading shall be captain or agent signed by the freighter shall be
made, all of which shall be signed by the captain proof against the freighter or consignee in favor of
and by the freighter. Of these copies the freighter the captain or agent.
shall keep one and send another to the consignee;
the captain shall take two, one for himself and
another for the agent. H. Passengers on Sea Voyage
There may, furthermore, be made as many copies
of the bill of lading as may be considered necessary 1. NATURE OF CONTRACT
by the persons interested; but when they are
issued to order or to the bearer there shall be ARTICLE 695
stated in all the copies, be they either of the first The right to passage, if issued to a specified
four or of the subsequent ones, the destination of person, can not be transferred without the consent
each one, stating whether it is for the agent, for of the captain or of the consignee.
the captain, for the freighter, or for the consignee.
If the copy sent to the latter should be duplicated 2. OBLIGATIONS OF PASSENGERS
there must be stated in said duplicate this fact, and
that it is not valid except in case of the loss of the ARTICLE 693
first one. Should the passage price not have been agreed
upon, the judge or court shall summarily fix it,
ARTICLE 713 after a statement of experts.
If before delivering the cargo a new bill of lading
should be demanded of the captain, it being alleged ARTICLE 699
that the previous ones are not presented on After the contract has been rescinded, before or
account of their loss or for any other sufficient after the commencement of the voyage, the
cause, he shall be obliged to issue it, provided captain shall have a right to claim payment for
security for the value of the cargo is given to his what he may have furnished the passengers.
satisfaction; but without changing the consignment
and stating therein the circumstances prescribed in ARTICLE 704
the last paragraph of Article 707, when the bills of The captain, in order to collect the price of the
lading referred to therein are in question, under the passage and expenses of maintenance, may retain
penalty otherwise to be liable for said cargo if not the goods belonging to the passenger, and in case
properly delivered through his fault. of the sale of the same he shall be given preference
over the other creditors, acting in the same way as
ARTICLE 714 in the collection of freight.
If before the vessel puts to sea the captain should
die or should discontinue in his position through ARTICLE 694
any accident, the freighters shall have a right to Should the passenger not arrive on board at the
demand of the new captain the ratification of the time fixed, or should leave the vessel without
first bills of lading, and the latter must do so, permission from the captain, when the latter is
provided all the copies previously issued be ready to leave the port, the captain may continue
presented or returned to him, and it should appear the voyage and demand the full passage price.

ARTICLE 700
30
The presentation of the bill of lading and the In all that relates to the preservation of order and
liability of the ship owner when bill of lading is not police on board the vessel the passengers shall
presented were asked in 2005. In 1998 it definition conform to the orders given by the captain, without
and two-fold character was also asked. any distinction whatsoever.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 244 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

In case of the death of a passenger during the


3. RIGHTS OF PASSENGERS voyage the captain is authorized, with regard to the
body, to take the steps required by the
ARTICLE 697 circumstances, and shall carefully take care of the
If before beginning the voyage it should be papers and goods there may be on board belonging
suspended through the sole fault of the captain or to the passenger, observing the provisions of Case
agent, the passengers shall be entitled to have No. 10 of Article 612 with regard to members of
their passage refunded and to recover for losses the crew.
and damages; but if the suspension was due to an
accidental cause, or to force majeure, or to any ARTICLE 612
other cause beyond the control of the captain or The following obligations are inherent in the office
agent, the passengers shall only be entitled to the of captain:
return of the passage money. 1. To have on board before starting on a
voyage a detailed inventory of the hull, engines,
ARTICLE 698 rigging, tackle, stores, and other equipments of
In case a voyage already begun should be the vessel; the navigation certificate; the roll of the
interrupted the passengers shall be obliged only to persons who make up the crew of the vessel, and
pay the passage in proportion to the distance the contracts entered into with the crew; the list of
covered, and shall not be entitled to recover for passengers; the health certificate; the certificate of
losses and damages if the interruption is due to an the registry proving the ownership of the vessel,
accidental cause or to force majeure, but have a and all the obligations which encumber the same
right to indemnity if the interruption should have up to that date; the charters or authenticated
been caused by the captain exclusively. If the copies thereof; the invoices or manifest of the
interruption should be by reason of the disability of cargo, and the instrument of the expert visit or
the vessel, and the passenger should agree to inspection, should it have been made at the port of
await her repair, he can not be required to pay any departure.
increased price of passage, but his living expenses 2. To have a copy of this Code on board.
during the delay shall be for his own account. 3. To have three folioed and stamped books,
In case the departure of the vessel is delayed the placing at the beginning of each one a note of the
passengers have a right to remain on board and to number of folios it contains, signed by the maritime
be furnished with food for the account of the official, and in his absence by the competent
vessel, unless the delay is due to an accidental authority.
cause or to force majeure. If the delay should In the first book, which shall be called "log book,"
exceed ten days, the passengers who request it he shall enter every day the condition of the
shall be entitled to the return of the passage; and if atmosphere, the prevailing winds, the course
it were due exclusively to the captain or agent they sailed, the rigging carried, the horsepower of the
may furthermore demand indemnity for losses and engines, the distance covered, the maneuvers
damages. executed, and other incidents of navigation. He
A vessel which is exclusively destined to the shall also enter the damage suffered by the vessel
transportation of passengers must take them in her hull, engines, rigging, and tackle, no matter
directly to the port or ports of destination, no what is its cause, as well as the imperfections and
matter what the number of passengers may be, averages of the cargo, and the effects and
making all the stops indicated in her itinerary. consequence of the jettison, should there be any;
and in cases of grave resolutions which require the
4. RESPONSIBILITIES OF CAPTAIN advice or a meeting of the officers of the vessel, or
even of the passengers and crew, he shall record
ARTICLE 701 the decision adopted. For the informations
The convenience or the interest of the passengers indicated he shall make use of the binnacle book,
shall not obligate nor empower the captain to stand and of the steam or engine book kept by the
in shore or enter places which may take the vessel engineer.
out of her course, nor to remain in the ports he In the second book, called the "accounting book,"
must or is under the necessity of touching for a he shall enter all the amounts collected and paid
period longer than that required for the business of for the account of the vessel, entering specifically
the navigation. article by article, the sources of the collection, and
the amounts invested in provisions, repairs,
ARTICLE 702 acquisition of rigging or goods, fuel, outfits, wages,
In the absence of an agreement to the contrary, it and all other expenses. He shall furthermore enter
shall be understood that the maintenance of the therein a list of all the members of the crew,
passengers during the voyage is included in the stating their domiciles, their wages and salaries,
price of the passage; but should said maintenance and the amounts they may have received on
be for the account of the latter, the captain shall be account, either directly or by delivery to their
under the obligation, in case of necessity, to families.
furnish them the victuals at a reasonable price In the third book, called "freight book," he shall
necessary for their maintenance. record the entry and exit of all the goods, stating
their marks and packages, names of the shippers
ARTICLE 703 and of the consignees, ports of loading and
A passenger shall be looked upon as a shipper in so unloading, and the freight earned. In the same
far as the goods he carries on board are concerned, book he shall record the names and places of
and the captain shall not be liable for what said sailing of the passengers and the number of
passenger may preserve under his immediate and packages of which their baggage consists, and the
special custody unless the damage arises from an price of the passage.
act of the captain or of the crew. 4. To make, before receiving the freight, with
the officers of the crew, and the two experts, if
ARTICLE 705 required by the shippers and passengers, an

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 245 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

examination of the vessel, in order to ascertain thereof, taking advantage of the semaphore,
whether she is watertight, and whether the rigging telegraph, mail, etc., according to the cases; notify
and engines are in good condition; and if she has him the freight he may have received, stating the
the equipment required for good navigation, name and domicile of the shippers, freight earned,
preserving a certificate of the memorandum of this and amounts borrowed on bottomry bond, advise
inspection, signed by all the persons who may have him of his departure, and give him any information
taken part therein, under their liability. and data which may be of interest.
The experts shall be appointed one by the captain 13. To observe the rules on the situation of
of the vessel and the other one by the persons who lights and evolutions to prevent collisions.
request the examination, and in case of 14. To remain on board in case of danger to
disagreement a third shall be appointed by the the vessel, until all hope to save her is lost, and
marine authority of the port. before abandoning her to hear the officers of the
5. To remain constantly on board the vessel crew, abiding by the decision of the majority; and if
with the crew during the time the freight is taken he should have to take a boat he shall take with
on board and carefully watch the stowage thereof; him, before anything else, the books and papers,
not to consent to any merchandise or goods of a and then the articles of most value, being obliged
dangerous character to be taken on, such as to prove in case of the loss of the books and papers
inflammable or explosive substances, without the that he did all he could to save them.
precautions which are recommended for their 15. In case of wreck he shall make the proper
packing, management and isolation; not to permit protest in due form at the first port reached, before
that any freight be carried on deck which by reason the competent authority or the Spanish * consul,
of its disposition, volume, or weight makes the within twenty-four hours, stating therein all the
work of the sailors difficult, and which might incidents of the wreck, in accordance with case 8 of
endanger the safety of the vessel; and if, on this article.
account of the nature of the merchandise, the 16. To comply with the obligations imposed by
special character of the shipment, and principally the laws and rules of navigation, customs, health,
the favorable season it takes place, he allows and others.
merchandise to be carried on deck, he must hear
the opinion of the officers of the vessel, and have I. Carriage of Goods by Sea Act
the consent of the shippers and of the agent. (Commonwealth Act No. 65; Public Act No. 65;
6. To demand a pilot at the expense of the Public Act 521, 74th US Congress)
vessel whenever required by navigation, and
principally when a port, canal, or river, or a CA No. 65 ACT TO DECLARE THAT
roadstead or anchoring place is to be entered with PUBLIC ACT NUMBERED FIVE HUNDRED AND
which neither he, the officers nor the crew are TWENTY-ONE, KNOWN AS "CARRIAGE OF
acquainted. GOODS BY SEA ACT," ENACTED BY THE
7. To be on deck at the time of sighting land SEVENTY-FOURTH CONGRESS OF THE UNITED
and to take command on entering and leaving STATES, BE ACCEPTED, AS IT IS HEREBY
ports, canals, roadsteads, and rivers, unless there ACCEPTED BY THE NATIONAL ASSEMBLY
is a pilot on board discharging his duties. He shall
not spend the night away from the vessel except WHEREAS, the Seventy-fourth Congress of the
for serious causes or by reason of official business. United States enacted Public Act Numbered Five
cdtai hundred and twenty-one, entitled:
8. To present himself, when making a port in
"Carriage of Goods by Sea Act";
distress, to the maritime authority if in Spain * and
WHEREAS, the primordial purpose of the said Acts
to the Spanish * consul if in a foreign country,
is to bring about uniformity in ocean bills of lading
before twenty-four hours have elapsed, and make
and to give effect to the Brussels Treaty, signed by
a statement of the name, registry, and port of
the United States with other powers;
departure of the vessel, of its cargo, and reason of
WHEREAS, the Government of the United States
arrival, which declaration shall be vised by the
has left it to the Philippine Government to decide
authority or by the consul if after examining the
whether or not the said Act shall apply to carriage
same it is found to be acceptable, giving the
of goods by sea in foreign trade to and from
captain the proper certificate in order to show his
Philippine ports;
arrival under stress and the reasons therefor. In
WHEREAS, the said Act of Congress contains
the absence of marine officials or of the consul, the
advanced legislation, which is in consonance with
declaration must be made before the local
modern maritime rules and the practices of the
authority.
great shipping countries of the world;
9. To take the steps necessary before the
WHEREAS, shipping companies, shippers, and
competent authority in order to enter in the
marine insurance companies, and various
certificate of the Commercial Registry of the vessel
chambers of commerce, which are directly affected
the obligations which he may contract in
by such legislation, have expressed their desire
accordance with Article 583.
that said Congressional Act be made applicable and
10. To put in a safe place and keep all the
extended to the Philippines; therefore,
papers and belongings of any members of the crew
Be it enacted by the National Assembly of the
who might die on the vessel, drawing up a detailed
Philippines:
inventory, in the presence of passengers as
Section 1
witnesses, and, in their absence, of members of the
That the provisions of Public Act Numbered Five
crew.
hundred and twenty-one of the Seventy-fourth
11. To conduct himself according to the rules
Congress of the United States, approved on April
and precepts contained in the instructions of the
sixteenth, nineteen hundred and thirty-six, be
agent, being liable for all that he may do in
accepted, as it is hereby accepted to be made
violation thereof.
applicable to all contracts for the carriage of goods
12. To give an account to the agent from the
by sea to and from Philippine ports in foreign trade:
port where the vessel arrives, of the reason

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 246 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Provided, That nothing in the Act shall be construed uncovered, or on the cases or coverings in which
as repealing any existing provision of the Code of such goods are contained, in such a manner as
Commerce which is now in force, or as limiting its should ordinarily remain legible until the end of the
application. voyage.
Section 2 (b) Either the number of packages or pieces, or the
This Act shall take effect upon its approval. quantity or weight, as the case may be, as
Approved: October 22,1936. furnished in writing by the shipper.
An Act Relating to the Carriage of Goods by Sea. (c) The apparent order and condition of the goods:
Be it enacted by the Senate and House of Provided, That no carrier, master, or agent of the
Representatives of the United States of America in carrier, shall be bound to state or show in the bill of
Congress assembled, That every bill of landing or lading any marks, number, quantity, or weight
similar document of title which is evidence of a which he has reasonable ground for suspecting not
contract for the carriage of goods by sea to or from accurately to represent the goods actually received,
ports of the United States, in foreign trade, shall or which he has had no reasonable means of
have effect subject to the provisions of the Act. checking.
(4) Such a bill of lading shall be prima facie
TITLE I evidence of the receipt by the carrier of the goods
Section 1 as therein described in accordance with paragraphs
When used in this Act (3) (a), (b), and (c) of this section: Provided, That
(a) The term "carrier" includes the owner or the nothing in this Act shall be construed as repealing
charterer who enters into a contract of carriage or limiting the application of any part of the Act, as
with a shipper. amended, entitled "An Act relating to bills of lading
(b) The term "contract of carriage" applies only to in interstate and foreign commerce," approved
contracts of carriage covered by a bill of lading or August 29, 1916 (U. S. C. title 49, secs. 81-124),
any similar document of title, insofar as such commonly known as the "Pomerene Bills of Lading
document relates to the carriage of goods by sea, Act."
including any bill of lading or any similar document (5) The shipper shall be deemed to have
as aforesaid issued under or pursuant to a charter guaranteed to the carrier the accuracy at the time
party from the moment at which such bill of lading of shipment of the marks, number, quantity, and
or similar document of title regulates the relations weight, as furnished by him; and the shipper shall
between a carrier and a holder of the same. indemnify the carrier against all loss damages, and
(c) The term "goods" includes goods, wares, expenses arising or resulting from inaccuracies in
merchandise, and articles of every kind such particulars. The right of the carrier to such
whatsoever, except live animals and cargo which indemnity shall in no way limit his responsibility
by the contract of carriage is stated as being and liability under the contract of carriage or to any
carried on deck and is so carried. person other than the shipper.
(d) The term "ship" means any vessel used for the (6) Unless notice of loss or damage and the general
carriage of goods by sea. nature of such loss or damage be given in writing
(e) The term "carriage of goods" covers the period to the carrier or his agent at the port of discharge
from the time when the goods are loaded on to the before or at the time of the removal of the goods
time when they are discharged from the ship. into the custody of the person entitled to delivery
RISKS thereof under the contract of carriage, such
Section 2 removal shall be prima facie evidence of the
Subject to the provisions of section 6, under every delivery by the carrier of the goods as described in
contract of carriage of goods by sea, the carrier in the bill of lading. If the loss or damage is not
relation to the loading handling, stowage, carriage, apparent, the notice must be given within three
custody, care, and discharge of such goods, shall days of the delivery.
be subject to the responsibilities and liabilities and Said notice of loss or damage maybe endorsed
entitled to the rights and immunities hereinafter set upon the receipt for the goods given by the person
forth. taking delivery thereof.
The notice in writing need not be given if the state
RESPONSIBILITIES AND LIABILITIES of the goods has at the time of their receipt been
Section 3 the subject of joint survey or inspection.
1) The carrier shall be bound, before and at the In any event the carrier and the ship shall be
beginning of the voyage, to exercise due diligence discharged from all liability in respect of loss or
to damage unless suit is brought within one year after
(a) Make the ship seaworthy; delivery of the goods or the date when the goods
(b) Properly man, equip, and supply the ship; should have been delivered: Provided, That if a
(c) Make the holds, refrigerating and cooling notice of loss or damage, either apparent or
chambers, and all other parts of the ship in which concealed, is not given as provided for in this
goods are carried, fit and safe for their reception section, that fact shall not affect or prejudice the
carriage and preservation. right of the shipper to bring suit within one year
(2) The carrier shall properly and carefully load, after the delivery of the goods or the date when
handle, stow, carry, keep, care for, and discharge the goods should have been delivered
the goods carried. In the case of any actual or apprehended loss or
(3) After receiving the goods into his charge the damage the carrier and the receiver shall give all
carrier, or the master or agent of the carrier, shall, reasonable facilities to each other for inspecting
on demand of the shipper, issue to the shipper a and tallying the goods.
bill of lading showing among other things (7) After the goods are loaded the bill of lading to
(a) The leading marks necessary for identification be issued by the carrier, master, or agent of the
of the goods as the same are furnished in writing carrier to the shipper shall, if the shipper so
by the shipper before the loading of such goods demands, be a "shipped" bill of lading Provided,
starts, provided such marks are stamped or That if the shipper shall have previously taken up
otherwise shown clearly upon the goods if any document of title to such goods, he shall

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 247 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

surrender the same as against the issue of the the benefit of this exception to show that neither
"shipped" bill of lading, but at the option of the the actual fault or privity of the carrier nor the fault
carrier such document of title may be noted at the or neglect of the agents or servants of the carrier
port of shipment by the carrier, master, or agent contributed to the loss or damage.
with name or name the names of the ship or ships (3) The shipper shall not be responsible for loss or
upon which the goods have been shipped and the damage sustained by the carrier or the ship arising
date or dates of shipment, and when so noted the from any cause without the act, fault, or neglect of
same shall for the purpose of this section be the shipper, his agents, or servants.
deemed to constitute a "shipped" bill of lading. (4) Any deviation in saving or attempting to save
(8) Any clause, covenant, or agreement in a life or property at sea, or any reasonable deviation
contract of carriage relieving the carrier or the ship shall not be deemed to be an infringement or
from liability for loss or damage to or in connection breach of this Act or of the contract of carriage,
with the goods, arising from negligence, fault, or and the carrier shall not be liable for any loss or
failure in the duties and obligations provided in this damage resulting therefrom: Provided, however,
section, or lessening such liability otherwise than That if the deviation is for the purpose of loading
as provided in this Act, shall be null and void and of cargo or unloading cargo or passengers it shall,
no effect. A benefit of insurance in favor of the prima facie, be regarded as unreasonable.
carrier, or similar clause, shall be deemed to be a (5) Neither the carrier nor the ship shall in any
clause relieving the carrier from liability. event be or become liable for any loss or damage
to or in connection with the transportation of goods
RIGHTS AND IMMUNITIES in an amount exceeding $600 per package lawful
Section 4 money of the United States, or in case of goods not
(1) Neither the carrier nor the ship shall be liable shipped in packages, per customary freight unit, or
for loss or damage arising or resulting from the equivalent of that sum in other currency,
unseaworthiness unless caused by want of due unless the nature and value of such goods have
diligence on the part of the carrier to make the ship been declared by the shipper before shipment and
seaworthy, and to secure that the ship is properly inserted in the bill of lading. This declaration, if
manned, equipped, and supplied, and to make to embodied in the bill of lading, shall be prima facie
the holds, refrigerating and cool chambers, and all evidence, but shall not be conclusive on the carrier.
other parts of the ship in which goods are carried By agreement between the carrier, master, or
fit and safe for their reception, carriage, and agent of the carrier, and the shipper another
preservation in accordance with the provisions of maximum amount than that mentioned in this
paragraph (1) of section 3. Whenever loss or paragraph may be fixed: Provided, That such
damage has resulted from unseaworthiness, the maximum shall not be less than the figure above
burden of proving the exercise of due diligence named. In no event shall the carrier be liable for
shall be on the carrier or other persons claiming more than the amount of damage actually
exemption under the section. sustained.
(2) Neither the carrier nor the ship shall be Neither the carrier nor the ship shall be responsible
responsible for loss or damage arising or resulting in any event for loss or damage to or in connection
from with the transportation of the goods if the nature or
(a) Act, neglect, or default of the master, mariner, value thereof has been knowingly and fraudulently
pilot, or the servants of the carrier in the misstated by the shipper in the bill of lading.
navigation or in the management of the ship; (6) Goods of an inflammable, explosive, or
(b) Fire, unless caused by the actual fault or privity dangerous nature to the shipment whereof the
of the carrier; carrier, master or agent of the carrier, has not
(c) Perils, dangers, and accidents of the sea or consented with knowledge of their nature and
other navigable waters; character, may at any time before discharge be
(d) Act of God; landed at any place or destroyed or rendered
(e) Act of war, innocuous by the carrier without compensation,
(f) Act of public enemies; and the shipper of such goods shall be liable for all
(g) Arrest or restraint of princes, rulers, or people, damages and expenses directly or indirectly arising
or seizure under legal process; out of or resulting from such shipment. If any such
(h) Quarantine restrictions; goods shipped with such knowledge and consent
(i) Act or omission of the shipper or owner of the shall become a danger to the ship or cargo, they
goods, his agent or representative; may in like manner be landed at any place, or
(j) Strikes or lockouts or stoppage or restraint of destroyed or rendered innocuous by the carrier
labor from whatever cause, whether partial or without liability on the part of the carrier except to
general; Provided, That nothing herein contained general average, if any.
shall be construed to relieve a carrier from
responsibility for the carrier's own acts; SURRENDER OF RIGHTS AND IMMUNITIES
(k) Riots and civil commotions AND INCREASE OF RESPONSIBILITIES AND
(l) Saving or attempting to save life or property at LIABILITIES
sea; Section 5
(m) Wastage in bulk or weight or any other loss or A carrier shall be at liberty to surrender in whole or
damage arising from inherent defect, quality, or in part all or any of his rights and immunities or to
vice of the goods; increase any of his responsibilities and liabilities
(n) Insufficiency of packing; under this Act, provided such surrender or increase
(o) Insufficiency of inadequacy of marks; shall be embodied in the bill of lading issued to the
(p) Latent defects not discoverable by due shipper.
diligence; and The provisions of this Act shall not be applicable to
(q) Any other cause arising without the actual fault charter parties; but if bills of lading are issued in
and privity of the carrier and without the fault or the case of a ship under charter party, they shall
neglect of the agents or servants of the carrier, but comply with the terms of this Act. Nothing in this
the burden of proof shall be on the person claiming Act shall be held to prevent the insertion in a bill of

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 248 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

lading of any lawful provision regarding general goods by sea, such bill of lading shall be subject to
average. the provisions of the Carriage of Goods by Sea
Act."
SPECIAL CONDITIONS Section 11
Section 6 Where under the customs of any trade the weight
Notwithstanding the provisions of the preceding of any bulk cargo inserted in the bill of lading is a
sections, a carrier, master or agent of the carrier, weight ascertained or accepted by a third party
and a shipper shall, in regard to any particular other than the carrier or the shipper, and the fact
goods be at liberty to enter into any agreement in that the weight is so ascertained or accepted is
any terms as to the responsibility and liability of stated in the bill of lading, then, notwithstanding
the carrier for such goods, and as to the rights and any thing in this Act, the bill of lading shall not be
immunities of the carrier in respect of such goods, deemed to be prima facie evidence against the
or his obligation as to seaworthiness (so far as the carrier of the receipt of goods of the weight so
stipulation regarding seaworthiness is not contrary inserted in the bill of lading, and the accuracy
to public policy), or the care or diligence of his thereof at the time of shipment shall not be
servants or agents in regard to the loading, deemed to have been guaranteed by the shipper.
handling stowage, carriage, custody, care, and Section 12
discharge of the goods carried by sea: Provided, Nothing in this Act shall be construed as
That in this case no bill of lading has been or shall superseding any part of the Act entitled "An act
be issued and that the terms agreed shall be relating to navigation of vessels, bills of lading, and
embodied in a receipt which shall be a non- to certain obligations, duties, and rights in
negotiable document and shall be marked as such. connection with the carriage of property," approved
Any agreement so entered into shall have full legal February 13,1893, or of any other law which would
effect: Provided, That this section shall not apply to be applicable in the absence of this Act, insofar as
ordinary commercial shipments made in the they relate to the duties, responsibilities, and
ordinary course of trade but only to other liabilities of the ship or carrier prior to the time
shipments where the character or condition of the when the goods are loaded on or after the time
property to be carried or the circumstances, terms, they are discharged from the ship.
and conditions under which the carriage is to be Section 13
performed are such as reasonably to justify a This Act shall apply to all contracts for carriage of
special agreement. goods by sea to or from ports of the United States
Section 7 in foreign trade. As used in this Act the term
Nothing contained in this Act shall prevent a carrier "United States" includes its districts, territories, and
or a shipper from entering into any agreement, possessions: Provided, however, That the Philippine
stipulation, condition, reservation, or exemption as legislature may by law exclude its application to
to the responsibility and liability of the carrier or transportation to or from ports of the Philippine
the ship for the loss or damage to or in connection Islands. The term "foreign trade" means the
with the custody and care and handling of goods transportation of goods between the ports of the
prior to the loading on and subsequent to the United States and ports of foreign countries.
discharge from the ship on which the goods are Nothing in this Act shall be held to apply to
carried by sea. contracts for carriage of goods by sea between any
Section 8 port of the United States or its possessions, and
The provisions of this Act shall not affect the rights any other port of the United States or its
and obligations of the carrier under the provisions possession: Provided, however, That any bill of
of the Shipping Act, 1916, or under the provisions lading or similar document of title which is evidence
of section 4281 to 4289, inclusive, of the Revised of a contract for the carriage of goods by sea
Statutes of the United States, or of any between such ports, containing an express
amendments thereto; or under the provisions of statement that it shall be subject to the provisions
any other enactment for the time being in force of this Act, shall be subjected hereto as fully as if
relating to the limitation of the liability of the subject hereto as fully as if subject hereto by the
owners of seagoing vessels. express provisions of this Act: Provided, further,
That every bill of lading or similar document of title
which is evidence of a contract for the carriage of
goods by sea from ports of the United States, in
TITLE II foreign trade, shall contain a statement that it shall
Section 9 have effect subject to the provisions of this Act.
Nothing contained in this Act shall be construed as Section 14
permitting a common carrier by water to Upon the certification of the Secretary of
discriminate between competing shippers similarly Commerce that the foreign commerce of the United
place in time and circumstances, either (a) with States in its competition with that of foreign
respect to the right to demand and receive bills of nations is prejudiced the provisions, or any of
lading subject to the provisions of this Act; or (b) them, of Title I of this Act, or by the laws of any
when issuing such bills of lading, either in the foreign country or countries relating to the carriage
surrender of any of the carrier's rights and of goods by sea, the President of the United States,
immunities or in the increase of any of the carrier's may, from time to time, by proclamation, suspend
responsibilities and liabilities pursuant to section 6, any or all provisions of Title I of this Act for such
title I, of this Act or (c) in any other way prohibited periods of time or indefinitely as may be
by the Shipping Act, 1916, s amended. designated in the proclamation. The President may
Section 10 at any time rescind such suspension of Title I
Section 25 of the Interstate Commerce Act is hereof, and any provisions thereof which may have
hereby amended by adding the following proviso at been suspended shall thereby be reinstated and
the end of paragraph 4 thereof: "Provided, again apply to contracts thereafter made for the
however, That insofar as any bill of lading carriage of goods by sea. Any proclamation of
authorized hereunder relates to the carriage of suspension or rescission of any such suspension

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 249 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

shall take effect on a date named therein, which Subject to the provisions of Section 6, under every
date shall be not less than ten days from the issue contract of carriage of goods by sea, the carrier in
of the proclamation. relation to the loading, handling, stowage, carriage,
Any contract for the carriage of goods by sea, custody, care, and discharge of such goods shall be
subject to the provisions of this Act, effective subject to the responsibilities and liabilities and
during any period when title I hereof, or any part entitled to the rights and immunities hereinafter set
thereof, is suspended, shall be subject to all forth..
provisions of law now or hereafter applicable to
that part of Title I which may have thus been RESPONSIBILITIES AND LIABILITIES
suspended. Sec. 3
Section 15 (1) The carrier shall be bound before and at the
This Act shall take effect ninety days after the date beginning of the voyage to exercise due diligence
of its approval; but nothing in this Act shall apply to
during a period not to exceed one year following its (a) Make the ship seaworthy;
approval to any contract for the carriage of goods (b) Properly man,equip, and supply the ship;
by sea, made before the date on which this Act is (c) Make the holds, refrigerating and cooling
approved, nor to any bill of lading or similar chambers, and all other parts of the ship in which
document of title issued, whether before or after goods are carried, fit and safe for their reception,
such date of approval in pursuance of any such carriage, and preservation.
contract as aforesaid. (2) The carrier shall properly and carefully
Section 16 load, handle, stow, carry, keep, care for,and
This Act may be cited as the "Carriage of Goods by discharge the goods carried.
Sea Act." (3) After receiving the goods into his carrier, or
Approved, April 16, 1936. the master or agent of the carrier, shall, on
demand of the shipper, issue to the shipper a bill of
lading showing among other things .
PUBLIC ACT 521 CARRIAGE OF (a) The loading marks necessary for
GOODS BY SEA ACT identification of the goods as the same are
furnished in writing by the shipper before the
Section 1 loading of such goods starts, provided such
That the provisions of Public Act No. 521 of the 7th marksare stamped or otherwise shown clearly upon
Congress of the United States, approved on April the goods if uncovered,in such a manner as should
16, 1936, be accepted, as it is hereby accepted to ordinarily remain legible until the end of the
be made applicable to all contracts for the carriage voyage..
of goods by sea to and from Philippine ports in (b) Either the number of packages or pieces, or
foreign trade: Provided, that nothing in this Act the quantity or weight, as the casemay be, as
shall be construed as repealing any existing furnished in writing by the shipper.
provision of the Code of Commerce which is now in (c) The apparent order and conditions of the
force, or as limiting its application. . goods: Provided, that no carrier, master, or agent
of the carrier, shall be bound to state or show in
Sec. 2 the bill of lading any marks, number, quantity, or
This Act shall take effect upon its approval. weight which he has reasonable ground for
(Approved October 22, 1936). suspecting not accurately to represent the good
actually received or which he has had no
TITLE I reasonable means of checking..
Sec. 1 (4) Such a bill of lading shall be prima facie
When used in this Act . evidence of the receipt by the carrier of the goods
(a) The term "carrier" includes the owner or as therein described in accordance with paragraphs
the charterer who enters into a contract of carriage (3) (a), (b), and (c), of this section: (The rest of
with a shipper. the provision is not applicable to the Philippines).
(b) The term "contract of carriage" applies only (5) The shipper shall be deemed to have
to contracts of carriage by covered by a bill of guaranteed to the carrier the accuracy at the time
lading or any similar document of title, insofar as of shipment of the marks, number, quantity, and
such document relates to the carriage of goods by weight, as furnished by him; and the shipper shall
sea, including any bill of lading or any similar indemnify the carrier against all loss, damages, and
document as aforesaid issued under or pursuant to expenses arising or resulting from inaccuracies in
a character party from the moment at which such such particulars. The right of the carrier to such
bill of lading or similar document of title regulates indemnity shall in no way limit his responsibility
the relations between a carrier and a holder of the and liability under the contract of carriage to any
same. . person other than the shipper..
(c) The term "goods" includes goods, wares, (6) Unless notice or loss or damage and the
merchandise, and articles of every kind general nature of such loss or damage by given in
whatsoever, except live animals and cargo which writing to the carrier or his agent at the port of
by the contract of carriage is stated as being discharge or at the time of the removal of the
carried on deck and is so carried.. goods into the custody of the person entitled to
(d) The term "ship" means any vessel used for delivery thereof under the contract of carriage,
the carriage of goods by sea.. such removal shall be prima facie evidence of the
(e) The term "carriage of goods" covers the delivery by the carrier of the goods as described in
period from the time when the goods are loaded to the bill of lading. If the loss or damage is not
the time when they are discharged from the ship. apparent, the notice must be given within three
days of the delivery..
RISKS Said notice of loss or damage may be endorsed
Sec. 2 upon the receipt for the goods given by the person
taking delivery thereof.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 250 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

The notice in writing need not be given if the state (g) Arrest or restraint of princes, rulers, or
of the goods has at the time of their receipt been people, or seizure under legal process;
the subject of joint survey or inspection. (h) Quarantine restrictions;.
In any event the carrier and the ship shall be (i) Act or omission of the shipper or owner of
discharged from all liability in respect of loss or the goods, his agent or representative;.
damage unless suit is brought within one year after (j) Strikes or lockouts or stoppage or restraint
delivery of the goods or the date when the goods of labor from whatever cause, whether partial or
should have been delivered: Provided, that, if a general: Provided, that nothing herein contained
notice of loss or damage, either apparent or shall be construed to relieve a carrier from
concealed, is not given as provided for in this responsibility for the carrier's own acts;.
section, that fact shall not affect or prejudice the (k) Riotsand civil commotions;.
right of the shipper to bring suit within one year (l) Saving or attempting to save life or
after the delivery of the goods or the date when property at sea;.
the goods should have been delivered. (m) Wastage in bulk or weight or any other loss
In the case of any actual or apprehended loss or or damage arising from inherent defect, quality, or
damage, the carrier and the receiver shall give all vice of the goods;
reasonable facilities to each other for inspecting (n) Insufficiency or packing;
and tallying the goods.. (o) Insufficiency or inadequacy of marks;.
(7) After the goods are loaded the bill of lading (p) Latent defects not discoverable by due
to be issued by the carrier, master, or agent of the diligence; and.
carrier to the shipper shall if the shipper so (q) Any other cause arising without the actual
demands, be a "shipped" bill of lading: Provided, fault and privity of the carrier and without the fault
that if the shipper shall have previously taken up or neglect of the agents or servants of the carrier,
any document of title to such goods, he shall but the burden of proof shall be on the person
surrender the same as against the issue of the claiming the benefit of this exception to show that
"shipped" bill of lading, but at the option of the neither the actual fault or privity of the carrier nor
carrier such document of title may be noted at the the fault or neglect of the agents or servants of the
port of shipment by the carrier, master, or agent carrier contributed to the loss or damage.
with the name or names of the ship or ships upon (3) The shipper shall not be responsible for loss
which the goods have been shipped and the date or or damage sustained by the carrier or the ship
dates of shipment, and when so noted the same arising or resulting from any cause without the act,
shall for the purpose of this section be deemed to or neglect of the shipper, his agents, or his
constitute a "shipped" bill of lading. servants..
(8) Any clause, covenant, or agreement in a (4) Any deviation in saving or attempting to
contract of carriage relieving the carrier of the ship save life or property at sea, or any reasonable
from liability for loss or damage to or in connection deviation shall not be deemed to be an
with the goods, arising from negligence, fault, or infringement or breach or this Act or of the contract
failure in the duties and obligations provide in this of carriage, and carrier shall not be liable for any
section or lessening such liability otherwise than as loss or damage resulting therefrom: Provided,
provided in this Act, shall be null and void and of however, that if the deviation is for the purpose of
no effect. A benefit of insurance in favor of the loading or unloading cargo or passengers it shall,
carrier, or similar clause, shall be deemed to be a prima facie, be regarded as unreasonable..
clause relieving the carrier from liability. (5) Neither the carrier nor the ship shall in any
event be or become liable for any loss or damage
RIGHTS AND IMMUNITIES to or in connection with the transportation of goods
Sec. 4 in an amount exceeding $500 per package of lawful
(1) Neither the carrier nor the ship shall be liable money of the United States, or in case of goods not
for loss or damage arising or resulting from shipped in packages, per customary freight unit, or
unseaworthiness unless caused by want of due the equivalent of that sum in other currency,
diligence on the part of the carrier to make the ship unless the nature and value of such goods have
seaworthy and to secure that the ship is properly been declared by the shipper before shipment and
manned, equipped, and supplied, and to make the inserted in the bill of lading. This declaration, if
holds, refrigerating and cooling chambers, and all embodied in the bill of lading, shall be prima facie
other parts of the ship in which goods are carried evidence, but shall not be conclusive on the
fit and safe for their reception, carriage, and carrier..
preservation, in accordance with the provisions of By agreement between the carrier, master or agent
paragraph (1) of Section (3). Whenever loss or of the carrier, and the shipper another maximum
damage has resulted from unseaworthiness, the amount than that mentioned in this paragraph may
burden of proving the exercise of due diligence be fixed: Provided, that such maximum shall not be
shall be on the carrier or other person claiming less than the figure above named. In no event shall
exemption under this section.. the carrier be liable for more than the amount of
(2) Neither the carrier nor the ship shall be damage actually sustained..
responsible for loss or damage arising or resulting Neither the carrier nor the ship shall be responsible
from in any event for loss damage to or in connection
(a) Act, neglect, or default of the master, with the transportation of the goods if the nature or
mariner, pilot, or the servants of the carrier in the value thereof has been knowingly and fraudulently
navigation or in the management of the ship; misstated by the shipper in the bill of lading..
(b) Fire, unless caused by the actual fault or (6) Goods of an inflammable, explosive, or
privity of the carrier;. dangerous nature to the shipment whereof, the
(c) Perils, dangers, and accidents of the sea or carrier, master or agent of the carrier, has not
other navigable water;. consented with knowledge of their nature and
(d) Act of God;. character, may at any time before discharge be
(e) Act of war;. landed at any place or destroyed or rendered
(f) Act of public enemies; innocuous by the carrier without compensation,

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 251 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

and the shipper of such goods shall be liable for all amendments thereto, or under the provisions of
damages and expenses directly or indirectly arising any other enactment for the time being in force
out of or resulting from such shipment. If any such relating to the limitation of the liability of the
goods shipped with such knowledge and consent owners of seagoing vessels..
shall become a danger to the ship or cargo, they
may in like manner be landed at any place, or TITLE II
destroyed or rendered innocuous by the carrier Sec. 9
without liability on the part of the carrier except to Nothing contained in this Act shall be construed as
general average if any.. permitting a common carrier by water to
discriminate between competing shippers similarly
SURRENDER OF RIGHTS AND IMMUNITIES placed in time and circumstances, either (a) with
AND INCREASE OF RESPONSIBILITIES AND respect to their right to demand and receive bills of
LIABILITIES lading subject to the provisions of this Act; or (b)
Sec. 5 when issuing such bills of lading either in the
A carrier shall be at liberty to surrender in whole or surrender of any of the carrier's rights and
in part all or any of his rights and immunities or to immunities or in the increase of any of the carrier's
increase any of his responsibilities and liabilities responsibilities and liabilities pursuant to Section 5,
under this Act, provided such surrender or increase Title I, of this Act; (c) in any other way prohibited
shall be embodied in the bill of lading issued to the by the Shipping Act, 1916, as amended..
shipper.
The provisions of this Act shall not be applicable to Sec. 10
charter parties; but if bills of lading are issued in (Not applicable to the Philippines.).
the case of a ship under a charter party, they shall
comply with the terms of this Act. Nothing in this Sec. 11
Act shall be held to prevent the insertion in a bill of When under the custom of any trade the weight of
lading of any lawful provisions regarding general any bulk cargo inserted in the bill of lading is a
average.. weight ascertained or accepted by a third party
other than the carrier or the shipper and the fact
SPECIAL CONDITIONS that the weight as ascertained or accepted is stated
Sec. 6 in the bill of lading, then notwithstanding anything
Notwithstanding the provisions of the preceding in this Act, the bill of lading shall not be deemed to
section, a carrier, master or agent of the carrier, be prima facie evidence against the carrier of the
and a shipper shall, in regard to any particular receipt of goods of the weight so inserted in the
goods be at liberty to enter into any agreement in bills of lading, and the accuracy thereof at the time
any terms as to the responsibility and liability of of shipment shall not be deemed to have been
the carrier for such goods, and as to the rights and guaranteed by the shipper..
immunities of the carrier in respect to such goods,
or his obligation to seaworthiness, (so far as the Sec. 12
stipulation regarding seaworthiness is contrary to (Not applicable to the Philippines.).
public policy), or the care or diligence of his
servants or agents in regard to the loading, Sec. 13
handling, stowage, carriage, custody, care and This Act shall apply to all contracts for carriage of
discharge of the goods carried by sea; provided, goods by seas to or from ports of the United States
that in this case no bill of lading has been or shall in foreign trade. As used in this Act the term
be issued and that the terms agreed shall be a "United States" includes its districts, territories, and
non-negotiable document and shall be marked as possessions: Provided, however, that the Philippine
such. . Legislature may by law exclude its application to
Any agreement so entered into shall have full legal transportation to or from ports of the Philippine
effect: Provided, that this section shall not apply to Islands. The term "foreign trade" means the
ordinary commercial shipments made in the transportation of goods between the ports of the
ordinary course of trade but only to other United States and ports of foreign countries.
shipments where the character or condition of the Nothing in this Act shall be held to apply to
property to be carried or the circumstances, terms contracts for carriage of goods by sea between any
and conditions under which the carriage is to be port of the United States or its possessions and any
performed are such as reasonably to justify a other port of the United States or its possessions:
special agreement. Provided, however, that any bill of lading or similar
document of the title which is evidence of a
Sec. 7 contract for the carriage of goods by sea between
Nothing contained in this Act shall prevent a carrier such ports, containing an express statement that it
or a shipper from entering into any agreement, shall be subject to the provisions of this Act; shall
stipulation, condition, reservation, or exemption as be subjected hereto as fully as if subject hereto by
to the responsibility and liability of the carrier or the express provisions of this Act: Provided,
the ship for the loss or damage to or in connection further, that every bill of lading or similar
with the custody and care and handling of goods document of title which is evidence of a contract for
prior to the loading on and subsequent to the the carriage of goods by sea from ports of the
discharge from the ship on which the goods are United States in foreign trade, shall contain a
carried by sea.. statement that it shall have effect subject to the
provisions of this Act. .
Sec. 8
The provisions of this Act shall not affect the rights Sec. 14
and obligations of the carrier under the provisions Upon the certification of the Secretary of
of the Shipping Act, 1916, or under the provisions Commerce that the foreign commerce of the United
of Sections 4281 to 4292, inclusive, of the Revised States in its competition with that of foreign
Statutes of the United States, or of any nations is prejudiced by the provisions, or any of

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 252 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

them, of the Title I of this Act, or by the laws of is notwitstanding that COGSA is a special law.
any foreign country or countries relating to the Goods in a foreign country shipped
carriage of goods by sea, the President of the to the Philippines are governed by the Civil Code
United States may, from time to time by
proclamation, suspend any or all provisions of Title 2) Art. 1753, CC (Conflict of Laws provision)
I of this Act for such periods of time or indefinitely
as may be designated in the proclamation. The 2. LIMIT OF LIABILITY PER PACKAGE
President may at any time rescind such suspension
of Title I hereof, and any provisions thereof which BELGIAN OVERSEAS vs. PHILIPPINE FIRST
may have been suspended shall thereby be INSURANCE CO., INC. (2002)
reinstated and again apply to contracts thereafter The Civil Code does not limit the liability of the
made for carriage of goods by sea. Any common carrier to a fixed amount per package. In
proclamation of suspension or rescission of any all matters not regulated by the Civil Code, the
such suspension shall take effect on the date right and the obligations of common carriers shall
named therein, which date shall be not less than be governed by the Code of Commerce and special
ten days from the issue of the proclamation. laws. Thus, the COGSA, which is suppletory to the
Any contract for the carriage of goods by sea, provisions of the Civil Code, supplements the latter
subject to the provisions of this Act, effective by establishing a statutory provision limiting the
during any period when Title I hereof, or any part carrier's liability in the absence of a shipper's
thereof, is suspended, shall be subject to all declaration of a higher value in the bill of lading. In
provisions of law now or hereafter applicable to the case before us, there was no stipulation in the
that part of Title I which may have thus been Bill of Lading limiting the carrier's liability. Neither
suspended.. did the shipper declare a higher valuation of the
goods to be shipped. Petitioners' liability should
Sec. 15 be computed based on US$500 per package
This Act shall take effect ninety days after the date and not on the per metric ton price declared
of its approval; but nothing in this Act shall apply in the Letter of Credit.
during a period not to exceed one year following its
approval to any contract for the carriage of goods On Notice of Claim/On Prescription of Action:
by sea, made before the date on which this Act is First, the provision of COGSA provides that the
approved nor to any bill of lading or similar notice of claim need not be given if the state of the
document of title issued, whether before or after goods, at the time of their receipt, has been the
such date of approval in pursuance of any such subject of a joint inspection or survey. Prior to
contract as aforesaid.. unloading the cargo, an Inspection Report as to the
condition of the goods was prepared and signed by
Sec. 16 representatives of both parties. Second, as stated
This Act may be cited as the "Carriage of Goods by in the same provision, a failure to file a notice of
Sea Act.". claim within three days will not bar recovery if it is
nonetheless filed within one year. This one-year
1. CONTRACTS COVERED UNDER COGSA prescriptive period also applies to the shipper, the
consignee, the insurer of the goods or any legal
COGSA is a special law that governs in all contracts holder of the bill of lading. "Inasmuch as the
of carriage of: neither the Civil Code nor the Code of Commerce
goods states a specific prescriptive period on the matter,
by sea the Carriage of Goods by Sea Act (COGSA)--which
between or to and from Philippine provides for a one-year period of limitation on
ports claims for loss of, or damage to, cargoes sustained
vessels involved in foreign trade during transit--may be applied suppletorily to the
case at bar." In the present case, the cargo was
Application of laws: discharged on July 31, 1990, while the Complaint
If the common carrier is was filed by respondent on July 25, 1991, within
coming to the Philippines: the one-year prescriptive period.
First: Civil Code
Second: COGSA (in foreign 3. NOTICE OF LOSS OF CLAIM
trade)
Third: Code of Commerce 4. PRESCRIPTION OF ACTION

If the private carrier is


coming to the Philippines: Filipino Merchants Insurance, Inc. v.
First: COGSA Alejandro (1986)
Second: Code of Commerce Clearly, the coverage of the Act includes the
Third: Civil Code (excluding insurer of the goods. Otherwise, what the Act
rules on common carriers) intends to prohibit after the lapse of the one-year
prescriptive period can be done indirectly by the
If the private or common shipper or owner of the goods by simply filing a
carrier is from the Philippines to a foreign country: claim against the insurer even after the lapse of
Apply the law of the foreign one year.
country (per Art. 1753, CC) UNLESS the parties
make COGSA applicable Maritime Agencies & Services, Inc. v. CA
The period for filing the claim is one year, in
Hierarchy of laws: accordance with the Carriage of Goods by Sea Act.
1) Art. 1766, CC (COGSA as only in matters not This was adopted and embodied by our legislature
regulated by this Code) This in Com. Act No. 65 which, as a special law, prevails
over the general provisions of the Civil Code on

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 253 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

prescription of actions. Section 3(6) of that Act


provides as follows: In any event, the carrier and V. INTERNATIONAL AIR TRANSPORT
the ship shall be discharged from all liability in
respect of loss or damage unless suit is brought
within one year after delivery of the goods or the A. The Warsaw Convention
date when the goods should have been delivered;
Provided, that if a notice of loss for damage; either
apparent or concealed, is not given as provided for Chapter III - Liability of the Carrier
in this section, that fact shall not effect or prejudice
the right of the shipper to bring suit within one Article 17
year after the delivery of the goods or the date The carrier is liable for damage sustained in the
when the goods should have been delivered. event of the death or wounding of a passenger or
any other bodily injury suffered by a passenger, if
5. WAIVER UNDER COGSA the accident which caused the damage so sustained
took place on board the aircraft or in the course of
any of the operations of embarking or
disembarking.

Article 18
1. The carrier is liable for damage sustained in the
event of the destruction or loss of, or of damage to,
any registered luggage or any goods, if the
occurrence which caused the damage so sustained
took place during the carriage by air.
2. The carriage by air within the meaning of the
preceding paragraph comprises the period during
which the luggage or goods are in charge of the
carrier, whether in an aerodrome or on board an
aircraft, or, in the case of a landing outside an
aerodrome, in any place whatsoever.
3. The period of the carriage by air does not extend
to any carriage by land, by sea or by river
performed outside an aerodrome. If, however, such
a carriage takes place in the performance of a
contract for carriage by air, for the purpose of
loading, delivery or transshipment, any damage is
presumed, subject to proof to the contrary, to have
been the result of an event which took place during
the carriage by air.

Article 19
The carrier is liable for damage occasioned by delay
in the carriage by air of passengers, luggage or
goods.

Article 20
1. The carrier is not liable if he proves that he and
his agents have taken all necessary measures to
avoid the damage or that it was impossible for him
or them to take such measures.
2. In the carriage of goods and luggage the carrier
is not liable if he proves that the damage was
occasioned by negligent pilotage or negligence in
the handling of the aircraft or in navigation and
that, in all other respects, he and his agents have
taken all necessary measures to avoid the damage.

Article 21
If the carrier proves that the damage was caused
by or contributed to by the negligence of the
injured person the Court may, in accordance with
the provisions of its own law, exonerate the carrier
wholly or partly from his liability.

Article 22
1. In the carriage of passengers the liability of the
carrier for each passenger is limited to the sum of
125,000 francs. Where, in accordance with the law
of the Court seised of the case, damages may be
awarded in the form of periodical payments, the
equivalent capital value of the said payments shall
not exceed 125,000 francs. Nevertheless, by
special contract, the carrier and the passenger may
agree to a higher limit of liability.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 254 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

2. In the carriage of registered luggage and of


goods, the liability of the carrier is limited to a sum Article 27
of 250 francs per kilogram, unless the consignor In the case of the death of the person liable, an
has made, at the time when the package was action for damages lies in accordance with the
handed over to the carrier, a special declaration of terms of this Convention against those legally
the value at delivery and has paid a supplementary representing his estate.
sum if the case so requires. In that case the carrier
will be liable to pay a sum not exceeding the Article 28
declared sum, unless he proves that that sum is 1. An action for damages must be brought, at the
greater than the actual value to the consignor at option of the plaintiff, in the territory of one of the
delivery. High Contracting Parties, either before the Court
3. As regards objects of which the passenger takes having jurisdiction where the carrier is ordinarily
charge himself the liability of the carrier is limited resident, or has his principal place of business, or
to 5,000 francs per passenger. has an establishment by which the contract has
4. The sums mentioned above shall be deemed to been made or before the Court having jurisdiction
refer to the French franc consisting of 65 at the place of destination.
milligrams gold of millesimal fineness 900. These 2. Questions of procedure shall be governed by the
sums may be converted into any national currency law of the Court seised of the case.
in round figures.
Article 29
Article 23 1. The right to damages shall be extinguished if an
Any provision tending to relieve the carrier of action is not brought within two years, reckoned
liability or to fix a lower limit than that which is laid from the date of arrival at the destination, or from
down in this Convention shall be null and void, but the date on which the aircraft ought to have
the nullity of any such provision does not involve arrived, or from the date on which the carriage
the nullity of the whole contract, which shall remain stopped.
subject to the provisions of this Convention. 2. The method of calculating the period of
limitation shall be determined by the law of the
Article 24 Court seised of the case.
1. In the cases covered by Articles 18 and 19 any
action for damages, however founded, can only be Article 30
brought subject to the conditions and limits set out 1. In the case of carriage to be performed by
in this Convention. various successive carriers and falling within the
2. In the cases covered by Article 17 the provisions definition set out in the third paragraph of Article 1,
of the preceding paragraph also apply, without each carrier who accepts passengers, luggage or
prejudice to the questions as to who are the goods is subjected to the rules set out in this
persons who have the right to bring suit and what Convention, and is deemed to be one of the
are their respective rights. contracting parties to the contract of carriage in so
far as the contract deals with that part of the
Article 25 carriage which is performed under his supervision.
1. The carrier shall not be entitled to avail himself 2. In the case of carriage of this nature, the
of the provisions of this Convention which exclude passenger or his representative can take action
or limit his liability, if the damage is caused by his only against the carrier who performed the carriage
wilful misconduct or by such default on his part as, during which the accident or the delay occurred,
in accordance with the law of the Court seised of save in the case where, by express agreement, the
the case, is considered to be equivalent to wilful first carrier has assumed liability for the whole
misconduct. journey.
2. Similarly the carrier shall not be entitled to avail 3. As regards luggage or goods, the passenger or
himself of the said provisions, if the damage is consignor will have a right of action against the
caused as aforesaid by any agent of the carrier first carrier, and the passenger or consignee who is
acting within the scope of his employment. entitled to delivery will have a right of action
against the last carrier, and further, each may take
Article 26 action against the carrier who performed the
1. Receipt by the person entitled to delivery of carriage during which the destruction, loss, damage
luggage or goods without complaint is prima facie or delay took place. These carriers will be jointly
evidence that the same have been delivered in and severally liable to the passenger or to the
good condition and in accordance with the consignor or consignee.
document of carriage.
2. In the case of damage, the person entitled to B. Applicability; meaning of international
delivery must complain to the carrier forthwith transportation
after the discovery of the damage, and, at the
latest, within three days from the date of receipt in International air transportation is
the case of luggage and seven days from the date transportation by air between points of contact of
of receipt in the case of goods. In the case of delay two high contracting parties, or those countries
the complaint must be made at the latest within that have acceded to the Convention.
fourteen days from the date on which the luggage
or goods have been placed at his disposal.
C. Liabilities under the Convention
3. Every complaint must be made in writing upon
the document of carriage or by separate notice in
writing despatched within the times aforesaid. The enumeration of causes of action in the
4. Failing complaint within the times aforesaid, no Warsaw Convention is not an exclusive list. You can
action shall lie against the carrier, save in the case have a cause of action even if it is not: a) death or
of fraud on his part. wounding of the passenger; b) damage or loss or
destruction of checked baggage, or c) delay in the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 255 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

transportation of passengers, luggage and goods. compensation. When the employee's lack of due
Note however, that the limitations of liability in the care contributed to his death or injury, the
Convention favor the carrier. compensation shall be equitably reduced. AND
NORTHWEST AIRLINES, INC., vs. CUENCA under 1712 If a fellow worker's intentional
(1965) malicious act is the only cause of the death or
The Articles merely declare the carrier liable for injury, the employer shall not be answerable
damages in the enumerated cases, if the conditions
therein specified are present. Neither said PAL vs. CA, DR. JOSEFINO MIRANDA and
provisions nor others in the aforementioned LUISA MIRANDA (1996)
Convention regulate or exclude liability for other The appellees do not seek payment for loss of any
breaches of contract by the carrier. Under baggage. They are claiming damages arising from
petitioner's theory, an air carrier would be exempt the discriminatory off-loading of their baggage.
from any liability for damages in the event of its That cannot be limited by the printed conditions in
absolute refusal, in bad faith, to comply with a the tickets and baggage checks. Neither can the
contract of carriage, which is absurd. Warsaw Convention exclude nor regulate the
liability for other breaches of contract by air
ALITALIA vs IAC (1990) carriers. A recognition of the Warsaw Convention
Under the Warsaw Convention, an air does not preclude the operation of our Civil Code
carrier is made liable for damages for: and related laws in determining the extent of
1. the death, wounding or other bodily injury liability of common carriers in breach of contract of
of a passenger if the accident causing it took place carriage, particularly for willful misconduct of their
on board the aircraft or in the course of its employees. Said convention does not operate as an
operations of embarking/disembarking exclusive enumeration of the instances for
2. the destruction or loss of, or damage to, declaring a carrier liable for breach of contract of
any registered luggage or goods, if the occurrence carriage or as an absolute limit of the extent of that
causing it took place during the carriage by air liability. The Warsaw Convention declares the
3. delay in the transportation by air of carrier liable in the enumerated cases and under
passengers, luggage or goods. certain limitations. However, it must not be
In these cases, the Convention provides construed to preclude the operation of the Civil
that the action for damages, however founded, Code and pertinent laws. It does not regulate,
can only be brought subject to the conditions and much less exempt, the carrier from liability for
limits set out therein. damages for violating the rights of its passengers
The Warsaw Convention however denies to under the contract of carriage, especially if willful
the carrier availment of the provisions w/c exclude misconduct on the part of the carrier's employees
or limit his liability, if the damage is caused by his is found or established, which is the case before
willful misconduct or by such default on his part as, Us.
in accordance w/ the law of the court seized of the
case, is considered to be equivalent to willful
misconduct, or if the damage is similarly caused by E. When Limitations Unavailable
any agent of the carrier acting w/n the scope of his TWA v. CA and Vinluan (1988)
employment. The petitioners contention that it is not liable is
The Convention does not operate as an devoid of merit. Private respondent had a first
exclusive enumeration of the instances of an class ticket for Flight No. 41 of petitioner from New
airlines liability, or as an absolute limit of the York to San Francisco on April 20, 1979. It was
extent of that liability. twice confirmed and yet respondent
Moreover, it should be deemed a limit of unceremoniously told him that there was no first
liability only in those cases where the cause of the class seat available for him and that he had to be
death or injury to person, or destruction, loss or downgraded to the economy class. As he protested,
damage to property or delay in its transport is not he was arrogantly threatened by one Mr. Braam.
attributable to or attended by any willful Worst still, while he was waiting for the flight, he
misconduct, bad faith, recklessness, or otherwise saw that several Caucasians who arrived much
improper conduct on the part of any official or later were accommodated in first class seats when
employee for which the carrier is responsible, and the other passengers did not show up. The
there is otherwise no special or extraordinary form discrimination is obvious and the humiliation to
of resulting injury. which private respondent was subjected is
The Convention has invariably been held undeniable. Consequently, the award of moral and
inapplicable, or as not restrictive of the carriers exemplary damages by the respondent court is in
liability, where there was satisfactory evidence of order.
malice or bad faith attributable to its officers and At the time of this unfortunate incident, the private
employees. respondent was a practicing lawyer, a senior
partner of a big law firm in Manila. He was a
Note: Liability of carrier in case of loss of luggage is director of several companies and was active in
limited to a sum of $USD 20 per kilo or $USD 9.07 civic and social organizations in the Philippines.
per pound unless a higher value is declared in Considering the circumstances of this case and the
advance and additional charges are paid. social standing of private respondent in the
community, he is entitled to the award of moral
and exemplary damages. However, the moral
D. Limitations on Liability damages should be reduced to P300,000.00, and
the exemplary damages should be reduced to
PAL INC. v CA and JESUS SAMSON (1981) P200,000.00. This award should be reasonably
Ratio: The limitation of their liability under 1711 of sufficient to indemnify private respondent for the
NCC: If the mishap was due to the employee's own humiliation and embarrassment that he suffered
notorious negligence, or voluntary act, or and to serve as an example to discourage the
drunkenness, the employer shall not be liable for

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 256 of 355


TRANSPORTATION LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

repetition of similar oppressive and discriminatory


acts.

F. Conditions on Liability

Luna v. Estrada (1992)


HELD:
The Warsaw Convention was a treaty commitment
voluntarily assumed by the Philippine government;
consequently, it has the force and effect of law in
this country. But, in the same token, jurisprudence
shows that the Warsaw Convention does not
operate as an exclusive enumeration of the
instances for declaring an airline liable for breach of
contract of carriage or as an absolute limit of the
extent of that liability.
The failure of private respondent to deliver their
luggage at the designated time and place does not
ipso facto amount to willful misconduct. For willful
misconduct to exist, there must be a showing that
the acts complained of were impelled by an
intention to violate the law, or were in persistent
disregard of one's rights. It must be evidenced by a
flagrantly or shamefully wrong or improper
conduct.

G. Venue of Court Actions

SANTOS vs NORTHWEST ORIENT AIRLINES


(1992)
(Petitioner claims that Art 28(1) is a rule merely of
venue and was waived by NOA when it did not
move to dismiss on the ground of improper venue.)
SC: A number of reasons tend to support
the characterization of Art 28(1) as a jurisdiction
and not a venue provision.
1. the wording of Art. 32, w/c indicates the
places where the action for damages must be
brought, underscores the mandatory nature of Art
28(1)
2. this characterization is consistent w/ one of
the objectives of the Convention, w/c is to regulate
in a uniform manner the conditions of intl
transportation by air.
3. the Convention doesnt contain any
provision prescribing rules of jurisdiction other than
Art 28(1), w/c means that the phrase rules as to
jurisdiction used in Art 32 must refer only to Art
28(1). In fact, the last sentence of Art 32
specifically deals w/ the exclusive enumeration in
Art 28(1) as jurisdictions, w/c as such, cannot be
left to the will of the parties regardless of the time
when the damage occurred.
Where the matter is governed by the
Warsaw Convention, jurisdiction takes on a dual
concept. Jurisdiction in the international sense
must be established in accordance w/ Art 28(1) of
the Warsaw Convention, following w/c the
jurisdiction of a particular court must be
established pursuant to the applicable domestic
law. Only after the question of which court has
jurisdiction is determined will the issue of venue be
taken up. This second question shall be governed
by the law of the court to w/c the case is
submitted.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 257 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

CODE OF COMMERCE 3. Absolute Disqualification from Trade

The following cannot engage in commerce nor hold


a. office or have any direct, administrative, or
Merchants and Commercial financial intervention in commercial or industrial
companies:
Transactions a. Persons sentenced to the penalty of civil
(Articles 1-63) interdiction, while they have not served
their sentence or have not been amnestied
1. Definition of Merchants or pardoned
b. Persons who have been declared
bankrupt, while they have not obtained
Merchant- is the middleman between the
their discharge, or been authorized by
consumer and manufacturer; a merchant must do
virtue of an agreement accepted at a
business in his own name
general meeting of creditors and approved
1.1. Natural persons by judicial authority, to continue at the
Those, who having legal capacity to engage in head of their establishments; the discharge
commerce, habitually devote themselves thereto being considered in such cases is limited to
(Art 1) that expressed in the agreement
Legal capacity to engage in commerce: c. Persons who, on account of laws or
having completed the age of 18 years31 special provisions, may not engage in
Having free disposition of their property (Art commerce
4)
Legal presumption of habitually 4. Relative Disqualification from Trade
engaging in commerce exists from the moment
the person who intends to engage therein The following cannot engage in the commerce,
announces through circulars, newspapers, either in person or by proxy, nor can they hold any
handbills, posters exhibited to the public, or in office or have any direct, administrative or financial
any manner whatsoever, an establishment intervention in commercial or industrial companies,
which has for its object some commercial within the limits of the districts, provinces or towns
operation. (Art 3) in which they discharge their duties:
A merchant need not devote his full a. Justices of the Supreme Court, judges 32
time to commerce and officials of the department of public
prosecutors in active service. This provision
1.2. Foreign entities shall not be applicable to the municipal
Foreigners and companies created abroad may mayors, judges or prosecuting attorneys,
engage in commerce subject to the laws of nor to those who by chance are temporarily
their country with respect to their capacity to discharging the functions of judges or
contract, prosecuting attorneys.
Foreign corporations and partnerships can b. Administrative, economic or military
engage business here, provided they get a heads of districts, provinces or posts
license from the SEC. For insurance companies, c. Employees engaged in the collection
they need a certificate of authority from the and administration of funds of the
Insurance Commission. Banks need a license State, appointed by the Government.
from the Monetary Board. Persons who by contract administer and
Code of Commerce governs: collect temporarily or their representatives
regards the creation of their establishments are exempted.
in Philippine territory, d. Stock and commercial brokers of
their mercantile operations, and whatever class they may be.
the jurisdiction of the courts of the e. Those who by virtue of laws or special
Philippines. provisions, may not engage in
But if theres a special treaty, the treaty commerce in a determinate territory.
governs. f. Members of Congress (87 Consti)
g. President, Vice President, Cabinet
members and their deputies or
2. Applicable Laws assistants (87 Consti)
h. Members of Constitutional Commission
(whether or not executed by merchants) (87 Consti)
a. Code of Commerce i. President, Vice President, Members of the
b. If no provision, commercial customs Cabinet, Congress, Supreme Court and the
c. In the absence of these two, Civil Code Constitutional Commission, Ombudsman
with respect to any loan, guaranty, or
Customs take precedence over civil law other form of financial accommodation
because of the progressive character of for any business purpose by any
commerce. For centuries, negotiable government-owned or controlled bank to
instruments are governed mostly by customs them (Art XI, Sec. 16, 87 Consti)
rather than law. But civil law can also
supplement the Code of Commerce the Code Absolute Incapacity Relative Incapacity
does not contain provisions on extinguishments
of obligations or damages. 32
Judges are no longer disqualified, as per Macariola vs.
Asuncion (114 SCRA 77, 1982). Since the relative
disqualification of judges is political in nature, this was
31
The Code of Commerce sets it at 21 years, but RA 6809 deemed abrogated by change in sovereignty from Spain
lowered the majority age to 18 years to the United States.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 258 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

Extends throughout the Extends only to the Theory of manifestation: in


Philippines territory where the commercial transactions, since time
officer is exercising his is of the essence the contract is
functions perfected from the moment the
Effect of act is null and Effect is to subject the acceptance is sent, even if it has not
void violator to disciplinary yet been received by the offeror. The
action or punishment offeror can no longer withdraw the
offer or change the terms of his offer.
Theory of cognition: in civil law, when
5. Acts of Commerce (Commercial a contract is entered into by
Transactions) correspondence, it will be perfected
only upon receipt by the offeror of
a. Those acts contained in the Code of the unconditional acceptance of the
Commerce offeree.
b. all others of analogous character iii. Compare with Art 1319, Civil Code:
Perfection is only from the time the
The Code of Commerce does not attempt offeror has actual knowledge of
anywhere to define what commercial acceptance.
transactions are. It only specifies 2 general iv. BUT different rule when a broker or
classes. agent intervenes: perfection is when
An act need not be performed by a merchant in the contracting parties shall have
order that it may be considered an act of accepted his offer. (Art 55)
commerce (Cia Agricola de Ultramar vs. Reyes,
4 Phil 2) 6.4. Indemnification
i. If the penalty for indemnification is
fixed, the injured party may demand
6. Commercial Contracts
through legal means the fulfillment of
the contract or the penalty stipulated.
6.1. Enforceability of Contracts
Recourse to one extinguishes the other
i. Commercial contracts shall be valid,
unless the contrary is stipulated. (Art
whatever the form and language,
56)
provided their existence is shown by any
means established by the civil law.
6.5. Interpretation
EXCEPT when the contract exceeds P300
i. Interpretation and compliance in good
(the equivalent of 1,500 pesetas), it
faith and full enforceability of their
cannot be proved by the testimony of a
provisions in their plain, usual and
witness alone. There must be some other
proper meanings (Art 57)
evidence.
ii. In case of conflicts between copies of the
contract, and an agent intervened in
6.2. Efficacy of Contracts
the negotiation, that which appears in
i. General Rule: Commercial contracts are
the agents book shall prevail (Art 58)
consensual, so a written instrument is
iii. In case of doubt, and the rules cannot
not necessary.
resolve the conflict, issues shall be
Exception: in the ff cases in Art 52
decided in favor of the debtor (Art 59)
Contracts stated in the Code33 or in
special laws34 which must be 6.6. Miscellaneous provisions
reduced to writing or require forms i. Days of grace, courtesy or others which
or formalities necessary for their under any name whatsoever defer the
efficacy fulfillment of commercial obligations,
Contracts executed in a foreign shall not be recognized, except those in
country in which the law requires which the parties may have previously
certain instruments, forms or fixed in contract or which are based on
formalities for their validity, a definite provision of law. (Art 61).
although Philippine law does not Ratio: Time is of the essence in
require them. commercial contracts, so days of grace
ii. if these contracts do not satisfy the are prohibited.
circumstances respectively required, it Exception: 30-day grace period in the
shall not give rise to obligations or Insurance Code to pay premiums
causes of action ii. Debtor is in delay when:
If day of performance is fixed by
6.3. Perfection of Contracts the parties or by law, debtor is in
i. Contracts entered into by correspondence default on the day following the day
shall be perfected from the moment an fixed (art 63)
answer is made accepting the offer or If no period is fixed, 10 days from
the conditions by which the latter may execution of contract and on 11th
be modified. (Art 54) day, debtor in delay without need
ii. Note that receipt of the acceptance by of demand (Art 62)
the offeror is immaterial, Potestative period (when debtor
33
desires), debtor is in delay from
The Code requires specific forms for charter parties and demand
loans on bottomry and respondentia (Arts 267, 578, 652 iii. Art. 50. Commercial contracts. They
and 720).
34 are governed by:
Negotiable Instruments Law requires negotiable
a) Code of Commerce
instruments to be in writing. Insurance Code requires
payment of premium for a fire insurance contract to exist.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 259 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

b) Special law if its the appropriate If one merchant does not present his
law like the Insurance Code books, while the other presents his and are
c) Civil Code to be applied in a kept in accordance with law, the one who
suppletory manner to other special presents will prevail, unless the reason for
laws. failure to produce is caused by a fortuitous
(This is not the same as in Art. 2. If what is event.
involved is an act of commerce, apply Art. If both books are kept in accordance with
2. But if it is a commercial contract, apply law and they conflict, the court will decide
Art. 50.) on the basis of the rules of preponderance
of evidence by taking into consideration the
7. Commercial Registry totality of the evidence presented by both
sides.
a. A book where entries are made of merchants
and of documents affecting their commercial 8. Cuentas en Participacion
transactions, or
b. An office established for the purpose of copying A partnership the existence of which was
and recording verbatim certain classes of
only known to those who had an interest in
documents of commercial nature the same, being no mutual agreements
between the partners and without a
7.1. Nature of registration: corporate name indicating to the public in
by individual merchants optional
some way that there were other people
by corporation compulsory, as it is the fact besides the one who ostensibly managed
of registration which creates the corporation and conducted the business, is exactly the
partnerships with a capital of P3000 or more accidental partnership of cuentas en
or where the contributions consists of real participacion defined in article 239 of the
estate properties compulsory, per Art. Code of Commerce.
1772, Civil Code
Philippine vessels Those who contract with the person under
with more than 3 tons gross
whose name the business of such
compulsory
partnership of cuentas en participacion is
with gross tonnage of 3 tons or less
conducted, shall have only a right of action
optional (Bar Review Materials in
against such person and not against the
Commercial Law J. Miravite, 2005 ed.)
other persons interested, and the latter, on
the other hand, shall have no right of
7.2. Effect of failure to register
action against the third person who
an individual merchant who fails to register
contracted with the manager unless such
cannot request the inscription of any
manager formally transfers his right to
document in the mercantile registry, nor
them. (Art 242 of the code Of Commerce.)
take advantage of its effects (Art. 18, Code
(Bourns vs Carman, 1906)
of Commerce)
failure to register the articles of
Joint Account Partnership
incorporation will not create the corporation
No firm name Has a firm name
failure to register the partnership does not
No common fund Has common fund
affect the existence of juridical personality,
whether or not it has P3000 or more or real No juridical personality Has juridical personality
estate properties in contributions by the Only ostensible partner All general partners
partners (Bar Review Materials in liable to 3rd persons liable to 3rd persons
Commercial Law J. Miravite, 2005 ed.) Only ostensible partner All general partners
manages manage
7.3. Bookkeeping of Commerce Liquidation done by Liquidation entrusted to
ostensible partner any partner/s
National Internal Revenue Code: a taxpayer
must keep a journal and a ledger. But if his
gross quarterly receipts do not exceed P5000,
he can keep a simplified set of books. In the
case of corporations and partnerships, if their
gross income exceed P25,000 quarterly, their
books must be audited by an independent CPA.
NIRC also requires that the books must be kept
for 3 years. In case of corporations, the
Corporation Code requires them to keep record
of all business transactions, minutes of meeting
of BOD and stockholder, and stock and transfer
book.
Art. 48 lays down certain evidentiary rules
regarding keeping of books:
This is an admission against interest. The
entries in the books of merchants may be
used as evidence against them.
If the books of 2 merchants conflict where
1 book is kept in accordance with law while
the other is not, the former will prevail.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 260 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

b. LoC

Letters of Credit 4. How it works:


(Articles 567-572)

1. Definition
Buyer procures LoC and obliges himself to
An engagement by a bank or other person reimburse the issuing bank upon receipt of the
documents of title
made at the request of a customer that the
issuer (bank) will honor a draft or other
demands for payment or other complaints with
the conditions specified in the credit. Issuing bank issues LoC in favor of seller
(Prudential Bank vs. IAC, 1992).
An instrument issued by a bank in behalf of a
customer authorizing a beneficiary to draw a
draft or drafts which will be honored on
presentation to the bank if drawn in accordance Issuing bank opens a LoC
with the terms and conditions specified in the with a correspondent bank
letter of credit. abroad (bank-to-bank
Art. 567, Code of Commerce: those issued by transaction
one merchant to another or for the purpose of
attending to a commercial transaction.

2. Purpose

To satisfy the seemingly irreconcilable interests Seller ships goods to the buyer and delivers
of a seller, who refuses to part with his goods documents of title and draft to the issuing (or
before he is paid, and a buyer, who wants to negotiating) bank to recover payment
have control of the goods before paying. (Bank
of America vs. CA, 1993)
The primary purpose of the LoC is to substitute
for and support the agreement of the 5. Perfection of the LoC
buyer/importer to pay money under a contract
or other arrangement. It creates in the From the time the correspondent bank makes
seller/exporter a secure expectation of payment to persons in whose favor the LoC has
payment. been opened (Belman Inc. vs. Central Bank,
1958)
3. Nature Take note: The opening of a LoC is only a mode
of payment, which is not an essential requisite
The buyer may be required to contract a bank to of a contract (Johannes Schuback & Sons vs.
issue a letter of credit in favor of the seller so CA, 1993). A contract can still be perfected,
that the issuing bank can authorize the seller to even without the perfection of a LoC.
draw drafts and engage to pay them upon their
presentment simultaneously with the tender of 6. Rules on LoC
documents required by the letter of credit. The
seller gets paid only if he delivers the documents Bank of America vs. CA (1993)
of title over the goods, while the buyer gets the
goods only after reimbursing the bank. If there is no provision in the Code of
Basic principle: bank deals with documents only. Commerce, follow Uniform Customs and
As such, they are not qualified to deal with Practice or generally observed usages and
goods. They will act on the basis of documents customs
only. Rule of Strict Conformity/Compliance:
3 distinct and separate contracts in the LoC: Documents tendered must strictly conform to
One links the party applying for the LoC the terms of the LoC. The tender of documents
(buyer) and the party for whose benefit the by the beneficiary (seller) must include all
LoC is issued (seller). documents required by the letter. A
Between the account party (buyer) and the correspondent bank which departs from what
issuing bank. Under this contract, has been stipulated under the letter of credit,
(sometimes called the "Application and as when it accepts a faulty tender, acts on its
Agreement" or the "Reimbursement own risks and it may not thereafter be able to
Agreement"), the account party applies to recover from the buyer or the issuing bank, as
the issuing bank for a specified LoC and the case may be, the money thus paid to the
agrees to reimburse the bank for amounts beneficiary
paid by that bank
Between the issuing bank and the Feati Bank vs CA (1991)
beneficiary (seller), in order to support the
contract. It is the LoC proper in which the An advising or notifying bank does not incur
bank promises to pay the seller pursuant to any obligation by the notification. Its only
the terms and conditions stated therein obligation is to check the apparent authenticity
Independent contracts involved in a LoC: of the LoC
contract of sale between buyer and seller Negotiating bank has a right of recourse
contract of the issuing bank against the issuer bank. Until the negotiating

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 261 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

bank is reimbursed, drawer of the draft is still 9. Letter of Credit-Trust Receipt


contingently liable.
Transaction
Relationship between the seller and the
negotiating bank is like that between drawer
and purchaser of drafts, ie. the involved bank Bank extends loan to borrower. Loan is covered
deals only with documents and not on the by a LoC, and the security for the loan is a
goods described in the documents. trust receipt.

7. Obligations of Parties in Letter of Credit 10. Kinds of LoC

Independence Principle: Negotiating bank has 10.1. Commercial LoC


10.2. Travellers LoC
no duty to verify if what is described in the LoC
or shipping documents actually tallies with that
Note: No protest is required in case of
loaded aboard a ship. Banks do not deal with
the property to be exported or shipped to the dishonor. LoCs are issued to definite persons
and not to order, thus non-negotiable.
importer, but deal only with documents.
International custom negates any duty on the
10.3. Other kinds: (Sundiang Reviewer)
part of a bank to verify whether what has been
described in letters of credits or drafts or Confirmed LoC - whenever the
shipping documents actually tallies with what beneficiary stipulates that the
was loaded aboard ship obligation of the opening bank shall
also be made the obligation of
BPI vs De Reny Fabrics (1970) another bank to himself
Irrevocable LoC - a definite
LoC is a primary obligation of the bank. It is undertaking on the part of the
issuing bank and constitutes the
separate from the underlying contract it may
engagement of that bank to the
support, and is not merely an accessory
beneficiary and bona fide holders of
contract.
drafts drawn and/or documents
presented thereunder, that the
8. Parties provisions for payment, acceptance
or negotiation contained in the
8.1. Buyer credit will be duly fulfilled, provided
- procures the LoC and obliges himself to that all terms and conditions of the
reimburse the issuing bank upon receipt of the credit are complied with.
documents title - Issuing bank cannot revoke
without consent of beneficiary and
8.2. Issuing bank applicant (Without such consent, it
- undertakes to pay the seller upon receipt cannot be cancelled even by a court
of the draft and proper documents of titles and to order)
surrender the documents to the buyer upon Revolving LoC - one that provides
reimbursement for renewed credit to become
available as soon as the opening
8.3. Seller bank has advised that the
- who, in compliance with the contract of negotiating or paying that the
sale, ships the goods to the buyer and delivers the drafts already drawn by the
documents of title and draft to the issuing bank to beneficiary have been reimburse to
recover payment. the opening bank by the buyer
Back-to-Back LoC - a credit with
8.4. Other parties may include: identical documentary requirements
Advising (notifying) bank and covering the same
- may be utilized to convey to the merchandise as another LoC,
seller the existence of the credit except for a difference in the price
Confirming bank of the merchandise as shown by
- will lend credence to the LoC the invoice and the draft. The
issued by a lesser known issuing second letter can be negotiated
bank. The confirming bank is only after the first is negotiated.
directly liable to pay the seller- Standby LoC - a security
beneficiary arrangement for the performance
Paying bank of certain obligations. It can be
- undertakes to encash the drafts drawn against only if another
drawn by the exporter/seller business transaction is not
Instead of going to the place of the performed. It may be issued in lieu
issuing bank to claim payment, the of a performance bond.
buyer may approach another bank - an absolute undertaking to
(termed the negotiating bank) to have pay the money advanced or the
the draft discounted (Charles Lee vs amount for which credit is given on
CA, 2002) the faith of the instrument. They
are primary obligations and not
accessory contracts. But while they
are a security arrangement, they
are not converted thereby into
contracts of guaranty. (IBAA vs
IAC, 1988)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 262 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

11. Sight Drafts the fixtures and equipment used in and about
the business (Sec 2)
No presentment required before
Exempt Transactions:
acceptance.
Sale or mortgage is made in the ordinary
course of business
12. Margin Fee When accompanied with a written waiver
by all the seller/mortgagors creditors (Sec.
Tax on sale of foreign exchange. Since the 2)
contract of sale is consensual, it falls due Sale by virtue of a judicial order (Sec. 8)
as soon as the local bank opens the LoC Sale by assignee in insolvency or those
(Pacific Oxygen Company vs. Central Bank, beyond the reach of creditors
1968). Sale of properties exempt from attachment
or execution (Rule 39, Sec. 13, Rules of
Court)

1.I. Creditors contemplated:


Bulk Sales Law Creditor at the time of the sale/mortgage
Need not be judgment creditors
(Act 3952, as amended) Claim need not be due

1. Purpose Fraudulent conveyance under the Bulk Sales


Law as against transfer in fraud of creditors
To regulate the sale, transfer, mortgage or under the CC:
The former is null and void while the latter
assignment of goods, wares, merchandise,
(under Arts. 1381-1389) is rescissible and
provisions or materials in bulk, and
is valid until set aside by a competent court
prescribing penalties for the violation of the
When the law is duly complied with, the
provisions thereof.
creditors may not object to the transaction,
but it may be rescinded if it is shown that it
To prevent the defrauding of creditors by
was, in fact, made in fraud of creditors
the secret sale or disposal or mortgage in
(Pandect of Commercial Law and
bulk of all or substantially all of a
Jurisprudence - Justice Vitug, 1997 ed.)
merchants stock of goods bulk until the
creditor of the seller shall have been paid in
The law covers all transactions, whether done
full.
in good faith or not, or whether the seller is in
a state of insolvency or not, as long as the
The law is penal in nature. Thus, its
transaction falls within the description of what
provisions must be strictly construed
is a bulk sale. Neither the motive nor the
against the government and liberally in
intention of the seller, nor the resulting
favor of the accused.
consequence thereof to his estate, constitutes
an element of what is a bulk sale; nor is the
The general scheme of the law is to declare
proof thereof relevant in determining whether
such bulk sales fraudulent and void as to
the said transaction falls within the coverage of
creditors of the vendor, or presumptively
the law.
so, unless specified formalities are
observed, such as the demanding and the
Albercht vs Cudikee (79 Pac. 628)
giving of a list of creditors, the giving of
actual or constructive notice to such
The common use of the term stock when applied to
creditors, by the record or otherwise, and
goods in a mercantile house refers to that which
the making of an inventory. (Comments
are kept for sale.
and Cases on Sales De Leon, 2005 ed.)
Boise Credit Mens Assoc. vs Ellis (133 Pac. 6)
Justification: police power of the state
(Liwanag vs Mengraj) Merchandise must be construed to mean such
things as are usually bought and sold in trade by
2. Types of Sales in Bulk35 merchants. (Peoples Savings Bank vs Ben Allsburg,
131 N.W. 101) It means something that is sold
Not in the ordinary course of trade or business everyday, and is constantly going out of the store
Any sale, transfer, mortgage or assignment of and being replaced by other goods.
a stock of goods, wares, merchandise,
provisions, or materials (Sec 2) Brown vs Quigley (130 N.W. 690)

In the course of trade or business The term (fixtures) refers to such articles of
Sale, transfer, mortgage or assignment of all, merchandise usually possessed and annexed to the
or substantially all, of the business or trade premises occupied by merchants to enable them
conducted or of all, or substantially all, of better to store, handle, and display their wares
although removable without material injury to the
premises at or before the end of tenancy.
35
This topic came out in 2007, 2006, 2005, 2001, 2000,
Comments ad Cases on Sales De Leon, 2000 ed.
1997, 1995, 1994, 1993, 1988. Specific questions were
asked of sec. 2 and sec. 5. In 1982 questions on the
rights and liabilities of parties were asked, these are Lands and buildings are not goods, merchandise
covered in sections 3, 4, 5 and 9. and fixtures therefore not covered by the BSL.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 263 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

assignor of each article to be


Philippine Law on Sales Villanueva, 1998 ed. included in the sale, transfer or
mortgage
The qualification in the normal course of iii. notify every creditor whose name
business applies only to the first type of and address is set forth in the
bulk sale defined by law. verified statement personally or by
Fraud and insolvency is not an element of registered mail, of the price, terms
what constitutes Bulk Sales. conditions of the sale, transfer,
The law covers all transactions, whether mortgage, or assignment.
done in good faith or bad faith.
3.3. Transfer for Consideration

It shall be unlawful for vendor to transfer title


3. Duties of Persons Selling in Bulk
without consideration or for a nominal
consideration only. (Sec 7)
3.1. Statement of Creditors

Vendor must, before receiving from the 4. Consequences of Non-compliance


vendee, mortgagee, or agent any part of the
purchase price, or any promissory note, Any person violating any provision of this Act shall,
memorandum, or other evidence therefore be punished by imprisonment not less than six
deliver a written statement of creditors with the months, nor more than five years, or fined in sum
following information: not exceeding five thousand pesos, or both. (Sec
11)
i. names and addresses of all
creditors to whom said vendor or 4.1. Incomplete or false or untrue sworn
mortgagor may be indebted written statement is a violation
ii. amount of indebtedness due or
owing, or to become due or owing 4.2. Effects of false statements in the
to each of said creditors (Sec 3) schedule of creditors
Without knowledge of the buyer: if the
The sworn statement shall be registered in the statement is fair upon its face he will
Bureau of Commerce. For the registration of be protected
each such sworn statement a fee of five pesos With knowledge or imputed knowledge
shall be charged. (Sec 9) of buyer: the vendee accepts it at his
peril. The sale is valid between the
If the vendor/mortgagor receives any part of vendor and the vendee but void as the
the purchase price, or any promissory note, or against the creditors
other evidence of indebtedness without having With names of certain creditors without
first delivered the sworn statement and without notice: the sale is void as to such
applying the purchase or mortgage money of creditors, whether that omission was
the said property to the pro rata payment of fraudulent or not
the bona fide claims of the creditors of the With respect to an innocent purchaser
vendor or mortgagor, he shall be deemed to for value from the original purchaser:
have violated this Act, and any such sale, purchaser shall be protected
transfer or mortgage shall be fraudulent and
void. (Sec 4) 4.3. Effects of violation of law on transfer
As between the parties: valid contract
If the vendor / mortgagor shall knowingly or As between persons other than the
willfully make, deliver or cause to be made or creditors: valid
delivered, a statement which shall not include As to affected creditors of the
the names of all such creditors, w/ the correct seller/mortgagor: void
amount due and to become due to each of Criminal liability, if expressly provided
them, or shall contain any false or untrue
statement, shall be deemed to have violated
the provisions of this Act. (Sec 6)
1.II
The vendor, mortgagor, transferor or assignor
Warehouse
must apply the purchase money to the pro-rata
payment of bona fide claims of the creditors as Receipts Law
shown in the verified statement. (Act 2137)
3.2. Inventory and Notification
1. Purpose and Coverage
Vendor / mortgagor must, at least ten days
before the sale, transfer or execution of a To regulate the status, rights and liabilities of
mortgage the parties in a warehousing contract
To protect those who, in good faith and for
i. make a full detailed inventory
value, acquire negotiable warehouse receipts
ii. preserve the same showing the
by negotiation
quantity and, so far as is possible
To render the title to, and the right of
with the exercise of reasonable
possession of, property stored in warehouses
diligence, the cost price to the
more easily convertible
vendor, transferor, mortgagor or

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 264 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

To facilitate the use of warehouse receipts as


documents of title Where a warehouse receipt or quedan is
In order to accomplish these, to place a much transferred or endorsed to a creditor only to secure
greater responsibility on the warehouseman the payment of a loan or debt, the transferee or
Covers negotiable warehouse receipts, which endorsee does not automatically become the owner
can only be issued by a warehouseman in the of the goods covered by the warehouse receipt or
business of receiving commodities on deposit quedan but he merely retains the right to keep,
for storage. In all other cases where receipts and with the consent of the owner to sell, them so
are not issued by a warehouseman, Art. 1507- as to satisfy the obligation from the proceeds of the
1520 of the Civil Code applies sale, this for the simple reason that the transaction
For public and private warehouses involved is not a sale but only a mortgage or
Bills of lading and quedans are governed by Art pledge, and if the property covered by the quedans
1507-1520 and 1636 of the Civil Code (Ratio: or warehouse receipts is lost later without the fault
Sugar centrals that issue quedans are not or negligence of the mortgagee or pledgee or the
warehousemen) transferee or endorsee of the warehouse receipt or
But note: a warehouse receipt is also cited in quedan, then said goods are to be regarded as lost
on account of the real owner, mortgagor or
Art 1636 as a document of title
pledgor.
All other negotiable receipts are covered by the
law on negotiable instruments
3.2. Form of Warehouse Receipt

2. Definitions Sec 2. Warehouse receipts need not be in any


particular form but every such receipt must
2.1. Warehouseman embody within its written or printed terms:
Person lawfully engaged in the business of
storing goods for profit (Sec. 58a) i. The location of the warehouse
Duly authorized officer/agent of a where the goods are stored
warehouseman may validly issue a ii. The date of the issue of the
warehouse receipt (National Bank vs receipt
Producers Warehouse Association, 42 Phil iii. The consecutive number of the
609) receipt
iv. A statement whether the goods
2.2. Warehouse received will be delivered to the
Building or place where goods are bearer, to a specified person, or
deposited and stored for profit to a specified person in his
order
2.3. Warehouse receipt v. The rate of storage charges
Written acknowledgment by a vi. A description of the goods or of
warehouseman that he has received and the packages containing them
holds certain goods therein described in vii. The signature of the
store for the person to whom it is issued warehouseman or his authorized
Simple written contract between the owner agent
of the goods and the warehouseman to pay viii. If the receipt is issued for goods of
the compensation for that service which the warehouseman is owner,
Bilateral contract; imports that goods are in either solely or in common with
the house of the warehouseman and is a others, the fact of such
symbolical representation of the property ownership, and
itself. ix. A statement of the amount of
Not a negotiable instrument although it is advances made and of liabilities
negotiable as provided by the act. incurred for which the
warehouseman claims a lien. If
the precise amount of such
3. Nature/Characteristics of Warehouse advances made or of such liabilities
incurred is, at the time of the issue
Receipts 36
of, unknown to the warehouseman
or to his agent who issues it, a
3.1. Function of Warehouse Receipt statement of the fact that advances
have been made or liabilities
Negotiation carries with it transfer of title over incurred and the purpose thereof is
the commodity covered by the receipt (thus, it sufficient.
has the same function as a negotiable bill of
lading)
The date of issue appearing in the receipt
indicates prima facie the date when the
Except: Where a negotiable warehouse
contract of deposit is perfected and when the
receipt is indorsed and delivered to a
storage charges shall begin to run against the
creditor as a collateral for a loan
depositor.
If commodity covered by receipt is lost through
The mere fact that the goods deposited are
a fortuitous event, the debtor will bear loss
incorrectly described does not make ineffective
the receipt when the identity of the goods is
fully established by evidence. Thus, its
Martinez vs PNB (1953)
endorsement and delivery shall constitute a
36
The negotiation and transfer of receipts was ask in sufficient transfer of the title of the goods
2007, 2005, 1993 and 1979.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 265 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

(American Foreign Banking Corp. vs Herridge, Sec. 5. A receipt in which it is stated that
49 Phil 975). the goods received will be delivered to the
bearer or to the order of any person named
3.3. Effect of Non-compliance: in such receipt
No provision shall be inserted in a
Sec. 2. A warehouseman shall be liable to negotiable receipt that it is non-negotiable.
any person injured thereby for all damages Such provision shall be void.
caused by the omission from a negotiable
receipt of any of the terms herein required. It is negotiated either by delivery or
If any of these requisites in Sec 2 are indorsement
absent, it becomes a deposit only When negotiable receipt not required to be
surrendered
3.4. Effect of omission of any of the essential
terms: Estrada vs CAR (1961)
Validity of receipt is not affected
Warehouseman is liable for damages (No surrender needed if ordered by court) The SC
Negotiability of receipt is not affected ordered the manager of Moncada Bonded
The issuance of a warehouse receipt in Warehouse to release shares in palay without the
the form provided by the law is merely necessity of producing and surrendering the
permissive and directory and not original of the warehouse receipts issued. The SC
mandatory in the sense that if the stated our order must be carried out in the
requirements are not observed, then the meantime that this cases have not been finally
goods delivered for storage become decided in order to ameliorate the precarious
ordinary deposits situation in which said petitioners find themselves.

3.5. Terms that cannot be included Duplicate Receipts


Those contrary to the provisions of the
Warehouse Receipts Law Sec. 6. When more than one negotiable
Those which may impair his obligation receipt is issued for the same goods, the
to exercise that degree of care in the word duplicate shall be plainly placed
safekeeping of the goods entrusted to upon the face of every such receipt, except
him which a reasonably careful man would the first one issued. A warehouseman shall
exercise in regard to similar goods of his be liable for all damages caused by his
own failure to do so to any one who purchased
Those contrary to law, morals, public the subsequent receipt for value supposing
customs, public order or public policy it to be an original, even though the
Those exempting the warehouseman purchase be after the delivery of the goods
from liability for misdelivery by the warehouseman to the holder of the
Those exempting the warehouseman original receipt.
from liability for negligence
Negotiable vs Non-negotiable receipts37
3.6. Kinds of Warehouse Receipts
i. Non-negotiable
Non-Negotiable Negotiable
If goods are sold by As long as the goods
Sec. 4. A receipt in which it is stated that
the goods received will be delivered to the assignment, assignee must covered by a
advise warehouseman. negotiable warehouse
depositor or to any other specified person
Until he does, his rights receipt, these goods
may be defeated by a may not be attached
Sec. 7. A non-negotiable receipt shall have subsequent attaching etc.
plainly placed upon its face by the creditor, or a subsequent
warehouseman issuing it non-negotiable levy on execution, or a
or not negotiable. In case of the vendors lien or stoppage in
warehousemans failure so to do, a holder transitu that could be
of the receipt who purchased it for value enforced against the
supposing it to be negotiable, may, at his assignor
option, treat such receipt as imposing upon Rights of the transferee: Rights of the person
the warehouseman the same liabilities he 1. Title of the goods, as to whom it is
would have incurred had the receipt been against the transferor negotiated (holder):
negotiable. (merely steps into the 1. Title to the goods
This section shall not apply to letters, shoes) of the person
memoranda, or written acknowledgement 2. Right to notify the negotiating the
of an informal character. warehouseman of the receipt and title of
transfer and acquire the the person to whose
It is transferred by its delivery to the direct obligation of the order the goods were
transferee accompanied by a deed of warehouseman to hold the to be delivered
assignment, donation or other form of goods for him 2. Direct obligation of
transfer the warehouseman to
Effect of failure to mark negotiable: does hold possession of
not render it non-negotiable if it contains the goods for him, as
words of negotiability if the warehouseman

ii. Negotiable 37
The comparison between negotiable versus non-
negotiable warehouse receipts was asked in 2007, 1988,
1984, 1983 and 1982.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 266 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

Non-Negotiable Negotiable
directly contracted Note: Negotiable Warehouse Receipt is different
with him from a Negotiable Instrument
Negotiation defeats
the lien of the seller Note: Negotiation takes effect as of the time when
of the goods (sec. 9) the indorsement is actually made.
Goods represented can be Goods represented
subject to attachment or cannot be subject to Negotiable Negotiable Warehouse
levy by execution (Sec. 42) attachment or levy Instruments Receipts
by execution, unless Allow negotiation
in proper If deliberately altered, If altered, it is still valid,
circumstances (Sec. it becomes null and but can be enforced only
25)38 void accdg to its original tenor

Deliver to X this is non-negotiable. To Subject is money Subject is merchandise


sell the goods, the warehouse receipt
must be assigned

Deliver to X or order - this is Object of value is the Object of value is the


negotiable. The goods can be sold by instrument itself goods deposited
special endorsement and delivery
Liability of Liability of intermediate
Deliver to X or bearer- this is
intermediate parties is parties is none (for failure
negotiable because it is deliverable to
secondary (NIL) to deliver goods)
bearer. The goods can be sold by
delivery. If originally payable to If originally payable to
bearer, it will always bearer but is endorsed
Lost/destroyed receipts remain so even if it is specially, it will become
endorsed specially or deliverable to order and
Sec. 14. Lost / destroyed receipts in blank can only be negotiated by
Where a negotiable receipt has been lost / indorsement and delivery
destroyed, a court may order the delivery Holder in due course Endorsee, even if a holder
of the goods upon may obtain a title in due course, obtains only
satisfactory proof of loss/ better than that which such title as the person
destruction the party negotiating negotiating had over the
giving of a bond with sufficient to him had goods
sureties to be approved by the
court to protect the warehouseman
from any liability or expense, which Who may negotiate a warehouse receipt:
he or any person injured by such its owner
delivery may incur by reason of the any person to whom the possession
original receipt remaining or custody of the receipt has been
outstanding entrusted by the owner, if, by the
A court may also order payment of terms of the receipt, the goods are
warehousemans reasonable costs and deliverable to the person to whom the
counsel fees. possession or custody of receipt has
been entrusted or in such a form that it
The delivery of goods shall not relieve the may be negotiated by delivery (Sec.
warehouseman from liability to a person to 40)
whom the negotiable receipt has been/shall Warranties:
be negotiated for value without notice of that receipt is genuine
the proceedings/delivery of goods. legal right to negotiate
no knowledge of defects that may
4. Assignment and Negotiation impair receipt
right of transfer to title over goods
Sec 41. A person to whom a negotiable receipt has and that the goods are merchantable
been duly negotiated acquires thereby: The indorser does not guarantee that the
warehouseman will comply with his
a. Such title to the goods as the person duties (Sec. 45)
negotiating the receipt to him had or had Creditor receiving the warehouse receipt
ability to convey to a purchaser in good which is given as a collateral makes no
faith for value, and also such title to the warranty (Sec. 46)
goods as the depositor or person to whose
order the goods were to be delivered by the 5. Rights and Duties of a
terms of the receipt had or had ability to
convey to a purchaser in good faith for
Warehouseman 39
value, and
b. The direct obligation of the warehouseman 5.1. Rights
to hold possession of the goods for him Degree of Care
according to the terms of the receipt as
fully as if the warehouseman and
39
contracted directly with him. The obligation and liabilities of a warehouseman was
asked in 200, 1999, 1998, 1993, 1991, 1984, 1989,
38
Sec. 25 was asked in 1999 and 1981. 1980, 1978 and 1977.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 267 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

Sec 3. A warehouseman may insert in a receipt 1. the person lawfully entitled to the
issued by him any other terms and conditions possession of the goods, or his agent;
provided that such terms and conditions shall 2. a person who is either himself entitled
not: to delivery by the terms of a non-
xxx negotiable receipt issued for the goods,
a) in any wise impair his obligation to exercise or who has written authority from the
that degree of care which a reasonably person so entitled either indorsed upon
careful man would exercise in regard to the receipt or written upon another
similar goods of his own paper; or
3. a person in possession of a negotiable
General Rule: Warehouseman is required receipt by the terms of which the goods
to exercise such degree of care which a are deliverable to him or order, or to
reasonable careful owner would exercise bearer, or which has been indorsed to
over similar goods of his own. He shall be him or in blank by the person to whom
liable for any loss or injury to the goods delivery was promised by the terms of
caused by his failure to exercise such care. the receipt or by his mediate or
immediate indorser.
Exception: He shall not be liable for any
loss or injury which could not have been Sec. 10. When a warehouseman delivers the
avoided by the exercise of such care. goods to one who is not in fact lawfully entitled
to the possession of them, the warehouseman
Exception to the exception: He may limit shall be liable as for conversion to all having a
his liability to an agreed value of the right of property or possession in the goods if
property received in case of loss. He he delivered the goods otherwise than as
cannot stipulate that he will not be authorized by (b) and (c) of Sec 9
responsible for any loss caused by his
negligence. Though he delivered the goods as authorized
by said subdivisions he shall be so liable, if
To be paid prior to such delivery he had either:

In case of non-payment, to exercise his lien 1. been requested, by or on behalf of the


on the goods deposited person lawfully entitled, not to make
such delivery or
To refuse delivery in proper legal 2. had information that the delivery about
circumstances to be made was to one not lawfully
entitled
5.2. Duties
Issue a warehouse receipt in the Conversion
required form for goods received - an unauthorized assumption and exercise
of the right of ownership over goods belonging
Obligation to Deliver Goods to another through the alteration of their
condition or the exclusion of the owners right
Sec 8. A warehouseman, in the absence of (Bouviers Law Dictionary)
some lawful excuse provided by this Act, is
bound to deliver the goods upon a demand Sec. 17.40 If more than one person claims the
made either by the holder of a receipt for the title/possession of the goods, the
goods or by the depositor; if such demand is warehouseman may, either as a defense to an
accompanied with: action or as an original suit, require all known
1. an offer to satisfy the warehouse mans claimants to interplead.
lien
2. an offer to surrender the receipt, if Sec. 18. If:
negotiable, with such indorsements as 1. someone other than the depositor or
would be necessary for the negotiation person claiming under him has a claim
of the receipt; and to the title or possession of goods AND
3. a readiness and willingness to sign, 2. the warehouseman has information of
when the goods are delivered, an such claim
acknowledgement that they have been the warehouseman shall be excused from
delivered, if such signature is requested liability for refusing to deliver the goods until
by the warehouseman. he has had:
The burden shall be upon the warehouseman to 2. reasonable time to ascertain the
establish the existence of a lawful excuse for validity of the adverse claim OR
such refusal. 3. bring legal proceedings to compel
claimants to interplead
General Rule: a demand should be made
on the warehouseman in order that the Sec. 18 not applicable to cases where the
duty to deliver the goods will arise
warehouseman himself makes a claim to
the goods (67 C.J. 536)
Exception: when the warehouseman has
In case there are adverse claimants, the
rendered it beyond his power to deliver the
warehouseman can refuse to deliver the
goods, demand may be dispensed with
goods to anyone of them until he has had
[Art. 1169(3), Civil Code]
reasonable time to ascertain the validity of
Sec 9. A warehouseman is justified in 40
This topic on adverse claimants was asked in 2005 and
delivering the goods to one who is: 1975.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 268 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

the various claims; he is not excused from


liability in case he makes a mistake To insure the goods in proper
(Comments and Cases on Credit circumstances
Transactions De Leon, 2002 ed.) Where the law provides
Original action or counterclaim for Where it was an inducement for the
interpleader, whichever is appropriate. In depositor to enter into the contract
such case, the warehouseman will be Established practice
relieved from liability in delivering the Where the warehouse receipt
goods to the person found by the court to contains a representation to that
have a better right (Comments and Cases effect
on Credit Transactions De Leon, 2002
ed.) To mark a non-negotiable warehouse
Other instances when the warehouseman receipt as such
may refuse to deliver:
when the holder of the receipt does To mark as such the duplicates of a
not satisfy the conditions negotiable warehouse receipt
prescribed in Sec. 8
when the warehouseman has legal To give the proper notice in case of
title in himself on the goods, such sale of the goods as provided in the law
title or right being derived directly
or indirectly from the transfer made To take up and cancel the warehouse
by the depositor at the time or receipt when the goods are delivered
subsequent to the deposit for
storage, or from the Other Duties
warehousemans lien (Sec. 16) If warehouseman fails to cancel receipt
when he delivers goods, he is liable if
General rule: The warehouseman cannot receipt should turn up again (Sec 11)
refuse to deliver on the ground that he owns Warehouseman should record partial
the goods (bailee cannot assert title to the delivery on receipt, or else he is liable
goods entrusted to him). on entire receipt (Sec 12)
Exceptions: In the 2 cases mentioned above If alteration is authorized,
warehouseman is liable as altered. If
Where the goods have already been not authorized, warehouseman is liable
lawfully sold to third persons to as originally issued (Sec 13)
satisfy the warehousemans lien or
disposed of because of their Effects of alteration:
perishable nature (Sec. 36)
In the valid exercise of the Alteration immaterial (WON fraudulent; WON
warehousemans lien (Sec. 31) (tenor of receipt not authorized)
The warehouseman will not be changed) warehouseman is liable
required to deliver the goods if such on the altered receipt
had been lost. But this is without accdg to its original
prejudice to liabilities which may be tenor
incurred by him due to such loss. Alteration material but Warehouseman is liable
authorized accdg to its terms as
On commingling of Goods altered
Material alteration Liable accdg to its
General Rule : innocently made original tenor
Sec. 22 A warehouseman shall keep the goods so Material alteration Liable accdg to the
far separate from fraudulently made original tenor to a
1. the goods of other depositors and purchaser of receipt for
2. from other goods of the same value without notice and
depositor for which a separate even to the alterer and
receipt has been issued subsequent purchasers
as to permit at all times the identification and with notice (except that
redelivery of the goods deposited. liability is limited only to
delivery as he is
Exception: excused from any
Sec. 23. liability)
1. If authorized by agreement or custom and
2. Goods are fungible A fraudulent alteration cannot divest
the warehouseman may mingle with other goods of the title of the owner of the stored
the same kind and grade. goods and the warehouseman is liable
to return them to the owner
The various depositors shall own the entire mass A bona fide holder acquires no right to
and each shall be entitled to such portion as the
the goods under a lost or stolen
amount deposited by him bears to the whole.
negotiable receipt or to which the
indorsemant of the depositor has been
The warehouseman shall be severally forged
liable to each depositor for the care and
redelivery of his share of such mass to
Warehouseman is liable for issuing receipt
the same extent and under the same
for non-existing goods or misdescribed
circumstances as if the goods had been
goods (Sec. 20)
kept separate.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 269 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

Effect of misdescription of goods: The warehousemans lien is possessory in


Warehouseman is under the obligation nature (PNB vs Judge Se)
to deliver the identical property Involuntary parting with possession of goods
stored with him and if he fails to do ordinarily does not result in loss of his lien by a
so, he is liable directly to the owner. warehouseman (93 C.J.S. 59)
As against a bona fide purchaser of a A warehouseman who has released his lien by
warehouse receipt, the warehouseman the surrender of the goods may not thereafter
is estopped from denying that he claim a lien on other goods of the same
has received the goods described in depositor for unpaid charges on the goods if
the receipt the goods were delivered to him under different
If the description consists merely of bailments
marks or label upon the goods or upon The loss of the warehousemans lien does not
the packages containing them, the necessarily mean the extinguishments of the
warehouseman is not liable even if depositors obligation to pay the warehousing
the goods are not of the kind as fees and charges which subsists to be a
indicated in the marks or labels. personal liability
Remedies discussed in PNB vs. Sajo, 292 SCRA
Warehouseman is estopped to set up title 202 (1998)
in himself (Sec 16) To refuse to deliver the goods until
Non-delivery or goods do not correspond to his lien is satisfied (Sec 31)
description => warehouseman is liable To sell the goods by public auction
and apply the proceeds to the value
6. Warehousemans Lien of the lien (Sec 33 and 34)
Effects:
Sec. 27. A warehouseman shall have a lien on the the warehouseman is not
goods deposited or on the proceeds thereof for liable for non-delivery even if
1. all lawful charges for storage and the receipt given for the
preservation of goods goods were negotiated (Sec.
2. all lawful claims for money 36)
advanced, interest, insurance, where the sale was made
transportation, labor, weighing, without the publication
coopering, and other charges in relation required and before the time
to such goods provided by law, such sale is
3. all reasonable charges for notice void and the purchaser of the
and advertisements of sale goods acquires no title in
4. sale of goods where default has been them (Eastern Paper Mills
made in satisfying the warehousemans Co., Inc. vs Republic
lien Warehousing Corp, 170 SCRA
595)
In case of a negotiable receipt, the charges By other means allowed by law to a
that are present at the time of the issuance of creditor against his debtor, to collect
the receipt must be so stated in the receipt from the depositor all charges and
with the amounts thereof specified. If the advances which the depositor
existing charges are not stated, the expressly or impliedly contracted with
warehouseman shall have no lien thereon, the warehouseman to pay (Sec 32)
except only for charges for storage of those Other remedies allowed by law to
goods subsequent to the date of the receipt. enforce a lien against personal
property (Sec 35)
Sec. 28. A warehousemans lien may be enforced:
1. against all goods belonging to the The warehouseman may refuse to deliver
person who is liable as debtor for the goods to any holder of the receipt when the
claims storage fee stipulated in the receipt has not yet
2. against all goods belonging to others been paid
which have been deposited at any time
by the person who is liable as debtor for PNB vs. Se (1996)
the claims
If such person had been so While the PNB is entitled to the stocks of sugar as
entrusted with the possession of the endorsee of the quedans, delivery to it shall be
goods such that a pledge by him at effected only upon payment of the storage fees.
the time of the deposit to one who Imperative is the right of the warehouseman to
took the goods in good faith for demand payment of his lien at this juncture,
value would have been valid. because in accordance with Section 29 of the
Warehouse Receipts Law, the warehouseman loses
Sec. 29. A warehouseman loses his lien: his lien upon goods by surrendering possession
1. by surrendering possession of the goods thereof. In other words, the lien may be lost where
2. by refusing to deliver the goods when a the warehouseman surrenders the possession of
demand is made with which he is bound to the goods without requiring payment of his lien,
comply because a warehouseman's lien is possessory in
nature.
Sec. 31. A warehouseman having a valid lien
against the person demanding the goods may But the warehouseman cannot refuse to deliver
refuse to deliver the goods until the lien is satisfied. the goods because of an adverse claim of

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 270 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

ownership [PNB vs. Sayo, 292 SCRA 202 Civil liabilities Criminal
(1998)] liabilities
receipt for
Rules on attachment/execution of goods goods of
deposited: which he is an
In case of negotiable receipt, the goods owner without
cannot be attached or levied in execution stating such
unless: fact of
receipt is first surrendered ownership
its negotiation is enjoined (Sec. 51)
receipt is impounded by the court (Sec. 5. delivery of
25) goods without
Creditors remedies: seek for the obtaining
attachment of the receipt or seek aid from negotiable
courts to compel the debtor to satisfy warehouse
claims by means allowed by law in regard receipt (Sec.
to property which cannot readily be 54)
attached or levied upon by ordinary process 3rd persons Negotiation of
(Sec. 26) warehouse
receipt issued
Not applicable: for mortgaged
If the depositor is not the owner of the goods with
goods (thief) or one who has no right intent to
to convey title to the goods binding deceive
upon the owner
Actions for recovery or manual delivery
of goods by the real owner
Where attachment is made prior to the
issuance of receipt General Bonded Warehouse Act

Rights acquired by attaching creditors (Act 3893 as amended by RA 247)


cannot be defeated by the issuance of a
negotiable receipt of title thereafter
1. Purpose
(International Breeding Co. vs Terminal
Warehouse Co., 126 Atl. 902)
An act to regulate the business of receiving
In case of a non-negotiable receipt, the commodities for storage, giving the director
goods can be attached, provided it is done of Commerce and Industry the duty to
prior to the notification of the enforce if, providing penalties for violation
warehouseman of the transfer (Sec. 42); of the provisions, exempting cooperative
reason: absent such notice, both the marketing associations of commodity
warehouseman and the sheriff have a right producers from application thereof.
to assume that the goods are still owned by To protect depositors by giving them a
the person whose name appears in the direct recourse against the bond filed by
receipt the warehouseman in case of the latters
insolvency
To encourage the establishment of more
7. Liabilities 41
warehouses
Civil liabilities Criminal
liabilities 2. Definition of Terms
Warehouseman For damages 1. issuance of
or his agent suffered for receipts for 2.1. Warehouse
failure to goods not Every building, structure, or other protected
comply with received (Sec. enclosure in which commodities are kept for
legal duties 50) storage.
2. issuance of
receipt 2.2. Warehouseman
containing
A person engaged in the business receiving
false
commodities for storage
statement
(Sec. 51)
2.3. Receipt
3. issuance of
duplicate Any receipt issued by a warehouseman for
negotiable commodities delivered to him.
warehouse
receipt not Gonzales vs Go Tiong (1958)
marked as
such (Sec. 52) The kind or nature of the receipts issued by
4. issuance of him for the deposits is not very material, much
a negotiable less decisive. Though it is desirable that
warehouse receipts issued by a bonded warehouseman
should conform to the provisions of the
41
Warehouseman Receipts Law, said provisions
Please read footnote 6.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 271 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

are not mandatory. Under Section 1 of the No person shall engage in the business of receiving
Warehouse Receipts Act, the issuance of a commodities for storage without first securing a
warehouse receipt in the form provided by it is license therefore from the Director of the Bureau of
merely permissive and directory and not Commerce and Industry. Said license shall be
obligatory. annual and shall expire on the thirty-first day of
December.
Commodities
Any farm, agricultural or horticultural Any person applying for a license shall set forth in
product; the application
animal and animal husbandry or the place or places where the business
livestock, dairy or poultry product; and warehouse are to be established or
water, marine or fish product; located and
mineral, chemical, drug or medicinal the maximum quantity of commodities
product; to be received.
forestry product; and any raw,
processed, manufactured or finished There shall be imposed an annual license fee of:
product or by-product P50 for the first 1000 square meters of
good, article, or merchandise, either of protected enclosure or 1000 cubic meters
domestic or of foreign production or of storage space, or any fraction of such
origin, which may be traded or dealt in enclosure or space, and
openly and legally. 2 centavos for each additional square
meter or cubic meter.
3. Business of Receiving Commodities for
Storage 5. Requirement of Bond

The business of receiving commodities for storage The application shall be accompanied by a cash
shall include any contract or transaction wherein bond or a bond secured by real estate or signed by
1. the warehouseman is obligated to a duly authorized bonding company at not less
return the very same commodities than 33 1/3% of the market value of the maximum
delivered to him or pay its value; quantity or commodities to be received.
2. the commodities delivered is to be Said bond shall be so conditioned as to respond for
milled for and on account of the the market value of the commodities actually
owner thereof; delivered and received at any time the
3. the commodities delivered is warehouseman is unable to return the commodities
commingled with the commodities or to pay its value.
delivered by or belonging to other The bond shall be approved by the Director of the
persons and the warehouseman is Bureau of Commerce and Industry before issuing a
obligated to return the commodities of license under this Act.
the same kind or pay its value. Whenever the Director shall determine that a bond
approved by him has become insufficient, he may
The kinds of commodity to be deposited must require an additional bond or bonds to be given by
be those, which may be traded or dealt in the warehouseman concerned.
openly and legally. Thus, illegal and prohibited Any person injured by the breach of any obligation
goods may not be validly received (Sec. 2) to secure which a bond is given, shall be entitled to
The warehouseman is not covered by law if the sue on the bond in his own name in any court of
owner merely rents space to a certain group of competent jurisdiction to recover the damages he
persons because the law covers warehouse that may have sustained by such breach.
accepts goods: (a) storage, (b) milling and
commingling with the obligation to return the Nothing contained herein shall except any property
same quantity or to pay their value. of assets of any warehouseman from being sued on
in case the bond given is not sufficient to respond
Limjoco vs Director of Commerce (1965) for the full market value of the commodities
received by such warehouseman.
Any contract or transaction wherein the palay
delivered is to be milled for and on account of the 6. Requirement of Insurance
owner shall be deemed included in the business of
receiving rice for storage. In other words, it is Every person licensed to engage in the business of
enough that the palay is delivered, even if only to receiving commodities for storage shall insure the
have it milled. commodities so received and stored against fire.
In this case it is a fact that palay is delivered to
appellant and sometimes piled inside her "camalig" For palay and corn license, a bond with the
in appreciable quantities, to wait for its turn in the National Grains Authority is required; also an
milling process. This is precisely the situation insurance cover is required
covered by the statute.
The main intention of the law-maker is to give
7. Duties of Bonded Warehouseman
protection to the owner of the commodity against
possible abuses (and we might add negligence) of
the person to whom the physical control of his 7.1. Storage of Commodities
properties is delivered.
Every warehouseman shall receive for storage,
4. Requirement of License so far as his license and the capacity of his
warehouse permit, any commodities, of the
kind customarily stored therein by him, which

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 272 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

may be tendered to him in a suitable condition iii. connivance with a warehouseman for the
for warehousing, in the usual manner and in purpose of evading the license requirement
the ordinary and usual course of business, (Sec. 13)
without making any discrimination between
persons desiring to avail themselves of
warehouse facilities.
1.III
Trust Receipts Law
7.2. Give the necessary bond (PD 115)
7.3. Insure against fire the commodity
received (Sec. 6) 1. Definition of Trust Receipt

7.4. Record-Keeping and Reporting As a document, it is a written or printed


Requirements document signed by the entrustee in favor of
the entruster whereby the latter releases the
Every warehouseman shall keep a complete goods to the possession of the former upon the
record of: entrustees promise to hold said goods in trust
for the entruster, to sell or dispose of the
the commodities received by him, goods, and to return the proceeds thereof to
the receipts issued therefor of the the extent of what is owing to the entruster;
withdrawals, OR to return the goods, if unsold or not
the liquidations and all receipts returned to otherwise dispose of (Sec. 4)
and cancelled by him. Trust Receipt transaction a separate and
independent security transaction intended to
He shall make reports to the Director of Bureau aid in financing importers and retail dealers
of Commerce and Industry concerning his who do not have sufficient funds to finance the
warehouse and the conditions, contents, importation/purchases and who may not be
operations, and business. able to acquire credit except through
utilization, as collateral, of the merchandise
7.5. Observe rules and regulations of the imported/purchased (Nacu vs. CA; South City
Bureau of Domestic Trade (Sec. 9) Home vs. BA Finance)
Goods are owned by the bank, and are only
A person injured by the breach of the released to the importer in trust after the grant
warehouseman may sue on the bond put of the loan. The bank acquires a security
up by the warehouseman to recover interest in the goods as holder of a security
damages he may have sustained on count title for the advances it made to the entrustee.
of such breach. In case the bond is Entrustee must deliver money or return unsold
insufficient to cover full market value of the goods to entrustor
commodity stored, he may sue on any Bank is preferred over other creditors.
property or assets of the warehouseman Bank is also not liable to buyer of goods as
not exempt by law from attachment and
vendor
execution (Sec. 7)
Purchaser from entrustee gets good title.
No particular form is required for trust receipt,
8. Warehouse Receipts Law vs. General but it must substantially contain:
Bonded Warehouse Act Description of the goods, documents or
instruments subject of the TR
Warehouse Receipts General Bonded Total invoice value of the goods and the
Law Warehouse Act amount of the draft to be paid by the
entrustee
Prescribes the mutual Regulates and
Undertaking or a commitment of the
duties and rights of a supervises warehouses
entrustee
warehouseman who which put up a bond
issues warehouse to hold in trust for the entruster
receipts, and his the goods, documents or
depositor, and covers all instruments therein described
warehouses whether to dispose of them in the
bonded or not manner provided for in the trust
receipt
*Bar Review Materials in Commercial Law - Jorge
Miravite, 2002 ed. to turn over the proceeds of the
sale of the goods, documents or
instruments to the entruster to the
9. Liabilities extent of the amount owing to the
entruster or as appears in the trust
a. civil: breach of obligations secured by the bond receipt or to return the goods,
b. criminal: documents or instruments in the
event of their non-sale within the
i. engaging in business covered by the Act in period specified therein (Sec. 5)
violation of the license requirement (Sec.
the trust receipt may contain other terms
11)
and conditions agreed upon by the parties
ii. receiving a quantity of commodity greater in addition to those hereinabove
than its capacity or that specified in the enumerated provided that such terms and
license, if the goods deposited are lost or conditions shall not be contrary to
destroyed (Sec. 12) provisions of this Decree, any existing laws,

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 273 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

public policy or morals, public order or to deliver them to a


good customs (Sec. 5) principal; or
trust receipts are denominated in Philippine to effect the
currency or acceptable and eligible foreign consummation of some
currency transactions involving delivery
to a depository or register; or
2. Purposes of the Law to effect their
presentation, collection or
To encourage the use of and promote renewal
transactions based on trust receipts; regulate
the use of trust receipts; encourage and The sale of goods/documents/instruments by a
promote the use of trust receipts as an person in the business of selling such for profit
additional and convenient aid to commerce and who, at the outset of the transaction, has, as
trade against the buyer,
To regulate trust receipt transactions in order general property rights in such goods/
to assure the protection of the rights and the documents/instruments, or
enforcement of the obligations of the parties who sells the same to the buyer on credit,
involved retaining title or other interest as security
To declare the misuse or misappropriation of for the payment of the purchase price
goods or the proceeds realized from the sale of does not constitute a trust receipt transaction and
goods released under trust receipts as an is outside the purview and coverage of this Decree.
offense punishable under Art. 315, RPC (Sec.
2) Notes :
To punish the dishonesty and abuse of This is not a simple loan transaction between a
confidence in the handling of money or goods creditor and debtor-importer
to the prejudice of another regardless of The law warrants the validity of the entrusters
whether or not the latter is the owner security interest as against the creditors of the
(Colinares vs. CA, 2000) trust receipt agreement.

3. Nature of Trust Receipt Transaction PD 115 Civil Code


Although the entrustee Buyer acquires only
Sec 4. Any transaction by and between an is not the owner of the whatever title the seller
entruster and an entrustee, whereby goods, anyone who buys has at the time the sale
the entruster, who owns/holds absolute title or from him acquires good is perfected (Art 1505)
title over the goods
security interests over certain specified goods,
Even if the entrustee is Generally, owner bears
documents or instruments
not the owner, he bears loss
releases the same to the possession of the
risk of loss while the
entrustee upon the latter's execution and
goods are in his
delivery of a signed document called a "trust
possession
receipt" wherein the entrustee binds himself
to hold the designated goods,
documents or instruments in trust for Landl & Co. (Phil) Inc. vs Metropolitan Bank
the entruster and (2004)
to sell or otherwise dispose of the
goods, documents or instruments with A trust receipt agreement is merely a collateral
the obligation to turn over to the agreement, the purpose of which is to serve as
entruster the proceeds or the goods, security for a loan.
documents or instruments themselves
if they are unsold or for other purposes Allied Banking vs Ordonez (1990)
substantially equivalent to any of the (Capital goods are covered.)
following:
Applies even to goods not destined for sale or
In the case of goods or documents manufacture, and would include items obtained to
to sell / procure their sale; or repair and maintain equipment used in business
to manufacture or process the
goods with the purpose of 4. Trust Receipts as Against Other
ultimate sale: Provided that the Transactions
entruster shall retain title over (Notes on Selected Commercial Laws: A Guide for
the goods whether in its Bar Reviewees, Tristan Catindig, 2003 ed.)
original or processed form until
the entrustee has complied fully Other Trust Receipt
with his obligation under the transactions Transaction
trust receipt; or Chattel subjects the no lien is created
to load, unload, ship or tranship Mortgage property to a over the property
or otherwise deal with them in lien
a manner preliminary or Pledge financer person financed
necessary to their sale; or possesses possesses the
the property property
In the case of instruments, Conditional There is a There is no sale of
to sell or procure Sale sale of the the property from
their sale or exchange; or property the entruster to
from the the entrustee

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 274 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

seller to the the contrary view of Prof. Catindig and


buyer the rulings in Colinares vs. CA and
Consignment 1.Bipartite 1. Tripartite Prudential Bank vs. IAC
2.Consignor 2. Seller does not
retains retain title to the 5.2. Entrustee
ownership of property borrower/buyer/importer
the property person to whom the goods are
delivered for sale or processing in trust,
with the obligation to return the
proceeds of sale of the goods or the
Colinares vs CA (2000) goods themselves to the entruster
(Loan vs trust receipts transaction) the owner of the goods purchased; in
fact, the law imposes on him the risk of
This situation belies what normally obtains in a loss of the goods. Res perit domino.
pure trust receipt transaction where goods are
owned by the bank and only released to the DBP vs. Pudential Bank, G.R. 143772,
importer in trust subsequent to the grant of the Nov. 22, 2005
loan. The bank acquires a security interest in the The entrustee has NO authority to mortgage goods
goods. The ownership of the merchandise covered by trust receipt.
continues to be vested in the person who had
advanced payment until he has been paid in full, or 5.3. Seller of the goods
if the merchandise has already been sold, the not strictly and actually a party to the
proceeds of the sale should be turned over to him. trust receipt transaction, but a party to
The bank takes full title to the goods and continues the contract of sale with the
to hold that as his indispensable security until the buyer/importer (entrustee)
goods are sold and the vendee is called upon to
pay for them. Trust receipts partake of the nature 6. Rights/Duties of the Entruster
of a conditional sale where the importer becomes
absolute owner of the imported merchandise as 6.1. Rights of Entruster
soon as he has paid its price.
Sec.7. The entruster shall be entitled to
Consolidated Bank vs CA (2001) the proceeds from the sale of the
(Simple loan vs trust receipt transaction) goods, documents or instruments to
the extent of the amount owing to the
The delivery to Corporation of the goods subject of entruster or as appears in the trust
the trust receipt occurred long before the trust receipt, or
receipt itself was executed. This situation is to the return of the goods, documents
inconsistent with what normally obtains in a pure or instruments in case of non-sale, and
trust receipt transaction, wherein the goods belong to the enforcement of all other rights
in ownership to the bank and are only released to conferred on him in the trust receipt
the importer in trust after the loan is granted. Extent of security interest
as against the innocent purchaser
Robles vs CA (1991) for value not preferred (Sec. 11)
(Bipartite transactions are covered). as against creditors of entrustee
preferred (Sec. 12)
In deciding WON the delivery trust receipts covered
a trial sale transaction or one that fell under the Prudential Bank vs NLRC (1995)
trust receipts law, the SC found that the requisites (Nature of interest of entruster in goods covered)
under Sec 4 were met:
1) Paramount retained ownership of the office The security interest of the entruster is not
equipment covered by the receipts; merely an empty or idle title. To a certain extent,
2) possession of the goods was subject to a such interest becomes a "lien" on the goods
fiduciary obligation to return them within a because the entruster's advances will have to be
specified period or to account for the settled first before the entrustee can consolidate
proceeds thereof his ownership over the goods. The law warrants
the validity of petitioner's security interest as
against all creditors of the trust receipt
5. Parties agreement. The only exception is when the
properties are in the hands of an innocent
5.1. Entruster purchaser for value and in good faith.
lender/financier
person holding title over the goods,
documents or instruments subject of a Prudential Bank vs NLRC (1995)
trust receipt transaction; releases The goods covered by trust receipts cannot be
possession of the goods upon execution levied upon by creditors of the entrustee.
of trust receipt
not the owner of the goods, but merely The entruster may cancel the trust and take
a holder of security interest possession of the goods, documents or
if it is made to appear in the trust instruments subject of the trust or of the
receipt as the owner of the goods proceeds realized therefrom at any time upon
purchased, it is merely theoretical, an default or failure of the entrustee to comply
artificial expedient and more of fiction with any of the terms and conditions of the
than fact (Garcia vs. CA; Vintola vs. trust receipt or any other agreement between
IBAA; PNB vs. Pineda); see, however, the entruster and the entrustee.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 275 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

return the goods, documents or


The entruster in possession of the goods, instruments in the event of non-sale or
documents or instruments may, on or after upon demand;
default, give notice to the entrustee of the observe all other terms and conditions
intention to sell, and may, not less than five of the trust receipt
days after serving or sending of such notice,
sell the goods, documents or instruments at Vintola vs IBAA (1987)
public or private sale, and the entruster may, (Liability of entrustee not extinguished by return
at a public sale, become a purchaser. of goods to entruster)

The proceeds of any such sale, whether public IBAA did not become the real owner of the goods
or private, shall be applied ; it was merely the holder of a security title for
to the payment of the expenses the advances it had made to the Vintolas. The
thereof; goods remain the Vintolas own property. The
to the payment of the expenses of re- trust receipt arrangement did not convert the
taking, keeping and storing the goods, IBAA into an investor. The fact that the Vintolas
documents or instruments; were unable to sell the seashells does not affect
to the satisfaction of the entrustee's IBAA's right to recover the advances made under
indebtedness to the entruster. the Letter of Credit

The entrustee shall receive any surplus but 7.3. Risk of Loss borne by entrustee
shall be liable to the entruster for any
deficiency. Sec. 10. The risk of loss shall be borne by the
entrustee ; irrespective of whether or not it was
6.2. Duties of Entruster due to the fault or negligence of the entrustee,
To give possession of the goods to the shall not extinguish his obligation to the entruster
entrustee for the value thereof.
To give at least 5 days notice to the
entrustee of the intention to sell the goods 7.4. Non-Liability of Entruster for Sale by
at an intended public sale Entrustee

Sec. 8. The entruster holding a security interest


State Investment vs CA (2000) shall not, merely by virtue of such interest or
(Entruster not entitled to proceeds of sale of having given the entrustee liberty of sale or other
goods not covered by trust receipt) disposition of the goods, documents or instruments
be responsible as principal or as vendor under any
The evidence for PNB fails to establish that the sale or contract to sell made by the entrustee.
vehicles sold to the Francos were among those
covered by the trust receipts. Neither the trust
receipts covering the units imported nor the
8. Purchaser in Good Faith
corresponding bills of lading contain the chassis
and engine numbers of the vehicles in question. Acquisition by purchaser of goods in good
faith
Sec 11. Any purchaser of goods from an entrustee
7. Rights/Duties of the Entrustee
with right to sell, or of documents or instruments
through their customary form of transfer, who buys
7.1. Rights of Entrustee such for value and in good faith from the entrustee,
acquires said goods, documents or instruments free
To receive the surplus from the public from the entruster's security interest.
sale
To have possession of the goods as a
condition for his liability under the Trust 9. Remedies Available
Receipt Law (Ramos vs. CA)
Failure to turn over proceeds of the sale of
7.2. Duties of Entrustee goods or to return unsold goods is a public
nuisance to be abated by the imposition of
Sec. 9. penal sanctions (Tiomico vs. Court of Appeals,
hold the goods, documents or 1999).
instruments in trust for the entruster and The offense is malum prohibitum. There is no
shall dispose of them strictly in accordance need to prove damage to the entrustor.
with the terms and conditions of the trust (Metropolitan Bank vs. Tonda, 2000), or intent
receipt; to defraud (People vs. Cuervo, 1981)
receive the proceeds in trust for the Offense: estafa under Art 315 of the Revised
entruster and turn over the same to the Penal Code.
extent of the amount owing to the Also, liable for damages under Art. 33, CC
entruster or as appears on the trust (Prudential vs. IAC, PP vs. Cuervo, MBTC vs.
receipt; Tonda)
insure the goods for their total value Effect of compliance:
against loss from fire, theft, pilferage or before criminal charge no criminal
other casualties; liability
keep said goods or proceeds separate after charge, before conviction
and capable of identification; extinguishments of criminal liability
Liability of entrustee accrues on his failure to
comply with his obligation to return. It is not

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 276 of 355


CODE OF COMMERCE COMMERCIAL LAW

absolutely necessary that the entruster cancels


the trust and take possession of the goods to Entrustor can:
be able to enforce his rights under this law. o cancel trust and take possession of the
PD 115 allows the bank to take possession of goods
the goods covered by the trust receipts. Thus, o file a 3rd party claim or separate civil action
even though the bank took possession of the at any time upon default or failure of
goods covered by the trust receipts, the entrustee to comply with terms and
entrustees remained liable for the entire conditions of the trust agreement
amount of the loans covered by the trust
receipts (Phil. Blooming vs. CA) Tupaz VI, et. al. vs. CA and BPI, G.R. 145578,
Nov. 18, 2005
Lee vs Rodil (1989)

Acts involving the violation of trust receipt Here, BPI chose not to file a separate civil action to
agreements occurring after 29 Jan 1973 would recover payment under the trust receipts. Instead,
make the accused criminally liable for estafa under respondent bank sought to recover payment in
par1(b), Art 315 of the RPC, pursuant to the Criminal Case Nos. 8848 and 8849. Although the
explicit provision in Sec. 13 of P.D. 115. trial court acquitted petitioner Jose Tupaz, his
acquittal did NOT extinguish his civil liability. His
Allied vs. Ordoez liability arose not from the criminal act of which he
was acquitted (ex delicto) but from the trust
The penal provisions of PD 115 encompasses any receipt contract (ex contractu) of 30 September
act violative of the obligation covered by the trust 1981. Petitioner Jose Tupaz signed the trust
receipt. It is not limited to transactions in goods receipt of 30 September 1981 in his personal
which are to be sold, reshipped or stored, but also capacity. Acquittal in a criminal case for estafa
applies to goods processed as a component of a does not extinguish civil liability arising from
product ultimately sold to the general public. breach of trust receipt contract.

Sarmiento, Jr. vs. CA (2002)

The breach of obligation of a trust receipt


agreement is separate and distinct from any
criminal liability for misuse and/or
misappropriation of goods or proceeds realized
from the sale of goods, documents or instruments
released under trust receipts, punishable under
Sec. 13 of the Trust Receipts Law (PD 115) in
relation to Article 315(1) (b) of the Revised Penal
Code. Being based on an obligation ex contractu
and not ex delicto, the civil action may proceed
independently of the criminal proceedings instituted
against petitioners regardless of the result of the
latter.

People vs Nitafan (1992)


(Violation of PD 115 is an offense against public
order, not property)

The Trust Receipts Law punishes the dishonesty


and abuse of confidence in the handling of money
or goods - it does not seek to enforce payment of
the loan. Thus, there can be no violation of a right
against imprisonment for non-payment of a debt.
P.D. 115, like BP 22, punishes the act "not as an
offense against property, but as an offense against
public order. Thus the law states that a breach of
a trust receipt agreement makes one liable for
estafa.

Philippines Bank vs Ong (2002)

The Supreme Court ruled that a Memorandum of


Agreement entered into between the bank-
entruster and entrustee extinguished the obligation
under the existing trust receipt because the
agreement did not only reschedule the debts of the
entrustee but it provided principal conditions which
are incompatible with the trust agreement. Hence,
the liability for breach of the Memorandum of
Agreement would be purely civil in nature and no
criminal liability under the Trust Receipt Law can be
imposed.

Prudential Bank vs. NLRC (1995)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 277 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

to the demands of a developing economy. (Sec.


2)
General Banking Law of 2000
1.04. BANKS, DEFINED: CORE BANKING
(RA 8791)
"Banks" shall refer to entities engaged in
Section 1 General Provisions 1. the lending of funds
2. obtained in the form of deposits. (SubSec.
3.1)
1.01. LONG TITLE
The lending of funds obtained in the form of
An act providing for the regulation of and deposits is classical or core banking function of
organization and operations of banks, quasi-banks, mobilizing savings (through deposit-taking) and
trust entities and for other purposes. allocating resources (through lending). It was
held in the case of RP v Security Credit and
Acceptance Corp (1967) that a bank is a
1.02. LAWS PRIMARILY APPLICABLE TO moneyed institute founded to facilitate the
42 borrowing, lending and safe-keeping of money
DIFFERENT BANKS
and to deal, in notes, bills of exchange and
credits. Moreover, an investment company
1. The General Banking Law (GBL) governs
which loans out the money of its customers,
collects the interest and charges a commission
a. Universal Banks (UB) (esp. Secs. 23-
to both lender and borrower, is a bank. xxx any
28)
person engage in the business carried on by
b. Commercial Banks (KB) (esp. Secs. 29-
banks of deposit, of discount, or of circulation
32)
is doing a banking business, although but one
of these functions is exercised. In reality,
2. The GBL has suppletory application to
however, banks do more than deposit-taking
and lending. Secs. 29 to 53 of the GBL
a. Thrift Banks (primarily governed by RA
enumerate these other activities which can all
7906, the Thrift Banks Act)
be conducted by a Universal Bank (UB). What
b. Rural Banks (primarily governed by RA
is more, both a UB and a Commercial Bank
7353, the Rural Banks Act)
(KB) can have equity interests in allied
c. Cooperative Banks (primarily governed
enterprises. UBs can also be stockholders in
by RA 6938, the Cooperative Code)
non-allied enterprises and can even exercise
(Sec. 71)
the powers of an investment house. (Morales)
Note: Sec 71: [1] For puposes of prescribing the
1.05. QUASI-BANKS, DEFINED
minimum ratio which the net worth of a thrift bank
must bear to its total risk assets, the provisions of
Section 33 [should be Sec. 34] of the GBL shall Quasi-banks" (QB) refer to entities engaged in
govern. [2] Although Sec. 71 provides that Islamic the borrowing of funds through the issuance,
banks shall be governed by special laws. It does endorsement or assignment with recourse or
not include Thrift Banks in the enumeration of acceptance of deposit substitutes (as defined in
Banks to which the GBL has application. Sec. 95 RA 7653, the New Central Bank Act)
for purposes of relending or purchasing of
3. The entry of foreign banks in the Phil. receivables and other obligations. (last par of
through the establishment of branches shall Sec. 4)
be governed by the provisions of the This is an inherent power of UBs and KBs. Thus
Foreign Banks Liberalization Act. The they do not require separate licensing or
conduct of offshore banking business in the authorization for this purpose. Thus, they can
Phil. shall be governed by PD 1034, the take deposit substitutes for re-lending.
"Offshore Banking System Decree." (Sec. (Morales)
72)
1.06. DEPOSIT SUBSTITUTES

1.03. POLICY OF THE GBL Deposit substitutes are


- deposits other than savings,
The State recognizes demand/current, time/fixed deposits, but
a. the vital role of banks in providing an also in the form of cash
environment conducive to the sustained - obtained from the public, i.e. 20 or more
development of the national economy and lenders at any one time
b. the fiduciary nature of banking that - obtained through the issuance,
requires high standards of integrity and endorsement, or acceptance with recourse
performance. to, of debt instruments (including, but not
limited to banker's acceptances, promissory
The State shall promote and maintain a stable notes, participations, certificates of
assignment, similar instruments with
and efficient banking and financial system that
recourse, and repurchase agreements)
is globally competitive, dynamic and responsive
- obtained for the purpose of relending or
purchasing of receivables and other
42 obligations. (Sec 95 NCBA; Subsec.
This topic was asked in 1980 and 2002. Note the
characteristics or functions of these banks. Also, pay X234.2.d Manual of Regulations for Banks)
attention to the limitations and restrictions on loans and
credit transactions which may be extended by the banks.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 278 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Deposit substitute taking may be classified as a under the NCBA and other applicable laws.
core-banking operation, especially in the case (Sec. 6)
of UBs and KBs, which are allowed, under Sec. No person, association, or corporation unless
6 of the GBL, to engage in Quasi-banking duly authorized to engage in the business of a
activities (more appropriately termed deposit bank, QB, trust entity, or savings and loan
substitute operations, as there is nothing association shall advertise or hold itself out as
"quasi" about banks performing these being engaged in the business of such bank,
operations themselves). Since a deposit QB, trust entity, or association, or use in
substitute is merely a product of the activity connection with its business title, the word or
called Quasi-banking (deposit substitute words "bank", "banking", "banker", "QB ",
operations), deposit substitute taking may be "quasi-banking", "quasi-banker", "savings and
considered a core banking function in the sense loan association", "trust corporation", "trust
that it mobilizes savings through deposit- company" or words of similar import or
substitute taking. It should likewise be noted transact in any manner the business of any
that the purpose of a deposit-substitute is such bank, corporation or association. (Sec.
relending, which is also a core banking 64)
function. (Morales)
The BSP supervises QBs, i.e. entities engaged An entity authorized by the BSP to perform UB
in obtaining deposit substitutes. This or KB functions shall likewise have the
supervision was premised on the finding by the authority to engage in quasi-banking functions.
Joint IMF-CBP Banking Survey Commission that (Sec. 6)
institutions regularly engaged in the lending
of funds obtained from the public through the Note: The determination of whether a person or
issuance of their own debt instruments (other entity is performing banking or quasi-banking
than deposit instruments) [and] beyond the functions without Bangko Sentral authority shall be
pale of CB regulatory authority weakened to a decided by the MB. To resolve such issue, the MB
large extent the effectiveness of CB action in may, through the appropriate supervising and
the field of credit regulations. This unregulated examining department of the BSP, examine,
segment of the financial system was the inspect or investigate the books and records of
money market that had developed since the such person or entity. Upon issuance of this
1960s by what later became known as authority, such person or entity may commence to
investment houses. The said money market engage in banking operations or quasi-banking
involved short-term instruments, and emerged functions and shall continue to do so unless such
in response to interest rate ceilings imposed by authority is sooner surrendered, revoked,
the Usury Law. These ceilings then applied to suspended or annulled by the BSP in accordance
deposits in banks but not to placements course with this Act or other special laws. The department
through the investment houses. Naturally, head and the examiners of the appropriate
investors flocked to these houses for higher supervising and examining department are hereby
yields. Before long, the deposit generating authorized to administer oaths to any such person,
ability of the banks was seriously undermined employee, officer, or director of any such entity
by the competition. In 1972, the hitherto and to compel the presentation or production of
unfettered money market was called Quasi- such books, documents, papers or records that are
banking and subjected to CB regulation, and reasonably necessary to ascertain the facts relative
funds placed with quasi-banks were labeled as to the true functions and operations of such person
deposit substitutes. (Morales) or entity. Failure or refusal to comply with the
required presentation or production of such books,
documents, papers or records within a reasonable
time shall subject the persons responsible therefor
to the penal sanctions provided under the NCBA.
1.07. CLASSIFICATION OF BANKS
(Sec. 6)

1. Universal banks (UB); 1.09. AUTHORITY OF THE BSP


2. Commercial banks (KB);
3. Thrift banks, composed of:
a. Savings and mortgage banks, A. Supervision
b. Stock savings and loan associations, and
c. Private development banks,; The operations and activities of banks shall be
4. Rural banks; subject to supervision of the Bangko Sentral.
5. Cooperative banks; "Supervision" shall include the following:
6. Islamic banks (under RA 6848, Charter of Al
Amanah Islamic Investment Bank of the 1. The issuance of rules of conduct or the
Phils.); establishment of standards of operation for
7. Other classifications of banks as determined by uniform application to all institutions or
the MB of the BSP. functions covered;
2. The conduct of examination to
1.08. RULE ON BANKING OPERATIONS determine compliance with laws and
regulations;
No person or entity shall engage in banking 3. Overseeing to ascertain that laws and
regulations are complied with;
operations or quasi-banking functions without
4. Regular investigation (not oftener than
authority from the BSP. Persons or entities
once a year) to determine whether an
found to be performing banking or quasi-
institution is conducting its business on a
banking functions without authority from the
safe or sound basis;
BSP shall be subject to appropriate sanctions

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 279 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

5. Inquiring into the solvency and liquidity amendment thereto, unless accompanied by a
of the institution; or certificate of authority issued by the MB, under its
6. Enforcing prompt corrective action. seal. Such certificate shall not be issued unless the
(Sec. 4) MB is satisfied from the evidence submitted to it
that:
* The BSP shall also have supervision over
QBs, trust entities and other financial 1. all requirements of existing laws and
institutions which under special laws are regulations to engage in the business for
subject to BSP supervision. (Sec. 4) which the applicant is proposed to be
incorporated have been complied with;
2. the public interest and economic conditions,
The BSP shall, when examining a bank, have
both general and local, justify the
the authority to examine an enterprise which is authorization; and
wholly or majority-owned or controlled by the 3. the amount of capital, the financing,
bank. (Sec. 7) organization, direction and administration,
as well as the integrity and responsibility of
the organizers and administrators
B. Policy Direction reasonably assure the safety of deposits
and the public interest. (Sec. 14)
The BSP shall provide policy direction in the areas
of money, banking and credit. For this purpose, the
MB may prescribe ratios, ceilings, limitations, or 2.03. PSE-LISTED BANKING CORPORATION
other forms of regulation on the different types of SUBJECT TO SEC REPORTORIAL RULES
accounts and practices of banks and QBs which
shall, to the extent feasible, conform to A commercial banking corporation listed in the PSE
internationally accepted standards, including those must adhere not only to the banking and other
of the Bank for International Settlements (BIS). allied special laws, but also to the rules
The Monetary Board may exempt particular promulgated by the SEC, the government entity
categories of transactions from such ratios, ceilings tasked not only with the enforcement of the
and limitations, but not limited to exceptional cases Revised Securities Act, but also the supervision of
or to enable a bank or quasi-bank under all corporations, partnerships or associations which
rehabilitation or during a merger or consolidation to are grantees of government-issued primary
continue in business with safety to its creditors, franchises and/or licenses or permits to operate in
depositors and the general public. (Sec. 5) the Phils.. That such banking institution is under
the supervision of BSP and PSE, does not exempt it
from complying with the continuing discluse
C. Authority of BSP over Building and Home requirements embodied in the RSA Rules. The
Associations bank is primarily subject to the control of BSP; and
as a corporation trading its securities in the stock
Within a period of 3 years from the effectivity of market, it is under the supervision of SEC. There is
the GBL, the BSP shall phase out and transfer its no over-supervision here; each regulating authority
supervising and regulatory powers over operates within the sphere of its powers; the
building and loan associations to the Home stringent requirement imposed are understandable,
Insurance and Guaranty Corporation which shall considering the paramount importance given to the
assume the same. (Sec. 94) interests of the investing public. (Union Bank of the
Phils. v SEC, 2001)

Section 2 Organization, Management


and Administration of Banks, Quasi-
Banks and Trust Entities 2.04. PROHIBITION ON TREASURY STOCKS

No bank shall purchase or acquire shares of its own


capital stock or accept its own shares as a security
2.01. CONDITIONS FOR THE ORGANIZATION
for a loan, except when authorized by the MB:
OF BANKS AND QBS
Provided, That in every case the stock so
purchased or acquired shall, within 6 months from
The Monetary Board may authorize the
the time of its purchase or acquisition, be sold or
organization of a bank or quasi-bank subject to the
disposed of at a public or private sale. (Sec. 10)
following conditions:
1. entity must be a stock corporation and
must only issue par value stocks;
2. its funds must be obtained from the
public, which shall mean 20 or more 2.05. RESTRICTIONS ON FOREIGN
persons; and STOCKHOLDINGS
3. minimum capital requirements
prescribed by the MB for each category of Foreign individuals and non-bank corporations may
banks must be satisfied (Sec. 8). own or control up to 40% of the voting stock of a
domestic bank. This rule shall apply to Filipinos and
domestic non-bank corporations. (Sec. 11)
2.02. CERTIFICATE OF AUTHORITY TO
REGISTER

The SEC shall not register the articles of


incorporation or the by-laws of any bank, or any

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 280 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Stockholdings of Family Groups or Related


Interests. Individuals related to each other
within the 4th degree of consanguinity or affinity,
whether legitimate, illegitimate or common-law,
shall be considered family groups or related
interests but may each own up to 40% of the
voting stock of a domestic bank: Provided, That
2.06. GRANDFATHER RULE said relationship must be fully disclosed in all
transactions by such individual or family group with
the bank.
The percentage of foreign-owned voting stocks in a
bank shall be determined by the citizenship of the
individual stockholders in that bank. The citizenship Corporate Stockholdings. 2/more corporations
of the corporation which is a stockholder in a bank owned or controlled by the same family group or
shall follow the citizenship of the controlling same group of persons shall be considered related
stockholders of the corporation, irrespective of the interests but may each own up to 40% of the
place of incorporation. (Sec. 11) voting stock of a domestic bank: Provided, That
said relationship must be fully disclosed in all
transactions by such corporations or related groups
BSP Circular 256 (2000) of persons with the bank.
Section 1. Foreign individuals and non-bank A natural person and a corporation or
corporations may own or control up to 40% of the corporations which are wholly-owned, or a
voting stock of a domestic bank: Provided, That the majority of the voting stock of which is
aggregate foreign owned voting stocks shall not owned, by him may own only up to a
exceed 40% of the outstanding voting stock of the combined 40% of the voting stock of a
bank. domestic bank.
Section 2. A Filipino individual and a domestic non- Every natural person acquiring shares
bank corporation may each own up to 40% of the cumulatively amounting to at least 2% of
voting stock of a domestic bank. There shall be no the total subscribed capital of a domestic
aggregate ceiling on the ownership by such bank must disclose all relevant information
individuals and corporations in a domestic bank. on all persons related to him within the 4th
Section 3. The citizenship of the corporation which degree of consanguinity or affinity as well as
is a stockholder of a bank shall follow the corporations, partnerships or associations
citizenship of the controlling stockholders of the where he has controlling interests. A
corporation, irrespective of the place of corporation acquiring shares amounting to at
incorporation. The term "controlling stockholders" least 2% of the total subscribed capital of a
shall refer to individuals holding more than 50% of domestic bank must disclose its controlling
the voting stock of the corporate stockholder. stockholder or group of stockholders as well
Section 4 The right of Philippine corporations, as the corporations, partnerships or
however, under Sec. 8 of RA 7721 (Act Liberalizing associations where such controlling
the Entry of Foreign Banks), to wit: stockholder or group of stockholders have
"x x x Any right, privilege or incentive granted controlling interest.
to foreign banks or their subsidiaries or Ceilings on stockholdings in a
affiliates under this Act, shall be equally
cooperative bank. The equity investment
enjoyed by and extended under the same
of any cooperative in any Cooperative Bank
conditions to Philippine banks. Philippine
shall not exceed 40% of the subscribed
corporations whose shares of stocks are listed
capital stock of such Cooperative Bank.
in the PSE or are of long standing for at least
Any arrangement, such as voting trust
10 years shall have the right to acquire,
agreement or proxy, which vests on any
purchase or own up to 60% of the voting stock
person or corporation the right to vote or
of a domestic bank."
control voting stocks in banks, if such
shall continue to be in force and effect.
agreement in itself, or in relation with
another previous similar agreement or
previous sale or transfer shall result in the
acquisition of control, in excess of the
2.07. DISCLOSURE OF STOCKHOLDINGS OF
prescribed limitations is unlawful and void.
FAMILY GROUPS OR RELATED INTERESTS
Transfers requiring prior Monetary Board
Stockholdings of individuals related to each approval.
other within the fourth degree of consanguinity (a) Any sale or transfer or series of sales or
or affinity, legitimate or common-law, shall be transfers which will result in ownership or
considered family groups or related interests control of more than 20% of the voting stock of
and must be fully disclosed in all transactions a bank by any person whether natural or
by such an individual with the bank. (Sec. 12) juridical or which will enable such person to
Two or more corporations owned or controlled elect, or be elected as, a director of such bank;
by the same family group or same group of and
persons shall be considered related interests (b) Any sale or transfer or series of sales or
and must be fully disclosed in all transactions transfers which will effect a change in the
by such corporations or related groups of majority ownership or control of the voting
persons with the bank. (Sec. 13) stock of the bank from one group of persons to
another group: Provided, That in no case shall
such sale or transfer be approved unless the
bank concerned shall immediately comply with
BSP Circular 332 (2002)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 281 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

the prescribed minimum capital requirement for The following are Temporarily disqualified:
new banks Directors/officers/employees disqualified
by the MB
.Persons who refuse to fully disclose the
extent of their business interest. This
disqualification shall be in effect as long
as the refusal persists;
Directors who have been absent or who
Section 3 Board of Directors and have not participated for whatever
Officers reasons in more than 50% of all
meetings, both regular and special, of the
board of directors during their
3.01. COMPOSITION OF THE BOARD OF
incumbency, or any 12 month period
DIRECTORS
during said incumbency. This
The provisions of the Corporation Code to the disqualification applies for purposes of
contrary notwithstanding, there shall be at the succeeding election;
least 5, and a maximum of 15 members of the Persons who are delinquent in the
board of directors of bank, 2 of whom shall be payment of their obligations.
independent directors. An "independent Delinquency in the payment of
director" shall mean a person other than an obligations means that an obligation of a
officer or employee of the bank, its subsidiaries person with a bank/quasi bank/trust
or affiliates or related interests. (Sec. 15) entity where he/she is a director or
In the case of a bank merger or consolidation, officer, or at least two obligations with
the number of directors shall not exceed 21. other banks/financial institution, under
(Sec. 17) different credit lines or loan contracts,
Non-Filipino citizens may become members of are past due. This disqualification shall
the board of directors of a bank to the extent of be in effect as long as the delinquency
the foreign participation in the equity of said persists.
bank. (Sec. 15 with Sec. 7, RA 7721) Persons convicted for offenses involving
dishonesty, breach of trust or violation of
banking laws but whose conviction has
3.02. QUALIFICATIONS / not yet become final and executory;
DISQUALIFICATIONS OF DIRECTORS (BSP Directors and officers of closed
CIRCULAR 296 ; 2001) banks/quasi-banks/trust entities pending
their clearance by the MB;
A director shall have the following minimum Directors disqualified for failure to
qualifications: observe/discharge their duties and
At least 25 years of age at the time of responsibilities prescribed under existing
his election or appointment; regulations. This disqualification applies
At least a college graduate or have at until the lapse of the specific period of
least 5 years experience in business; disqualification or upon approval by the
Must have attended a special seminar MB;Directors who failed to attend the
for board of directors conducted or special seminar for board of directors
accredited by the BSP: required;
Must be fit and proper for the position Persons dismissed/terminated from
of a director of the bank/quasi- employment for cause. This
bank/trust entity. In determining disqualification shall be in effect until
whether a person is fit and proper for they have cleared themselves of
the position of a director, the following involvement in the alleged irregularity;
matters must be considered: Those under preventive suspension; or
- integrity/probity; Persons with derogatory records with the
- competence; NBI, court, police, interpol and monetary
- education; authority (central bank) of other
- diligence; and countries (for foreign directors and
- experience/training. officers) involving violation of any law,
rule or regulation of the Government or
The following are Permanently disqualified from any of its instrumentalities adversely
being directors : affecting the integrity and/or ability to
Directors/officers/employees permanently discharge the duties of a bank/quasi
disqualified by the MB; bank/trust entity director/officer. This
Persons who have been convicted by final disqualification applies until they have
judgement for offenses involving cleared themselves of involvement in the
dishonesty or breach of trust; alleged irregularity.
Persons who have been convicted by final
judgement for violation of banking laws;
Persons who have been judicially 3.03.
declared insolvent, spendthrift or QUALIFICATIONS/DISQUALIFICATIONS
incapacitated to contract; or OF OFFICERS (BSP CIRCULAR 296 ; 2001)
Directors, officers or employees of closed An officer shall have the following minimum
banks/quasi-banks/trust entities who qualifications:
were responsible for such institutions At least 21 years of age;
closure. At least a college graduate, or have at
least 5 years experience in banking or

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 282 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

trust operations or related activities or in the board of directors of the bank, the MB may
a field related to his position and disqualify, suspend or remove any bank
responsibilities, or have undergone director or officer who commits or omits an act
training in banking or trust operations which render him unfit for the position. In
acceptable to the appropriate supervising determining whether an individual is fit and
and examining department of the BSP: proper to hold the position of a director or
Provided, however, That trust officers officer of a bank, regard shall be given to his
shall have at least 2 years of actual integrity, experience, education, training, and
experience or training in trust operations competence. (Sec. 16)
or fund management or other related
fields; and The suspension of bank officers which is only
Must be fit and proper for the position he preventive in nature would require no notice or
is being proposed/appointed to. In hearing, and until such time that the officers
determining whether a person is fit and have proved their innocence, they may be
proper for a particular position, the preventively suspended from holding office so
following matters must be considered: as not to influence the conduct of investigation,
- integrity/probity; and to prevent the commission of further
- competence; irregularities. (Busego v CA, 1999)
- education;
- diligence; and As a general rule, a banking corporation is
- experience/training. liable for the wrongful or tortuous acts and
The disqualifications for directors declarations of its officers or agents within the
mentioned for shall likewise apply to course and scope of their employment. A bank
officers, except that stated in Items b.2 will be held liable for the negligence of its
(persons who refuse to fully disclose the officers or agents when acting within the course
extent of their business interest ) and b.7 and scope of their employment. It may be
(directors disqualified for failure to liable for the tortuous acts of its officers even
observe/discharge their duties and as regards that species of tort of which malice
responsibilities). is an essential element. A bank holding out its
Except as may be authorized, the officers and agents as worthy of confidence will
spouse or a relative within the 2nd not be permitted to profit by the frauds these
degree of consanguinity or affinity of any officers or agents were enabled to perpetrate in
person holding the position of Chairman, the apparent course of their employment; nor
President, Executive Vice President or will it be permitted to shirk its responsibility for
any position of equivalent rank, General such frauds, even though no benefit may
Manager, Treasurer, Chief Cashier or accrue to the bank therefrom. If an officer or
Chief Accountant is disqualified from official of a bank in his official capacity receives
holding or being elected or appointed to money to satisfy an evidence of indebtedness
any of said positions in the same lodged for his bank collection, the bank is liable
bank/quasi-bank; and the spouse or for his misappropriation of such sum. (PCI
relative within the second degree of Bank v CA, 2001)
consanguinity or affinity of any person
holding the position of Manager, Cashier, 3.05. GOOD GOVERNANCE (BSP CIRCULAR
or Accountant of a branch or office of a 283; 2001)
bank/quasi-bank/trust entity is The position of a bank/quasi-bank/trust entity
disqualified from holding or being director is a position of trust. A director assumes
appointed to any of said positions in the certain responsibilities to different constituencies or
same branch or office. stakeholders These constituencies or stakeholders
In the case of UBs, CBs, and TBs, any have the right to expect that the institution is being
appointive or elective officials whether run in a prudent and sound manner.
full time or part time, except in cases
where such service is incident to financial The board of directors is primarily responsible for
assistance provided by the government the corporate governance of the bank/quasi-
or government-owned or controlled bank/trust entity. To ensure good governance of
corporations or in cases allowed under the bank/quasi-bank/trust entity, the board of
existing law. directors should establish strategic objectives,
In the case of Cooperative Banks, any policies and procedures that will guide and direct
officer or employee of the Cooperative the activities of the bank/quasi-bank/ trust entity
Development Authority or any elective and the means to attain the same as well as the
public official, except a barangay official. mechanism for monitoring managements
Except as may otherwise be allowed performance.
under The Anti-Dummy Law, as
amended, foreigners cannot be officers or 3.06. REGULATION OF THE COMPENSATION
employees of banks. AND OTHER BENEFITS OF DIRECTORS AND
OFFICERS
3.04. FIT AND PROPER RULE To protect the funds of depositors and
To maintain the quality of bank management creditors, the MB may regulate the payment by
and afford better protection to depositors and the bank to its directors and officers of
the public in general, the MB shall prescribe, compensation, allowance, fees, bonuses, stock
pass upon and review the qualifications and options, profit sharing and fringe benefits only
disqualifications of individuals elected or in exceptional cases and when the
appointed bank directors or officers and circumstances warrant, such as but not limited
disqualify those found unfit. After due notice to to the following instances when a bank is

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 283 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

1. under comptrollership or conservatorship; 3.11. STRIKES AND LOCKOUTS


or The banking industry is hereby declared as
2. found by the MB to be conducting business indispensable to the national interest. (Sec. 22)
in an unsafe or unsound manner; Notwithstanding the provisions of any law to
3. found by the MB to be in an unsatisfactory
the contrary, any strike or lockout involving
financial condition. (Sec. 18)
banks, if unsettled after 7 calendar days shall
be reported by the BSP to the Secretary of
Labor who may assume jurisdiction over the
dispute, decide it, or certify the same to the
3.07. PROHIBITION AGAINST PUBLIC NLRC for compulsory arbitration. However, the
OFFICIALS President of the Philippines may at any time
No appointive or elective public official, intervene and assume jurisdiction over such
whether full-time or part-time shall at the same labor dispute in order to settle or terminate the
time serve as officer of any private bank, save same. (Sec.22)
in cases where
1. such service is incident to financial
assistance provided by the government or a
Section 4 Deposits
GOCC to the bank or
2. unless otherwise provided in the Rural
Banks Act, 4.01. ACCEPTANCE OF DEMAND DEPOSITS
3. unless otherwise provided under existing
laws. (Sec. 19) A bank other than a UB or KB cannot accept or
create demand deposits except upon prior approval
of, and subject to such conditions and rules as may
3.08. CONDUCT OF BOARD OF DIRECTORS be prescribed by the Monetary Board. (Sec. 33)
MEETINGS
4.02. TYPES OF DEPOSITS
The meetings of the board of directors may be
1. Time Deposit Interest rate stipulated
conducted through modern technologies such
depending on the number of days. During this
as, but not limited to, teleconferencing and period, the money deposited cannot be
video-conferencing. (Sec. 15)
withdrawn. High interest rates.
2. Savings Deposit Under the fine print, if you
3.09. BANK BRANCHES deposit today, you cannot withdraw the amount
until 60 days later. Bank pays an interest rate,
Universal or commercial banks may open but not as high as time deposits.
branches or other offices within or outside the 3. Demand Deposits / Current Accounts No
Phils. upon prior approval of the BSP. interest is paid by the bank because the
Branching by all other banks shall be governed depositor can take out his funds any time. It is
by pertinent laws. (Sec. 20) called demand deposit because the depositor
can withdraw the money he deposited on the
A bank authorized to establish branches or very same day when he deposited it.
other offices shall be responsible for all (Villanueva)
business conducted in such branches and
offices to the same extent and in the same 4.03. MAY ALL BANKS ACCEPT DEMAND
manner as though such business had all been DEPOSITS?
conducted in the head office. A bank and its
branches and offices shall be treated as one GR: A bank cannot accept or create demand
unit. (Sec. 20) deposits except upon prior approval of, and subject
to such conditions and rules as may be prescribed
A bank may, subject to prior approval of the by the MB. (Sec. 33)
MB, use any or all of its branches as outlets for Exc: UBs and KBs
the presentation and/or sale of the financial
products of its allied undertaking or of its
investment house units. (Sec. 20) 4.04. BANKS AS DEBTORS

3.10. BANKING DAYS AND HOURS


As per Art. 1980 of the Civil Code, loans from the
Unless otherwise authorized by the BSP in the depositor (creditor) to a bank (debtor) may be in
interest of the banking public, all banks the form of savings deposits, demand/current
including their branches and offices shall deposits (all those liabilities of the BSP and of
transact business on all working days for at other banks which are denominated in Phil currency
least 6 hours a day. (Sec. 21) and are subject to payment in legal tender upon
demand by the presentation of checks as per Sec.
Working days shall mean Mondays to Fridays, 58 of NCBA) and time/fixed deposits. For this
except if such days are holidays. (Sec. 21) reason, San Carlos Milling Co., Ltd v. BPI, 1933)
declared that banks are run for gain, and they
Banks or any of their branches or offices may solicit deposits in order that they can use the
open for business on Saturdays, Sundays or money for that very purpose. For the same
holidays for at least 3 hours a day. Banks reason, it has been held that a bank has a right of
which opt to open on days other than working set off of the deposits in its hands for the payment
days shall report to the BSP the additional days of any indebtedness to it on the part of a
during which they or their branches or offices depositor. (Gullas v. PNB, 1935) Conversely, the
shall transact business. (Sec. 21) depositor has every right to apply his deposit in a
bank against his loan from such bank. (RP v. CA,

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 284 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

1975) (Morales; Villanueva cites Serrano v. CB, HELD: Bank was negligent and so Sps. Tan entitled
1980; Ppl v. Ong, 1991) to damages. Failure to present original deposit slip,
which could have proven its claim that it did not
4.05. PRESUMPTION OF OWNERSHIP OF receive respondents missing check was a
DEPOSITS suppression of the best evidence that could have
It is presumed that money deposited in a bank bolstered its claim and confirmed its innocence, the
account belongs to the person in whose name presumption now arises that it withheld the same for
the deposit account is opened. A bank is fraudulent purposes. Citing the case of Canlas v.
justified in paying out the money to the Asian Savings Bank (2000), the Court held that the
depositor or upon his order, and cannot be degree of diligence required of banks is more than
liable to any other person who turned out to he that of a good father of a family in keeping with their
the true owner of the funds deposited. Thus, it responsibility to exercise the necessary care and
was held in Fulton Iron Works Co v China prudence in handling their clients money. It find no
Banking Corp (1930), The specialized function compelling reason to disallow the application of the
of a bank is to serve as a place of deposit for provisions on common carriers to this case if only to
money, to keep it safely while on deposit, and emphasize the fact that banking institutions (like
to pay it out, upon demand, to the person who petitioner) have the duty to exercise the highest
effected the deposit or upon his order. A bank
degree of diligence when transacting with the public.
is not a guardian of trust funds deposited w/ it
By the nature of their business, they are required to
in the sense that it must see to their proper
observe the highest standards of integrity and
application, not is it its business to pry into the
uses to which money on deposit in its vault are performance, and utmost assiduousness as well.
being put; and so long as it serves its function
and pays the money out in good faith to the 4.07. OPTION TO EXERCISE SET-OFF ON
person who deposited it, or upon his order, DEPOSIT FOR OUTSTANDING LOAN
w/out knowledge or notice that it is in fact A bank is under no duty or obligation to make an
assisting in the misappropriation of the fund, application or set-off against the deposit accounts
the bank will be protected. As is well said it of a borrower. To apply the deposit to the
would seriously interfere w/ commercial payment of a loan is a privilege, a right of set-off
transactions to charge banks w/ the duty of which the bank has the option to exercise, but not
supervising the administration of trust funds, the obligation. (BPI v. CA, 1994)
when, in due course of business, they receive
checks and drafts in proper form drawn upon
such funds in their custody. The law imposes 4.08. NOTE ON SAFETY DEPOSIT BOXES
no such duty upon them. Note however that In the case of rent of safety deposit box. The
there is a limitation in this regard as per contract is a special kind of deposit and cannot be
survivorship agreements. (Morales) characterized as an ordinary contract of lease
because the full and absolute possession and
control of the deposit box is not given to the
4.06. OBLIGATION OF BANKS TO DEPOSITORS renters. The prevailing rule is that the relation
between the bank renting out and the renter is that
The bank is under the obligation to treat of bailer and bailee the bailment being for hire and
mutual benefiit. (CA Agro-industrial Dev. Corp. v.
deposit accounts of it depositors with
CA, 1983; reiterated in Sia v. CA, 1993, according
meticulous care. It must bear the blame for 43
failing to discover the mistake of its employees to Villanueva)
despite the established procedure requiring
bank papers to pass through bank personnel 4.09. MB ORDER OF CLOSURE
whose duty it is to check and countercheck In case a bank or QB notifies the BSP or publicly
them for possible errors. (Metropolitan Bank announces a bank holiday, or in any manner
and Trust Co. v. CA, 1994 and Firestone Tire v suspends the payment of its deposit liabilities
CA, 2001) continuously for more than 30 days, the MB may
summarily and without need for prior hearing close
As a business affected with public interest and such banking institution and place it under
because of the nature of its functions, a bank is receivership of the Phil. Deposit Insurance Corp.
under obligation to treat the accounts of its (PDIC). (Sec. 53)
depositors with meticulous case, always having
in mind the fiduciary nature of their
relationship. (PCI Bank v. CA, 1997) Section 5 Loans

Solidbank Corporation/ Metropolitan Bank and 5.01. RISK-BASED CAPITAL RATIO


Trust Co. v. Sps. Tan The MB shall prescribe the minimum ratio which
GR No. 167346 the net worth of a bank must bear to its total risk
April 2, 2007 assets which may include contingent accounts [i.e.
10 checks were deposited by representative of Sps. net worth : total risk assets] (Sec. 33)
Tan and upon checking their passbook, it was
discovered that one check was not posted. The bank
proffered the duplicate deposit slip which indicated 5.02. BSP CIRCULAR 280 (2001)
that the said check was not deposited but it was The risk-based capital ratio of a bank, expressed as
discovered that it had been cleared in another bank a percentage of qualifying capital to risk-weighted
by another person. Sps. Tan filed a collection case assets, shall not be less than 10% for both solo
against the bank and was able to get favorable
judgment from RTC and CA. 43
This topic was asked in 2004. Note the liability of back
in case of loss.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 285 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

basis (head office plus branches) and consolidated The basis for determining compliance with SBL
basis (parent bank plus subsidiary financial allied is the total credit commitment of the bank to
undertakings, but excluding insurance the borrower. (Sec. 35.1)
companies). The ratio shall be maintained daily. Unless the MB prescribes otherwise, the total
amount of loans, credit accommodations and
guarantees prescribed in the preceding
paragraph may be increased by an additional
5.03. POWER OF THE MB IN THIS REGARD 10% of the net worth of such bank provided
The MB may the additional liabilities of any borrower are
- require that such ratio be determined on adequately secured by trust receipts, shipping
the basis of the net worth and risk assets of documents, warehouse receipts or other similar
a bank and its subsidiaries, financial or documents transferring or securing title
otherwise; covering readily marketable, non-perishable
- prescribe the composition and the manner goods which must be fully covered by
of determining the net worth and total risk insurance. (Sec. 35.2)
assets of banks and their subsidiaries. Inclusions. The above prescribed ceilings shall
Provided, that include:
- in the exercise of this authority, the MB a. the direct liability of the maker or acceptor
shall, to the extent feasible, conform to of paper discounted with or sold to such
internationally accepted standards, bank and the liability of a general indorser,
including those of the Bank for drawer or guarantor who obtains a loan or
International Settlements (BIS), other credit accommodation from or
relating to risk-based capital discounts paper with or sells papers to such
requirements; bank;
- the MB may alter or suspend b. in the case of an individual who owns or
compliance with such ratio whenever controls a majority interest in a
necessary for a maximum period of 1 corporation, partnership, association or any
year; and, other entity, the liabilities of said entities to
- such ratio shall be applied uniformly to such bank;
banks of the same category. (Sec. 33) c. in the case of a corporation, all liabilities to
such bank of all subsidiaries in which such
corporation owns or controls a majority
In case of a bank merger or consolidation, or interest; and
when a bank is under rehabilitation under a d. in the case of a partnership, association or
program approved by the BSP, the MB may other entity, the liabilities of the members
temporarily relieve the surviving bank, thereof to such bank. (35.3)
consolidated bank, or constituent bank or
corporations under rehabilitation from full * Even if a parent corporation, partnership,
compliance with the required capital ratio under association, entity or an individual who
such conditions as it may prescribe. (Sec. 33) owns or controls a majority interest in such
entities has no liability to the bank, the MB
may prescribe the combination of the
liabilities of subsidiary corporations or
members of the partnership, association,
5.04. EFFECT OF NON-COMPLIANCE
entity or such individual under certain
The MB may limit or prohibit the distribution of circumstances, including but not limited to
net profits by such bank and may require that any of the following situations:
part or all of the net profits be used to increase
the capital accounts of the bank until the a. the parent corporation, partnership,
minimum requirement has been met. association, entity or individual
The MB may, furthermore, restrict or prohibit guarantees the repayment of the
the acquisition of major assets and the making liabilities;
of new investments by the bank, with the b. the liabilities were incurred for the
exception of purchases of readily marketable accommodation of the parent
evidences of indebtedness of the RP and the corporation or another subsidiary or of
BSP and any other evidences of indebtedness the partnership or association or entity
or obligations the servicing and repayment of or such individual; or
which are fully guaranteed by the RP, until the c. the subsidiaries though separate
minimum required capital ratio has been entities operate merely as departments
restored. (Sec. 33) or divisions of a single entity. (35.4)

** Certain types of contingent accounts


of borrowers may be included among
those subject to these prescribed limits
5.05. SINGLE BORROWERS LIMIT (SBL)
as may be determined by the MB.
Except as the MB may otherwise prescribe for (35.7)
reasons of national interest, the total amount
of loans, credit accommodations and
guarantees as may be defined by the MB that *** Loans and other credit
may be extended by a bank to any person, accommodations, deposits maintained
partnership, association, corporation or other with, and usual guaranteed by a bank
entity shall at no time exceed 20% of the net to any other bank or non-bank entity,
worth of such bank. (Sec. 35.1) whether locally or abroad, shall be

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 286 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

subject to the limits as herein interests shall be upon terms not less
prescribed. (35.6) favorable to the bank than those offered to
others. (Sec. 36 par. 2)
- After due notice to the board of directors of
Exclusions. For purposes of this Section, loans,
the bank, the office of any bank director or
other credit accommodations and guarantees officer who violates the provisions of this
shall exclude: Section may be declared vacant and the
director or officer shall be subject to the
a. loans and other credit accommodations penal provisions of the NCBA. (Sec. 36 par.
secured by obligations of the BSP or of the 3)
Phil. Govt; - The MB may regulate the amount of loans,
b. loans and other credit accommodations credit accommodations and guarantees that
fully guaranteed by the govt as to the may be extended, directly or indirectly, by
payment of principal and interest; a bank to its DOSRI, as well as investments
c. loans and other credit accommodations of such bank in enterprises owned or
covered by assignment of deposits controlled by said directors, officers,
maintained in the lending bank and held in stockholders and their related interests.
the Phils.;
d. loans, credit accommodations and * The outstanding loans, credit
acceptances under letters of credit to the accommodations and guarantees which a
extent covered by margin deposits; and bank may extend to each of its DOSRI,
e. other loans or credit accommodations shall be limited to an amount equivalent to
which the MB may from time to time, their respective unencumbered deposits
specify as non-risk items. (35.5) and book value of their paid-in capital
contribution in the bank.
5.06. RESTRICTION ON BANK EXPOSURE TO
44
DOSRI ** The loans, credit accommodations and
guarantees secured by assets considered
DOSRI = Directors, Officers, Stockholders and their
as non-risk by the MB shall be excluded
Related Interests;
from such limit.
NOTE: The MB shall define the term "related
*** The loans, credit accommodations and
interests." (Sec. 36 par. 5)
advances to officers in the form of fringe
benefits granted in accordance with rules
GR: A director or officer of any bank shall
as may be prescribed by the Monetary
neither,
Board shall not be subject to the individual
1. directly or indirectly, for himself or as
limit. (Sec. 36 par. 4)
the representative or agent of others,
borrow from such bank; nor
5.07. LIMITS ON LOANS AND OTHER CREDIT
2. become a guarantor, indorser or surety
ACCOMMODATIONS ON
for loans from such bank to others, or
in any manner be an obligor or incur
Loans and other credit accommodations
any contractual liability to the bank.
against
EXC. Except with the written approval of
real estate shall not exceed 75%
the majority of all the directors of the
bank, excluding the director of the appraised value
of the respective real
concerned. The required approval
shall be entered upon the records of estate security, plus
60% of the appraised
the bank and a copy of such entry
shall be transmitted forthwith to the value of the insured
improvements, and
appropriate supervising and
examining department of the BSP. such loans may be
made to the owner of
* Such written approval shall not be the real estate or to his
assignees. (Sec. 37)
required for loans, other credit
accommodations and advances security of shall not exceed 75%
granted to officers under a fringe chattels of the appraised value
benefit plan approved by the BSP. and of the security, and
(Sec. 36 par. 1) intangible such loans and other
properties credit accommodations
** The limit on loans, credit (such as, may be made to the
accommodations and guarantees but not title-holder of the
prescribed herein shall not apply to limited to, chattels and intangible
loans, credit accommodations and patents, properties or his
guarantees extended by a trademarks, assignees. (Sec. 38)
cooperative bank to its cooperative trade
shareholders. (Sec. 36 par. 6) names, and
copyrights)
Principles Involved.
Exception. In both cases, the MB may prescribe
- Dealings of a bank with any of its directors, otherwise. (Sec. 37-38)
officers or stockholders and their related
44
This topic was asked in 2006 specifically on requisites
before a bank can lend to DOSRI.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 287 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

5.08. FORECLOSURE OF REAL ESTATE


MORTGAGE Debtor is Capable
In the event of foreclosure, whether judicially Before granting a loan or other credit
or extrajudicially, of any mortgage on real accommodation, a bank must ascertain
estate which is security for any loan or other that the debtor is capable of fulfilling his
credit accommodation granted, the mortgagor commitments to the bank. Toward this end,
or debtor whose real property has been sold for a bank may demand from its credit
the full or partial payment of his obligation shall applicants a statement of their assets and
have the right within one year after the sale of liabilities and of their income and
the real estate, to redeem the property by expenditures and such information as may
paying the amount due under the mortgage be prescribed by law or by rules and
deed, with interest thereon at the rate specified regulations of MB to enable the bank to
in the mortgage, and all the costs and properly evaluate the credit application
expenses incurred by the bank or institution which includes the corresponding financial
from the sale and custody of said property less statements submitted for taxation purposes
the income derived therefrom. However, the to the BIR. Should such statements prove
purchaser at the auction sale concerned to be false or incorrect in any material
whether in a judicial or extrajudicial foreclosure detail, the bank may terminate any loan or
shall have the right to enter upon and take other credit accommodation granted on the
possession of such property immediately after basis of said statements and shall have the
the date of the confirmation of the auction sale right to demand immediate repayment or
and administer the same in accordance with liquidation of the obligation. (Sec. 40)
law. Any petition in court to enjoin or restrain
the conduct of foreclosure proceedings 5.10. AMMORTIZATION
instituted pursuant to this provision shall be Amortization on Loans and Other Credit
given due course only upon the filing by the Accommodations. The amortization schedule
petitioner of a bond in an amount fixed by the of bank loans and other credit accommodations
court conditioned that he will pay all the shall be adapted to the nature of the operations
damages which the bank may suffer by the to be financed.
enjoining or the restraint of the foreclosure
proceeding. - In case of loans and other credit
accommodations with maturities of more
Juridical Mortgagor. Notwithstanding Act 3135, than 5 years, provisions must be made for
juridical persons whose property is being sold periodic amortization payments, but such
pursuant to an extrajudicial foreclosure, shall payments must be made at least annually:
have the right to redeem the property in Provided, however, That when the
accordance with this provision until, but not borrowed funds are to be used for purposes
after, the registration of the certificate of which do not initially produce revenues
foreclosure sale with the applicable Register of adequate for regular amortization
Deeds which in no case shall be more than 3 payments therefrom, the bank may permit
months after foreclosure, whichever is earlier. the initial amortization payment to be
Owners of property that has been sold in a deferred until such time as said revenues
foreclosure sale prior to the effectivity of the are sufficient for such purpose, but in no
GBL shall retain their redemption rights until case shall the initial amortization date be
their expiration. (Sec. 47) later than 5 years from the date on which
the loan or other credit accommodation is
granted.
5.09. OTHER SECURITY REQUIREMENTS OF - In case of loans and other credit
BANKS accommodations to microfinance sectors,
the schedule of loan amortization shall take
Grant and Purpose of Loans and Other Credit into consideration the projected cash flow
Accommodations of the borrower and adopt this into the
A bank shall grant loans and other credit terms and conditions formulated by banks.
accommodations only in amounts and for (Sec. 44)
the periods of time essential for the
effective completion of the operations to be
financed. (Sec. 39) 5.11. PREPAYMENT OF LOANS AND OTHER
Such grant of loans and other credit CREDIT ACCOMMODATIONS
A borrower may at any time prior to the agreed
accommodations shall be consistent with
safe and sound banking practices. (Sec. maturity date prepay, in whole or in part, the
39) unpaid balance of any bank loan and other
The purpose of all loans and other credit credit accommodation, subject to such
reasonable terms and conditions as may be
accommodations shall be stated in the
agreed upon between the bank and its
application and in the contract between the
borrower. (Sec. 45)
bank and the borrower. If the bank finds
that the proceeds of the loan or other credit
accommodation have been employed,
5.12. SOME OF MBS POWERS RELATED TO
without its approval, for purposes other
LOANS AND CREDIT ACCOMMODATIONS
than those agreed upon with the bank, it
shall have the right to terminate the loan or
The MB is hereby authorized to issue such
other credit accommodation and demand
immediate repayment of the obligation. regulations as it may deem necessary with
(Sec. 39) respect to unsecured loans or other credit

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 288 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

accommodations that may be granted by 6.02. ACQUISITION OF REAL ESTATE


banks. (Sec. 41) Any bank may acquire real estate as shall be
necessary for its own use in the conduct of its
The MB may, by regulation, prescribe further business. (Sec. 51)
security requirements to which the various
types of bank credits shall be subject, and, in The total investment in such real estate and
accordance with the authority granted to it in improvements thereof, including bank
Sec. 106 of the NCBA, the Board may by equipment, shall not exceed 50% of combined
regulation, reduce the maximum ratios capital accounts.
established in Secs. 36 and 37 [should be Secs.
37 and 38] of this Act, or, in special cases, - Unless otherwise provided by the MB, the
increase the maximum ratios established equity investment of a bank in another
therein. (Sec. 42) corporation engaged primarily in real estate
shall be considered as part of the bank's
The MB may, in accordance with the authority total investment in real estate. (Sec. 51)
granted to it in Sec. 106 of the NCBA, and
taking into account the requirements of the 6.03. BY WAY OF SATISFACTION OF CLAIMS
economy for the effective utilization of long-
term funds, prescribe the maturities, as well as
related terms and conditions for various types Notwithstanding the limitations just mentioned,
of bank loans and other credit a bank may acquire, hold or convey real
accommodations. Any change by the MB in the property under the following circumstances:
maximum maturities shall apply only to loans
and other credit accommodations made after 1. Such as shall be mortgaged to it in
the date of such action. (Sec. 43) good faith by way of security for debts;
2. Such as shall be conveyed to it in
The Monetary Board shall regulate the interest satisfaction of debts previously contracted
imposed on microfinance borrowers by lending in the course of its dealings; or
investors and similar lenders, such as, but not 3. Such as it shall purchase at sales under
limited to, the unconscionable rates of interest judgments, decrees, mortgages, or trust
collected on salary loans and similar credit deeds held by it and such as it shall
accommodations. (Sec. 43) purchase to secure debts due it. (Sec. 52)

Development Assistance Incentives. The BSP Any real property acquired or held under these
shall provide incentives to banks which, without circumstances shall be disposed of by the bank
government guarantee, extend loans to finance within a period of 5 years or as may be
educational institutions, cooperatives, hospitals prescribed by the MB. The bank may, after said
and other medical services, socialized or low- period, continue to hold the property for its
cost housing, local government units and other own use, subject to the limitation that the total
activities with social content. (Sec. 46) investment in real estate and improvements
thereof, including bank equipment, shall not
Renewal or Extension of Loans and Other Credit exceed 50% of combined capital accounts.
(Sec. 52)
Accommodations. The MB may, by regulation,
prescribe the conditions and limitations under
which a bank may grant extensions or renewals
of its loans and other credit accommodations.
(Sec. 48) 6.04. OTHER BANKING SERVICES
1. Receive in custody funds, documents and
Provisions for Losses and Write-Offs. The MB valuable objects;
may fix, by regulation or by order in a specific 2. Act as financial agent and buy and sell, by
case, the amount of reserves for bad debts or order of and for the account of their customers,
doubtful accounts or other contingencies. shares, evidences of indebtedness and all types
Writing off of loans, other credit of securities;
accommodations, advances and other assets 3. Make collections and payments for the account
shall be subject to regulations issued by the of others and perform such other services for
MB. (Sec. 49) their customers as are not incompatible with
banking business;
4. Upon prior approval of MB, act as managing
agent, adviser, consultant or administrator of
investment management/advisory/consultancy
Section 6 Other Operations accounts; and
5. Rent out safety deposit boxes. (Sec. 53)

6.01. MAJOR INVESTMENTS The bank shall perform the services permitted
under 1-4 as depositary or as an agent.
For the purpose of enhancing bank supervision, the Accordingly, it shall keep the funds, securities
MB shall establish criteria for reviewing major and other effects which it receives duly
acquisitions or investments by a bank including separate from the bank's own assets and
corporate affiliations or structures that may expose liabilities. (Sec. 53)
the bank to undue risks or in any way hinder
effective supervision. (Sec. 50) The MB may regulate all these operations in
order to ensure that such operations do not

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 289 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

endanger the interests of the depositors and Section 4.2. Banks may outsource
other creditors of the bank. (Sec. 53) credit card services; printing of bank
loan statements and other non-deposit
records, bank forms and promotional
6.05. PROHIBITIONS materials; credit investigation and
A. Against Acting as an Insurer collection; processing of export, import
A bank shall not directly engage in and other trading transactions; transfer
insurance business as the insurer. (Sec. agent services for debt and equity
54) securities; property appraisal;
B. Prohibited Transactions of Directors, property management services;
Officers, Employees, or Agents of Any messenger, courier and postal services;
Bank* security guard services; vehicle service
1. Making false entries in any bank report contracts; janitorial services.
or statement or participating in any Section 5. Service Providers. When allowed
fraudulent transaction, thereby by law and under this circular, banks may
affecting the financial interest of, or enter into outsourcing contracts only with
causing damage to, the bank or any service providers with demonstrable
person; technical and financial capability
2. Without order of a court of competent commensurate to the services to be
jurisdiction, disclosing to any rendered.
unauthorized person any information Consistent with the provisions of the
relative to the funds or properties in Banks Secrecy Law, no bank shall
the custody of the bank belonging to employ casual or nonregular personnel
private individuals, corporations, or any or too lengthy probationary personnel
other entity: Provided, That with in the conduct of its business involving
respect to bank deposits, the provisions bank deposits. (Subsec. 55.4)
of existing laws shall prevail;
3. Accepting gifts, fees or commissions or 6.06. PROHIBITED TRANSACTIONS OF
any other form of remuneration in BORROWERS OF BANK*
connection with the approval of a loan
or other credit accommodation from
1. Fraudulently overvaluing property offered as
said bank;
security for a loan or other credit
4. Overvaluing or aiding the overvaluing
accommodation from the bank;
of any security for the purpose of
2. Furnishing false or misrepresenting or
influencing in any way the actions of
suppressing material facts for the purpose of
the bank or any bank; or
obtaining, renewing, or increasing a loan or
5. Outsourcing inherent banking functions.
other credit accommodation or extending the
(SubSec. 55.1)
period thereof;
C. BSP Circular 268 (2000)
3. Attempting to defraud the said bank in the
Section 2.1 Outsourcing of inherent
event of a court action to recover a loan or
banking functions shall refer to any
other credit accommodation; or
contract between the bank and a service
4. Offering any director, officer, employee or
provider for the latter to supply the
agent of a bank any gift, fee, commission, or
manpower to service the deposit
any other form of compensation in order to
transactions of the former.
influence such persons into approving a loan or
Section 2.2 Banks cannot outsource
other credit accommodation application.
management functions except as may be
(SubSec. 55.2)
authorized by the Monetary Board when
circumstances justify.
* No examiner, officer or employee of the BSP
Section 3. Outsourcing of Information
or of any department, bureau, office, branch or
Technology Systems/Processes. Subject to
agency of the Govt that is assigned to
prior approval of the MB, banks may
supervise, examine, assist or render technical
outsource all information technology
assistance to any bank shall commit any of the
systems and processes except for functions
acts enumerated in Subsecs. 55.1 and 55.2 or
excluded in Section 3.1.
aid in the commission of the same. The making
Section 3.1 Functions affecting the
of false reports or misrepresentation or
ability of the bank to ensure the fit of
suppression of material facts by personnel of
technology services deployed to meet
the BSP shall constitute fraud and shall be
its strategic and business objectives
subject to the administrative and criminal
and to comply with all pertinent
sanctions provided under the NCBA. (Subsec.
banking laws and regulations may not
55.3)
be outsourced. Subject to prior
approval of the MB, consultants and/or
service providers may be engaged to
provide assistance/support.
6.07. CONDUCTING BUSINESS IN AN UNSAFE
Section 4. Outsourcing of Other Banking
OR UNSOUND MANNER
Functions.
Section 4.1 Subject to prior approval
of the MB, banks may outsource data In determining whether a particular act or
imaging, storage, retrieval and other omission, which is not otherwise prohibited by any
related systems; clearing and law, rule or regulation affecting banks, QBs or trust
processing of checks not included in the entities, may be deemed as conducting business in
Philippine Clearing House System; an unsafe or unsound manner, the MB shall
printing of bank deposit statements.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 290 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

consider any of the following circumstances where


the act or omission has A copy of the report shall be furnished to the
MB.
1. resulted or may result in material loss
or damage, or abnormal risk or danger to The MB may also direct the board of directors
the safety, stability, liquidity or solvency of of a bank, QB, trusty entity and/or the
the institution; individual members thereof, to conduct, either
2. resulted or may result in material loss personally or by a committee created by the
or damage or abnormal risk to the board, an annual balance sheet audit of the
institution's depositors, creditors, investors, bank, QB or trust entity to review the internal
stockholders or to the BSP or to the public audit and control system of the bank, QB or
in general; trust entity and to submit a report of such
3. has caused any undue injury, or has audit. (Sec. 58)
given any unwarranted benefits, advantage
or preference to the bank or any party in 6.10. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
the discharge by the director or officer of
his duties and responsibilities through
Every bank, QB or trust entity shall submit to
manifest partiality, evident bad faith or
the appropriate supervising and examining
gross inexcusable negligence; or such
department of the BSP financial statements in
involves entering into any contract or
such form and frequency as may be prescribed
transaction manifestly and grossly
by the BSP. (Sec. 60)
disadvantageous to the bank, QB or trust
entity, WON the director or officer profited
or will profit thereby. Such statements, which shall be as of a specific
date designated by the BSP, shall show the
Whenever a bank, QB or trust entity persists in actual financial condition of the institution
conducting its business in an unsafe or unsound submitting the statement, and of its branches,
manner, the MB may, without prejudice to the offices, subsidiaries and affiliates, including the
administrative sanctions provided in Sec. 37 of the results of its operations, and shall contain such
NCBA, take action under Sec. 30 of the same Act information as may be required in BSP
and/or immediately exclude the erring bank from regulations. (Sec. 60)
clearing, the provisions of law to the contrary
notwithstanding. (Sec. 56) In periods of national and/or local emergency
or of imminent panic which directly threaten
6.08. ON DIVIDEND DECLARATION monetary and banking stability, the MB, by a
vote of at least 5 of its members, in special
cases and upon application of the bank, quasi-
No bank or QB shall declare dividends greater bank or trust entity, may allow such bank, QB
than its accumulated net profits then on hand, or trust entity to defer for a stated period of
deducting therefrom its losses and bad debts. time the publication of the statement of
(Sec. 57) financial condition required herein. (Sec. 61)

No bank nor QB shall declare dividends, if at


the time of declaration:
6.11. PUBLICATION/POSTING OF FINANCIAL
1. Its clearing account with the BSP is STATEMENTS
overdrawn; or
2. It is deficient in the required liquidity
Every bank, QB or trust entity, shall publish a
floor for govt deposits for 5 or more
consecutive days; or statement of its financial condition, including
3. It does not comply with the liquidity those of its subsidiaries and affiliates, in such
standards/ratios prescribed by the BSP for terms understandable to the layman and in
purposes of determining funds available for such frequency as may be prescribed by the
dividend declaration; or BSP, in English or Filipino, at least once every
4. It has committed a major violation as quarter in a newspaper of general circulation in
may be determined by the BSP. (Sec. 57) the city or province where the principal office,
in the case of a domestic institution, or the
principal branch or office in the case of a
foreign bank, is located, but if no newspaper is
published in the same province, then in a
6.09. INDEPENDENT AUDITOR
newspaper published in Metro Manila or in the
nearest city or province. The Bangko Sentral
The MB may require a bank, QB or trust entity may by regulation prescribe the newspaper
to engage the services of an independent where the statements prescribed herein shall
auditor to be chosen by the bank, QB or trust be published. (Sec. 61)
entity concerned from a list of CPAs acceptable
to the MB. The Monetary Board may allow the posting of
the financial statements of a bank, QB or trust
The term of the engagement shall be as entity in public places it may determine, in lieu
prescribed by the MB which may either be on a of the publication required in the preceding
continuing basis where the auditor shall act as paragraph, when warranted by the
resident examiner, or on the basis of special circumstances. (Sec. 61)
engagements, but in any case, the independent
auditor shall be responsible to the bank's, QBs Banks shall also make available to the public in
or trust entity's board of directors. such form and manner as the BSP may

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 291 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

prescribe the complete set of its audited


financial statements as well as such other Powers
relevant information including those on
enterprises majority-owned or controlled by the
bank, that will inform the public of the true
financial condition of a bank as of any given THE POWERS AUTHORIZED THE GENERAL POWERS INCIDENT TO
time. (Sec. 61) FOR A COMMERCIAL CORPORATIONS,
BANK;
6.12. PUBLICATION OF CAPITAL STOCK ALL SUCH POWERS AS MAY BE
the powers of an
A bank, QB or trust entity incorporated under investment house NECESSARY TO CARRY ON THE
the laws of the Phils. shall not publish the as provided in BUSINESS OF COMMERCIAL BANKING,
amount of its authorized or subscribed capital existing laws; SUCH AS
stock without indicating at the same time and
with equal prominence, the amount of its and ACCEPTING DRAFTS AND ISSUING
capital actually paid up. (Sec. 62) the power to invest LETTERS OF CREDIT;
in non-allied
No branch of any foreign bank doing business enterprises as
in the Phils. shall in any way announce the provided in the DISCOUNTING AND NEGOTIATING
amount of the capital and surplus of its head GBL. (Sec. 23) PROMISSORY NOTES, DRAFTS, BILLS OF
office, or of the bank in its entirety without EXCHANGE, AND OTHER EVIDENCES OF
indicating at the same time and with equal DEBT;
prominence the amount of the capital, if any,
definitely assigned to such branch. In case no
capital has been definitely assigned to such ACCEPTING OR CREATING DEMAND
branch, such fact shall be stated in, and shall DEPOSITS;
form part of the publication. (Sec. 62)
RECEIVING OTHER TYPES OF DEPOSITS
AND DEPOSIT SUBSTITUTES;
6.13. ELECTRONIC TRANSACTIONS
The BSP shall have full authority to regulate
the use of electronic devices, such as BUYING AND SELLING FOREIGN
computers, and processes for recording, storing EXCHANGE AND GOLD OR SILVER
and transmitting information or data in BULLION;
connection with the operations of a bank, QB or
trust entity, including the delivery of services ACQUIRING MARKETABLE BONDS AND
and products to customers by such entity. OTHER DEBT SECURITIES; AND
(Sec. 59)

EXTENDING CREDIT,
6.14. OTHER RELATED PROVISIONS OF THE
GBL
SUBJECT TO SUCH RULES AS THE MB
MAY PROMULGATE. THESE RULES MAY
The Bangko Sentral may charge equitable INCLUDE THE DETERMINATION OF
rates, commissions or fees, as may be BONDS AND OTHER DEBT SECURITIES
prescribed by the Monetary Board for ELIGIBLE FOR INVESTMENT, THE
supervision, examination and other services MATURITIES AND AGGREGATE AMOUNT
which it renders under this Act. (Sec. 65) OF SUCH INVESTMENT. (SEC. 29)

Unless otherwise provided, the violation of any BSP Circular 271 (2002)
of the provisions of this Act shall be subject to (1) invest in the equities of
Secs 34, 35, 36 and 37 of the NCBA. If the allied enterprises;
offender is a director or officer of a bank, (2) purchase, hold and convey
quasi-bank or trust entity, the MB may also real estate;
suspend or remove such director or officer. If (3) receive in custody funds,
the violation is committed by a corporation, documents and valuable
such corporation may be dissolved by quo objects;
warranto proceedings instituted by the (4) act as financial agent;
Sol.Gen.. (Sec. 66) (5) make collections and
payments for the account
The provisions of any law to the contrary of others;
notwithstanding, the BSP shall be consulted by (6) act as managing agent,
other government agencies or instrumentalities adviser, consultant or
in actions or proceedings initiated by or administrator of
brought before them involving controversies in investment
banks, QBs or trust entities arising out of and management/advisory/-
involving relations between and among their consultancy accounts;
directors, officers or stockholders, as well as (7) rent out safety deposit
disputes between any or all of them and the boxes; and
bank, QBs or trust entity of which they are (8) engage in quasi-banking
directors, officers or stockholders. (Sec. 63) functions.

Universal Banks Commercial Banks

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 292 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Equity Investments

A PUBLICLY-LISTED UB OR KB MAY OWN UP TO ONE 100% OF THE


VOTING STOCK OF ONLY ONE OTHER UB OR KB. (SEC. 25)
A UB MAY INVEST IN THE A KB MAY INVEST ONLY IN THE EQUITIES
EQUITIES OF OF ALLIED ENTERPRISES (EITHER BSP Circular 263 (2000)
FINANCIAL OR NON-FINANCIAL). (SEC. With prior BSP approval, banks may invest
30) in equities of the following financial allied
ALLIED (EITHER FINANCIAL undertakings:
OR NON-FINANCIAL) AND a. Leasing companies including leasing of
EXCEPT AS THE MB MAY OTHERWISE stalls and spaces in a commercial
PRESCRIBE: establishment; Provided, That bank
NON-ALLIED
investment in/acquisition of shares of such
ENTERPRISES. (SEC. 24)
leasing company shall be
THE TOTAL INVESTMENT IN EQUITIES OF
limited/applicable only in cases of
ALLIED ENTERPRISES SHALL NOT EXCEED conversion of outstanding loan obligations
EXCEPT AS THE MB MAY 35% OF THE NET WORTH OF THE BANK;
OTHERWISE PRESCRIBE: into equity.
AND b. Banks;
c. Investment houses;
THE TOTAL INVESTMENT THE EQUITY INVESTMENT IN ANY ONE d. Financing companies;
IN EQUITIES OF ALLIED ENTERPRISE SHALL NOT EXCEED 25% OF e. Credit card companies;
AND NON-ALLIED THE NET WORTH OF THE BANK. (SEC. 30) f. Financial institutions catering to small
ENTERPRISES SHALL NOT and medium scale industries including
EXCEED 50% OF THE NET venture capital corporations;
WORTH OF THE BANK; AND g. Companies engaged in stock
brokerage/securities dealership; and
h. Companies engaged in foreign exchange
THE EQUITY INVESTMENT dealership/brokerage.
IN ANY ONE ENTERPRISE,
WHETHER ALLIED OR NON- Equity Investments in Non-Financial Allied
ALLIED, SHALL NOT Enterprises
EXCEED 25% OF THE NET
WORTH OF THE BANK.
(SEC. 24)
A UB OR KB MAY OWN UP TO ONE HUNDRED PERCENT (100%) OF THE
EQUITY IN A NON-FINANCIAL ALLIED ENTERPRISE. (SEC. 26 AND 32)
"NET WORTH" SHALL MEAN THE TOTAL OF THE UNIMPAIRED PAID-IN Equity Investments in QBs
CAPITAL INCLUDING PAID-IN SURPLUS, RETAINED EARNINGS AND
UNDIVIDED PROFIT, NET OF VALUATION RESERVES AND OTHER
ADJUSTMENTS AS MAY BE REQUIRED BY THE BSP. (SEC. 24)
TO PROMOTE COMPETITIVE CONDITIONS IN FINANCIAL MARKETS, THE
MB MAY FURTHER LIMIT TO 40% EQUITY INVESTMENTS OF UBS AND
THE ACQUISITION OF SUCH EQUITY OR EQUITIES IS SUBJECT TO THE KBS IN QBS. (SEC. 28)
PRIOR APPROVAL OF THE MB WHICH SHALL PROMULGATE
APPROPRIATE GUIDELINES TO GOVERN SUCH INVESTMENTS. (SEC. 24 Equity
& 30) Investments in
Non-Allied
Equity Investments in Financial Allied Enterprises
Enterprises

THE EQUITY INVESTMENT


A UB CAN OWN UP TO A KB MAY OWN UP TO 100% OF THE OF A UB, OR OF ITS
100% OF THE EQUITY IN EQUITY OF WHOLLY OR MAJORITY-
OWNED SUBSIDIARIES, IN
A THRIFT BANK, A THRIFT BANK OR A SINGLE NON-ALLIED
ENTERPRISE

A RURAL BANK OR A RURAL BANK. (SEC. 31) 1. shall not exceed


35% of the total
equity in that
A FINANCIAL ALLIED WHERE THE EQUITY INVESTMENT OF A enterprise nor
ENTERPRISE. (SEC. 25) KB IS IN OTHER FINANCIAL ALLIED 2. shall it exceed
ENTERPRISES, INCLUDING ANOTHER 35% of the voting
COMMERCIAL BANK, SUCH INVESTMENT stock in that
SHALL REMAIN A MINORITY HOLDING IN enterprise. (Sec.
THAT ENTERPRISE. (SEC. 31) 27)

Section 7 Foreign Banks

7.01. TRANSACTING BUSINESS IN THE PHILS

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 293 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Residents and citizens of the Phils. who are


The entry of foreign banks in the Phils. through creditors of a branch in the Phils. of a foreign
the establishment of branches shall be bank shall have preferential rights to the assets
governed by the provisions of the Foreign of such branch in accordance with existing
Banks Liberalization Act. (Sec. 72) laws. (Sec. 75)

In the case of a foreign bank which has more 7.04. SUMMONS AND LEGAL PROCESS
than 1 branch in the Phils., all such branches
shall be treated as 1 unit for the purpose of the Upon the Phil. Agent or Head of the Foreign
GBL, and all references to the Phil. branches of Bank Designated to Accept Service
foreign banks shall be held to refer to such
units. (Sec. 74) Summons and legal process served upon
the Phil. agent or head of any foreign bank
In all matters not specifically covered by designated to accept service thereof shall
special provisions applicable only to a foreign give jurisdiction to the courts over such
bank or its branches and other offices in the bank, and service of notices on such agent
Phils., any foreign bank licensed to do business or head shall be as binding upon the bank
in the Phils. shall be bound by the provisions of which he represents as if made upon the
the GBL and all other laws, rules and bank itself.
regulations applicable to banks organized under
the laws of the Phils. of the same class, except Should the authority of such agent or head
those that provide for the creation, formation, to accept service of summons and legal
organization or dissolution of corporations or processes for the bank or notice to it be
for the fixing of the relations, liabilities, revoked, or should such agent or head
responsibilities, or duties of stockholders, become mentally incompetent or otherwise
members, directors or officers of corporations unable to accept service while exercising
to each other or to the corporation. (Sec. 77) such authority, it shall be the duty of the
The conduct of offshore banking business in the bank to name and designate promptly
Philippines shall be governed by Offshore another agent or head upon whom service
Banking System Decree (PD 1034) (Sec. 72) of summons and processes in legal
proceedings against the bank and of
7.02. ACQUISITION OF VOTING STOCK IN A notices affecting the bank may be made,
DOMESTIC BANK and to file with the SEC a duly
authenticated nomination of such agent.
Within 7 years from the effectivity of the GBL (Sec. 76)
and subject to guidelines issued pursuant to
the Foreign Banks Liberalization Act, the MB
may authorize a foreign bank to acquire up to Upon the BSP Deputy Governor In-Charge of
100% of the voting stock of only 1 domestic the Supervising and Examining Departments
bank.
In the absence of the agent or head or
Within the same period, the MB may authorize should there be no person authorized by
any foreign bank, which prior to the effectivity the bank upon whom service of summons,
of the GBL availed itself of the privilege to processes and all legal notices may be
acquire up to 60% of the voting stock of a bank made, service of summons, processes and
under the Foreign Banks Liberalization Act and legal notices may be made upon the BSP
the Thrift Banks Act, to further acquire voting Deputy Governor In-Charge of the
shares of such bank to the extent necessary for supervising and examining departments
it to own 100% of the voting stock thereof. and such service shall be as effective as if
made upon the bank or its duly authorized
In the exercise of this authority, the MB shall agent or head.
adopt measures as may be necessary to ensure
that at all times the control of 70% of the The said Deputy Governor shall register
resources or assets of the entire banking and transmit by mail to the president or the
system is held by banks which are at least secretary of the bank at its head or
majority-owned by Filipinos. principal office a copy, duly certified by
him, of the summons, process, or notice.
Any such right, privilege or incentive granted to The sending of such copy of the summons,
a foreign bank shall be equally enjoyed by and process, or notice shall be a necessary part
extended under the same conditions to banks of the services and shall complete the
organized under Philippine laws. (Sec. 73) service.

The registry receipt of mailing shall be


7.03. HEAD OFFICE GUARANTEE prima facie evidence of the transmission of
the summons, process or notice.
In order to provide effective protection of the
interests of the depositors and other creditors All costs necessarily incurred by the said
of Phil. branches of a foreign bank, the head Deputy Governor for the making and
office of such branches shall fully guarantee the mailing and sending of a copy of the
prompt payment of all liabilities of its Phil. summons, process, or notice to the
branch. president or the secretary of the bank at its
head or principal office shall be paid in

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 294 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

advance by the party at whose instance the and its branches shall be treated as one
service is made. (Sec. 76) unit. (Sec. 93)

7.05. REVOCATION OF LICENSE

The MB may revoke the license to transact 8.03. APPLICABILITY OF CIVIL CODE
business in the Phils. of any foreign bank, if it
finds that the foreign bank is insolvent or in Art 1442 of the Civil Code: The principles of the
imminent danger thereof or that its general law of trusts, insofar as they are not in
continuance in business will involve probable conflict w/ the Civil Code, the Code of Commerce,
loss to those transacting business with it. the Rules of Court and special laws [including the
GBL] are hereby adopted.
After the revocation of its license, it shall be
unlawful for any such foreign bank to transact
business in the Phils. unless its license is 8.04. HISTORY
renewed or reissued. The BSP shall take the
necessary action to protect the creditors of The idea of property held in trust is a great
such foreign bank and the public. legacy from the Wars of the Roses and the
messiness of the English Reformation. The purpose
The provisions of the NCBA on sanctions and of the arrangement is to separate the benefits from
penalties shall likewise be applicable. (Sec. 78) the responsibilities of ownershipto permit, for
example, land or a business left to a widow or
children to be managed by a strong third party
committed to act solely in the interest of the
beneficiaries of the trust. Though beneficiaries
have since the 15th century had the right to call
trustees to the law courts to account for their
stewardship, in fact the guts of the system is the
pride of the trustee, for whom the opportunity to
employ his powers unselfishly should be an honor
and a privilege. Obviously, the trustee as
Section 8 Trust Operations described in law needs a soul, and comments could
be made about the American innovation of 1818
8.01. AUTHORITY TO ENGAGE IN TRUST which first chartered a soulless corp to perform
BUSINESS trust functions. The trust company, so called,
performed a number of functions closely analogous
Only a stock corporation or a person duly to banking: its basic job, after all, was to invest
authorized by the MB to engage in trust business and manage safely the assets left w/ it by others.
shall act as a trustee or administer any trust or The question of the standard of care to which such
hold property in trust or on deposit for the use, a company could be held was variously resolved
benefit, or behalf of others. For purposes of the xxx. In 1833 the Supreme Judicial Council of
GBL, such a corporation is referred to as a trust Massachusetts ruled that a trustee could manage a
entity. (Sec. 79) trust in any way a prudent man would treat his
own assets; but other states lagged far behind and
will into the 20th century most laws prescribed a
A trust receipt is a written/printed document and legal list of investments approved for trusts xxx
delivered by the entrustee in favor of the entruster, (Morales quoting Martin Mayer in The Bankers
whereby the latter releases the goods, documents (1974))
or instruments over which he holds absolute title or
a security interest ot the possession of the former,
upon the entrustees promist to hold said goods in 8.05. PRUDENT MAN AND SELF-DEALING
trust for the entruster, an to sell or otherwise RULES
dispose of the goods, etc. with the obligation to
turn over the proceeds thereof to the extent of
what is owing to the enstruster; or to return the Prudent Man Rule
45 A trust entity shall administer the funds or
goods if UNSOLD, or for other purposes.
property under its custody with the diligence
8.02. BRANCHES OF TRUST ENTITY that a prudent man would exercise in the
conduct of an enterprise of a like character and
with similar aims. (Sec. 80 par. 1)
The ordinary business of a trust entity shall
be transacted at the place of business
The MB shall promulgate such rules and
specified in its articles of incorporation.
regulations as may be necessary to prevent
Such trust entity may, with prior approval
of the MB, establish branches in the circumvention of the prudent man rule and the
responsibility therein imposed on a trust entity.
Philippines, and the said entity shall be
responsible for all business conducted in (Sec. 80 par. 3)
such branches to the same extent and in
the same manner as though such business This rule is part of the code of conduct required
had all been conducted in the head office. of a trustee and thus set out in the behavioral
For the purpose of this Act, the trust entity guidelines of the Manual of Regulation of
Banks: Sec X401 Statement of Principles. The
cardinal principle common to all trust and other
fiduciary relationships is fidelity. Policies
45
In 2007, the definition of Trust Receipt was asked.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 295 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

predicated upon this principle are directed instrument itself). (Morales on the basis of
towards confidentiality, scrupulous care, safety Subsec. X409.3 of the Manual of Regulations
and prudent management of property including for Banks and Subsec. 4409Q.3 of the Manual
reasonable probability of income w/ proper of Regulations for Non-Bank Financial
accounting and appropriate reporting thereon. Institutions)
Practices are designed to promote efficiency in
administration and operation; to adhere and
conform w/ the terms of the instrument or Rationale of the Rules
contract; and to maintain absolute separation
of property free from any intrusion of conflict of For the protection of the public xxx, there is
interest. need for writing into the law provisions
A bank authorized to engage in trust and intended to ensure that trust managers shall
fiduciary business is under no obligation, handle trust accounts along the prudent man
either legal or moral, to accept any such concept of managing funds in trust, since
business being offered nor has it the right trustors usually entrust their funds xxx in full
to accept if the same is contrary to law, confidence, secure in the belief that the trustee
rules, regulations public order and public will manage his funds as a prudent man would.
policy. It shall advertise its services in a
dignified manner and enter such business There is need therefore to put in safeguards in
only when demand for such service is the law so as to ensure that the expected
evident, when specially equipped to render prudence in management shall indeed be the
such service and upon full appreciation of norm, Such safeguards or guidelines may take
the responsibilities involved. It shall be the form of prohibition form purchasing or
ready and willing to give full disclosure of acquiring property for the trust or for account
the services being offered and shall conduct of the trustor or beneficiary of the trust from
its dealing w/ transparency. Harmonious the bank proper or any of its depts or
relationship shall likewise be pursued w/ directors, officers or employees, unless
other professions to achieve the common specifically authorized by the trustor.
goal of mutual service to the public and
protection of its interest. (Morales noting It has been said that the essence of
that there is a similar statement of trusteeship is that the trustee would not be
principles in Sec 4401Q of the Manual of motivated by self-interest, that on no account
Regulations for Non-Financial Institutions) shall it receive any personal advantage from
the trusteeship, that it shall permit no dealings
of any character between itself as an individual
Self-Dealing Rule or corp and itself in its capacity as trustee, and
GR:No trust entity shall, for the account of the that it shall receive from the trust no profit or
trustor or the beneficiary of the trust, financial return, directly or indirectly, other
than its rightful compensation for services
1. purchase or acquire property from, or rendered. (Morales citing Recommendation 70
2. sell, transfer, assign or lend money or of Joint IMF-CBP Banking Survey Commission)
property to, or
3. purchase debt instruments of
a. any of the departments, directors,
officers, stockholders, or employees 8.06. REGISTRATION REQUIREMENT
of the trust entity
b. relatives within the 1st degree of
The SEC shall not register the articles of
consanguinity or affinity, or the
incorporation and by-laws or any amendment
related interests, of such directors,
thereto, of any trust entity, unless
officers and stockholders,
accompanied by a certificate of authority issued
by the BSP. (Sec. 80)
EXC.
Reiterates the requirements under the
1. the transaction is specifically authorized
Corporation Code. (Morales)
by the trustor and
2. the relationship of the trustee and the
Note: Sec 17 par 2 of the Corporation Code: No
other party involved in the transaction
articles of incorporation or amendment to the
is fully disclosed to the trustor or
articles of incorporation of banks, banking and
beneficiary of the trust prior to the
Quasi-banking institutions, building and loan
transaction. (Sec. 80 par. 2)
associations, trust companies and other financial
intermediaries, insurance companies, public
The MB shall promulgate such rules and
utilities, educational institutions, and other corps
regulations as may be necessary to prevent
governed by special laws shall be accepted or
circumvention of the self-dealing rule or the
approved by the SEC unless accompanied by a
evasion of the responsibility therein imposed on
favorable recommendation of the appropriate
a trust entity. (Sec. 80 par. 3)
government agency to the effect that such articles
or amendment is in accordance with law. AND Sec
Basically, a trustee cannot engage in a self
46 par 4: The SEC shall not accept for filing the
dealing transaction unless: (1) the transaction
by-laws or any amendment thereto of any bank,
is specifically authorized by the trustor and (2)
banking institution, building and loan association,
the relationship of the trustee and its
trust company, insurance company, public utility,
counterparty is fully disclosed to the trustor or
educational institution or other special corps
beneficiary of the trust prior to the transactions
governed by special laws, unless accompanied by a
(either in a separate instrument of in the trust

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 296 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

certificate of the appropriate government agency to 8.09. GENERAL GROUPINGS


the effect that such by-laws or amendments are in
accordance with law. 1. Trust Business

- any activity resulting from a trustor-


The certificate of authority need not be issued trustee relationship (trusteeship)
by the MB itself under its seal. (Morales) involving the appointment of a trustee
by a trustor for the administration,
holding management of funds and/or
properties of the trustor by the trustee
8.07. MINIMUM CAPITALIZATION for the use benefit or advantage of the
trustor or of others called beneficiaries
- Trust entity enters into a property
A trust entity, before it can engage in trust or
relationship, wherein legal title to the
other fiduciary business, shall comply with the
property is transferred to it (as trustee)
minimum paid-in capital requirement which will
by a trustor for the benefit of one or
be determined by the MB. (Sec. 82)
more beneficiaries, who may or may
not include the trustor. There is thus a
This means it must have combined capital division of legal and beneficial interests
accounts of P250M. Combined capital in and to the property entrusted to the
accounts refers to the the total capital stock, trust entity. The trustor is able to shift
retained earnings and profit and loss summary, the burden of management of the
net of (1) such unbooked valuation reserves property to the trustee and, at the
and other capital adjustments as may be same time, confer the benefits of
required by the BSP and (2) total outstanding ownership on the beneficiary.
unsecured credit accommodations, both direct
and indirect, to DOSRI When applicant is a Note: Art 1440 Civil Code. A person who
domestic bank, the combined capital accounts establishes a trust is called the trustor; one in
must not be less that the minimum capital whom confidence is reposed as regards property
prescribed by the MB for such bank but in no for the benefit of another person is known as the
case less than P250M; and when applicant is a trustee; and the person for whose benefit the trust
branch of a foreign bank, it must comply with / has been created is referred to as the beneficiary.
the capital requirement applicable to such local
bank. (Morales citing various provisions of the
Manual of Regulations for Non-Bank Financial 2. Other fiduciary business
Institutions and the Manual of Regulation for
Banks) - any activity of a trust licensed bank
resulting from a contract or agreement
8.08. POWERS OF A TRUST ENTITY whereby the bank binds itself to render
A trust entity, in addition to the general powers services or to act in a representative
incident to corporations, shall have the power to: capacity such as in an agency,
guardianship, Administratorship of
1. Act as trustee on any mortgage wills, properties and estates,
or bond issued by any municipality, executorship, receivership, and other
corporation, or any body politic and to similar services which do not create or
accept and execute any trust consistent result in a trusteeship.
with law; - It shall exclude collecting or paying
2. Act under the order or agency arrangements and similar
appointment of any court as guardian, fiduciary services which are inherent in
receiver, trustee, or depositary of the the use of the facilities of the other
estate of any minor or other incompetent depts of said bank. Investment
person, and as receiver and depositary of management activities, which are
any moneys paid into court by parties to considered as among other fiduciary
any legal proceedings and of property of business, shall be separately defined in
any kind which may be brought under the the succeeding item to highlights its
jurisdiction of the court; being a major source of fiduciary
3. Act as the executor of any will business.
when it is named the executor thereof; - Does not act as a trustee but renders
4. Act as administrator of the services to its counterparty in a
estate of any deceased person, with the will representative capacity. In particular,
annexed, or as administrator of the estate the trust entity acts as agent, adviser,
of any deceased person when there is no consultant or administrator, in respect
will; of an investment management account.
5. Accept and execute any trust - Art 1060 Civil Code. A corporation or
for the holding, management, and association authorized to conduct the
administration of any estate, real or business of a trust company in the Phils
personal, and the rents, issues and profits may be appointed as an executor,
thereof; and administrator, guardian of an estate, or
6. Establish and manage common trustee, in like manner as an individual;
trust funds, subject to such rules and but it shall not be appointed guardian
regulations as may be prescribed by the of the person of a ward.
MB. (Sec. 83)

3. Investment management activity

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 297 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

If the trust entity fails to comply with any law


- Any activity resulting from a contract or or regulation, the BSP shall retain such interest
agreement primarily for financial return on the securities deposited with it for the
whereby the bank (the investment benefit of rightful claimants.
manager) binds itself to handle or All claims arising out of the trust business of a
manage investible funds or any trust entity shall have priority over all other
investment portfolio in a representative claims as regards the cash or securities
capacity as financial or managing deposited as above provided. The MB may not
agent, adviser, consultant or permit the cash or securities deposited to be
administrator of financial or investment reduced below the prescribed minimum
management, advisory, consultancy or amount until the depositing entity shall
any similar arrangement which does discontinue its trust business and shall satisfy
not create of result in a trusteeship. the MB that it has complied with all its
(Morales) obligations in connection with such business.
(Sec. 84)
8.10. NECESSARY DEPOSITS

1. Basic Security 4. Bond


- Before transacting trust business, every
trust entity shall deposit with the BSP as - Before an executor, administrator,
security for the faithful performance of its guardian, trustee, receiver or depositary
trust duties, cash or securities approved by appointed by the court enters upon the
the MB in an amount equal to not less than execution of his duties, he shall, upon order
P500,000 or such higher amount as may be of the court, file a bond in such sum, as the
fixed by the MB. court may direct. (Sec. 85)

- The MB shall require every trust entity to - Upon the application of any executor,
increase the amount of its cash or administrator, guardian, trustee, receiver,
securities on deposit with the BSP depositary or any other person in interest,
whenever in its judgment such increase is the court may, after notice and hearing,
necessary by reason of the trust business order that the subject matter of the trust or
of such entity. (Sec. 84) any part thereof be deposited with a trust
entity. Upon presentation of proof to the
court that the subject matter of the trust
has been deposited with a trust entity, the
court may order that the bond given by
2. Paid-In Capital and Security such persons for the faithful performance of
- The paid-in capital and surplus of such their duties be reduced to such sums as it
entity must be at least equal to the amount may deem proper: Provided, however, That
required to be deposited with the BSP in the reduced bond shall be sufficient to
accordance with the provisions of this secure adequately the proper
paragraph. (Sec. 84) administration and care of any property
remaining under the control of such
3. Reserves persons and the proper accounting for such
property. Property so deposited with any
- In addition to basic security, a trust entity trust entity shall be held by such entity
is required to maintain reserves against under the orders and direction of the court.
peso-denominated common trust funds as (Sec.85)
well as certain trust and other fiduciary
accounts. (Morales citing Subsec X405.5 - No bond or other security shall be required
Manual of Regulation for banks; Subsec by the court from a trust entity for the
4405Q.5 Manual of regulation for Non-bank faithful performance of its duties as court-
Financial Institutions) appointed trustee, executor, administrator,
guardian, receiver, or depositary. However,
the court may, upon proper application with
it showing special cause therefor, require
the trust entity to post a bond or other
Failure to Maintain such Amounts
security for the protection of funds or
Should the capital and surplus fall below property confided to such entity. (Sec. 86)
said amount, the MB shall have the same
authority as that granted to it under the - That trust entities need not post a bond,
provisions of the fifth paragraph of Sec. 34 unless required by the court, for the faithful
of the GBL. performance of Sec 85 GBL duties is based
on the presumption that trust entities
A trust entity so long as it shall continue to be already have a basic security deposit with
solvent and comply with laws or regulations the BSP. (Morales)
shall have the right to collect the interest
earned on such securities deposited with the
BSP and, from time to time, with the approval
of the BSP, to exchange the securities for
others.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 298 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

8.11. SEPARATION OF TRUST BUSINESS AND then subsidiaries of trust companies. When
ASSETS FROM THE OTHER BUSINESSES AND monopolies were being made in the 19 th and
ASSETS OF THE BANK 20th centuries, the devise used was the trust,
as it could hold the stock of all companies w/in
The trust business and all funds, properties or the group. Accordingly, then the US Congress
securities received by any trust entity as was breaking up monopolies, what were passed
executor, administrator, guardian, trustee, were anti-trust laws. (Morales)
receiver, or depositary shall be kept separate
and distinct from the general business including
all other funds, properties, and assets of such 8.13. LOANS OR INVESTMENTS PRESCRIBED
trust entity. The accounts of all such funds, BY MB
properties, or securities shall likewise be kept
separate and distinct from the accounts of the Unless otherwise specifically enumerated in the
general business of the trust entity. (Sec. 87) agreement or indenture and directed in writing by
the client, court of competent jurisdiction or other
Trust Business Separation. Trust and other competent authority, loans and investments of the
[trust or other fiduciary] fund shall be limited to:
fiduciary business of a bank shall be carried out
1. (a) evidences of indebtedness of the RP
through a trust dept which shall be
and BSP, and
organizationally, operationally, administratively
(b) any other evidences of indebtedness or
and functionally separate and distinct from the
obligations the servicing and repayment of
other depts and/or business of the institution.
which are fully guaranteed by the RP or
(Morales citing Subsec X406.1.a Manual of
(c) loans against such government
Regulations for Banks)
securities;
2. loans fully guaranteed by the RP as to the
Trust Assets Separation. All moneys,
payment of principal and interest;
properties or securities by a bank in its capacity
3. loans fully secured by [a] a hold-out on, [b]
as trustee, fiduciary or invesmtnet manager
assignment or [c] pledge of deposits
shall be kept physically separate and distinct
maintained either w/ the bank or other
fromt eh other assets of its other business and
banks, or of deposit substitutes of the
shal be under the joint custody of at least 2
bank, or of [d] chattel mortgage bonds
persons, one of whom shall be an officer of the
issued by the trustee or fiduciary; and
trust or investment management dept,
4. loans fully secured by real estate or
designated for that purpose by the board of
chattels (Morales referring to Subsec
directors. The investment of each trust, other
X409.2 Ibid; similar rule in Subsec 4409Q.2
fiduciary or investment management account
Manual o Regulations for Non-Bank
shall be kept physically separate from those of
Financial Institutions)
other trust, other fiduciary or investment
management accounts, and adequately
identifies as the assets of property of the
8.14. REAL ESTATE INVESTMENTS
relevant account. (Morales citing Sec X422
Ibid.)
Unless otherwise specifically directed by the
trustor or the nature of the trust, real estate
Investment of Non-Trust Funds. The
acquired by a trust entity in whatever manner
investment of funds other than trust funds of a
and for whatever purpose, shall likewise be
trust entity which is a bank, financing company
governed by the relevant provisions of Sec. 52
or an investment house shall be governed by
of the GBL. (Sec. 89)
the relevant provisions of the GBL and other
applicable laws. (Sec. 90)
The reference to Sec 52 is w/out prejudice to
the directives of the trustor or the nature of the
If the trust entity is a unit of a bank, a
trust itself. It is to be understood that the trust
financing company or an investment house,
entity can take specific directives from the
then non-trust business activities are
trustor only if the trust is revocable. But if it is
conducted by other units of such bank,
irrevocable, then the trustor is out of the
financing company or investment house.
picture and the trust entity should take
(Morales)
instructions from the beneficiaries themselves
in the context of the trust instrument in
question. (Morales)
8.12. INVESTMENT LIMITATIONS
8.15. SANCTIONS AND PENALTIES
Unless otherwise directed by the instrument
creating the trust, the lending and investment A trust entity or any of its officers and directors
of funds and other assets acquired by a trust found to have willfully violated any pertinent
entity as executor, administrator, guardian, provisions of the GBL, shall be subject to the
trustee, receiver or depositary of the estate of sanctions and penalties provided under Sec. 66
any minor or other incompetent person shall be of the GBL and Secs. 36 and 37 of the NCBA.
limited to loans or investments as may be
prescribed by law, the MB or any court of 8.16. EXEMPTION OF TRUST ASSETS FROM
competent jurisdiction. (Sec. 88) CLAIMS

Historical Note. It used to be that a trust No assets held by a trust entity in its capacity
company, particularly in the US could own as trustee shall be subject to any claims other
anything. In fact, many national banks were

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 299 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

than those of the parties interested in the 9.03. RECEIVERSHIP AND INVOLUNTARY
specific trusts. (Sec. 92) LIQUIDATION

Rationale. The creditors of the trustee will not The grounds and procedures for placing a bank
be able to attach, garnish or otherwise claim under receivership or liquidation, as well as the
the trust assets, because the trustee is not the powers and duties of the receiver or liquidator
beneficial owner thereof. Only the :parties appointed for the bank shall be governed by
interested in the specific trust (normally, the the provisions of Secs. 30, 31, 32, and 33 of
beneficiaries of the trust) can claim those the NCBA: Provided, That the petitioner or
assets. This is further reinforced by the plaintiff files with the clerk or judge of the court
following: Art 2240 Civil Code. Property held in which the action is pending a bond, executed
by the insolvent debtor as a trustee of an in favor of the BSP, in an amount to be fixed by
express or implied trust, shall be excluded from the court. This shall also apply to the extent
the insolvency proceedings. (Morales) possible to the receivership and liquidation
proceedings of QBs. (Sec. 69)

9.04. PENALTY FOR TRANSACTIONS AFTER A


BANK BECOMES INSOLVENT

Any director or officer of any bank declared


insolvent or placed under receivership by the
MB shall be subject to the penal provisions of
the NCBA if he
1. refuses to turn over the bank's records and
assets to the designated receivers,
2. tampers with banks records,
3. appropriates for himself or another party or
destroys or causes the misappropriation
and destruction of the bank's assets,
4. receives or permits or causes to be
received in said bank any deposit,
collection of loans and/or receivables,
5. pays out or permits or causes to be paid
out any funds of said bank, or
6. transfers or permits or causes to be
transferred any securities or property of
said bank (Sec. 70)

Section 9 Conservatorship and Cessation


of Banking Business II. The New Central Bank Act (RA
7653)
9.01. CONSERVATORSHIP
A. Creation, Responsibilities and
The grounds and procedures for placing a bank Corporate Powers of the BSP
under conservatorship, as well as, the powers
and duties of the conservator appointed for the
bank shall be governed by the provisions of 1. DECLARATION OF POLICY
Sec. 29 and the last two paragraphs of Sec. 30
of the NCBA: Provided, That this Section shall 1. The State shall maintain a central monetary
also apply to conservatorship proceedings of authority that shall function and operate as an
QBs. (Sec. 67, please refer to companion independent and accountable body corporate in
reviewer) the discharge of its mandated responsibilities
concerning money, banking and credit. (Sec. 1)

9.02. VOLUNTARY LIQUIDATION 2. In line with this policy, and considering its
unique functions and responsibilities, the
In case of the voluntary liquidation of any bank central monetary authority established under
organized under the laws of the Phils., or of the NCBA, while being a govt-owned
any branch or office in the Phils. of a foreign corporation, shall enjoy fiscal and
bank, written notice of such liquidation shall be administrative autonomy. (Sec. 1)
sent to the MB before such liquidation is
undertaken, and the MB shall have the right to NOTE
intervene and take such steps as may be The NCBA establishes the independent central
necessary to protect the interests of creditors. monetary authority, which is a body corporate
(Sec. 68) known as the BSP. (Sec. 2)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 300 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

2. PRIMARY OBJECTIVE AND ROLE OF THE 6. CREATION: FROM CB TO BSP


BSP

1. To maintain price stability conducive to a 1. Transfer of Assets and Liabilities


balanced and sustainable growth of the
economy. (Primary Objective) Upon the effectivity of this Act, 3 members of
2. To promote and maintain monetary stability the MB, which may include the Governor, in
and the convertibility of the peso. representation of the BSP, the Secretary of
3. To provide policy directions in the areas of Finance and the Secretary of Budget and
money, banking, and credit. Management in representation of the National
4. To have supervision over the operations of Government, and the Chairmen of the
banks Committees on Banks of the Senate and the
5. To exercise such regulatory powers (as House of Representatives shall determine the
provided under the NCBA and other pertinent assets and liabilities of the Central Bank (CB)
laws) over the operations of finance companies which may be transferred to or assumed by the
and non-bank financial institutions performing BSP. (Sec. 132)46
quasi-banking functions and institutions 2. Mandate to Organize
performing similar functions. (Sec. 3)
The BSP shall be organized by the MB by
NOTE adopting, if it so desires, an entirely new
Phase-out of Regulatory Powers Over the staffing pattern on organizational structure to
Operations of Finance Corporations and Other suit the operations of the BSP. No preferential
Institutions Performing Similar Functions. The BSP or priority right shall be given to or enjoyed by
shall, within a period of 5 years from the effectivity any personnel for appointment to any position
of this Act, phase out its regulatory powers over in the new staffing pattern, nor shall any
finance companies without quasi-banking functions personnel be considered as having prior or
and other institutions performing similar functions vested rights with respect to retention in the
as provided in existing laws, the same to be BSP or in any position which may be created in
assumed by the SEC. (Sec. 130) the new staffing pattern, even if he should be
the incumbent of a similar position prior to
3. CAPITAL OF THE BSP organization. The formulation of the program
of organization shall be completed within 6
The capital of the BSP shall be P50B, to be fully months after the effectivity of this Act, and
subscribed by the Govt of the RP. (Sec. 2) shall be fully implemented within a period of 6
months thereafter. Personnel who may not be
retained are deemed separated from the
4. PLACE OF BUSINESS OF THE BSP service. (Sec. 133)

The BSP shall have its principal place of business in


Metro Manila, but may maintain branches, agencies 3. Separation Benefits
and correspondents in such other places as the
proper conduct of its business may require. (Sec.
4)
46
The Committee shall complete its work within 90 days
from the constitution of the MB submitting a comprehensive
5. CORPORATE POWERS report with all its findings and justification. The following
guidelines shall be strictly observed in the determination of
1. To adopt, alter, and use a corporate seal which which assets and liabilities shall be transferred to the BSP:
shall be judicially noticed; (a) the MB and the Secretary of Finance shall have primary
responsibility for working out creative monetary and financial
2. To enter into contracts; solutions to retire the Central Bank liabilities and losses at the
3. To lease or own real and personal property, least cost to the Government; (b) the BSP shall remit 75% of
and to sell or otherwise dispose of the same; its net profits to a special deposit account (sinking fund) until
4. To sue and be sued; and such time as the net liabilities of the Central Bank shall have
5. To acquire and hold such assets and incur such been liquidated through generally accepted finance
mechanisms such as, but not limited to, write-offs, set-offs,
liabilities in connection with its operations condonation, collections, reappraisal, revaluation and bond
authorized by the provisions of the NCBA, or as issuance by the National Government, or to the National
are essential to the proper conduct of such Government as dividends; (c) the assets and liabilities to be
operations; transferred shall be limited to an amount that will enable the
BSP to perform its responsibilities adequately and operate on
6. To compromise, condone or release, in whole
a viable basis: Provided, That the assets shall exceed the
or in part, any claim of or settled liability to the liabilities as certified by the COA, by an initial amount of
BSP, regardless of the amount involved, under P10B; (d) liabilities to be assumed by the BSP shall include
such terms and conditions as may be liability for notes and coins in circulation as of the effective
prescribed by the MB to protect the interests of date of this Act; and (e) any asset or liability of the Central
Bank not transferred to the BSP shall be retained and
the BSP;
administered, disposed of and liquidated by the Central Bank
7. To do and perform any and all things that may itself which shall continue to exist as the CB Board of
be necessary or proper to carry out the Liquidators only for the purposes provided in this paragraph
purposes of the NCBA (Sec. 5) but not later than twenty-five (25) years or until such time
that liabilities have been liquidated: Provided, That the BSP
may financially assist the Central Bank of Liquidators in the
NOTE
liquidation of CB liabilities: Provided, finally, That upon
The powers and functions of the BSP shall be disposition of said retained assets and liquidation of said
exercised by the BSP MB. (Sec. 6) retained liabilities, the Central Bank shall be deemed
abolished.
All actions taken by the BSP MB under this section shall
be reported to Congress and the President within 30 days.
(Sec. 132)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 301 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Pursuant to Sec. 15 of this Act, the MB is


authorized to provide separation incentives, 1. Must be natural-born citizens of the
and all those who shall retire or be separated Philippines,
from the service on account of reorganization 2. Must be at least 35 years of age, with the
under the preceding section shall be entitled to exception of the Governor who should at
such incentives, which shall be in addition to all least be 40 years of age,
gratuities and benefits to which they may be 3. Must be of good moral character,
entitled under existing laws. (Sec. 134) 4. Must be of unquestionable integrity,
5. Must be of known probity and patriotism,
and
4. Transfer of Powers 6. Must be with recognized competence in
social and economic disciplines. (Sec. 8)
All powers, duties and functions vested by law
in the Central Bank of the Philippines not 2 . Disqualifications of Members
inconsistent with the provisions of this Act shall
be deemed transferred to the BSP. All 1. The disqualifications imposed by RA 6713
references to the Central Bank of the (Code of Conduct and Ethical Standards for
Philippines in any law or special charters shall Public Officials and Employees), and
be deemed to refer to the BSP. (Sec. 136) 2. A Member may not be a director, officer,
employee, consultant, lawyer, agent or
5. Implementing Details stockholder of any bank, QB or any other
institution which is subject to supervision or
The BSP shall be made operational by the examination by the BSP. In such cases, he
performance of the following acts: (a) the shall resign from, and divest himself of any
President shall constitute the MB by appointing and all interests in such institution before
the members thereof within 60 days from the assumption of office as member of the MB.
effectivity of this Act; and (b) the transfer of 3. The members of the MB coming from the
such assets and liabilities from the Central private sector shall not hold any other
Bank to the BSP as provided in Sec. 132 shall public office or public employment during
be completed within 90 days from the their tenure.
constitution of the MB. 4. No person shall be a member of the MB if
he has been connected directly with any
All incumbent personnel in the Central Bank as multilateral banking or financial institution
of the date of the approval of this Act shall or has a substantial interest in any private
continue to exercise their duties and functions bank in the Phils., within 1 year prior to his
as personnel of the BSP subject to the appointment;
provisions of Section 133: Provided, That such 5. No member of the MB shall be employed in
personnel in the Central Bank as may be any such institution within 2 years after the
necessary for the purpose of implementing expiration of his term except when he
Section 132 may be assigned by the BSP MB to serves as an official representative of the
the Central Bank. (Sec. 131) Philippine Government to such institution.
(Sec. 9)

B. The Monetary Board NOTE


1. In addition to the requirements of RA 6713
(Code of Conduct and Ethical Standards for
1. COMPOSITION Public Officials and Employees), any
member of the MB with personal or
The MB is composed of 7 members appointed by pecuniary interest in any matter in the
the President for a term of 6 years. No member of agenda of the MB shall disclose his interest
the MB may be reappointed more than once. to the MB and shall retire from the meeting
when the matter is taken up. The decision
1. BSP Governor, who shall be the Chairman of taken on the matter shall be made public.
the MB shall be head of a department and The minutes shall reflect the disclosure
his appointment shall be subject to made and the retirement of the member
confirmation by the COA. Whenever the concerned from the meeting. (Sec. 14)
Governor is unable to attend a meeting of the
Board, he shall designate a Deputy Governor to 2. Outside Interests of the Governor and the
act as his alternate: Provided, That in such Full-time Members of the Board. The
event, the MB shall designate one of its Governor of the BSP and the full-time
members as acting Chairman; members of the Board shall limit their
2. Cabinet Member designated by the professional activities to those pertaining
President. Whenever the designated Cabinet directly to their positions with the BSP.
Member is unable to attend a meeting of the Accordingly, they may not accept any other
Board, he shall designate an Undersecretary in employment, whether public or private,
his Department to attend as his alternate; and remunerated or ad honorem, with the
3. 5 Members from the Private Sector all of exception of positions in eleemosynary,
whom shall serve full-time: Provided, however, civic, cultural or religious organizations or
That three 3 shall have a term of 6 years, and whenever, by designation of the President,
the other 2, 3 years. the Governor or the full-time member is
tasked to represent the interest of the
2. MEMBERS Government or other government agencies
in matters connected with or affecting the
1 . Qualifications of Members

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 302 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

economy or the financial system of the


country. (Sec. 20) 4. Adopt an annual budget for and authorize
such expenditures by the BSP as are in the
interest of the effective administration and
3. Vacancies operations of the BSP in accordance with
applicable laws and regulations; and
Any vacancy in the MB created by the death,
resignation, or removal of any member shall be 5. Indemnify its members and other officials
filled by the appointment of a new member to of the BSP, including personnel of the
complete the unexpired period of the term of the departments performing supervision and
member concerned. (Sec. 7) examination functions against all costs and
expenses reasonably incurred by such persons in
4. Removal connection with any civil or criminal action, suit
or proceedings to which he may be, or is, made a
The President may remove any member of the MB party by reason of the performance of his
for any of the following reasons: functions or duties, unless he is finally adjudged
in such action or proceeding to be liable for
1. If he no longer possesses the qualifications negligence or misconduct.48 (Sec. 15)
specified
2. If he is subsequently disqualified under any
of the instances provided for 4. MEETINGS
disqualification;
3. If he is physically or mentally incapacitated NOTES
that he cannot properly discharge his
duties and responsibilities and such 1. The MB shall meet at least once a week. (Sec.
incapacity has lasted for more than 6 11)
months; or 2. The MB may be called to a meeting by the
4. If he is guilty of acts or operations which Governor or by 2 other members of the MB.
are of fraudulent or illegal character or (Sec. 11)
which are manifestly opposed to the aims 3. The presence of 4 members shall constitute a
and interests of the BSP. (Sec. 10) quorum: Provided, That in all cases the
Governor or his duly designated alternate shall
be among the 4 (Sec. 11)
5. Salary 4. Unless otherwise provided in this Act, all
decisions of the MB shall require the
The salary of the Governor and the members of the concurrence of at least 4 members. (Sec. 11)
MB from the private sector shall be fixed by the 5. The BSP shall maintain and preserve a
President at a sum commensurate to the complete record of the proceedings and
importance and responsibility attached to the deliberations of the MB, including the tapes and
position. (Sec. 13) transcripts of the stenographic notes, either in
their original form or in microfilm. (Sec. 11)
6. The Deputy Governors may attend the
meetings of the MB with the right to be heard.
3. EXERCISE OF AUTHORITY (Sec. 12)
7. In case of emergencies where time is
In the exercise of its authority, the MB shall: insufficient to call a meeting of the MB, the
1. Issue rules and regulations it considers Governor of the BSP, with the concurrence of 2
necessary for the effective discharge of the other members of the MB, may decide any
responsibilities and exercise of the powers vested matter or take any action within the authority
upon the MB and the BSP. The rules and
MB shall make its own system conform as closely as possible
regulations issued shall be reported to the with the principles provided for under RA 6758
President and the Congress within 15 days from (Compensation and Position Classification Act of 1989):
the date of their issuance; Provided, however, That compensation and wage structure of
employees whose positions fall under salary grade 19 and
below shall be in accordance with the rates prescribed under
2. Direct the management, operations, and
RA 6758.
administration of the BSP, reorganize its On the recommendation of the Governor, appoint, fix
personnel, and issue such rules and regulations the remunerations and other emoluments, and remove
as it may deem necessary or convenient for this personnel of the BSP, subject to pertinent civil service laws:
purpose. The legal units of the BSP shall be Provided, That the MB shall have exclusive and final authority
to promote, transfer, assign, or reassign personnel of the BSP
under the exclusive supervision and control of the
and these personnel actions are deemed made in the interest
MB; of the service and not disciplinary: Provided, further, That the
MB may delegate such authority to the Governor under such
3. Establish a human resource management guidelines as it may determine. (Sec. 15)
48
system which shall govern the selection, hiring, In the event of a settlement or compromise,
appointment, transfer, promotion, or dismissal of indemnification shall be provided only in connection with such
matters covered by the settlement as to which the BSP is
all personnel. Such system shall aim to establish
advised by external counsel that the person to be indemnified
professionalism and excellence at all levels of the did not commit any negligence or misconduct.
BSP in accordance with sound principles of The costs and expenses incurred in defending the
management.47 aforementioned action, suit or proceeding may be paid by the
BSP in advance of the final disposition of such action, suit or
proceeding upon receipt of an undertaking by or on behalf of
47
A compensation structure, based on job evaluation the member, officer, or employee to repay the amount
studies and wage surveys and subject to the MB's approval, advanced should it ultimately be determined by the MB that
shall be instituted as an integral component of the BSP's he is not entitled to be indemnified as provided in this
human resource development program: Provided, That the subsection. (Sec. 15)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 303 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

of the Board. The Governor shall submit a department head in accordance with the
report to the President and Congress within 72 position and compensation plans approved by
hours after the action has been taken. At the the MB, as well as to impose disciplinary
soonest possible time, the Governor shall call a measures upon personnel of the BSP, subject
meeting of the MB to submit his action for to the provisions of Section 15(c) of this Act:
ratification. (Sec. 19) Provided, That removal of personnel shall be
with the approval of the MB;

5. SANCTIONS 5. render opinions, decisions, or rulings, which


shall be final and executory until reversed or
NOTES modified by the MB, on matters regarding
application or enforcement of laws pertaining to
1. Members of the MB, officials, examiners, and institutions supervised by the BSP and laws
employees of the BSP who willfully violate this pertaining to quasi-banks, as well as
Act or who are guilty of negligence, abuses or regulations, policies or instructions issued by
acts of malfeasance or misfeasance or fail to the MB, and the implementation thereof; and
exercise extraordinary diligence in the
performance of his duties shall be held liable 6. exercise such other powers as may be vested
for any loss or injury suffered by the BSP or in him by the MB. (Sec. 17)
other banking institutions as a result of such
violation, negligence, abuse, malfeasance,
misfeasance or failure to exercise extraordinary 2. Representation of the MB and the BSP
diligence. (Sec. 16)
The Governor of the BSP shall be the principal
2. Similar responsibility shall apply to members, representative of the MB and of the BSP and, in
officers, and employees of the BSP for: such capacity and in accordance with the
instructions of the MB, he shall be empowered to:
a.the disclosure of any information of a
confidential nature, or any information on the
discussions or resolutions of the MB, or about 1. represent the MB and the BSP in all dealings
the confidential operations of the BSP, unless with other offices, agencies and
the disclosure is in connection with the instrumentalities of the Government and all
performance of official functions with the other persons or entities, public or private,
BSP, or is with prior authorization of the MB whether domestic, foreign or international;
or the Governor; or
2. sign contracts entered into by the BSP, notes
b.the use of such information for personal gain and securities issued by the BSP, all reports,
or to the detriment of the Government, the balance sheets, profit and loss statements,
BSP or third parties: Provided, however, That correspondence and other documents of the
any data or information required to be BSP. The signature of the Governor may be in
submitted to the President and/or the facsimile whenever appropriate;
Congress, or to be published under the
provisions of this Act shall not be considered 3. represent the BSP, either personally or through
confidential. (Sec. 16) counsel, including private counsel, as may be
authorized by the MB, in any legal proceedings,
action or specialized legal studies; and
6. GOVERNOR
4. delegate his power to represent the BSP, as
1. Powers and Duties provided in subsections (a), (b) and (c) of this
section, to other officers upon his own
The Governor shall be the chief executive officer of responsibility: Provided, however, That in order
the BSP. (Sec. 17) to preserve the integrity and the prestige of his
office, the Governor of the BSP may choose not
1. prepare the agenda for the meetings of the MB to participate in preliminary discussions with
and to submit for the consideration of the MB any multilateral banking or financial institution
the policies and measures which he believes to on any negotiations for the Govt within or
be necessary to carry out the purposes and outside the Phils. During the negotiations, he
provisions of the NCBA; may instead be represented by a permanent
2. execute and administer the policies and negotiator. (Sec. 18)
measures approved by the MB;

3. direct and supervise the operations and internal 3. Deputy Governor(s)


administration of the BSP. The Governor may
delegate certain of his administrative NOTES
responsibilities to other officers or may assign 1. The Governor of the BSP, with the approval of
specific tasks or responsibilities to any full-time the MB, shall appoint not more than 3 Deputy
member of the MB without additional Governors who shall perform duties as may be
remuneration or allowance whenever he may assigned to them by the Governor and the
deem fit or subject to such rules and Board.
regulations as the MB may prescribe; 2. In the absence of the Governor, a Deputy
Governor designated by the Governor shall act
as chief executive of the BSP and shall exercise
4. appoint and fix the remunerations and other the powers and perform the duties of the
emoluments of personnel below the rank of a Governor. Whenever the Government is unable

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 304 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

to attend meetings of government boards or or (b) in which a controlling proportion of


councils in which he is an ex officio member the shares is owned by the same interest
pursuant to provisions of special laws, a Deputy that owns a controlling proportion of the
Governor as may be designated by the shares of his bank,
Governor shall be vested with authority to in excess of 5% of the capital and surplus of the
participate and exercise the right to vote in bank, or in the maximum amount permitted by
such meetings. (Sec. 21) law, whichever is lower, shall be required by the
lending bank to waive the secrecy of his deposits of
whatever nature in all banks in the Philippines. 51
(Sec. 26)
C. Operations of the BSP
3. Examination and Fees
1. SUPERVISION AND EXAMINATION
The supervising and examining department
head, personally or by deputy, shall examine
The BSP shall have supervision over, and conduct
the books of every banking institution once in
periodic or special examinations of, banking
every 12 months, and at such other times as
institutions and quasi-banks, including their
the MB by an affirmative vote of 5 members,
subsidiaries and affiliates49 engaged in allied
may deem expedient and to make a report on
activities. (Sec. 24)
the same to the MB: Provided, That there shall
be an interval of at least twelve 12 months
The department heads and the examiners of the
between annual examinations.
supervising and/or examining departments are
hereby authorized to administer oaths to any
The bank concerned shall afford to the head of
director, officer, or employee of any institution
the appropriate supervising and examining
under their respective supervision or subject to
departments and to his authorized deputies full
their examination and to compel the presentation
opportunity to examine its books, cash and
of all books, documents, papers or records
available assets and general condition at any
necessary in their judgment to ascertain the facts
time during banking hours when requested to
relative to the true condition of any institution as
do so by the BSP: Provided, however, That
well as the books and records of persons and
none of the reports and other papers relative to
entities relative to or in connection with the
such examinations shall be open to inspection
operations, activities or transactions of the
by the public except insofar as such publicity is
institution under examination, subject to the
incidental to the proceedings hereinafter
provision of existing laws protecting or
authorized or is necessary for the prosecution
safeguarding the secrecy or confidentiality of bank
of violations in connection with the business of
deposits as well as investments of private persons,
such institutions.
natural or juridical, in debt instruments issued by
the Govt. (Sec. 24)
Banking and quasi-banking institutions which
1. No Restraining Order are subject to examination by the BSP shall pay
to the BSP, within the first 30 days of each
No restraining order or injunction shall be issued by year, an annual fee in an amount equal to a
the court enjoining the BSP from examining any percentage as may be prescribed by the MB of
institution subject to supervision or examination by its average total assets during the preceding
the BSP, unless there is convincing proof that the year as shown on its end-of-month balance
action of the BSP is plainly arbitrary and made in sheets, after deducting cash on hand and
bad faith and the petitioner or plaintiff files with the amounts due from banks, including the BSP
clerk or judge of the court in which the action is and banks abroad. (Sec. 28)
pending a bond executed in favor of the BSP, in an
amount to be fixed by the court. (Sec. 24)50
2. HANDLING OF BANKS IN DISTRESS
2. Waiver of Secrecy of Deposits in DOSRI
Accounts 1. Conservatorship

Any director, officer or stockholder who, together 1. Powers of Conservator


with his related interest (DOSRI), contracts a loan
or any form of financial accommodation from: Whenever, on the basis of a report submitted by
the appropriate supervising or examining
1. his bank; or department, the MB finds that a bank or a QB is in
2. from a bank (a) which is a subsidiary of a a state of continuing inability or unwillingness to
bank holding company of which both his maintain a condition of liquidity deemed adequate
bank and the lending bank are subsidiaries to protect the interest of depositors and creditors,
the MB may appoint a conservator with such
powers as the MB shall deem necessary to:
49
Subsidiary a corporation more than 50% of the
voting stock of which is owned by a bank or QB. a. take charge of the assets, liabilities,
Affiliate a corporation the voting stock of which, to the
extent of 50% or less, is owned by a bank or QB or which is
and the management thereof,
related or linked to such institution or intermediary through b. reorganize the management,
common stockholders or such other factors as may be
determined by the MB. (Sec. 24) 51
Any information obtained from an examination of his
50
The provisions of Rule 58 of the New Rules of Court deposits shall be held strictly confidential and may be used by
insofar as they are applicable and not inconsistent with the the examiners only in connection with their supervisory and
provisions of this section shall govern the issuance and examination responsibility or by the BSP in an appropriate
dissolution of the restraining order or injunction contemplated legal action it has initiated involving the deposit account.
in this section. (Sec. 24) (Sec. 26)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 305 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

c. collect all monies and debts due said attendant to the conservatorship shall be borne
institution, and by the bank or quasi-bank concerned. (Sec. 29)
d. exercise all powers necessary to
restore its viability. (Sec. 29) 2. Closure

2. Period of Conservatorship
1. When closure is ordered
The conservatorship shall not exceed 1 year. (Sec.
29) The MB shall terminate the conservatorship Whenever, upon report of the head of the
when it is satisfied that the institution can continue supervising or examining department, the MB finds
to operate on its own and the conservatorship is no that a bank or quasi-bank:
longer necessary. The conservatorship shall
likewise be terminated should the MB, on the basis
of the report of the conservator or of its own is unable to pay its liabilities as they
findings, determine that the continuance in become due in the ordinary course of
business of the institution would involve probable business: Provided, That this shall
loss to its depositors or creditors, in which case the not include inability to pay caused by
provisions of Section 30 shall apply. (Sec. 29) extraordinary demands induced by
financial panic in the banking
3. Conservator community;
has insufficient realizable assets, as
The conservator shall report and be responsible to determined by the BSP, to meet its
the MB and shall have the power to overrule or liabilities; or
revoke the actions of the previous management cannot continue in business without
and board of directors of the bank or quasi-bank. involving probable losses to its
(Sec. 29) depositors or creditors; or
has willfully violated a cease and
While the Central Bank law gives vast desist order under Sec. 37 that has
and far-reaching powers to the conservator of a become final, involving acts or
bank, such powers must be related to the transactions which amount to fraud
preservation of the assets of the bank, the or a dissipation of the assets of the
reorganization of the management and the institution;
restoration of viability. Such powers cannot
extend to the post-facto repudiation of in which cases, the MB may summarily and without
perfected transactions, otherwise they would need for prior hearing forbid the institution from
infringe against the non-impairment clause of doing business in the Philippines (Sec. 30)
the Constitution. The law merely gives the
conservator power to revoke contracts that are
deemed to be defective - i.e., void, voidable,
unenforceable or rescissible. The conservator
merely takes the place of a banks board of
directors. What the said board cannot do - such
as repudiating a contract validly entered into
under the doctrine of implied authority - the 2. Related Provisions in RA 8791 (General Banking
conservator cannot do either. Ineluctably, his Law of 2000)
power is not unilateral and he cannot simply
repudiate valid obligations of the Bank. His
authority would be only to bring court actions In case a bank or quasi-bank notifies the BSP
to assail such contracts. (First Philippine or publicly announces a bank holiday, or in any
International Bank vs CA ; 1996) manner suspends the payment of its deposit
liabilities continuously for more than 30 days,
The conservator should be competent and the MB may summarily and without need for
knowledgeable in bank operations and prior hearing close such banking institution and
management. (Sec. 29) place it under receivership of the Philippine
Deposit Insurance Corporation. (Sec 53)
The conservator shall receive remuneration to
be fixed by the MB in an amount not to exceed Whenever a bank, quasi-bank or trust entity
2/3 of the salary of the president of the persists in conducting its business in an unsafe
institution in 1 year, payable in 12 equal or unsound manner, the MB may take action
monthly payments: Provided, That, if at any under Sec 30. Conducting business in an
time within one-year period, the unsafe or unsound manner means:
conservatorship is terminated on the ground
that the institution can operate on its own, the - The act or omission has resulted or
conservator shall receive the balance of the may result in material loss or
remuneration which he would have received up damage, or abnormal risk or danger
to the end of the year; but if the to safety, stability, liquidity or
conservatorship is terminated on other solvency or
grounds, the conservator shall not be entitled - to the institution's depositors,
to such remaining balance. The MB may creditors, investors, stockholders or
appoint a conservator connected with the BSP, to the Bangko Sentral or to the public
in which case he shall not be entitled to receive in general or
any remuneration or emolument from the BSP - The act or omission has caused any
during the conservatorship. The expenses undue injury, or has given any

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 306 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

unwarranted benefits, advantage or to its depositors or creditors. (Rural


preference to the bank or any party Bank of Buhi vs CA ; 1988)
in the discharge by the director or
officer of his duties and
responsibilities through manifest 2. Functions and Obligations of the Receiver
partiality, evident bad faith or gross
inexcusable negligence or The receiver shall immediately gather and take
- The act or omission involves entering charge of all the assets and liabilities of the
into any contract or transaction institution, administer the same for the benefit of
manifestly and grossly its creditors, and exercise the general powers of a
disadvantageous to the bank, quasi- receiver under the Revised Rules of Court but shall
bank or trust entity, whether or not not, with the exception of administrative
the director or officer profited or will expenditures, pay or commit any act that will
profit thereby (Sec. 56) involve the transfer or disposition of any asset
of the institution: Provided, That the receiver may
3. Receivership deposit or place the funds of the institution in
non-speculative investments.
1. When Receiver is Designated
The receiver shall determine as soon as possible,
Whenever, upon report of the head of the but not later than 90 days from take over, whether
supervising or examining department, the MB finds the institution may be rehabilitated or otherwise
that a bank or quasi-bank: placed in such a condition so that it may be
permitted to resume business with safety to its
depositors and creditors and the general public:
is unable to pay its liabilities as they Provided, That any determination for the
become due in the ordinary course of resumption of business of the institution shall be
business: Provided, That this shall subject to prior approval of the MB. (Sec. 30)
not include inability to pay caused by
extraordinary demands induced by
financial panic in the banking 3. Related Provisions in RA 8791 (General Banking
community; Law of 2000)
has insufficient realizable assets, as
determined by the BSP, to meet its The petitioner or plaintiff must file with the clerk or
liabilities; or judge of the court in which the action is
cannot continue in business without pending a bond, executed in favor of the BSP,
involving probable losses to its in an amount to be fixed by the court. (Sec 69)
depositors or creditors; or
has willfully violated a cease and Any director or officer of any bank placed under
desist order under Sec. 37 that has receivership who refuses to turn over the banks
become final, involving acts or records and assets to designated receivers,
transactions which amount to fraud tampers with records, appropriates or destroys or
or a dissipation of the assets of the causes the misappropriation and destruction of the
institution; banks assets, receives or permits or causes to be
received in said bank any deposit, collection of
in which cases, the MB may summarily loans and/or receivables, pays out or permits or
and without need for prior hearing forbid causes to be transferred any securities or property
the institution from doing business in the of said bank shall be subject to the penal provisions
Philippines and designate the Philippine of the New Central Bank Act. (Sec 70)
Deposit Insurance Corporation (PDIC) as
receiver of the banking institution. For a
quasi-bank, any person of recognized 4. Liquidation
competence in banking or finance may be
designed as receiver. (Sec. 30) If the receiver determines that the institution
cannot be rehabilitated or permitted to resume
There is no requirement whether business in accordance with the next preceding
paragraph, the MB shall notify in writing the board
express or implied, that a hearing be
of directors of its findings and direct the receiver to
first conducted before a banking
proceed with the liquidation of the institution.
institution may be placed under
receivership. The law is explicit as to
the conditions prerequisite to the
1. Receivers Acts
action of the MB to forbid the
institution to do business in the
1. file ex parte with the proper RTC, and
Philippines and to appoint a receiver
without requirement of prior notice or any
to immediately take charge of the
other action, a petition for assistance in the
bank's assets and liabilities. They
liquidation of the institution pursuant to a
are: (a) an examination made by the
liquidation plan adopted by the Philippine
examining department of the CB; (b)
Deposit Insurance Corporation for general
report by said department to the MB;
application to all closed banks. In case of
and (c) prima facie showing that the
quasi-banks, the liquidation plan shall be
bank is in a condition of insolvency or
adopted by the MB.
so situated that its continuance in
2. upon acquiring jurisdiction, the court shall,
business would involve probable loss
upon motion by the receiver after due
notice, adjudicate disputed claims against

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 307 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

the institution, assist the enforcement of


individual liabilities of the stockholders, The petitioner or plaintiff must file with the
directors and officers, and decide on other clerk or judge of the court in which the action
issues as may be material to implement the is pending a bond, executed in favor of the
liquidation plan adopted. The receiver shall BSP, in an amount to be fixed by the court.
pay the cost of the proceedings from the (Sec 69)
assets of the institution.

The exclusive jurisdiction of the 3. Provisions common to Conservatorship and


liquidation court pertains only to the Receivership
adjudication of claims against the
bank. It does not cover the reverse The actions of the MB taken under these
situation where it is the bank which sections shall be final and executory, and
files a claim against another person or may not be restrained or set aside by the
legal entity. (Manalo vs CA ; 2001) court except on petition for certiorari on the
ground that the action taken was in excess
3. convert the assets of the institutions to of jurisdiction or with such grave abuse of
money, dispose of the same to creditors discretion as to amount to lack or excess of
and other parties, for the purpose of paying jurisdiction. The petition for certiorari may
the debts of such institution in accordance only be filed by the stockholders of record
with the rules on concurrence and representing the majority of the capital
preference of credit under the Civil Code stock within 10 days from receipt by the
and board of directors of the institution of the
4. he may, in the name of the institution, and order directing receivership, liquidation or
with the assistance of counsel as he may conservatorship.
retain, institute such actions as may be The designation of a conservator or the
necessary to collect and recover accounts appointment of a receiver shall be vested
and assets of, or defend any action against, exclusively with the MB. Furthermore, the
the institution. (Sec. 30) designation of a conservator is not a
5. In case of liquidation of a bank or quasi- precondition to the designation of a
bank, after payment of the cost of receiver. (Sec. 30)
proceedings, including reasonable expenses
and fees of the receiver to be allowed by 5. Other Operations
the court, the receiver shall pay the debts
of such institution, under order of the 1. Research, Statistics, Data and Information
court, in accordance with the rules on
concurrence and preference of credit as Research and Statistics. The BSP shall prepare
provided in the Civil Code. (Sec. 31)
data and conduct economic research for the
6. All revenues and earnings realized by the
guidance of the MB in the formulation and
receiver in winding up the affairs and
implementation of its policies.52 (Sec. 22)
administering the assets of any bank or
The BSP shall have the authority to request
quasi-bank within the purview of this Act
from government offices and instrumentalities,
shall be used to pay the costs, fees and
or GOCCs, any data which it may require for
expenses mentioned in no. 5, salaries of
the proper discharge of its functions and
such personnel whose employment is
responsibilities. The BSP through the Governor
rendered necessary in the discharge of the
or in his absence, a duly authorized
liquidation together with other additional
representative shall have the power to issue a
expenses caused thereby. The balance of
subpoena for the production of the books and
revenues and earnings, after the payment
records for the aforesaid purpose. Those who
of all said expenses, shall form part of the
refuse the subpoena without justifiable cause,
assets available for payment to creditors.
or who refuse to supply the bank with data
(Sec. 32)
requested or required, shall be subject to
punishment for contempt in accordance with
The assets of an institution under
the provisions of the Rules of Court. (Sec. 23)
receivership or liquidation shall be deemed
Data on individual firms, other than banks,
in custodia legis in the hands of the
gathered by the Department of Economic
receiver and shall, from the moment the
Research and other departments or units of the
institution was placed under such
BSP shall not be made available to any person
receivership or liquidation, be exempt from
or entity outside of the BSP whether public or
any order of garnishment, levy,
private except under order of the court or
attachment, or execution. (Sec. 30)
under such conditions as may be prescribed by
The BSP may, if public interest so requires,
the MB: Provided, however, That the collective
award to an institution, upon such terms
data on firms may be released to interested
and conditions as the MB may approve, the
persons or entities: Provided, finally, That in
banking franchise of a bank under
the case of data on banks, the provisions of
liquidation to operate in the area where
Sec. 27 of this Act (infra) shall apply. (Sec. 23)
said bank or its branches were previously
operating: Provided, That whatever
proceeds may be realized from such award
shall be subject to the appropriate 52
Such data shall include, among others, forecasts of
exclusive disposition of the MB. (Sec. 33) the balance of payments of the Philippines, statistics on the
monthly movement of the monetary aggregates and of prices
and other statistical series and economic studies useful for
2. Related Provisions in RA 8791 (General Banking the formulation and analysis of monetary, banking, credit and
Law of 2000) exchange policies. (Sec. 22)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 308 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

2. Training of Technical Personnel condition of the BSP and a statistical


appendix.54 (Sec. 40)
The BSP shall promote and sponsor the training The BSP shall publish another version of the
of technical personnel in the field of money and annual report in terms understandable to the
banking. (Sec. 23)53 layman. (Sec. 40)55

3. Operating Departments 6. Profits, Losses and Special Accounts

The MB shall, in accordance with its Within the 30 days following the end of each
authority under this Act, determine and fiscal year56, the BSP shall determine its net
provide for such operating departments profits or losses. In the calculation of net
and other offices, including a public profits, the BSP shall make adequate allowance
information office, of the BSP as it deems or establish adequate reserves for bad and
convenient for the proper and efficient doubtful accounts. (Sec. 43)
conduct of the operations and the Within the first 60 days following the end of
accomplishment of the objectives of the
each fiscal year, the MB shall determine and
BSP. The functions and duties of such
carry out the distribution of the net profits, in
operating departments and other offices
accordance with the following rule: 50% of the
shall be determined by the MB. (Sec. 38)
net profits shall be carried to surplus and the
remaining 50% shall revert back to the
National Treasury, except as otherwise
4. Reports and Publications
provided in the transitory provisions of this Act.
(Sec. 44)
The BSP shall publish a general balance
sheet showing the volume and composition Profits or losses arising from any revaluation of
of its assets and liabilities as of the last the BSP's net assets or liabilities in gold or
working day of the month within sixty (60) foreign currencies with respect to the Philippine
days after the end of each month except peso shall not be included in the computation
for the month of December, which shall be of the annual profits and losses of the BSP.
submitted within ninety (90) days after the Any profits or losses arising in this manner
end hereof. (Sec. 39) shall be offset by any amounts which, as a
The MB shall publish and submit the consequence of such revaluations, are owed by
following reports to the President and to the Philippines to any international or regional
the Congress: intergovernmental financial institution of which
not later than 90 days after the end of each the Philippines is a member or are owed by
quarter, an analysis of economic and these institutions to the Philippines. Any
financial developments, including the remaining profit or loss shall be carried in a
condition of net international reserves and special frozen account which shall be named
monetary aggregates; "Revaluation of International Reserve" and the
within 90 days after the end of the year, net balance of which shall appear either among
the liabilities or among the assets of the BSP,
the preceding year's budget and profit and
depending on whether the revaluations have
loss statement of the BSP showing in
produced net profits or net losses. The
reasonable detail the result of its
Revaluation of International Reserve account
operations;
shall be neither credited nor debited for any
120 days after the end of each semester, a
purposes other than those specifically
review of the state of the financial system;
authorized in this section. (Sec. 45) 57
and
as soon as practicable, abnormal 54
The statistical appendix shall present, as a minimum,
movements in monetary aggregates and the following data: (a) the monthly movement of monetary
the general price level, and, not later than aggregates and their components; (b) the monthly movement
72 hours after they are taken, remedial of purchases and sales of foreign exchange and of the
measures in response to such abnormal international reserves of the BSP; (c) the balance of
movements. (Sec. 39) payments of the Philippines; (d) monthly indices of consumer
prices and of import and export prices; (e) the monthly
movement, in summary form, of exports and imports, by
5. Annual Report volume and value; (f) the monthly movement of the accounts
of the BSP and of other banks; (g) the principal data on
government receipts and expenditures and on the status of
Before the end of March of each year, the BSP the public debt, both domestic and foreign; and (h) the texts
shall publish and submit to the President and of the major legal and administrative measures adopted by
the Congress an annual report on the condition the Government and the MB during the year which relate to
of the BSP including a review of the policies the functions or operations of the BSP or of the financial
system. (Sec. 40)
and measures adopted by the MB during the 55
Failure to comply with the reportorial requirements
past year and an analysis of the economic and
pursuant to this article without justifiable reason as may be
financial circumstances which gave rise to said determined by the MB shall cause the withholding of the
policies and measures. The annual report shall salary of the personnel concerned until the requirements are
also include a statement of the financial complied with. (Sec. 40)
The balance sheets and other financial statements of
the BSP shall be signed by the officers responsible for their
53 preparation, by the Governor, and by the auditor of the BSP.
Toward this end, the BSP is hereby authorized to (Sec. 41)
defray the costs of study, at home or abroad, of qualified 56
The fiscal year of the BSP shall begin on January first
employees of the BSP, of promising university graduates or of
and end on December thirty-first of each year. (Sec. 42)
any other qualified persons who shall be determined by 57
proper competitive examinations. The MB shall prescribe Sections 43 and 43-A of RA 265, as amended,
rules and regulations to govern the training program of the creating the Monetary Adjustment Account (MAA) and the
BSP. Exchange Stabilization Adjustment Account (ESAA),

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 309 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

regulations as the MB may prescribe: Provided,


7. n.b. Auditor however, That personnel of the supervising and
examining departments are prohibited from
The Chairman of the COA shall act as the ex borrowing from a bank under their supervision
officio auditor of the BSP and, as such, he is or examination. (Sec. 27)
empowered and authorized to appoint a
representative who shall be the auditor of the
BSP and, in accordance with law, fix his salary,
and to appoint and fix salaries and number of 4. SANCTIONS
personnel to assist said representative in his
work. The salaries and other emoluments shall 1. Refusal to Make Reports or Permit
be paid by the COA. The auditor of the BSP Examination
and personnel under him may be removed only
by the Chairman of the COA. (Sec. 47) Any officer, owner, agent, manager, director or OIC
The representative of the Chairman of the COA of any institution subject to the supervision or
must be a CPA with at least 10 years examination by the BSP within the purview of this
experience as such. No relative of any member Act who, being required in writing by the MB or by
of the MB or the Chairman of the COA within the head of the supervising and examining
the 6th degree of consanguinity or affinity shall department willfully refuses to file the required
be appointed such representative. (Sec. 47) report or permit any lawful examination into the
affairs of such institution shall be punished by a
fine of not less than P50,000 nor more than
3. PROHIBITIONS ON BSP PERSONNEL P100,000 or by imprisonment of not less than 1
year nor more than 5 years, or both, in the
In addition to the prohibitions found in RA 3019 discretion of the court. (Sec. 34)
(Anti-Graft and Corrupt Practices Act) and 6713
(Code of Conduct and Ethical Standards for Public 2. False Statement
Officials and Employees), personnel of the BSP are
hereby prohibited from: The willful making of a false or misleading
statement on a material fact to the MB or to the
1. being an officer, director, lawyer or agent, examiners of the BSP shall be punished by a fine of
employee, consultant or stockholder, directly or not less than P100,000 nor more than P200,000, or
indirectly, of any institution subject to by imprisonment of not more 5 years, or both, at
supervision or examination by the BSP, the discretion of the court. (Sec. 35)
EXC:
a. non-stock savings and loan associations
and provident funds organized 3. Violation of This Act and Other Banking
exclusively for employees of the BSP, Laws, Rules, Regulations, Orders or
and Instructions
b. as otherwise provided in the NCBA in
this Act; Whenever a bank or QB, or whenever any person
or entity willfully violates this Act or other pertinent
2. directly or indirectly requesting or receiving any banking laws being enforced or implemented by the
gift, present or pecuniary or material benefit BSP or any order, instruction, rule or regulation
for himself or another, from any institution issued by the MB, the person or persons
subject to supervision or examination by the responsible for such violation shall unless otherwise
BSP; provided in this Act be punished by a fine of not
less than P50,000 nor more than P200,000 or by
3. revealing in any manner, except under orders imprisonment of not less than 2 years nor more
of the court, the Congress or any government than 10 years, or both, at the discretion of the
office or agency authorized by law, or under court.
such conditions as may be prescribed by the
MB, information relating to the condition or Whenever a bank or QB persists in carrying on its
business of any institution. This prohibition business in an unlawful or unsafe manner, the
shall not be held to apply to the giving of Board may, without prejudice to the penalties
information to the MB or the Governor of the provided in the preceding paragraph of this section
BSP, or to any person authorized by either of and the administrative sanctions provided in Sec.
them, in writing, to receive such information; 37, take action under Sec. 30. (Sec. 36)
and

4. borrowing from any institution subject to 4. Administrative Sanctions on Banks and


supervision or examination by the BSP shall be QBs
prohibited unless said borrowings are
adequately secured, fully disclosed to the MB, Without prejudice to the criminal sanctions against
and shall be subject to such further rules and the culpable persons provided in Secs. 34-36, the
MB may, at its discretion, impose upon any bank or
respectively, are hereby repealed. Amounts outstanding as of
QB, their directors and/or officers, for any
the effective date of this Act based on these accounts shall
continue to be for the account of the CB and shall be
governed by the transitory provisions of this Act. The 1. willful violation of its charter or by-laws,
Revaluation of International Reserve (RIR) account as of the 2. willful delay in the submission of reports or
effective date of this Act of the CB shall continue to be for the publications thereof as required by law,
account of the same entity and shall be governed by the
provisions of Sec. 44 of RA 265, as amended, until otherwise
rules and regulations;
provided for in accordance with the transitory provisions of 3. any refusal to permit examination into the
this Act. (Sec. 46) affairs of the institution;

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 310 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

4. any willful making of a false or misleading order. If no such hearing is requested within said
statement to the Board or the appropriate period, the order shall be final. If a hearing is
supervising and examining department or conducted, all issues shall be determined on the
its examiners; basis of records, after which the MB may either
5. any willful failure or refusal to comply with, reconsider or make final its order. (Sec. 37)
or violation of, any banking law or any
order, instruction or regulation issued by 7. Daily Fines
the MB, or any order, instruction or ruling
by the Governor; or The Governor is hereby authorized, at his
6. any commission of irregularities, and/or discretion, to impose upon banking institutions, for
conducting business in an unsafe or any failure to comply with the requirements of law,
unsound manner as may be determined by MB regulations and policies, and/or instructions
the MB, issued by the MB or by the Governor, fines not in
excess of P10,000 a day for each violation, the
the following administrative sanctions (which imposition of which shall be final and executory
need not be applied in the order of their severity), until reversed, modified or lifted by the MB on
whenever applicable: appeal. (Sec. 37)

2. fines in amounts as may be determined by


the MB to be appropriate, but in no case to D. Peso, Currency, Legal Tender, and Bank
exceed P30,000 a day for each violation,
Deposit Accounts
taking into consideration the attendant
circumstances, such as the nature and
1. PESO
gravity of the violation or irregularity and
the size of the bank or quasi-bank;
The unit of monetary value in the Philippines is the
3. suspension of rediscounting privileges or
"peso," which is represented by the sign "P." The
access to BSP credit facilities;
peso is divided into 100 equal parts called
4. suspension of lending or foreign exchange
"centavos," which are represented by the sign "c."
operations or authority to accept new
(Sec. 48)
deposits or make new investments;
5. suspension of interbank clearing privileges;
2. CURRENCY
and/or
6. revocation of quasi-banking license.
The word "currency" is hereby defined, for
Resignation or termination from office shall purposes of this Act, as meaning all Philippine
notes and coins issued or circulating in
not exempt such director or officer from
accordance with the provisions of this Act.
administrative or criminal sanctions. (Sec.
(Sec. 49)
37)
The MB, with the approval of the President of
5. Preventive Suspension the Philippines, shall prescribe the
denominations, dimensions, designs,
The MB may, whenever warranted by inscriptions and other characteristics of notes
circumstances, preventively suspend any director issued by the BSP: Provided, however, That
or officer of a bank or quasi-bank pending an said notes shall state that they are liabilities of
investigation: Provided, That should the case be the BSP and are fully guaranteed by the
not finally decided by the BSP within a period of Government of the Republic of the Philippines.
120 days after the date of suspension, said director Said notes shall bear the signatures, in
or officer shall be reinstated in his position: facsimile, of the President of the Philippines
Provided, further, That when the delay in the and of the Governor of the BSP. Similarly, the
disposition of the case is due to the fault, MB, with the approval of the President of the
negligence or petition of the director or officer, the Philippines, shall prescribe the weight, fineness,
period of delay shall not be counted in computing designs, denominations and other
the period of suspension herein provided. (Sec. 37) characteristics of the coins issued by the BSP.
In the minting of coins, the MB shall give full
6. Cease and Desist Order consideration to the availability of suitable
metals and to their relative prices and cost of
WON there is an administrative proceeding, if the minting. (Sec. 53)
institution and/or the directors and/or officers The MB shall prescribe the amounts of notes
concerned continue with or otherwise persist in the and coins to be printed and minted,
commission of the indicated practice or violation, respectively, and the conditions to which the
the MB may issue an order requiring the institution printing of notes and the minting of coins shall
and/or the directors and/or officers concerned to be subject. The MB shall have the authority to
cease and desist from the indicated practice or contract institutions, mints or firms for such
violation, and may further order that immediate operations. All expenses incurred in the printing
action be taken to correct the conditions resulting of notes and the minting of coins shall be for
from such practice or violation. The cease and the account of the BSP. (Sec. 54)
desist order shall be immediately effective upon The BSP shall exchange, on demand and
service on the respondents. without charge, Philippine currency of any
denomination for Philippine notes and coins of
The respondents shall be afforded an opportunity any other denomination requested. If for any
to defend their action in a hearing before the MB or reason the BSP is temporarily unable to provide
any committee chaired by any MB member created notes or coins of the denominations requested,
for the purpose, upon request made by the it shall meet its obligations by delivering notes
respondents within 5 days from their receipt of the

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 311 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

and coins of the denominations which most part of the assets or liabilities of the BSP. (Sec.
nearly approximate those requested. (Sec. 55) 51)
The BSP shall withdraw from circulation and
shall demonetize all notes and coins which for 5. LEGAL TENDER POWER
any reason whatsoever are unfit for circulation
and shall replace them by adequate notes and All notes and coins issued by the BSP shall be fully
coins: Provided, however, That the BSP shall guaranteed by the Government of the Republic of
not replace notes and coins the identification of the Philippines and shall be legal tender in the
which is impossible, coins which show signs of Philippines for all debts, both public and private:
filing, clipping or perforation, and notes which Provided, however, That, unless otherwise fixed by
have lost more than 2/5 of their surface or all the MB, coins shall be legal tender in amounts not
of the signatures inscribed thereon. Notes and exceeding P50 for denominations of 25 centavos
coins in such mutilated conditions shall be and above, and in amounts not exceeding P20 for
withdrawn from circulation and demonetized 58
denominations of 10 centavos or less. (Sec. 52)
without compensation to the bearer. (Sec. 56)
The BSP may call in for replacement notes of 6. DEMAND DEPOSITS
any series or denomination which are more
than 5 years old and coins which are more 10 For purposes of this Act, the term "demand
years old. Notes and coins called in for deposits" means all those liabilities of the BSP
replacement in accordance with this provision and of other banks which are denominated in
shall remain legal tender for a period of 1 year Philippine currency and are subject to payment
from the date of call. After this period, they in legal tender upon demand by the
shall cease to be legal tender but during the presentation of checks. (Sec. 58)
following year, or for such longer period as the
MB may determine, they may be exchanged at Only banks duly authorized to do so may
par and without charge in the BSP and by accept funds or create liabilities payable in
agents duly authorized by the BSP for this pesos upon demand by the presentation of
purpose. After the expiration of this latter checks, and such operations shall be subject to
period, the notes and coins which have not the control of the MB in accordance with the
been exchanged shall cease to be a liability of powers granted it with respect thereto under
the BSP and shall be demonetized. The BSP this Act. (Sec. 59)
shall also demonetize all notes and coins which
have been called in and replaced. (Sec. 57) Checks representing demand deposits do not
have legal tender power and their acceptance
3. EXCLUSIVE ISSUE POWER in the payment of debts, both public and
private, is at the option of the creditor:
Provided, however, That a check which has
The BSP shall have the sole power and been cleared and credited to the account of the
authority to issue currency, within the territory creditor shall be equivalent to a delivery to the
of the Philippines. No other person or entity, creditor of cash in an amount equal to the
public or private, may put into circulation amount credited to his account. (Sec. 60)
notes, coins or any other object or document
which, in the opinion of the MB, might circulate
as currency, nor reproduce or imitate the
facsimiles of BSP notes without prior authority
from the BSP. The MB may issue such
regulations as it may deem advisable in order
to prevent the circulation of foreign currency or
E. Monetary Administration by the BSP
of currency substitutes as well as to prevent
the reproduction of facsimiles of BSP notes. The
BSP shall have the authority to investigate, 1. DOMESTIC MONETARY STABILIZATION
make arrests, conduct searches and seizures in
accordance with law, for the purpose of
maintaining the integrity of the currency. The MB shall endeavor to control any expansion
Violation of this provision or any regulation or contraction in monetary aggregates which is
issued by the BSP pursuant thereto shall prejudicial to the attainment or maintenance of
constitute an offense punishable by price stability.59 (Sec. 61)
imprisonment of not less than 5 years but not
more than 10 years. In case the RPC provides Whenever abnormal movements in the
for a greater penalty, then that penalty shall be monetary aggregates, in credit, or in prices
imposed. (Sec. 50) endanger the stability of the Philippine
economy or important sectors thereof, the MB
4. LIABILITY FOR NOTES AND COINS shall take such remedial measures as are
appropriate and within the powers granted to
Notes and coins issued by the BSP shall be the MB and the BSP under the provisions of this
liabilities of the BSP and may be issued only Act; and submit to the President of the
against, and in amounts not exceeding, the Philippines and the Congress, and make public,
assets of the BSP. Said notes and coins shall a detailed report which shall include, as a
be a first and paramount lien on all assets of
the BSP. 58
This topic on Legal Tender was asked in 2000.
The BSP's holdings of its own notes and 59
For purposes of this article and of this Act, the MB
coins shall not be considered as part of its shall formulate definitions of monetary aggregates, credit and
currency issue and, accordingly, shall not form prices and shall make public such definitions and any changes
thereof. (Sec. 62)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 312 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

minimum, a description and analysis of: (1) the 2. assets in foreign currencies in the form of:
causes of the rise or fall of the monetary documents and instruments customarily
aggregates, of credit or of prices; (2) the employed for the international transfer of
extent to which the changes in the monetary funds;
aggregates, in credit, or in prices have been 3. demand and time deposits in central banks,
reflected in changes in the level of domestic treasuries and commercial banks abroad;
output, employment, wages and economic foreign government securities; and foreign
activity in general, and the nature and notes and coins. (Sec. 66)
significance of any such changes; and (3) the
measures which the MB has taken and the The MB shall endeavor to hold the foreign
other monetary, fiscal or administrative exchange resources of the BSP in freely
measures which it recommends to be adopted. convertible currencies; moreover, the Board
shall give particular consideration to the
Whenever the monetary aggregates, or the prospects of continued strength and
level of credit, increases or decreases by more convertibility of the currencies in which the
than 15%, or the cost of living index increases reserve is maintained, as well as to the
by more than 10%, in relation to the level anticipated demands for such currencies. The
existing at the end of the corresponding month MB shall issue regulations determining the
of the preceding year, or even though any of other qualifications which foreign exchange
these quantitative guidelines have not been assets must meet in order to be included in the
reached when in its judgment the international reserves of the BSP. The BSP shall
circumstances so warrant, the MB shall submit be free to convert any of the assets in its
the reports mentioned in this section, and shall international reserves into other assets as
state therein whether, in the opinion of the described in subsecs (a) and (b) of Sec. 66.
Board, said changes in the monetary (Sec. 66)
aggregates, credit or cost of living represent a
threat to the stability of the Philippine economy Whenever the international reserve of the BSP
or of important sectors thereof. falls to a level which the MB considers
inadequate to meet prospective net demands
The MB shall continue to submit periodic on the BSP for foreign currencies, or whenever
reports to the President of the Philippines and the international reserve appears to be in
to Congress until it considers that the imminent danger of falling to such a level, or
monetary, credit or price disturbances have whenever the international reserve is falling as
disappeared or have been adequately a result of payments or remittances abroad
controlled. (Sec. 63) which, in the opinion of the MB, are contrary to
the national welfare, the MB shall:

2. INTERNATIONAL MONETARY 1. take such remedial measures as are


STABILIZATION appropriate and within the powers granted
to the MB and the BSP under the provisions
The BSP shall exercise its powers under this Act of this Act; and
2. submit to the President of the Philippines
to preserve the international value of the peso
and to Congress a detailed report which
and to maintain its convertibility into other
shall include, as a minimum, a description
freely convertible currencies primarily for,
and analysis of:
although not necessarily limited to, current
a. the nature and causes of the
payments for foreign trade and invisibles. (Sec.
existing or imminent decline;
64)
b. the remedial measures already
taken or to be taken by the MB;
In order to maintain the international stability
c. the monetary, fiscal or
and convertibility of the Philippine peso, the
administrative measures further
BSP shall maintain international reserves
proposed; and
adequate to meet any foreseeable net demands
d. the character and extent of the
on the BSP for foreign currencies. In judging
cooperation required from other
the adequacy of the international reserves, the
government agencies for the
MB shall be guided by the prospective receipts
successful execution of the policies
and payments of foreign exchange by the
of the MB.
Philippines. The Board shall give special
attention to the volume and maturity of the
If the resultant actions fail to check the
BSP's own liabilities in foreign currencies, to
deterioration of the reserve position of the BSP,
the volume and maturity of the foreign
or if the deterioration cannot be checked
exchange assets and liabilities of other banks
except by chronic restrictions on exchange and
operating in the Philippines and, insofar as they
trade transactions or by sacrifice of the
are known or can be estimated, the volume
domestic objectives of a balanced and
and maturity of the foreign exchange assets
sustainable growth of the economy, the MB
and liabilities of all other persons and entities in
shall propose to the President, with appropriate
the Philippines. (Sec. 65)
notice of the Congress, such additional action
as it deems necessary to restore equilibrium in
The international reserves of the BSP may
the international balance of payments of the
include but shall not be limited to the following Philippines. The MB shall submit periodic
assets: reports to the President and to Congress until
1. gold; and the threat to the international monetary

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 313 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

stability of the Philippines has disappeared. with the provisions of Section 74 of this Act. 60
(Sec. 67) (Sec. 70)

The BSP shall endeavor to maintain at all times


3. INSTRUMENTS OF BSP ACTION a net positive foreign asset position so that its
gross foreign exchange assets will always
In order to achieve the primary objective of price exceed its gross foreign liabilities. In the event
stability, the MB shall rely on its moral influence that the equivalent amount in pesos of the
and the powers granted to it under this Act for the foreign exchange liabilities of the BSP exceed
management of monetary aggregates. (Sec. 68) twice the equivalent amount in pesos of the
foreign exchange assets of the bank, the BSP
shall, within 60 days from the date the limit is
1. Purchases in Gold exceeded, submit a report to the Congress
stating the origin of these liabilities, and the
The BSP may buy and sell gold in any form, subject manner in which they will be paid. (Sec. 71)
to such regulations as the MB may issue. The
purchases and sales of gold authorized by this The BSP shall avoid the acquisition and holding
section shall be made in the national currency at of currencies which are not freely convertible,
the prevailing international market price as and may acquire such currencies in an amount
determined by the MB. (Sec. 69) exceeding the minimum balance necessary to
cover current demands for said currencies only
when, and to the extent that, such acquisition
2. Purchases in Gold and Foreign Exchange is considered by the MB to be in the national
interest. The MB shall determine the
The BSP may buy and sell foreign notes and coins, procedures which shall apply to the acquisition
and documents and instruments of types and disposition by the BSP of foreign exchange
customarily employed for the international transfer which is not freely utilizable in the international
of funds. The BSP may engage in future exchange market. (Sec. 73)
operations. The BSP may engage in foreign
exchange transactions with the following entities or
persons only: 3. Emergency Restrictions on Exchange
Operations
1. banking institutions
operating in the Philippines; In order to achieve the primary objective of the
2. the Government, its BSP as set forth in Sec. 3 of this Act, or protect
political subdivisions & the international reserves of the BSP in the
instrumentalities; imminence of, or during an exchange crisis, or
3. foreign or international in time of national emergency and to give the
financial institutions; MB and the Government time in which to take
4. foreign governments and constructive measures to forestall, combat, or
their instrumentalities; and overcome such a crisis or emergency, the MB,
5. other entities or persons with the concurrence of at least 5 of its
which the MB is hereby empowered to members and with the approval of the
authorize as foreign exchange dealers, President of the Philippines, may temporarily
subject to such rules and regulations as suspend or restrict sales of exchange by the
the MB shall prescribe. (Sec. 70) BSP, and may subject all transactions in gold
and foreign exchange to license by the BSP,
In order to maintain the convertibility of the and may require that any foreign exchange
peso, the BSP may, at the request of any thereafter obtained by any person residing or
banking institution operating in the Philippines, entity operating in the Philippines be delivered
buy any quantity of foreign exchange offered, to the BSP or to any bank or agent designated
and sell any quantity of foreign exchange by the BSP for the purpose, at the effective
demanded, by such institution, provided that exchange rate or rates: Provided, however,
the foreign currencies so offered or demanded That foreign currency deposits made under RA
are freely convertible into gold or United States 6426 (FCDU Law) shall be exempt from these
dollars. This requirement shall not apply to requirements. (Sec. 72)
demands for foreign notes and coins. (Sec. 70)
4. Operations with Foreign Entities
The BSP shall effect its exchange transactions
between foreign currencies and the Philippine
peso at the rates determined in accordance
60
Sec 74. Exchange Rates. The MB shall determine
the exchange rate policy of the country.
The MB shall determine the rates at which the BSP shall
buy and sell spot exchange, and shall establish deviation
limits from the effective exchange rate or rates as it may
deem proper. The BSP shall not collect any additional
commissions or charges of any sort, other than actual
telegraphic or cable costs incurred by it.
The MB shall similarly determine the rates for other
types of foreign exchange transactions by the BSP, including
purchases and sales of foreign notes and coins, but the
margins between the effective exchange rates and the rates
thus established may not exceed the corresponding margins
for spot exchange transactions by more than the additional
costs or expenses involved in each type of transactions.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 314 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

The MB may authorize the BSP to grant the provisions of the preceding section. (Sec.
loans to and receive loans from foreign 79)
banks and other foreign or international
entities, both public and private, and may The banks shall report to the BSP the
engage in such other operations with these volume and composition of their purchases and
entities as are in the national interest and sales of gold and foreign exchange each day,
are appropriate to its character as a central and must furnish such additional information as
bank. The BSP may also act as agent or the BSP may request with reference to the
correspondent for such entities. Upon movements in their accounts in foreign
authority of the MB, the BSP may pledge currencies. The MB may also require other
any gold or other assets which it possesses persons and entities to report to it currently all
as security against loans which it receives transactions or operations in gold, in any shape
from foreign or international entities. (Sec. or form, and in foreign exchange whether
75) entered into or undertaken by them directly or
through agents, or to submit such data as may
4. REGULATION OF FOREIGN EXCHANGE be required on operations or activities giving
OPERATIONS OF THE BANKS rise to or in connection with or relating to a
gold or foreign exchange transaction. The MB
In order that the BSP may at all times shall prescribe the forms on which such
have foreign exchange resources sufficient to declarations must be made. The accuracy of
enable it to maintain the international stability the declarations may be verified by the BSP by
and convertibility of the peso, or in order to whatever inspection it may deem necessary.
promote the domestic investment of bank (Sec. 80)
resources, the MB may require the banks to sell
to the BSP or to other banks all or part of their 5. LOANS TO BANKING AND OTHER
surplus holdings of foreign exchange. Such FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS
transfers may be required for all foreign
currencies or for only certain of such
currencies, according to the decision of the MB. Guiding Principles. The rediscounts, discounts,
The transfers shall be made at the rates loans and advances which the BSP is
established under the provisions of Sec. 74 of authorized to extend to banking institutions
this Act. (Sec. 76) under the provisions of the present article of
this Act shall be used to influence the volume
The MB may, whenever warranted, of credit consistent with the objective of price
determine the net assets and net liabilities of stability. (Sec. 81)
banks and shall, in making such a
determination, take into account the bank's 1. Normal Credit Operations
networth, outstanding liabilities, actual and
contingent, or such other financial or
performance ratios as may be appropriate Authorized Types of Operations.
under the circumstances. Any such Subject to the principle stated in the preceding
determination of net assets and net liabilities section of this Act, the BSP may normally and
shall be applied in all banks uniformly and regularly carry on the following credit
without discrimination. (Sec. 76) operations with banking institutions operating
in the Philippines:
The MB may require the banks to
1. Commercial credits. The BSP
maintain a balanced position between their
may rediscount, discount, buy and
assets and liabilities in Philippine pesos or in
sell bills, acceptances, promissory
any other currency or currencies in which they
notes and other credit instruments
operate. The banks shall be granted a
with maturities of not more than
reasonable period of time in which to adjust
180 days from the date of their
their currency positions to any such
rediscount, discount or acquisition
requirement. (Sec. 77)61
by the BSP and resulting from
transactions related to:
In order to restrain the banks from
taking speculative positions with respect to
the importation, exportation,
future fluctuations in foreign exchange rates,
purchase or sale of readily
the MB may issue such regulations governing
saleable goods and products, or
bank purchases and sales of non-spot
their transportation within the
exchange as it may consider necessary for said
Philippines;
purpose. (Sec. 78)
the storing of non-perishable
The banks shall bear the risks of non- goods & products w/c are duly
insured & deposited, under
compliance with the terms of the foreign
conditions assuring their
exchange documents and instruments which
preservation, in authorized
they buy and sell, and shall also bear any other
bonded warehouses or in other
typically commercial or banking risks, including
places approved by the MB.
exchange risks not assumed by the BSP under
2. Production credits. The BSP may
61 rediscount, discount, buy and sell
The powers granted under this section shall be
bills, acceptances, promissory notes
exercised only when special circumstances make such action
necessary, in the opinion of the MB, and shall be applied to all and other credit instruments having
banks alike and without discrimination. (Sec. 77) maturities of not more than 360

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 315 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

days from the date of their municipal governments, or by


rediscount, discount or acquisition any Philippine Government
by the BSP and resulting from instrumentality, and having
transactions related to the maturities of not more than 10
production or processing of years from the date of advance.
agricultural, animal, mineral, or
industrial products. Documents or Advances made against the
instruments acquired in accordance collateral named in clauses (6) and
with this subsection shall be (7) may not exceed 80% of the
secured by a pledge of the current market value of the
respective crops or products: collateral.
Provided, however, That the crops
or products need not be pledged to The rediscounts, discounts, loans
secure the documents if the original and advances made in accordance
loan granted by the BSP is secured with the provisions of this section
by a lien or mortgage on real estate may not be renewed or extended
property 70% of the appraised unless extraordinary circumstances
value of which equals or exceeds fully justify such renewal or
the amount of the loan granted. extension. (Sec. 82)

3. Other credits. Special credit 2. Special Credit Operation


instruments not otherwise
rediscountable under the The BSP may extend loans and advances to
immediately preceding subsections banking institutions for a period of not more than 7
(a) and (b) may be eligible for days without any collateral for the purpose of
rediscounting in accordance with providing liquidity to the banking system in times
rules and regulations which the BSP of need. (Sec. 83)
shall prescribe. Whenever
necessary, the BSP shall provide
funds from non-inflationary 3. Emergency Credit Operation
sources: Provided, however, That
the MB shall prescribe additional In periods of national and/or local emergency
safeguards for disbursing these
or of imminent financial panic which directly
funds.
threaten monetary and banking stability, the
MB may, by a vote of at least 5 of its members,
4. Advances. The BSP may grant
authorize the BSP to grant extraordinary loans
advances against the following
or advances to banking institutions secured by
kinds of collaterals for fixed periods
assets as defined hereunder: Provided, That
which, with the exception of
while such loans or advances are outstanding,
advances against collateral named
the debtor institution shall not, except upon
in clause (4) of the present
prior authorization by the MB, expand the total
subsection, shall not exceed 180
volume of its loans or investments.62
days:
The MB may, at its discretion, likewise
a. gold coins or bullion;
authorize the BSP to grant emergency loans or
b. securities representing
obligations of the BSP or of
62
other domestic institutions of The amount of any emergency loan or advance shall
recognized solvency; not exceed the sum of 50% of total deposits and deposit
c. the credit instruments to which substitutes of the banking institution and shall be disbursed in
2 or more tranches. The amount of the first tranche shall be
reference is made in subsection limited to 25% of the total deposit and deposit substitutes of
(a) of this section; the institution and shall be secured by government securities
d. the credit instruments to which to the extent of their applicable loan values and other
reference is made in subsection unencumbered first class collaterals which the MB may
(b) of this section, for periods approve: Provided, That if as determined by the MB, the
circumstances surrounding the emergency warrant a loan or
which shall not exceed 360 advance greater than the amount provided hereinabove, the
days; amount of the first tranche may exceed 25% of the bank's
e. utilized portions of advances in total deposit and deposit substitutes if the same is adequately
current amount covered by secured by applicable loan values of government securities
and unencumbered first class collaterals approved by the MB,
regular overdraft agreements
and the principal stockholders of the institution furnish an
related to operations included acceptable undertaking to indemnify and hold harmless from
under subsections (a) and (b) suit a conservator whose appointment the MB may find
of this section, and certified as necessary at any time. Prior to the release of the first
to amount and liquidity by the tranche, the banking institution shall submit to the BSP a
resolution of its board of directors authorizing the BSP to
institution soliciting the
evaluate other assets of the banking institution certified by its
advance; external auditor to be good and available for collateral
f. negotiable treasury bills, purposes should the release of the subsequent tranche be
certificates of indebtedness, thereafter applied for. The MB may, by a vote of at least 5 of
notes and other negotiable its members, authorize the release of a subsequent tranche
on condition that the principal stockholders of the institution:
obligations of the Government
(a) furnish an acceptable undertaking to indemnify and hold
maturing within 3 years from harmless from suit a conservator whose appointment the MB
the date of the advance; and may find necessary at any time; and (b) provide acceptable
g. negotiable bonds issued by the security which, in the judgment of the MB, would be adequate
Government of the Philippines, to supplement, where necessary, the assets tendered by the
banking institution to collateralize the subsequent tranche.
by Philippine provincial, city or
(Sec. 84)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 316 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

advances to banking institutions, even during additional conditions which borrowing


normal periods, for the purpose of assisting a institutions must satisfy in order to have
bank in a precarious financial condition or access to the credit of the BSP. These
under serious financial pressures brought by conditions may refer to the rates of interest
unforeseen events, or events which, though charged by the banks, to the purposes for
foreseeable, could not be prevented by the which their loans in general are destined,
bank concerned: Provided, however, That the and to any other clearly definable aspect of
MB has ascertained that the bank is not the credit policy of the bank. (Sec. 88)
insolvent and has the assets defined hereunder
to secure the advances: Provided, further, That The BSP may make direct provisional
a concurrent vote of at least 5 members of the advances with or without interest to the
MB is obtained. National Government to finance
In connection with the exercise of these expenditures authorized in its annual
powers, the prohibitions in Sec. 128 of this Act appropriation: Provided, That said
shall not apply insofar as it refers to acceptance advances shall be repaid before the end of
as collateral of shares and their acquisition as a 3 months extendible by another 3 months
result of foreclosure proceedings, including the as the MB may allow following the date the
exercise of voting rights pertaining to said National Government received such
shares: Provided, however, That should the provisional advances and shall not, in their
BSP acquire any of the shares it has accepted aggregate, exceed 20% of the average
as collateral as a result of foreclosure annual income of the borrower for the last
proceedings, the BSP shall dispose of said 3 preceding fiscal years. (Sec. 89)
shares by public bidding within 1 year from the
date of consolidation of title by the BSP.
Whenever a financial institution incurs an
overdraft in its account with the BSP, the same 6. OPEN MARKET OPERATIONS
shall be eliminated within the period prescribed
in Sec. 102 of this Act. (Sec. 84) Principles. The open market purchases and sales of
securities by the BSP shall be made exclusively in
accordance with its primary objective of achieving
Credit Terms price stability. (Sec. 90)
The BSP shall collect interest and other 1. Purchases and Sales of Government
appropriate charges on all loans and advances Securities
it extends, the closure, receivership or
liquidations of the debtor-institution The BSP may buy and sell in the open market for
notwithstanding. This provision shall apply its own account: (a) evidences of indebtedness
prospectively. (Sec. 85) issued directly by the Government of the
Philippines or by its political subdivisions; and (b)
The MB shall fix the interest and rediscount evidences of indebtedness issued by government
rates to be charged by the BSP on its credit instrumentalities and fully guaranteed by the
operations in accordance with the character Government.
and term of the operation, but after due
consideration has been given to the credit The evidences of indebtedness acquired under the
needs of the market, the composition of the provisions of this section must be freely negotiable
BSP's portfolio, and the general requirements and regularly serviced and must be available to the
of the national monetary policy. Interest and general public through banking institutions and
rediscount rates shall be applied to all banks of local government treasuries in denominations of a
the same category uniformly and without thousand pesos or more. (Sec. 91)
discrimination. (Sec. 85)

The documents rediscounted, discounted,


bought or accepted as collateral by the BSP in 2. Issue and Negotiation of BSP Obligations
the course of the credit operations authorized
in this article shall bear the endorsement of the In order to provide the BSP with effective
institution from which they are received. (Sec. instruments for open market operations, the BSP
86) may issue, place, buy and sell freely negotiable
evidences of indebtedness of the BSP: Provided,
Documents rediscounted, discounted or That issuance of such certificates of indebtedness
accepted as collateral by the BSP must be shall be made only in cases of extraordinary
withdrawn by the borrowing institution on the movement in price levels.
dates of their maturities, or upon liquidation of
the obligations which they represent or to Said evidences of indebtedness may be issued
which they relate whenever said obligations directly against the international reserve of the BSP
have been liquidated prior to their dates of or against the securities which it has acquired or
maturity. Banks shall have the right at any may be issued without relation to specific types of
time to withdraw any documents which they assets of the BSP.
have presented to the BSP as collateral, upon
payment in full of the corresponding debt to The MB shall determine the interest rates,
the BSP, including interest charges. (Sec. 87) maturities and other characteristics of said
obligations of the BSP, and may, if it deems it
The MB may prescribe, within the general advisable, denominate the obligations in gold or
powers granted to it under this Act, foreign currencies.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 317 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

for the borrower's own account, for the purpose of


The evidences of indebtedness of the BSP to which relending or purchasing of receivables and other
this section refers may be acquired by the BSP obligations. These instruments may include, but
before their maturity, either through purchases in need not be limited to, bankers acceptances,
the open market or through redemptions at par promissory notes, participations, certificates of
and by lot if the BSP has reserved the right to assignment and similar instruments with recourse,
make such redemptions. The evidences of and repurchase agreements. The MB shall
indebtedness acquired or redeemed by the BSP determine what specific instruments shall be
shall not be included among its assets, and shall be considered as deposit substitutes for the purposes
immediately retired and cancelled. (Sec. 92) of Section 94 of this Act: Provided, however, That
deposit substitutes of commercial, industrial and
other non-financial companies for the limited
7. BSP PORTFOLIO purpose of financing their own needs or the needs
of their agents or dealers shall not be covered by
VI the provisions of Sec. 94 of this Act. (Sec. 95)
BSP PORTFOLIO
3. Required Reserves

At least once every month the MB shall review Against Peso Deposits. The MB may fix and, when
the portfolio of the BSP in relation to its future it deems necessary, alter the minimum reserve
credit policy. In reviewing the BSP's portfolio, ratios to peso deposits, as well as to deposit
the MB shall especially consider whether a substitutes, which each bank and/or quasi-bank
sufficiently large part of the portfolio consists of may maintain, and such ratio shall be applied
assets with early maturities, in order that a uniformly to all banks of the same category as well
contraction in BSP credit may be effected as to quasi-banks. (Sec. 96)
promptly whenever the national monetary
policy so requires. (Sec. 93) Against Foreign Currency Deposits. The MB is
similarly authorized to prescribe and modify the
minimum reserve ratios applicable to deposits
8. BANK RESERVES denominated in foreign currencies. (Sec. 97)

1. Reserve Requirements Against Unused Balances of Overdraft Lines. In


order to facilitate BSP control over the volume of
In order to control the volume of money created by bank credit, the MB may establish minimum
the credit operations of the banking system, all reserve requirements for unused balances of
banks operating in the Philippines shall be required overdraft lines. The powers of the MB to prescribe
to maintain reserves against their deposit liabilities: and modify reserve requirements against unused
Provided, That the MB may, at its discretion, also balances of overdraft lines shall be the same as its
require all banks and/or quasi-banks to maintain powers with respect to reserve requirements
reserves against funds held in trust and liabilities against demand deposits. (Sec. 98)
for deposit substitutes as defined in this Act.
Increase in Reserve Requirements. Whenever
The required reserves of each bank shall be in the opinion of the MB it becomes necessary
proportional to the volume of its deposit liabilities to increase reserve requirements against
and shall ordinarily take the form of a deposit in existing liabilities, the increase shall be made in
the BSP. Reserve requirements shall be applied to a gradual manner and shall not exceed four
all banks of the same category uniformly and percentage points in any thirty-day period.
without discrimination. Banks and other affected financial institutions
shall be notified reasonably in advance of the
Reserves against deposit substitutes, if imposed, date on which such increase is to become
shall be determined in the same manner as effective. (Sec. 99)
provided for reserve requirements against regular
bank deposits, with respect to the imposition, 4. Computation on Reserves
increase, and computation of reserves.
The reserve position of each bank or quasi-bank
The MB may exempt from reserve requirements shall be calculated daily on the basis of the
deposits and deposit substitutes with remaining amount, at the close of business for the day, of the
maturities of 2 years or more, as well as interbank institution's reserves and the amount of its liability
borrowings. accounts against which reserves are required to be
maintained: Provided, That with reference to
Since the requirement to maintain bank reserves is holidays or non-banking days, the reserve position
imposed primarily to control the volume of money, as calculated at the close of the business day
the BSP shall not pay interest on the reserves immediately preceding such holidays and non-
maintained with it unless the MB decides otherwise banking days shall apply on such days. For the
as warranted by circumstances. (Sec. 94) purpose of computing the reserve position of each
bank or quasi-bank, its principal office in the
Philippines and all its branches and agencies
located therein shall be considered as a single unit.
2. Deposit Substitutes (Sec. 100)

The term "deposit substitutes" is defined as an 5. Reserve Deficiencies


alternative form of obtaining funds from the public,
other than deposits, through the issuance, Whenever the reserve position of any bank or
endorsement, or acceptance of debt instruments quasi-bank, computed in the manner specified in

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 318 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

the preceding section of this Act, is below the Deposits maintained by banks with the BSP as part
required minimum, the bank or quasi-bank shall of their reserve requirements shall be exempt from
pay the BSP 1/10 of 1% per day on the amount of attachment, garnishments, or any other order or
the deficiency or the prevailing ninety-one-day process of any court, government agency or any
treasury bill rate plus three percentage points, other administrative body issued to satisfy the
whichever is higher: Provided, however, That banks claim of a party other than the Government, or its
and quasi-banks shall ordinarily be permitted to political subdivisions or instrumentalities. (Sec.
offset any reserve deficiency occurring on one or 103)
more days of the week with any excess reserves
which they may hold on other days of the same
week and shall be required to pay the penalty only 9. SELECTIVE REGULATION OF BANK
on the average daily deficiency during the week. OPERATIONS
In cases of abuse, the MB may deny any bank or
quasi-bank the privilege of offsetting reserve Guiding Principle. The MB shall use the powers
deficiencies in the aforesaid manner. (Sec. 101) granted to it to ensure that the supply,
availability and cost of money are in accord
If a bank or quasi-bank chronically has a reserve with the needs of the Philippine economy and
deficiency, the MB may limit or prohibit the making that bank credit is not granted for speculative
of new loans or investments by the institution and purposes prejudicial to the national interests.
may require that part or all of the net profits of the Regulations on bank operations shall be applied
institution be assigned to surplus. The MB may to all banks of the same category uniformly and
modify or set aside the reserve deficiency penalties without discrimination. (Sec. 104)
provided in this section, for part or the entire Margin Requirements Against Letters of Credit.
period of a strike or lockout affecting a bank or a The MB may at any time prescribe minimum
quasi-bank as defined in the Labor Code, or of a cash margins for the opening of letters of
national emergency affecting operations of banks credit, and may relate the size of the required
or quasi-banks. The MB may also modify or set margin to the nature of the transaction to be
aside reserved deficiency penalties for financed. (Sec. 105)
rehabilitation program of a bank. (Sec. 101) Required Security Against Bank Loans. In order
to promote liquidity and solvency of the
banking system, the MB may issue such
7. Interbank Settlement regulations as it may deem necessary with
respect to the maximum permissible maturities
The BSP shall establish facilities for interbank of the loans and investments which the banks
clearing under such rules and regulations as the MB may make, and the kind and amount of
may prescribe: Provided, That the BSP may charge security to be required against the various
administrative and other fees for the maintenance types of credit operations of the banks. (Sec.
of such facilities. 106)
Portfolio Ceilings. Whenever the MB considers it
The deposit reserves maintained by the banks in advisable to prevent or check an expansion of
the BSP in accordance with the provisions of bank credit, it may place an upper limit on the
Section 94 of this Act shall serve as basis for the amount of loans and investments which the
clearing of checks and the settlement of interbank banks may hold, or may place a limit on the
balances, subject to such rules and regulations as rate of increase of such assets within specified
the MB may issue with respect to such operations: periods of time. The MB may apply such limits
Provided, That any bank which incurs on to the loans and investments of each bank or to
overdrawing in its deposit account with the BSP specific categories thereof. In no case shall the
shall fully cover said overdraft, including interest MB establish limits which are below the value of
thereon at a rate equivalent to 1/10 of 1% per day the loans or investments of the banks on the
or the prevailing ninety-one-day treasury bill rate date on which they are notified of such
plus three percentage points, whichever is higher, restrictions. The restrictions shall be applied to
not later than the next clearing day: Provided, all banks uniformly and without discrimination.
further, That settlement of clearing balances shall (Sec. 107)
not be effected for any account which continues to Minimum Capital Ratios. The MB may prescribe
be overdrawn for 5 consecutive banking days until minimum ratios which the capital and surplus
such time as the overdrawing is fully covered or of the banks must bear to the volume of their
otherwise converted into an emergency loan or assets, or to specific categories thereof, and
advance pursuant to the provisions of Sec. 84 of may alter said ratios whenever it deems
this Act: Provided, finally, That the appropriate necessary. (Sec. 108)
clearing office shall be officially notified of banks
with overdrawn balances. Banks with existing RELATED PROVISIONS IN RA 8791 (GENERAL
overdrafts with the BSP as of the effectivity of this BANKING ACT OF 2000)
Act shall, within such period as may be prescribed
by the MB, either convert the overdraft into an Except as the MB may otherwise prescribe,
emergency loan or advance with a plan of
loans and other credit accommodations against
payment, or settle such overdrafts, and that, upon
real estate shall not exceed 75% of the
failure to so comply herewith, the BSP shall take
appraised value of the respective real estate
such action against the bank as may be warranted
security, plus 60% of the appraised value of the
under this Act. (Sec. 102)
insured improvements, and such loans may be
made to the owner of the real estate or to his
assignees. (Sec 37)
8. Exemption from Attachment and Other
Purposes

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 319 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Except as the MB may otherwise prescribe, and instrumentalities as well as of


loans and other credit accommodations on government-owned or controlled
security of chattels and intangible properties corporations and, as a general policy, their
such as patents, trademarks, trade names, and cash balances should be deposited with the
copyrights shall not exceed 75% of the BSP, with only minimum working balances
appraised value of the security, an such loans to be held by government-owned banks
and other credit accommodation may be made and such other banks incorporated in the
to the title-holder of the chattels and intangible Philippines as the MB may designate,
properties or his assignees. subject to such rules and regulations as the
Board may prescribe: Provided, That such
The MB may prescribe the maturities, as well banks may hold deposits of the political
as related terms and conditions for various subdivisions and instrumentalities of the
types of bank loans and other credit Government beyond their minimum
accommodations. (Sec 43) working balances whenever such
subdivisions or instrumentalities have
10. COORDINATION OF CREDIT POLICIES BY outstanding loans with said banks. The BSP
GOVERNMENT INSTITUTIONS may pay interest on deposits of the
Government or of its political subdivisions
Coordination of Credit Policies. GOCCs which and instrumentalities, as well as on
perform banking or credit functions shall deposits of banks with the BSP. (Sec. 113)
coordinate their general credit policies with
those of the MB. Toward this end, the MB may,
whenever it deems it expedient, make
suggestions or recommendations to such C. Fiscal Operations
corporations for the more effective coordination
of their policies with those of the BSP. (Sec. The BSP shall open a general cash account
109) for the Treasurer of the Philippines, in
which the liquid funds of the Government
shall be deposited. Transfers of funds from
F. BSPS Functions as Banker and this account to other accounts shall be
made only upon order of the Treasurer of
Financial Advisor of the Govt the Philippines. (Sec. 114)

1. FUNCTION AS BANKER OF THE GOVT D. Other Banks as Agents of the BSP

In the performance of its functions as fiscal


I agent, the BSP may engage the services of
FUNCTION AS BANKER other government-owned and controlled
OF THE GOVT banks and of other domestic banks for
operations in localities at home or abroad
in which the BSP does not have offices or
The BSP shall act as a banker of the agencies adequately equipped to perform
Government, its political subdivisions and said operations: Provided, however, That
instrumentalities. (Sec. 110) for fiscal operations in foreign countries,
the BSP may engage the services of foreign
banking and financial institutions. (Sec.
A. Representing the 115)
Government
E. Remuneration for Services
With the International Monetary Fund
(IMF). The BSP shall represent the The BSP may charge equitable rates,
Government in all dealings, negotiations commissions or fees for services which it
and transactions with the IMF and shall renders to the Government, its political
carry such accounts as may result from subdivisions and instrumentalities. (Sec.
Philippine membership in, or operations 116)
with, the IMF. (Sec. 111)

With Other Financial Institutions. The 2. MARKETING AND STABILIZING SECURITIES


BSP may be authorized by the Government FOR THE ACCOUNT OF THE GOVT
to represent it in dealings, negotiations or
transactions with the International Bank for 1. The Issue and Placing of Government
Reconstruction and Development and with Securities
other foreign or international financial
institutions or agencies. The President Issue of Government Obligations. The issue of
may, however, designate any of his other securities representing obligations of the
financial advisors to jointly represent the Government, its political subdivisions or
Government in such dealings, negotiations instrumentalities, may be made through the BSP,
or transactions. (Sec. 112) which may act as agent of, and for the account of,
the Government or its respective subdivisions or
instrumentality, as the case may be.
B. Official Depositary
Provided:That the BSP shall not guarantee the
The BSP shall be the official depository of placement of said securities, and shall not
the Government, its political subdivisions subscribe to their issue except to replace its

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 320 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

maturing holdings of securities with the same type implications of the contemplated action. Such
as the maturing securities. (Sec. 117) opinions must similarly be requested by all
political subdivisions and instrumentalities of
Methods of Placing Government Securities. The BSP the Government before any credit operation
may place the securities through direct sale to abroad is undertaken by them. The opinion of
financial institutions and the public. The BSP shall the MB shall be based on the gold and foreign
not be a member of any stock exchange or exchange resources and obligations of the
syndicate, but may intervene therein for the sole nation and on the effects of the proposed
purpose of regulating their operations in the operation on the balance of payments and on
placing of government securities. (Sec. 118) monetary aggregates. (Sec. 123)

The Government, or its political subdivisions or Whenever the Government, or any of its
instrumentalities, shall reimburse the BSP for the political subdivisions or instrumentalities,
expenses incurred in the placing of the aforesaid contemplates borrowing within the Philippines,
securities. (Sec. 118) the prior opinion of the MB shall likewise be
requested in order that the Board may render
Servicing and Redemption of the Public Debt. The an opinion on the probable effects of the
servicing and redemption of the public debt shall proposed operation on monetary aggregates,
also be effected through the BSP. (Sec. 119) the price level, and the balance of payments.
(Sec. 123)

2. BSP Support of the Government Securities Representation on the National Economic and
Market Development Authority (NEDA). In order to
assure effective coordination between the
The Securities Stabilization Fund. There shall be economic, financial and fiscal policies of the
established a "Securities Stabilization Fund" (SSF) Government and the monetary, credit and
which shall be administered by the BSP for the exchange policies of the BSP, the Deputy
account of the Government. The operations of the Governor designated by the Governor of the
SSF shall consist of purchases and sales, in the BSP shall be an ex officio member of the NEDA
open market, of bonds and other evidences of Board. (Sec. 124)
indebtedness issued or fully guaranteed by the
Government. The purpose of these operations 4. PRIVILEGES AND PROHIBITIONS
shall be to increase the liquidity and stabilize the
value of said securities in order thereby to promote 1. Privileges
investment in government obligations. The MB shall
use the resources of the SSF to prevent, or 1. Tax Exemptions. The BSP shall be exempt for a
moderate, sharp fluctuations in the quotations of period of 5 years from the approval of this Act
said government obligations, but shall not from all national, provincial, municipal and city
endeavor to alter movements of the market taxes, fees, charges and assessments. This
resulting from basic changes in the pattern or level exemption shall apply to all property of the
of interest rates. (Sec. 120)63 BSP, to the resources, receipts, expenditures,
profits and income of the BSP, as well as to all
Phase-out of Fiscal Agency Functions. Unless contracts, deeds, documents and transactions
circumstances warrant otherwise and approved by related to the conduct of the business of the
the Congress Oversight Committee, the BSP shall, BSP: Provided, however, That said exemptions
within a period of 3 years but in no case longer shall apply only to such taxes, fees, charges
than 5 years from the approval of this Act, phase and assessments for which the BSP itself would
out all fiscal agency functions provided for in otherwise be liable, and shall not apply to
Secs.117-120 and 120 as well as in other pertinent taxes, fees, charges, or assessments payable
provisions of this Act and transfer the same to the by persons or other entities doing business with
Department of Finance. (Sec. 129) the BSP: Provided, further, That foreign loans
and other obligations of the BSP shall be
Profits and Losses of the Fund. The SSF shall retain exempt, both as to principal and interest, from
net profits which it may make on its operations, any and all taxes if the payment of such taxes
regardless of whether said profits arise from capital has been assumed by the BSP. (Sec. 125)
gains or from interest earnings. The SSF shall 2. Exemption from Customs Duties. The
correspondingly bear any net losses which it may importation and exportation by the BSP of
incur. (Sec. 122) notes and coins, and of gold and other metals
and the importation of all equipment needed
for bank note production, minting of coins,
metal refining and other security printing
3. FUNCITON AS FINANCIAL ADVISOR OF THE operations shall be fully exempt from all
GOVT customs duties and consular fees and from all
other taxes, assessments and charges related
Financial Advice on Official Credit Operations. to such importation or exportation. (Sec. 126)
Before undertaking any credit operation 3. Applicability of the Civil Service Law (CSL).
abroad, the Government, through the Appointments in the BSP, except as to those
Secretary of Finance, shall request the opinion, which are policy-determining, primarily
in writing, of the MB on the monetary confidential or highly technical in nature, shall
be made only according to the CSL and
63 regulations: Provided, That no qualification
Resources of the SSF. Subject to Sec. 132 of this Act,
the resources of the SSF shall come from the balance of the
requirements for positions in the BSP shall be
fund as held by the CB under RA 265 as of the effective date imposed other than those set by the MB:
of this Act. (Sec. 121)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 321 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Provided, further, That, the MB or Governor, in


accordance with Secs. 15(c)64 and 17(d)65 of
A. Purpose
this Act, respectively, may without need of
obtaining prior approval from any other
1. To give encouragement to the people to deposit
government agency, appoint personnel in the
their money in banking institutions and to
BSP whose services are deemed necessary in
discourage private hoarding (Sec. 1)
order not to unduly disrupt the operations of
the BSP. Officers and employees of the BSP,
2. So that the peoples money may be properly
including all members of the MB, shall not
utilized by banks in authorized loans to assist in
engage directly or indirectly in partisan
the economic development of the country.
activities or take part in any election except to
(Sec. 1)
vote. (Sec. 127)

2. PROHIBITIONS B. Coverage

All deposits of whatever nature* with banks or


The BSP shall not acquire shares of any kind or
banking institutions in the Phils. are hereby
accept them as collateral, and shall not participate
considered as of an absolutely confidential nature
in the ownership or management of any enterprise,
and may not be examined. (Sec. 2)
either directly or indirectly.
NOTE
The BSP shall not engage in development banking
This includes investments in bonds issued by the
or financing: Provided, however, That outstanding
Philippine Government, its political subdivisions and
loans obtained or extended for development
its instrumentalities. (Sec. 2)
financing shall not be affected by the prohibition of
this section. (Sec. 128)

C. Prohibited Acts

1. No person, government official, bureau or office


may examine, inquire into or look into such
deposits; and

2. No official or employee of any banking


institution may disclosure to any unauthorized
person any information concerning said
deposits (Sec. 3).

III. Law on Secrecy of Bank NOTE


Deposits (RA 1405) RA 1405 does not prohibit attachment or
garnishment of bank accounts. (China Banking
64
Sec. 15. Exercise of Authority. In the exercise of
Corp v. Ortega, 1973, Philippine Commercial and
its authority, the Monetary Board shall: xxx (c) establish a Industrial Bank v. CA, 1991)
human resource management system which shall govern the
selection, hiring, appointment, transfer, promotion, or D. Exceptions (Under RA 1405)66
dismissal of all personnel.
Such system shall aim to establish professionalism and
excellence at all levels of the Bangko Sentral in accordance 1. upon written permission of the depositor, (Sec.
with sound principles of management.
2)
A compensation structure, based on job evaluation
studies and wage surveys and subject to the Board's
approval, shall be instituted as an integral component of the 2. in cases of impeachment, (Sec. 2)
Bangko Sentral's human resource development program:
Provided, That the Monetary Board shall make its own system 3. upon order of a competent court in cases of
conform as closely as possible with the principles provided for
under Republic Act No. 6758: Provided, however, That
compensation and wage structure of employees whose a. bribery,
positions fall under salary grade 19 and below shall be in b. dereliction of duty of public officials, or
accordance with the rates prescribed under Republic Act No. c. where the money deposited or invested is
6758. the subject matter of the litigation. (Sec. 2)
On the recommendation of the Governor, appoint, fix
the remunerations and other emoluments, and remove
personnel of the Bangko Sentral, subject to pertinent civil NOTES
service laws: Provided, That the Monetary Board shall have 1. RA 1405 does not prohibit attachment or
exclusive and final authority to promote, transfer, assign, or garnishment of bank accounts. (China Banking
reassign personnel of the Bangko Sentral and these personnel Corp v. Ortega, 1973, Philippine Commercial
actions are deemed made in the interest of the service and
and Industrial Bank v. CA, 1991)
not disciplinary: Provided, further, That the Monetary Board
may delegate such authority to the Governor under such 2. In a collection suit by an insurance company to
guidelines as it may determine. xxx determine how the defendant has applied the
65
Sec. 17. Powers and Duties of the Governor. The proceeds of a check paid to it, the grant by the
Governor shall be the chief executive officer of the Bangko trial court of examination of the pertinent
Sentral. His powers and duties shall be to: xxx (d) appoint records of the bank was allowed without need
and fix the remunerations and other emoluments of personnel of notice to the depositor himself, pursuant to
below the rank of a department head in accordance with the Sec. 10, Rule 57 of the Rules of Court covering
position and compensation plans approved by the Monetary
Board, as well as to impose disciplinary measures upon examination of party who property is attached
personnel of the Bangko Sentral, subject to the provisions of 66
Sec. 15(c) of this Act: Provided, That removal of personnel Exceptions were asked in 2006, 2005, 2000, 1998,
shall be with the approval of the Monetary Board; xxx 1997, 1995, 1994, 1991, 1990, 1989, 1988, 1983 and
1977.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 322 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

and persons indebted to him or controlling his or the National Internal Revenue Code of
property; delivery of property to officer. (Onate 1997)
v Aborgar, 1994)
3. The exception applies to cases of concealment 3. in the following cases under the Anti-Money
of illegally acquired property in anti-graft Laundering Lact of 2001 (RA 9160):
cases. The inquiry into illegally acquired
property or property NOT "legitimately a. when a banking and other covered
acquired" extends to cases where such institutions are required to report to the
property is concealed by being held by or Anti-Money Laundering Council (AMLC) any
recorded in the name of other persons. This single, series or combination of transations
proposition is made clear by R.A. No. 3019 involving a total amount in excess of P4.0
which quite categorically states that the term, Million (or an equivalent in foreign
"legitimately acquired property of a public currency) within 5 working days from
officer or employee shall not include .. property occurrence thereof, unless the Supervising
unlawfully acquired by the respondent, but its Authority concerned prescribes a longer
ownership is concealed by its being recorded in period not to exceed 19 working days.
the name of, or held by, respondent's spouse, (Sec. 9(c) RA 9160)
ascendants, descendants, relatives or any other
persons." (Banco Filipino vs Purisima ; 1988) b. when the AMLC inquires into or examines
4. It also extends to cases of concealment of any particular deposit or investment upon
illegally acquired property not involving anti- order of any competent court, when it has
graft cases. In the case of Mellon Bank, N.A. v. been established that there is probable
Magsino, 1990, which involved the erroneous cause that deposits or investments involved
wire transfer and of US$ 1 Million instead of the are in any way related to money laundering
intended US$ 1,000, and the resulting illegal offense, except that no court order is
conversion by the recipients, the Supreme required in the following cases:
Court held that an inquiry into the
whereabouts of money illegally acquired i. kidnapping for ransom
extends to whatever is concealed or being held ii. unlawful activities under Sections 4, 5,
or recorded in the name of persons other than 6, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, and 16 of
the one responsible for the illegal acquisition, the Comprehensive Dangersous Drugs
inasmuch as the case is aimed at recovering Act of 2002
the amount converted. iii. hijacking and other violations under TA
6235, and
OTHER EXCEPTIONS iv. destructive arson and murder including
those perpetrated by terrorists against
1. upon order of a competent court in cases of non-combatants and similar targets.
unexplained wealth under RA 3019 or the Anti- (Sec. 11 RA 9160)
Graft and Corrupt Practices Act (PNB v.
Gancayco, 1965; Banco Filipino v. Purisima, c. Bangko Sentrals inquiry into or
1988; Marquez v. Desierto, 2001) examination of deposits or investments
with any bank, when the inquiry or
a. Sec. 8 of RA 3019 provides that bank examination is made in the course of the
deposits shall be taken into consideration Bangko Sentrals periodic or special
in the enforcement of this section, examination of such bank (Sec. 11 RA
notwithstanding any provision of law to the 9160)
contrary.
b. Sec. 8 of RA 3019 is intended to amend 4. In the following cases under the NIRC:
Sec. 2 of RA 1405 by providing an
additional exception to the rule against the a. Inquiry by the Commissioner of Internal
disclosure of bank deposits. Cases of Revenue into the deposits of a decedent for
unexplained wealth are similar to cases of the purpose of determining the gross estate
bribery or dereliction of duty. (PNB v. of such decedent. (Sec. 6(F), NIRC)
Gancayco)
c. In Banco Filipino v. Purisima, 1988, the b. In case a taxpayer offers to compromise his
court went further and stated that the tax liabilities on the ground of financial
provisions of the Anti-Graft Law warrant incapacity, he must waive, in writing the
examination of bank records not only in the secrecy of his bank deposits in favor of the
name of the respondent but also those in Commissioner of Internal Revenue (Sec.
the name of the respondents relatives or in 6(F), NIRC)
the name of other persons.

2. when inquiry is conducted under the authority


of the Commissioner of Internal Revenue into 5. under Sec. 26 of RA 7653 or the New Central
the bank accounts of the following: Bank Act of 1993, when the examination is
conducted pursuant to the required waiver of
a. a decedent in order to determine his gross the secrecy of deposits (of whatever nature in
estate all banks in the Philippines) made by any
b. any taxpayer who has filed an application DOSRI (Director, Officer or Stockholder who,
for compromise of his tax liability, which together with his Related Interest, contracts a
application shall include a written waiver of loan or any form of financial accommodation
his privilege under RA 1405 or under other from:
general or special laws. (Sec. 6(F) RA 8424
a. his bank; or

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 323 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

Tuason. (Morales, The Phil. General


b. from a bank banking Law Annotated, 2nd ed.
2004)
i. which is a subsidiary of a bank holding
company of which both his bank and b. It used to be believed that the RA 1405 did
the lending bank are subsidiaries or not apply to the Ombudsman, on account
ii. in which a controlling proportion of the of his authority under Sec. 15(8) of RA
shares is owned by the same interest 6770 or the Ombudsman Act of 1989 to
that owns a controlling proportion of examine and have access to bank
the shares of his bank, in excess of 5% accounts and records. However, the SC
of the capital and surplus of the bank, (Marquez v. Desierto, 2001) restricted the
or in the maximum amount permitted Ombudsmans power as follows: before
by law, whichever is lower. an in camera inspection may be allowed,
there must be a pending case before a
Any information obtained from an examination court of competent jurisdiction. Further, the
of his deposits shall be held strictly confidential account must be clearly identified, the
and may be used by the examiners only in inspection limited to the subject matter of
connection with their supervisory and the pending case before the court of
examination responsibility or by the Bangko competent jurisdiction. The bank personnel
Sentral in an appropriate legal action it has and the account holder must be notified to
initiated involving the deposit account. be present during the inspection, and such
inspection may cover only the account
6. Disclosure of certain information about bank identified in the pending case. (Morales,
deposits which have been dormant for at least The Phil. General banking Law Annotated,
ten years, to the Treasurer of the Philippine in 2nd ed. 2004)
a sworn statement, a copy of which is posted in
the bank premises. (Sec. 2, Unclaimed c. Further, it is interesting to note that the
Balances Law (Act No. 3926, as amended)) Secretary of Justice in his Opinion No. 13
(s. 1987) concluded that the Presidential
[not included in the above enumeration for Commission on Good Government can
reasons that shall be soon be provided] compel banks to disclose or produce bank
records without violating the bank secrecy
a. In 1981, PD 1792 added the following laws. (Morales, The Phil. General banking
grounds when the bank can be compelled Law Annotated, 2nd ed. 2004)
to reveal the amount of a depositor:
d. Moreover, under Sec. 1(d) of RA 6382
i. made in the course of a special or (1990), which created the Davide
general examination of a bank and is Commission that conducted a fact finding
specifically authorized by the Monetary investigation of the failed coup d etat of
Board after being satisfied that there is December 1989, the commission had the
reasonable ground to believe that a power to ask the Monetary board to
bank fraud or serious irregularity has disclose information on and/or grant
been or is being committed and that it authority to examine bank deposits, trust
is necessary to look into the deposit to finds, or banking transactions in the name
establish such fraud or irregularity, or of and/or utilized by a person, natural or
juridical, under investigation by the
ii. made by an independent auditor hired Commission, in any bank or banking
by the bank to conduct its regular audit institution in the Philippines, when the
provided that the examination is for Commission has reasonable ground to
audit purposes only and the results believe that said deposits, trust or
thereof shall be for the exclusive use of investment funds, or banking transactions
the bank. However, Sec. 135 of RA have been used in support of furtherance of
7653 or the New Central Bank Act the objectives of the coup d etat.
reverted RA 1405 to its version prior to (Morales, The Phil. General banking Law
the promulgation of the decree. Annotated, 2nd ed. 2004)

a) Thus Villanueva says that these two E. When May Foreign Currency Deposits
instances as excluded from the
Be Examined/Garnished
enumeration of exceptions to the
secrecy of bank deposits
GENERAL RULE:
(Villanueva, Commercial Law
Review, 2004).
Sec. 8. Secrecy of Foreign Currency Deposits.- All
b) Morales however notes that With
foreign currency deposits authorized under this Act,
the Amendment of the Anti-Money
as amended by PD 1035, as well as foreign
Laudering Act of 2001, exception
currency deposits authorized under PD 1034, are
(1) has been substantially
declared and considered of an absolutely
resurrected. While there is no
confidential nature and, except upon the written
similar development of exception
permission of the depositor, in no instance shall
(2), the exclusion of the Bangko
such foreign currency deposits be examined,
Sentral examiners and independent
inquired or looked into by any person, government
auditors from the coverage of the
official bureau or office whether judicial or
Secrecy of Bank Deposits Law finds
administrative or legislative or any other entity
basis in Opinion No. 243 (s. 1975)
whether public or private: Provided, however, that
of then Secretary of Justice Pedro

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 324 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

said foreign currency deposits shall be exempt from Exception of the Secrecy of Bank
attachment, garnishment, or any other order or
Deposits Act
process of any court, legislative body, government
agency or any administrative body whatsoever
1. POLICY OF THE LAW
EXCEPTIONS:
to protect and preserve the integrity and
1. upon written permission of the depositor (Sec.
8, Foreign Currency Deposit Act ; Intengan vs confidentiality of bank accounts
CA ; 2002) to ensure that the Philippines shall not be used
as a money laundering site for the proceeds of
2. upon order of a competent court in cases of any unlawful activity
violation of the Anti-Money Laundering Act of consistent with its foreign policy, to extend
2001 [as in the case of peso deposits, supra] cooperation in transnational investigations and
prosecutions of persons involved in money
3. during Bangko Sentrals periodic or special laundering activities whenever committed.
examinations [as in the case of peso deposits, (Sec. 2 RA 9160)
supra], and

4. disclosure ot the Treasurer of the Philippines 2. POLICY AGAINST POLITICAL HARASSMENT


when the unclaimed balances law applies
(Morales, The Phil. General banking Law This Act shall not be used for political prosecution
Annotated, 2nd ed. 2004) or harassment or as an instrument to hamper
competition in trade and commerce. No case for
5. In a case where a Filipino child was raped by a money laundering may be filed against and no
foreigner, the SC allowed garnishment of assets shall be frozen, attached or forfeited to the
foreign currency deposits stating : We rule that prejudice of a candidate for an electoral office
the questioned Section 113 of Central Bank during an election period. (Sec. 16)
Circular No. 960 which exempts from
attachment, garnishment, or any other order or
process of any court. Legislative body, 3. COVERED TRANSACTION
government agency or any administrative body
whatsoever, is applicable to a foreign transient, a covered transaction is a transaction in cash or
injustice would result especially to a citizen other equivalent monetary instrument involving a
aggrieved by a foreign guest. (Salvacion vs CB total amount in excess of PhP 500,000.00 within
; 1997) one banking day. (Sec. 3(b))

F. Penalty For Violations


4. SUSPICIOUS TRANSACTIONS
Any violation of this law will subject offender upon
Transactions with covered institutions, regardless
conviction to an imprisonment of not more than 5
of the amounts involved, where any of the
years or a fine of not more than P20,000 or both,
following circumstances exist:
in the discretion of the court. (Sec. 5)
1. there is no underlying legal or trade
obligation, purpose or economic
G. What Else Should I Know About RA justification;
1405?
2. the client is not properly identified;
1. It took effect on April 9, 1955, and is entitled
An act prohibiting disclosure of or inquiry into,
deposits with any banking institution and 3. the amount involved is not commensurate
providing the penalty therefore. with the business or financial capacity of
2. Sec. 6 of RA 6426 or The Foreign Currency the client;
Deposit Act provides that the secrecy of
deposits under this act shall be governed in 4. taking into account all known
accordance with the provisions of RA 1405. circumstances, it may be perceived that the
client's transaction is structured in order to
3. SubSec. 55.4 of RA 8791 or the General avoid being the subject of reporting
Banking Law of 1991 provides that in line with requirements under the Act;
RA 1405, no bank shall employ casual or non-
regular personnel or too lengthy probationary 5. any circumstances relating to the
personnel in the conduct of its business transaction which is observed to deviate
involving bank deposits. from the profile of the client and/or the
client's past transactions with the covered
institution;

6. the transactions is in a way related to an


unlawful activity or offense under this Act
that is about to be, is being or has been
ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING ACT committed; or
(RA 9160 as amended by RA
7. any transactions that is similar or
9194) analogous to any of the foregoing. (Sec.
3(b-1))

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 325 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

preserved and safety stored for at least five


years from the dates when they were
5. COVERED INSTITUTIONS closed. (Sec. 9(b))

1. banks, non-banks, quasi-banks, trust entities, 3. Reporting of Covered and Suspicious


and all other institutions and their subsidiaries Transactions
and affiliates supervised or regulated by the
BSP; report to the Anti-Money Laundering
Council (AMLC) all covered transactions and
2. insurance companies and all other institutions suspicious transactions within 5 working
supervised or regulated by the Insurance days from occurrences thereof, unless the
Commission; and Supervising Authority prescribes a longer
period not exceeding 10 working days.
3. the following entities supervised or regulated when reporting covered or suspicious
by SEC: transactions, covered institutions and their
officers and employees shall not be deemed
a. securities dealers, brokers, salesmen, to have violated the Secrecy of Bank
investment houses and other similar Deposits Act (RA 1405), the Foreign
entities managing securities or rendering Currency Deposits Act (RA 6426) and the
services as investment agent, advisor, or General Banking Law of 2000 (RA 8791)
consultant, and other similar laws, but they are
b. mutual funds, close and investment prohibited from communicating, directly or
companies, common trust funds, pre-need indirectly, in any manner or by an means,
companies and other similar entities, to any person, the fact that a covered or
c. foreign exchange corporations, money suspicious transaction report was made,
changers, money payment, remittance, and the contents thereof, or any other
transfer companies and other similar information in relation thereto. In case of
entities, and violation thereof, the concerned officer and
d. other entities administering or otherwise employee of the covered institution shall be
dealing in currency, commodities or criminally liable. However, no
financial derivatives based thereon, administrative, criminal or civil
valuable objects, cash substitutes and proceedings, shall lie against any person
other similar monetary instruments or for having made a covered or suspicious
property (Sec. 3(a)) transaction report in the regular
performance of his duties in good faith,
whether or not such reporting results in
6. OBLIGATIONS OF COVERED any criminal prosecution under this Act of
67
INSTITUTIONS any other law.

1. Customer Identification when reporting covered or suspicious


transactions to the AMLC, covered
establish and record the true identity of its instituting and their officers and employees
clients based on official documents. are prohibited from communicating directly
maintain a system of verifying the true or indirectly, in any manner or by any
identity of their clients means, to any person or entity, the media,
in the case of corporate clients, require a the fact that a covered or suspicious
system of verifying their legal existence transaction report was made, the contents
and organizational structure, as well as the thereof, or any other information in relation
authority and identification of all persons thereto. Neither may such reporting be
purporting to act on their behalf. published or aired in any manner or form
anonymous accounts, accounts under by the mass media, electronic mail, or
fictitious names, and all other similar other similar devices. In case of violation
accounts shall be absolutely prohibited. thereof, the concerned officer and
exception: peso and foreign currency employee of the covered institution and
non-checking numbered accounts shall media shall be held criminally liable. (Sec.
be allowed; but the BSP may conduct 9(c))
annual testing solely limited to the
determination of the existence and true
identity of the owners of such 7. WHEN IS MONEY LAUNDERING
68
accounts. (Sec. 9(a)) COMMITTED?

Money laundering is a crime whereby the proceeds


2. Record Keeping of an unlawful activity are transacted, thereby
making them appear to have originated from
all records of all transactions of covered legitimate sources. It is committed by the
institutions shall be maintained and safely following:
stored for five years from the date of
transactions. 1. transacting or attempting to transacts with
with respect to closed accounts, the records monetary instrument or property, knowing
on customer identification, account files
and business correspondence, shall be 68
This topic was asked in 2007 and 2006. Note the
predicate crimes to money laundering and that prior
67
This topic was asked in 2006. conviction for the predicate crimes is necessary.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 326 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

such to represent, involve, or relate to the Notwithstanding the provisions of the


proceeds of any unlawful activity; Secrecy of Bank Deposits Act (RA
2. facilitating the offense of money laundering 1405), the Foreign Currency Deposits
referred to in (1) by knowingly performing Act (RA 6426) and the General Banking
or failing to perform any act; or Law of 2000 (RA 8791) and other laws,
3. knowingly failing to disclose and file a the AMLC may inquire into or examine
report with the AMLC of any monetary any particular deposit or investment
instrument or property as required. (Sec. with any banking institution or non-
4) bank financial institution.
This inquiry must be upon order of any
competent court in cases of violation of
8. UNLAWFUL ACTIVITIES the Anti-Money Laundering Act, when it
has been established that there is
Unlawful activity refers to any act or omission or probable cause that the deposits or
series or combination thereof involving or having investments are related to an unlawful
direct relation to following: activity or a money laundering
offense, except that no court order
1. Kidnapping for ransom (Art 267 RPC) shall be required in the following
2. Drug Trafficking (Sections. 4-6, 8-10, 12- unlawful activities:
16 Comprehensive Dangerous Act of 1. Kidnapping for ransom
2002); 2. Drug Trafficking;
3. Graft and Corrupt Practices (Sec. 3 par B, 3. Hijacking; destructive arson and
C, E, G, H, I of the Anti-Graft and Corrupt murder, including those
Practices Act); perpetrated by terrorists against
4. Plunder (RA 7080); non-combatant persons and similar
5. Robbery and extortion (Articles 294-96, targets;
299-302 RPC);
6. Jueteng and Masiao (PD 1602); 2. Examination by the BSP
7. Piracy on the high seas (RPC and PD 532);
8. Qualified theft (Art. 310 RPC); To ensure compliance with this Act, the
9. Swindling (Art. 315 RPC); Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas (BSP) may
10. Smuggling (RA 455 and 1937); inquire into or examine any deposit of
11. Violations of the E-Commerce Act of 2000; investment with any banking institution
12. Hijacking (RA 6235); destructive arson and or non-bank financial institution when
murder, including those perpetrated by the examination is made in the course
terrorists against non-combatant persons of a periodic or special examination, in
and similar targets (RPC); accordance with the rules of
13. Fraudulent practices and other violations examination of the BSP. (Sec. 11)
under Securities Regulation Code of 2000;
14. Felonies or offenses of a similar nature that
are punishable under the penal laws of 11. FORFEITURE PROVISIONS
other countries."(Sec. 3(i))
1. Civil Forfeiture

NOTE When there is a covered transaction


Any person may be charged with and convicted report made, and the court has, in a
of both the offense of money laundering and petition filed for the purpose ordered
the unlawful activity. Any proceeding relating seizure of any monetary instrument or
to the unlawful activity shall be given property, in whole or in part, directly or
precedence over the prosecution of any offense indirectly, related to said report, the
or violation under RA 9160, as amended, Revised Rules of Court on civil
without prejudice to freezing and other forfeiture shall apply.
remedies provided RA 9160. (Sec. 6)
2. Claim on Forfeited Assets

9. FREEZING OF MONETARY INSTRUMENT OF Where the court has issued an order of


PROPERTY forfeiture of the monetary instrument
or property in a criminal prosecution for
The Court of Appeals may issue a freeze order any money laundering offense, the
which shall be effective immediately offender or any other person claiming
1. upon application ex parte by the AMLC and an interest therein may apply, by
2. after determination that probable cause verified petition,
exists that any monetary instrument or for a declaration that the same
property is in any way related to an legitimately belongs to him and
unlawful activity, for segregation or exclusion of the
The freeze order shall be for a period of twenty
monetary instrument or property
days unless extended by the court. (Sec. 10) corresponding thereto.
The verified petition shall be filed with
the court which rendered the judgment
10. EXAMINATION OF ACCOUNTS of conviction and order of forfeiture,
within fifteen days from the date of the
order or forfeiture, in default of which
1. Examination by the AMLC the said order shall become final and

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 327 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

executory. This provision shall apply in the Council, on the basis of substantial
both civil and criminal forfeiture. evidence, to be, in whole or in part,
wherever located, representing, involving,
3. Payment in Lieu of Forfeiture or related to directly or indirectly, in any
manner or by any means, the proceeds of
Where the court has issued an order of an unlawful activity.
forfeiture of the monetary instrument to institute civil forfeiture proceedings and
or property subject of a money all other remedial proceedings through the
laundering offense, and said order Office of the Solicitor General;
cannot be enforced because any to cause the filing of complaints with the
particular monetary instrument or DOJ or the Ombudsman for the prosecution
property of money laundering offenses;
cannot, with due diligence, be located, to investigate suspicious transactions and
or covered transactions deemed suspicious
has been substantially altered, after an investigation by AMLC, money
destroyed, diminished in value or laundering activities and other violations of
otherwise rendered worthless by any the Anti-Money Laundering Act;
act or omission, directly or indirectly, to apply before the Court of Appeals, ex
attributable to the offender, or parte, for the freezing of any monetary
has been concealed, removed, instrument or property alleged to be the
converted or otherwise transferred to proceeds of any unlawful activity;
prevent the same from being found or to implement such measures as may be
to avoid forfeiture thereof, or necessary and justified under the Anti-
is located outside the Philippines or has Money Laundering Act to counteract money
been placed or brought outside the laundering;
jurisdiction of the court, or to receive and take action in respect of,
has been commingled with other any request from foreign states for
monetary instruments or property assistance in their own anti-money
belonging to either the offender himself laundering operations provided in this Act;
or a third person or entity, thereby to develop educational programs on the
rendering the same difficult to identify pernicious effects of money laundering, the
or be segregated for purposes of methods and techniques used in the money
forfeiture, laundering, the viable means of preventing
the court may, instead of enforcing the money laundering and the effective ways of
order of forfeiture of the monetary prosecuting and punishing offenders;
instrument or property or part thereof to enlist the assistance of any branch,
or interest therein, accordingly order department, bureau, office, agency, or
the convicted offender to pay an instrumentality of the government,
amount equal to the value of said including GOCCs, in undertaking any and all
monetary instrument or property. This anti-money laundering operations, which
provision shall apply in both civil and may include the use of its personnel,
criminal forfeiture. (Sec. 12) facilities and resources for the more
resolute prevention, detection, and
investigation of money laundering offenses
NOTE and prosecution of offenders; and
Restitution for any aggrieved party shall be to impose administrative sanctions for the
governed by the Civil Code. (Sec. 17) violation of laws, rules, regulations, and
orders and resolutions issued pursuant
thereto. (Sec. 7)
12. ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING COUNCIL
(AMLC) Secretariat
The AMLC is also authorized to establish a
Composition: Three Members secretariat to be headed by an Executive
1. Governor of the BSP (chairman), Director who shall be appointed by the
2. Commissioner of the Insurance Commission Council for a term of 5 years.
3. Chairman of the SEC. The Executive Director must be a member
of the Philippine Bar, at least thirty-five
years of age and of good moral character,
Functions unquestionable integrity and known
The AMLC shall shall act unanimously in the probity.
discharge of its functions which are as follows: All members of the Secretariat must have
served for at least 5 years either in the
to require and receive covered or
Insurance Commission, the SEC or the BSP
suspicious transaction reports from covered and shall hold full-time permanent positions
institutions; within the BSP. (Sec. 8)
to issue orders addressed to the
appropriate Supervising Authority or the
covered institutions or to request for
assistance from a foreign State to
determine the true identity of the owner of
any monetary instrument or property
subject of a covered transaction or 13. MUTUAL ASSISTANCE AMONG STATES
suspicious transaction report, believed by

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 328 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

1. Request for Assistance from a Provided, That the court shall not issue
Foreign State. such an order unless the application is
accompanied by an authenticated copy
Where a foreign State makes a request for of the order of a court in the requesting
assistance in the investigation or State ordering the forfeiture of said
prosecution of a money laundering offense, monetary instrument or property of a
the AMLC may execute the request or person who has been convicted of a
refuse to execute the same and inform the money laundering offense in the
foreign State of any valid reason for not requesting State, and a certification of
executing the request or for delaying the an affidavit of a competent officer of
execution thereof. The principles of the requesting State stating that the
mutuality and reciprocity shall, for this conviction and the order of forfeiture
purpose, be at all times recognized. are final and that no further appeal lies
in respect or either.
2. Power of the AMLC to Act on a
Request for Assistance from a Foreign 4. Limitations on Request for
State. Mutual Assistance.

The AMLC may execute a request for The AMLC may refuse to comply with any
assistance from a foreign State by: request for assistance where the action
1) tracking sought by the request contravenes any
down, freezing, restraining and seizing provision of the Constitution or the
assets alleged to be proceeds of any execution of a request is likely to prejudice
unlawful activity under the procedures the national interest of the Philippines
laid down in the Anti-Money Laundering unless there is a treaty between the
Act; Philippines and the requesting State
2) giving relating to the provision of assistance in
information needed by the foreign relation to money laundering offenses.
State within the procedures laid down
in this Act; and 5. Requirements for Requests for
3) applying for Mutual Assistance from Foreign State.
an order of forfeiture of any monetary
instrument or property in the court: A request for mutual assistance from a
Provided, That the court shall not issue foreign State must
such an order unless the application is 1) confirm that
accompanied by an authenticated copy an investigation or prosecution is being
of the order of a court in the requesting conducted in respect of a money
State ordering the forfeiture of said launderer named therein or that he has
monetary instrument or property of a been convicted of any money
person who has been convicted of a laundering offense;
money laundering offense in the 2) state the
requesting State, and a certification of grounds on which any person is being
an affidavit of a competent officer of investigated or prosecuted for money
the requesting State stating that the laundering or the details of his
conviction and the order of forfeiture conviction;
are final and that no further appeal lies 3) gives
in respect or either. sufficient particulars as to the identity
of said person;
3. Obtaining Assistance from 4) give
Foreign States. particulars sufficient to identity any
covered institution believed to have any
The AMLC may make a request to any information, document, material or
foreign State for assistance in: object which may be of assistance to
1) tracking the investigation or prosecution;
down, freezing, restraining and seizing 5) ask from
assets alleged to be proceeds of any the covered institution concerned any
unlawful activity; information, document, material or
2) obtaining object which may be of assistance to
information that it needs relating to any the investigation or prosecution;
covered transaction, money laundering 6) specify the
offense or any other matter directly or manner in which and to whom said
indirectly, related thereto; information, document, material or
3) to the object detained pursuant to said
extent allowed by the law of the request, is to be produced;
Foreign State, applying with the proper 7) give all the
court therein for an order to enter any particulars necessary for the issuance
premises belonging to or in the by the court in the requested State of
possession or control of, any or all of the writs, orders or processes needed
the persons named in said request, by the requesting State; and
and/or search any or all such persons 8) contain
named therein and/or remove any such other information as may assist in
document, material or object named in the execution of the request.
said request:
6. Authentication of Documents.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 329 of 355


BANKING LAW COMMERCIAL LAW

A document is authenticated if the same is


signed or certified by a judge, magistrate
or equivalent officer in or of, the requesting
State, and authenticated by the oath or
affirmation of a witness or sealed with an
official or public seal of a minister,
secretary of State, or officer in or of, the
government of the requesting State, or of
the person administering the government
or a department of the requesting territory,
protectorate or colony. The certificate of
authentication may also be made by a
secretary of the embassy or legation,
consul general, consul, vice consul,
consular agent or any officer in the foreign
service of the Philippines stationed in the
foreign State in which the record is kept,
and authenticated by the seal of his office.

7. Extradition.

The Philippines shall negotiate for the


inclusion of money laundering offenses as
herein defined among extraditable offenses
in all future treaties. (Sec. 13)

13. WHAT ELSE SHOULD I KNOW ABOUT THE


ANTI-MONEY LAUNDERING ACT?

The complete title of the Act is An Act Defining


the Crime of Money Laundering, Providing
Penalties Therfore and for Other Purposes.
The Act was approved by President Macapagal-
Arroyo on Sept. 29, 2001. It was subsequently
amended by RA 9194 which was approved by
the same President on Mar. 7, 2003.
One of the many amendments made by RA
9194 was the deletion of the phrase that
provided that The provisions of this Act shall
not apply to deposits and investments made
prior to its effectivity.
The Act provided the AMLC with an initial
appropriation of Php 25,000,000.
The Act also required the BSP, the Insurance
Commission and the SEC to (1) promulgate
rules and regulations implementing the act,
which would be submitted to a Congressional
Oversight Committee, and (2) to formulate
money laundering prevention programs in
accordance with the Act.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 330 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE Sec. 231. Reverse Reciprocity of Foreign Laws. -


Any condition, restriction, limitation, diminution,
(RA 8293, as amended by RA 9150) requirement, penalty or any similar burden
imposed by the law of a foreign country on a
Philippine national seeking protection of intellectual
Chapter I. property rights in that country, shall reciprocally be
INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS IN enforceable upon nationals of said country, within
GENERAL Philippine jurisdiction.

1. State Policies
Chapter II.
Sec. 2. Declaration of State Policy. - The State PATENTS
recognizes that an effective intellectual and
industrial property system is vital to the
development of domestic and creative activity, 1. What are Patentable
facilitates transfer of technology, attracts foreign
investments, and ensures market access for our 1.1. Inventions
products. It shall protect and secure the exclusive
rights of scientists, inventors, artists and other Sec. 21. Patentable Inventions. - Any technical
gifted citizens to their intellectual property and solution of a problem in any field of human
creations, particularly when beneficial to the activity which is new, involves an inventive
people, for such periods as provided in this Act. step and is industrially applicable shall be
The use of intellectual property bears a social patentable. It may be, or may relate to, a
function. To this end, the State shall promote the product, or process, or an improvement of any
diffusion of knowledge and information for the of the foregoing. (Sec. 7, RA 165a)
promotion of national development and progress
and the common good. Sec. 23. Novelty. - An invention shall not be
It is also the policy of the State to streamline considered new if it forms part of a prior art.
administrative procedures of registering patents, (Sec. 9, RA 165a)
trademarks and copyright, to liberalize the
registration on the transfer of technology, and to Sec. 24. Prior Art. - Prior art shall consist of:
enhance the enforcement of intellectual property
rights in the Philippines. 24.1. Everything which has been made
available to the public anywhere in the
world, before the filing date or the priority
date of the application claiming the
2. Intellectual Property Rights invention; and

Sec. 4.1 The term "intellectual property rights" 24.2. The whole contents of an application
consists of: for a patent, utility model, or industrial
1. Copyright and Related Rights; design registration, published in accordance
2. Trademarks and Service Marks; with this Act, filed or effective in the
3. Geographic Indications; Philippines, with a filing or priority date that
4. Industrial Designs; is earlier than the filing or priority date of
5. Patents; the application: Provided, That the
6. Layout-Designs (Topographies) of application which has validly claimed the
Integrated Circuits; and filing date of an earlier application under
7. Protection of Undisclosed Information Section 31 of this Act, shall be prior art
[TRIPS]. with effect as of the filing date of such
earlier application: Provided further, That
Kho v. CA, et al., 379 SCRA 410 [2002] the applicant or the inventor identified in
both applications are not one and the
Trademark, copyright and patents are different same. (Sec. 9, RA 165a)
intellectual property rights that cannot be
interchanged with one another. A trademark is any Sec. 26. Inventive Step. - An invention
visible sign capable of distinguishing the goods involves an inventive step if, having regard to
(trademark) or services (service mark) of an prior art, it is not obvious to a person skilled in
enterprise and shall include a stamped or marked the art at the time of the filing date or priority
container of goods. date of the application claiming the invention.

In relation thereto, a trade name means the name Sec. 27. Industrial Applicability. - An invention
or designation identifying or distinguishing an that can be produced and used in any industry
enterprise. Meanwhile, the scope of a copyright is shall be industrially applicable.
confined to literary and artistic works which are
original intellectual creations in the literary and 1.2. Utility Model
artistic domain protected from the moment of their
creation. Patentable inventions, on the other hand, Sec. 109.1 (a) An invention qualifies for
refer to any technical solution of a problem in any registration as a utility model if it is new and
field of human activity which is new, involves an industrially applicable.
inventive step and is industrially applicable. (b) Section 21, "Patentable Inventions", shall
apply except the reference to inventive step as
3. Reverse Reciprocity a condition of protection.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 331 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

1.3. Industrial Designs Sec. 29. First to File Rule. - If two (2) or more
persons have made the invention separately
Sec. 112.1 An Industrial Design is any and independently of each other, the right to
composition of lines or colors or any three- the patent shall belong to the person who filed
dimensional form, whether or not associated an application for such invention, or where two
with lines or colors: Provided, That such or more applications are filed for the same
composition or form gives a special appearance invention, to the applicant who has the earliest
to and can serve as pattern for an industrial filing date or, the earliest priority date. (3rd
product or handicraft; Sentence, Sec. 10, RA 165a.)

1.4. Lay-out Designs (Topographies) of 4. Right of Priority


Integrated Circuits
Sec. 31. Right of Priority. - An application for
Sec. 112.2 Integrated Circuit means a patent filed by any person who has previously
product, in its final form, or an intermediate applied for the same invention in another country
form, in which the elements, at least one of which by treaty, convention, or law affords similar
which is an active element and some or all of privileges to Filipino citizens, shall be considered as
the interconnections are integrally formed in filed as of the date of filing the foreign application:
and/or on a piece of material, and which is Provided, That: (a) the local application expressly
intended to perform an electronic function; and claims priority; (b) it is filed within twelve (12)
months from the date the earliest foreign
Sec. 112.3 Layout-Design is synonymous with application was filed; and (c) a certified copy of the
'Topography' and means the three-dimensional foreign application together with an English
disposition, however expressed, of the translation is filed within six (6) months from the
elements, at least one of which is an active date of filing in the Philippines. (Sec. 15, RA 165a)
element, and of some or all of the
interconnections of an integrated circuit, or
such a three-dimensional disposition prepared 5. Contents of the Application for Patent
for an integrated circuit intended for
manufacture. Sec. 32. The Application. -

32.1. The patent application shall be in Filipino


2. Exclusions from Patent Protection
or English and shall contain the following:
(a) A request for the grant of a patent;
Sec. 22. Non-Patentable Inventions. - The (b) A description of the invention;
following shall be excluded from patent (c) Drawings necessary for the
protection: understanding of the invention;
(d) One or more claims; and
22.1. Discoveries, scientific theories and (e) An abstract.
mathematical methods;
22.2. Schemes, rules and methods of 32.2. No patent may be granted unless the
performing mental acts, playing games or application identifies the inventor. If the
doing business, and programs for applicant is not the inventor, the Office may
computers; require him to submit said authority. (Sec. 13,
RA 165a)
22.3 Methods for treatment of the human
or animal body by surgery or therapy and Sec. 34. The Request. - The request shall contain a
diagnostic methods practiced on the human petition for the grant of the patent, the name and
or animal body. This provision shall not other data of the applicant, the inventor and the
apply to products and composition for use agent and the title of the invention.
in any of these methods;
Sec. 35. Disclosure and Description of the
22.4. Plant varieties or animal breeds or Invention. -
essentially biological process for the
production of plants or animals. This 35.1. Disclosure. - The application shall
provision shall not apply to micro- disclose the invention in a manner sufficiently
organisms and non-biological and clear and complete for it to be carried out by a
microbiological processes. person skilled in the art. Where the application
Provisions under this subsection shall concerns a microbiological process or the
not preclude Congress to consider the product thereof and involves the use of a
enactment of a law providing sui micro-organism which cannot be sufficiently
generis protection of plant varieties and disclosed in the application in such a way as to
animal breeds and a system of enable the invention to be carried out by a
community intellectual rights person skilled in the art, and such material is
protection: not available to the public, the application shall
be supplemented by a deposit of such material
22.5. Aesthetic creations; and with an international depository institution.
22.6. Anything which is contrary to public 35.2. Description. - The Regulations shall
order or morality. (Sec. 8, RA 165a) prescribe the contents of the description and
the order of presentation. (Sec. 14, RA 165a)
3. First-To-File Rule
Sec. 36. The Claims. -

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 332 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

36.1. The application shall contain one (1) or final action by the examiner. (Sec. 16, RA
more claims which shall define the matter for 165a)
which protection is sought. Each claim shall be
clear and concise, and shall be supported by 6.2. Classification and Search
the description.
Sec. 43. Classification and Search. - An
36.2. The Regulations shall prescribe the application that has complied with the formal
manner of the presentation of claims. requirement shall be classified and a search
conducted to determine the prior art.
Sec. 37. The Abstract. - The abstract shall consist
of a concise summary of the disclosure of the 6.3. Publication
invention as contained in the description, claims
and drawings in preferably not more than one Sec. 44. Publication of Patent Application. -
hundred fifty (150) words. It must be drafted in a
way which allows the clear understanding of the 44.1. The patent application shall be
technical problem, the gist of the solution of that published in the IPO Gazette together with
problem through the invention, and the principal a search document established by or on
use or uses of the invention. The abstract shall behalf of the Office citing any documents
merely serve for technical information. that reflect prior art, after the expiration of
eighteen (18) months from the filing date
6. Procedure for Grant of Patent or priority date.

6.1. Filing Date 44.3. The Director General, subject to the


approval of the Secretary of Trade and
Sec. 40. Filing Date Requirements. - Industry, may prohibit or restrict the
publication of an application, if in his
40.1. The filing date of a patent application opinion, to do so would be prejudicial to the
shall be the date of receipt by the Office of national security and interests of the
at least the following elements: Republic of the Philippines.

(a) An express or implicit indication 6.4. Inspection


that a Philippine patent is sought;
(b) Information identifying the Sec. 45. Confidentiality Before Publication. - A
applicant; and patent application, which has not yet been
(c) Description of the invention and published, and all related documents, shall not
one (1) or more claims in Filipino be made available for inspection without the
or English. consent of the applicant.

40.2. If any of these elements is not Sec. 44.2. After publication of a patent
submitted within the period set by the application, any interested party may inspect
Regulations, the application shall be the application documents filed with the Office.
considered withdrawn.
Sec. 47. Observation by Third Parties. -
Sec. 41. According a Filing Date. - The Office Following the publication of the patent
shall examine whether the patent application application, any person may present
satisfies the requirements for the grant of date observations in writing concerning the
of filing as provided in Section 40 hereof. If the patentability of the invention. Such
date of filing cannot be accorded, the applicant observations shall be communicated to the
shall be given an opportunity to correct the applicant who may comment on them. The
deficiencies in accordance with the Office shall acknowledge and put such
implementing Regulations. If the application observations and comment in the file of the
does not contain all the elements indicated in application to which it relates.
Section 40, the filing date should be that date
when all the elements are received. If the 6.5. Request for Substantive Examination
deficiencies are not remedied within the
prescribed time limit, the application shall be Sec. 48. Request for Substantive Examination.
considered withdrawn. -
1. Formality Examination
48.1. The application shall be deemed
Sec. 42. Formality Examination. - withdrawn unless within six (6) months
from the date of publication under Section
42.1. After the patent application has been 41, a written request to determine whether
accorded a filing date and the required fees a patent application meets the
have been paid on time in accordance with requirements of Sections 21 to 27 and
the Regulations, the applicant shall comply Sections 32 to 39 and the fees have been
with the formal requirements specified by paid on time.
Section 32 and the Regulations within the
prescribed period, otherwise the application 48.2. Withdrawal of the request for
shall be considered withdrawn. examination shall be irrevocable and shall
not authorize the refund of any fee.
42.2. The Regulations shall determine the
procedure for the re-examination and SEC. 49. Amendment of Application. - An
revival of an application as well as the applicant may amend the patent application
appeal to the Director of Patents from any during examination: Provided, That such

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 333 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

amendment shall not include new matter the patent, and to conclude licensing
outside the scope of the disclosure contained in contracts for the same. (Sec. 37, RA 165a)
the application as filed.
Pearl and Dean, Inc v. Shoemart Inc (2003)
6.6. Grant or Refusal of Application
To be able to effectively and legally preclude others
Sec. 50. Grant of Patent. - from copying and profiting from the invention, a
patent is a primordial requirement. No patent, no
50.1. If the application meets the protection. The ultimate goal of a patent system is
requirements of this Act, the Office shall to bring new designs and technologies into the
grant the patent: Provided, That all the public domain through disclosure. Ideas, once
fees are paid on time. disclosed to the public without the protection of a
50.2. If the required fees for grant and valid patent, are subject to appropriation without
printing are not paid in due time, the significant restraint.
application shall be deemed to be
withdrawn. 8. Term
50.3. A patent shall take effect on the date Sec. 54. Term of Patent. - The term of a patent
of the publication of the grant of the patent shall be twenty (20) years from the filing date of
in the IPO Gazette. (Sec. 18, RA 165a) the application. (Sec. 21, RA 165a)
Sec. 51. Refusal of the Application. - Sec. 109.3. A utility model registration shall
expire, without any possibility of renewal, at the
51.1. The final order of refusal of the end of the seventh year after the date of the filing
examiner to grant the patent shall be of the application.
appealable to the Director in accordance
with this Act. Sec. 118. The Term of Industrial Design or
Layout-Design Registration. - 118.1. The
51.2. The Regulations shall provide for the registration of an industrial design shall be for a
procedure by which an appeal from the period of five (5) years from the filing date of the
order of refusal from the Director shall be application.
undertaken.
118.2. The registration of an industrial design
6.7. Publication of the Grant of Patent may be renewed for not more than two (2)
consecutive periods of five (5) years each, by
Sec. 52. Publication Upon Grant of Patent. - paying the renewal fee. xxx xxx xxx
52.1. The grant of the patent together with 118.5. Registration of a layout-design shall be
other related information shall be published valid for a period often (10) years, without
in the IPO Gazette within the time renewal, and such validity to be counted from
prescribed by the Regulations. the date of commencement of the protection
accorded to the layout-design. The protection
52.2. Any interested party may inspect the of a layout-design under this Act shall
complete description, claims, and drawings commence:
of the patent on file with the Office. (Sec.
18, RA 165a) a) on the date of the first commercial
exploitation, anywhere in the world, of
7. Rights Conferred by Patent the layout-design by or with the
consent of the right holder: Provided,
Sec. 71. Rights Conferred by Patent. - That an application for registration is
filed with the Intellectual Property
71.1. Office within two (2) years from such
A patent shall confer on its owner the following date of first commercial exploitation;
exclusive rights: or
b) on the filing date accorded to the
(a) Where the subject matter of a patent application for the registration of the
is a product, to restrain, prohibit and layout-design if the layout-design has
prevent any unauthorized person or not been previously exploited
entity from making, using, offering for commercially anywhere in the world.
sale, selling or importing that
product; 9. Limitations on Rights of Patentees
(b) Where the subject matter of a patent
is a process, to restrain, prevent or Sec. 72. Limitations of Patent Rights. - The owner
prohibit any unauthorized person or of a patent has no right to prevent third parties
entity from using the process, and from performing, without his authorization, the acts
from manufacturing, dealing in, using, referred to in Section 71 hereof in the following
selling or offering for sale, or circumstances:
importing any product obtained
directly or indirectly from such 72.1. Using a patented product which has been
process. put on the market in the Philippines by the
owner of the product, or with his express
71.2. Patent owners shall also have the consent, insofar as such use is performed after
right to assign, or transfer by succession

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 334 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

that product has been so put on the said 10. Notice Requirement
market;
Sec. 80. Damages; Requirement of Notice. -
72.2. Where the act is done privately and on a Damages cannot be recovered for acts of
non-commercial scale or for a non-commercial infringement committed before the infringer had
purpose: Provided, That it does not significantly known; or had reasonable grounds to know of the
prejudice the economic interests of the owner patent. It is presumed that the infringer had known
of the patent; of the patent if on the patented product, or on the
container or package in which the article is supplied
72.3. Where the act consists of making or to the public, or on the advertising material relating
using exclusively for the purpose of to the patented product or process, are placed the
experiments that relate to the subject matter of words "Philippine Patent" with the number of the
the patented invention; patent. (Sec. 44, RA 165a)
72.4. Where the act consists of the preparation
for individual cases, in a pharmacy or by a 11. Patent Infringement
medical professional, of a medicine in
accordance with a medical prescription or acts 11.1. Civil Action
concerning the medicine so prepared;
Sec. 76. Civil Action for Infringement. -
72.5. Where the invention is used in any ship,
vessel, aircraft, or land vehicle of any other 76.1. The making, using, offering for sale,
country entering the territory of the Philippines selling, or importing a patented product or
temporarily or accidentally: Provided, That such a product obtained directly or indirectly
invention is used exclusively for the needs of from a patented process, or the use of a
the ship, vessel, aircraft, or land vehicle and patented process without the authorization
not used for the manufacturing of anything to of the patentee constitutes patent
be sold within the Philippines. (Secs. 38 and infringement.
39, RA 165a)
76.2. Any patentee, or anyone possessing
Sec. 73. Prior User. - any right, title or interest in and to the
patented invention, whose rights have been
73.1. Notwithstanding Section 72 hereof, any infringed, may bring a civil action before a
prior user, who, in good faith was using the court of competent jurisdiction, to recover
invention or has undertaken serious from the infringer such damages sustained
preparations to use the invention in his thereby, plus attorneys fees and other
enterprise or business, before the filing date or expenses of litigation, and to secure an
priority date of the application on which a injunction for the protection of his rights.
patent is granted, shall have the right to
continue the use thereof as envisaged in such 76.3. If the damages are inadequate or
preparations within the territory where the cannot be readily ascertained with
patent produces its effect. reasonable certainty, the court may award
by way of damages a sum equivalent to
73.2. The right of the prior user may only be reasonable royalty.
transferred or assigned together with his
enterprise or business, or with that part of his 76.4. The court may, according to the
enterprise or business in which the use or circumstances of the case, award damages
preparations for use have been made. (Sec. 40, in a sum above the amount found as actual
RA 165a) damages sustained: Provided, That the
award does not exceed three (3) times the
Sec. 74. Use of Invention by Government. - amount of such actual damages.

74.1. A Government agency or third person 76.5. The court may, in its discretion,
authorized by the Government may exploit the order that the infringing goods, materials
invention even without agreement of the patent and implements predominantly used in the
owner where: infringement be disposed of outside the
channels of commerce or destroyed,
(a) the public interest, in particular, without compensation.
national security, nutrition, health or
the development of other sectors, as 76.6. Anyone who actively induces the
determined by the appropriate agency infringement of a patent or provides the
of the government, so requires; or infringer with a component of a patented
(b) A judicial or administrative body has product or of a product produced because
determined that the manner of of a patented process knowing it to be
exploitation, by the owner of the especially adopted for infringing the
patent or his licensee, is anti- patented invention and not suitable for
competitive. substantial non-infringing use shall be
liable as a contributory infringer and shall
74.2. The use by the Government, or third be jointly and severally liable with the
person authorized by the Government shall be infringer. (Sec. 42, RA 165a)
subject, mutatis mutandis, to the conditions set
forth in Sections 95 to 97 and 100 to 102.
(Sec. 41, RA 165a)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 335 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

11.2. Criminal Action or device must perform the same function, or


accomplish the same result by identical or
Sec. 84. Criminal Action for Repetition of substantially identical means and the principle or
Infringement. - If infringement is repeated by mode of operation must be substantially the same.
the infringer or by anyone in connivance with
him after finality of the judgment of the court Creser Precision Systems, Inc. v. CA, et al.,
against the infringer, the offenders shall, 286 SCRA 13 [1998]
without prejudice to the institution of a civil
action for damages, be criminally liable therefor Only the patentee or his successor-in-interest may
and, upon conviction, shall suffer imprisonment file an action for infringement. Moreover, there can
for the period of not less than six (6) months be no infringement of a patent until a patent has
but not more than three (3) years and/or a fine been issued, since whatever right one has to the
of not less than One hundred thousand pesos invention covered by the patent arises alone from
(P100,000) but not more than Three hundred the grant of patent. In short, a person or entity
thousand pesos (P300,000), at the discretion of who has not been granted letter of patent over an
the court. The criminal action herein provided invention and has not acquired any rights or title
shall prescribe in three (3) years from date of thereto either as an assignee or a licensee, has no
the commission of the crime. (Sec. 48, RA cause of action for infringement because the right
165a) to maintain an infringement suit depends upon the
existence of a patent.
Sony Computer v Supergreen, Inc. (2007)
SMITH KLINE BECKMAN CORPORATION v
Supergreen is engaged in reproduction and CA (2003)
distribution of counterfeit PlayStation game
software, consoles and accessories, violative of The doctrine of equivalents provides that an
Sonys intellectual property rights. NBI served infringement also takes place when a device
search warrants on subject premises [Cavite] and appropriates a prior invention by incorporating its
seized a replicating machine and several units of innovative concept and, although with some
counterfeit PlayStation consoles, joy pads, modification and change, performs substantially the
housing, labels and game software. Respondent filed same function in substantially the same way to
Motion to Quash which was granted by RTC achieve substantially the same result The
alleging impropriety of venue/lack of jurisdiction. principle or mode of operation must be the
SC: The alleged acts constitute a transitory or same or substantially the same.
continuing offense under Section 168, IPC [RA The doctrine of equivalents thus requires
8293] in relation to Art. 189(1) RPC on unfair satisfaction of the function-means-and-result test,
competition. Respondents imitation of the general the patentee having the burden to show that all
appearance of petitioners goods was done three components of such equivalency test are
allegedly in Cavite, but sold such in Mandaluyong met.
City, Metro Manila.
14. Voluntary Licensing
12. Tests of infringement
Sec. 85. Voluntary License Contract. - To
Godines v. CA, 226 SCRA 576 [1993] encourage the transfer and dissemination of
technology, prevent or control practices and
Tests have been established to determine conditions that may in particular cases constitute
infringement. These are [a] literal infringement; an abuse of intellectual property rights having an
and [b] the doctrine of equivalents. In using literal adverse effect on competition and trade, all
infringement as a test, resort must be had in the technology transfer arrangements shall comply
first instance to the words of the claim. To with the provisions of this Chapter.
determine whether the particular item falls within
the literal meaning of the patent claims, the court Sec. 88. Mandatory Provisions. - The following
must juxtapose the claims of the patent and the provisions shall be included in voluntary license
accused product within the overall context of the contracts:
claims and specifications, to determine whether
there is exact identity of all material elements. On 88.1. That the laws of the Philippines shall
the other hand, under the doctrine of equivalents, govern the interpretation of the same and in
an infringement also occurs when a device the event of litigation, the venue shall be the
appropriates a prior invention by incorporating its proper court in the place where the licensee
innovative concept and, albeit with some has its principal office;
modification and change, performs substantially the
same function in substantially the same way to 88.2. Continued access to improvements in
achieve substantially the same result. techniques and processes related to the
technology shall be made available during the
13. Patent infringement period of the technology transfer arrangement;

88.3. In the event the technology transfer


Del Rosario v CA (1996) arrangement shall provide for arbitration, the
Procedure of Arbitration of the Arbitration Law
It is elementary that a patent may be infringed of the Philippines or the Arbitration Rules of the
where the essential or substantial features of the United Nations Commission on International
patented invention are taken or appropriated, or Trade Law (UNCITRAL) or the Rules of
the device, machine or other subject matter alleged Conciliation and Arbitration of the International
to infringe is substantially identical with the patent Chamber of Commerce (ICC) shall apply and
invention. In order to infringe a patent, a machine

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 336 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

the venue of arbitration shall be the Philippines


or any neutral country; and 87.13. Those which prevent the licensee from
adapting the imported technology to local
88.4. The Philippine taxes on all payments conditions, or introducing innovation to it, as
relating to the technology transfer arrangement long as it does not impair the quality standards
shall be borne by the licensor. prescribed by the licensor;

Sec. 87. Prohibited Clauses. - Except in cases 87.14. Those which exempt the licensor for
under Section 91, the following provisions shall be liability for non-fulfillment of his responsibilities
deemed prima facie to have an adverse on under the technology transfer arrangement
competition and trade: and/or liability arising from third party suits
brought about by the use of the licensed
87.1. Those which impose upon the licensee product or the licensed technology; and
the obligation to acquire from a specific source
capital goods, intermediate products, raw 87.15. Other clauses with equivalent effects.
materials, and other technologies, or of (Sec. 33-C[2], RA 165a)
permanently employing personnel indicated by
the licensor; 15. Compulsory Licensing
87.2. Those pursuant to which the licensor Sec. 93. Grounds for Compulsory Licensing. - The
reserves the right to fix the sale or resale Director of Legal Affairs may grant a license to
prices of the products manufactured on the exploit a patented invention, even without the
basis of the license; agreement of the patent owner, in favor of any
person who has shown his capability to exploit the
87.3. Those that contain restrictions regarding invention, under any of the following
the volume and structure of production; circumstances:
87.4. Those that prohibit the use of 93.1. National emergency or other
competitive technologies in a non-exclusive circumstances of extreme urgency;
technology transfer agreement;
93.2. Where the public interest, in particular,
87.5. Those that establish a full or partial national security, nutrition, health or the
purchase option in favor of the licensor; development of other vital sectors of the
national economy as determined by the
87.6. Those that obligate the licensee to appropriate agency of the Government, so
transfer for free to the licensor the inventions requires; or
or improvements that may be obtained through
the use of the licensed technology; 93.3. Where a judicial or administrative body
has determined that the manner of exploitation
87.7. Those that require payment of royalties by the owner of the patent or his licensee is
to the owners of patents for patents which are anti-competitive; or
not used;
93.4. In case of public non-commercial use of
87.8. Those that prohibit the licensee to export the patent by the patentee, without satisfactory
the licensed product unless justified for the reason;
protection of the legitimate interest of the
licensor such as exports to countries where 93.5. If the patented invention is not being
exclusive licenses to manufacture and/or worked in the Philippines on a commercial
distribute the licensed product(s) have already scale, although capable of being worked,
been granted; without satisfactory reason: Provided, That the
importation of the patented article shall
87.9. Those which restrict the use of the constitute working or using the patent. (Secs.
technology supplied after the expiration of the 34, 34-A, and 34-B, RA 165a)
technology transfer arrangement, except in
cases of early termination of the technology Sec. 97. Compulsory License Based on
transfer arrangement due to reason(s) Interdependence of Patents. - If the invention
attributable to the licensee; protected by a patent, hereafter referred to as the
"second patent," within the country cannot be
87.10. Those which require payments for worked without infringing another patent, hereafter
patents and other industrial property rights referred to as the "first patent," granted on a prior
after their expiration, termination application or benefiting from an earlier priority, a
arrangement; compulsory license may be granted to the owner of
the second patent to the extent necessary for the
87.11. Those which require that the working of his invention, subject to the following
technology recipient shall not contest the conditions:
validity of any of the patents of the technology
supplier; 97.1. The invention claimed in the second
patent involves an important technical advance
87.12. Those which restrict the research and of considerable economic significance in
development activities of the licensee designed relation to the first patent;
to absorb and adapt the transferred technology
to local conditions or to initiate research and 97.2. The owner of the first patent shall be
development programs in connection with new entitled to a cross-license on reasonable terms
products, processes or equipment;

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 337 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

to use the invention claimed in the second (c) That the patent is contrary to public
patent; order or morality.

97.3. The use authorized in respect of the first 61.2. Where the grounds for cancellation relate
patent shall be non-assignable except with the to some of the claims or parts of the claim,
assignment of the second patent; and cancellation may be effected to such extent
only. (Secs. 28 and 29, RA 165a)
97.4. The terms and conditions of Sections 95,
96 and 98 to 100 of this Act. (Sec. 34-C, RA Sec. 62. Requirement of the Petition. - The petition
165a) for cancellation shall be in writing, verified by the
petitioner or by any person in his behalf who knows
16. Assignment and Transfer of Patent the facts, specify the grounds upon which it is
based, include a statement of the facts to be relied
Sec. 104. Assignment of Inventions. - An upon, and filed with the Office. Copies of printed
assignment may be of the entire right, title or publications or of patents of other countries, and
interest in and to the patent and the invention other supporting documents mentioned in the
covered thereby, or of an undivided share of the petition shall be attached thereto, together with the
entire patent and invention, in which event the translation thereof in English, if not in English
parties become joint owners thereof. An language. (Sec. 30, RA 165)
assignment may be limited to a specified territory.
(Sec. 51, RA 165) Sec. 63. Notice of Hearing. - Upon filing of a
petition for cancellation, the Director of Legal
Sec. 105. Form of Assignment. - The assignment Affairs shall forthwith serve notice of the filing
must be in writing, acknowledged before a notary thereof upon the patentee and all persons having
public or other officer authorized to administer oath grants or licenses, or any other right, title or
or perform notarial acts, and certified under the interest in and to the patent and the invention
hand and official seal of the notary or such other covered thereby, as appears of record in the Office,
officer. (Sec. 52, RA 165) and of notice of the date of hearing thereon on
such persons and the petitioner. Notice of the filing
Sec. 106. Recording. - of the petition shall be published in the IPO
Gazette. (Sec. 31, RA 165a)
106.1. The Office shall record assignments,
licenses and other instruments relating to the Sec. 66. Effect of Cancellation of Patent or Claim. -
transmission of any right, title or interest in The rights conferred by the patent or any specified
and to inventions, and patents or application claim or claims cancelled shall terminate. Notice of
for patents or inventions to which they relate, the cancellation shall be published in the IPO
which are presented in due form to the Office Gazette. Unless restrained by the Director General,
for registration, in books and records kept for the decision or order to cancel by Director of Legal
the purpose. The original documents together Affairs shall be immediately executory even
with a signed duplicate thereof shall be filed, pending appeal. (Sec. 32, RA 165a)
and the contents thereof should be kept
confidential. If the original is not available, an
authenticated copy thereof in duplicate may be Chapter III.
filed. Upon recording, the Office shall retain the
duplicate, return the original or the INDUSTRIAL DESIGNSAND LAY-OUT
authenticated copy to the party who filed the DESIGNS (TOPOGRAPHIES) OF
same and notice of the recording shall be
published in the IPO Gazette.
INTEGRATED CIRCUITS

106.2. Such instruments shall be void as 1. Substantive Conditions for Protection


against any subsequent purchaser or
mortgagee for valuable consideration and
Sec. 113. Substantive Conditions for Protection. -
without notice, unless, it is so recorded in the
113.1. Only industrial designs that are new or
Office, within three (3) months from the date of
ornamental shall benefit from protection under this
said instrument, or prior to the subsequent
Act.
purchase or mortgage. (Sec. 53, RA 165a)
113.2. Industrial designs dictated essentially
17. Cancellation of Patent by technical or functional considerations to
obtain a technical result or those that are
Sec. 61. Cancellation of Patents. - contrary to public order, health or morals shall
not be protected.
61.1. Any interested person may, upon
payment of the required fee, petition to cancel 113.3. Only layout -designs of integrated
the patent or any claim thereof, or parts of the circuits that are original shall benefit from
claim, on any of the following grounds: protection under this Act. A layout-design shall
be considered original if it is the result of its
(a) That what is claimed as the invention is creator's own intellectual effort and is not
not new or patentable; commonplace among creators of layout-designs
(b) That the patent does not disclose the and manufacturers of integrated circuits at the
invention in a manner sufficiently clear time of its creation.
and complete for it to be carried out by
any person skilled in the art; or 113.4. A layout-design consisting of a
combination of elements and interconnections

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 338 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

that are commonplace shall be protected only if 120.1. At any time during the term of the
the combination, taken as a whole, is original. industrial design registration, any person upon
payment of the required fee, may petition the
1.1. Rights Conferred on Registered Owner of Director of Legal Affairs to cancel the industrial
Lay-out Design design on any of the following grounds:

Sec. 119.4. Rights Conferred to the Owner of a (a) If the subject matter of the industrial
Layout-Design Registration. - The owner of a design is not registerable within the
layout-design registration shall enjoy the following terms of Sections 112 and 113;
rights: (b) If the subject matter is not new; or
(c) If the subject matter of the industrial
(1) to reproduce, whether by incorporation in design extends beyond the content of
an integrated circuit or otherwise, the the application as originally filed.
registered layout-design in its entirety or
any part thereof, except the act of 120.2. Where the grounds for cancellation
reproducing any part that does not relate to a part of the industrial design,
comply with the requirement of cancellation may be effected to such extent
originality; and only. The restriction may be effected in the
(2) to sell or otherwise distribute for form of an alteration of the effected features of
commercial purposes the registered the design.
layout design, an article or an integrated
circuit in which the registered layout- 120.3. Grounds for Cancellation of Layout-
design is incorporated. Design of Integrated Circuits.- Any interested
person may petition that the registration of a
Sec. 119.5. Limitations of Layout Rights. - The layout-design be canceled on the ground that:
owner of a layout design has no right to prevent
third parties from reproducing, selling or otherwise (a) the layout-design is not protectable
distributing for commercial purposes the registered under this Act;
layout-design in the following circumstances: (b) the right holder is not entitled to
protection under this Act; or
(1) Reproduction of the registered layout- (c) where the application for registration
design for private purposes or for the of the layout-design, was not filed
sole purpose of evaluation, analysis, within two (2) years from its first
research or teaching; commercial exploitation anywhere in
(3) Where the act is performed in respect of a the world.
layout-design created on the basis of such
analysis or evaluation and which is itself Where the grounds for cancellation are
original in the meaning as provided established with respect only to a part of the
herein; layout-design, only the corresponding part of
(4) Where the act is performed in respect of a the registration shall be canceled.
registered lay-out-design, or in respect of Any canceled layout-design registration or part
an integrated circuit in which such a thereof, shall be regarded as null and void from
layout-design is incorporated, that has the beginning and may be expunged from the
been put on the market by or with the records of the Intellectual Property Office.
consent of the right holder; Reference to all canceled layout-design
(5) In respect of an integrated circuit where registration shall be published in the IPO
the person performing or ordering such Gazette.
an act did not know and had no
reasonable ground to know when
acquiring the integrated circuit or the
article incorporating such an integrated Chapter IV.
circuit, that it incorporated an unlawfully TRADEMARKS
reproduced layout-design: Provided,
however, That after the time that such
person has received sufficient notice that 1. Marks and Names
the layout-design was unlawfully
reproduced, that person may perform any Sec. 121. Definitions. - As used in Part III, the
of the said acts only with respect to the following terms have the following meanings:
stock on hand or ordered before such
time and shall be liable to pay to the right 121.1. "Mark" means any visible sign capable
holder a sum equivalent to at least 5% of of distinguishing the goods (trademark) or
net sales or such other reasonable royalty services (service mark) of an enterprise and
as would be payable under a freely shall include a stamped or marked container of
negotiated license in respect of such goods; (Sec. 38, RA 166a)
layout-design; or
(6) Where the act is performed in respect of 121.2. "Collective mark" means any visible
an identical layout-design which is original sign designated as such in the application for
and has been created independently by a registration and capable of distinguishing the
third party. origin or any other common characteristic,
including the quality of goods or services of
1.2. Grounds for Cancellation of Registration different enterprises which use the sign under
the control of the registered owner of the
Sec. 120. Cancellation of Design Registration. collective mark; (Sec. 40, RA 166a)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 339 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

121.3. "Trade name" means the name or (a) Consists of immoral, deceptive or
designation identifying or distinguishing an scandalous matter, or matter which may
enterprise; (Sec. 38, RA 166a) disparage or falsely suggest a connection
with persons, living or dead, institutions,
1.1. Product name and container not proper beliefs, or national symbols, or bring them
subjects of copyright and patent registration into contempt or disrepute;
(b) Consists of the flag or coat of arms or
Kho v. CA, et al., 379 SCRA 410 [2002] other insignia of the Philippines or any of
its political subdivisions, or of any foreign
The name and container of a beauty cream product nation, or any simulation thereof;
are proper subjects of a trademark inasmuch as (c) Consists of a name, portrait or signature
the same falls squarely within its definition. In identifying a particular living individual
order to be entitled to exclusively use the same in except by his written consent, or the
the sale of the beauty cream product, the user name, signature, or portrait of a deceased
must sufficiently prove that she registered or used President of the Philippines, during the life
it before anybody else did. The petitioners of his widow, if any, except by written
copyright and patent registration of the name and consent of the widow;
container would not guarantee her right to the (d) Is identical with a registered mark
exclusive use of the same for the reason that they belonging to a different proprietor or a
are not appropriate subjects of the said intellectual mark with an earlier filing or priority date,
rights. Consequently, a preliminary injunction order in respect of:
cannot be issued for the reason that the petitioner 1) The same goods or services, or
has not proven that she has a clear right over the 2) Closely related goods or services,
said name and container to the exclusion of others, or
not having proven that she has registered a 3) If it nearly resembles such a mark
trademark thereto or used the same before anyone as to be likely to deceive or cause
did. confusion;
(e) Is identical with, or confusingly similar to,
2. Acquisition of Ownership or constitutes a translation of a mark
which is considered by the competent
Sec. 122. How Marks are Acquired. - The rights in authority of the Philippines to be well-
a mark shall be acquired through registration made known internationally and in the
validly in accordance with the provisions of this Philippines, whether or not it is registered
law. (Sec. 2-A, RA 166a) here, as being already the mark of a
person other than the applicant for
Sec. 165. Trade Names or Business Names. - registration, and used for identical or
similar goods or services: Provided, That
165.1. A name or designation may not be used in determining whether a mark is well-
as a trade name if by its nature or the use to known, account shall be taken of the
which such name or designation may be put, it knowledge of the relevant sector of the
is contrary to public order or morals and if, in public, rather than of the public at large,
particular, it is liable to deceive trade circles or including knowledge in the Philippines
the public as to the nature of the enterprise which has been obtained as a result of the
identified by that name. promotion of the mark;
(f) Is identical with, or confusingly similar to,
165.2. (a) Notwithstanding any laws or or constitutes a translation of a mark
regulations providing for any obligation to considered well-known in accordance with
register trade names, such names shall be the preceding paragraph, which is
protected, even prior to or without registration, registered in the Philippines with respect
against any unlawful act committed by third to goods or services which are not similar
parties. to those with respect to which registration
(b) In particular, any subsequent use of the is applied for: Provided, That use of the
trade name by a third party, whether as a mark in relation to those goods or services
trade name or a mark or collective mark, or would indicate a connection between
any such use of a similar trade name or mark, those goods or services, and the owner of
likely to mislead the public, shall be deemed the registered mark: Provided further,
unlawful. That the interests of the owner of the
registered mark are likely to be damaged
by such use;
3. Use of Mark as a Requirement (g) Is likely to mislead the public, particularly
as to the nature, quality, characteristics or
Sec. 124.2. The applicant or the registrant shall geographical origin of the goods or
file a declaration of actual use of the mark with services;
evidence to that effect, as prescribed by the (h) Consists exclusively of signs that are
Regulations within three (3) years from the filing generic for the goods or services that they
date of the application. Otherwise, the application seek to identify;
shall be refused or the mark shall be removed from (i) Consists exclusively of signs or of
the Register by the Director. indications that have become customary
or usual to designate the goods or
4. Non-Registrable Marks services in everyday language or in bona
fide and established trade practice;
Sec. 123.1. A mark cannot be registered if it: (j) Consists exclusively of signs or of
indications that may serve in trade to
designate the kind, quality, quantity,

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 340 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

intended purpose, value, geographical


origin, time or production of the goods or The totality or holistic test is contrary to the
rendering of the services, or other elementary postulate of the law on trademarks and
characteristics of the goods or services; unfair competition that confusing similarity is to be
(k) Consists of shapes that may be determined on the basis of visual, aural,
necessitated by technical factors or by the connotative comparisons and overall impressions
nature of the goods themselves or factors engendered by the marks in controversy as they
that affect their intrinsic value; are encountered in the marketplace. The totality or
(l) Consists of color alone, unless defined by holistic test only relies on visual comparisons
a given form; or between two trademarks whereas the dominancy
(m) Is contrary to public order or morality. test relies not only on the visual but also on the
aural and connotative comparisons and overall
A mark is valid if it is distinctive and hence not impressions between the two trademarks.
barred from registration under the Trademark
Law. However, once registered, not only the McDonalds Corporation v. L.C. Big Mak
marks validity but also the registrants ownership Burger, Inc., et al., 437 SCRA 10 [2004]
thereof is prima facie presumed.
This Court, xxx, has relied on the dominancy test
5. Tests to Determine Confusing Similarity rather than the holistic test. The dominancy test
considers the dominant features in the competing
Between Marks
marks in determining whether they are confusingly
similar. Under the dominancy test, courts give
5.1. Colorable imitation greater weight to the similarity of the appearance
of the product arising from the adoption of the
Societe des Produits Nestl, S.A. v. CA, 356 dominant features of the registered mark,
SCRA 207 [2001] disregarding minor differences. Courts will
consider more the aural and visual impressions
Colorable imitation denotes such a close or created by the marks in the public mind, giving
ingenious imitation as to be calculated to deceive little weight to factors like prices, quality, sales
ordinary persons, or such a resemblance to the outlets and market segments.
original as to deceive an ordinary purchaser giving
such attention as a purchaser usually gives, as to McDonalds Corp v MACJOY Fastfood Corp
cause him to purchase the one supposing it to be (2007)
the other. In ascertaining whether one mark is
confusingly similar to or is a colorable imitation of Applying the dominancy test to the instant case,
another, no set rules can be deduced. Each case the Court finds that herein petitioners
must be decided on its own merits. The MCDONALDS and respondents MACJOY marks
complexities attendant to an accurate assessment are confusingly similar with each other such that an
of likelihood of confusion require that the entire ordinary purchaser can conclude an association or
panoply of elements constituting the relevant relation between the marks.
factual landscape be comprehensively examined. To begin with, both marks use the corporate M
design logo and the prefixes Mc and/or Mac as
dominant features. The first letter M in both
5.2. Holistic test marks puts emphasis on the prefixes Mc and/or
Mac by the similar way in which they are depicted
Del Monte Corporation, et al. v. CA, 181 SCRA i.e. in an arch-like, capitalized and stylized manner.
410 [1990] For sure, it is the prefix Mc, an abbreviation of
Mac, which visually and aurally catches the
To determine whether a trademark has been attention of the consuming public. Verily, the word
infringed, we must consider the mark as a whole MACJOY attracts attention the same way as did
and not as dissected. If the buyer is deceived, it is McDonalds, MacFries, McSpaghetti, McDo,
attributable to the marks as a totality, not usually Big Mac and the rest of the MCDONALDS marks
to any part of it. The court therefore should be which all use the prefixes Mc and/or Mac.
guided by its first impression, for the buyer acts Besides and most importantly, both trademarks are
quickly and is governed by a casual glance, the used in the sale of fastfood products. Indisputably,
value of which may be dissipated as soon as the the respondents trademark application for the
court assumed to analyze carefully the respective MACJOY & DEVICE trademark covers goods under
features of the mark. Classes 29 and 30 of the International
Classification of Goods, namely, fried chicken,
chicken barbeque, burgers, fries, spaghetti, etc.
5.3. Test of dominancy Likewise, the petitioners trademark registration for
the MCDONALDS marks in the Philippines covers
Asia Brewery v. CA and San Miguel, 224 SCRA goods which are similar if not identical to those
437 [1993] covered by the respondents application.
Infringement is determined by the test of
dominancy rather than by differences or
variations in the details of one trademark and of 6. Well-known Marks
another. Similarity in size, form and color, while
relevant, is not conclusive. If the competing Sec. 123.1. (e) Is identical with, or confusingly
trademark contains the main or essential or similar to, or constitutes a translation of a mark
dominant features of another, and confusion is which is considered by the competent authority of
likely to result, infringement takes place. the Philippines to be well-known internationally and
in the Philippines, whether or not it is registered
Societe Des Produits Nestle, S.A. v. CA (2001) here, as being already the mark of a person other

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 341 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

than the applicant for registration, and used for the name or names of the color or
identical or similar goods or services: Provided, colors claimed and an indication, in
That in determining whether a mark is well-known, respect of each color, of the
account shall be taken of the knowledge of the principal parts of the mark which
relevant sector of the public, rather than of the are in that color;
public at large, including knowledge in the (h) Where the mark is a three-
Philippines which has been obtained as a result of dimensional mark, a statement to
the promotion of the mark; that effect;
(f) Is identical with, or confusingly similar to, or (i) One or more reproductions of the
constitutes a translation of a mark considered well- mark, as prescribed in the
known in accordance with the preceding paragraph, Regulations;
which is registered in the Philippines with respect (j) A transliteration or translation of the
to goods or services which are not similar to those mark or of some parts of the mark,
with respect to which registration is applied for: as prescribed in the Regulations;
Provided, That use of the mark in relation to those (k) The names of the goods or services
goods or services would indicate a connection for which the registration is sought,
between those goods or services, and the owner of grouped according to the classes of
the registered mark: Provided further, That the the Nice Classification, together with
interests of the owner of the registered mark are the number of the class of the said
likely to be damaged by such use; Classification to which each group of
goods or services belongs; and
Sec. 147.2. The exclusive right of the owner of a (l) A signature by, or other self-
well-known mark defined in Subsection 123.1(e) identification of, the applicant or his
which is registered in the Philippines, shall extend representative.
to goods and services which are not similar to
those in respect of which the mark is registered: 124.2. The applicant or the registrant shall
Provided, That use of that mark in relation to those file a declaration of actual use of the mark
goods or services would indicate a connection with evidence to that effect, as prescribed
between those goods or services and the owner of by the Regulations within three (3) years
the registered mark: Provided, further, That the from the filing date of the application.
interests of the owner of the registered mark are Otherwise, the application shall be refused
likely to be damaged by such use. or the mark shall be removed from the
Register by the Director.
7. Registration
124.3. One (1) application may relate to
7.1. Requirements for Registration several goods and/or services, whether
they belong to one (1) class or to several
Sec. 124. Requirements of Application. - classes of the Nice Classification.

124.1. The application for the registra 124.4. If during the examination of the
(a) A request for registration; application, the Office finds factual basis to
tion of the mark shall be in Filipino or in English reasonably doubt the veracity of any
and shall contain the following: indication or element in the application, it
(b) The name and address of the may require the applicant to submit
applicant; sufficient evidence to remove the doubt.
(c) The name of a State of which the (Sec. 5, RA 166a)
applicant is a national or where he
has domicile; and the name of a
State in which the applicant has a 7.2. Priority Right
real and effective industrial or
commercial establishment, if any; Sec. 131. Priority Right. -
(d) Where the applicant is a juridical
entity, the law under which it is 131.1. An application for registration of a mark
organized and existing; filed in the Philippines by a person referred to
(e) The appointment of an agent or in Section 3, and who previously duly filed an
representative, if the applicant is application for registration of the same mark in
not domiciled in the Philippines; one of those countries, shall be considered as
(f) Where the applicant claims the filed as of the day the application was first filed
priority of an earlier application, an in the foreign country.
indication of:
1) The name of the State with 131.2. No registration of a mark in the
whose national office the earlier Philippines by a person described in this section
application was filed or it filed shall be granted until such mark has been
with an office other than a registered in the country of origin of the
national office, the name of applicant.
that office,
2) The date on which the earlier 131.3. Nothing in this section shall entitle the
application was filed, and owner of a registration granted under this
3) Where available, the application section to sue for acts committed prior to the
number of the earlier date on which his mark was registered in this
application; country: Provided, That, notwithstanding the
(g) Where the applicant claims color as foregoing, the owner of a well-known mark as
a distinctive feature of the mark, a defined in Section 123.1(e) of this Act, that is
statement to that effect as well as not registered in the Philippines, may, against

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 342 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

an identical or confusingly similar mark, oppose


its registration, or petition the cancellation of 133.2. Where the Office finds that the
its registration or sue for unfair competition, conditions referred to in Subsection 133.1 are
without prejudice to availing himself of other fulfilled, it shall, upon payment of the
remedies provided for under the law. prescribed fee. Forthwith cause the application,
as filed, to be published in the prescribed
131.4. In like manner and subject to the same manner.
conditions and requirements, the right provided
in this section may be based upon a 133.3. If after the examination, the applicant
subsequent regularly filed application in the is not entitled to registration for any reason,
same foreign country: Provided, That any the Office shall advise the applicant thereof and
foreign application filed prior to such the reasons therefor. The applicant shall have a
subsequent application has been withdrawn, period of four (4) months in which to reply or
abandoned, or otherwise disposed of, without amend his application, which shall then be re-
having been laid open to public inspection and examined. The Regulations shall determine the
without leaving any rights outstanding, and has procedure for the re-examination or revival of
not served, nor thereafter shall serve, as a an application as well as the appeal to the
basis for claiming a right of priority. (Sec. 37, Director of Trademarks from any final action by
RA 166a) the Examiner.

133.4. An abandoned application may be


7.3. Classification of Goods and Services revived as a pending application within three
(3) months from the date of abandonment,
Sec. 144. Classification of Goods and Services. - upon good cause shown and the payment of
the required fee.
144.1. Each registration, and any publication
of the Office which concerns an application or 133.5. The final decision of refusal of the
registration effected by the Office shall indicate Director of Trademarks shall be appealable to
the goods or services by their names, grouped the Director General in accordance with the
according to the classes of the Nice procedure fixed by the Regulations. (Sec. 7, RA
Classification, and each group shall be 166a)
preceded by the number of the class of that
Classification to which that group of goods or Sec. 134. Opposition. - Any person who believes
services belongs, presented in the order of the that he would be damaged by the registration of a
classes of the said Classification. mark may, upon payment of the required fee and
within thirty (30) days after the publication
144.2. Goods or services may not be referred to in Subsection 133.2, file with the Office
considered as being similar or dissimilar to an opposition to the application. Such opposition
each other on the ground that, in any shall be in writing and verified by the oppositor or
registration or publication by the Office, they by any person on his behalf who knows the facts,
appear in different classes of the Nice and shall specify the grounds on which it is based
Classification. (Sec. 6, RA 166a) and include a statement of the facts relied upon.
Copies of certificates of registration of marks
registered in other countries or other supporting
7.4.Registration Procedure documents mentioned in the opposition shall be
filed therewith, together with the translation in
Sec. 132. Application Number and Filing Date. - English, if not in the English language. For good
cause shown and upon payment of the required
132.1. The Office shall examine whether the surcharge, the time for filing an opposition may be
application satisfies the requirements for the extended by the Director of Legal Affairs, who shall
grant of a filing date as provided in Section 127 notify the applicant of such extension. The
and Regulations relating thereto. If the Regulations shall fix the maximum period of time
application does not satisfy the filing within which to file the opposition. (Sec. 8, RA
requirements, the Office shall notify the 165a)
applicant who shall within a period fixed by the
Regulations complete or correct the application Sec. 135. Notice and Hearing. - Upon the filing of
as required, otherwise, the application shall be an opposition, the Office shall serve notice of the
considered withdrawn. filing on the applicant, and of the date of the
hearing thereof upon the applicant and the
132.2. Once an application meets the filing oppositor and all other persons having any right,
requirements of Section 127, it shall be title or interest in the mark covered by the
numbered in the sequential order, and the application, as appear of record in the Office. (Sec.
applicant shall be informed of the application 9 RA 165)
number and the filing date of the application
will be deemed to have been abandoned. Sec. 136. Issuance and Publication of Certificate. -
When the period for filing the opposition has
Sec. 133. Examination and Publication. - expired, or when the Director of Legal Affairs shall
have denied the opposition, the Office upon
133.1. Once the application meets the filing payment of the required fee, shall issue the
requirements of Section 127, the Office shall certificate of registration. Upon issuance of a
examine whether the application meets the certificate of registration, notice thereof making
requirements of Section 124 and the mark as reference to the publication of the application shall
defined in Section 121 is registrable under be published in the IPO Gazette. (Sec. 10, RA 165)
Section 123.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 343 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

Sec. 138. Certificates of Registration. - A 7.6. Rights Conferred by Registration


certificate of registration of a mark shall be prima
facie evidence of the validity of the registration, the Sec. 147. Rights Conferred. -
registrants ownership of the mark, and of the
registrants exclusive right to use the same in 147.1. The owner of a registered mark shall
connection with the goods or services and those have the exclusive right to prevent all third
that are related thereto specified in the certificate. parties not having the owners consent from
(Sec. 20, RA 165) using in the course of trade identical or similar
signs or containers for goods or services which
are identical or similar to those in respect of
7.5. Duration of Registration which the trademark is registered where such
use would result in a likelihood of confusion. In
Sec. 145. Duration.- A certificate of registration case of the use, of an identical sign for identical
shall remain in force for ten (10) years: Provided, goods or services, a likelihood of confusion
That the registrant shall file a declaration of actual shall be presumed.
use and evidence to that effect, or shall show valid
reasons based on the existence of obstacles to such 147.2. The exclusive right of the owner of a
use, as prescribed by the Regulations, within one well-known mark defined in Subsection
(1) year from the fifth anniversary of the date of 123.1(e) which is registered in the Philippines,
the registration of the mark. Otherwise, the mark shall extend to goods and services which are
shall be removed from the Register by the Office. not similar to those in respect of which the
(Sec. 12, RA 166a) mark is registered: Provided, That use of that
mark in relation to those goods or services
Sec. 146. Renewal. - would indicate a connection between those
goods or services and the owner of the
146.1. A certificate of registration may be registered mark: Provided, further, That the
renewed for periods of ten (10) years at its interests of the owner of the registered mark
expiration upon payment of the prescribed fee are likely to be damaged by such use.
and upon filing of a request. The request shall
contain the following indications:
7.7. Protection limited to goods specified in
(a) An indication that renewal is sought; registration certificate
(b) The name and address of the
registrant or his successor-in- Faberge, Inc. v. IAC and Co Beng Kay, 215
interest, hereafter referred to as the SCRA 316 [1992]
"right holder";
(c) The registration number of the The certificate of registration can confer upon the
registration concerned; petitioner the exclusive right to use its own symbol
(d) The filing date of the application only to those goods specified in the certificate,
which resulted in the registration subject to any conditions a limitations stated
concerned to be renewed; therein. One who has adopted and used a
(e) Where the right holder has a trademark on his goods does not prevent the
representative, the name and adoption and use of the same trademark by others
address of that representative; for products which are of a different description.
(f) The names of the recorded goods or
services for which the renewal is 8. Infringement and Remedies
requested or the names of the
recorded goods or services for which Sec. 155. Remedies; Infringement. - Any person
the renewal is not requested, who shall, without the consent of the owner of the
grouped according to the classes of registered mark:
the Nice Classification to which that
group of goods or services belongs 155.1. Use in commerce any reproduction,
and presented in the order of the counterfeit, copy, or colorable imitation of a
classes of the said Classification; and registered mark or the same container or a
(g) A signature by the right holder or his dominant feature thereof in connection with the
representative. sale, offering for sale, distribution, advertising
of any goods or services including other
146.2. Such request shall be in Filipino or English preparatory steps necessary to carry out the
and may be made at any time within six (6) sale of any goods or services on or in
months before the expiration of the period for connection with which such use is likely to
which the registration was issued or renewed, or it cause confusion, or to cause mistake, or to
may be made within six (6) months after such deceive; or
expiration on payment of the additional fee herein
prescribed. 155.2. Reproduce, counterfeit, copy or
colorably imitate a registered mark or a
146.3. If the Office refuses to renew the dominant feature thereof and apply such
registration, it shall notify the registrant of his reproduction, counterfeit, copy or colorable
refusal and the reasons therefor. imitation to labels, signs, prints, packages,
wrappers, receptacles or advertisements
146.4. An applicant for renewal not domiciled in intended to be used in commerce upon or in
the Philippines shall be subject to and comply with connection with the sale, offering for sale,
the requirements of this Act. (Sec. 15, RA 166a) distribution, or advertising of goods or services
on or in connection with which such use is
likely to cause confusion, or to cause mistake,

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 344 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

or to deceive, shall be liable in a civil action for Sec. 170. Penalties. - Independent of the civil and
infringement by the registrant for the remedies administrative sanctions imposed by law, a criminal
hereinafter set forth: Provided, That the penalty of imprisonment from two (2) years to five
infringement takes place at the moment any of (5) years and a fine ranging from Fifty thousand
the acts stated in Subsection pesos (P50,000) to Two hundred thousand pesos
(P200,000), shall be imposed on any person who is
155.1. or this subsection are committed found guilty of committing any of the acts
regardless of whether there is actual sale of mentioned in Section 155, Section 168 and
goods or services using the infringing material. Subsection 169.1. (Arts. 188 and 189, Revised
(Sec. 22, RA No 166a) Penal Code)

Sec. 156. Actions, and Damages and Injunction Sec. 159. Limitations to Actions for Infringement. -
for Infringement. - Notwithstanding any other provision of this Act, the
remedies given to the owner of a right infringed
156.1. The owner of a registered mark may under this Act shall be limited as follows:
recover damages from any person who
infringes his rights, and the measure of the 159.1. Notwithstanding the provisions of
damages suffered shall be either the Section 155 hereof, a registered mark shall
reasonable profit which the complaining party have no effect against any person who, in good
would have made, had the defendant not faith, before the filing date or the priority date,
infringed his rights, or the profit which the was using the mark for the purposes of his
defendant actually made out of the business or enterprise: Provided, That his right
infringement, or in the event such measure of may only be transferred or assigned together
damages cannot be readily ascertained with with his enterprise or business or with that part
reasonable certainty, then the court may award of his enterprise or business in which the mark
as damages a reasonable percentage based is used.
upon the amount of gross sales of the
defendant or the value of the services in 159.2. Where an infringer who is engaged
connection with which the mark or trade name solely in the business of printing the mark or
was used in the infringement of the rights of other infringing materials for others is an
the complaining party. (Sec. 23, First Par., RA innocent infringer, the owner of the right
166a) infringed shall be entitled as against such
infringer only to an injunction against future
156.2. On application of the complainant, the printing.
court may impound during the pendency of the
action, sales invoices and other documents 159.3. Where the infringement complained of
evidencing sales. is contained in or is part of paid advertisement
156.3. In cases where actual intent to mislead in a newspaper, magazine, or other similar
the public or to defraud the complainant is periodical or in an electronic communication,
shown, in the discretion of the court, the the remedies of the owner of the right infringed
damages may be doubled. (Sec. 23, First Par., as against the publisher or distributor of such
RA 166) newspaper, magazine, or other similar
periodical or electronic communication shall be
156.4. The complainant, upon proper showing, limited to an injunction against the
may also be granted injunction. (Sec. 23, presentation of such advertising matter in
Second Par., RA 166a) future issues of such newspapers, magazines,
or other similar periodicals or in future
Sec. 157. Power of Court to Order Infringing transmissions of such electronic
Material Destroyed. - communications. The limitations of this
subparagraph shall apply only to innocent
157.1. In any action arising under this Act, in infringers: Provided, That such injunctive relief
which a violation of any right of the owner of shall not be available to the owner of the right
the registered mark is established, the court infringed with respect to an issue of a
may order that goods found to be infringing be, newspaper, magazine, or other similar
without compensation of any sort, disposed of periodical or an electronic communication
outside the channels of commerce in such a containing infringing matter where restraining
manner as to avoid any harm caused to the the dissemination of such infringing matter in
right holder, or destroyed; and all labels, signs, any particular issue of such periodical or in an
prints, packages, wrappers, receptacles and electronic communication would delay the
advertisements in the possession of the delivery of such issue or transmission of such
defendant, bearing the registered mark or electronic communication is customarily
trade name or any reproduction, counterfeit, conducted in accordance with the sound
copy or colorable imitation thereof, all plates, business practice, and not due to any method
molds, matrices and other means of making or device adopted to evade this section or to
the same, shall be delivered up and destroyed. prevent or delay the issuance of an injunction
or restraining order with respect to such
157.2. In regard to counterfeit goods, the infringing matter.
simple removal of the trademark affixed shall
not be sufficient other than in exceptional cases
which shall be determined by the Regulations, Mighty Corporation v. E. & J. Gallo Winery,
to permit the release of the goods into the 434 SCRA 473 [2004]
channels of commerce. (Sec. 24, RA 166a).
A crucial issue in any trademark infringement case
is the likelihood of confusion, mistake or deceit as

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 345 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

to the identity, source or origin of the goods or committed with knowledge that such imitation is
identity of the business as a consequence of using likely to cause confusion, or to cause mistake, or to
a certain mark. Likelihood of confusion is deceive. Such knowledge is presumed if the
admittedly a relative term, to be determined rigidly registrant gives notice that his mark is registered
according to the particular (and sometimes by displaying with the mark the words "Registered
peculiar) circumstances of each case. In Mark" or the letter R within a circle or if the
determining likelihood of confusion, the court must defendant had otherwise actual notice of the
consider: [a] the resemblance between the registration. (Sec. 21, RA 166a)
trademarks; [b] the similarity of the goods to
which the trademarks are attached; [c] the likely 9. Unfair Competition
effect on the purchaser; and [d] the registrants
express or implied consent and other fair and Sec. 168. Unfair Competition, Rights, Regulation
equitable considerations. and Remedies. -
McDonalds Corporation v. L.C. Big Mak 168.1. A person who has identified in the mind
Burger, Inc., et al., 437 SCRA 10 [2004] of the public the goods he manufactures or
deals in, his business or services from those of
To establish trademark infringement, the following others, whether or not a registered mark is
elements must be shown: [1] the validity of the employed, has a property right in the goodwill
mark; [2] the plaintiffs ownership of the mark; of the said goods, business or services so
and [3] the use of the mark or its colorable identified, which will be protected in the same
imitation by the alleged infringer results in manner as other property rights.
likelihood of confusion. Of these, it is the element
of likelihood of confusion that is the gravamen of 168.2. Any person who shall employ deception
trademark infringement. Two types of confusion or any other means contrary to good faith by
arise from the use of similar or colorable imitation which he shall pass off the goods manufactured
marks, namely, confusion of goods (product by him or in which he deals, or his business, or
confusion) and confusion of business (source or services for those of the one having established
origin confusion). While there is confusion of goods such goodwill, or who shall commit any acts
when the products are competing, confusion of calculated to produce said result, shall be guilty
business exists when the products are non- of unfair competition, and shall be subject to an
competing but related enough to produce confusion action therefor.
of affiliation.
168.3. In particular, and without in any way
Canon Kabushiki Kaisha v. CA, et al., 336 limiting the scope of protection against unfair
SCRA 266 [2000] competition, the following shall be deemed
guilty of unfair competition:
The likelihood of confusion of goods or business is a
relative concept, to be determined according to the (a) Any person, who is selling his goods
particular, and sometimes peculiar, circumstances and gives them the general
of each case. In cases of confusion of business or appearance of goods of another
origin, the question that usually arises is whether manufacturer or dealer, either as to
the respective goods or services of the senior user the goods themselves or in the
and the junior user are so related as to likely cause wrapping of the packages in which
confusion of business or origin, and thereby render they are contained, or the devices or
the trademark or tradenames confusingly similar. words thereon, or in any other feature
Goods are related when they belong to the same of their appearance, which would be
class or have the same descriptive properties; likely to influence purchasers to
when they possess the same physical attributes or believe that the goods offered are
essential characteristics with reference to their those of a manufacturer or dealer,
form, composition, texture or quality. They may other than the actual manufacturer or
also be related because they serve the same dealer, or who otherwise clothes the
purpose or are sold through the same channels of goods with such appearance as shall
distribution. deceive the public and defraud
another of his legitimate trade, or any
Samson v. Daway, 434 SCRA 612 [2004] subsequent vendor of such goods or
any agent of any vendor engaged in
R.A. No. 8293 and R.A. No. 166 are special laws selling such goods with a like purpose;
conferring jurisdiction over violations of intellectual (b) Any person who by any artifice, or
property rights to the Regional Trial Court. They device, or who employs any other
should therefore prevail over R.A. No. 7691, which means calculated to induce the false
is a general law. Hence, jurisdiction is properly belief that such person is offering the
lodged with the Regional Trial Court even if the services of another who has identified
penalty therefore is imprisonment of less than six such services in the mind of the
years, or from 2 to 5 years and a fine ranging from public; or
P50,000 to P200,000. (c) Any person who shall make any false
statement in the course of trade or
who shall commit any other act
8.1. Notice Requirement contrary to good faith of a nature
calculated to discredit the goods,
Sec. 158. Damages; Requirement of Notice. - In business or services of another.
any suit for infringement, the owner of the
registered mark shall not be entitled to recover
profits or damages unless the acts have been

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 346 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

168.4. The remedies provided by Sections Chapter V.


156, 157 and 161 shall apply mutatis
mutandis. (Sec. 29, RA 166a) COPYRIGHTS

1. Basic Principles
Del Monte Corporation, et al. v. CA, 181 SCRA
410 [1990]
1. Works are protected by the sole fact of their
The following are the distinctions between creation.
infringement of trademark and unfair competition: Sec. 172.2. Works are protected by the sole
1. Infringement of trademark is the fact of their creation, irrespective of their mode
unauthorized use of a trademark, whereas or form of expression, as well as of their
unfair competition is the passing off of content, quality and purpose. (Sec. 2, PD No.
ones goods as those of another. 49a)
2. In infringement of trademark, fraudulent
intent is unnecessary, whereas in unfair 2. Protection extends only to the expression of an
competition fraudulent intent is essential. idea, not the idea itself.
3. In infringement of trademark the prior
registration of the trademark is a Sec. 175. Unprotected Subject Matter. -
prerequisite to the action, whereas in unfair Notwithstanding the provisions of Sections 172 and
competition registration is not necessary. 173, no protection shall extend, under this law, to
any idea, procedure, system method or operation,
concept, principle, discovery or mere data as such,
Mighty Corporation v. E. & J. Gallo Winery, even if they are expressed, explained, illustrated or
434 SCRA 473 [2004] embodied in a work; xxx xxx xxx

The law on unfair competition is broader and more 2. Definition


inclusive than the law on trademark infringement.
The latter is more limited but it recognizes a more Sec. 177. Copy or Economic Rights. - Subject to
exclusive right derived from the trademark the provisions of Chapter VIII, copyright or
adoption and registration by the person whose economic rights shall consist of the exclusive right
goods or business is first associated with it. Hence, to carry out, authorize or prevent the following
even if one fails to establish his exclusive property acts:
right to a trademark, he may still obtain relief on
the ground of his competitors unfairness or fraud. 177.1. Reproduction of the work or substantial
Conduct constitutes unfair competition if the effect portion of the work;
is to pass off on the public the goods of one man as
the goods of another. 177.2. Dramatization, translation, adaptation,
abridgment, arrangement or other
transformation of the work;
McDonalds Corporation v. L.C. Big Mak
Burger, Inc., et al., 437 SCRA 10 [2004] 177.3. The first public distribution of the
original and each copy of the work by sale or
The elements of an action for unfair competition other forms of transfer of ownership;
are: [1] confusing similarity in the general
appearance of the goods, and [2] intent to deceive 177.4. Rental of the original or a copy of an
the public and defraud a competitor. The confusing audiovisual or cinematographic work, a work
similarity may or may not result from similarity in embodied in a sound recording, a computer
the marks, but may result from other external program, a compilation of data and other
factors in the packaging or presentation of the materials or a musical work in graphic form,
goods. The intent to deceive and defraud may be irrespective of the ownership of the original or
inferred from the similarity in appearance of the the copy which is the subject of the rental;
goods as offered for sale to the public. Actual
fraudulent intent need not be shown. 177.5. Public display of the original or a copy
of the work;
Caterpillar, Inc v. Samson (2006)
177.6. Public performance of the work; and
An action for unfair competition is based on the
proposition that no dealer in merchandise should 177.7. Other communication to the public of
be allowed to dress his goods in simulation of the the work (Sec. 5, PD No. 49a)
goods of another dealer, so that purchasers
desiring to buy the goods of the latter would be 3. Copyrightable Works
induced to buy the goods of the former. The most
usual devices employed in committing this crime Sec. 172. Literary and Artistic Works. -
are the simulation of labels and the reproduction of
form, color and general appearance of the package 172.1. Literary and artistic works, hereinafter
used by the pioneer manufacturer or dealer. referred to as "works", are original intellectual
creations in the literary and artistic domain
protected from the moment of their creation
and shall include in particular:

(a) Books, pamphlets, articles and other


writings;
(b) Periodicals and newspapers;

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 347 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

(c) Lectures, sermons, addresses, 3.1. Format of a show not copyrightable


dissertations prepared for oral
delivery, whether or not reduced in Joaquin, Jr., et al. v. Drilon, et al., 302 SCRA
writing or other material form; 225 [1999]
(d) Letters;
(e) Dramatic or dramatico-musical The format of a show is not copyrightable. Section
compositions; choreographic works 2 of PD No. 49, otherwise known as the Decree on
or entertainment in dumb shows; Intellectual Property, enumerates the classes of
(f) Musical compositions, with or without work entitled to copyright protection. This provision
words; is substantially the same as Section 172 of the
(g) Works of drawing, painting, Intellectual Property Code (R.A. No. 8293). The
architecture, sculpture, engraving, format or mechanics of a television show is not
lithography or other works of art; included in the list of protected works. For this
models or designs for works of art; reason, the protection afforded by the law cannot
(h) Original ornamental designs or be extended to cover them. Copyright, in the strict
models for articles of manufacture, sense of the term, is purely a statutory right.
whether or not registrable as an Being a statutory grant, the rights are only such as
industrial design, and other works of the statute confers, and may be obtained and
applied art; enjoyed only with respect to the subjects and by
(i) Illustrations, maps, plans, sketches, the persons, and on terms and conditions specified
charts and three-dimensional works in the statute.
relative to geography, topography,
architecture or science; 4. Non-copyrightable Works (175, 176)
(j) Drawings or plastic works of a
scientific or technical character; Sec. 175. Unprotected Subject Matter. -
(k) Photographic works including works Notwithstanding the provisions of Sections 172 and
produced by a process analogous to 173, no protection shall extend, under this law, to
photography; lantern slides; any idea, procedure, system method or operation,
(l) Audiovisual works and concept, principle, discovery or mere data as such,
cinematographic works and works even if they are expressed, explained, illustrated or
produced by a process analogous to embodied in a work; news of the day and other
cinematography or any process for miscellaneous facts having the character of mere
making audio-visual recordings; items of press information; or any official text of a
(m) Pictorial illustrations and legislative, administrative or legal nature, as well
advertisements; as any official translation thereof.
(n) Computer programs; and
(o) Other literary, scholarly, scientific Sec. 176. Works of the Government. -
and artistic works.
176.1. No copyright shall subsist in any work
Sec. 173. Derivative Works. - of the Government of the Philippines. However,
prior approval of the government agency or
173.1. The following derivative works shall office wherein the work is created shall be
also be protected by copyright: necessary for exploitation of such work for
profit. Such agency or office may, among other
(a) Dramatizations, translations, things, impose as a condition the payment of
adaptations, abridgments, royalties. No prior approval or conditions shall
arrangements, and other alterations be required for the use of any purpose of
of literary or artistic works; and statutes, rules and regulations, and speeches,
(b) Collections of literary, scholarly or lectures, sermons, addresses, and
artistic works, and compilations of dissertations, pronounced, read or rendered in
data and other materials which are courts of justice, before administrative
original by reason of the selection or agencies, in deliberative assemblies and in
coordination or arrangement of their meetings of public character. (Sec. 9, First
contents. (Sec. 2, [P] and [Q], PD Par., PD No. 49)
No. 49)
176.2. The Author of speeches, lectures,
173.2. The works referred to in paragraphs (a) sermons, addresses, and dissertations
and (b) of Subsection 173.1 shall be protected mentioned in the preceding paragraphs shall
as a new works: Provided however, That such have the exclusive right of making a collection
new work shall not affect the force of any of his works.
subsisting copyright upon the original works 176.3. Notwithstanding the foregoing
employed or any part thereof, or be construed provisions, the Government is not precluded
to imply any right to such use of the original from receiving and holding copyrights
works, or to secure or extend copyright in such transferred to it by assignment, bequest or
original works. (Sec. 8, PD 49; Art. 10, TRIPS) otherwise; nor shall publication or republication
by the government in a public document of any
Sec. 174. Published Edition of Work. - In addition work in which copy right is subsisting be taken
to the right to publish granted by the author, his to cause any abridgment or annulment of the
heirs or assigns, the publisher shall have a copy copyright or to authorize any use or
right consisting merely of the right of reproduction appropriation of such work without the consent
of the typographical arrangement of the published of the copyright owners. (Sec. 9, Third Par., PD
edition of the work. No. 49)

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 348 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

5. Standard for Copyright Protection lifetime of the author and for fifty (50) years after
his death. (Sec. 31, PD No. 49)
Ching Kian Chuan v. Court of Appeals, 363
SCRA 142 [2001] Sec. 201. Works Not Covered. - The provisions of
this Chapter shall not apply to prints, etchings,
A person to be entitled to a copyright must be the engravings, works of applied art, or works of
original creator of the work. He must have created similar kind wherein the author primarily derives
it by his own skill, labor, and judgment without gain from the proceeds of reproductions. (Sec. 33,
directly copying or evasively imitating the work of PD No. 49)
another.
8. Moral Rights
Ching v Salinas (2005)
Sec. 193. Scope of Moral Rights. - The author of a
Ownership of copyrighted material is shown by work shall, independently of the economic rights in
proof of originality and copyrightability. By Section 177 or the grant of an assignment or
originality is meant that the material was not license with respect to such right, have the right:
copied, and evidences at least minimal creativity;
that it was independently created by the author 193.1. To require that the authorship of the
and that it possesses at least same minimal degree works be attributed to him, in particular, the
of creativity. Copying is shown by proof of access right that his name, as far as practicable, be
to copyrighted material and substantial similarity indicated in a prominent way on the copies,
between the two works. The applicant must thus and in connection with the public use of his
demonstrate the existence and the validity of his work;
copyright because in the absence of copyright
protection, even original creation may be freely 193.2. To make any alterations of his work
copied. prior to, or to withhold it from publication;

6. Economic Rights 193.3. To object to any distortion, mutilation


or other modification of, or other derogatory
Sec. 177. Copy or Economic Rights. - Subject to action in relation to, his work which would be
the provisions of Chapter VIII, copyright or prejudicial to his honor or reputation; and
economic rights shall consist of the exclusive right
to carry out, authorize or prevent the following 193.4. To restrain the use of his name with
acts: respect to any work not of his own creation or
in a distorted version of his work. (Sec. 34, PD
177.1. Reproduction of the work or substantial No. 49)
portion of the work;
9. Ownership of Copyright
177.2. Dramatization, translation, adaptation,
abridgment, arrangement or other Sec. 178. Rules on Copyright Ownership. -
transformation of the work; Copyright ownership shall be governed by the
following rules:
177.3. The first public distribution of the
original and each copy of the work by sale or 178.1. Subject to the provisions of this
other forms of transfer of ownership; section, in the case of original literary and
artistic works, copyright shall belong to the
177.4. Rental of the original or a copy of an author of the work;
audiovisual or cinematographic work, a work
embodied in a sound recording, a computer 178.2. In the case of works of joint authorship,
program, a compilation of data and other the co-authors shall be the original owners of
materials or a musical work in graphic form, the copyright and in the absence of agreement,
irrespective of the ownership of the original or their rights shall be governed by the rules on
the copy which is the subject of the rental; co-ownership. If, however, a work of joint
authorship consists of parts that can be used
177.5. Public display of the original or a copy separately and the author of each part can be
of the work; identified, the author of each part shall be the
original owner of the copyright in the part that
177.6. Public performance of the work; and he has created;

177.7. Other communication to the public of 178.3. In the case of work created by an
the work (Sec. 5, PD No. 49a) author during and in the course of his
employment, the copyright shall belong to:
7. Droit de Suite
(a) The employee, if the creation of the
Sec. 200. Sale or Lease of Work. - In every sale or object of copyright is not a part of his
lease of an original work of painting or sculpture or regular duties even if the employee
of the original manuscript of a writer or composer, uses the time, facilities and materials
subsequent to the first disposition thereof by the of the employer.
author, the author or his heirs shall have an (b) The employer, if the work is the result
inalienable right to participate in the gross of the performance of his regularly-
proceeds of the sale or lease to the extent of five assigned duties, unless there is an
percent (5%). This right shall exist during the agreement, express or implied, to the
contrary.

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 349 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

That the source is clearly indicated;


178.4. In the case of a work-commissioned by (Sec. 11, PD No. 49)
a person other than an employer of the author (d) The reproduction and communication
and who pays for it and the work is made in to the public of literary, scientific or
pursuance of the commission, the person who artistic works as part of reports of
so commissioned the work shall have current events by means of
ownership of work, but the copyright thereto photography, cinematography or
shall remain with the creator, unless there is a broadcasting to the extent necessary
written stipulation to the contrary; for the purpose; (Sec. 12, PD No. 49)
(e) The inclusion of a work in a
178.5. In the case of audiovisual work, the publication, broadcast, or other
copyright shall belong to the producer, the communication to the public, sound
author of the scenario, the composer of the recording or film, if such inclusion is
music, the film director, and the author of the made by way of illustration for
work so adapted. However, subject to contrary teaching purposes and is compatible
or other stipulations among the creators, the with fair use: Provided, That the
producers shall exercise the copyright to an source and of the name of the
extent required for the exhibition of the work in author, if appearing in the work, are
any manner, except for the right to collect mentioned;
performing license fees for the performance of (f) The recording made in schools,
musical compositions, with or without words, universities, or educational
which are incorporated into the work; and institutions of a work included in a
broadcast for the use of such
178.6. In respect of letters, the copyright shall schools, universities or educational
belong to the writer subject to the provisions of institutions: Provided, That such
Article 723 of the Civil Code. (Sec. 6, PD No. recording must be deleted within a
49a) reasonable period after they were
first broadcast: Provided, further,
Sec. 179. Anonymous and Pseudonymous Works. - That such recording may not be
For purposes of this Act, the publishers shall be made from audiovisual works which
deemed to represent the authors of articles and are part of the general cinema
other writings published without the names of the repertoire of feature films except for
authors or under pseudonyms, unless the contrary brief excerpts of the work;
appears, or the pseudonyms or adopted name (g) The making of ephemeral recordings
leaves no doubts as to the authors identity, or if by a broadcasting organization by
the author of the anonymous works discloses his means of its own facilities and for
identity. (Sec. 7, PD 49) use in its own broadcast;
(h) The use made of a work by or under
the direction or control of the
10. Limitations on Copyright Government, by the National Library
or by educational, scientific or
Sec. 184. Limitations on Copyright. - professional institutions where such
use is in the public interest and is
184.1. Notwithstanding the provisions of compatible with fair use;
Chapter V, the following acts shall not (i) The public performance or the
constitute infringement of copyright: communication to the public of a
work, in a place where no admission
(a) the recitation or performance of a fee is charged in respect of such
work, once it has been lawfully made public performance or
accessible to the public, if done communication, by a club or
privately and free of charge or if institution for charitable or
made strictly for a charitable or educational purpose only, whose aim
religious institution or society; (Sec. is not profit making, subject to such
10(1), PD No. 49) other limitations as may be provided
(b) The making of quotations from a in the Regulations;
published work if they are compatible (j) Public display of the original or a
with fair use and only to the extent copy of the work not made by means
justified for the purpose, including of a film, slide, television image or
quotations from newspaper articles otherwise on screen or by means of
and periodicals in the form of press any other device or process:
summaries: Provided, That the Provided, That either the work has
source and the name of the author, if been published, or, that original or
appearing on the work, are the copy displayed has been sold,
mentioned; (Sec. 11, Third Par., PD given away or otherwise transferred
No. 49) to another person by the author or
(c) The reproduction or communication his successor in title; and
to the public by mass media of (k) Any use made of a work for the
articles on current political, social, purpose of any judicial proceedings
economic, scientific or religious topic, or for the giving of professional
lectures, addresses and other works advice by a legal practitioner.
of the same nature, which are
delivered in public if such use is for 184.2. The provisions of this section shall
information purposes and has not be interpreted in such a way as to allow the
been expressly reserved: Provided, work to be used in a manner which does

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 350 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

not conflict with the normal exploitation of library which, by law, is entitled to receive
the work and does not unreasonably copies of a printed work, shall be entitled,
prejudice the right holder's legitimate when special reasons so require, to reproduce a
interest. copy of a published work which is considered
necessary for the collection of the library but
Sec. 187. Reproduction of Published Work. - which is out of stock. (Sec. 13, PD 49a)

187.1. Notwithstanding the provision of Sec. 189. Reproduction of Computer Program.


Section 177, and subject to the provisions of
Subsection 187.2, the private reproduction of a 189.1. Notwithstanding the provisions of
published work in a single copy, where the Section 177, the reproduction in one (1) back-
reproduction is made by a natural person up copy or adaptation of a computer program
exclusively for research and private study, shall shall be permitted, without the authorization of
be permitted, without the authorization of the the author of, or other owner of copyright in, a
owner of copyright in the work. computer program, by the lawful owner of that
computer program: Provided, That the copy or
187.2. The permission granted under adaptation is necessary for:
Subsection 187.1 shall not extend to the
reproduction of: (a) The use of the computer program in
conjunction with a computer for the
(a) A work of architecture in form of purpose, and to the extent, for which
building or other construction; the computer program has been
(b) An entire book, or a substantial past obtained; and
thereof, or of a musical work in which (b) Archival purposes, and, for the
graphics form by reprographic means; replacement of the lawfully owned copy
(c) A compilation of data and other of the computer program in the event
materials; that the lawfully obtained copy of the
(d) A computer program except as computer program is lost, destroyed or
provided in Section 189; and rendered unusable.
(e) Any work in cases where reproduction
would unreasonably conflict with a 189.2. No copy or adaptation mentioned in this
normal exploitation of the work or Section shall be used for any purpose other
would otherwise unreasonably than the ones determined in this Section, and
prejudice the legitimate interests of the any such copy or adaptation shall be destroyed
author. in the event that continued possession of the
copy of the computer program ceases to be
Sec. 188. Reprographic Reproduction by Libraries. lawful.
-
189.3. This provision shall be without prejudice
188.1. Notwithstanding the provisions of to the application of Section 185 whenever
Subsection 177.6, any library or archive whose appropriate.
activities are not for profit may, without the
authorization of the author of copyright owner, Sec. 190. Importation for Personal Purposes. -
make a single copy of the work by reprographic
reproduction: 190.1. Notwithstanding the provision of
Subsection 177.6, but subject to the limitation
(a) Where the work by reason of its fragile under the Subsection 185.2, the importation of
character or rarity cannot be lent to a copy of a work by an individual for his
user in its original form; personal purposes shall be permitted without
(b) Where the works are isolated articles the authorization of the author of, or other
contained in composite works or brief owner of copyright in, the work under the
portions of other published works and following circumstances:
the reproduction is necessary to
supply them; when this is considered (a) When copies of the work are not
expedient, to person requesting their available in the Philippines and:
loan for purposes of research or study
instead of lending the volumes or 1) Not more than one (1) copy at
booklets which contain them; and one time is imported for strictly
(c) Where the making of such a copy is in individual use only; or
order to preserve and, if necessary in 2) The importation is by authority of
the event that it is lost, destroyed or and for the use of the Philippine
rendered unusable, replace a copy, or Government; or
to replace, in the permanent collection 3) The importation, consisting of not
of another similar library or archive, a more than three (3) such copies
copy which has been lost, destroyed or likenesses in any one invoice,
or rendered unusable and copies are is not for sale but for the use only
not available with the publisher. of any religious, charitable, or
educational society or institution
188.2. Notwithstanding the above provisions, duly incorporated or registered,
it shall not be permissible to produce a volume or is for the encouragement of
of a work published in several volumes or to the fine arts, or for any state
produce missing tomes or pages of magazines school, college, university, or free
or similar works, unless the volume, tome or public library in the Philippines.
part is out of stock; Provided, That every

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 351 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

(b) When such copies form parts of 13. Duration of Copyright


libraries and personal baggage
belonging to persons or families Sec. 213. Term of Protection. - 213.1. Subject to
arriving from foreign countries and are the provisions of Subsections 213.2 to 213.5, the
not intended for sale: Provided, That copyright in works under Sections 172 and 173
such copies do not exceed three (3). shall be protected during the life of the author and
for fifty (50 years after his death. This rule also
190.2. Copies imported as allowed by this applies to posthumous works. (Sec. 21, First
Section may not lawfully be used in any way to Sentence, PD No. 49a)
violate the rights of owner the copyright or
annul or limit the protection secured by this 213.2. In case of works of joint authorship, the
Act, and such unlawful use shall be deemed an economic rights shall be protected during the
infringement and shall be punishable as such life of the last surviving author and for fifty
without prejudice to the proprietors right of (50) years after his death. (Sec. 21, Second
action. Sentence, PD No. 49)
190.3. Subject to the approval of the 213.3. In case of anonymous or
Secretary of Finance, the Commissioner of pseudonymous works, the copyright shall be
Customs is hereby empowered to make rules protected for fifty (50) years from the date on
and regulations for preventing the importation which the work was first lawfully published:
of articles the importation of which is prohibited Provided, That where, before the expiration of
under this Section and under treaties and the said period, the author's identity is revealed
conventions to which the Philippines may be a or is no longer in doubt, the provisions of
party and for seizing and condemning and Subsections 213.1 and 213.2 shall apply, as
disposing of the same in case they are the case may be: Provided, further, That such
discovered after they have been imported. works if not published before shall be protected
(Sec. 30, PD No. 49) for fifty (50) years counted from the making of
the work. (Sec. 23, PD No. 49)
11. Doctrine of Fair Use
213.4. In case of works of applied art the
Sec. 185. Fair Use of a Copyrighted Work. - protection shall be for a period of twenty-five
(25) years from the date of making. (Sec.
185.1. The fair use of a copyrighted work for 24(B), PD No. 49a)
criticism, comment, news reporting, teaching
including multiple copies for classroom use, 213.5. In case of photographic works, the
scholarship, research, and similar purposes is protection shall be for fifty (50) years from
not an infringement of copyright. publication of the work and, if unpublished, fifty
Decompilation, which is understood here to be (50) years from the making. (Sec. 24(C), PD
the reproduction of the code and translation of 49a)
the forms of the computer program to achieve
the inter-operability of an independently 213.6. In case of audio-visual works including
created computer program with other programs those produced by process analogous to
may also constitute fair use. In determining photography or any process for making audio-
whether the use made of a work in any visual recordings, the term shall be fifty (50)
particular case is fair use, the factors to be years from date of publication and, if
considered shall include: unpublished, from the date of making. (Sec.
24(C), PD No. 49a)
(a) The purpose and character of the
use, including whether such use is of Sec. 214. Calculation of Term. - The term of
a commercial nature or is for non- protection subsequent to the death of the author
profit education purposes; provided in the preceding Section shall run from
(b) The nature of the copyrighted work; the date of his death or of publication, but such
(c) The amount and substantiality of the terms shall always be deemed to begin on the first
portion used in relation to the day of January of the year following the event
copyrighted work as a whole; and which gave rise to them. (Sec. 25, PD No. 49)
(d) The effect of the use upon the
potential market for or value of the 14. Transfer and Assignment of Copyright
copyrighted work.
Sec. 180. Rights of Assignee. -
185.2. The fact that a work is unpublished
shall not by itself bar a finding of fair use if 180.1. The copyright may be assigned in whole
such finding is made upon consideration of all or in part. Within the scope of the assignment,
the above factors. the assignee is entitled to all the rights and
remedies which the assignor had with respect
12. Notice of Copyright to the copyright.

Sec. 192. Notice of Copyright. - Each copy of a 180.2. The copyright is not deemed assigned
work published or offered for sale may contain a inter vivos in whole or in part unless there is a
notice bearing the name of the copyright owner, written indication of such intention.
and the year of its first publication, and, in copies
produced after the creators death, the year of such 180.3. The submission of a literary,
death. (Sec. 27, PD No. 49a) photographic or artistic work to a newspaper,
magazine or periodical for publication shall

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 352 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

constitute only a license to make a single


publication unless a greater right is expressly Sec. 208. Scope of Right. - Subject to the
granted. If two (2) or more persons jointly own provisions of Section 212, producers of sound
a copyright or any part thereof, neither of the recordings shall enjoy the following exclusive
owners shall be entitled to grant licenses rights:
without the prior written consent of the other
owner or owners. (Sec. 15, PD No. 49a) 208.1. The right to authorize the direct or
indirect reproduction of their sound recordings,
Sec. 181. Copyright and Material Object. - The in any manner or form; the placing of these
copyright is distinct from the property in the reproductions in the market and the right of
material object subject to it. Consequently, the rental or lending;
transfer or assignment of the copyright shall not
itself constitute a transfer of the material object. 208.2. The right to authorize the first public
Nor shall a transfer or assignment of the sole copy distribution of the original and copies of their
or of one or several copies of the work imply sound recordings through sale or rental or
transfer or assignment of the copyright. (Sec. 16, other forms of transferring ownership; and
PD No. 49)
208.3. The right to authorize the commercial
Sec. 182. Filing of Assignment of License. - An rental to the public of the original and copies of
assignment or exclusive license may be filed in their sound recordings, even after distribution
duplicate with the National Library upon payment by them by or pursuant to authorization by the
of the prescribed fee for registration in books and producer. (Sec. 46, PD No. 49a)
records kept for the purpose. Upon recording, a
copy of the instrument shall be, returned to the Sec. 211. Scope of Right. - Subject to the
sender with a notation of the fact of record. Notice provisions of Section 212, broadcasting
of the record shall be published in the IPO Gazette. organizations shall enjoy the exclusive right to
(Sec. 19, PD No. 49a) carry out, authorize or prevent any of the following
acts:
Sec. 183. Designation of Society. - The copyright
owners or their heirs may designate a society of 211.1. The rebroadcasting of their broadcasts;
artists, writers or composers to enforce their
economic rights and moral rights on their behalf. 211.2. The recording in any manner, including
(Sec. 32, PD No. 49a) the making of films or the use of video tape, of
their broadcasts for the purpose of
15. Neighboring Rights communication to the public of television
broadcasts of the same; and
Sec. 203. Scope of Performers' Rights. - Subject to
the provisions of Section 212, performers shall 211.3. The use of such records for fresh
enjoy the following exclusive rights: transmissions or for fresh recording. (Sec. 52,
PD No. 49)
203.1. As regards their performances, the
right of authorizing: Sec. 215. Term of Protection for Performers,
Producers and Broadcasting Organizations.-
(a) The broadcasting and other
communication to the public of their 215.1. The rights granted to performers and
performance; and producers of sound recordings under this law
(b) The fixation of their unfixed shall expire:
performance.
(a) For performances not incorporated in
203.2. The right of authorizing the direct or recordings, fifty (50) years from the
indirect reproduction of their performances end of the year in which the
fixed in sound recordings, in any manner or performance took place; and
form; (b) For sound or image and sound
recordings and for performances
203.3. Subject to the provisions of Section incorporated therein, fifty (50) years
206, the right of authorizing the first public from the end of the year in which the
distribution of the original and copies of their recording took place.
performance fixed in the sound recording
through sale or rental or other forms of transfer 215.2. In case of broadcasts, the term shall be
of ownership; twenty (20) years from the date the broadcast
took place. The extended term shall be applied
203.4. The right of authorizing the commercial only to old works with subsisting protection
rental to the public of the original and copies of under the prior law. (Sec. 55, PD 49a)
their performances fixed in sound recordings,
even after distribution of them by, or pursuant 16. Infringement
to the authorization by the performer; and
Habana, et al., v. Robles, et al., 310 SCRA 511
203.5. The right of authorizing the making [1999]
available to the public of their performances
fixed in sound recordings, by wire or wireless Infringement consists in the doing by any person,
means, in such a way that members of the without the consent of the owner of the copyright,
public may access them from a place and time of anything the sole right to do which is conferred
individually chosen by them. (Sec. 42, PD No. by statute on the owner of the copyright. The act of
49a) lifting from anothers book substantial portions of

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 353 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

discussions and examples and the failure to lieu of actual damages and
acknowledge the same is an infringement of profits, such damages which to
copyright. For there to be substantial reproduction the court shall appear to be just
of a book it does not necessarily require that the and shall not be regarded as
entire copyrighted work, or even a large portion of penalty.
it, be copied. If so much is taken that the value of (c) Deliver under oath, for
the original work is substantially diminished, there impounding during the pendency
is an infringement of copyright and to an injurious of the action, upon such terms
extent, the work is appropriated. It is no defense and conditions as the court may
that the pirate did not know whether or not he was prescribe, sales invoices and
infringing any copyright; he at least knew that other documents evidencing
what he was copying was not his, and he copied at sales, all articles and their
his peril. In cases of infringement, copying alone is packaging alleged to infringe a
not what is prohibited. The copying must produce copyright and implements for
an injurious effect. making them.
(d) Deliver under oath for
Columbia Picture Entertainment, Inc v CA destruction without any
compensation all infringing
It is evidently incorrect to suggest, as the ruling in copies or devices, as well as all
20th Century Fox may appear to do, that in plates, molds, or other means for
copyright infringement cases, the presentation of making such infringing copies as
master tapes of the copyrighted films is always the court may order.
necessary to meet the requirement of probable (e) Such other terms and conditions,
cause and that, in the absence thereof, there can including the payment of moral
be no finding of probable cause for the issuance of and exemplary damages, which
a search warrant. It is true that such master tapes the court may deem proper, wise
are object evidence, with the merit that in this and equitable and the destruction
class of evidence the ascertainment of the of infringing copies of the work
controverted fact is made through demonstrations even in the event of acquittal in a
involving the direct use of the senses of the criminal case.
presiding magistrate. (City of Manila v. Cabangis,
10 Phil. 151 [1908]; Kabase v. State, 31 Ala. App. 216. 2. In an infringement action, the
77, 12 So. 2ND, 758, 764). Such auxiliary court shall also have the power to order the
procedure, however, does not rule out the use of seizure and impounding of any article which
testimonial or documentary evidence, depositions, may serve as evidence in the court
admissions, or other classes of evidence tending to proceedings. (Sec. 28, PD 49a)
prove the factum probandum (See Phil. Movie
Workers Association v. Premiere Productions, Inc.,
92 Phil. 843 [1953]) especially where the 17.2. Criminal Action
production in court of object evidence would result
in delay, inconvenience or expenses out of Sec. 217. Criminal Penalties. -
proportion to its evidentiary value.
217. 1. Any person infringing any right
17. Remedies for Infringement secured by provisions of Part IV of this Act
or aiding or abetting such infringement
17.1. Civil Action shall be guilty of a crime punishable by:

Sec. 216. Remedies for Infringement. - (a) Imprisonment of one (1) year to
three (3) years plus a fine ranging
216.1. Any person infringing a right from Fifty thousand pesos
protected under this law shall be liable: (P50,000) to One hundred fifty
thousand pesos (P150,000) for the
(a) To an injunction restraining such first offense.
infringement. The court may also (b) Imprisonment of three (3) years
order the defendant to desist and one (1) day to six (6) years
from an infringement, among plus a fine ranging from One
others, to prevent the entry into hundred fifty thousand pesos
the channels of commerce of (P150,000) to Five hundred
imported goods that involve an thousand pesos (P500,000) for the
infringement, immediately after second offense.
customs clearance of such goods. (c) Imprisonment of six (6) years and
(b) Pay to the copyright proprietor or one (1) day to nine (9) years plus a
his assigns or heirs such actual fine ranging from Five hundred
damages, including legal costs thousand pesos (P500,000) to One
and other expenses, as he may million five hundred thousand
have incurred due to the pesos (P1,500,000) for the third
infringement as well as the and subsequent offenses.
profits the infringer may have (d) In all cases, subsidiary
made due to such infringement, imprisonment in cases of
and in proving profits the plaintiff insolvency.
shall be required to prove sales
only and the defendant shall be 217. 2. In determining the number of
required to prove every element years of imprisonment and the amount of
of cost which he claims, or, in fine, the court shall consider the value of

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 354 of 355


INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE COMMERCIAL LAW

the infringing materials that the defendant the defendant does not put in issue
has produced or manufactured and the the question whether copyright
damage that the copyright owner has subsists in the work or other subject
suffered by reason of the infringement. matter; and
(b) Where the subsistence of the
217. 3. Any person who at the time when copyright is established, the plaintiff
copyright subsists in a work has in his shall be presumed to be the owner of
possession an article which he knows, or the copyright if he claims to be the
ought to know, to be an infringing copy of owner of the copyright and the
the work for the purpose of: defendant does not put in issue the
question of his ownership.
(a) Selling, letting for hire, or by way (d) Where the defendant, without good
of trade offering or exposing for faith, puts in issue the questions of
sale, or hire, the article; whether copyright subsists in a work
(b) Distributing the article for purpose or other subject matter to which the
of trade, or for any other purpose action relates, or the ownership of
to an extent that will prejudice the copyright in such work or subject
rights of the copyright owner in the matter, thereby occasioning
work; or unnecessary costs or delay in the
(c) Trade exhibit of the article in proceedings, the court may direct that
public, shall be guilty of an offense any costs to the defendant in respect
and shall be liable on conviction to of the action shall not be allowed by
imprisonment and fine as above him and that any costs occasioned by
mentioned. (Sec. 29, PD No. 49a) the defendant to other parties shall be
paid by him to such other parties.
SUMMERVILLE vs. CA (2007)
19. Presumption of Ownership
Summerville holds copyrights and patents over
ROYAL brand playing cards; it alleges that fakes Sec. 219. Presumption of Authorship. -
thereof proliferate. Stemming from a letter-
complaint, seizure of cards [CROWN brand] inside a 219.1. The natural person whose name is
[fake, allegedly] ROYAL brand plastic container, indicated on a work in the usual manner as the
and the printing machines manufacturing the cards author shall, in the absence of proof to the
were seized. contrary, be presumed to be the author of the
Are the machines and cards inside the supposedly work. This provision shall be applicable even if
infringing case proper subjects of the seizure? NO. the name is a pseudonym, where the
First, private respondents are the owners of pseudonym leaves no doubt as to the identity
copyrights and patents pertaining to the CROWN of the author.
brand. Second, the cards, and the machines are
useless to prove trademark infringement with 219.2. The person or body, corporate whose
respect to the plastic container, hence unnecessary name appears on an audio-visual work in the
to retain. usual manner shall, in the absence of proof to
the contrary, be presumed to be the maker of
18. Affidavit Evidence said work.

Sec. 218. Affidavit Evidence. -

218.1. In an action under this Chapter, an


affidavit made before a notary public by or on
behalf of the owner of the copyright in any
work or other subject matter and stating that:

(a) At the time specified therein, copyright


subsisted in the work or other subject
matter;
(b) He or the person named therein is the
owner of the copyright; and
(c) The copy of the work or other subject
matter annexed thereto is a true copy
thereof, shall be admitted in evidence
in any proceedings for an offense
under this Chapter and shall be prima
facie proof of the matters therein
stated until the contrary is proved, and
the court before which such affidavit is
produced shall assume that the
affidavit was made by or on behalf of
the owner of the copyright.

218.2. In an action under this Chapter.

(a) Copyright shall be presumed to


subsist in the work or other subject
matter to which the action relates if

100% UP L AW U P B A R O P S 2 0 0 8 Page 355 of 355

S-ar putea să vă placă și